* lisp/emacs-lisp/timer.el (with-timeout): Make sure we cancel the timer
[emacs.git] / src / xdisp.c
blob01472a6bb0293fb1db875392af4a8635c1a54235
1 /* Display generation from window structure and buffer text.
3 Copyright (C) 1985-1988, 1993-1995, 1997-2011 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
7 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
20 /* New redisplay written by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>.
22 Redisplay.
24 Emacs separates the task of updating the display from code
25 modifying global state, e.g. buffer text. This way functions
26 operating on buffers don't also have to be concerned with updating
27 the display.
29 Updating the display is triggered by the Lisp interpreter when it
30 decides it's time to do it. This is done either automatically for
31 you as part of the interpreter's command loop or as the result of
32 calling Lisp functions like `sit-for'. The C function `redisplay'
33 in xdisp.c is the only entry into the inner redisplay code.
35 The following diagram shows how redisplay code is invoked. As you
36 can see, Lisp calls redisplay and vice versa. Under window systems
37 like X, some portions of the redisplay code are also called
38 asynchronously during mouse movement or expose events. It is very
39 important that these code parts do NOT use the C library (malloc,
40 free) because many C libraries under Unix are not reentrant. They
41 may also NOT call functions of the Lisp interpreter which could
42 change the interpreter's state. If you don't follow these rules,
43 you will encounter bugs which are very hard to explain.
45 +--------------+ redisplay +----------------+
46 | Lisp machine |---------------->| Redisplay code |<--+
47 +--------------+ (xdisp.c) +----------------+ |
48 ^ | |
49 +----------------------------------+ |
50 Don't use this path when called |
51 asynchronously! |
53 expose_window (asynchronous) |
55 X expose events -----+
57 What does redisplay do? Obviously, it has to figure out somehow what
58 has been changed since the last time the display has been updated,
59 and to make these changes visible. Preferably it would do that in
60 a moderately intelligent way, i.e. fast.
62 Changes in buffer text can be deduced from window and buffer
63 structures, and from some global variables like `beg_unchanged' and
64 `end_unchanged'. The contents of the display are additionally
65 recorded in a `glyph matrix', a two-dimensional matrix of glyph
66 structures. Each row in such a matrix corresponds to a line on the
67 display, and each glyph in a row corresponds to a column displaying
68 a character, an image, or what else. This matrix is called the
69 `current glyph matrix' or `current matrix' in redisplay
70 terminology.
72 For buffer parts that have been changed since the last update, a
73 second glyph matrix is constructed, the so called `desired glyph
74 matrix' or short `desired matrix'. Current and desired matrix are
75 then compared to find a cheap way to update the display, e.g. by
76 reusing part of the display by scrolling lines.
78 You will find a lot of redisplay optimizations when you start
79 looking at the innards of redisplay. The overall goal of all these
80 optimizations is to make redisplay fast because it is done
81 frequently. Some of these optimizations are implemented by the
82 following functions:
84 . try_cursor_movement
86 This function tries to update the display if the text in the
87 window did not change and did not scroll, only point moved, and
88 it did not move off the displayed portion of the text.
90 . try_window_reusing_current_matrix
92 This function reuses the current matrix of a window when text
93 has not changed, but the window start changed (e.g., due to
94 scrolling).
96 . try_window_id
98 This function attempts to redisplay a window by reusing parts of
99 its existing display. It finds and reuses the part that was not
100 changed, and redraws the rest.
102 . try_window
104 This function performs the full redisplay of a single window
105 assuming that its fonts were not changed and that the cursor
106 will not end up in the scroll margins. (Loading fonts requires
107 re-adjustment of dimensions of glyph matrices, which makes this
108 method impossible to use.)
110 These optimizations are tried in sequence (some can be skipped if
111 it is known that they are not applicable). If none of the
112 optimizations were successful, redisplay calls redisplay_windows,
113 which performs a full redisplay of all windows.
115 Desired matrices.
117 Desired matrices are always built per Emacs window. The function
118 `display_line' is the central function to look at if you are
119 interested. It constructs one row in a desired matrix given an
120 iterator structure containing both a buffer position and a
121 description of the environment in which the text is to be
122 displayed. But this is too early, read on.
124 Characters and pixmaps displayed for a range of buffer text depend
125 on various settings of buffers and windows, on overlays and text
126 properties, on display tables, on selective display. The good news
127 is that all this hairy stuff is hidden behind a small set of
128 interface functions taking an iterator structure (struct it)
129 argument.
131 Iteration over things to be displayed is then simple. It is
132 started by initializing an iterator with a call to init_iterator,
133 passing it the buffer position where to start iteration. For
134 iteration over strings, pass -1 as the position to init_iterator,
135 and call reseat_to_string when the string is ready, to initialize
136 the iterator for that string. Thereafter, calls to
137 get_next_display_element fill the iterator structure with relevant
138 information about the next thing to display. Calls to
139 set_iterator_to_next move the iterator to the next thing.
141 Besides this, an iterator also contains information about the
142 display environment in which glyphs for display elements are to be
143 produced. It has fields for the width and height of the display,
144 the information whether long lines are truncated or continued, a
145 current X and Y position, and lots of other stuff you can better
146 see in dispextern.h.
148 Glyphs in a desired matrix are normally constructed in a loop
149 calling get_next_display_element and then PRODUCE_GLYPHS. The call
150 to PRODUCE_GLYPHS will fill the iterator structure with pixel
151 information about the element being displayed and at the same time
152 produce glyphs for it. If the display element fits on the line
153 being displayed, set_iterator_to_next is called next, otherwise the
154 glyphs produced are discarded. The function display_line is the
155 workhorse of filling glyph rows in the desired matrix with glyphs.
156 In addition to producing glyphs, it also handles line truncation
157 and continuation, word wrap, and cursor positioning (for the
158 latter, see also set_cursor_from_row).
160 Frame matrices.
162 That just couldn't be all, could it? What about terminal types not
163 supporting operations on sub-windows of the screen? To update the
164 display on such a terminal, window-based glyph matrices are not
165 well suited. To be able to reuse part of the display (scrolling
166 lines up and down), we must instead have a view of the whole
167 screen. This is what `frame matrices' are for. They are a trick.
169 Frames on terminals like above have a glyph pool. Windows on such
170 a frame sub-allocate their glyph memory from their frame's glyph
171 pool. The frame itself is given its own glyph matrices. By
172 coincidence---or maybe something else---rows in window glyph
173 matrices are slices of corresponding rows in frame matrices. Thus
174 writing to window matrices implicitly updates a frame matrix which
175 provides us with the view of the whole screen that we originally
176 wanted to have without having to move many bytes around. To be
177 honest, there is a little bit more done, but not much more. If you
178 plan to extend that code, take a look at dispnew.c. The function
179 build_frame_matrix is a good starting point.
181 Bidirectional display.
183 Bidirectional display adds quite some hair to this already complex
184 design. The good news are that a large portion of that hairy stuff
185 is hidden in bidi.c behind only 3 interfaces. bidi.c implements a
186 reordering engine which is called by set_iterator_to_next and
187 returns the next character to display in the visual order. See
188 commentary on bidi.c for more details. As far as redisplay is
189 concerned, the effect of calling bidi_move_to_visually_next, the
190 main interface of the reordering engine, is that the iterator gets
191 magically placed on the buffer or string position that is to be
192 displayed next. In other words, a linear iteration through the
193 buffer/string is replaced with a non-linear one. All the rest of
194 the redisplay is oblivious to the bidi reordering.
196 Well, almost oblivious---there are still complications, most of
197 them due to the fact that buffer and string positions no longer
198 change monotonously with glyph indices in a glyph row. Moreover,
199 for continued lines, the buffer positions may not even be
200 monotonously changing with vertical positions. Also, accounting
201 for face changes, overlays, etc. becomes more complex because
202 non-linear iteration could potentially skip many positions with
203 changes, and then cross them again on the way back...
205 One other prominent effect of bidirectional display is that some
206 paragraphs of text need to be displayed starting at the right
207 margin of the window---the so-called right-to-left, or R2L
208 paragraphs. R2L paragraphs are displayed with R2L glyph rows,
209 which have their reversed_p flag set. The bidi reordering engine
210 produces characters in such rows starting from the character which
211 should be the rightmost on display. PRODUCE_GLYPHS then reverses
212 the order, when it fills up the glyph row whose reversed_p flag is
213 set, by prepending each new glyph to what is already there, instead
214 of appending it. When the glyph row is complete, the function
215 extend_face_to_end_of_line fills the empty space to the left of the
216 leftmost character with special glyphs, which will display as,
217 well, empty. On text terminals, these special glyphs are simply
218 blank characters. On graphics terminals, there's a single stretch
219 glyph of a suitably computed width. Both the blanks and the
220 stretch glyph are given the face of the background of the line.
221 This way, the terminal-specific back-end can still draw the glyphs
222 left to right, even for R2L lines.
224 Bidirectional display and character compositions
226 Some scripts cannot be displayed by drawing each character
227 individually, because adjacent characters change each other's shape
228 on display. For example, Arabic and Indic scripts belong to this
229 category.
231 Emacs display supports this by providing "character compositions",
232 most of which is implemented in composite.c. During the buffer
233 scan that delivers characters to PRODUCE_GLYPHS, if the next
234 character to be delivered is a composed character, the iteration
235 calls composition_reseat_it and next_element_from_composition. If
236 they succeed to compose the character with one or more of the
237 following characters, the whole sequence of characters that where
238 composed is recorded in the `struct composition_it' object that is
239 part of the buffer iterator. The composed sequence could produce
240 one or more font glyphs (called "grapheme clusters") on the screen.
241 Each of these grapheme clusters is then delivered to PRODUCE_GLYPHS
242 in the direction corresponding to the current bidi scan direction
243 (recorded in the scan_dir member of the `struct bidi_it' object
244 that is part of the buffer iterator). In particular, if the bidi
245 iterator currently scans the buffer backwards, the grapheme
246 clusters are delivered back to front. This reorders the grapheme
247 clusters as appropriate for the current bidi context. Note that
248 this means that the grapheme clusters are always stored in the
249 LGSTRING object (see composite.c) in the logical order.
251 Moving an iterator in bidirectional text
252 without producing glyphs
254 Note one important detail mentioned above: that the bidi reordering
255 engine, driven by the iterator, produces characters in R2L rows
256 starting at the character that will be the rightmost on display.
257 As far as the iterator is concerned, the geometry of such rows is
258 still left to right, i.e. the iterator "thinks" the first character
259 is at the leftmost pixel position. The iterator does not know that
260 PRODUCE_GLYPHS reverses the order of the glyphs that the iterator
261 delivers. This is important when functions from the move_it_*
262 family are used to get to certain screen position or to match
263 screen coordinates with buffer coordinates: these functions use the
264 iterator geometry, which is left to right even in R2L paragraphs.
265 This works well with most callers of move_it_*, because they need
266 to get to a specific column, and columns are still numbered in the
267 reading order, i.e. the rightmost character in a R2L paragraph is
268 still column zero. But some callers do not get well with this; a
269 notable example is mouse clicks that need to find the character
270 that corresponds to certain pixel coordinates. See
271 buffer_posn_from_coords in dispnew.c for how this is handled. */
273 #include <config.h>
274 #include <stdio.h>
275 #include <limits.h>
276 #include <setjmp.h>
278 #include "lisp.h"
279 #include "keyboard.h"
280 #include "frame.h"
281 #include "window.h"
282 #include "termchar.h"
283 #include "dispextern.h"
284 #include "buffer.h"
285 #include "character.h"
286 #include "charset.h"
287 #include "indent.h"
288 #include "commands.h"
289 #include "keymap.h"
290 #include "macros.h"
291 #include "disptab.h"
292 #include "termhooks.h"
293 #include "termopts.h"
294 #include "intervals.h"
295 #include "coding.h"
296 #include "process.h"
297 #include "region-cache.h"
298 #include "font.h"
299 #include "fontset.h"
300 #include "blockinput.h"
302 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
303 #include "xterm.h"
304 #endif
305 #ifdef WINDOWSNT
306 #include "w32term.h"
307 #endif
308 #ifdef HAVE_NS
309 #include "nsterm.h"
310 #endif
311 #ifdef USE_GTK
312 #include "gtkutil.h"
313 #endif
315 #include "font.h"
317 #ifndef FRAME_X_OUTPUT
318 #define FRAME_X_OUTPUT(f) ((f)->output_data.x)
319 #endif
321 #define INFINITY 10000000
323 Lisp_Object Qoverriding_local_map, Qoverriding_terminal_local_map;
324 Lisp_Object Qwindow_scroll_functions;
325 static Lisp_Object Qwindow_text_change_functions;
326 static Lisp_Object Qredisplay_end_trigger_functions;
327 Lisp_Object Qinhibit_point_motion_hooks;
328 static Lisp_Object QCeval, QCpropertize;
329 Lisp_Object QCfile, QCdata;
330 static Lisp_Object Qfontified;
331 static Lisp_Object Qgrow_only;
332 static Lisp_Object Qinhibit_eval_during_redisplay;
333 static Lisp_Object Qbuffer_position, Qposition, Qobject;
334 static Lisp_Object Qright_to_left, Qleft_to_right;
336 /* Cursor shapes */
337 Lisp_Object Qbar, Qhbar, Qbox, Qhollow;
339 /* Pointer shapes */
340 static Lisp_Object Qarrow, Qhand;
341 Lisp_Object Qtext;
343 /* Holds the list (error). */
344 static Lisp_Object list_of_error;
346 static Lisp_Object Qfontification_functions;
348 static Lisp_Object Qwrap_prefix;
349 static Lisp_Object Qline_prefix;
351 /* Non-nil means don't actually do any redisplay. */
353 Lisp_Object Qinhibit_redisplay;
355 /* Names of text properties relevant for redisplay. */
357 Lisp_Object Qdisplay;
359 Lisp_Object Qspace, QCalign_to;
360 static Lisp_Object QCrelative_width, QCrelative_height;
361 Lisp_Object Qleft_margin, Qright_margin;
362 static Lisp_Object Qspace_width, Qraise;
363 static Lisp_Object Qslice;
364 Lisp_Object Qcenter;
365 static Lisp_Object Qmargin, Qpointer;
366 static Lisp_Object Qline_height;
368 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
370 /* Test if overflow newline into fringe. Called with iterator IT
371 at or past right window margin, and with IT->current_x set. */
373 #define IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE(IT) \
374 (!NILP (Voverflow_newline_into_fringe) \
375 && FRAME_WINDOW_P ((IT)->f) \
376 && ((IT)->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L \
377 ? (WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH ((IT)->w) > 0) \
378 : (WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH ((IT)->w) > 0)) \
379 && (IT)->current_x == (IT)->last_visible_x \
380 && (IT)->line_wrap != WORD_WRAP)
382 #else /* !HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
383 #define IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE(it) 0
384 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
386 /* Test if the display element loaded in IT is a space or tab
387 character. This is used to determine word wrapping. */
389 #define IT_DISPLAYING_WHITESPACE(it) \
390 (it->what == IT_CHARACTER && (it->c == ' ' || it->c == '\t'))
392 /* Name of the face used to highlight trailing whitespace. */
394 static Lisp_Object Qtrailing_whitespace;
396 /* Name and number of the face used to highlight escape glyphs. */
398 static Lisp_Object Qescape_glyph;
400 /* Name and number of the face used to highlight non-breaking spaces. */
402 static Lisp_Object Qnobreak_space;
404 /* The symbol `image' which is the car of the lists used to represent
405 images in Lisp. Also a tool bar style. */
407 Lisp_Object Qimage;
409 /* The image map types. */
410 Lisp_Object QCmap;
411 static Lisp_Object QCpointer;
412 static Lisp_Object Qrect, Qcircle, Qpoly;
414 /* Tool bar styles */
415 Lisp_Object Qboth, Qboth_horiz, Qtext_image_horiz;
417 /* Non-zero means print newline to stdout before next mini-buffer
418 message. */
420 int noninteractive_need_newline;
422 /* Non-zero means print newline to message log before next message. */
424 static int message_log_need_newline;
426 /* Three markers that message_dolog uses.
427 It could allocate them itself, but that causes trouble
428 in handling memory-full errors. */
429 static Lisp_Object message_dolog_marker1;
430 static Lisp_Object message_dolog_marker2;
431 static Lisp_Object message_dolog_marker3;
433 /* The buffer position of the first character appearing entirely or
434 partially on the line of the selected window which contains the
435 cursor; <= 0 if not known. Set by set_cursor_from_row, used for
436 redisplay optimization in redisplay_internal. */
438 static struct text_pos this_line_start_pos;
440 /* Number of characters past the end of the line above, including the
441 terminating newline. */
443 static struct text_pos this_line_end_pos;
445 /* The vertical positions and the height of this line. */
447 static int this_line_vpos;
448 static int this_line_y;
449 static int this_line_pixel_height;
451 /* X position at which this display line starts. Usually zero;
452 negative if first character is partially visible. */
454 static int this_line_start_x;
456 /* The smallest character position seen by move_it_* functions as they
457 move across display lines. Used to set MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS of
458 hscrolled lines, see display_line. */
460 static struct text_pos this_line_min_pos;
462 /* Buffer that this_line_.* variables are referring to. */
464 static struct buffer *this_line_buffer;
467 /* Values of those variables at last redisplay are stored as
468 properties on `overlay-arrow-position' symbol. However, if
469 Voverlay_arrow_position is a marker, last-arrow-position is its
470 numerical position. */
472 static Lisp_Object Qlast_arrow_position, Qlast_arrow_string;
474 /* Alternative overlay-arrow-string and overlay-arrow-bitmap
475 properties on a symbol in overlay-arrow-variable-list. */
477 static Lisp_Object Qoverlay_arrow_string, Qoverlay_arrow_bitmap;
479 Lisp_Object Qmenu_bar_update_hook;
481 /* Nonzero if an overlay arrow has been displayed in this window. */
483 static int overlay_arrow_seen;
485 /* Number of windows showing the buffer of the selected window (or
486 another buffer with the same base buffer). keyboard.c refers to
487 this. */
489 int buffer_shared;
491 /* Vector containing glyphs for an ellipsis `...'. */
493 static Lisp_Object default_invis_vector[3];
495 /* This is the window where the echo area message was displayed. It
496 is always a mini-buffer window, but it may not be the same window
497 currently active as a mini-buffer. */
499 Lisp_Object echo_area_window;
501 /* List of pairs (MESSAGE . MULTIBYTE). The function save_message
502 pushes the current message and the value of
503 message_enable_multibyte on the stack, the function restore_message
504 pops the stack and displays MESSAGE again. */
506 static Lisp_Object Vmessage_stack;
508 /* Nonzero means multibyte characters were enabled when the echo area
509 message was specified. */
511 static int message_enable_multibyte;
513 /* Nonzero if we should redraw the mode lines on the next redisplay. */
515 int update_mode_lines;
517 /* Nonzero if window sizes or contents have changed since last
518 redisplay that finished. */
520 int windows_or_buffers_changed;
522 /* Nonzero means a frame's cursor type has been changed. */
524 int cursor_type_changed;
526 /* Nonzero after display_mode_line if %l was used and it displayed a
527 line number. */
529 static int line_number_displayed;
531 /* The name of the *Messages* buffer, a string. */
533 static Lisp_Object Vmessages_buffer_name;
535 /* Current, index 0, and last displayed echo area message. Either
536 buffers from echo_buffers, or nil to indicate no message. */
538 Lisp_Object echo_area_buffer[2];
540 /* The buffers referenced from echo_area_buffer. */
542 static Lisp_Object echo_buffer[2];
544 /* A vector saved used in with_area_buffer to reduce consing. */
546 static Lisp_Object Vwith_echo_area_save_vector;
548 /* Non-zero means display_echo_area should display the last echo area
549 message again. Set by redisplay_preserve_echo_area. */
551 static int display_last_displayed_message_p;
553 /* Nonzero if echo area is being used by print; zero if being used by
554 message. */
556 static int message_buf_print;
558 /* The symbol `inhibit-menubar-update' and its DEFVAR_BOOL variable. */
560 static Lisp_Object Qinhibit_menubar_update;
561 static Lisp_Object Qmessage_truncate_lines;
563 /* Set to 1 in clear_message to make redisplay_internal aware
564 of an emptied echo area. */
566 static int message_cleared_p;
568 /* A scratch glyph row with contents used for generating truncation
569 glyphs. Also used in direct_output_for_insert. */
571 #define MAX_SCRATCH_GLYPHS 100
572 static struct glyph_row scratch_glyph_row;
573 static struct glyph scratch_glyphs[MAX_SCRATCH_GLYPHS];
575 /* Ascent and height of the last line processed by move_it_to. */
577 static int last_max_ascent, last_height;
579 /* Non-zero if there's a help-echo in the echo area. */
581 int help_echo_showing_p;
583 /* If >= 0, computed, exact values of mode-line and header-line height
584 to use in the macros CURRENT_MODE_LINE_HEIGHT and
585 CURRENT_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT. */
587 int current_mode_line_height, current_header_line_height;
589 /* The maximum distance to look ahead for text properties. Values
590 that are too small let us call compute_char_face and similar
591 functions too often which is expensive. Values that are too large
592 let us call compute_char_face and alike too often because we
593 might not be interested in text properties that far away. */
595 #define TEXT_PROP_DISTANCE_LIMIT 100
597 /* SAVE_IT and RESTORE_IT are called when we save a snapshot of the
598 iterator state and later restore it. This is needed because the
599 bidi iterator on bidi.c keeps a stacked cache of its states, which
600 is really a singleton. When we use scratch iterator objects to
601 move around the buffer, we can cause the bidi cache to be pushed or
602 popped, and therefore we need to restore the cache state when we
603 return to the original iterator. */
604 #define SAVE_IT(ITCOPY,ITORIG,CACHE) \
605 do { \
606 if (CACHE) \
607 bidi_unshelve_cache (CACHE, 1); \
608 ITCOPY = ITORIG; \
609 CACHE = bidi_shelve_cache (); \
610 } while (0)
612 #define RESTORE_IT(pITORIG,pITCOPY,CACHE) \
613 do { \
614 if (pITORIG != pITCOPY) \
615 *(pITORIG) = *(pITCOPY); \
616 bidi_unshelve_cache (CACHE, 0); \
617 CACHE = NULL; \
618 } while (0)
620 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
622 /* Non-zero means print traces of redisplay if compiled with
623 GLYPH_DEBUG != 0. */
625 int trace_redisplay_p;
627 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
629 #ifdef DEBUG_TRACE_MOVE
630 /* Non-zero means trace with TRACE_MOVE to stderr. */
631 int trace_move;
633 #define TRACE_MOVE(x) if (trace_move) fprintf x; else (void) 0
634 #else
635 #define TRACE_MOVE(x) (void) 0
636 #endif
638 static Lisp_Object Qauto_hscroll_mode;
640 /* Buffer being redisplayed -- for redisplay_window_error. */
642 static struct buffer *displayed_buffer;
644 /* Value returned from text property handlers (see below). */
646 enum prop_handled
648 HANDLED_NORMALLY,
649 HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS,
650 HANDLED_OVERLAY_STRING_CONSUMED,
651 HANDLED_RETURN
654 /* A description of text properties that redisplay is interested
655 in. */
657 struct props
659 /* The name of the property. */
660 Lisp_Object *name;
662 /* A unique index for the property. */
663 enum prop_idx idx;
665 /* A handler function called to set up iterator IT from the property
666 at IT's current position. Value is used to steer handle_stop. */
667 enum prop_handled (*handler) (struct it *it);
670 static enum prop_handled handle_face_prop (struct it *);
671 static enum prop_handled handle_invisible_prop (struct it *);
672 static enum prop_handled handle_display_prop (struct it *);
673 static enum prop_handled handle_composition_prop (struct it *);
674 static enum prop_handled handle_overlay_change (struct it *);
675 static enum prop_handled handle_fontified_prop (struct it *);
677 /* Properties handled by iterators. */
679 static struct props it_props[] =
681 {&Qfontified, FONTIFIED_PROP_IDX, handle_fontified_prop},
682 /* Handle `face' before `display' because some sub-properties of
683 `display' need to know the face. */
684 {&Qface, FACE_PROP_IDX, handle_face_prop},
685 {&Qdisplay, DISPLAY_PROP_IDX, handle_display_prop},
686 {&Qinvisible, INVISIBLE_PROP_IDX, handle_invisible_prop},
687 {&Qcomposition, COMPOSITION_PROP_IDX, handle_composition_prop},
688 {NULL, 0, NULL}
691 /* Value is the position described by X. If X is a marker, value is
692 the marker_position of X. Otherwise, value is X. */
694 #define COERCE_MARKER(X) (MARKERP ((X)) ? Fmarker_position (X) : (X))
696 /* Enumeration returned by some move_it_.* functions internally. */
698 enum move_it_result
700 /* Not used. Undefined value. */
701 MOVE_UNDEFINED,
703 /* Move ended at the requested buffer position or ZV. */
704 MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV,
706 /* Move ended at the requested X pixel position. */
707 MOVE_X_REACHED,
709 /* Move within a line ended at the end of a line that must be
710 continued. */
711 MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED,
713 /* Move within a line ended at the end of a line that would
714 be displayed truncated. */
715 MOVE_LINE_TRUNCATED,
717 /* Move within a line ended at a line end. */
718 MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR
721 /* This counter is used to clear the face cache every once in a while
722 in redisplay_internal. It is incremented for each redisplay.
723 Every CLEAR_FACE_CACHE_COUNT full redisplays, the face cache is
724 cleared. */
726 #define CLEAR_FACE_CACHE_COUNT 500
727 static int clear_face_cache_count;
729 /* Similarly for the image cache. */
731 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
732 #define CLEAR_IMAGE_CACHE_COUNT 101
733 static int clear_image_cache_count;
735 /* Null glyph slice */
736 static struct glyph_slice null_glyph_slice = { 0, 0, 0, 0 };
737 #endif
739 /* Non-zero while redisplay_internal is in progress. */
741 int redisplaying_p;
743 static Lisp_Object Qinhibit_free_realized_faces;
745 /* If a string, XTread_socket generates an event to display that string.
746 (The display is done in read_char.) */
748 Lisp_Object help_echo_string;
749 Lisp_Object help_echo_window;
750 Lisp_Object help_echo_object;
751 EMACS_INT help_echo_pos;
753 /* Temporary variable for XTread_socket. */
755 Lisp_Object previous_help_echo_string;
757 /* Platform-independent portion of hourglass implementation. */
759 /* Non-zero means an hourglass cursor is currently shown. */
760 int hourglass_shown_p;
762 /* If non-null, an asynchronous timer that, when it expires, displays
763 an hourglass cursor on all frames. */
764 struct atimer *hourglass_atimer;
766 /* Name of the face used to display glyphless characters. */
767 Lisp_Object Qglyphless_char;
769 /* Symbol for the purpose of Vglyphless_char_display. */
770 static Lisp_Object Qglyphless_char_display;
772 /* Method symbols for Vglyphless_char_display. */
773 static Lisp_Object Qhex_code, Qempty_box, Qthin_space, Qzero_width;
775 /* Default pixel width of `thin-space' display method. */
776 #define THIN_SPACE_WIDTH 1
778 /* Default number of seconds to wait before displaying an hourglass
779 cursor. */
780 #define DEFAULT_HOURGLASS_DELAY 1
783 /* Function prototypes. */
785 static void setup_for_ellipsis (struct it *, int);
786 static void set_iterator_to_next (struct it *, int);
787 static void mark_window_display_accurate_1 (struct window *, int);
788 static int single_display_spec_string_p (Lisp_Object, Lisp_Object);
789 static int display_prop_string_p (Lisp_Object, Lisp_Object);
790 static int cursor_row_p (struct glyph_row *);
791 static int redisplay_mode_lines (Lisp_Object, int);
792 static char *decode_mode_spec_coding (Lisp_Object, char *, int);
794 static Lisp_Object get_it_property (struct it *it, Lisp_Object prop);
796 static void handle_line_prefix (struct it *);
798 static void pint2str (char *, int, EMACS_INT);
799 static void pint2hrstr (char *, int, EMACS_INT);
800 static struct text_pos run_window_scroll_functions (Lisp_Object,
801 struct text_pos);
802 static void reconsider_clip_changes (struct window *, struct buffer *);
803 static int text_outside_line_unchanged_p (struct window *,
804 EMACS_INT, EMACS_INT);
805 static void store_mode_line_noprop_char (char);
806 static int store_mode_line_noprop (const char *, int, int);
807 static void handle_stop (struct it *);
808 static void handle_stop_backwards (struct it *, EMACS_INT);
809 static void vmessage (const char *, va_list) ATTRIBUTE_FORMAT_PRINTF (1, 0);
810 static void ensure_echo_area_buffers (void);
811 static Lisp_Object unwind_with_echo_area_buffer (Lisp_Object);
812 static Lisp_Object with_echo_area_buffer_unwind_data (struct window *);
813 static int with_echo_area_buffer (struct window *, int,
814 int (*) (EMACS_INT, Lisp_Object, EMACS_INT, EMACS_INT),
815 EMACS_INT, Lisp_Object, EMACS_INT, EMACS_INT);
816 static void clear_garbaged_frames (void);
817 static int current_message_1 (EMACS_INT, Lisp_Object, EMACS_INT, EMACS_INT);
818 static void pop_message (void);
819 static int truncate_message_1 (EMACS_INT, Lisp_Object, EMACS_INT, EMACS_INT);
820 static void set_message (const char *, Lisp_Object, EMACS_INT, int);
821 static int set_message_1 (EMACS_INT, Lisp_Object, EMACS_INT, EMACS_INT);
822 static int display_echo_area (struct window *);
823 static int display_echo_area_1 (EMACS_INT, Lisp_Object, EMACS_INT, EMACS_INT);
824 static int resize_mini_window_1 (EMACS_INT, Lisp_Object, EMACS_INT, EMACS_INT);
825 static Lisp_Object unwind_redisplay (Lisp_Object);
826 static int string_char_and_length (const unsigned char *, int *);
827 static struct text_pos display_prop_end (struct it *, Lisp_Object,
828 struct text_pos);
829 static int compute_window_start_on_continuation_line (struct window *);
830 static Lisp_Object safe_eval_handler (Lisp_Object);
831 static void insert_left_trunc_glyphs (struct it *);
832 static struct glyph_row *get_overlay_arrow_glyph_row (struct window *,
833 Lisp_Object);
834 static void extend_face_to_end_of_line (struct it *);
835 static int append_space_for_newline (struct it *, int);
836 static int cursor_row_fully_visible_p (struct window *, int, int);
837 static int try_scrolling (Lisp_Object, int, EMACS_INT, EMACS_INT, int, int);
838 static int try_cursor_movement (Lisp_Object, struct text_pos, int *);
839 static int trailing_whitespace_p (EMACS_INT);
840 static intmax_t message_log_check_duplicate (EMACS_INT, EMACS_INT);
841 static void push_it (struct it *, struct text_pos *);
842 static void pop_it (struct it *);
843 static void sync_frame_with_window_matrix_rows (struct window *);
844 static void select_frame_for_redisplay (Lisp_Object);
845 static void redisplay_internal (void);
846 static int echo_area_display (int);
847 static void redisplay_windows (Lisp_Object);
848 static void redisplay_window (Lisp_Object, int);
849 static Lisp_Object redisplay_window_error (Lisp_Object);
850 static Lisp_Object redisplay_window_0 (Lisp_Object);
851 static Lisp_Object redisplay_window_1 (Lisp_Object);
852 static int set_cursor_from_row (struct window *, struct glyph_row *,
853 struct glyph_matrix *, EMACS_INT, EMACS_INT,
854 int, int);
855 static int update_menu_bar (struct frame *, int, int);
856 static int try_window_reusing_current_matrix (struct window *);
857 static int try_window_id (struct window *);
858 static int display_line (struct it *);
859 static int display_mode_lines (struct window *);
860 static int display_mode_line (struct window *, enum face_id, Lisp_Object);
861 static int display_mode_element (struct it *, int, int, int, Lisp_Object, Lisp_Object, int);
862 static int store_mode_line_string (const char *, Lisp_Object, int, int, int, Lisp_Object);
863 static const char *decode_mode_spec (struct window *, int, int, Lisp_Object *);
864 static void display_menu_bar (struct window *);
865 static EMACS_INT display_count_lines (EMACS_INT, EMACS_INT, EMACS_INT,
866 EMACS_INT *);
867 static int display_string (const char *, Lisp_Object, Lisp_Object,
868 EMACS_INT, EMACS_INT, struct it *, int, int, int, int);
869 static void compute_line_metrics (struct it *);
870 static void run_redisplay_end_trigger_hook (struct it *);
871 static int get_overlay_strings (struct it *, EMACS_INT);
872 static int get_overlay_strings_1 (struct it *, EMACS_INT, int);
873 static void next_overlay_string (struct it *);
874 static void reseat (struct it *, struct text_pos, int);
875 static void reseat_1 (struct it *, struct text_pos, int);
876 static void back_to_previous_visible_line_start (struct it *);
877 void reseat_at_previous_visible_line_start (struct it *);
878 static void reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (struct it *, int);
879 static int next_element_from_ellipsis (struct it *);
880 static int next_element_from_display_vector (struct it *);
881 static int next_element_from_string (struct it *);
882 static int next_element_from_c_string (struct it *);
883 static int next_element_from_buffer (struct it *);
884 static int next_element_from_composition (struct it *);
885 static int next_element_from_image (struct it *);
886 static int next_element_from_stretch (struct it *);
887 static void load_overlay_strings (struct it *, EMACS_INT);
888 static int init_from_display_pos (struct it *, struct window *,
889 struct display_pos *);
890 static void reseat_to_string (struct it *, const char *,
891 Lisp_Object, EMACS_INT, EMACS_INT, int, int);
892 static int get_next_display_element (struct it *);
893 static enum move_it_result
894 move_it_in_display_line_to (struct it *, EMACS_INT, int,
895 enum move_operation_enum);
896 void move_it_vertically_backward (struct it *, int);
897 static void init_to_row_start (struct it *, struct window *,
898 struct glyph_row *);
899 static int init_to_row_end (struct it *, struct window *,
900 struct glyph_row *);
901 static void back_to_previous_line_start (struct it *);
902 static int forward_to_next_line_start (struct it *, int *, struct bidi_it *);
903 static struct text_pos string_pos_nchars_ahead (struct text_pos,
904 Lisp_Object, EMACS_INT);
905 static struct text_pos string_pos (EMACS_INT, Lisp_Object);
906 static struct text_pos c_string_pos (EMACS_INT, const char *, int);
907 static EMACS_INT number_of_chars (const char *, int);
908 static void compute_stop_pos (struct it *);
909 static void compute_string_pos (struct text_pos *, struct text_pos,
910 Lisp_Object);
911 static int face_before_or_after_it_pos (struct it *, int);
912 static EMACS_INT next_overlay_change (EMACS_INT);
913 static int handle_display_spec (struct it *, Lisp_Object, Lisp_Object,
914 Lisp_Object, struct text_pos *, EMACS_INT, int);
915 static int handle_single_display_spec (struct it *, Lisp_Object,
916 Lisp_Object, Lisp_Object,
917 struct text_pos *, EMACS_INT, int, int);
918 static int underlying_face_id (struct it *);
919 static int in_ellipses_for_invisible_text_p (struct display_pos *,
920 struct window *);
922 #define face_before_it_pos(IT) face_before_or_after_it_pos ((IT), 1)
923 #define face_after_it_pos(IT) face_before_or_after_it_pos ((IT), 0)
925 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
927 static void x_consider_frame_title (Lisp_Object);
928 static int tool_bar_lines_needed (struct frame *, int *);
929 static void update_tool_bar (struct frame *, int);
930 static void build_desired_tool_bar_string (struct frame *f);
931 static int redisplay_tool_bar (struct frame *);
932 static void display_tool_bar_line (struct it *, int);
933 static void notice_overwritten_cursor (struct window *,
934 enum glyph_row_area,
935 int, int, int, int);
936 static void append_stretch_glyph (struct it *, Lisp_Object,
937 int, int, int);
940 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
942 static void show_mouse_face (Mouse_HLInfo *, enum draw_glyphs_face);
943 static int coords_in_mouse_face_p (struct window *, int, int);
947 /***********************************************************************
948 Window display dimensions
949 ***********************************************************************/
951 /* Return the bottom boundary y-position for text lines in window W.
952 This is the first y position at which a line cannot start.
953 It is relative to the top of the window.
955 This is the height of W minus the height of a mode line, if any. */
957 inline int
958 window_text_bottom_y (struct window *w)
960 int height = WINDOW_TOTAL_HEIGHT (w);
962 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w))
963 height -= CURRENT_MODE_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
964 return height;
967 /* Return the pixel width of display area AREA of window W. AREA < 0
968 means return the total width of W, not including fringes to
969 the left and right of the window. */
971 inline int
972 window_box_width (struct window *w, int area)
974 int cols = XFASTINT (w->total_cols);
975 int pixels = 0;
977 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
979 cols -= WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w);
981 if (area == TEXT_AREA)
983 if (INTEGERP (w->left_margin_cols))
984 cols -= XFASTINT (w->left_margin_cols);
985 if (INTEGERP (w->right_margin_cols))
986 cols -= XFASTINT (w->right_margin_cols);
987 pixels = -WINDOW_TOTAL_FRINGE_WIDTH (w);
989 else if (area == LEFT_MARGIN_AREA)
991 cols = (INTEGERP (w->left_margin_cols)
992 ? XFASTINT (w->left_margin_cols) : 0);
993 pixels = 0;
995 else if (area == RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA)
997 cols = (INTEGERP (w->right_margin_cols)
998 ? XFASTINT (w->right_margin_cols) : 0);
999 pixels = 0;
1003 return cols * WINDOW_FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (w) + pixels;
1007 /* Return the pixel height of the display area of window W, not
1008 including mode lines of W, if any. */
1010 inline int
1011 window_box_height (struct window *w)
1013 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
1014 int height = WINDOW_TOTAL_HEIGHT (w);
1016 xassert (height >= 0);
1018 /* Note: the code below that determines the mode-line/header-line
1019 height is essentially the same as that contained in the macro
1020 CURRENT_{MODE,HEADER}_LINE_HEIGHT, except that it checks whether
1021 the appropriate glyph row has its `mode_line_p' flag set,
1022 and if it doesn't, uses estimate_mode_line_height instead. */
1024 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w))
1026 struct glyph_row *ml_row
1027 = (w->current_matrix && w->current_matrix->rows
1028 ? MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)
1029 : 0);
1030 if (ml_row && ml_row->mode_line_p)
1031 height -= ml_row->height;
1032 else
1033 height -= estimate_mode_line_height (f, CURRENT_MODE_LINE_FACE_ID (w));
1036 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w))
1038 struct glyph_row *hl_row
1039 = (w->current_matrix && w->current_matrix->rows
1040 ? MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)
1041 : 0);
1042 if (hl_row && hl_row->mode_line_p)
1043 height -= hl_row->height;
1044 else
1045 height -= estimate_mode_line_height (f, HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID);
1048 /* With a very small font and a mode-line that's taller than
1049 default, we might end up with a negative height. */
1050 return max (0, height);
1053 /* Return the window-relative coordinate of the left edge of display
1054 area AREA of window W. AREA < 0 means return the left edge of the
1055 whole window, to the right of the left fringe of W. */
1057 inline int
1058 window_box_left_offset (struct window *w, int area)
1060 int x;
1062 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
1063 return 0;
1065 x = WINDOW_LEFT_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (w);
1067 if (area == TEXT_AREA)
1068 x += (WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
1069 + window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA));
1070 else if (area == RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA)
1071 x += (WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
1072 + window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA)
1073 + window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA)
1074 + (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
1076 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)));
1077 else if (area == LEFT_MARGIN_AREA
1078 && WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w))
1079 x += WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w);
1081 return x;
1085 /* Return the window-relative coordinate of the right edge of display
1086 area AREA of window W. AREA < 0 means return the right edge of the
1087 whole window, to the left of the right fringe of W. */
1089 inline int
1090 window_box_right_offset (struct window *w, int area)
1092 return window_box_left_offset (w, area) + window_box_width (w, area);
1095 /* Return the frame-relative coordinate of the left edge of display
1096 area AREA of window W. AREA < 0 means return the left edge of the
1097 whole window, to the right of the left fringe of W. */
1099 inline int
1100 window_box_left (struct window *w, int area)
1102 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
1103 int x;
1105 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
1106 return FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
1108 x = (WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w)
1109 + window_box_left_offset (w, area));
1111 return x;
1115 /* Return the frame-relative coordinate of the right edge of display
1116 area AREA of window W. AREA < 0 means return the right edge of the
1117 whole window, to the left of the right fringe of W. */
1119 inline int
1120 window_box_right (struct window *w, int area)
1122 return window_box_left (w, area) + window_box_width (w, area);
1125 /* Get the bounding box of the display area AREA of window W, without
1126 mode lines, in frame-relative coordinates. AREA < 0 means the
1127 whole window, not including the left and right fringes of
1128 the window. Return in *BOX_X and *BOX_Y the frame-relative pixel
1129 coordinates of the upper-left corner of the box. Return in
1130 *BOX_WIDTH, and *BOX_HEIGHT the pixel width and height of the box. */
1132 inline void
1133 window_box (struct window *w, int area, int *box_x, int *box_y,
1134 int *box_width, int *box_height)
1136 if (box_width)
1137 *box_width = window_box_width (w, area);
1138 if (box_height)
1139 *box_height = window_box_height (w);
1140 if (box_x)
1141 *box_x = window_box_left (w, area);
1142 if (box_y)
1144 *box_y = WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_Y (w);
1145 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w))
1146 *box_y += CURRENT_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
1151 /* Get the bounding box of the display area AREA of window W, without
1152 mode lines. AREA < 0 means the whole window, not including the
1153 left and right fringe of the window. Return in *TOP_LEFT_X
1154 and TOP_LEFT_Y the frame-relative pixel coordinates of the
1155 upper-left corner of the box. Return in *BOTTOM_RIGHT_X, and
1156 *BOTTOM_RIGHT_Y the coordinates of the bottom-right corner of the
1157 box. */
1159 static inline void
1160 window_box_edges (struct window *w, int area, int *top_left_x, int *top_left_y,
1161 int *bottom_right_x, int *bottom_right_y)
1163 window_box (w, area, top_left_x, top_left_y, bottom_right_x,
1164 bottom_right_y);
1165 *bottom_right_x += *top_left_x;
1166 *bottom_right_y += *top_left_y;
1171 /***********************************************************************
1172 Utilities
1173 ***********************************************************************/
1175 /* Return the bottom y-position of the line the iterator IT is in.
1176 This can modify IT's settings. */
1179 line_bottom_y (struct it *it)
1181 int line_height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
1182 int line_top_y = it->current_y;
1184 if (line_height == 0)
1186 if (last_height)
1187 line_height = last_height;
1188 else if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < ZV)
1190 move_it_by_lines (it, 1);
1191 line_height = (it->max_ascent || it->max_descent
1192 ? it->max_ascent + it->max_descent
1193 : last_height);
1195 else
1197 struct glyph_row *row = it->glyph_row;
1199 /* Use the default character height. */
1200 it->glyph_row = NULL;
1201 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
1202 it->c = ' ';
1203 it->len = 1;
1204 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
1205 line_height = it->ascent + it->descent;
1206 it->glyph_row = row;
1210 return line_top_y + line_height;
1213 /* Subroutine of pos_visible_p below. Extracts a display string, if
1214 any, from the display spec given as its argument. */
1215 static Lisp_Object
1216 string_from_display_spec (Lisp_Object spec)
1218 if (CONSP (spec))
1220 while (CONSP (spec))
1222 if (STRINGP (XCAR (spec)))
1223 return XCAR (spec);
1224 spec = XCDR (spec);
1227 else if (VECTORP (spec))
1229 ptrdiff_t i;
1231 for (i = 0; i < ASIZE (spec); i++)
1233 if (STRINGP (AREF (spec, i)))
1234 return AREF (spec, i);
1236 return Qnil;
1239 return spec;
1242 /* Return 1 if position CHARPOS is visible in window W.
1243 CHARPOS < 0 means return info about WINDOW_END position.
1244 If visible, set *X and *Y to pixel coordinates of top left corner.
1245 Set *RTOP and *RBOT to pixel height of an invisible area of glyph at POS.
1246 Set *ROWH and *VPOS to row's visible height and VPOS (row number). */
1249 pos_visible_p (struct window *w, EMACS_INT charpos, int *x, int *y,
1250 int *rtop, int *rbot, int *rowh, int *vpos)
1252 struct it it;
1253 void *itdata = bidi_shelve_cache ();
1254 struct text_pos top;
1255 int visible_p = 0;
1256 struct buffer *old_buffer = NULL;
1258 if (FRAME_INITIAL_P (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w))))
1259 return visible_p;
1261 if (XBUFFER (w->buffer) != current_buffer)
1263 old_buffer = current_buffer;
1264 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (w->buffer));
1267 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (top, w->start);
1269 /* Compute exact mode line heights. */
1270 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w))
1271 current_mode_line_height
1272 = display_mode_line (w, CURRENT_MODE_LINE_FACE_ID (w),
1273 BVAR (current_buffer, mode_line_format));
1275 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w))
1276 current_header_line_height
1277 = display_mode_line (w, HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID,
1278 BVAR (current_buffer, header_line_format));
1280 start_display (&it, w, top);
1281 move_it_to (&it, charpos, -1, it.last_visible_y-1, -1,
1282 (charpos >= 0 ? MOVE_TO_POS : 0) | MOVE_TO_Y);
1284 if (charpos >= 0
1285 && (((!it.bidi_p || it.bidi_it.scan_dir == 1)
1286 && IT_CHARPOS (it) >= charpos)
1287 /* When scanning backwards under bidi iteration, move_it_to
1288 stops at or _before_ CHARPOS, because it stops at or to
1289 the _right_ of the character at CHARPOS. */
1290 || (it.bidi_p && it.bidi_it.scan_dir == -1
1291 && IT_CHARPOS (it) <= charpos)))
1293 /* We have reached CHARPOS, or passed it. How the call to
1294 move_it_to can overshoot: (i) If CHARPOS is on invisible text
1295 or covered by a display property, move_it_to stops at the end
1296 of the invisible text, to the right of CHARPOS. (ii) If
1297 CHARPOS is in a display vector, move_it_to stops on its last
1298 glyph. */
1299 int top_x = it.current_x;
1300 int top_y = it.current_y;
1301 enum it_method it_method = it.method;
1302 /* Calling line_bottom_y may change it.method, it.position, etc. */
1303 int bottom_y = (last_height = 0, line_bottom_y (&it));
1304 int window_top_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
1306 if (top_y < window_top_y)
1307 visible_p = bottom_y > window_top_y;
1308 else if (top_y < it.last_visible_y)
1309 visible_p = 1;
1310 if (visible_p)
1312 if (it_method == GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR)
1314 /* We stopped on the last glyph of a display vector.
1315 Try and recompute. Hack alert! */
1316 if (charpos < 2 || top.charpos >= charpos)
1317 top_x = it.glyph_row->x;
1318 else
1320 struct it it2;
1321 start_display (&it2, w, top);
1322 move_it_to (&it2, charpos - 1, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
1323 get_next_display_element (&it2);
1324 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (&it2);
1325 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (&it2)
1326 || it2.current_x > it2.last_visible_x)
1327 top_x = it.glyph_row->x;
1328 else
1330 top_x = it2.current_x;
1331 top_y = it2.current_y;
1335 else if (IT_CHARPOS (it) != charpos)
1337 Lisp_Object cpos = make_number (charpos);
1338 Lisp_Object spec = Fget_char_property (cpos, Qdisplay, Qnil);
1339 Lisp_Object string = string_from_display_spec (spec);
1340 int newline_in_string = 0;
1342 if (STRINGP (string))
1344 const char *s = SSDATA (string);
1345 const char *e = s + SBYTES (string);
1346 while (s < e)
1348 if (*s++ == '\n')
1350 newline_in_string = 1;
1351 break;
1355 /* The tricky code below is needed because there's a
1356 discrepancy between move_it_to and how we set cursor
1357 when the display line ends in a newline from a
1358 display string. move_it_to will stop _after_ such
1359 display strings, whereas set_cursor_from_row
1360 conspires with cursor_row_p to place the cursor on
1361 the first glyph produced from the display string. */
1363 /* We have overshoot PT because it is covered by a
1364 display property whose value is a string. If the
1365 string includes embedded newlines, we are also in the
1366 wrong display line. Backtrack to the correct line,
1367 where the display string begins. */
1368 if (newline_in_string)
1370 Lisp_Object startpos, endpos;
1371 EMACS_INT start, end;
1372 struct it it3;
1374 /* Find the first and the last buffer positions
1375 covered by the display string. */
1376 endpos =
1377 Fnext_single_char_property_change (cpos, Qdisplay,
1378 Qnil, Qnil);
1379 startpos =
1380 Fprevious_single_char_property_change (endpos, Qdisplay,
1381 Qnil, Qnil);
1382 start = XFASTINT (startpos);
1383 end = XFASTINT (endpos);
1384 /* Move to the last buffer position before the
1385 display property. */
1386 start_display (&it3, w, top);
1387 move_it_to (&it3, start - 1, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
1388 /* Move forward one more line if the position before
1389 the display string is a newline or if it is the
1390 rightmost character on a line that is
1391 continued or word-wrapped. */
1392 if (it3.method == GET_FROM_BUFFER
1393 && it3.c == '\n')
1394 move_it_by_lines (&it3, 1);
1395 else if (move_it_in_display_line_to (&it3, -1,
1396 it3.current_x
1397 + it3.pixel_width,
1398 MOVE_TO_X)
1399 == MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED)
1401 move_it_by_lines (&it3, 1);
1402 /* When we are under word-wrap, the #$@%!
1403 move_it_by_lines moves 2 lines, so we need to
1404 fix that up. */
1405 if (it3.line_wrap == WORD_WRAP)
1406 move_it_by_lines (&it3, -1);
1409 /* Record the vertical coordinate of the display
1410 line where we wound up. */
1411 top_y = it3.current_y;
1412 if (it3.bidi_p)
1414 /* When characters are reordered for display,
1415 the character displayed to the left of the
1416 display string could be _after_ the display
1417 property in the logical order. Use the
1418 smallest vertical position of these two. */
1419 start_display (&it3, w, top);
1420 move_it_to (&it3, end + 1, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
1421 if (it3.current_y < top_y)
1422 top_y = it3.current_y;
1424 /* Move from the top of the window to the beginning
1425 of the display line where the display string
1426 begins. */
1427 start_display (&it3, w, top);
1428 move_it_to (&it3, -1, 0, top_y, -1, MOVE_TO_X | MOVE_TO_Y);
1429 /* Finally, advance the iterator until we hit the
1430 first display element whose character position is
1431 CHARPOS, or until the first newline from the
1432 display string, which signals the end of the
1433 display line. */
1434 while (get_next_display_element (&it3))
1436 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (&it3);
1437 if (IT_CHARPOS (it3) == charpos
1438 || ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (&it3))
1439 break;
1440 set_iterator_to_next (&it3, 0);
1442 top_x = it3.current_x - it3.pixel_width;
1443 /* Normally, we would exit the above loop because we
1444 found the display element whose character
1445 position is CHARPOS. For the contingency that we
1446 didn't, and stopped at the first newline from the
1447 display string, move back over the glyphs
1448 prfoduced from the string, until we find the
1449 rightmost glyph not from the string. */
1450 if (IT_CHARPOS (it3) != charpos && EQ (it3.object, string))
1452 struct glyph *g = it3.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
1453 + it3.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
1455 while (EQ ((g - 1)->object, string))
1457 --g;
1458 top_x -= g->pixel_width;
1460 xassert (g < it3.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
1461 + it3.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA]);
1466 *x = top_x;
1467 *y = max (top_y + max (0, it.max_ascent - it.ascent), window_top_y);
1468 *rtop = max (0, window_top_y - top_y);
1469 *rbot = max (0, bottom_y - it.last_visible_y);
1470 *rowh = max (0, (min (bottom_y, it.last_visible_y)
1471 - max (top_y, window_top_y)));
1472 *vpos = it.vpos;
1475 else
1477 /* We were asked to provide info about WINDOW_END. */
1478 struct it it2;
1479 void *it2data = NULL;
1481 SAVE_IT (it2, it, it2data);
1482 if (IT_CHARPOS (it) < ZV && FETCH_BYTE (IT_BYTEPOS (it)) != '\n')
1483 move_it_by_lines (&it, 1);
1484 if (charpos < IT_CHARPOS (it)
1485 || (it.what == IT_EOB && charpos == IT_CHARPOS (it)))
1487 visible_p = 1;
1488 RESTORE_IT (&it2, &it2, it2data);
1489 move_it_to (&it2, charpos, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
1490 *x = it2.current_x;
1491 *y = it2.current_y + it2.max_ascent - it2.ascent;
1492 *rtop = max (0, -it2.current_y);
1493 *rbot = max (0, ((it2.current_y + it2.max_ascent + it2.max_descent)
1494 - it.last_visible_y));
1495 *rowh = max (0, (min (it2.current_y + it2.max_ascent + it2.max_descent,
1496 it.last_visible_y)
1497 - max (it2.current_y,
1498 WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w))));
1499 *vpos = it2.vpos;
1501 else
1502 bidi_unshelve_cache (it2data, 1);
1504 bidi_unshelve_cache (itdata, 0);
1506 if (old_buffer)
1507 set_buffer_internal_1 (old_buffer);
1509 current_header_line_height = current_mode_line_height = -1;
1511 if (visible_p && XFASTINT (w->hscroll) > 0)
1512 *x -= XFASTINT (w->hscroll) * WINDOW_FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (w);
1514 #if 0
1515 /* Debugging code. */
1516 if (visible_p)
1517 fprintf (stderr, "+pv pt=%d vs=%d --> x=%d y=%d rt=%d rb=%d rh=%d vp=%d\n",
1518 charpos, w->vscroll, *x, *y, *rtop, *rbot, *rowh, *vpos);
1519 else
1520 fprintf (stderr, "-pv pt=%d vs=%d\n", charpos, w->vscroll);
1521 #endif
1523 return visible_p;
1527 /* Return the next character from STR. Return in *LEN the length of
1528 the character. This is like STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH but never
1529 returns an invalid character. If we find one, we return a `?', but
1530 with the length of the invalid character. */
1532 static inline int
1533 string_char_and_length (const unsigned char *str, int *len)
1535 int c;
1537 c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (str, *len);
1538 if (!CHAR_VALID_P (c))
1539 /* We may not change the length here because other places in Emacs
1540 don't use this function, i.e. they silently accept invalid
1541 characters. */
1542 c = '?';
1544 return c;
1549 /* Given a position POS containing a valid character and byte position
1550 in STRING, return the position NCHARS ahead (NCHARS >= 0). */
1552 static struct text_pos
1553 string_pos_nchars_ahead (struct text_pos pos, Lisp_Object string, EMACS_INT nchars)
1555 xassert (STRINGP (string) && nchars >= 0);
1557 if (STRING_MULTIBYTE (string))
1559 const unsigned char *p = SDATA (string) + BYTEPOS (pos);
1560 int len;
1562 while (nchars--)
1564 string_char_and_length (p, &len);
1565 p += len;
1566 CHARPOS (pos) += 1;
1567 BYTEPOS (pos) += len;
1570 else
1571 SET_TEXT_POS (pos, CHARPOS (pos) + nchars, BYTEPOS (pos) + nchars);
1573 return pos;
1577 /* Value is the text position, i.e. character and byte position,
1578 for character position CHARPOS in STRING. */
1580 static inline struct text_pos
1581 string_pos (EMACS_INT charpos, Lisp_Object string)
1583 struct text_pos pos;
1584 xassert (STRINGP (string));
1585 xassert (charpos >= 0);
1586 SET_TEXT_POS (pos, charpos, string_char_to_byte (string, charpos));
1587 return pos;
1591 /* Value is a text position, i.e. character and byte position, for
1592 character position CHARPOS in C string S. MULTIBYTE_P non-zero
1593 means recognize multibyte characters. */
1595 static struct text_pos
1596 c_string_pos (EMACS_INT charpos, const char *s, int multibyte_p)
1598 struct text_pos pos;
1600 xassert (s != NULL);
1601 xassert (charpos >= 0);
1603 if (multibyte_p)
1605 int len;
1607 SET_TEXT_POS (pos, 0, 0);
1608 while (charpos--)
1610 string_char_and_length ((const unsigned char *) s, &len);
1611 s += len;
1612 CHARPOS (pos) += 1;
1613 BYTEPOS (pos) += len;
1616 else
1617 SET_TEXT_POS (pos, charpos, charpos);
1619 return pos;
1623 /* Value is the number of characters in C string S. MULTIBYTE_P
1624 non-zero means recognize multibyte characters. */
1626 static EMACS_INT
1627 number_of_chars (const char *s, int multibyte_p)
1629 EMACS_INT nchars;
1631 if (multibyte_p)
1633 EMACS_INT rest = strlen (s);
1634 int len;
1635 const unsigned char *p = (const unsigned char *) s;
1637 for (nchars = 0; rest > 0; ++nchars)
1639 string_char_and_length (p, &len);
1640 rest -= len, p += len;
1643 else
1644 nchars = strlen (s);
1646 return nchars;
1650 /* Compute byte position NEWPOS->bytepos corresponding to
1651 NEWPOS->charpos. POS is a known position in string STRING.
1652 NEWPOS->charpos must be >= POS.charpos. */
1654 static void
1655 compute_string_pos (struct text_pos *newpos, struct text_pos pos, Lisp_Object string)
1657 xassert (STRINGP (string));
1658 xassert (CHARPOS (*newpos) >= CHARPOS (pos));
1660 if (STRING_MULTIBYTE (string))
1661 *newpos = string_pos_nchars_ahead (pos, string,
1662 CHARPOS (*newpos) - CHARPOS (pos));
1663 else
1664 BYTEPOS (*newpos) = CHARPOS (*newpos);
1667 /* EXPORT:
1668 Return an estimation of the pixel height of mode or header lines on
1669 frame F. FACE_ID specifies what line's height to estimate. */
1672 estimate_mode_line_height (struct frame *f, enum face_id face_id)
1674 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
1675 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
1677 int height = FONT_HEIGHT (FRAME_FONT (f));
1679 /* This function is called so early when Emacs starts that the face
1680 cache and mode line face are not yet initialized. */
1681 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
1683 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, face_id);
1684 if (face)
1686 if (face->font)
1687 height = FONT_HEIGHT (face->font);
1688 if (face->box_line_width > 0)
1689 height += 2 * face->box_line_width;
1693 return height;
1695 #endif
1697 return 1;
1700 /* Given a pixel position (PIX_X, PIX_Y) on frame F, return glyph
1701 co-ordinates in (*X, *Y). Set *BOUNDS to the rectangle that the
1702 glyph at X, Y occupies, if BOUNDS != 0. If NOCLIP is non-zero, do
1703 not force the value into range. */
1705 void
1706 pixel_to_glyph_coords (FRAME_PTR f, register int pix_x, register int pix_y,
1707 int *x, int *y, NativeRectangle *bounds, int noclip)
1710 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
1711 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
1713 /* Arrange for the division in FRAME_PIXEL_X_TO_COL etc. to round down
1714 even for negative values. */
1715 if (pix_x < 0)
1716 pix_x -= FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) - 1;
1717 if (pix_y < 0)
1718 pix_y -= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) - 1;
1720 pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_X_TO_COL (f, pix_x);
1721 pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_Y_TO_LINE (f, pix_y);
1723 if (bounds)
1724 STORE_NATIVE_RECT (*bounds,
1725 FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, pix_x),
1726 FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, pix_y),
1727 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) - 1,
1728 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) - 1);
1730 if (!noclip)
1732 if (pix_x < 0)
1733 pix_x = 0;
1734 else if (pix_x > FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f))
1735 pix_x = FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f);
1737 if (pix_y < 0)
1738 pix_y = 0;
1739 else if (pix_y > FRAME_LINES (f))
1740 pix_y = FRAME_LINES (f);
1743 #endif
1745 *x = pix_x;
1746 *y = pix_y;
1750 /* Find the glyph under window-relative coordinates X/Y in window W.
1751 Consider only glyphs from buffer text, i.e. no glyphs from overlay
1752 strings. Return in *HPOS and *VPOS the row and column number of
1753 the glyph found. Return in *AREA the glyph area containing X.
1754 Value is a pointer to the glyph found or null if X/Y is not on
1755 text, or we can't tell because W's current matrix is not up to
1756 date. */
1758 static
1759 struct glyph *
1760 x_y_to_hpos_vpos (struct window *w, int x, int y, int *hpos, int *vpos,
1761 int *dx, int *dy, int *area)
1763 struct glyph *glyph, *end;
1764 struct glyph_row *row = NULL;
1765 int x0, i;
1767 /* Find row containing Y. Give up if some row is not enabled. */
1768 for (i = 0; i < w->current_matrix->nrows; ++i)
1770 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, i);
1771 if (!row->enabled_p)
1772 return NULL;
1773 if (y >= row->y && y < MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row))
1774 break;
1777 *vpos = i;
1778 *hpos = 0;
1780 /* Give up if Y is not in the window. */
1781 if (i == w->current_matrix->nrows)
1782 return NULL;
1784 /* Get the glyph area containing X. */
1785 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
1787 *area = TEXT_AREA;
1788 x0 = 0;
1790 else
1792 if (x < window_box_left_offset (w, TEXT_AREA))
1794 *area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA;
1795 x0 = window_box_left_offset (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA);
1797 else if (x < window_box_right_offset (w, TEXT_AREA))
1799 *area = TEXT_AREA;
1800 x0 = window_box_left_offset (w, TEXT_AREA) + min (row->x, 0);
1802 else
1804 *area = RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA;
1805 x0 = window_box_left_offset (w, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA);
1809 /* Find glyph containing X. */
1810 glyph = row->glyphs[*area];
1811 end = glyph + row->used[*area];
1812 x -= x0;
1813 while (glyph < end && x >= glyph->pixel_width)
1815 x -= glyph->pixel_width;
1816 ++glyph;
1819 if (glyph == end)
1820 return NULL;
1822 if (dx)
1824 *dx = x;
1825 *dy = y - (row->y + row->ascent - glyph->ascent);
1828 *hpos = glyph - row->glyphs[*area];
1829 return glyph;
1832 /* Convert frame-relative x/y to coordinates relative to window W.
1833 Takes pseudo-windows into account. */
1835 static void
1836 frame_to_window_pixel_xy (struct window *w, int *x, int *y)
1838 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
1840 /* A pseudo-window is always full-width, and starts at the
1841 left edge of the frame, plus a frame border. */
1842 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
1843 *x -= FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
1844 *y = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_Y (w, *y);
1846 else
1848 *x -= WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w);
1849 *y = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_Y (w, *y);
1853 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
1855 /* EXPORT:
1856 Return in RECTS[] at most N clipping rectangles for glyph string S.
1857 Return the number of stored rectangles. */
1860 get_glyph_string_clip_rects (struct glyph_string *s, NativeRectangle *rects, int n)
1862 XRectangle r;
1864 if (n <= 0)
1865 return 0;
1867 if (s->row->full_width_p)
1869 /* Draw full-width. X coordinates are relative to S->w->left_col. */
1870 r.x = WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (s->w);
1871 r.width = WINDOW_TOTAL_WIDTH (s->w);
1873 /* Unless displaying a mode or menu bar line, which are always
1874 fully visible, clip to the visible part of the row. */
1875 if (s->w->pseudo_window_p)
1876 r.height = s->row->visible_height;
1877 else
1878 r.height = s->height;
1880 else
1882 /* This is a text line that may be partially visible. */
1883 r.x = window_box_left (s->w, s->area);
1884 r.width = window_box_width (s->w, s->area);
1885 r.height = s->row->visible_height;
1888 if (s->clip_head)
1889 if (r.x < s->clip_head->x)
1891 if (r.width >= s->clip_head->x - r.x)
1892 r.width -= s->clip_head->x - r.x;
1893 else
1894 r.width = 0;
1895 r.x = s->clip_head->x;
1897 if (s->clip_tail)
1898 if (r.x + r.width > s->clip_tail->x + s->clip_tail->background_width)
1900 if (s->clip_tail->x + s->clip_tail->background_width >= r.x)
1901 r.width = s->clip_tail->x + s->clip_tail->background_width - r.x;
1902 else
1903 r.width = 0;
1906 /* If S draws overlapping rows, it's sufficient to use the top and
1907 bottom of the window for clipping because this glyph string
1908 intentionally draws over other lines. */
1909 if (s->for_overlaps)
1911 r.y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (s->w);
1912 r.height = window_text_bottom_y (s->w) - r.y;
1914 /* Alas, the above simple strategy does not work for the
1915 environments with anti-aliased text: if the same text is
1916 drawn onto the same place multiple times, it gets thicker.
1917 If the overlap we are processing is for the erased cursor, we
1918 take the intersection with the rectagle of the cursor. */
1919 if (s->for_overlaps & OVERLAPS_ERASED_CURSOR)
1921 XRectangle rc, r_save = r;
1923 rc.x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (s->w, s->w->phys_cursor.x);
1924 rc.y = s->w->phys_cursor.y;
1925 rc.width = s->w->phys_cursor_width;
1926 rc.height = s->w->phys_cursor_height;
1928 x_intersect_rectangles (&r_save, &rc, &r);
1931 else
1933 /* Don't use S->y for clipping because it doesn't take partially
1934 visible lines into account. For example, it can be negative for
1935 partially visible lines at the top of a window. */
1936 if (!s->row->full_width_p
1937 && MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_AT_TOP_P (s->w, s->row))
1938 r.y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (s->w);
1939 else
1940 r.y = max (0, s->row->y);
1943 r.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (s->w, r.y);
1945 /* If drawing the cursor, don't let glyph draw outside its
1946 advertised boundaries. Cleartype does this under some circumstances. */
1947 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1949 struct glyph *glyph = s->first_glyph;
1950 int height, max_y;
1952 if (s->x > r.x)
1954 r.width -= s->x - r.x;
1955 r.x = s->x;
1957 r.width = min (r.width, glyph->pixel_width);
1959 /* If r.y is below window bottom, ensure that we still see a cursor. */
1960 height = min (glyph->ascent + glyph->descent,
1961 min (FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (s->f), s->row->visible_height));
1962 max_y = window_text_bottom_y (s->w) - height;
1963 max_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (s->w, max_y);
1964 if (s->ybase - glyph->ascent > max_y)
1966 r.y = max_y;
1967 r.height = height;
1969 else
1971 /* Don't draw cursor glyph taller than our actual glyph. */
1972 height = max (FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (s->f), glyph->ascent + glyph->descent);
1973 if (height < r.height)
1975 max_y = r.y + r.height;
1976 r.y = min (max_y, max (r.y, s->ybase + glyph->descent - height));
1977 r.height = min (max_y - r.y, height);
1982 if (s->row->clip)
1984 XRectangle r_save = r;
1986 if (! x_intersect_rectangles (&r_save, s->row->clip, &r))
1987 r.width = 0;
1990 if ((s->for_overlaps & OVERLAPS_BOTH) == 0
1991 || ((s->for_overlaps & OVERLAPS_BOTH) == OVERLAPS_BOTH && n == 1))
1993 #ifdef CONVERT_FROM_XRECT
1994 CONVERT_FROM_XRECT (r, *rects);
1995 #else
1996 *rects = r;
1997 #endif
1998 return 1;
2000 else
2002 /* If we are processing overlapping and allowed to return
2003 multiple clipping rectangles, we exclude the row of the glyph
2004 string from the clipping rectangle. This is to avoid drawing
2005 the same text on the environment with anti-aliasing. */
2006 #ifdef CONVERT_FROM_XRECT
2007 XRectangle rs[2];
2008 #else
2009 XRectangle *rs = rects;
2010 #endif
2011 int i = 0, row_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (s->w, s->row->y);
2013 if (s->for_overlaps & OVERLAPS_PRED)
2015 rs[i] = r;
2016 if (r.y + r.height > row_y)
2018 if (r.y < row_y)
2019 rs[i].height = row_y - r.y;
2020 else
2021 rs[i].height = 0;
2023 i++;
2025 if (s->for_overlaps & OVERLAPS_SUCC)
2027 rs[i] = r;
2028 if (r.y < row_y + s->row->visible_height)
2030 if (r.y + r.height > row_y + s->row->visible_height)
2032 rs[i].y = row_y + s->row->visible_height;
2033 rs[i].height = r.y + r.height - rs[i].y;
2035 else
2036 rs[i].height = 0;
2038 i++;
2041 n = i;
2042 #ifdef CONVERT_FROM_XRECT
2043 for (i = 0; i < n; i++)
2044 CONVERT_FROM_XRECT (rs[i], rects[i]);
2045 #endif
2046 return n;
2050 /* EXPORT:
2051 Return in *NR the clipping rectangle for glyph string S. */
2053 void
2054 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (struct glyph_string *s, NativeRectangle *nr)
2056 get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s, nr, 1);
2060 /* EXPORT:
2061 Return the position and height of the phys cursor in window W.
2062 Set w->phys_cursor_width to width of phys cursor.
2065 void
2066 get_phys_cursor_geometry (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row,
2067 struct glyph *glyph, int *xp, int *yp, int *heightp)
2069 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
2070 int x, y, wd, h, h0, y0;
2072 /* Compute the width of the rectangle to draw. If on a stretch
2073 glyph, and `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a
2074 rectangle as wide as the glyph, but use a canonical character
2075 width instead. */
2076 wd = glyph->pixel_width - 1;
2077 #if defined (HAVE_NTGUI) || defined (HAVE_NS)
2078 wd++; /* Why? */
2079 #endif
2081 x = w->phys_cursor.x;
2082 if (x < 0)
2084 wd += x;
2085 x = 0;
2088 if (glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
2089 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2090 wd = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f), wd);
2091 w->phys_cursor_width = wd;
2093 y = w->phys_cursor.y + row->ascent - glyph->ascent;
2095 /* If y is below window bottom, ensure that we still see a cursor. */
2096 h0 = min (FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f), row->visible_height);
2098 h = max (h0, glyph->ascent + glyph->descent);
2099 h0 = min (h0, glyph->ascent + glyph->descent);
2101 y0 = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
2102 if (y < y0)
2104 h = max (h - (y0 - y) + 1, h0);
2105 y = y0 - 1;
2107 else
2109 y0 = window_text_bottom_y (w) - h0;
2110 if (y > y0)
2112 h += y - y0;
2113 y = y0;
2117 *xp = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, x);
2118 *yp = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, y);
2119 *heightp = h;
2123 * Remember which glyph the mouse is over.
2126 void
2127 remember_mouse_glyph (struct frame *f, int gx, int gy, NativeRectangle *rect)
2129 Lisp_Object window;
2130 struct window *w;
2131 struct glyph_row *r, *gr, *end_row;
2132 enum window_part part;
2133 enum glyph_row_area area;
2134 int x, y, width, height;
2136 /* Try to determine frame pixel position and size of the glyph under
2137 frame pixel coordinates X/Y on frame F. */
2139 if (!f->glyphs_initialized_p
2140 || (window = window_from_coordinates (f, gx, gy, &part, 0),
2141 NILP (window)))
2143 width = FRAME_SMALLEST_CHAR_WIDTH (f);
2144 height = FRAME_SMALLEST_FONT_HEIGHT (f);
2145 goto virtual_glyph;
2148 w = XWINDOW (window);
2149 width = WINDOW_FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (w);
2150 height = WINDOW_FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
2152 x = window_relative_x_coord (w, part, gx);
2153 y = gy - WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_Y (w);
2155 r = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
2156 end_row = MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix, w);
2158 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
2160 area = TEXT_AREA;
2161 part = ON_MODE_LINE; /* Don't adjust margin. */
2162 goto text_glyph;
2165 switch (part)
2167 case ON_LEFT_MARGIN:
2168 area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA;
2169 goto text_glyph;
2171 case ON_RIGHT_MARGIN:
2172 area = RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA;
2173 goto text_glyph;
2175 case ON_HEADER_LINE:
2176 case ON_MODE_LINE:
2177 gr = (part == ON_HEADER_LINE
2178 ? MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)
2179 : MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix));
2180 gy = gr->y;
2181 area = TEXT_AREA;
2182 goto text_glyph_row_found;
2184 case ON_TEXT:
2185 area = TEXT_AREA;
2187 text_glyph:
2188 gr = 0; gy = 0;
2189 for (; r <= end_row && r->enabled_p; ++r)
2190 if (r->y + r->height > y)
2192 gr = r; gy = r->y;
2193 break;
2196 text_glyph_row_found:
2197 if (gr && gy <= y)
2199 struct glyph *g = gr->glyphs[area];
2200 struct glyph *end = g + gr->used[area];
2202 height = gr->height;
2203 for (gx = gr->x; g < end; gx += g->pixel_width, ++g)
2204 if (gx + g->pixel_width > x)
2205 break;
2207 if (g < end)
2209 if (g->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
2211 /* Don't remember when mouse is over image, as
2212 image may have hot-spots. */
2213 STORE_NATIVE_RECT (*rect, 0, 0, 0, 0);
2214 return;
2216 width = g->pixel_width;
2218 else
2220 /* Use nominal char spacing at end of line. */
2221 x -= gx;
2222 gx += (x / width) * width;
2225 if (part != ON_MODE_LINE && part != ON_HEADER_LINE)
2226 gx += window_box_left_offset (w, area);
2228 else
2230 /* Use nominal line height at end of window. */
2231 gx = (x / width) * width;
2232 y -= gy;
2233 gy += (y / height) * height;
2235 break;
2237 case ON_LEFT_FRINGE:
2238 gx = (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
2239 ? WINDOW_LEFT_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (w)
2240 : window_box_right_offset (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA));
2241 width = WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w);
2242 goto row_glyph;
2244 case ON_RIGHT_FRINGE:
2245 gx = (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
2246 ? window_box_right_offset (w, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA)
2247 : window_box_right_offset (w, TEXT_AREA));
2248 width = WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w);
2249 goto row_glyph;
2251 case ON_SCROLL_BAR:
2252 gx = (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w)
2254 : (window_box_right_offset (w, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA)
2255 + (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
2256 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
2257 : 0)));
2258 width = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (w);
2260 row_glyph:
2261 gr = 0, gy = 0;
2262 for (; r <= end_row && r->enabled_p; ++r)
2263 if (r->y + r->height > y)
2265 gr = r; gy = r->y;
2266 break;
2269 if (gr && gy <= y)
2270 height = gr->height;
2271 else
2273 /* Use nominal line height at end of window. */
2274 y -= gy;
2275 gy += (y / height) * height;
2277 break;
2279 default:
2281 virtual_glyph:
2282 /* If there is no glyph under the mouse, then we divide the screen
2283 into a grid of the smallest glyph in the frame, and use that
2284 as our "glyph". */
2286 /* Arrange for the division in FRAME_PIXEL_X_TO_COL etc. to
2287 round down even for negative values. */
2288 if (gx < 0)
2289 gx -= width - 1;
2290 if (gy < 0)
2291 gy -= height - 1;
2293 gx = (gx / width) * width;
2294 gy = (gy / height) * height;
2296 goto store_rect;
2299 gx += WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w);
2300 gy += WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_Y (w);
2302 store_rect:
2303 STORE_NATIVE_RECT (*rect, gx, gy, width, height);
2305 /* Visible feedback for debugging. */
2306 #if 0
2307 #if HAVE_X_WINDOWS
2308 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2309 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2310 gx, gy, width, height);
2311 #endif
2312 #endif
2316 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
2319 /***********************************************************************
2320 Lisp form evaluation
2321 ***********************************************************************/
2323 /* Error handler for safe_eval and safe_call. */
2325 static Lisp_Object
2326 safe_eval_handler (Lisp_Object arg)
2328 add_to_log ("Error during redisplay: %S", arg, Qnil);
2329 return Qnil;
2333 /* Evaluate SEXPR and return the result, or nil if something went
2334 wrong. Prevent redisplay during the evaluation. */
2336 /* Call function ARGS[0] with arguments ARGS[1] to ARGS[NARGS - 1].
2337 Return the result, or nil if something went wrong. Prevent
2338 redisplay during the evaluation. */
2340 Lisp_Object
2341 safe_call (ptrdiff_t nargs, Lisp_Object *args)
2343 Lisp_Object val;
2345 if (inhibit_eval_during_redisplay)
2346 val = Qnil;
2347 else
2349 int count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
2350 struct gcpro gcpro1;
2352 GCPRO1 (args[0]);
2353 gcpro1.nvars = nargs;
2354 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay, Qt);
2355 /* Use Qt to ensure debugger does not run,
2356 so there is no possibility of wanting to redisplay. */
2357 val = internal_condition_case_n (Ffuncall, nargs, args, Qt,
2358 safe_eval_handler);
2359 UNGCPRO;
2360 val = unbind_to (count, val);
2363 return val;
2367 /* Call function FN with one argument ARG.
2368 Return the result, or nil if something went wrong. */
2370 Lisp_Object
2371 safe_call1 (Lisp_Object fn, Lisp_Object arg)
2373 Lisp_Object args[2];
2374 args[0] = fn;
2375 args[1] = arg;
2376 return safe_call (2, args);
2379 static Lisp_Object Qeval;
2381 Lisp_Object
2382 safe_eval (Lisp_Object sexpr)
2384 return safe_call1 (Qeval, sexpr);
2387 /* Call function FN with one argument ARG.
2388 Return the result, or nil if something went wrong. */
2390 Lisp_Object
2391 safe_call2 (Lisp_Object fn, Lisp_Object arg1, Lisp_Object arg2)
2393 Lisp_Object args[3];
2394 args[0] = fn;
2395 args[1] = arg1;
2396 args[2] = arg2;
2397 return safe_call (3, args);
2402 /***********************************************************************
2403 Debugging
2404 ***********************************************************************/
2406 #if 0
2408 /* Define CHECK_IT to perform sanity checks on iterators.
2409 This is for debugging. It is too slow to do unconditionally. */
2411 static void
2412 check_it (struct it *it)
2414 if (it->method == GET_FROM_STRING)
2416 xassert (STRINGP (it->string));
2417 xassert (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= 0);
2419 else
2421 xassert (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) < 0);
2422 if (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER)
2424 /* Check that character and byte positions agree. */
2425 xassert (IT_CHARPOS (*it) == BYTE_TO_CHAR (IT_BYTEPOS (*it)));
2429 if (it->dpvec)
2430 xassert (it->current.dpvec_index >= 0);
2431 else
2432 xassert (it->current.dpvec_index < 0);
2435 #define CHECK_IT(IT) check_it ((IT))
2437 #else /* not 0 */
2439 #define CHECK_IT(IT) (void) 0
2441 #endif /* not 0 */
2444 #if GLYPH_DEBUG && XASSERTS
2446 /* Check that the window end of window W is what we expect it
2447 to be---the last row in the current matrix displaying text. */
2449 static void
2450 check_window_end (struct window *w)
2452 if (!MINI_WINDOW_P (w)
2453 && !NILP (w->window_end_valid))
2455 struct glyph_row *row;
2456 xassert ((row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix,
2457 XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos)),
2458 !row->enabled_p
2459 || MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row)
2460 || MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (row, w->current_matrix) == 0));
2464 #define CHECK_WINDOW_END(W) check_window_end ((W))
2466 #else
2468 #define CHECK_WINDOW_END(W) (void) 0
2470 #endif
2474 /***********************************************************************
2475 Iterator initialization
2476 ***********************************************************************/
2478 /* Initialize IT for displaying current_buffer in window W, starting
2479 at character position CHARPOS. CHARPOS < 0 means that no buffer
2480 position is specified which is useful when the iterator is assigned
2481 a position later. BYTEPOS is the byte position corresponding to
2482 CHARPOS. BYTEPOS < 0 means compute it from CHARPOS.
2484 If ROW is not null, calls to produce_glyphs with IT as parameter
2485 will produce glyphs in that row.
2487 BASE_FACE_ID is the id of a base face to use. It must be one of
2488 DEFAULT_FACE_ID for normal text, MODE_LINE_FACE_ID,
2489 MODE_LINE_INACTIVE_FACE_ID, or HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID for displaying
2490 mode lines, or TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID for displaying the tool-bar.
2492 If ROW is null and BASE_FACE_ID is equal to MODE_LINE_FACE_ID,
2493 MODE_LINE_INACTIVE_FACE_ID, or HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID, the iterator
2494 will be initialized to use the corresponding mode line glyph row of
2495 the desired matrix of W. */
2497 void
2498 init_iterator (struct it *it, struct window *w,
2499 EMACS_INT charpos, EMACS_INT bytepos,
2500 struct glyph_row *row, enum face_id base_face_id)
2502 int highlight_region_p;
2503 enum face_id remapped_base_face_id = base_face_id;
2505 /* Some precondition checks. */
2506 xassert (w != NULL && it != NULL);
2507 xassert (charpos < 0 || (charpos >= BUF_BEG (current_buffer)
2508 && charpos <= ZV));
2510 /* If face attributes have been changed since the last redisplay,
2511 free realized faces now because they depend on face definitions
2512 that might have changed. Don't free faces while there might be
2513 desired matrices pending which reference these faces. */
2514 if (face_change_count && !inhibit_free_realized_faces)
2516 face_change_count = 0;
2517 free_all_realized_faces (Qnil);
2520 /* Perhaps remap BASE_FACE_ID to a user-specified alternative. */
2521 if (! NILP (Vface_remapping_alist))
2522 remapped_base_face_id = lookup_basic_face (XFRAME (w->frame), base_face_id);
2524 /* Use one of the mode line rows of W's desired matrix if
2525 appropriate. */
2526 if (row == NULL)
2528 if (base_face_id == MODE_LINE_FACE_ID
2529 || base_face_id == MODE_LINE_INACTIVE_FACE_ID)
2530 row = MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->desired_matrix);
2531 else if (base_face_id == HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID)
2532 row = MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->desired_matrix);
2535 /* Clear IT. */
2536 memset (it, 0, sizeof *it);
2537 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
2538 it->current.dpvec_index = -1;
2539 it->base_face_id = remapped_base_face_id;
2540 it->string = Qnil;
2541 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = -1;
2542 it->paragraph_embedding = L2R;
2543 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = Qnil;
2544 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
2545 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = 0;
2547 /* The window in which we iterate over current_buffer: */
2548 XSETWINDOW (it->window, w);
2549 it->w = w;
2550 it->f = XFRAME (w->frame);
2552 it->cmp_it.id = -1;
2554 /* Extra space between lines (on window systems only). */
2555 if (base_face_id == DEFAULT_FACE_ID
2556 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
2558 if (NATNUMP (BVAR (current_buffer, extra_line_spacing)))
2559 it->extra_line_spacing = XFASTINT (BVAR (current_buffer, extra_line_spacing));
2560 else if (FLOATP (BVAR (current_buffer, extra_line_spacing)))
2561 it->extra_line_spacing = (XFLOAT_DATA (BVAR (current_buffer, extra_line_spacing))
2562 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it->f));
2563 else if (it->f->extra_line_spacing > 0)
2564 it->extra_line_spacing = it->f->extra_line_spacing;
2565 it->max_extra_line_spacing = 0;
2568 /* If realized faces have been removed, e.g. because of face
2569 attribute changes of named faces, recompute them. When running
2570 in batch mode, the face cache of the initial frame is null. If
2571 we happen to get called, make a dummy face cache. */
2572 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (it->f) == NULL)
2573 init_frame_faces (it->f);
2574 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (it->f)->used == 0)
2575 recompute_basic_faces (it->f);
2577 /* Current value of the `slice', `space-width', and 'height' properties. */
2578 it->slice.x = it->slice.y = it->slice.width = it->slice.height = Qnil;
2579 it->space_width = Qnil;
2580 it->font_height = Qnil;
2581 it->override_ascent = -1;
2583 /* Are control characters displayed as `^C'? */
2584 it->ctl_arrow_p = !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, ctl_arrow));
2586 /* -1 means everything between a CR and the following line end
2587 is invisible. >0 means lines indented more than this value are
2588 invisible. */
2589 it->selective = (INTEGERP (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display))
2590 ? XINT (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display))
2591 : (!NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display))
2592 ? -1 : 0));
2593 it->selective_display_ellipsis_p
2594 = !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display_ellipses));
2596 /* Display table to use. */
2597 it->dp = window_display_table (w);
2599 /* Are multibyte characters enabled in current_buffer? */
2600 it->multibyte_p = !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters));
2602 /* Non-zero if we should highlight the region. */
2603 highlight_region_p
2604 = (!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
2605 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, mark_active))
2606 && XMARKER (BVAR (current_buffer, mark))->buffer != 0);
2608 /* Set IT->region_beg_charpos and IT->region_end_charpos to the
2609 start and end of a visible region in window IT->w. Set both to
2610 -1 to indicate no region. */
2611 if (highlight_region_p
2612 /* Maybe highlight only in selected window. */
2613 && (/* Either show region everywhere. */
2614 highlight_nonselected_windows
2615 /* Or show region in the selected window. */
2616 || w == XWINDOW (selected_window)
2617 /* Or show the region if we are in the mini-buffer and W is
2618 the window the mini-buffer refers to. */
2619 || (MINI_WINDOW_P (XWINDOW (selected_window))
2620 && WINDOWP (minibuf_selected_window)
2621 && w == XWINDOW (minibuf_selected_window))))
2623 EMACS_INT markpos = marker_position (BVAR (current_buffer, mark));
2624 it->region_beg_charpos = min (PT, markpos);
2625 it->region_end_charpos = max (PT, markpos);
2627 else
2628 it->region_beg_charpos = it->region_end_charpos = -1;
2630 /* Get the position at which the redisplay_end_trigger hook should
2631 be run, if it is to be run at all. */
2632 if (MARKERP (w->redisplay_end_trigger)
2633 && XMARKER (w->redisplay_end_trigger)->buffer != 0)
2634 it->redisplay_end_trigger_charpos
2635 = marker_position (w->redisplay_end_trigger);
2636 else if (INTEGERP (w->redisplay_end_trigger))
2637 it->redisplay_end_trigger_charpos = XINT (w->redisplay_end_trigger);
2639 it->tab_width = SANE_TAB_WIDTH (current_buffer);
2641 /* Are lines in the display truncated? */
2642 if (base_face_id != DEFAULT_FACE_ID
2643 || XINT (it->w->hscroll)
2644 || (! WINDOW_FULL_WIDTH_P (it->w)
2645 && ((!NILP (Vtruncate_partial_width_windows)
2646 && !INTEGERP (Vtruncate_partial_width_windows))
2647 || (INTEGERP (Vtruncate_partial_width_windows)
2648 && (WINDOW_TOTAL_COLS (it->w)
2649 < XINT (Vtruncate_partial_width_windows))))))
2650 it->line_wrap = TRUNCATE;
2651 else if (NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, truncate_lines)))
2652 it->line_wrap = NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, word_wrap))
2653 ? WINDOW_WRAP : WORD_WRAP;
2654 else
2655 it->line_wrap = TRUNCATE;
2657 /* Get dimensions of truncation and continuation glyphs. These are
2658 displayed as fringe bitmaps under X, so we don't need them for such
2659 frames. */
2660 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
2662 if (it->line_wrap == TRUNCATE)
2664 /* We will need the truncation glyph. */
2665 xassert (it->glyph_row == NULL);
2666 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_TRUNCATION);
2667 it->truncation_pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
2669 else
2671 /* We will need the continuation glyph. */
2672 xassert (it->glyph_row == NULL);
2673 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_CONTINUATION);
2674 it->continuation_pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
2677 /* Reset these values to zero because the produce_special_glyphs
2678 above has changed them. */
2679 it->pixel_width = it->ascent = it->descent = 0;
2680 it->phys_ascent = it->phys_descent = 0;
2683 /* Set this after getting the dimensions of truncation and
2684 continuation glyphs, so that we don't produce glyphs when calling
2685 produce_special_glyphs, above. */
2686 it->glyph_row = row;
2687 it->area = TEXT_AREA;
2689 /* Forget any previous info about this row being reversed. */
2690 if (it->glyph_row)
2691 it->glyph_row->reversed_p = 0;
2693 /* Get the dimensions of the display area. The display area
2694 consists of the visible window area plus a horizontally scrolled
2695 part to the left of the window. All x-values are relative to the
2696 start of this total display area. */
2697 if (base_face_id != DEFAULT_FACE_ID)
2699 /* Mode lines, menu bar in terminal frames. */
2700 it->first_visible_x = 0;
2701 it->last_visible_x = WINDOW_TOTAL_WIDTH (w);
2703 else
2705 it->first_visible_x
2706 = XFASTINT (it->w->hscroll) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it->f);
2707 it->last_visible_x = (it->first_visible_x
2708 + window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA));
2710 /* If we truncate lines, leave room for the truncator glyph(s) at
2711 the right margin. Otherwise, leave room for the continuation
2712 glyph(s). Truncation and continuation glyphs are not inserted
2713 for window-based redisplay. */
2714 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
2716 if (it->line_wrap == TRUNCATE)
2717 it->last_visible_x -= it->truncation_pixel_width;
2718 else
2719 it->last_visible_x -= it->continuation_pixel_width;
2722 it->header_line_p = WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w);
2723 it->current_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w) + w->vscroll;
2726 /* Leave room for a border glyph. */
2727 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
2728 && !WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (it->w))
2729 it->last_visible_x -= 1;
2731 it->last_visible_y = window_text_bottom_y (w);
2733 /* For mode lines and alike, arrange for the first glyph having a
2734 left box line if the face specifies a box. */
2735 if (base_face_id != DEFAULT_FACE_ID)
2737 struct face *face;
2739 it->face_id = remapped_base_face_id;
2741 /* If we have a boxed mode line, make the first character appear
2742 with a left box line. */
2743 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, remapped_base_face_id);
2744 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2745 it->start_of_box_run_p = 1;
2748 /* If a buffer position was specified, set the iterator there,
2749 getting overlays and face properties from that position. */
2750 if (charpos >= BUF_BEG (current_buffer))
2752 it->end_charpos = ZV;
2753 it->face_id = -1;
2754 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = charpos;
2756 /* Compute byte position if not specified. */
2757 if (bytepos < charpos)
2758 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = CHAR_TO_BYTE (charpos);
2759 else
2760 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = bytepos;
2762 it->start = it->current;
2763 /* Do we need to reorder bidirectional text? Not if this is a
2764 unibyte buffer: by definition, none of the single-byte
2765 characters are strong R2L, so no reordering is needed. And
2766 bidi.c doesn't support unibyte buffers anyway. */
2767 it->bidi_p =
2768 !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, bidi_display_reordering))
2769 && it->multibyte_p;
2771 /* If we are to reorder bidirectional text, init the bidi
2772 iterator. */
2773 if (it->bidi_p)
2775 /* Note the paragraph direction that this buffer wants to
2776 use. */
2777 if (EQ (BVAR (current_buffer, bidi_paragraph_direction),
2778 Qleft_to_right))
2779 it->paragraph_embedding = L2R;
2780 else if (EQ (BVAR (current_buffer, bidi_paragraph_direction),
2781 Qright_to_left))
2782 it->paragraph_embedding = R2L;
2783 else
2784 it->paragraph_embedding = NEUTRAL_DIR;
2785 bidi_unshelve_cache (NULL, 0);
2786 bidi_init_it (charpos, IT_BYTEPOS (*it), FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f),
2787 &it->bidi_it);
2790 /* Compute faces etc. */
2791 reseat (it, it->current.pos, 1);
2794 CHECK_IT (it);
2798 /* Initialize IT for the display of window W with window start POS. */
2800 void
2801 start_display (struct it *it, struct window *w, struct text_pos pos)
2803 struct glyph_row *row;
2804 int first_vpos = WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w) ? 1 : 0;
2806 row = w->desired_matrix->rows + first_vpos;
2807 init_iterator (it, w, CHARPOS (pos), BYTEPOS (pos), row, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
2808 it->first_vpos = first_vpos;
2810 /* Don't reseat to previous visible line start if current start
2811 position is in a string or image. */
2812 if (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER && it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE)
2814 int start_at_line_beg_p;
2815 int first_y = it->current_y;
2817 /* If window start is not at a line start, skip forward to POS to
2818 get the correct continuation lines width. */
2819 start_at_line_beg_p = (CHARPOS (pos) == BEGV
2820 || FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (pos) - 1) == '\n');
2821 if (!start_at_line_beg_p)
2823 int new_x;
2825 reseat_at_previous_visible_line_start (it);
2826 move_it_to (it, CHARPOS (pos), -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
2828 new_x = it->current_x + it->pixel_width;
2830 /* If lines are continued, this line may end in the middle
2831 of a multi-glyph character (e.g. a control character
2832 displayed as \003, or in the middle of an overlay
2833 string). In this case move_it_to above will not have
2834 taken us to the start of the continuation line but to the
2835 end of the continued line. */
2836 if (it->current_x > 0
2837 && it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE /* Lines are continued. */
2838 && (/* And glyph doesn't fit on the line. */
2839 new_x > it->last_visible_x
2840 /* Or it fits exactly and we're on a window
2841 system frame. */
2842 || (new_x == it->last_visible_x
2843 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))))
2845 if (it->current.dpvec_index >= 0
2846 || it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0)
2848 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
2849 move_it_in_display_line_to (it, -1, -1, 0);
2852 it->continuation_lines_width += it->current_x;
2855 /* We're starting a new display line, not affected by the
2856 height of the continued line, so clear the appropriate
2857 fields in the iterator structure. */
2858 it->max_ascent = it->max_descent = 0;
2859 it->max_phys_ascent = it->max_phys_descent = 0;
2861 it->current_y = first_y;
2862 it->vpos = 0;
2863 it->current_x = it->hpos = 0;
2869 /* Return 1 if POS is a position in ellipses displayed for invisible
2870 text. W is the window we display, for text property lookup. */
2872 static int
2873 in_ellipses_for_invisible_text_p (struct display_pos *pos, struct window *w)
2875 Lisp_Object prop, window;
2876 int ellipses_p = 0;
2877 EMACS_INT charpos = CHARPOS (pos->pos);
2879 /* If POS specifies a position in a display vector, this might
2880 be for an ellipsis displayed for invisible text. We won't
2881 get the iterator set up for delivering that ellipsis unless
2882 we make sure that it gets aware of the invisible text. */
2883 if (pos->dpvec_index >= 0
2884 && pos->overlay_string_index < 0
2885 && CHARPOS (pos->string_pos) < 0
2886 && charpos > BEGV
2887 && (XSETWINDOW (window, w),
2888 prop = Fget_char_property (make_number (charpos),
2889 Qinvisible, window),
2890 !TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop)))
2892 prop = Fget_char_property (make_number (charpos - 1), Qinvisible,
2893 window);
2894 ellipses_p = 2 == TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop);
2897 return ellipses_p;
2901 /* Initialize IT for stepping through current_buffer in window W,
2902 starting at position POS that includes overlay string and display
2903 vector/ control character translation position information. Value
2904 is zero if there are overlay strings with newlines at POS. */
2906 static int
2907 init_from_display_pos (struct it *it, struct window *w, struct display_pos *pos)
2909 EMACS_INT charpos = CHARPOS (pos->pos), bytepos = BYTEPOS (pos->pos);
2910 int i, overlay_strings_with_newlines = 0;
2912 /* If POS specifies a position in a display vector, this might
2913 be for an ellipsis displayed for invisible text. We won't
2914 get the iterator set up for delivering that ellipsis unless
2915 we make sure that it gets aware of the invisible text. */
2916 if (in_ellipses_for_invisible_text_p (pos, w))
2918 --charpos;
2919 bytepos = 0;
2922 /* Keep in mind: the call to reseat in init_iterator skips invisible
2923 text, so we might end up at a position different from POS. This
2924 is only a problem when POS is a row start after a newline and an
2925 overlay starts there with an after-string, and the overlay has an
2926 invisible property. Since we don't skip invisible text in
2927 display_line and elsewhere immediately after consuming the
2928 newline before the row start, such a POS will not be in a string,
2929 but the call to init_iterator below will move us to the
2930 after-string. */
2931 init_iterator (it, w, charpos, bytepos, NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
2933 /* This only scans the current chunk -- it should scan all chunks.
2934 However, OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE has been increased from 3 in 21.1
2935 to 16 in 22.1 to make this a lesser problem. */
2936 for (i = 0; i < it->n_overlay_strings && i < OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE; ++i)
2938 const char *s = SSDATA (it->overlay_strings[i]);
2939 const char *e = s + SBYTES (it->overlay_strings[i]);
2941 while (s < e && *s != '\n')
2942 ++s;
2944 if (s < e)
2946 overlay_strings_with_newlines = 1;
2947 break;
2951 /* If position is within an overlay string, set up IT to the right
2952 overlay string. */
2953 if (pos->overlay_string_index >= 0)
2955 int relative_index;
2957 /* If the first overlay string happens to have a `display'
2958 property for an image, the iterator will be set up for that
2959 image, and we have to undo that setup first before we can
2960 correct the overlay string index. */
2961 if (it->method == GET_FROM_IMAGE)
2962 pop_it (it);
2964 /* We already have the first chunk of overlay strings in
2965 IT->overlay_strings. Load more until the one for
2966 pos->overlay_string_index is in IT->overlay_strings. */
2967 if (pos->overlay_string_index >= OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE)
2969 int n = pos->overlay_string_index / OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE;
2970 it->current.overlay_string_index = 0;
2971 while (n--)
2973 load_overlay_strings (it, 0);
2974 it->current.overlay_string_index += OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE;
2978 it->current.overlay_string_index = pos->overlay_string_index;
2979 relative_index = (it->current.overlay_string_index
2980 % OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE);
2981 it->string = it->overlay_strings[relative_index];
2982 xassert (STRINGP (it->string));
2983 it->current.string_pos = pos->string_pos;
2984 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
2987 if (CHARPOS (pos->string_pos) >= 0)
2989 /* Recorded position is not in an overlay string, but in another
2990 string. This can only be a string from a `display' property.
2991 IT should already be filled with that string. */
2992 it->current.string_pos = pos->string_pos;
2993 xassert (STRINGP (it->string));
2996 /* Restore position in display vector translations, control
2997 character translations or ellipses. */
2998 if (pos->dpvec_index >= 0)
3000 if (it->dpvec == NULL)
3001 get_next_display_element (it);
3002 xassert (it->dpvec && it->current.dpvec_index == 0);
3003 it->current.dpvec_index = pos->dpvec_index;
3006 CHECK_IT (it);
3007 return !overlay_strings_with_newlines;
3011 /* Initialize IT for stepping through current_buffer in window W
3012 starting at ROW->start. */
3014 static void
3015 init_to_row_start (struct it *it, struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
3017 init_from_display_pos (it, w, &row->start);
3018 it->start = row->start;
3019 it->continuation_lines_width = row->continuation_lines_width;
3020 CHECK_IT (it);
3024 /* Initialize IT for stepping through current_buffer in window W
3025 starting in the line following ROW, i.e. starting at ROW->end.
3026 Value is zero if there are overlay strings with newlines at ROW's
3027 end position. */
3029 static int
3030 init_to_row_end (struct it *it, struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
3032 int success = 0;
3034 if (init_from_display_pos (it, w, &row->end))
3036 if (row->continued_p)
3037 it->continuation_lines_width
3038 = row->continuation_lines_width + row->pixel_width;
3039 CHECK_IT (it);
3040 success = 1;
3043 return success;
3049 /***********************************************************************
3050 Text properties
3051 ***********************************************************************/
3053 /* Called when IT reaches IT->stop_charpos. Handle text property and
3054 overlay changes. Set IT->stop_charpos to the next position where
3055 to stop. */
3057 static void
3058 handle_stop (struct it *it)
3060 enum prop_handled handled;
3061 int handle_overlay_change_p;
3062 struct props *p;
3064 it->dpvec = NULL;
3065 it->current.dpvec_index = -1;
3066 handle_overlay_change_p = !it->ignore_overlay_strings_at_pos_p;
3067 it->ignore_overlay_strings_at_pos_p = 0;
3068 it->ellipsis_p = 0;
3070 /* Use face of preceding text for ellipsis (if invisible) */
3071 if (it->selective_display_ellipsis_p)
3072 it->saved_face_id = it->face_id;
3076 handled = HANDLED_NORMALLY;
3078 /* Call text property handlers. */
3079 for (p = it_props; p->handler; ++p)
3081 handled = p->handler (it);
3083 if (handled == HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS)
3084 break;
3085 else if (handled == HANDLED_RETURN)
3087 /* We still want to show before and after strings from
3088 overlays even if the actual buffer text is replaced. */
3089 if (!handle_overlay_change_p
3090 || it->sp > 1
3091 || !get_overlay_strings_1 (it, 0, 0))
3093 if (it->ellipsis_p)
3094 setup_for_ellipsis (it, 0);
3095 /* When handling a display spec, we might load an
3096 empty string. In that case, discard it here. We
3097 used to discard it in handle_single_display_spec,
3098 but that causes get_overlay_strings_1, above, to
3099 ignore overlay strings that we must check. */
3100 if (STRINGP (it->string) && !SCHARS (it->string))
3101 pop_it (it);
3102 return;
3104 else if (STRINGP (it->string) && !SCHARS (it->string))
3105 pop_it (it);
3106 else
3108 it->ignore_overlay_strings_at_pos_p = 1;
3109 it->string_from_display_prop_p = 0;
3110 it->from_disp_prop_p = 0;
3111 handle_overlay_change_p = 0;
3113 handled = HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS;
3114 break;
3116 else if (handled == HANDLED_OVERLAY_STRING_CONSUMED)
3117 handle_overlay_change_p = 0;
3120 if (handled != HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS)
3122 /* Don't check for overlay strings below when set to deliver
3123 characters from a display vector. */
3124 if (it->method == GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR)
3125 handle_overlay_change_p = 0;
3127 /* Handle overlay changes.
3128 This sets HANDLED to HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS
3129 if it finds overlays. */
3130 if (handle_overlay_change_p)
3131 handled = handle_overlay_change (it);
3134 if (it->ellipsis_p)
3136 setup_for_ellipsis (it, 0);
3137 break;
3140 while (handled == HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS);
3142 /* Determine where to stop next. */
3143 if (handled == HANDLED_NORMALLY)
3144 compute_stop_pos (it);
3148 /* Compute IT->stop_charpos from text property and overlay change
3149 information for IT's current position. */
3151 static void
3152 compute_stop_pos (struct it *it)
3154 register INTERVAL iv, next_iv;
3155 Lisp_Object object, limit, position;
3156 EMACS_INT charpos, bytepos;
3158 /* If nowhere else, stop at the end. */
3159 it->stop_charpos = it->end_charpos;
3161 if (STRINGP (it->string))
3163 /* Strings are usually short, so don't limit the search for
3164 properties. */
3165 object = it->string;
3166 limit = Qnil;
3167 charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
3168 bytepos = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it);
3170 else
3172 EMACS_INT pos;
3174 /* If next overlay change is in front of the current stop pos
3175 (which is IT->end_charpos), stop there. Note: value of
3176 next_overlay_change is point-max if no overlay change
3177 follows. */
3178 charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
3179 bytepos = IT_BYTEPOS (*it);
3180 pos = next_overlay_change (charpos);
3181 if (pos < it->stop_charpos)
3182 it->stop_charpos = pos;
3184 /* If showing the region, we have to stop at the region
3185 start or end because the face might change there. */
3186 if (it->region_beg_charpos > 0)
3188 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < it->region_beg_charpos)
3189 it->stop_charpos = min (it->stop_charpos, it->region_beg_charpos);
3190 else if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < it->region_end_charpos)
3191 it->stop_charpos = min (it->stop_charpos, it->region_end_charpos);
3194 /* Set up variables for computing the stop position from text
3195 property changes. */
3196 XSETBUFFER (object, current_buffer);
3197 limit = make_number (IT_CHARPOS (*it) + TEXT_PROP_DISTANCE_LIMIT);
3200 /* Get the interval containing IT's position. Value is a null
3201 interval if there isn't such an interval. */
3202 position = make_number (charpos);
3203 iv = validate_interval_range (object, &position, &position, 0);
3204 if (!NULL_INTERVAL_P (iv))
3206 Lisp_Object values_here[LAST_PROP_IDX];
3207 struct props *p;
3209 /* Get properties here. */
3210 for (p = it_props; p->handler; ++p)
3211 values_here[p->idx] = textget (iv->plist, *p->name);
3213 /* Look for an interval following iv that has different
3214 properties. */
3215 for (next_iv = next_interval (iv);
3216 (!NULL_INTERVAL_P (next_iv)
3217 && (NILP (limit)
3218 || XFASTINT (limit) > next_iv->position));
3219 next_iv = next_interval (next_iv))
3221 for (p = it_props; p->handler; ++p)
3223 Lisp_Object new_value;
3225 new_value = textget (next_iv->plist, *p->name);
3226 if (!EQ (values_here[p->idx], new_value))
3227 break;
3230 if (p->handler)
3231 break;
3234 if (!NULL_INTERVAL_P (next_iv))
3236 if (INTEGERP (limit)
3237 && next_iv->position >= XFASTINT (limit))
3238 /* No text property change up to limit. */
3239 it->stop_charpos = min (XFASTINT (limit), it->stop_charpos);
3240 else
3241 /* Text properties change in next_iv. */
3242 it->stop_charpos = min (it->stop_charpos, next_iv->position);
3246 if (it->cmp_it.id < 0)
3248 EMACS_INT stoppos = it->end_charpos;
3250 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
3251 stoppos = -1;
3252 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, charpos, bytepos,
3253 stoppos, it->string);
3256 xassert (STRINGP (it->string)
3257 || (it->stop_charpos >= BEGV
3258 && it->stop_charpos >= IT_CHARPOS (*it)));
3262 /* Return the position of the next overlay change after POS in
3263 current_buffer. Value is point-max if no overlay change
3264 follows. This is like `next-overlay-change' but doesn't use
3265 xmalloc. */
3267 static EMACS_INT
3268 next_overlay_change (EMACS_INT pos)
3270 ptrdiff_t i, noverlays;
3271 EMACS_INT endpos;
3272 Lisp_Object *overlays;
3274 /* Get all overlays at the given position. */
3275 GET_OVERLAYS_AT (pos, overlays, noverlays, &endpos, 1);
3277 /* If any of these overlays ends before endpos,
3278 use its ending point instead. */
3279 for (i = 0; i < noverlays; ++i)
3281 Lisp_Object oend;
3282 EMACS_INT oendpos;
3284 oend = OVERLAY_END (overlays[i]);
3285 oendpos = OVERLAY_POSITION (oend);
3286 endpos = min (endpos, oendpos);
3289 return endpos;
3292 /* How many characters forward to search for a display property or
3293 display string. Searching too far forward makes the bidi display
3294 sluggish, especially in small windows. */
3295 #define MAX_DISP_SCAN 250
3297 /* Return the character position of a display string at or after
3298 position specified by POSITION. If no display string exists at or
3299 after POSITION, return ZV. A display string is either an overlay
3300 with `display' property whose value is a string, or a `display'
3301 text property whose value is a string. STRING is data about the
3302 string to iterate; if STRING->lstring is nil, we are iterating a
3303 buffer. FRAME_WINDOW_P is non-zero when we are displaying a window
3304 on a GUI frame. DISP_PROP is set to zero if we searched
3305 MAX_DISP_SCAN characters forward without finding any display
3306 strings, non-zero otherwise. It is set to 2 if the display string
3307 uses any kind of `(space ...)' spec that will produce a stretch of
3308 white space in the text area. */
3309 EMACS_INT
3310 compute_display_string_pos (struct text_pos *position,
3311 struct bidi_string_data *string,
3312 int frame_window_p, int *disp_prop)
3314 /* OBJECT = nil means current buffer. */
3315 Lisp_Object object =
3316 (string && STRINGP (string->lstring)) ? string->lstring : Qnil;
3317 Lisp_Object pos, spec, limpos;
3318 int string_p = (string && (STRINGP (string->lstring) || string->s));
3319 EMACS_INT eob = string_p ? string->schars : ZV;
3320 EMACS_INT begb = string_p ? 0 : BEGV;
3321 EMACS_INT bufpos, charpos = CHARPOS (*position);
3322 EMACS_INT lim =
3323 (charpos < eob - MAX_DISP_SCAN) ? charpos + MAX_DISP_SCAN : eob;
3324 struct text_pos tpos;
3325 int rv = 0;
3327 *disp_prop = 1;
3329 if (charpos >= eob
3330 /* We don't support display properties whose values are strings
3331 that have display string properties. */
3332 || string->from_disp_str
3333 /* C strings cannot have display properties. */
3334 || (string->s && !STRINGP (object)))
3336 *disp_prop = 0;
3337 return eob;
3340 /* If the character at CHARPOS is where the display string begins,
3341 return CHARPOS. */
3342 pos = make_number (charpos);
3343 if (STRINGP (object))
3344 bufpos = string->bufpos;
3345 else
3346 bufpos = charpos;
3347 tpos = *position;
3348 if (!NILP (spec = Fget_char_property (pos, Qdisplay, object))
3349 && (charpos <= begb
3350 || !EQ (Fget_char_property (make_number (charpos - 1), Qdisplay,
3351 object),
3352 spec))
3353 && (rv = handle_display_spec (NULL, spec, object, Qnil, &tpos, bufpos,
3354 frame_window_p)))
3356 if (rv == 2)
3357 *disp_prop = 2;
3358 return charpos;
3361 /* Look forward for the first character with a `display' property
3362 that will replace the underlying text when displayed. */
3363 limpos = make_number (lim);
3364 do {
3365 pos = Fnext_single_char_property_change (pos, Qdisplay, object, limpos);
3366 CHARPOS (tpos) = XFASTINT (pos);
3367 if (CHARPOS (tpos) >= lim)
3369 *disp_prop = 0;
3370 break;
3372 if (STRINGP (object))
3373 BYTEPOS (tpos) = string_char_to_byte (object, CHARPOS (tpos));
3374 else
3375 BYTEPOS (tpos) = CHAR_TO_BYTE (CHARPOS (tpos));
3376 spec = Fget_char_property (pos, Qdisplay, object);
3377 if (!STRINGP (object))
3378 bufpos = CHARPOS (tpos);
3379 } while (NILP (spec)
3380 || !(rv = handle_display_spec (NULL, spec, object, Qnil, &tpos,
3381 bufpos, frame_window_p)));
3382 if (rv == 2)
3383 *disp_prop = 2;
3385 return CHARPOS (tpos);
3388 /* Return the character position of the end of the display string that
3389 started at CHARPOS. If there's no display string at CHARPOS,
3390 return -1. A display string is either an overlay with `display'
3391 property whose value is a string or a `display' text property whose
3392 value is a string. */
3393 EMACS_INT
3394 compute_display_string_end (EMACS_INT charpos, struct bidi_string_data *string)
3396 /* OBJECT = nil means current buffer. */
3397 Lisp_Object object =
3398 (string && STRINGP (string->lstring)) ? string->lstring : Qnil;
3399 Lisp_Object pos = make_number (charpos);
3400 EMACS_INT eob =
3401 (STRINGP (object) || (string && string->s)) ? string->schars : ZV;
3403 if (charpos >= eob || (string->s && !STRINGP (object)))
3404 return eob;
3406 /* It could happen that the display property or overlay was removed
3407 since we found it in compute_display_string_pos above. One way
3408 this can happen is if JIT font-lock was called (through
3409 handle_fontified_prop), and jit-lock-functions remove text
3410 properties or overlays from the portion of buffer that includes
3411 CHARPOS. Muse mode is known to do that, for example. In this
3412 case, we return -1 to the caller, to signal that no display
3413 string is actually present at CHARPOS. See bidi_fetch_char for
3414 how this is handled.
3416 An alternative would be to never look for display properties past
3417 it->stop_charpos. But neither compute_display_string_pos nor
3418 bidi_fetch_char that calls it know or care where the next
3419 stop_charpos is. */
3420 if (NILP (Fget_char_property (pos, Qdisplay, object)))
3421 return -1;
3423 /* Look forward for the first character where the `display' property
3424 changes. */
3425 pos = Fnext_single_char_property_change (pos, Qdisplay, object, Qnil);
3427 return XFASTINT (pos);
3432 /***********************************************************************
3433 Fontification
3434 ***********************************************************************/
3436 /* Handle changes in the `fontified' property of the current buffer by
3437 calling hook functions from Qfontification_functions to fontify
3438 regions of text. */
3440 static enum prop_handled
3441 handle_fontified_prop (struct it *it)
3443 Lisp_Object prop, pos;
3444 enum prop_handled handled = HANDLED_NORMALLY;
3446 if (!NILP (Vmemory_full))
3447 return handled;
3449 /* Get the value of the `fontified' property at IT's current buffer
3450 position. (The `fontified' property doesn't have a special
3451 meaning in strings.) If the value is nil, call functions from
3452 Qfontification_functions. */
3453 if (!STRINGP (it->string)
3454 && it->s == NULL
3455 && !NILP (Vfontification_functions)
3456 && !NILP (Vrun_hooks)
3457 && (pos = make_number (IT_CHARPOS (*it)),
3458 prop = Fget_char_property (pos, Qfontified, Qnil),
3459 /* Ignore the special cased nil value always present at EOB since
3460 no amount of fontifying will be able to change it. */
3461 NILP (prop) && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < Z))
3463 int count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
3464 Lisp_Object val;
3465 struct buffer *obuf = current_buffer;
3466 int begv = BEGV, zv = ZV;
3467 int old_clip_changed = current_buffer->clip_changed;
3469 val = Vfontification_functions;
3470 specbind (Qfontification_functions, Qnil);
3472 xassert (it->end_charpos == ZV);
3474 if (!CONSP (val) || EQ (XCAR (val), Qlambda))
3475 safe_call1 (val, pos);
3476 else
3478 Lisp_Object fns, fn;
3479 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2;
3481 fns = Qnil;
3482 GCPRO2 (val, fns);
3484 for (; CONSP (val); val = XCDR (val))
3486 fn = XCAR (val);
3488 if (EQ (fn, Qt))
3490 /* A value of t indicates this hook has a local
3491 binding; it means to run the global binding too.
3492 In a global value, t should not occur. If it
3493 does, we must ignore it to avoid an endless
3494 loop. */
3495 for (fns = Fdefault_value (Qfontification_functions);
3496 CONSP (fns);
3497 fns = XCDR (fns))
3499 fn = XCAR (fns);
3500 if (!EQ (fn, Qt))
3501 safe_call1 (fn, pos);
3504 else
3505 safe_call1 (fn, pos);
3508 UNGCPRO;
3511 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
3513 /* Fontification functions routinely call `save-restriction'.
3514 Normally, this tags clip_changed, which can confuse redisplay
3515 (see discussion in Bug#6671). Since we don't perform any
3516 special handling of fontification changes in the case where
3517 `save-restriction' isn't called, there's no point doing so in
3518 this case either. So, if the buffer's restrictions are
3519 actually left unchanged, reset clip_changed. */
3520 if (obuf == current_buffer)
3522 if (begv == BEGV && zv == ZV)
3523 current_buffer->clip_changed = old_clip_changed;
3525 /* There isn't much we can reasonably do to protect against
3526 misbehaving fontification, but here's a fig leaf. */
3527 else if (!NILP (BVAR (obuf, name)))
3528 set_buffer_internal_1 (obuf);
3530 /* The fontification code may have added/removed text.
3531 It could do even a lot worse, but let's at least protect against
3532 the most obvious case where only the text past `pos' gets changed',
3533 as is/was done in grep.el where some escapes sequences are turned
3534 into face properties (bug#7876). */
3535 it->end_charpos = ZV;
3537 /* Return HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS only if function fontified
3538 something. This avoids an endless loop if they failed to
3539 fontify the text for which reason ever. */
3540 if (!NILP (Fget_char_property (pos, Qfontified, Qnil)))
3541 handled = HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS;
3544 return handled;
3549 /***********************************************************************
3550 Faces
3551 ***********************************************************************/
3553 /* Set up iterator IT from face properties at its current position.
3554 Called from handle_stop. */
3556 static enum prop_handled
3557 handle_face_prop (struct it *it)
3559 int new_face_id;
3560 EMACS_INT next_stop;
3562 if (!STRINGP (it->string))
3564 new_face_id
3565 = face_at_buffer_position (it->w,
3566 IT_CHARPOS (*it),
3567 it->region_beg_charpos,
3568 it->region_end_charpos,
3569 &next_stop,
3570 (IT_CHARPOS (*it)
3571 + TEXT_PROP_DISTANCE_LIMIT),
3572 0, it->base_face_id);
3574 /* Is this a start of a run of characters with box face?
3575 Caveat: this can be called for a freshly initialized
3576 iterator; face_id is -1 in this case. We know that the new
3577 face will not change until limit, i.e. if the new face has a
3578 box, all characters up to limit will have one. But, as
3579 usual, we don't know whether limit is really the end. */
3580 if (new_face_id != it->face_id)
3582 struct face *new_face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, new_face_id);
3584 /* If new face has a box but old face has not, this is
3585 the start of a run of characters with box, i.e. it has
3586 a shadow on the left side. The value of face_id of the
3587 iterator will be -1 if this is the initial call that gets
3588 the face. In this case, we have to look in front of IT's
3589 position and see whether there is a face != new_face_id. */
3590 it->start_of_box_run_p
3591 = (new_face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
3592 && (it->face_id >= 0
3593 || IT_CHARPOS (*it) == BEG
3594 || new_face_id != face_before_it_pos (it)));
3595 it->face_box_p = new_face->box != FACE_NO_BOX;
3598 else
3600 int base_face_id;
3601 EMACS_INT bufpos;
3602 int i;
3603 Lisp_Object from_overlay
3604 = (it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0
3605 ? it->string_overlays[it->current.overlay_string_index]
3606 : Qnil);
3608 /* See if we got to this string directly or indirectly from
3609 an overlay property. That includes the before-string or
3610 after-string of an overlay, strings in display properties
3611 provided by an overlay, their text properties, etc.
3613 FROM_OVERLAY is the overlay that brought us here, or nil if none. */
3614 if (! NILP (from_overlay))
3615 for (i = it->sp - 1; i >= 0; i--)
3617 if (it->stack[i].current.overlay_string_index >= 0)
3618 from_overlay
3619 = it->string_overlays[it->stack[i].current.overlay_string_index];
3620 else if (! NILP (it->stack[i].from_overlay))
3621 from_overlay = it->stack[i].from_overlay;
3623 if (!NILP (from_overlay))
3624 break;
3627 if (! NILP (from_overlay))
3629 bufpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
3630 /* For a string from an overlay, the base face depends
3631 only on text properties and ignores overlays. */
3632 base_face_id
3633 = face_for_overlay_string (it->w,
3634 IT_CHARPOS (*it),
3635 it->region_beg_charpos,
3636 it->region_end_charpos,
3637 &next_stop,
3638 (IT_CHARPOS (*it)
3639 + TEXT_PROP_DISTANCE_LIMIT),
3641 from_overlay);
3643 else
3645 bufpos = 0;
3647 /* For strings from a `display' property, use the face at
3648 IT's current buffer position as the base face to merge
3649 with, so that overlay strings appear in the same face as
3650 surrounding text, unless they specify their own
3651 faces. */
3652 base_face_id = underlying_face_id (it);
3655 new_face_id = face_at_string_position (it->w,
3656 it->string,
3657 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
3658 bufpos,
3659 it->region_beg_charpos,
3660 it->region_end_charpos,
3661 &next_stop,
3662 base_face_id, 0);
3664 /* Is this a start of a run of characters with box? Caveat:
3665 this can be called for a freshly allocated iterator; face_id
3666 is -1 is this case. We know that the new face will not
3667 change until the next check pos, i.e. if the new face has a
3668 box, all characters up to that position will have a
3669 box. But, as usual, we don't know whether that position
3670 is really the end. */
3671 if (new_face_id != it->face_id)
3673 struct face *new_face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, new_face_id);
3674 struct face *old_face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
3676 /* If new face has a box but old face hasn't, this is the
3677 start of a run of characters with box, i.e. it has a
3678 shadow on the left side. */
3679 it->start_of_box_run_p
3680 = new_face->box && (old_face == NULL || !old_face->box);
3681 it->face_box_p = new_face->box != FACE_NO_BOX;
3685 it->face_id = new_face_id;
3686 return HANDLED_NORMALLY;
3690 /* Return the ID of the face ``underlying'' IT's current position,
3691 which is in a string. If the iterator is associated with a
3692 buffer, return the face at IT's current buffer position.
3693 Otherwise, use the iterator's base_face_id. */
3695 static int
3696 underlying_face_id (struct it *it)
3698 int face_id = it->base_face_id, i;
3700 xassert (STRINGP (it->string));
3702 for (i = it->sp - 1; i >= 0; --i)
3703 if (NILP (it->stack[i].string))
3704 face_id = it->stack[i].face_id;
3706 return face_id;
3710 /* Compute the face one character before or after the current position
3711 of IT, in the visual order. BEFORE_P non-zero means get the face
3712 in front (to the left in L2R paragraphs, to the right in R2L
3713 paragraphs) of IT's screen position. Value is the ID of the face. */
3715 static int
3716 face_before_or_after_it_pos (struct it *it, int before_p)
3718 int face_id, limit;
3719 EMACS_INT next_check_charpos;
3720 struct it it_copy;
3721 void *it_copy_data = NULL;
3723 xassert (it->s == NULL);
3725 if (STRINGP (it->string))
3727 EMACS_INT bufpos, charpos;
3728 int base_face_id;
3730 /* No face change past the end of the string (for the case
3731 we are padding with spaces). No face change before the
3732 string start. */
3733 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= SCHARS (it->string)
3734 || (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) == 0 && before_p))
3735 return it->face_id;
3737 if (!it->bidi_p)
3739 /* Set charpos to the position before or after IT's current
3740 position, in the logical order, which in the non-bidi
3741 case is the same as the visual order. */
3742 if (before_p)
3743 charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) - 1;
3744 else if (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION)
3745 /* For composition, we must check the character after the
3746 composition. */
3747 charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) + it->cmp_it.nchars;
3748 else
3749 charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) + 1;
3751 else
3753 if (before_p)
3755 /* With bidi iteration, the character before the current
3756 in the visual order cannot be found by simple
3757 iteration, because "reverse" reordering is not
3758 supported. Instead, we need to use the move_it_*
3759 family of functions. */
3760 /* Ignore face changes before the first visible
3761 character on this display line. */
3762 if (it->current_x <= it->first_visible_x)
3763 return it->face_id;
3764 SAVE_IT (it_copy, *it, it_copy_data);
3765 /* Implementation note: Since move_it_in_display_line
3766 works in the iterator geometry, and thinks the first
3767 character is always the leftmost, even in R2L lines,
3768 we don't need to distinguish between the R2L and L2R
3769 cases here. */
3770 move_it_in_display_line (&it_copy, SCHARS (it_copy.string),
3771 it_copy.current_x - 1, MOVE_TO_X);
3772 charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (it_copy);
3773 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it_copy_data);
3775 else
3777 /* Set charpos to the string position of the character
3778 that comes after IT's current position in the visual
3779 order. */
3780 int n = (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION ? it->cmp_it.nchars : 1);
3782 it_copy = *it;
3783 while (n--)
3784 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it_copy.bidi_it);
3786 charpos = it_copy.bidi_it.charpos;
3789 xassert (0 <= charpos && charpos <= SCHARS (it->string));
3791 if (it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0)
3792 bufpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
3793 else
3794 bufpos = 0;
3796 base_face_id = underlying_face_id (it);
3798 /* Get the face for ASCII, or unibyte. */
3799 face_id = face_at_string_position (it->w,
3800 it->string,
3801 charpos,
3802 bufpos,
3803 it->region_beg_charpos,
3804 it->region_end_charpos,
3805 &next_check_charpos,
3806 base_face_id, 0);
3808 /* Correct the face for charsets different from ASCII. Do it
3809 for the multibyte case only. The face returned above is
3810 suitable for unibyte text if IT->string is unibyte. */
3811 if (STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string))
3813 struct text_pos pos1 = string_pos (charpos, it->string);
3814 const unsigned char *p = SDATA (it->string) + BYTEPOS (pos1);
3815 int c, len;
3816 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
3818 c = string_char_and_length (p, &len);
3819 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, c, charpos, it->string);
3822 else
3824 struct text_pos pos;
3826 if ((IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= ZV && !before_p)
3827 || (IT_CHARPOS (*it) <= BEGV && before_p))
3828 return it->face_id;
3830 limit = IT_CHARPOS (*it) + TEXT_PROP_DISTANCE_LIMIT;
3831 pos = it->current.pos;
3833 if (!it->bidi_p)
3835 if (before_p)
3836 DEC_TEXT_POS (pos, it->multibyte_p);
3837 else
3839 if (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION)
3841 /* For composition, we must check the position after
3842 the composition. */
3843 pos.charpos += it->cmp_it.nchars;
3844 pos.bytepos += it->len;
3846 else
3847 INC_TEXT_POS (pos, it->multibyte_p);
3850 else
3852 if (before_p)
3854 /* With bidi iteration, the character before the current
3855 in the visual order cannot be found by simple
3856 iteration, because "reverse" reordering is not
3857 supported. Instead, we need to use the move_it_*
3858 family of functions. */
3859 /* Ignore face changes before the first visible
3860 character on this display line. */
3861 if (it->current_x <= it->first_visible_x)
3862 return it->face_id;
3863 SAVE_IT (it_copy, *it, it_copy_data);
3864 /* Implementation note: Since move_it_in_display_line
3865 works in the iterator geometry, and thinks the first
3866 character is always the leftmost, even in R2L lines,
3867 we don't need to distinguish between the R2L and L2R
3868 cases here. */
3869 move_it_in_display_line (&it_copy, ZV,
3870 it_copy.current_x - 1, MOVE_TO_X);
3871 pos = it_copy.current.pos;
3872 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it_copy_data);
3874 else
3876 /* Set charpos to the buffer position of the character
3877 that comes after IT's current position in the visual
3878 order. */
3879 int n = (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION ? it->cmp_it.nchars : 1);
3881 it_copy = *it;
3882 while (n--)
3883 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it_copy.bidi_it);
3885 SET_TEXT_POS (pos,
3886 it_copy.bidi_it.charpos, it_copy.bidi_it.bytepos);
3889 xassert (BEGV <= CHARPOS (pos) && CHARPOS (pos) <= ZV);
3891 /* Determine face for CHARSET_ASCII, or unibyte. */
3892 face_id = face_at_buffer_position (it->w,
3893 CHARPOS (pos),
3894 it->region_beg_charpos,
3895 it->region_end_charpos,
3896 &next_check_charpos,
3897 limit, 0, -1);
3899 /* Correct the face for charsets different from ASCII. Do it
3900 for the multibyte case only. The face returned above is
3901 suitable for unibyte text if current_buffer is unibyte. */
3902 if (it->multibyte_p)
3904 int c = FETCH_MULTIBYTE_CHAR (BYTEPOS (pos));
3905 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
3906 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, c, CHARPOS (pos), Qnil);
3910 return face_id;
3915 /***********************************************************************
3916 Invisible text
3917 ***********************************************************************/
3919 /* Set up iterator IT from invisible properties at its current
3920 position. Called from handle_stop. */
3922 static enum prop_handled
3923 handle_invisible_prop (struct it *it)
3925 enum prop_handled handled = HANDLED_NORMALLY;
3927 if (STRINGP (it->string))
3929 Lisp_Object prop, end_charpos, limit, charpos;
3931 /* Get the value of the invisible text property at the
3932 current position. Value will be nil if there is no such
3933 property. */
3934 charpos = make_number (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it));
3935 prop = Fget_text_property (charpos, Qinvisible, it->string);
3937 if (!NILP (prop)
3938 && IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) < it->end_charpos)
3940 EMACS_INT endpos;
3942 handled = HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS;
3944 /* Get the position at which the next change of the
3945 invisible text property can be found in IT->string.
3946 Value will be nil if the property value is the same for
3947 all the rest of IT->string. */
3948 XSETINT (limit, SCHARS (it->string));
3949 end_charpos = Fnext_single_property_change (charpos, Qinvisible,
3950 it->string, limit);
3952 /* Text at current position is invisible. The next
3953 change in the property is at position end_charpos.
3954 Move IT's current position to that position. */
3955 if (INTEGERP (end_charpos)
3956 && (endpos = XFASTINT (end_charpos)) < XFASTINT (limit))
3958 struct text_pos old;
3959 EMACS_INT oldpos;
3961 old = it->current.string_pos;
3962 oldpos = CHARPOS (old);
3963 if (it->bidi_p)
3965 if (it->bidi_it.first_elt
3966 && it->bidi_it.charpos < SCHARS (it->string))
3967 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding,
3968 &it->bidi_it, 1);
3969 /* Bidi-iterate out of the invisible text. */
3972 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
3974 while (oldpos <= it->bidi_it.charpos
3975 && it->bidi_it.charpos < endpos);
3977 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
3978 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
3979 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= endpos)
3980 it->prev_stop = endpos;
3982 else
3984 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = XFASTINT (end_charpos);
3985 compute_string_pos (&it->current.string_pos, old, it->string);
3988 else
3990 /* The rest of the string is invisible. If this is an
3991 overlay string, proceed with the next overlay string
3992 or whatever comes and return a character from there. */
3993 if (it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0)
3995 next_overlay_string (it);
3996 /* Don't check for overlay strings when we just
3997 finished processing them. */
3998 handled = HANDLED_OVERLAY_STRING_CONSUMED;
4000 else
4002 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = SCHARS (it->string);
4003 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = SBYTES (it->string);
4008 else
4010 int invis_p;
4011 EMACS_INT newpos, next_stop, start_charpos, tem;
4012 Lisp_Object pos, prop, overlay;
4014 /* First of all, is there invisible text at this position? */
4015 tem = start_charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
4016 pos = make_number (tem);
4017 prop = get_char_property_and_overlay (pos, Qinvisible, it->window,
4018 &overlay);
4019 invis_p = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop);
4021 /* If we are on invisible text, skip over it. */
4022 if (invis_p && start_charpos < it->end_charpos)
4024 /* Record whether we have to display an ellipsis for the
4025 invisible text. */
4026 int display_ellipsis_p = invis_p == 2;
4028 handled = HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS;
4030 /* Loop skipping over invisible text. The loop is left at
4031 ZV or with IT on the first char being visible again. */
4034 /* Try to skip some invisible text. Return value is the
4035 position reached which can be equal to where we start
4036 if there is nothing invisible there. This skips both
4037 over invisible text properties and overlays with
4038 invisible property. */
4039 newpos = skip_invisible (tem, &next_stop, ZV, it->window);
4041 /* If we skipped nothing at all we weren't at invisible
4042 text in the first place. If everything to the end of
4043 the buffer was skipped, end the loop. */
4044 if (newpos == tem || newpos >= ZV)
4045 invis_p = 0;
4046 else
4048 /* We skipped some characters but not necessarily
4049 all there are. Check if we ended up on visible
4050 text. Fget_char_property returns the property of
4051 the char before the given position, i.e. if we
4052 get invis_p = 0, this means that the char at
4053 newpos is visible. */
4054 pos = make_number (newpos);
4055 prop = Fget_char_property (pos, Qinvisible, it->window);
4056 invis_p = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop);
4059 /* If we ended up on invisible text, proceed to
4060 skip starting with next_stop. */
4061 if (invis_p)
4062 tem = next_stop;
4064 /* If there are adjacent invisible texts, don't lose the
4065 second one's ellipsis. */
4066 if (invis_p == 2)
4067 display_ellipsis_p = 1;
4069 while (invis_p);
4071 /* The position newpos is now either ZV or on visible text. */
4072 if (it->bidi_p && newpos < ZV)
4074 EMACS_INT bpos = CHAR_TO_BYTE (newpos);
4076 if (FETCH_BYTE (bpos) == '\n'
4077 || (newpos > BEGV && FETCH_BYTE (bpos - 1) == '\n'))
4079 /* If the invisible text ends on a newline or the
4080 character after a newline, we can avoid the
4081 costly, character by character, bidi iteration to
4082 newpos, and instead simply reseat the iterator
4083 there. That's because all bidi reordering
4084 information is tossed at the newline. This is a
4085 big win for modes that hide complete lines, like
4086 Outline, Org, etc. (Implementation note: the
4087 call to reseat_1 is necessary, because it signals
4088 to the bidi iterator that it needs to reinit its
4089 internal information when the next element for
4090 display is requested. */
4091 struct text_pos tpos;
4093 SET_TEXT_POS (tpos, newpos, bpos);
4094 reseat_1 (it, tpos, 0);
4096 else /* Must use the slow method. */
4098 /* With bidi iteration, the region of invisible text
4099 could start and/or end in the middle of a
4100 non-base embedding level. Therefore, we need to
4101 skip invisible text using the bidi iterator,
4102 starting at IT's current position, until we find
4103 ourselves outside the invisible text. Skipping
4104 invisible text _after_ bidi iteration avoids
4105 affecting the visual order of the displayed text
4106 when invisible properties are added or
4107 removed. */
4108 if (it->bidi_it.first_elt && it->bidi_it.charpos < ZV)
4110 /* If we were `reseat'ed to a new paragraph,
4111 determine the paragraph base direction. We
4112 need to do it now because
4113 next_element_from_buffer may not have a
4114 chance to do it, if we are going to skip any
4115 text at the beginning, which resets the
4116 FIRST_ELT flag. */
4117 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding,
4118 &it->bidi_it, 1);
4122 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
4124 while (it->stop_charpos <= it->bidi_it.charpos
4125 && it->bidi_it.charpos < newpos);
4126 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
4127 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
4128 /* If we overstepped NEWPOS, record its position in
4129 the iterator, so that we skip invisible text if
4130 later the bidi iteration lands us in the
4131 invisible region again. */
4132 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= newpos)
4133 it->prev_stop = newpos;
4136 else
4138 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = newpos;
4139 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = CHAR_TO_BYTE (newpos);
4142 /* If there are before-strings at the start of invisible
4143 text, and the text is invisible because of a text
4144 property, arrange to show before-strings because 20.x did
4145 it that way. (If the text is invisible because of an
4146 overlay property instead of a text property, this is
4147 already handled in the overlay code.) */
4148 if (NILP (overlay)
4149 && get_overlay_strings (it, it->stop_charpos))
4151 handled = HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS;
4152 it->stack[it->sp - 1].display_ellipsis_p = display_ellipsis_p;
4154 else if (display_ellipsis_p)
4156 /* Make sure that the glyphs of the ellipsis will get
4157 correct `charpos' values. If we would not update
4158 it->position here, the glyphs would belong to the
4159 last visible character _before_ the invisible
4160 text, which confuses `set_cursor_from_row'.
4162 We use the last invisible position instead of the
4163 first because this way the cursor is always drawn on
4164 the first "." of the ellipsis, whenever PT is inside
4165 the invisible text. Otherwise the cursor would be
4166 placed _after_ the ellipsis when the point is after the
4167 first invisible character. */
4168 if (!STRINGP (it->object))
4170 it->position.charpos = newpos - 1;
4171 it->position.bytepos = CHAR_TO_BYTE (it->position.charpos);
4173 it->ellipsis_p = 1;
4174 /* Let the ellipsis display before
4175 considering any properties of the following char.
4176 Fixes jasonr@gnu.org 01 Oct 07 bug. */
4177 handled = HANDLED_RETURN;
4182 return handled;
4186 /* Make iterator IT return `...' next.
4187 Replaces LEN characters from buffer. */
4189 static void
4190 setup_for_ellipsis (struct it *it, int len)
4192 /* Use the display table definition for `...'. Invalid glyphs
4193 will be handled by the method returning elements from dpvec. */
4194 if (it->dp && VECTORP (DISP_INVIS_VECTOR (it->dp)))
4196 struct Lisp_Vector *v = XVECTOR (DISP_INVIS_VECTOR (it->dp));
4197 it->dpvec = v->contents;
4198 it->dpend = v->contents + v->header.size;
4200 else
4202 /* Default `...'. */
4203 it->dpvec = default_invis_vector;
4204 it->dpend = default_invis_vector + 3;
4207 it->dpvec_char_len = len;
4208 it->current.dpvec_index = 0;
4209 it->dpvec_face_id = -1;
4211 /* Remember the current face id in case glyphs specify faces.
4212 IT's face is restored in set_iterator_to_next.
4213 saved_face_id was set to preceding char's face in handle_stop. */
4214 if (it->saved_face_id < 0 || it->saved_face_id != it->face_id)
4215 it->saved_face_id = it->face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
4217 it->method = GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR;
4218 it->ellipsis_p = 1;
4223 /***********************************************************************
4224 'display' property
4225 ***********************************************************************/
4227 /* Set up iterator IT from `display' property at its current position.
4228 Called from handle_stop.
4229 We return HANDLED_RETURN if some part of the display property
4230 overrides the display of the buffer text itself.
4231 Otherwise we return HANDLED_NORMALLY. */
4233 static enum prop_handled
4234 handle_display_prop (struct it *it)
4236 Lisp_Object propval, object, overlay;
4237 struct text_pos *position;
4238 EMACS_INT bufpos;
4239 /* Nonzero if some property replaces the display of the text itself. */
4240 int display_replaced_p = 0;
4242 if (STRINGP (it->string))
4244 object = it->string;
4245 position = &it->current.string_pos;
4246 bufpos = CHARPOS (it->current.pos);
4248 else
4250 XSETWINDOW (object, it->w);
4251 position = &it->current.pos;
4252 bufpos = CHARPOS (*position);
4255 /* Reset those iterator values set from display property values. */
4256 it->slice.x = it->slice.y = it->slice.width = it->slice.height = Qnil;
4257 it->space_width = Qnil;
4258 it->font_height = Qnil;
4259 it->voffset = 0;
4261 /* We don't support recursive `display' properties, i.e. string
4262 values that have a string `display' property, that have a string
4263 `display' property etc. */
4264 if (!it->string_from_display_prop_p)
4265 it->area = TEXT_AREA;
4267 propval = get_char_property_and_overlay (make_number (position->charpos),
4268 Qdisplay, object, &overlay);
4269 if (NILP (propval))
4270 return HANDLED_NORMALLY;
4271 /* Now OVERLAY is the overlay that gave us this property, or nil
4272 if it was a text property. */
4274 if (!STRINGP (it->string))
4275 object = it->w->buffer;
4277 display_replaced_p = handle_display_spec (it, propval, object, overlay,
4278 position, bufpos,
4279 FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f));
4281 return display_replaced_p ? HANDLED_RETURN : HANDLED_NORMALLY;
4284 /* Subroutine of handle_display_prop. Returns non-zero if the display
4285 specification in SPEC is a replacing specification, i.e. it would
4286 replace the text covered by `display' property with something else,
4287 such as an image or a display string. If SPEC includes any kind or
4288 `(space ...) specification, the value is 2; this is used by
4289 compute_display_string_pos, which see.
4291 See handle_single_display_spec for documentation of arguments.
4292 frame_window_p is non-zero if the window being redisplayed is on a
4293 GUI frame; this argument is used only if IT is NULL, see below.
4295 IT can be NULL, if this is called by the bidi reordering code
4296 through compute_display_string_pos, which see. In that case, this
4297 function only examines SPEC, but does not otherwise "handle" it, in
4298 the sense that it doesn't set up members of IT from the display
4299 spec. */
4300 static int
4301 handle_display_spec (struct it *it, Lisp_Object spec, Lisp_Object object,
4302 Lisp_Object overlay, struct text_pos *position,
4303 EMACS_INT bufpos, int frame_window_p)
4305 int replacing_p = 0;
4306 int rv;
4308 if (CONSP (spec)
4309 /* Simple specerties. */
4310 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qimage)
4311 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qspace)
4312 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qwhen)
4313 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qslice)
4314 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qspace_width)
4315 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qheight)
4316 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qraise)
4317 /* Marginal area specifications. */
4318 && !(CONSP (XCAR (spec)) && EQ (XCAR (XCAR (spec)), Qmargin))
4319 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qleft_fringe)
4320 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qright_fringe)
4321 && !NILP (XCAR (spec)))
4323 for (; CONSP (spec); spec = XCDR (spec))
4325 if ((rv = handle_single_display_spec (it, XCAR (spec), object,
4326 overlay, position, bufpos,
4327 replacing_p, frame_window_p)))
4329 replacing_p = rv;
4330 /* If some text in a string is replaced, `position' no
4331 longer points to the position of `object'. */
4332 if (!it || STRINGP (object))
4333 break;
4337 else if (VECTORP (spec))
4339 int i;
4340 for (i = 0; i < ASIZE (spec); ++i)
4341 if ((rv = handle_single_display_spec (it, AREF (spec, i), object,
4342 overlay, position, bufpos,
4343 replacing_p, frame_window_p)))
4345 replacing_p = rv;
4346 /* If some text in a string is replaced, `position' no
4347 longer points to the position of `object'. */
4348 if (!it || STRINGP (object))
4349 break;
4352 else
4354 if ((rv = handle_single_display_spec (it, spec, object, overlay,
4355 position, bufpos, 0,
4356 frame_window_p)))
4357 replacing_p = rv;
4360 return replacing_p;
4363 /* Value is the position of the end of the `display' property starting
4364 at START_POS in OBJECT. */
4366 static struct text_pos
4367 display_prop_end (struct it *it, Lisp_Object object, struct text_pos start_pos)
4369 Lisp_Object end;
4370 struct text_pos end_pos;
4372 end = Fnext_single_char_property_change (make_number (CHARPOS (start_pos)),
4373 Qdisplay, object, Qnil);
4374 CHARPOS (end_pos) = XFASTINT (end);
4375 if (STRINGP (object))
4376 compute_string_pos (&end_pos, start_pos, it->string);
4377 else
4378 BYTEPOS (end_pos) = CHAR_TO_BYTE (XFASTINT (end));
4380 return end_pos;
4384 /* Set up IT from a single `display' property specification SPEC. OBJECT
4385 is the object in which the `display' property was found. *POSITION
4386 is the position in OBJECT at which the `display' property was found.
4387 BUFPOS is the buffer position of OBJECT (different from POSITION if
4388 OBJECT is not a buffer). DISPLAY_REPLACED_P non-zero means that we
4389 previously saw a display specification which already replaced text
4390 display with something else, for example an image; we ignore such
4391 properties after the first one has been processed.
4393 OVERLAY is the overlay this `display' property came from,
4394 or nil if it was a text property.
4396 If SPEC is a `space' or `image' specification, and in some other
4397 cases too, set *POSITION to the position where the `display'
4398 property ends.
4400 If IT is NULL, only examine the property specification in SPEC, but
4401 don't set up IT. In that case, FRAME_WINDOW_P non-zero means SPEC
4402 is intended to be displayed in a window on a GUI frame.
4404 Value is non-zero if something was found which replaces the display
4405 of buffer or string text. */
4407 static int
4408 handle_single_display_spec (struct it *it, Lisp_Object spec, Lisp_Object object,
4409 Lisp_Object overlay, struct text_pos *position,
4410 EMACS_INT bufpos, int display_replaced_p,
4411 int frame_window_p)
4413 Lisp_Object form;
4414 Lisp_Object location, value;
4415 struct text_pos start_pos = *position;
4416 int valid_p;
4418 /* If SPEC is a list of the form `(when FORM . VALUE)', evaluate FORM.
4419 If the result is non-nil, use VALUE instead of SPEC. */
4420 form = Qt;
4421 if (CONSP (spec) && EQ (XCAR (spec), Qwhen))
4423 spec = XCDR (spec);
4424 if (!CONSP (spec))
4425 return 0;
4426 form = XCAR (spec);
4427 spec = XCDR (spec);
4430 if (!NILP (form) && !EQ (form, Qt))
4432 int count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
4433 struct gcpro gcpro1;
4435 /* Bind `object' to the object having the `display' property, a
4436 buffer or string. Bind `position' to the position in the
4437 object where the property was found, and `buffer-position'
4438 to the current position in the buffer. */
4440 if (NILP (object))
4441 XSETBUFFER (object, current_buffer);
4442 specbind (Qobject, object);
4443 specbind (Qposition, make_number (CHARPOS (*position)));
4444 specbind (Qbuffer_position, make_number (bufpos));
4445 GCPRO1 (form);
4446 form = safe_eval (form);
4447 UNGCPRO;
4448 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
4451 if (NILP (form))
4452 return 0;
4454 /* Handle `(height HEIGHT)' specifications. */
4455 if (CONSP (spec)
4456 && EQ (XCAR (spec), Qheight)
4457 && CONSP (XCDR (spec)))
4459 if (it)
4461 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
4462 return 0;
4464 it->font_height = XCAR (XCDR (spec));
4465 if (!NILP (it->font_height))
4467 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
4468 int new_height = -1;
4470 if (CONSP (it->font_height)
4471 && (EQ (XCAR (it->font_height), Qplus)
4472 || EQ (XCAR (it->font_height), Qminus))
4473 && CONSP (XCDR (it->font_height))
4474 && INTEGERP (XCAR (XCDR (it->font_height))))
4476 /* `(+ N)' or `(- N)' where N is an integer. */
4477 int steps = XINT (XCAR (XCDR (it->font_height)));
4478 if (EQ (XCAR (it->font_height), Qplus))
4479 steps = - steps;
4480 it->face_id = smaller_face (it->f, it->face_id, steps);
4482 else if (FUNCTIONP (it->font_height))
4484 /* Call function with current height as argument.
4485 Value is the new height. */
4486 Lisp_Object height;
4487 height = safe_call1 (it->font_height,
4488 face->lface[LFACE_HEIGHT_INDEX]);
4489 if (NUMBERP (height))
4490 new_height = XFLOATINT (height);
4492 else if (NUMBERP (it->font_height))
4494 /* Value is a multiple of the canonical char height. */
4495 struct face *f;
4497 f = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f,
4498 lookup_basic_face (it->f, DEFAULT_FACE_ID));
4499 new_height = (XFLOATINT (it->font_height)
4500 * XINT (f->lface[LFACE_HEIGHT_INDEX]));
4502 else
4504 /* Evaluate IT->font_height with `height' bound to the
4505 current specified height to get the new height. */
4506 int count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
4508 specbind (Qheight, face->lface[LFACE_HEIGHT_INDEX]);
4509 value = safe_eval (it->font_height);
4510 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
4512 if (NUMBERP (value))
4513 new_height = XFLOATINT (value);
4516 if (new_height > 0)
4517 it->face_id = face_with_height (it->f, it->face_id, new_height);
4521 return 0;
4524 /* Handle `(space-width WIDTH)'. */
4525 if (CONSP (spec)
4526 && EQ (XCAR (spec), Qspace_width)
4527 && CONSP (XCDR (spec)))
4529 if (it)
4531 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
4532 return 0;
4534 value = XCAR (XCDR (spec));
4535 if (NUMBERP (value) && XFLOATINT (value) > 0)
4536 it->space_width = value;
4539 return 0;
4542 /* Handle `(slice X Y WIDTH HEIGHT)'. */
4543 if (CONSP (spec)
4544 && EQ (XCAR (spec), Qslice))
4546 Lisp_Object tem;
4548 if (it)
4550 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
4551 return 0;
4553 if (tem = XCDR (spec), CONSP (tem))
4555 it->slice.x = XCAR (tem);
4556 if (tem = XCDR (tem), CONSP (tem))
4558 it->slice.y = XCAR (tem);
4559 if (tem = XCDR (tem), CONSP (tem))
4561 it->slice.width = XCAR (tem);
4562 if (tem = XCDR (tem), CONSP (tem))
4563 it->slice.height = XCAR (tem);
4569 return 0;
4572 /* Handle `(raise FACTOR)'. */
4573 if (CONSP (spec)
4574 && EQ (XCAR (spec), Qraise)
4575 && CONSP (XCDR (spec)))
4577 if (it)
4579 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
4580 return 0;
4582 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
4583 value = XCAR (XCDR (spec));
4584 if (NUMBERP (value))
4586 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
4587 it->voffset = - (XFLOATINT (value)
4588 * (FONT_HEIGHT (face->font)));
4590 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
4593 return 0;
4596 /* Don't handle the other kinds of display specifications
4597 inside a string that we got from a `display' property. */
4598 if (it && it->string_from_display_prop_p)
4599 return 0;
4601 /* Characters having this form of property are not displayed, so
4602 we have to find the end of the property. */
4603 if (it)
4605 start_pos = *position;
4606 *position = display_prop_end (it, object, start_pos);
4608 value = Qnil;
4610 /* Stop the scan at that end position--we assume that all
4611 text properties change there. */
4612 if (it)
4613 it->stop_charpos = position->charpos;
4615 /* Handle `(left-fringe BITMAP [FACE])'
4616 and `(right-fringe BITMAP [FACE])'. */
4617 if (CONSP (spec)
4618 && (EQ (XCAR (spec), Qleft_fringe)
4619 || EQ (XCAR (spec), Qright_fringe))
4620 && CONSP (XCDR (spec)))
4622 int fringe_bitmap;
4624 if (it)
4626 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
4627 /* If we return here, POSITION has been advanced
4628 across the text with this property. */
4629 return 0;
4631 else if (!frame_window_p)
4632 return 0;
4634 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
4635 value = XCAR (XCDR (spec));
4636 if (!SYMBOLP (value)
4637 || !(fringe_bitmap = lookup_fringe_bitmap (value)))
4638 /* If we return here, POSITION has been advanced
4639 across the text with this property. */
4640 return 0;
4642 if (it)
4644 int face_id = lookup_basic_face (it->f, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);;
4646 if (CONSP (XCDR (XCDR (spec))))
4648 Lisp_Object face_name = XCAR (XCDR (XCDR (spec)));
4649 int face_id2 = lookup_derived_face (it->f, face_name,
4650 FRINGE_FACE_ID, 0);
4651 if (face_id2 >= 0)
4652 face_id = face_id2;
4655 /* Save current settings of IT so that we can restore them
4656 when we are finished with the glyph property value. */
4657 push_it (it, position);
4659 it->area = TEXT_AREA;
4660 it->what = IT_IMAGE;
4661 it->image_id = -1; /* no image */
4662 it->position = start_pos;
4663 it->object = NILP (object) ? it->w->buffer : object;
4664 it->method = GET_FROM_IMAGE;
4665 it->from_overlay = Qnil;
4666 it->face_id = face_id;
4667 it->from_disp_prop_p = 1;
4669 /* Say that we haven't consumed the characters with
4670 `display' property yet. The call to pop_it in
4671 set_iterator_to_next will clean this up. */
4672 *position = start_pos;
4674 if (EQ (XCAR (spec), Qleft_fringe))
4676 it->left_user_fringe_bitmap = fringe_bitmap;
4677 it->left_user_fringe_face_id = face_id;
4679 else
4681 it->right_user_fringe_bitmap = fringe_bitmap;
4682 it->right_user_fringe_face_id = face_id;
4685 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
4686 return 1;
4689 /* Prepare to handle `((margin left-margin) ...)',
4690 `((margin right-margin) ...)' and `((margin nil) ...)'
4691 prefixes for display specifications. */
4692 location = Qunbound;
4693 if (CONSP (spec) && CONSP (XCAR (spec)))
4695 Lisp_Object tem;
4697 value = XCDR (spec);
4698 if (CONSP (value))
4699 value = XCAR (value);
4701 tem = XCAR (spec);
4702 if (EQ (XCAR (tem), Qmargin)
4703 && (tem = XCDR (tem),
4704 tem = CONSP (tem) ? XCAR (tem) : Qnil,
4705 (NILP (tem)
4706 || EQ (tem, Qleft_margin)
4707 || EQ (tem, Qright_margin))))
4708 location = tem;
4711 if (EQ (location, Qunbound))
4713 location = Qnil;
4714 value = spec;
4717 /* After this point, VALUE is the property after any
4718 margin prefix has been stripped. It must be a string,
4719 an image specification, or `(space ...)'.
4721 LOCATION specifies where to display: `left-margin',
4722 `right-margin' or nil. */
4724 valid_p = (STRINGP (value)
4725 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
4726 || ((it ? FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f) : frame_window_p)
4727 && valid_image_p (value))
4728 #endif /* not HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
4729 || (CONSP (value) && EQ (XCAR (value), Qspace)));
4731 if (valid_p && !display_replaced_p)
4733 int retval = 1;
4735 if (!it)
4737 /* Callers need to know whether the display spec is any kind
4738 of `(space ...)' spec that is about to affect text-area
4739 display. */
4740 if (CONSP (value) && EQ (XCAR (value), Qspace) && NILP (location))
4741 retval = 2;
4742 return retval;
4745 /* Save current settings of IT so that we can restore them
4746 when we are finished with the glyph property value. */
4747 push_it (it, position);
4748 it->from_overlay = overlay;
4749 it->from_disp_prop_p = 1;
4751 if (NILP (location))
4752 it->area = TEXT_AREA;
4753 else if (EQ (location, Qleft_margin))
4754 it->area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA;
4755 else
4756 it->area = RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA;
4758 if (STRINGP (value))
4760 it->string = value;
4761 it->multibyte_p = STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string);
4762 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
4763 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = 0;
4764 it->end_charpos = it->string_nchars = SCHARS (it->string);
4765 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
4766 it->stop_charpos = 0;
4767 it->prev_stop = 0;
4768 it->base_level_stop = 0;
4769 it->string_from_display_prop_p = 1;
4770 /* Say that we haven't consumed the characters with
4771 `display' property yet. The call to pop_it in
4772 set_iterator_to_next will clean this up. */
4773 if (BUFFERP (object))
4774 *position = start_pos;
4776 /* Force paragraph direction to be that of the parent
4777 object. If the parent object's paragraph direction is
4778 not yet determined, default to L2R. */
4779 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
4780 it->paragraph_embedding = it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir;
4781 else
4782 it->paragraph_embedding = L2R;
4784 /* Set up the bidi iterator for this display string. */
4785 if (it->bidi_p)
4787 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = it->string;
4788 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
4789 it->bidi_it.string.schars = it->end_charpos;
4790 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = bufpos;
4791 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = 1;
4792 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
4793 bidi_init_it (0, 0, FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f), &it->bidi_it);
4796 else if (CONSP (value) && EQ (XCAR (value), Qspace))
4798 it->method = GET_FROM_STRETCH;
4799 it->object = value;
4800 *position = it->position = start_pos;
4801 retval = 1 + (it->area == TEXT_AREA);
4803 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
4804 else
4806 it->what = IT_IMAGE;
4807 it->image_id = lookup_image (it->f, value);
4808 it->position = start_pos;
4809 it->object = NILP (object) ? it->w->buffer : object;
4810 it->method = GET_FROM_IMAGE;
4812 /* Say that we haven't consumed the characters with
4813 `display' property yet. The call to pop_it in
4814 set_iterator_to_next will clean this up. */
4815 *position = start_pos;
4817 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
4819 return retval;
4822 /* Invalid property or property not supported. Restore
4823 POSITION to what it was before. */
4824 *position = start_pos;
4825 return 0;
4828 /* Check if PROP is a display property value whose text should be
4829 treated as intangible. OVERLAY is the overlay from which PROP
4830 came, or nil if it came from a text property. CHARPOS and BYTEPOS
4831 specify the buffer position covered by PROP. */
4834 display_prop_intangible_p (Lisp_Object prop, Lisp_Object overlay,
4835 EMACS_INT charpos, EMACS_INT bytepos)
4837 int frame_window_p = FRAME_WINDOW_P (XFRAME (selected_frame));
4838 struct text_pos position;
4840 SET_TEXT_POS (position, charpos, bytepos);
4841 return handle_display_spec (NULL, prop, Qnil, overlay,
4842 &position, charpos, frame_window_p);
4846 /* Return 1 if PROP is a display sub-property value containing STRING.
4848 Implementation note: this and the following function are really
4849 special cases of handle_display_spec and
4850 handle_single_display_spec, and should ideally use the same code.
4851 Until they do, these two pairs must be consistent and must be
4852 modified in sync. */
4854 static int
4855 single_display_spec_string_p (Lisp_Object prop, Lisp_Object string)
4857 if (EQ (string, prop))
4858 return 1;
4860 /* Skip over `when FORM'. */
4861 if (CONSP (prop) && EQ (XCAR (prop), Qwhen))
4863 prop = XCDR (prop);
4864 if (!CONSP (prop))
4865 return 0;
4866 /* Actually, the condition following `when' should be eval'ed,
4867 like handle_single_display_spec does, and we should return
4868 zero if it evaluates to nil. However, this function is
4869 called only when the buffer was already displayed and some
4870 glyph in the glyph matrix was found to come from a display
4871 string. Therefore, the condition was already evaluated, and
4872 the result was non-nil, otherwise the display string wouldn't
4873 have been displayed and we would have never been called for
4874 this property. Thus, we can skip the evaluation and assume
4875 its result is non-nil. */
4876 prop = XCDR (prop);
4879 if (CONSP (prop))
4880 /* Skip over `margin LOCATION'. */
4881 if (EQ (XCAR (prop), Qmargin))
4883 prop = XCDR (prop);
4884 if (!CONSP (prop))
4885 return 0;
4887 prop = XCDR (prop);
4888 if (!CONSP (prop))
4889 return 0;
4892 return EQ (prop, string) || (CONSP (prop) && EQ (XCAR (prop), string));
4896 /* Return 1 if STRING appears in the `display' property PROP. */
4898 static int
4899 display_prop_string_p (Lisp_Object prop, Lisp_Object string)
4901 if (CONSP (prop)
4902 && !EQ (XCAR (prop), Qwhen)
4903 && !(CONSP (XCAR (prop)) && EQ (Qmargin, XCAR (XCAR (prop)))))
4905 /* A list of sub-properties. */
4906 while (CONSP (prop))
4908 if (single_display_spec_string_p (XCAR (prop), string))
4909 return 1;
4910 prop = XCDR (prop);
4913 else if (VECTORP (prop))
4915 /* A vector of sub-properties. */
4916 int i;
4917 for (i = 0; i < ASIZE (prop); ++i)
4918 if (single_display_spec_string_p (AREF (prop, i), string))
4919 return 1;
4921 else
4922 return single_display_spec_string_p (prop, string);
4924 return 0;
4927 /* Look for STRING in overlays and text properties in the current
4928 buffer, between character positions FROM and TO (excluding TO).
4929 BACK_P non-zero means look back (in this case, TO is supposed to be
4930 less than FROM).
4931 Value is the first character position where STRING was found, or
4932 zero if it wasn't found before hitting TO.
4934 This function may only use code that doesn't eval because it is
4935 called asynchronously from note_mouse_highlight. */
4937 static EMACS_INT
4938 string_buffer_position_lim (Lisp_Object string,
4939 EMACS_INT from, EMACS_INT to, int back_p)
4941 Lisp_Object limit, prop, pos;
4942 int found = 0;
4944 pos = make_number (from);
4946 if (!back_p) /* looking forward */
4948 limit = make_number (min (to, ZV));
4949 while (!found && !EQ (pos, limit))
4951 prop = Fget_char_property (pos, Qdisplay, Qnil);
4952 if (!NILP (prop) && display_prop_string_p (prop, string))
4953 found = 1;
4954 else
4955 pos = Fnext_single_char_property_change (pos, Qdisplay, Qnil,
4956 limit);
4959 else /* looking back */
4961 limit = make_number (max (to, BEGV));
4962 while (!found && !EQ (pos, limit))
4964 prop = Fget_char_property (pos, Qdisplay, Qnil);
4965 if (!NILP (prop) && display_prop_string_p (prop, string))
4966 found = 1;
4967 else
4968 pos = Fprevious_single_char_property_change (pos, Qdisplay, Qnil,
4969 limit);
4973 return found ? XINT (pos) : 0;
4976 /* Determine which buffer position in current buffer STRING comes from.
4977 AROUND_CHARPOS is an approximate position where it could come from.
4978 Value is the buffer position or 0 if it couldn't be determined.
4980 This function is necessary because we don't record buffer positions
4981 in glyphs generated from strings (to keep struct glyph small).
4982 This function may only use code that doesn't eval because it is
4983 called asynchronously from note_mouse_highlight. */
4985 static EMACS_INT
4986 string_buffer_position (Lisp_Object string, EMACS_INT around_charpos)
4988 const int MAX_DISTANCE = 1000;
4989 EMACS_INT found = string_buffer_position_lim (string, around_charpos,
4990 around_charpos + MAX_DISTANCE,
4993 if (!found)
4994 found = string_buffer_position_lim (string, around_charpos,
4995 around_charpos - MAX_DISTANCE, 1);
4996 return found;
5001 /***********************************************************************
5002 `composition' property
5003 ***********************************************************************/
5005 /* Set up iterator IT from `composition' property at its current
5006 position. Called from handle_stop. */
5008 static enum prop_handled
5009 handle_composition_prop (struct it *it)
5011 Lisp_Object prop, string;
5012 EMACS_INT pos, pos_byte, start, end;
5014 if (STRINGP (it->string))
5016 unsigned char *s;
5018 pos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
5019 pos_byte = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it);
5020 string = it->string;
5021 s = SDATA (string) + pos_byte;
5022 it->c = STRING_CHAR (s);
5024 else
5026 pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
5027 pos_byte = IT_BYTEPOS (*it);
5028 string = Qnil;
5029 it->c = FETCH_CHAR (pos_byte);
5032 /* If there's a valid composition and point is not inside of the
5033 composition (in the case that the composition is from the current
5034 buffer), draw a glyph composed from the composition components. */
5035 if (find_composition (pos, -1, &start, &end, &prop, string)
5036 && COMPOSITION_VALID_P (start, end, prop)
5037 && (STRINGP (it->string) || (PT <= start || PT >= end)))
5039 if (start < pos)
5040 /* As we can't handle this situation (perhaps font-lock added
5041 a new composition), we just return here hoping that next
5042 redisplay will detect this composition much earlier. */
5043 return HANDLED_NORMALLY;
5044 if (start != pos)
5046 if (STRINGP (it->string))
5047 pos_byte = string_char_to_byte (it->string, start);
5048 else
5049 pos_byte = CHAR_TO_BYTE (start);
5051 it->cmp_it.id = get_composition_id (start, pos_byte, end - start,
5052 prop, string);
5054 if (it->cmp_it.id >= 0)
5056 it->cmp_it.ch = -1;
5057 it->cmp_it.nchars = COMPOSITION_LENGTH (prop);
5058 it->cmp_it.nglyphs = -1;
5062 return HANDLED_NORMALLY;
5067 /***********************************************************************
5068 Overlay strings
5069 ***********************************************************************/
5071 /* The following structure is used to record overlay strings for
5072 later sorting in load_overlay_strings. */
5074 struct overlay_entry
5076 Lisp_Object overlay;
5077 Lisp_Object string;
5078 int priority;
5079 int after_string_p;
5083 /* Set up iterator IT from overlay strings at its current position.
5084 Called from handle_stop. */
5086 static enum prop_handled
5087 handle_overlay_change (struct it *it)
5089 if (!STRINGP (it->string) && get_overlay_strings (it, 0))
5090 return HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS;
5091 else
5092 return HANDLED_NORMALLY;
5096 /* Set up the next overlay string for delivery by IT, if there is an
5097 overlay string to deliver. Called by set_iterator_to_next when the
5098 end of the current overlay string is reached. If there are more
5099 overlay strings to display, IT->string and
5100 IT->current.overlay_string_index are set appropriately here.
5101 Otherwise IT->string is set to nil. */
5103 static void
5104 next_overlay_string (struct it *it)
5106 ++it->current.overlay_string_index;
5107 if (it->current.overlay_string_index == it->n_overlay_strings)
5109 /* No more overlay strings. Restore IT's settings to what
5110 they were before overlay strings were processed, and
5111 continue to deliver from current_buffer. */
5113 it->ellipsis_p = (it->stack[it->sp - 1].display_ellipsis_p != 0);
5114 pop_it (it);
5115 xassert (it->sp > 0
5116 || (NILP (it->string)
5117 && it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER
5118 && it->stop_charpos >= BEGV
5119 && it->stop_charpos <= it->end_charpos));
5120 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
5121 it->n_overlay_strings = 0;
5122 it->overlay_strings_charpos = -1;
5124 /* If we're at the end of the buffer, record that we have
5125 processed the overlay strings there already, so that
5126 next_element_from_buffer doesn't try it again. */
5127 if (NILP (it->string) && IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->end_charpos)
5128 it->overlay_strings_at_end_processed_p = 1;
5130 else
5132 /* There are more overlay strings to process. If
5133 IT->current.overlay_string_index has advanced to a position
5134 where we must load IT->overlay_strings with more strings, do
5135 it. We must load at the IT->overlay_strings_charpos where
5136 IT->n_overlay_strings was originally computed; when invisible
5137 text is present, this might not be IT_CHARPOS (Bug#7016). */
5138 int i = it->current.overlay_string_index % OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE;
5140 if (it->current.overlay_string_index && i == 0)
5141 load_overlay_strings (it, it->overlay_strings_charpos);
5143 /* Initialize IT to deliver display elements from the overlay
5144 string. */
5145 it->string = it->overlay_strings[i];
5146 it->multibyte_p = STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string);
5147 SET_TEXT_POS (it->current.string_pos, 0, 0);
5148 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
5149 it->stop_charpos = 0;
5150 if (it->cmp_it.stop_pos >= 0)
5151 it->cmp_it.stop_pos = 0;
5152 it->prev_stop = 0;
5153 it->base_level_stop = 0;
5155 /* Set up the bidi iterator for this overlay string. */
5156 if (it->bidi_p)
5158 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = it->string;
5159 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
5160 it->bidi_it.string.schars = SCHARS (it->string);
5161 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = it->overlay_strings_charpos;
5162 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = it->string_from_display_prop_p;
5163 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
5164 bidi_init_it (0, 0, FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f), &it->bidi_it);
5168 CHECK_IT (it);
5172 /* Compare two overlay_entry structures E1 and E2. Used as a
5173 comparison function for qsort in load_overlay_strings. Overlay
5174 strings for the same position are sorted so that
5176 1. All after-strings come in front of before-strings, except
5177 when they come from the same overlay.
5179 2. Within after-strings, strings are sorted so that overlay strings
5180 from overlays with higher priorities come first.
5182 2. Within before-strings, strings are sorted so that overlay
5183 strings from overlays with higher priorities come last.
5185 Value is analogous to strcmp. */
5188 static int
5189 compare_overlay_entries (const void *e1, const void *e2)
5191 struct overlay_entry *entry1 = (struct overlay_entry *) e1;
5192 struct overlay_entry *entry2 = (struct overlay_entry *) e2;
5193 int result;
5195 if (entry1->after_string_p != entry2->after_string_p)
5197 /* Let after-strings appear in front of before-strings if
5198 they come from different overlays. */
5199 if (EQ (entry1->overlay, entry2->overlay))
5200 result = entry1->after_string_p ? 1 : -1;
5201 else
5202 result = entry1->after_string_p ? -1 : 1;
5204 else if (entry1->after_string_p)
5205 /* After-strings sorted in order of decreasing priority. */
5206 result = entry2->priority - entry1->priority;
5207 else
5208 /* Before-strings sorted in order of increasing priority. */
5209 result = entry1->priority - entry2->priority;
5211 return result;
5215 /* Load the vector IT->overlay_strings with overlay strings from IT's
5216 current buffer position, or from CHARPOS if that is > 0. Set
5217 IT->n_overlays to the total number of overlay strings found.
5219 Overlay strings are processed OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE strings at
5220 a time. On entry into load_overlay_strings,
5221 IT->current.overlay_string_index gives the number of overlay
5222 strings that have already been loaded by previous calls to this
5223 function.
5225 IT->add_overlay_start contains an additional overlay start
5226 position to consider for taking overlay strings from, if non-zero.
5227 This position comes into play when the overlay has an `invisible'
5228 property, and both before and after-strings. When we've skipped to
5229 the end of the overlay, because of its `invisible' property, we
5230 nevertheless want its before-string to appear.
5231 IT->add_overlay_start will contain the overlay start position
5232 in this case.
5234 Overlay strings are sorted so that after-string strings come in
5235 front of before-string strings. Within before and after-strings,
5236 strings are sorted by overlay priority. See also function
5237 compare_overlay_entries. */
5239 static void
5240 load_overlay_strings (struct it *it, EMACS_INT charpos)
5242 Lisp_Object overlay, window, str, invisible;
5243 struct Lisp_Overlay *ov;
5244 EMACS_INT start, end;
5245 int size = 20;
5246 int n = 0, i, j, invis_p;
5247 struct overlay_entry *entries
5248 = (struct overlay_entry *) alloca (size * sizeof *entries);
5250 if (charpos <= 0)
5251 charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
5253 /* Append the overlay string STRING of overlay OVERLAY to vector
5254 `entries' which has size `size' and currently contains `n'
5255 elements. AFTER_P non-zero means STRING is an after-string of
5256 OVERLAY. */
5257 #define RECORD_OVERLAY_STRING(OVERLAY, STRING, AFTER_P) \
5258 do \
5260 Lisp_Object priority; \
5262 if (n == size) \
5264 int new_size = 2 * size; \
5265 struct overlay_entry *old = entries; \
5266 entries = \
5267 (struct overlay_entry *) alloca (new_size \
5268 * sizeof *entries); \
5269 memcpy (entries, old, size * sizeof *entries); \
5270 size = new_size; \
5273 entries[n].string = (STRING); \
5274 entries[n].overlay = (OVERLAY); \
5275 priority = Foverlay_get ((OVERLAY), Qpriority); \
5276 entries[n].priority = INTEGERP (priority) ? XINT (priority) : 0; \
5277 entries[n].after_string_p = (AFTER_P); \
5278 ++n; \
5280 while (0)
5282 /* Process overlay before the overlay center. */
5283 for (ov = current_buffer->overlays_before; ov; ov = ov->next)
5285 XSETMISC (overlay, ov);
5286 xassert (OVERLAYP (overlay));
5287 start = OVERLAY_POSITION (OVERLAY_START (overlay));
5288 end = OVERLAY_POSITION (OVERLAY_END (overlay));
5290 if (end < charpos)
5291 break;
5293 /* Skip this overlay if it doesn't start or end at IT's current
5294 position. */
5295 if (end != charpos && start != charpos)
5296 continue;
5298 /* Skip this overlay if it doesn't apply to IT->w. */
5299 window = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qwindow);
5300 if (WINDOWP (window) && XWINDOW (window) != it->w)
5301 continue;
5303 /* If the text ``under'' the overlay is invisible, both before-
5304 and after-strings from this overlay are visible; start and
5305 end position are indistinguishable. */
5306 invisible = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qinvisible);
5307 invis_p = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (invisible);
5309 /* If overlay has a non-empty before-string, record it. */
5310 if ((start == charpos || (end == charpos && invis_p))
5311 && (str = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qbefore_string), STRINGP (str))
5312 && SCHARS (str))
5313 RECORD_OVERLAY_STRING (overlay, str, 0);
5315 /* If overlay has a non-empty after-string, record it. */
5316 if ((end == charpos || (start == charpos && invis_p))
5317 && (str = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qafter_string), STRINGP (str))
5318 && SCHARS (str))
5319 RECORD_OVERLAY_STRING (overlay, str, 1);
5322 /* Process overlays after the overlay center. */
5323 for (ov = current_buffer->overlays_after; ov; ov = ov->next)
5325 XSETMISC (overlay, ov);
5326 xassert (OVERLAYP (overlay));
5327 start = OVERLAY_POSITION (OVERLAY_START (overlay));
5328 end = OVERLAY_POSITION (OVERLAY_END (overlay));
5330 if (start > charpos)
5331 break;
5333 /* Skip this overlay if it doesn't start or end at IT's current
5334 position. */
5335 if (end != charpos && start != charpos)
5336 continue;
5338 /* Skip this overlay if it doesn't apply to IT->w. */
5339 window = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qwindow);
5340 if (WINDOWP (window) && XWINDOW (window) != it->w)
5341 continue;
5343 /* If the text ``under'' the overlay is invisible, it has a zero
5344 dimension, and both before- and after-strings apply. */
5345 invisible = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qinvisible);
5346 invis_p = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (invisible);
5348 /* If overlay has a non-empty before-string, record it. */
5349 if ((start == charpos || (end == charpos && invis_p))
5350 && (str = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qbefore_string), STRINGP (str))
5351 && SCHARS (str))
5352 RECORD_OVERLAY_STRING (overlay, str, 0);
5354 /* If overlay has a non-empty after-string, record it. */
5355 if ((end == charpos || (start == charpos && invis_p))
5356 && (str = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qafter_string), STRINGP (str))
5357 && SCHARS (str))
5358 RECORD_OVERLAY_STRING (overlay, str, 1);
5361 #undef RECORD_OVERLAY_STRING
5363 /* Sort entries. */
5364 if (n > 1)
5365 qsort (entries, n, sizeof *entries, compare_overlay_entries);
5367 /* Record number of overlay strings, and where we computed it. */
5368 it->n_overlay_strings = n;
5369 it->overlay_strings_charpos = charpos;
5371 /* IT->current.overlay_string_index is the number of overlay strings
5372 that have already been consumed by IT. Copy some of the
5373 remaining overlay strings to IT->overlay_strings. */
5374 i = 0;
5375 j = it->current.overlay_string_index;
5376 while (i < OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE && j < n)
5378 it->overlay_strings[i] = entries[j].string;
5379 it->string_overlays[i++] = entries[j++].overlay;
5382 CHECK_IT (it);
5386 /* Get the first chunk of overlay strings at IT's current buffer
5387 position, or at CHARPOS if that is > 0. Value is non-zero if at
5388 least one overlay string was found. */
5390 static int
5391 get_overlay_strings_1 (struct it *it, EMACS_INT charpos, int compute_stop_p)
5393 /* Get the first OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE overlay strings to
5394 process. This fills IT->overlay_strings with strings, and sets
5395 IT->n_overlay_strings to the total number of strings to process.
5396 IT->pos.overlay_string_index has to be set temporarily to zero
5397 because load_overlay_strings needs this; it must be set to -1
5398 when no overlay strings are found because a zero value would
5399 indicate a position in the first overlay string. */
5400 it->current.overlay_string_index = 0;
5401 load_overlay_strings (it, charpos);
5403 /* If we found overlay strings, set up IT to deliver display
5404 elements from the first one. Otherwise set up IT to deliver
5405 from current_buffer. */
5406 if (it->n_overlay_strings)
5408 /* Make sure we know settings in current_buffer, so that we can
5409 restore meaningful values when we're done with the overlay
5410 strings. */
5411 if (compute_stop_p)
5412 compute_stop_pos (it);
5413 xassert (it->face_id >= 0);
5415 /* Save IT's settings. They are restored after all overlay
5416 strings have been processed. */
5417 xassert (!compute_stop_p || it->sp == 0);
5419 /* When called from handle_stop, there might be an empty display
5420 string loaded. In that case, don't bother saving it. */
5421 if (!STRINGP (it->string) || SCHARS (it->string))
5422 push_it (it, NULL);
5424 /* Set up IT to deliver display elements from the first overlay
5425 string. */
5426 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = 0;
5427 it->string = it->overlay_strings[0];
5428 it->from_overlay = Qnil;
5429 it->stop_charpos = 0;
5430 xassert (STRINGP (it->string));
5431 it->end_charpos = SCHARS (it->string);
5432 it->prev_stop = 0;
5433 it->base_level_stop = 0;
5434 it->multibyte_p = STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string);
5435 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
5436 it->from_disp_prop_p = 0;
5438 /* Force paragraph direction to be that of the parent
5439 buffer. */
5440 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
5441 it->paragraph_embedding = it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir;
5442 else
5443 it->paragraph_embedding = L2R;
5445 /* Set up the bidi iterator for this overlay string. */
5446 if (it->bidi_p)
5448 EMACS_INT pos = (charpos > 0 ? charpos : IT_CHARPOS (*it));
5450 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = it->string;
5451 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
5452 it->bidi_it.string.schars = SCHARS (it->string);
5453 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = pos;
5454 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = it->string_from_display_prop_p;
5455 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
5456 bidi_init_it (0, 0, FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f), &it->bidi_it);
5458 return 1;
5461 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
5462 return 0;
5465 static int
5466 get_overlay_strings (struct it *it, EMACS_INT charpos)
5468 it->string = Qnil;
5469 it->method = GET_FROM_BUFFER;
5471 (void) get_overlay_strings_1 (it, charpos, 1);
5473 CHECK_IT (it);
5475 /* Value is non-zero if we found at least one overlay string. */
5476 return STRINGP (it->string);
5481 /***********************************************************************
5482 Saving and restoring state
5483 ***********************************************************************/
5485 /* Save current settings of IT on IT->stack. Called, for example,
5486 before setting up IT for an overlay string, to be able to restore
5487 IT's settings to what they were after the overlay string has been
5488 processed. If POSITION is non-NULL, it is the position to save on
5489 the stack instead of IT->position. */
5491 static void
5492 push_it (struct it *it, struct text_pos *position)
5494 struct iterator_stack_entry *p;
5496 xassert (it->sp < IT_STACK_SIZE);
5497 p = it->stack + it->sp;
5499 p->stop_charpos = it->stop_charpos;
5500 p->prev_stop = it->prev_stop;
5501 p->base_level_stop = it->base_level_stop;
5502 p->cmp_it = it->cmp_it;
5503 xassert (it->face_id >= 0);
5504 p->face_id = it->face_id;
5505 p->string = it->string;
5506 p->method = it->method;
5507 p->from_overlay = it->from_overlay;
5508 switch (p->method)
5510 case GET_FROM_IMAGE:
5511 p->u.image.object = it->object;
5512 p->u.image.image_id = it->image_id;
5513 p->u.image.slice = it->slice;
5514 break;
5515 case GET_FROM_STRETCH:
5516 p->u.stretch.object = it->object;
5517 break;
5519 p->position = position ? *position : it->position;
5520 p->current = it->current;
5521 p->end_charpos = it->end_charpos;
5522 p->string_nchars = it->string_nchars;
5523 p->area = it->area;
5524 p->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
5525 p->avoid_cursor_p = it->avoid_cursor_p;
5526 p->space_width = it->space_width;
5527 p->font_height = it->font_height;
5528 p->voffset = it->voffset;
5529 p->string_from_display_prop_p = it->string_from_display_prop_p;
5530 p->display_ellipsis_p = 0;
5531 p->line_wrap = it->line_wrap;
5532 p->bidi_p = it->bidi_p;
5533 p->paragraph_embedding = it->paragraph_embedding;
5534 p->from_disp_prop_p = it->from_disp_prop_p;
5535 ++it->sp;
5537 /* Save the state of the bidi iterator as well. */
5538 if (it->bidi_p)
5539 bidi_push_it (&it->bidi_it);
5542 static void
5543 iterate_out_of_display_property (struct it *it)
5545 int buffer_p = BUFFERP (it->object);
5546 EMACS_INT eob = (buffer_p ? ZV : it->end_charpos);
5547 EMACS_INT bob = (buffer_p ? BEGV : 0);
5549 xassert (eob >= CHARPOS (it->position) && CHARPOS (it->position) >= bob);
5551 /* Maybe initialize paragraph direction. If we are at the beginning
5552 of a new paragraph, next_element_from_buffer may not have a
5553 chance to do that. */
5554 if (it->bidi_it.first_elt && it->bidi_it.charpos < eob)
5555 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding, &it->bidi_it, 1);
5556 /* prev_stop can be zero, so check against BEGV as well. */
5557 while (it->bidi_it.charpos >= bob
5558 && it->prev_stop <= it->bidi_it.charpos
5559 && it->bidi_it.charpos < CHARPOS (it->position)
5560 && it->bidi_it.charpos < eob)
5561 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
5562 /* Record the stop_pos we just crossed, for when we cross it
5563 back, maybe. */
5564 if (it->bidi_it.charpos > CHARPOS (it->position))
5565 it->prev_stop = CHARPOS (it->position);
5566 /* If we ended up not where pop_it put us, resync IT's
5567 positional members with the bidi iterator. */
5568 if (it->bidi_it.charpos != CHARPOS (it->position))
5569 SET_TEXT_POS (it->position, it->bidi_it.charpos, it->bidi_it.bytepos);
5570 if (buffer_p)
5571 it->current.pos = it->position;
5572 else
5573 it->current.string_pos = it->position;
5576 /* Restore IT's settings from IT->stack. Called, for example, when no
5577 more overlay strings must be processed, and we return to delivering
5578 display elements from a buffer, or when the end of a string from a
5579 `display' property is reached and we return to delivering display
5580 elements from an overlay string, or from a buffer. */
5582 static void
5583 pop_it (struct it *it)
5585 struct iterator_stack_entry *p;
5586 int from_display_prop = it->from_disp_prop_p;
5588 xassert (it->sp > 0);
5589 --it->sp;
5590 p = it->stack + it->sp;
5591 it->stop_charpos = p->stop_charpos;
5592 it->prev_stop = p->prev_stop;
5593 it->base_level_stop = p->base_level_stop;
5594 it->cmp_it = p->cmp_it;
5595 it->face_id = p->face_id;
5596 it->current = p->current;
5597 it->position = p->position;
5598 it->string = p->string;
5599 it->from_overlay = p->from_overlay;
5600 if (NILP (it->string))
5601 SET_TEXT_POS (it->current.string_pos, -1, -1);
5602 it->method = p->method;
5603 switch (it->method)
5605 case GET_FROM_IMAGE:
5606 it->image_id = p->u.image.image_id;
5607 it->object = p->u.image.object;
5608 it->slice = p->u.image.slice;
5609 break;
5610 case GET_FROM_STRETCH:
5611 it->object = p->u.stretch.object;
5612 break;
5613 case GET_FROM_BUFFER:
5614 it->object = it->w->buffer;
5615 break;
5616 case GET_FROM_STRING:
5617 it->object = it->string;
5618 break;
5619 case GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR:
5620 if (it->s)
5621 it->method = GET_FROM_C_STRING;
5622 else if (STRINGP (it->string))
5623 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
5624 else
5626 it->method = GET_FROM_BUFFER;
5627 it->object = it->w->buffer;
5630 it->end_charpos = p->end_charpos;
5631 it->string_nchars = p->string_nchars;
5632 it->area = p->area;
5633 it->multibyte_p = p->multibyte_p;
5634 it->avoid_cursor_p = p->avoid_cursor_p;
5635 it->space_width = p->space_width;
5636 it->font_height = p->font_height;
5637 it->voffset = p->voffset;
5638 it->string_from_display_prop_p = p->string_from_display_prop_p;
5639 it->line_wrap = p->line_wrap;
5640 it->bidi_p = p->bidi_p;
5641 it->paragraph_embedding = p->paragraph_embedding;
5642 it->from_disp_prop_p = p->from_disp_prop_p;
5643 if (it->bidi_p)
5645 bidi_pop_it (&it->bidi_it);
5646 /* Bidi-iterate until we get out of the portion of text, if any,
5647 covered by a `display' text property or by an overlay with
5648 `display' property. (We cannot just jump there, because the
5649 internal coherency of the bidi iterator state can not be
5650 preserved across such jumps.) We also must determine the
5651 paragraph base direction if the overlay we just processed is
5652 at the beginning of a new paragraph. */
5653 if (from_display_prop
5654 && (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER || it->method == GET_FROM_STRING))
5655 iterate_out_of_display_property (it);
5657 xassert ((BUFFERP (it->object)
5658 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) == it->bidi_it.charpos
5659 && IT_BYTEPOS (*it) == it->bidi_it.bytepos)
5660 || (STRINGP (it->object)
5661 && IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) == it->bidi_it.charpos
5662 && IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) == it->bidi_it.bytepos)
5663 || (CONSP (it->object) && it->method == GET_FROM_STRETCH));
5669 /***********************************************************************
5670 Moving over lines
5671 ***********************************************************************/
5673 /* Set IT's current position to the previous line start. */
5675 static void
5676 back_to_previous_line_start (struct it *it)
5678 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = find_next_newline_no_quit (IT_CHARPOS (*it) - 1, -1);
5679 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = CHAR_TO_BYTE (IT_CHARPOS (*it));
5683 /* Move IT to the next line start.
5685 Value is non-zero if a newline was found. Set *SKIPPED_P to 1 if
5686 we skipped over part of the text (as opposed to moving the iterator
5687 continuously over the text). Otherwise, don't change the value
5688 of *SKIPPED_P.
5690 If BIDI_IT_PREV is non-NULL, store into it the state of the bidi
5691 iterator on the newline, if it was found.
5693 Newlines may come from buffer text, overlay strings, or strings
5694 displayed via the `display' property. That's the reason we can't
5695 simply use find_next_newline_no_quit.
5697 Note that this function may not skip over invisible text that is so
5698 because of text properties and immediately follows a newline. If
5699 it would, function reseat_at_next_visible_line_start, when called
5700 from set_iterator_to_next, would effectively make invisible
5701 characters following a newline part of the wrong glyph row, which
5702 leads to wrong cursor motion. */
5704 static int
5705 forward_to_next_line_start (struct it *it, int *skipped_p,
5706 struct bidi_it *bidi_it_prev)
5708 EMACS_INT old_selective;
5709 int newline_found_p, n;
5710 const int MAX_NEWLINE_DISTANCE = 500;
5712 /* If already on a newline, just consume it to avoid unintended
5713 skipping over invisible text below. */
5714 if (it->what == IT_CHARACTER
5715 && it->c == '\n'
5716 && CHARPOS (it->position) == IT_CHARPOS (*it))
5718 if (it->bidi_p && bidi_it_prev)
5719 *bidi_it_prev = it->bidi_it;
5720 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
5721 it->c = 0;
5722 return 1;
5725 /* Don't handle selective display in the following. It's (a)
5726 unnecessary because it's done by the caller, and (b) leads to an
5727 infinite recursion because next_element_from_ellipsis indirectly
5728 calls this function. */
5729 old_selective = it->selective;
5730 it->selective = 0;
5732 /* Scan for a newline within MAX_NEWLINE_DISTANCE display elements
5733 from buffer text. */
5734 for (n = newline_found_p = 0;
5735 !newline_found_p && n < MAX_NEWLINE_DISTANCE;
5736 n += STRINGP (it->string) ? 0 : 1)
5738 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
5739 return 0;
5740 newline_found_p = it->what == IT_CHARACTER && it->c == '\n';
5741 if (newline_found_p && it->bidi_p && bidi_it_prev)
5742 *bidi_it_prev = it->bidi_it;
5743 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
5746 /* If we didn't find a newline near enough, see if we can use a
5747 short-cut. */
5748 if (!newline_found_p)
5750 EMACS_INT start = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
5751 EMACS_INT limit = find_next_newline_no_quit (start, 1);
5752 Lisp_Object pos;
5754 xassert (!STRINGP (it->string));
5756 /* If there isn't any `display' property in sight, and no
5757 overlays, we can just use the position of the newline in
5758 buffer text. */
5759 if (it->stop_charpos >= limit
5760 || ((pos = Fnext_single_property_change (make_number (start),
5761 Qdisplay, Qnil,
5762 make_number (limit)),
5763 NILP (pos))
5764 && next_overlay_change (start) == ZV))
5766 if (!it->bidi_p)
5768 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = limit;
5769 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = CHAR_TO_BYTE (limit);
5771 else
5773 struct bidi_it bprev;
5775 /* Help bidi.c avoid expensive searches for display
5776 properties and overlays, by telling it that there are
5777 none up to `limit'. */
5778 if (it->bidi_it.disp_pos < limit)
5780 it->bidi_it.disp_pos = limit;
5781 it->bidi_it.disp_prop = 0;
5783 do {
5784 bprev = it->bidi_it;
5785 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
5786 } while (it->bidi_it.charpos != limit);
5787 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = limit;
5788 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
5789 if (bidi_it_prev)
5790 *bidi_it_prev = bprev;
5792 *skipped_p = newline_found_p = 1;
5794 else
5796 while (get_next_display_element (it)
5797 && !newline_found_p)
5799 newline_found_p = ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it);
5800 if (newline_found_p && it->bidi_p && bidi_it_prev)
5801 *bidi_it_prev = it->bidi_it;
5802 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
5807 it->selective = old_selective;
5808 return newline_found_p;
5812 /* Set IT's current position to the previous visible line start. Skip
5813 invisible text that is so either due to text properties or due to
5814 selective display. Caution: this does not change IT->current_x and
5815 IT->hpos. */
5817 static void
5818 back_to_previous_visible_line_start (struct it *it)
5820 while (IT_CHARPOS (*it) > BEGV)
5822 back_to_previous_line_start (it);
5824 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) <= BEGV)
5825 break;
5827 /* If selective > 0, then lines indented more than its value are
5828 invisible. */
5829 if (it->selective > 0
5830 && indented_beyond_p (IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it),
5831 it->selective))
5832 continue;
5834 /* Check the newline before point for invisibility. */
5836 Lisp_Object prop;
5837 prop = Fget_char_property (make_number (IT_CHARPOS (*it) - 1),
5838 Qinvisible, it->window);
5839 if (TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop))
5840 continue;
5843 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) <= BEGV)
5844 break;
5847 struct it it2;
5848 void *it2data = NULL;
5849 EMACS_INT pos;
5850 EMACS_INT beg, end;
5851 Lisp_Object val, overlay;
5853 SAVE_IT (it2, *it, it2data);
5855 /* If newline is part of a composition, continue from start of composition */
5856 if (find_composition (IT_CHARPOS (*it), -1, &beg, &end, &val, Qnil)
5857 && beg < IT_CHARPOS (*it))
5858 goto replaced;
5860 /* If newline is replaced by a display property, find start of overlay
5861 or interval and continue search from that point. */
5862 pos = --IT_CHARPOS (it2);
5863 --IT_BYTEPOS (it2);
5864 it2.sp = 0;
5865 bidi_unshelve_cache (NULL, 0);
5866 it2.string_from_display_prop_p = 0;
5867 it2.from_disp_prop_p = 0;
5868 if (handle_display_prop (&it2) == HANDLED_RETURN
5869 && !NILP (val = get_char_property_and_overlay
5870 (make_number (pos), Qdisplay, Qnil, &overlay))
5871 && (OVERLAYP (overlay)
5872 ? (beg = OVERLAY_POSITION (OVERLAY_START (overlay)))
5873 : get_property_and_range (pos, Qdisplay, &val, &beg, &end, Qnil)))
5875 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it2data);
5876 goto replaced;
5879 /* Newline is not replaced by anything -- so we are done. */
5880 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it2data);
5881 break;
5883 replaced:
5884 if (beg < BEGV)
5885 beg = BEGV;
5886 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = beg;
5887 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = buf_charpos_to_bytepos (current_buffer, beg);
5891 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
5893 xassert (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= BEGV);
5894 xassert (IT_CHARPOS (*it) == BEGV
5895 || FETCH_BYTE (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) - 1) == '\n');
5896 CHECK_IT (it);
5900 /* Reseat iterator IT at the previous visible line start. Skip
5901 invisible text that is so either due to text properties or due to
5902 selective display. At the end, update IT's overlay information,
5903 face information etc. */
5905 void
5906 reseat_at_previous_visible_line_start (struct it *it)
5908 back_to_previous_visible_line_start (it);
5909 reseat (it, it->current.pos, 1);
5910 CHECK_IT (it);
5914 /* Reseat iterator IT on the next visible line start in the current
5915 buffer. ON_NEWLINE_P non-zero means position IT on the newline
5916 preceding the line start. Skip over invisible text that is so
5917 because of selective display. Compute faces, overlays etc at the
5918 new position. Note that this function does not skip over text that
5919 is invisible because of text properties. */
5921 static void
5922 reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (struct it *it, int on_newline_p)
5924 int newline_found_p, skipped_p = 0;
5925 struct bidi_it bidi_it_prev;
5927 newline_found_p = forward_to_next_line_start (it, &skipped_p, &bidi_it_prev);
5929 /* Skip over lines that are invisible because they are indented
5930 more than the value of IT->selective. */
5931 if (it->selective > 0)
5932 while (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < ZV
5933 && indented_beyond_p (IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it),
5934 it->selective))
5936 xassert (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) == BEGV
5937 || FETCH_BYTE (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) - 1) == '\n');
5938 newline_found_p =
5939 forward_to_next_line_start (it, &skipped_p, &bidi_it_prev);
5942 /* Position on the newline if that's what's requested. */
5943 if (on_newline_p && newline_found_p)
5945 if (STRINGP (it->string))
5947 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) > 0)
5949 if (!it->bidi_p)
5951 --IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
5952 --IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it);
5954 else
5956 /* We need to restore the bidi iterator to the state
5957 it had on the newline, and resync the IT's
5958 position with that. */
5959 it->bidi_it = bidi_it_prev;
5960 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
5961 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
5965 else if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) > BEGV)
5967 if (!it->bidi_p)
5969 --IT_CHARPOS (*it);
5970 --IT_BYTEPOS (*it);
5972 else
5974 /* We need to restore the bidi iterator to the state it
5975 had on the newline and resync IT with that. */
5976 it->bidi_it = bidi_it_prev;
5977 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
5978 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
5980 reseat (it, it->current.pos, 0);
5983 else if (skipped_p)
5984 reseat (it, it->current.pos, 0);
5986 CHECK_IT (it);
5991 /***********************************************************************
5992 Changing an iterator's position
5993 ***********************************************************************/
5995 /* Change IT's current position to POS in current_buffer. If FORCE_P
5996 is non-zero, always check for text properties at the new position.
5997 Otherwise, text properties are only looked up if POS >=
5998 IT->check_charpos of a property. */
6000 static void
6001 reseat (struct it *it, struct text_pos pos, int force_p)
6003 EMACS_INT original_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
6005 reseat_1 (it, pos, 0);
6007 /* Determine where to check text properties. Avoid doing it
6008 where possible because text property lookup is very expensive. */
6009 if (force_p
6010 || CHARPOS (pos) > it->stop_charpos
6011 || CHARPOS (pos) < original_pos)
6013 if (it->bidi_p)
6015 /* For bidi iteration, we need to prime prev_stop and
6016 base_level_stop with our best estimations. */
6017 /* Implementation note: Of course, POS is not necessarily a
6018 stop position, so assigning prev_pos to it is a lie; we
6019 should have called compute_stop_backwards. However, if
6020 the current buffer does not include any R2L characters,
6021 that call would be a waste of cycles, because the
6022 iterator will never move back, and thus never cross this
6023 "fake" stop position. So we delay that backward search
6024 until the time we really need it, in next_element_from_buffer. */
6025 if (CHARPOS (pos) != it->prev_stop)
6026 it->prev_stop = CHARPOS (pos);
6027 if (CHARPOS (pos) < it->base_level_stop)
6028 it->base_level_stop = 0; /* meaning it's unknown */
6029 handle_stop (it);
6031 else
6033 handle_stop (it);
6034 it->prev_stop = it->base_level_stop = 0;
6039 CHECK_IT (it);
6043 /* Change IT's buffer position to POS. SET_STOP_P non-zero means set
6044 IT->stop_pos to POS, also. */
6046 static void
6047 reseat_1 (struct it *it, struct text_pos pos, int set_stop_p)
6049 /* Don't call this function when scanning a C string. */
6050 xassert (it->s == NULL);
6052 /* POS must be a reasonable value. */
6053 xassert (CHARPOS (pos) >= BEGV && CHARPOS (pos) <= ZV);
6055 it->current.pos = it->position = pos;
6056 it->end_charpos = ZV;
6057 it->dpvec = NULL;
6058 it->current.dpvec_index = -1;
6059 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
6060 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = -1;
6061 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = -1;
6062 it->string = Qnil;
6063 it->method = GET_FROM_BUFFER;
6064 it->object = it->w->buffer;
6065 it->area = TEXT_AREA;
6066 it->multibyte_p = !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters));
6067 it->sp = 0;
6068 it->string_from_display_prop_p = 0;
6069 it->from_disp_prop_p = 0;
6070 it->face_before_selective_p = 0;
6071 if (it->bidi_p)
6073 bidi_init_it (IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it), FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f),
6074 &it->bidi_it);
6075 bidi_unshelve_cache (NULL, 0);
6076 it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir = NEUTRAL_DIR;
6077 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
6078 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = Qnil;
6079 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = 0;
6080 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = 0;
6083 if (set_stop_p)
6085 it->stop_charpos = CHARPOS (pos);
6086 it->base_level_stop = CHARPOS (pos);
6091 /* Set up IT for displaying a string, starting at CHARPOS in window W.
6092 If S is non-null, it is a C string to iterate over. Otherwise,
6093 STRING gives a Lisp string to iterate over.
6095 If PRECISION > 0, don't return more then PRECISION number of
6096 characters from the string.
6098 If FIELD_WIDTH > 0, return padding spaces until FIELD_WIDTH
6099 characters have been returned. FIELD_WIDTH < 0 means an infinite
6100 field width.
6102 MULTIBYTE = 0 means disable processing of multibyte characters,
6103 MULTIBYTE > 0 means enable it,
6104 MULTIBYTE < 0 means use IT->multibyte_p.
6106 IT must be initialized via a prior call to init_iterator before
6107 calling this function. */
6109 static void
6110 reseat_to_string (struct it *it, const char *s, Lisp_Object string,
6111 EMACS_INT charpos, EMACS_INT precision, int field_width,
6112 int multibyte)
6114 /* No region in strings. */
6115 it->region_beg_charpos = it->region_end_charpos = -1;
6117 /* No text property checks performed by default, but see below. */
6118 it->stop_charpos = -1;
6120 /* Set iterator position and end position. */
6121 memset (&it->current, 0, sizeof it->current);
6122 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
6123 it->current.dpvec_index = -1;
6124 xassert (charpos >= 0);
6126 /* If STRING is specified, use its multibyteness, otherwise use the
6127 setting of MULTIBYTE, if specified. */
6128 if (multibyte >= 0)
6129 it->multibyte_p = multibyte > 0;
6131 /* Bidirectional reordering of strings is controlled by the default
6132 value of bidi-display-reordering. */
6133 it->bidi_p = !NILP (BVAR (&buffer_defaults, bidi_display_reordering));
6135 if (s == NULL)
6137 xassert (STRINGP (string));
6138 it->string = string;
6139 it->s = NULL;
6140 it->end_charpos = it->string_nchars = SCHARS (string);
6141 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
6142 it->current.string_pos = string_pos (charpos, string);
6144 if (it->bidi_p)
6146 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = string;
6147 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
6148 it->bidi_it.string.schars = it->end_charpos;
6149 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = 0;
6150 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = 0;
6151 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
6152 bidi_init_it (charpos, IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it),
6153 FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f), &it->bidi_it);
6156 else
6158 it->s = (const unsigned char *) s;
6159 it->string = Qnil;
6161 /* Note that we use IT->current.pos, not it->current.string_pos,
6162 for displaying C strings. */
6163 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = -1;
6164 if (it->multibyte_p)
6166 it->current.pos = c_string_pos (charpos, s, 1);
6167 it->end_charpos = it->string_nchars = number_of_chars (s, 1);
6169 else
6171 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = charpos;
6172 it->end_charpos = it->string_nchars = strlen (s);
6175 if (it->bidi_p)
6177 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = Qnil;
6178 it->bidi_it.string.s = (const unsigned char *) s;
6179 it->bidi_it.string.schars = it->end_charpos;
6180 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = 0;
6181 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = 0;
6182 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
6183 bidi_init_it (charpos, IT_BYTEPOS (*it), FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f),
6184 &it->bidi_it);
6186 it->method = GET_FROM_C_STRING;
6189 /* PRECISION > 0 means don't return more than PRECISION characters
6190 from the string. */
6191 if (precision > 0 && it->end_charpos - charpos > precision)
6193 it->end_charpos = it->string_nchars = charpos + precision;
6194 if (it->bidi_p)
6195 it->bidi_it.string.schars = it->end_charpos;
6198 /* FIELD_WIDTH > 0 means pad with spaces until FIELD_WIDTH
6199 characters have been returned. FIELD_WIDTH == 0 means don't pad,
6200 FIELD_WIDTH < 0 means infinite field width. This is useful for
6201 padding with `-' at the end of a mode line. */
6202 if (field_width < 0)
6203 field_width = INFINITY;
6204 /* Implementation note: We deliberately don't enlarge
6205 it->bidi_it.string.schars here to fit it->end_charpos, because
6206 the bidi iterator cannot produce characters out of thin air. */
6207 if (field_width > it->end_charpos - charpos)
6208 it->end_charpos = charpos + field_width;
6210 /* Use the standard display table for displaying strings. */
6211 if (DISP_TABLE_P (Vstandard_display_table))
6212 it->dp = XCHAR_TABLE (Vstandard_display_table);
6214 it->stop_charpos = charpos;
6215 it->prev_stop = charpos;
6216 it->base_level_stop = 0;
6217 if (it->bidi_p)
6219 it->bidi_it.first_elt = 1;
6220 it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir = NEUTRAL_DIR;
6221 it->bidi_it.disp_pos = -1;
6223 if (s == NULL && it->multibyte_p)
6225 EMACS_INT endpos = SCHARS (it->string);
6226 if (endpos > it->end_charpos)
6227 endpos = it->end_charpos;
6228 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, charpos, -1, endpos,
6229 it->string);
6231 CHECK_IT (it);
6236 /***********************************************************************
6237 Iteration
6238 ***********************************************************************/
6240 /* Map enum it_method value to corresponding next_element_from_* function. */
6242 static int (* get_next_element[NUM_IT_METHODS]) (struct it *it) =
6244 next_element_from_buffer,
6245 next_element_from_display_vector,
6246 next_element_from_string,
6247 next_element_from_c_string,
6248 next_element_from_image,
6249 next_element_from_stretch
6252 #define GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT(it) (*get_next_element[(it)->method]) (it)
6255 /* Return 1 iff a character at CHARPOS (and BYTEPOS) is composed
6256 (possibly with the following characters). */
6258 #define CHAR_COMPOSED_P(IT,CHARPOS,BYTEPOS,END_CHARPOS) \
6259 ((IT)->cmp_it.id >= 0 \
6260 || ((IT)->cmp_it.stop_pos == (CHARPOS) \
6261 && composition_reseat_it (&(IT)->cmp_it, CHARPOS, BYTEPOS, \
6262 END_CHARPOS, (IT)->w, \
6263 FACE_FROM_ID ((IT)->f, (IT)->face_id), \
6264 (IT)->string)))
6267 /* Lookup the char-table Vglyphless_char_display for character C (-1
6268 if we want information for no-font case), and return the display
6269 method symbol. By side-effect, update it->what and
6270 it->glyphless_method. This function is called from
6271 get_next_display_element for each character element, and from
6272 x_produce_glyphs when no suitable font was found. */
6274 Lisp_Object
6275 lookup_glyphless_char_display (int c, struct it *it)
6277 Lisp_Object glyphless_method = Qnil;
6279 if (CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display)
6280 && CHAR_TABLE_EXTRA_SLOTS (XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display)) >= 1)
6282 if (c >= 0)
6284 glyphless_method = CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display, c);
6285 if (CONSP (glyphless_method))
6286 glyphless_method = FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
6287 ? XCAR (glyphless_method)
6288 : XCDR (glyphless_method);
6290 else
6291 glyphless_method = XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display)->extras[0];
6294 retry:
6295 if (NILP (glyphless_method))
6297 if (c >= 0)
6298 /* The default is to display the character by a proper font. */
6299 return Qnil;
6300 /* The default for the no-font case is to display an empty box. */
6301 glyphless_method = Qempty_box;
6303 if (EQ (glyphless_method, Qzero_width))
6305 if (c >= 0)
6306 return glyphless_method;
6307 /* This method can't be used for the no-font case. */
6308 glyphless_method = Qempty_box;
6310 if (EQ (glyphless_method, Qthin_space))
6311 it->glyphless_method = GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE;
6312 else if (EQ (glyphless_method, Qempty_box))
6313 it->glyphless_method = GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_EMPTY_BOX;
6314 else if (EQ (glyphless_method, Qhex_code))
6315 it->glyphless_method = GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE;
6316 else if (STRINGP (glyphless_method))
6317 it->glyphless_method = GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM;
6318 else
6320 /* Invalid value. We use the default method. */
6321 glyphless_method = Qnil;
6322 goto retry;
6324 it->what = IT_GLYPHLESS;
6325 return glyphless_method;
6328 /* Load IT's display element fields with information about the next
6329 display element from the current position of IT. Value is zero if
6330 end of buffer (or C string) is reached. */
6332 static struct frame *last_escape_glyph_frame = NULL;
6333 static unsigned last_escape_glyph_face_id = (1 << FACE_ID_BITS);
6334 static int last_escape_glyph_merged_face_id = 0;
6336 struct frame *last_glyphless_glyph_frame = NULL;
6337 unsigned last_glyphless_glyph_face_id = (1 << FACE_ID_BITS);
6338 int last_glyphless_glyph_merged_face_id = 0;
6340 static int
6341 get_next_display_element (struct it *it)
6343 /* Non-zero means that we found a display element. Zero means that
6344 we hit the end of what we iterate over. Performance note: the
6345 function pointer `method' used here turns out to be faster than
6346 using a sequence of if-statements. */
6347 int success_p;
6349 get_next:
6350 success_p = GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
6352 if (it->what == IT_CHARACTER)
6354 /* UAX#9, L4: "A character is depicted by a mirrored glyph if
6355 and only if (a) the resolved directionality of that character
6356 is R..." */
6357 /* FIXME: Do we need an exception for characters from display
6358 tables? */
6359 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.type == STRONG_R)
6360 it->c = bidi_mirror_char (it->c);
6361 /* Map via display table or translate control characters.
6362 IT->c, IT->len etc. have been set to the next character by
6363 the function call above. If we have a display table, and it
6364 contains an entry for IT->c, translate it. Don't do this if
6365 IT->c itself comes from a display table, otherwise we could
6366 end up in an infinite recursion. (An alternative could be to
6367 count the recursion depth of this function and signal an
6368 error when a certain maximum depth is reached.) Is it worth
6369 it? */
6370 if (success_p && it->dpvec == NULL)
6372 Lisp_Object dv;
6373 struct charset *unibyte = CHARSET_FROM_ID (charset_unibyte);
6374 enum { char_is_other = 0, char_is_nbsp, char_is_soft_hyphen }
6375 nbsp_or_shy = char_is_other;
6376 int c = it->c; /* This is the character to display. */
6378 if (! it->multibyte_p && ! ASCII_CHAR_P (c))
6380 xassert (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (c));
6381 if (unibyte_display_via_language_environment)
6383 c = DECODE_CHAR (unibyte, c);
6384 if (c < 0)
6385 c = BYTE8_TO_CHAR (it->c);
6387 else
6388 c = BYTE8_TO_CHAR (it->c);
6391 if (it->dp
6392 && (dv = DISP_CHAR_VECTOR (it->dp, c),
6393 VECTORP (dv)))
6395 struct Lisp_Vector *v = XVECTOR (dv);
6397 /* Return the first character from the display table
6398 entry, if not empty. If empty, don't display the
6399 current character. */
6400 if (v->header.size)
6402 it->dpvec_char_len = it->len;
6403 it->dpvec = v->contents;
6404 it->dpend = v->contents + v->header.size;
6405 it->current.dpvec_index = 0;
6406 it->dpvec_face_id = -1;
6407 it->saved_face_id = it->face_id;
6408 it->method = GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR;
6409 it->ellipsis_p = 0;
6411 else
6413 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
6415 goto get_next;
6418 if (! NILP (lookup_glyphless_char_display (c, it)))
6420 if (it->what == IT_GLYPHLESS)
6421 goto done;
6422 /* Don't display this character. */
6423 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
6424 goto get_next;
6427 if (! ASCII_CHAR_P (c) && ! NILP (Vnobreak_char_display))
6428 nbsp_or_shy = (c == 0xA0 ? char_is_nbsp
6429 : c == 0xAD ? char_is_soft_hyphen
6430 : char_is_other);
6432 /* Translate control characters into `\003' or `^C' form.
6433 Control characters coming from a display table entry are
6434 currently not translated because we use IT->dpvec to hold
6435 the translation. This could easily be changed but I
6436 don't believe that it is worth doing.
6438 NBSP and SOFT-HYPEN are property translated too.
6440 Non-printable characters and raw-byte characters are also
6441 translated to octal form. */
6442 if (((c < ' ' || c == 127) /* ASCII control chars */
6443 ? (it->area != TEXT_AREA
6444 /* In mode line, treat \n, \t like other crl chars. */
6445 || (c != '\t'
6446 && it->glyph_row
6447 && (it->glyph_row->mode_line_p || it->avoid_cursor_p))
6448 || (c != '\n' && c != '\t'))
6449 : (nbsp_or_shy
6450 || CHAR_BYTE8_P (c)
6451 || ! CHAR_PRINTABLE_P (c))))
6453 /* C is a control character, NBSP, SOFT-HYPEN, raw-byte,
6454 or a non-printable character which must be displayed
6455 either as '\003' or as `^C' where the '\\' and '^'
6456 can be defined in the display table. Fill
6457 IT->ctl_chars with glyphs for what we have to
6458 display. Then, set IT->dpvec to these glyphs. */
6459 Lisp_Object gc;
6460 int ctl_len;
6461 int face_id;
6462 EMACS_INT lface_id = 0;
6463 int escape_glyph;
6465 /* Handle control characters with ^. */
6467 if (ASCII_CHAR_P (c) && it->ctl_arrow_p)
6469 int g;
6471 g = '^'; /* default glyph for Control */
6472 /* Set IT->ctl_chars[0] to the glyph for `^'. */
6473 if (it->dp
6474 && (gc = DISP_CTRL_GLYPH (it->dp), GLYPH_CODE_P (gc))
6475 && GLYPH_CODE_CHAR_VALID_P (gc))
6477 g = GLYPH_CODE_CHAR (gc);
6478 lface_id = GLYPH_CODE_FACE (gc);
6480 if (lface_id)
6482 face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qt, lface_id, it->face_id);
6484 else if (it->f == last_escape_glyph_frame
6485 && it->face_id == last_escape_glyph_face_id)
6487 face_id = last_escape_glyph_merged_face_id;
6489 else
6491 /* Merge the escape-glyph face into the current face. */
6492 face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qescape_glyph, 0,
6493 it->face_id);
6494 last_escape_glyph_frame = it->f;
6495 last_escape_glyph_face_id = it->face_id;
6496 last_escape_glyph_merged_face_id = face_id;
6499 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[0], g);
6500 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[1], c ^ 0100);
6501 ctl_len = 2;
6502 goto display_control;
6505 /* Handle non-break space in the mode where it only gets
6506 highlighting. */
6508 if (EQ (Vnobreak_char_display, Qt)
6509 && nbsp_or_shy == char_is_nbsp)
6511 /* Merge the no-break-space face into the current face. */
6512 face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qnobreak_space, 0,
6513 it->face_id);
6515 c = ' ';
6516 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[0], ' ');
6517 ctl_len = 1;
6518 goto display_control;
6521 /* Handle sequences that start with the "escape glyph". */
6523 /* the default escape glyph is \. */
6524 escape_glyph = '\\';
6526 if (it->dp
6527 && (gc = DISP_ESCAPE_GLYPH (it->dp), GLYPH_CODE_P (gc))
6528 && GLYPH_CODE_CHAR_VALID_P (gc))
6530 escape_glyph = GLYPH_CODE_CHAR (gc);
6531 lface_id = GLYPH_CODE_FACE (gc);
6533 if (lface_id)
6535 /* The display table specified a face.
6536 Merge it into face_id and also into escape_glyph. */
6537 face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qt, lface_id,
6538 it->face_id);
6540 else if (it->f == last_escape_glyph_frame
6541 && it->face_id == last_escape_glyph_face_id)
6543 face_id = last_escape_glyph_merged_face_id;
6545 else
6547 /* Merge the escape-glyph face into the current face. */
6548 face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qescape_glyph, 0,
6549 it->face_id);
6550 last_escape_glyph_frame = it->f;
6551 last_escape_glyph_face_id = it->face_id;
6552 last_escape_glyph_merged_face_id = face_id;
6555 /* Handle soft hyphens in the mode where they only get
6556 highlighting. */
6558 if (EQ (Vnobreak_char_display, Qt)
6559 && nbsp_or_shy == char_is_soft_hyphen)
6561 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[0], '-');
6562 ctl_len = 1;
6563 goto display_control;
6566 /* Handle non-break space and soft hyphen
6567 with the escape glyph. */
6569 if (nbsp_or_shy)
6571 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[0], escape_glyph);
6572 c = (nbsp_or_shy == char_is_nbsp ? ' ' : '-');
6573 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[1], c);
6574 ctl_len = 2;
6575 goto display_control;
6579 char str[10];
6580 int len, i;
6582 if (CHAR_BYTE8_P (c))
6583 /* Display \200 instead of \17777600. */
6584 c = CHAR_TO_BYTE8 (c);
6585 len = sprintf (str, "%03o", c);
6587 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[0], escape_glyph);
6588 for (i = 0; i < len; i++)
6589 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[i + 1], str[i]);
6590 ctl_len = len + 1;
6593 display_control:
6594 /* Set up IT->dpvec and return first character from it. */
6595 it->dpvec_char_len = it->len;
6596 it->dpvec = it->ctl_chars;
6597 it->dpend = it->dpvec + ctl_len;
6598 it->current.dpvec_index = 0;
6599 it->dpvec_face_id = face_id;
6600 it->saved_face_id = it->face_id;
6601 it->method = GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR;
6602 it->ellipsis_p = 0;
6603 goto get_next;
6605 it->char_to_display = c;
6607 else if (success_p)
6609 it->char_to_display = it->c;
6613 /* Adjust face id for a multibyte character. There are no multibyte
6614 character in unibyte text. */
6615 if ((it->what == IT_CHARACTER || it->what == IT_COMPOSITION)
6616 && it->multibyte_p
6617 && success_p
6618 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
6620 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
6622 if (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION && it->cmp_it.ch >= 0)
6624 /* Automatic composition with glyph-string. */
6625 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (it->cmp_it.id);
6627 it->face_id = face_for_font (it->f, LGSTRING_FONT (gstring), face);
6629 else
6631 EMACS_INT pos = (it->s ? -1
6632 : STRINGP (it->string) ? IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it)
6633 : IT_CHARPOS (*it));
6634 int c;
6636 if (it->what == IT_CHARACTER)
6637 c = it->char_to_display;
6638 else
6640 struct composition *cmp = composition_table[it->cmp_it.id];
6641 int i;
6643 c = ' ';
6644 for (i = 0; i < cmp->glyph_len; i++)
6645 /* TAB in a composition means display glyphs with
6646 padding space on the left or right. */
6647 if ((c = COMPOSITION_GLYPH (cmp, i)) != '\t')
6648 break;
6650 it->face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, c, pos, it->string);
6654 done:
6655 /* Is this character the last one of a run of characters with
6656 box? If yes, set IT->end_of_box_run_p to 1. */
6657 if (it->face_box_p
6658 && it->s == NULL)
6660 if (it->method == GET_FROM_STRING && it->sp)
6662 int face_id = underlying_face_id (it);
6663 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
6665 if (face)
6667 if (face->box == FACE_NO_BOX)
6669 /* If the box comes from face properties in a
6670 display string, check faces in that string. */
6671 int string_face_id = face_after_it_pos (it);
6672 it->end_of_box_run_p
6673 = (FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, string_face_id)->box
6674 == FACE_NO_BOX);
6676 /* Otherwise, the box comes from the underlying face.
6677 If this is the last string character displayed, check
6678 the next buffer location. */
6679 else if ((IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= SCHARS (it->string) - 1)
6680 && (it->current.overlay_string_index
6681 == it->n_overlay_strings - 1))
6683 EMACS_INT ignore;
6684 int next_face_id;
6685 struct text_pos pos = it->current.pos;
6686 INC_TEXT_POS (pos, it->multibyte_p);
6688 next_face_id = face_at_buffer_position
6689 (it->w, CHARPOS (pos), it->region_beg_charpos,
6690 it->region_end_charpos, &ignore,
6691 (IT_CHARPOS (*it) + TEXT_PROP_DISTANCE_LIMIT), 0,
6692 -1);
6693 it->end_of_box_run_p
6694 = (FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, next_face_id)->box
6695 == FACE_NO_BOX);
6699 else
6701 int face_id = face_after_it_pos (it);
6702 it->end_of_box_run_p
6703 = (face_id != it->face_id
6704 && FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id)->box == FACE_NO_BOX);
6708 /* Value is 0 if end of buffer or string reached. */
6709 return success_p;
6713 /* Move IT to the next display element.
6715 RESEAT_P non-zero means if called on a newline in buffer text,
6716 skip to the next visible line start.
6718 Functions get_next_display_element and set_iterator_to_next are
6719 separate because I find this arrangement easier to handle than a
6720 get_next_display_element function that also increments IT's
6721 position. The way it is we can first look at an iterator's current
6722 display element, decide whether it fits on a line, and if it does,
6723 increment the iterator position. The other way around we probably
6724 would either need a flag indicating whether the iterator has to be
6725 incremented the next time, or we would have to implement a
6726 decrement position function which would not be easy to write. */
6728 void
6729 set_iterator_to_next (struct it *it, int reseat_p)
6731 /* Reset flags indicating start and end of a sequence of characters
6732 with box. Reset them at the start of this function because
6733 moving the iterator to a new position might set them. */
6734 it->start_of_box_run_p = it->end_of_box_run_p = 0;
6736 switch (it->method)
6738 case GET_FROM_BUFFER:
6739 /* The current display element of IT is a character from
6740 current_buffer. Advance in the buffer, and maybe skip over
6741 invisible lines that are so because of selective display. */
6742 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it) && reseat_p)
6743 reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (it, 0);
6744 else if (it->cmp_it.id >= 0)
6746 /* We are currently getting glyphs from a composition. */
6747 int i;
6749 if (! it->bidi_p)
6751 IT_CHARPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nchars;
6752 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nbytes;
6753 if (it->cmp_it.to < it->cmp_it.nglyphs)
6755 it->cmp_it.from = it->cmp_it.to;
6757 else
6759 it->cmp_it.id = -1;
6760 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, IT_CHARPOS (*it),
6761 IT_BYTEPOS (*it),
6762 it->end_charpos, Qnil);
6765 else if (! it->cmp_it.reversed_p)
6767 /* Composition created while scanning forward. */
6768 /* Update IT's char/byte positions to point to the first
6769 character of the next grapheme cluster, or to the
6770 character visually after the current composition. */
6771 for (i = 0; i < it->cmp_it.nchars; i++)
6772 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
6773 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
6774 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
6776 if (it->cmp_it.to < it->cmp_it.nglyphs)
6778 /* Proceed to the next grapheme cluster. */
6779 it->cmp_it.from = it->cmp_it.to;
6781 else
6783 /* No more grapheme clusters in this composition.
6784 Find the next stop position. */
6785 EMACS_INT stop = it->end_charpos;
6786 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
6787 /* Now we are scanning backward and don't know
6788 where to stop. */
6789 stop = -1;
6790 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, IT_CHARPOS (*it),
6791 IT_BYTEPOS (*it), stop, Qnil);
6794 else
6796 /* Composition created while scanning backward. */
6797 /* Update IT's char/byte positions to point to the last
6798 character of the previous grapheme cluster, or the
6799 character visually after the current composition. */
6800 for (i = 0; i < it->cmp_it.nchars; i++)
6801 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
6802 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
6803 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
6804 if (it->cmp_it.from > 0)
6806 /* Proceed to the previous grapheme cluster. */
6807 it->cmp_it.to = it->cmp_it.from;
6809 else
6811 /* No more grapheme clusters in this composition.
6812 Find the next stop position. */
6813 EMACS_INT stop = it->end_charpos;
6814 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
6815 /* Now we are scanning backward and don't know
6816 where to stop. */
6817 stop = -1;
6818 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, IT_CHARPOS (*it),
6819 IT_BYTEPOS (*it), stop, Qnil);
6823 else
6825 xassert (it->len != 0);
6827 if (!it->bidi_p)
6829 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->len;
6830 IT_CHARPOS (*it) += 1;
6832 else
6834 int prev_scan_dir = it->bidi_it.scan_dir;
6835 /* If this is a new paragraph, determine its base
6836 direction (a.k.a. its base embedding level). */
6837 if (it->bidi_it.new_paragraph)
6838 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding, &it->bidi_it, 0);
6839 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
6840 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
6841 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
6842 if (prev_scan_dir != it->bidi_it.scan_dir)
6844 /* As the scan direction was changed, we must
6845 re-compute the stop position for composition. */
6846 EMACS_INT stop = it->end_charpos;
6847 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
6848 stop = -1;
6849 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, IT_CHARPOS (*it),
6850 IT_BYTEPOS (*it), stop, Qnil);
6853 xassert (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) == CHAR_TO_BYTE (IT_CHARPOS (*it)));
6855 break;
6857 case GET_FROM_C_STRING:
6858 /* Current display element of IT is from a C string. */
6859 if (!it->bidi_p
6860 /* If the string position is beyond string's end, it means
6861 next_element_from_c_string is padding the string with
6862 blanks, in which case we bypass the bidi iterator,
6863 because it cannot deal with such virtual characters. */
6864 || IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->bidi_it.string.schars)
6866 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->len;
6867 IT_CHARPOS (*it) += 1;
6869 else
6871 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
6872 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
6873 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
6875 break;
6877 case GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR:
6878 /* Current display element of IT is from a display table entry.
6879 Advance in the display table definition. Reset it to null if
6880 end reached, and continue with characters from buffers/
6881 strings. */
6882 ++it->current.dpvec_index;
6884 /* Restore face of the iterator to what they were before the
6885 display vector entry (these entries may contain faces). */
6886 it->face_id = it->saved_face_id;
6888 if (it->dpvec + it->current.dpvec_index == it->dpend)
6890 int recheck_faces = it->ellipsis_p;
6892 if (it->s)
6893 it->method = GET_FROM_C_STRING;
6894 else if (STRINGP (it->string))
6895 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
6896 else
6898 it->method = GET_FROM_BUFFER;
6899 it->object = it->w->buffer;
6902 it->dpvec = NULL;
6903 it->current.dpvec_index = -1;
6905 /* Skip over characters which were displayed via IT->dpvec. */
6906 if (it->dpvec_char_len < 0)
6907 reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (it, 1);
6908 else if (it->dpvec_char_len > 0)
6910 if (it->method == GET_FROM_STRING
6911 && it->n_overlay_strings > 0)
6912 it->ignore_overlay_strings_at_pos_p = 1;
6913 it->len = it->dpvec_char_len;
6914 set_iterator_to_next (it, reseat_p);
6917 /* Maybe recheck faces after display vector */
6918 if (recheck_faces)
6919 it->stop_charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
6921 break;
6923 case GET_FROM_STRING:
6924 /* Current display element is a character from a Lisp string. */
6925 xassert (it->s == NULL && STRINGP (it->string));
6926 if (it->cmp_it.id >= 0)
6928 int i;
6930 if (! it->bidi_p)
6932 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nchars;
6933 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nbytes;
6934 if (it->cmp_it.to < it->cmp_it.nglyphs)
6935 it->cmp_it.from = it->cmp_it.to;
6936 else
6938 it->cmp_it.id = -1;
6939 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it,
6940 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
6941 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it),
6942 it->end_charpos, it->string);
6945 else if (! it->cmp_it.reversed_p)
6947 for (i = 0; i < it->cmp_it.nchars; i++)
6948 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
6949 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
6950 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
6952 if (it->cmp_it.to < it->cmp_it.nglyphs)
6953 it->cmp_it.from = it->cmp_it.to;
6954 else
6956 EMACS_INT stop = it->end_charpos;
6957 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
6958 stop = -1;
6959 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it,
6960 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
6961 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it), stop,
6962 it->string);
6965 else
6967 for (i = 0; i < it->cmp_it.nchars; i++)
6968 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
6969 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
6970 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
6971 if (it->cmp_it.from > 0)
6972 it->cmp_it.to = it->cmp_it.from;
6973 else
6975 EMACS_INT stop = it->end_charpos;
6976 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
6977 stop = -1;
6978 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it,
6979 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
6980 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it), stop,
6981 it->string);
6985 else
6987 if (!it->bidi_p
6988 /* If the string position is beyond string's end, it
6989 means next_element_from_string is padding the string
6990 with blanks, in which case we bypass the bidi
6991 iterator, because it cannot deal with such virtual
6992 characters. */
6993 || IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->bidi_it.string.schars)
6995 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->len;
6996 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) += 1;
6998 else
7000 int prev_scan_dir = it->bidi_it.scan_dir;
7002 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7003 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7004 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7005 if (prev_scan_dir != it->bidi_it.scan_dir)
7007 EMACS_INT stop = it->end_charpos;
7009 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
7010 stop = -1;
7011 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it,
7012 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
7013 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it), stop,
7014 it->string);
7019 consider_string_end:
7021 if (it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0)
7023 /* IT->string is an overlay string. Advance to the
7024 next, if there is one. */
7025 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= SCHARS (it->string))
7027 it->ellipsis_p = 0;
7028 next_overlay_string (it);
7029 if (it->ellipsis_p)
7030 setup_for_ellipsis (it, 0);
7033 else
7035 /* IT->string is not an overlay string. If we reached
7036 its end, and there is something on IT->stack, proceed
7037 with what is on the stack. This can be either another
7038 string, this time an overlay string, or a buffer. */
7039 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) == SCHARS (it->string)
7040 && it->sp > 0)
7042 pop_it (it);
7043 if (it->method == GET_FROM_STRING)
7044 goto consider_string_end;
7047 break;
7049 case GET_FROM_IMAGE:
7050 case GET_FROM_STRETCH:
7051 /* The position etc with which we have to proceed are on
7052 the stack. The position may be at the end of a string,
7053 if the `display' property takes up the whole string. */
7054 xassert (it->sp > 0);
7055 pop_it (it);
7056 if (it->method == GET_FROM_STRING)
7057 goto consider_string_end;
7058 break;
7060 default:
7061 /* There are no other methods defined, so this should be a bug. */
7062 abort ();
7065 xassert (it->method != GET_FROM_STRING
7066 || (STRINGP (it->string)
7067 && IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= 0));
7070 /* Load IT's display element fields with information about the next
7071 display element which comes from a display table entry or from the
7072 result of translating a control character to one of the forms `^C'
7073 or `\003'.
7075 IT->dpvec holds the glyphs to return as characters.
7076 IT->saved_face_id holds the face id before the display vector--it
7077 is restored into IT->face_id in set_iterator_to_next. */
7079 static int
7080 next_element_from_display_vector (struct it *it)
7082 Lisp_Object gc;
7084 /* Precondition. */
7085 xassert (it->dpvec && it->current.dpvec_index >= 0);
7087 it->face_id = it->saved_face_id;
7089 /* KFS: This code used to check ip->dpvec[0] instead of the current element.
7090 That seemed totally bogus - so I changed it... */
7091 gc = it->dpvec[it->current.dpvec_index];
7093 if (GLYPH_CODE_P (gc) && GLYPH_CODE_CHAR_VALID_P (gc))
7095 it->c = GLYPH_CODE_CHAR (gc);
7096 it->len = CHAR_BYTES (it->c);
7098 /* The entry may contain a face id to use. Such a face id is
7099 the id of a Lisp face, not a realized face. A face id of
7100 zero means no face is specified. */
7101 if (it->dpvec_face_id >= 0)
7102 it->face_id = it->dpvec_face_id;
7103 else
7105 EMACS_INT lface_id = GLYPH_CODE_FACE (gc);
7106 if (lface_id > 0)
7107 it->face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qt, lface_id,
7108 it->saved_face_id);
7111 else
7112 /* Display table entry is invalid. Return a space. */
7113 it->c = ' ', it->len = 1;
7115 /* Don't change position and object of the iterator here. They are
7116 still the values of the character that had this display table
7117 entry or was translated, and that's what we want. */
7118 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
7119 return 1;
7122 /* Get the first element of string/buffer in the visual order, after
7123 being reseated to a new position in a string or a buffer. */
7124 static void
7125 get_visually_first_element (struct it *it)
7127 int string_p = STRINGP (it->string) || it->s;
7128 EMACS_INT eob = (string_p ? it->bidi_it.string.schars : ZV);
7129 EMACS_INT bob = (string_p ? 0 : BEGV);
7131 if (STRINGP (it->string))
7133 it->bidi_it.charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
7134 it->bidi_it.bytepos = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it);
7136 else
7138 it->bidi_it.charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
7139 it->bidi_it.bytepos = IT_BYTEPOS (*it);
7142 if (it->bidi_it.charpos == eob)
7144 /* Nothing to do, but reset the FIRST_ELT flag, like
7145 bidi_paragraph_init does, because we are not going to
7146 call it. */
7147 it->bidi_it.first_elt = 0;
7149 else if (it->bidi_it.charpos == bob
7150 || (!string_p
7151 && (FETCH_CHAR (it->bidi_it.bytepos - 1) == '\n'
7152 || FETCH_CHAR (it->bidi_it.bytepos) == '\n')))
7154 /* If we are at the beginning of a line/string, we can produce
7155 the next element right away. */
7156 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding, &it->bidi_it, 1);
7157 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7159 else
7161 EMACS_INT orig_bytepos = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7163 /* We need to prime the bidi iterator starting at the line's or
7164 string's beginning, before we will be able to produce the
7165 next element. */
7166 if (string_p)
7167 it->bidi_it.charpos = it->bidi_it.bytepos = 0;
7168 else
7170 it->bidi_it.charpos = find_next_newline_no_quit (IT_CHARPOS (*it),
7171 -1);
7172 it->bidi_it.bytepos = CHAR_TO_BYTE (it->bidi_it.charpos);
7174 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding, &it->bidi_it, 1);
7177 /* Now return to buffer/string position where we were asked
7178 to get the next display element, and produce that. */
7179 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7181 while (it->bidi_it.bytepos != orig_bytepos
7182 && it->bidi_it.charpos < eob);
7185 /* Adjust IT's position information to where we ended up. */
7186 if (STRINGP (it->string))
7188 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7189 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7191 else
7193 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7194 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7197 if (STRINGP (it->string) || !it->s)
7199 EMACS_INT stop, charpos, bytepos;
7201 if (STRINGP (it->string))
7203 xassert (!it->s);
7204 stop = SCHARS (it->string);
7205 if (stop > it->end_charpos)
7206 stop = it->end_charpos;
7207 charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
7208 bytepos = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it);
7210 else
7212 stop = it->end_charpos;
7213 charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
7214 bytepos = IT_BYTEPOS (*it);
7216 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
7217 stop = -1;
7218 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, charpos, bytepos, stop,
7219 it->string);
7223 /* Load IT with the next display element from Lisp string IT->string.
7224 IT->current.string_pos is the current position within the string.
7225 If IT->current.overlay_string_index >= 0, the Lisp string is an
7226 overlay string. */
7228 static int
7229 next_element_from_string (struct it *it)
7231 struct text_pos position;
7233 xassert (STRINGP (it->string));
7234 xassert (!it->bidi_p || EQ (it->string, it->bidi_it.string.lstring));
7235 xassert (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= 0);
7236 position = it->current.string_pos;
7238 /* With bidi reordering, the character to display might not be the
7239 character at IT_STRING_CHARPOS. BIDI_IT.FIRST_ELT non-zero means
7240 that we were reseat()ed to a new string, whose paragraph
7241 direction is not known. */
7242 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.first_elt)
7244 get_visually_first_element (it);
7245 SET_TEXT_POS (position, IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it), IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it));
7248 /* Time to check for invisible text? */
7249 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) < it->end_charpos)
7251 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->stop_charpos)
7253 if (!(!it->bidi_p
7254 || BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it)
7255 || IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) == it->stop_charpos))
7257 /* With bidi non-linear iteration, we could find
7258 ourselves far beyond the last computed stop_charpos,
7259 with several other stop positions in between that we
7260 missed. Scan them all now, in buffer's logical
7261 order, until we find and handle the last stop_charpos
7262 that precedes our current position. */
7263 handle_stop_backwards (it, it->stop_charpos);
7264 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7266 else
7268 if (it->bidi_p)
7270 /* Take note of the stop position we just moved
7271 across, for when we will move back across it. */
7272 it->prev_stop = it->stop_charpos;
7273 /* If we are at base paragraph embedding level, take
7274 note of the last stop position seen at this
7275 level. */
7276 if (BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it))
7277 it->base_level_stop = it->stop_charpos;
7279 handle_stop (it);
7281 /* Since a handler may have changed IT->method, we must
7282 recurse here. */
7283 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7286 else if (it->bidi_p
7287 /* If we are before prev_stop, we may have overstepped
7288 on our way backwards a stop_pos, and if so, we need
7289 to handle that stop_pos. */
7290 && IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) < it->prev_stop
7291 /* We can sometimes back up for reasons that have nothing
7292 to do with bidi reordering. E.g., compositions. The
7293 code below is only needed when we are above the base
7294 embedding level, so test for that explicitly. */
7295 && !BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it))
7297 /* If we lost track of base_level_stop, we have no better
7298 place for handle_stop_backwards to start from than string
7299 beginning. This happens, e.g., when we were reseated to
7300 the previous screenful of text by vertical-motion. */
7301 if (it->base_level_stop <= 0
7302 || IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) < it->base_level_stop)
7303 it->base_level_stop = 0;
7304 handle_stop_backwards (it, it->base_level_stop);
7305 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7309 if (it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0)
7311 /* Get the next character from an overlay string. In overlay
7312 strings, There is no field width or padding with spaces to
7313 do. */
7314 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= SCHARS (it->string))
7316 it->what = IT_EOB;
7317 return 0;
7319 else if (CHAR_COMPOSED_P (it, IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
7320 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it),
7321 it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0
7322 ? -1
7323 : SCHARS (it->string))
7324 && next_element_from_composition (it))
7326 return 1;
7328 else if (STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string))
7330 const unsigned char *s = (SDATA (it->string)
7331 + IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it));
7332 it->c = string_char_and_length (s, &it->len);
7334 else
7336 it->c = SREF (it->string, IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it));
7337 it->len = 1;
7340 else
7342 /* Get the next character from a Lisp string that is not an
7343 overlay string. Such strings come from the mode line, for
7344 example. We may have to pad with spaces, or truncate the
7345 string. See also next_element_from_c_string. */
7346 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->end_charpos)
7348 it->what = IT_EOB;
7349 return 0;
7351 else if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->string_nchars)
7353 /* Pad with spaces. */
7354 it->c = ' ', it->len = 1;
7355 CHARPOS (position) = BYTEPOS (position) = -1;
7357 else if (CHAR_COMPOSED_P (it, IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
7358 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it),
7359 it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0
7360 ? -1
7361 : it->string_nchars)
7362 && next_element_from_composition (it))
7364 return 1;
7366 else if (STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string))
7368 const unsigned char *s = (SDATA (it->string)
7369 + IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it));
7370 it->c = string_char_and_length (s, &it->len);
7372 else
7374 it->c = SREF (it->string, IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it));
7375 it->len = 1;
7379 /* Record what we have and where it came from. */
7380 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
7381 it->object = it->string;
7382 it->position = position;
7383 return 1;
7387 /* Load IT with next display element from C string IT->s.
7388 IT->string_nchars is the maximum number of characters to return
7389 from the string. IT->end_charpos may be greater than
7390 IT->string_nchars when this function is called, in which case we
7391 may have to return padding spaces. Value is zero if end of string
7392 reached, including padding spaces. */
7394 static int
7395 next_element_from_c_string (struct it *it)
7397 int success_p = 1;
7399 xassert (it->s);
7400 xassert (!it->bidi_p || it->s == it->bidi_it.string.s);
7401 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
7402 BYTEPOS (it->position) = CHARPOS (it->position) = 0;
7403 it->object = Qnil;
7405 /* With bidi reordering, the character to display might not be the
7406 character at IT_CHARPOS. BIDI_IT.FIRST_ELT non-zero means that
7407 we were reseated to a new string, whose paragraph direction is
7408 not known. */
7409 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.first_elt)
7410 get_visually_first_element (it);
7412 /* IT's position can be greater than IT->string_nchars in case a
7413 field width or precision has been specified when the iterator was
7414 initialized. */
7415 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->end_charpos)
7417 /* End of the game. */
7418 it->what = IT_EOB;
7419 success_p = 0;
7421 else if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->string_nchars)
7423 /* Pad with spaces. */
7424 it->c = ' ', it->len = 1;
7425 BYTEPOS (it->position) = CHARPOS (it->position) = -1;
7427 else if (it->multibyte_p)
7428 it->c = string_char_and_length (it->s + IT_BYTEPOS (*it), &it->len);
7429 else
7430 it->c = it->s[IT_BYTEPOS (*it)], it->len = 1;
7432 return success_p;
7436 /* Set up IT to return characters from an ellipsis, if appropriate.
7437 The definition of the ellipsis glyphs may come from a display table
7438 entry. This function fills IT with the first glyph from the
7439 ellipsis if an ellipsis is to be displayed. */
7441 static int
7442 next_element_from_ellipsis (struct it *it)
7444 if (it->selective_display_ellipsis_p)
7445 setup_for_ellipsis (it, it->len);
7446 else
7448 /* The face at the current position may be different from the
7449 face we find after the invisible text. Remember what it
7450 was in IT->saved_face_id, and signal that it's there by
7451 setting face_before_selective_p. */
7452 it->saved_face_id = it->face_id;
7453 it->method = GET_FROM_BUFFER;
7454 it->object = it->w->buffer;
7455 reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (it, 1);
7456 it->face_before_selective_p = 1;
7459 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7463 /* Deliver an image display element. The iterator IT is already
7464 filled with image information (done in handle_display_prop). Value
7465 is always 1. */
7468 static int
7469 next_element_from_image (struct it *it)
7471 it->what = IT_IMAGE;
7472 it->ignore_overlay_strings_at_pos_p = 0;
7473 return 1;
7477 /* Fill iterator IT with next display element from a stretch glyph
7478 property. IT->object is the value of the text property. Value is
7479 always 1. */
7481 static int
7482 next_element_from_stretch (struct it *it)
7484 it->what = IT_STRETCH;
7485 return 1;
7488 /* Scan backwards from IT's current position until we find a stop
7489 position, or until BEGV. This is called when we find ourself
7490 before both the last known prev_stop and base_level_stop while
7491 reordering bidirectional text. */
7493 static void
7494 compute_stop_pos_backwards (struct it *it)
7496 const int SCAN_BACK_LIMIT = 1000;
7497 struct text_pos pos;
7498 struct display_pos save_current = it->current;
7499 struct text_pos save_position = it->position;
7500 EMACS_INT charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
7501 EMACS_INT where_we_are = charpos;
7502 EMACS_INT save_stop_pos = it->stop_charpos;
7503 EMACS_INT save_end_pos = it->end_charpos;
7505 xassert (NILP (it->string) && !it->s);
7506 xassert (it->bidi_p);
7507 it->bidi_p = 0;
7510 it->end_charpos = min (charpos + 1, ZV);
7511 charpos = max (charpos - SCAN_BACK_LIMIT, BEGV);
7512 SET_TEXT_POS (pos, charpos, BYTE_TO_CHAR (charpos));
7513 reseat_1 (it, pos, 0);
7514 compute_stop_pos (it);
7515 /* We must advance forward, right? */
7516 if (it->stop_charpos <= charpos)
7517 abort ();
7519 while (charpos > BEGV && it->stop_charpos >= it->end_charpos);
7521 if (it->stop_charpos <= where_we_are)
7522 it->prev_stop = it->stop_charpos;
7523 else
7524 it->prev_stop = BEGV;
7525 it->bidi_p = 1;
7526 it->current = save_current;
7527 it->position = save_position;
7528 it->stop_charpos = save_stop_pos;
7529 it->end_charpos = save_end_pos;
7532 /* Scan forward from CHARPOS in the current buffer/string, until we
7533 find a stop position > current IT's position. Then handle the stop
7534 position before that. This is called when we bump into a stop
7535 position while reordering bidirectional text. CHARPOS should be
7536 the last previously processed stop_pos (or BEGV/0, if none were
7537 processed yet) whose position is less that IT's current
7538 position. */
7540 static void
7541 handle_stop_backwards (struct it *it, EMACS_INT charpos)
7543 int bufp = !STRINGP (it->string);
7544 EMACS_INT where_we_are = (bufp ? IT_CHARPOS (*it) : IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it));
7545 struct display_pos save_current = it->current;
7546 struct text_pos save_position = it->position;
7547 struct text_pos pos1;
7548 EMACS_INT next_stop;
7550 /* Scan in strict logical order. */
7551 xassert (it->bidi_p);
7552 it->bidi_p = 0;
7555 it->prev_stop = charpos;
7556 if (bufp)
7558 SET_TEXT_POS (pos1, charpos, CHAR_TO_BYTE (charpos));
7559 reseat_1 (it, pos1, 0);
7561 else
7562 it->current.string_pos = string_pos (charpos, it->string);
7563 compute_stop_pos (it);
7564 /* We must advance forward, right? */
7565 if (it->stop_charpos <= it->prev_stop)
7566 abort ();
7567 charpos = it->stop_charpos;
7569 while (charpos <= where_we_are);
7571 it->bidi_p = 1;
7572 it->current = save_current;
7573 it->position = save_position;
7574 next_stop = it->stop_charpos;
7575 it->stop_charpos = it->prev_stop;
7576 handle_stop (it);
7577 it->stop_charpos = next_stop;
7580 /* Load IT with the next display element from current_buffer. Value
7581 is zero if end of buffer reached. IT->stop_charpos is the next
7582 position at which to stop and check for text properties or buffer
7583 end. */
7585 static int
7586 next_element_from_buffer (struct it *it)
7588 int success_p = 1;
7590 xassert (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= BEGV);
7591 xassert (NILP (it->string) && !it->s);
7592 xassert (!it->bidi_p
7593 || (EQ (it->bidi_it.string.lstring, Qnil)
7594 && it->bidi_it.string.s == NULL));
7596 /* With bidi reordering, the character to display might not be the
7597 character at IT_CHARPOS. BIDI_IT.FIRST_ELT non-zero means that
7598 we were reseat()ed to a new buffer position, which is potentially
7599 a different paragraph. */
7600 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.first_elt)
7602 get_visually_first_element (it);
7603 SET_TEXT_POS (it->position, IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
7606 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->stop_charpos)
7608 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->end_charpos)
7610 int overlay_strings_follow_p;
7612 /* End of the game, except when overlay strings follow that
7613 haven't been returned yet. */
7614 if (it->overlay_strings_at_end_processed_p)
7615 overlay_strings_follow_p = 0;
7616 else
7618 it->overlay_strings_at_end_processed_p = 1;
7619 overlay_strings_follow_p = get_overlay_strings (it, 0);
7622 if (overlay_strings_follow_p)
7623 success_p = GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7624 else
7626 it->what = IT_EOB;
7627 it->position = it->current.pos;
7628 success_p = 0;
7631 else if (!(!it->bidi_p
7632 || BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it)
7633 || IT_CHARPOS (*it) == it->stop_charpos))
7635 /* With bidi non-linear iteration, we could find ourselves
7636 far beyond the last computed stop_charpos, with several
7637 other stop positions in between that we missed. Scan
7638 them all now, in buffer's logical order, until we find
7639 and handle the last stop_charpos that precedes our
7640 current position. */
7641 handle_stop_backwards (it, it->stop_charpos);
7642 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7644 else
7646 if (it->bidi_p)
7648 /* Take note of the stop position we just moved across,
7649 for when we will move back across it. */
7650 it->prev_stop = it->stop_charpos;
7651 /* If we are at base paragraph embedding level, take
7652 note of the last stop position seen at this
7653 level. */
7654 if (BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it))
7655 it->base_level_stop = it->stop_charpos;
7657 handle_stop (it);
7658 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7661 else if (it->bidi_p
7662 /* If we are before prev_stop, we may have overstepped on
7663 our way backwards a stop_pos, and if so, we need to
7664 handle that stop_pos. */
7665 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < it->prev_stop
7666 /* We can sometimes back up for reasons that have nothing
7667 to do with bidi reordering. E.g., compositions. The
7668 code below is only needed when we are above the base
7669 embedding level, so test for that explicitly. */
7670 && !BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it))
7672 if (it->base_level_stop <= 0
7673 || IT_CHARPOS (*it) < it->base_level_stop)
7675 /* If we lost track of base_level_stop, we need to find
7676 prev_stop by looking backwards. This happens, e.g., when
7677 we were reseated to the previous screenful of text by
7678 vertical-motion. */
7679 it->base_level_stop = BEGV;
7680 compute_stop_pos_backwards (it);
7681 handle_stop_backwards (it, it->prev_stop);
7683 else
7684 handle_stop_backwards (it, it->base_level_stop);
7685 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7687 else
7689 /* No face changes, overlays etc. in sight, so just return a
7690 character from current_buffer. */
7691 unsigned char *p;
7692 EMACS_INT stop;
7694 /* Maybe run the redisplay end trigger hook. Performance note:
7695 This doesn't seem to cost measurable time. */
7696 if (it->redisplay_end_trigger_charpos
7697 && it->glyph_row
7698 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->redisplay_end_trigger_charpos)
7699 run_redisplay_end_trigger_hook (it);
7701 stop = it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0 ? -1 : it->end_charpos;
7702 if (CHAR_COMPOSED_P (it, IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it),
7703 stop)
7704 && next_element_from_composition (it))
7706 return 1;
7709 /* Get the next character, maybe multibyte. */
7710 p = BYTE_POS_ADDR (IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
7711 if (it->multibyte_p && !ASCII_BYTE_P (*p))
7712 it->c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (p, it->len);
7713 else
7714 it->c = *p, it->len = 1;
7716 /* Record what we have and where it came from. */
7717 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
7718 it->object = it->w->buffer;
7719 it->position = it->current.pos;
7721 /* Normally we return the character found above, except when we
7722 really want to return an ellipsis for selective display. */
7723 if (it->selective)
7725 if (it->c == '\n')
7727 /* A value of selective > 0 means hide lines indented more
7728 than that number of columns. */
7729 if (it->selective > 0
7730 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) + 1 < ZV
7731 && indented_beyond_p (IT_CHARPOS (*it) + 1,
7732 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) + 1,
7733 it->selective))
7735 success_p = next_element_from_ellipsis (it);
7736 it->dpvec_char_len = -1;
7739 else if (it->c == '\r' && it->selective == -1)
7741 /* A value of selective == -1 means that everything from the
7742 CR to the end of the line is invisible, with maybe an
7743 ellipsis displayed for it. */
7744 success_p = next_element_from_ellipsis (it);
7745 it->dpvec_char_len = -1;
7750 /* Value is zero if end of buffer reached. */
7751 xassert (!success_p || it->what != IT_CHARACTER || it->len > 0);
7752 return success_p;
7756 /* Run the redisplay end trigger hook for IT. */
7758 static void
7759 run_redisplay_end_trigger_hook (struct it *it)
7761 Lisp_Object args[3];
7763 /* IT->glyph_row should be non-null, i.e. we should be actually
7764 displaying something, or otherwise we should not run the hook. */
7765 xassert (it->glyph_row);
7767 /* Set up hook arguments. */
7768 args[0] = Qredisplay_end_trigger_functions;
7769 args[1] = it->window;
7770 XSETINT (args[2], it->redisplay_end_trigger_charpos);
7771 it->redisplay_end_trigger_charpos = 0;
7773 /* Since we are *trying* to run these functions, don't try to run
7774 them again, even if they get an error. */
7775 it->w->redisplay_end_trigger = Qnil;
7776 Frun_hook_with_args (3, args);
7778 /* Notice if it changed the face of the character we are on. */
7779 handle_face_prop (it);
7783 /* Deliver a composition display element. Unlike the other
7784 next_element_from_XXX, this function is not registered in the array
7785 get_next_element[]. It is called from next_element_from_buffer and
7786 next_element_from_string when necessary. */
7788 static int
7789 next_element_from_composition (struct it *it)
7791 it->what = IT_COMPOSITION;
7792 it->len = it->cmp_it.nbytes;
7793 if (STRINGP (it->string))
7795 if (it->c < 0)
7797 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nchars;
7798 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nbytes;
7799 return 0;
7801 it->position = it->current.string_pos;
7802 it->object = it->string;
7803 it->c = composition_update_it (&it->cmp_it, IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
7804 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it), it->string);
7806 else
7808 if (it->c < 0)
7810 IT_CHARPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nchars;
7811 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nbytes;
7812 if (it->bidi_p)
7814 if (it->bidi_it.new_paragraph)
7815 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding, &it->bidi_it, 0);
7816 /* Resync the bidi iterator with IT's new position.
7817 FIXME: this doesn't support bidirectional text. */
7818 while (it->bidi_it.charpos < IT_CHARPOS (*it))
7819 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7821 return 0;
7823 it->position = it->current.pos;
7824 it->object = it->w->buffer;
7825 it->c = composition_update_it (&it->cmp_it, IT_CHARPOS (*it),
7826 IT_BYTEPOS (*it), Qnil);
7828 return 1;
7833 /***********************************************************************
7834 Moving an iterator without producing glyphs
7835 ***********************************************************************/
7837 /* Check if iterator is at a position corresponding to a valid buffer
7838 position after some move_it_ call. */
7840 #define IT_POS_VALID_AFTER_MOVE_P(it) \
7841 ((it)->method == GET_FROM_STRING \
7842 ? IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) == 0 \
7843 : 1)
7846 /* Move iterator IT to a specified buffer or X position within one
7847 line on the display without producing glyphs.
7849 OP should be a bit mask including some or all of these bits:
7850 MOVE_TO_X: Stop upon reaching x-position TO_X.
7851 MOVE_TO_POS: Stop upon reaching buffer or string position TO_CHARPOS.
7852 Regardless of OP's value, stop upon reaching the end of the display line.
7854 TO_X is normally a value 0 <= TO_X <= IT->last_visible_x.
7855 This means, in particular, that TO_X includes window's horizontal
7856 scroll amount.
7858 The return value has several possible values that
7859 say what condition caused the scan to stop:
7861 MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV
7862 - when TO_POS or ZV was reached.
7864 MOVE_X_REACHED
7865 -when TO_X was reached before TO_POS or ZV were reached.
7867 MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED
7868 - when we reached the end of the display area and the line must
7869 be continued.
7871 MOVE_LINE_TRUNCATED
7872 - when we reached the end of the display area and the line is
7873 truncated.
7875 MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR
7876 - when we stopped at a line end, i.e. a newline or a CR and selective
7877 display is on. */
7879 static enum move_it_result
7880 move_it_in_display_line_to (struct it *it,
7881 EMACS_INT to_charpos, int to_x,
7882 enum move_operation_enum op)
7884 enum move_it_result result = MOVE_UNDEFINED;
7885 struct glyph_row *saved_glyph_row;
7886 struct it wrap_it, atpos_it, atx_it, ppos_it;
7887 void *wrap_data = NULL, *atpos_data = NULL, *atx_data = NULL;
7888 void *ppos_data = NULL;
7889 int may_wrap = 0;
7890 enum it_method prev_method = it->method;
7891 EMACS_INT prev_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
7892 int saw_smaller_pos = prev_pos < to_charpos;
7894 /* Don't produce glyphs in produce_glyphs. */
7895 saved_glyph_row = it->glyph_row;
7896 it->glyph_row = NULL;
7898 /* Use wrap_it to save a copy of IT wherever a word wrap could
7899 occur. Use atpos_it to save a copy of IT at the desired buffer
7900 position, if found, so that we can scan ahead and check if the
7901 word later overshoots the window edge. Use atx_it similarly, for
7902 pixel positions. */
7903 wrap_it.sp = -1;
7904 atpos_it.sp = -1;
7905 atx_it.sp = -1;
7907 /* Use ppos_it under bidi reordering to save a copy of IT for the
7908 position > CHARPOS that is the closest to CHARPOS. We restore
7909 that position in IT when we have scanned the entire display line
7910 without finding a match for CHARPOS and all the character
7911 positions are greater than CHARPOS. */
7912 if (it->bidi_p)
7914 SAVE_IT (ppos_it, *it, ppos_data);
7915 SET_TEXT_POS (ppos_it.current.pos, ZV, ZV_BYTE);
7916 if ((op & MOVE_TO_POS) && IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= to_charpos)
7917 SAVE_IT (ppos_it, *it, ppos_data);
7920 #define BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P() \
7921 ((op & MOVE_TO_POS) != 0 \
7922 && BUFFERP (it->object) \
7923 && (IT_CHARPOS (*it) == to_charpos \
7924 || ((!it->bidi_p \
7925 || BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it)) \
7926 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos) \
7927 || (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION \
7928 && ((IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos \
7929 && to_charpos >= it->cmp_it.charpos) \
7930 || (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < to_charpos \
7931 && to_charpos <= it->cmp_it.charpos)))) \
7932 && (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER \
7933 || (it->method == GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR \
7934 && it->dpvec + it->current.dpvec_index + 1 >= it->dpend)))
7936 /* If there's a line-/wrap-prefix, handle it. */
7937 if (it->hpos == 0 && it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER
7938 && it->current_y < it->last_visible_y)
7939 handle_line_prefix (it);
7941 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < CHARPOS (this_line_min_pos))
7942 SET_TEXT_POS (this_line_min_pos, IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
7944 while (1)
7946 int x, i, ascent = 0, descent = 0;
7948 /* Utility macro to reset an iterator with x, ascent, and descent. */
7949 #define IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT(IT) \
7950 ((IT)->current_x = x, (IT)->max_ascent = ascent, \
7951 (IT)->max_descent = descent)
7953 /* Stop if we move beyond TO_CHARPOS (after an image or a
7954 display string or stretch glyph). */
7955 if ((op & MOVE_TO_POS) != 0
7956 && BUFFERP (it->object)
7957 && it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER
7958 && (((!it->bidi_p
7959 /* When the iterator is at base embedding level, we
7960 are guaranteed that characters are delivered for
7961 display in strictly increasing order of their
7962 buffer positions. */
7963 || BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it))
7964 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos)
7965 || (it->bidi_p
7966 && (prev_method == GET_FROM_IMAGE
7967 || prev_method == GET_FROM_STRETCH
7968 || prev_method == GET_FROM_STRING)
7969 /* Passed TO_CHARPOS from left to right. */
7970 && ((prev_pos < to_charpos
7971 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos)
7972 /* Passed TO_CHARPOS from right to left. */
7973 || (prev_pos > to_charpos
7974 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < to_charpos)))))
7976 if (it->line_wrap != WORD_WRAP || wrap_it.sp < 0)
7978 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
7979 break;
7981 else if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP && atpos_it.sp < 0)
7982 /* If wrap_it is valid, the current position might be in a
7983 word that is wrapped. So, save the iterator in
7984 atpos_it and continue to see if wrapping happens. */
7985 SAVE_IT (atpos_it, *it, atpos_data);
7988 /* Stop when ZV reached.
7989 We used to stop here when TO_CHARPOS reached as well, but that is
7990 too soon if this glyph does not fit on this line. So we handle it
7991 explicitly below. */
7992 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
7994 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
7995 break;
7998 if (it->line_wrap == TRUNCATE)
8000 if (BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ())
8002 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8003 break;
8006 else
8008 if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP)
8010 if (IT_DISPLAYING_WHITESPACE (it))
8011 may_wrap = 1;
8012 else if (may_wrap)
8014 /* We have reached a glyph that follows one or more
8015 whitespace characters. If the position is
8016 already found, we are done. */
8017 if (atpos_it.sp >= 0)
8019 RESTORE_IT (it, &atpos_it, atpos_data);
8020 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8021 goto done;
8023 if (atx_it.sp >= 0)
8025 RESTORE_IT (it, &atx_it, atx_data);
8026 result = MOVE_X_REACHED;
8027 goto done;
8029 /* Otherwise, we can wrap here. */
8030 SAVE_IT (wrap_it, *it, wrap_data);
8031 may_wrap = 0;
8036 /* Remember the line height for the current line, in case
8037 the next element doesn't fit on the line. */
8038 ascent = it->max_ascent;
8039 descent = it->max_descent;
8041 /* The call to produce_glyphs will get the metrics of the
8042 display element IT is loaded with. Record the x-position
8043 before this display element, in case it doesn't fit on the
8044 line. */
8045 x = it->current_x;
8047 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
8049 if (it->area != TEXT_AREA)
8051 prev_method = it->method;
8052 if (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER)
8053 prev_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
8054 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
8055 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < CHARPOS (this_line_min_pos))
8056 SET_TEXT_POS (this_line_min_pos,
8057 IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
8058 if (it->bidi_p
8059 && (op & MOVE_TO_POS)
8060 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos
8061 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < IT_CHARPOS (ppos_it))
8062 SAVE_IT (ppos_it, *it, ppos_data);
8063 continue;
8066 /* The number of glyphs we get back in IT->nglyphs will normally
8067 be 1 except when IT->c is (i) a TAB, or (ii) a multi-glyph
8068 character on a terminal frame, or (iii) a line end. For the
8069 second case, IT->nglyphs - 1 padding glyphs will be present.
8070 (On X frames, there is only one glyph produced for a
8071 composite character.)
8073 The behavior implemented below means, for continuation lines,
8074 that as many spaces of a TAB as fit on the current line are
8075 displayed there. For terminal frames, as many glyphs of a
8076 multi-glyph character are displayed in the current line, too.
8077 This is what the old redisplay code did, and we keep it that
8078 way. Under X, the whole shape of a complex character must
8079 fit on the line or it will be completely displayed in the
8080 next line.
8082 Note that both for tabs and padding glyphs, all glyphs have
8083 the same width. */
8084 if (it->nglyphs)
8086 /* More than one glyph or glyph doesn't fit on line. All
8087 glyphs have the same width. */
8088 int single_glyph_width = it->pixel_width / it->nglyphs;
8089 int new_x;
8090 int x_before_this_char = x;
8091 int hpos_before_this_char = it->hpos;
8093 for (i = 0; i < it->nglyphs; ++i, x = new_x)
8095 new_x = x + single_glyph_width;
8097 /* We want to leave anything reaching TO_X to the caller. */
8098 if ((op & MOVE_TO_X) && new_x > to_x)
8100 if (BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ())
8102 if (it->line_wrap != WORD_WRAP || wrap_it.sp < 0)
8103 goto buffer_pos_reached;
8104 if (atpos_it.sp < 0)
8106 SAVE_IT (atpos_it, *it, atpos_data);
8107 IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT (&atpos_it);
8110 else
8112 if (it->line_wrap != WORD_WRAP || wrap_it.sp < 0)
8114 it->current_x = x;
8115 result = MOVE_X_REACHED;
8116 break;
8118 if (atx_it.sp < 0)
8120 SAVE_IT (atx_it, *it, atx_data);
8121 IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT (&atx_it);
8126 if (/* Lines are continued. */
8127 it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE
8128 && (/* And glyph doesn't fit on the line. */
8129 new_x > it->last_visible_x
8130 /* Or it fits exactly and we're on a window
8131 system frame. */
8132 || (new_x == it->last_visible_x
8133 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))))
8135 if (/* IT->hpos == 0 means the very first glyph
8136 doesn't fit on the line, e.g. a wide image. */
8137 it->hpos == 0
8138 || (new_x == it->last_visible_x
8139 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)))
8141 ++it->hpos;
8142 it->current_x = new_x;
8144 /* The character's last glyph just barely fits
8145 in this row. */
8146 if (i == it->nglyphs - 1)
8148 /* If this is the destination position,
8149 return a position *before* it in this row,
8150 now that we know it fits in this row. */
8151 if (BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ())
8153 if (it->line_wrap != WORD_WRAP
8154 || wrap_it.sp < 0)
8156 it->hpos = hpos_before_this_char;
8157 it->current_x = x_before_this_char;
8158 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8159 break;
8161 if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP
8162 && atpos_it.sp < 0)
8164 SAVE_IT (atpos_it, *it, atpos_data);
8165 atpos_it.current_x = x_before_this_char;
8166 atpos_it.hpos = hpos_before_this_char;
8170 prev_method = it->method;
8171 if (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER)
8172 prev_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
8173 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
8174 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < CHARPOS (this_line_min_pos))
8175 SET_TEXT_POS (this_line_min_pos,
8176 IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
8177 /* On graphical terminals, newlines may
8178 "overflow" into the fringe if
8179 overflow-newline-into-fringe is non-nil.
8180 On text-only terminals, newlines may
8181 overflow into the last glyph on the
8182 display line.*/
8183 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
8184 || IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE (it))
8186 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
8188 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8189 break;
8191 if (BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ())
8193 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
8194 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8195 else
8196 result = MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED;
8197 break;
8199 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
8201 result = MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR;
8202 break;
8207 else
8208 IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT (it);
8210 if (wrap_it.sp >= 0)
8212 RESTORE_IT (it, &wrap_it, wrap_data);
8213 atpos_it.sp = -1;
8214 atx_it.sp = -1;
8217 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it_in: continued at %d\n",
8218 IT_CHARPOS (*it)));
8219 result = MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED;
8220 break;
8223 if (BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ())
8225 if (it->line_wrap != WORD_WRAP || wrap_it.sp < 0)
8226 goto buffer_pos_reached;
8227 if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP && atpos_it.sp < 0)
8229 SAVE_IT (atpos_it, *it, atpos_data);
8230 IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT (&atpos_it);
8234 if (new_x > it->first_visible_x)
8236 /* Glyph is visible. Increment number of glyphs that
8237 would be displayed. */
8238 ++it->hpos;
8242 if (result != MOVE_UNDEFINED)
8243 break;
8245 else if (BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ())
8247 buffer_pos_reached:
8248 IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT (it);
8249 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8250 break;
8252 else if ((op & MOVE_TO_X) && it->current_x >= to_x)
8254 /* Stop when TO_X specified and reached. This check is
8255 necessary here because of lines consisting of a line end,
8256 only. The line end will not produce any glyphs and we
8257 would never get MOVE_X_REACHED. */
8258 xassert (it->nglyphs == 0);
8259 result = MOVE_X_REACHED;
8260 break;
8263 /* Is this a line end? If yes, we're done. */
8264 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
8266 /* If we are past TO_CHARPOS, but never saw any character
8267 positions smaller than TO_CHARPOS, return
8268 MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV, like the unidirectional display
8269 did. */
8270 if (it->bidi_p && (op & MOVE_TO_POS) != 0)
8272 if (!saw_smaller_pos && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos)
8274 if (IT_CHARPOS (ppos_it) < ZV)
8276 RESTORE_IT (it, &ppos_it, ppos_data);
8277 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8279 else
8280 goto buffer_pos_reached;
8282 else if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP && atpos_it.sp >= 0
8283 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos)
8284 goto buffer_pos_reached;
8285 else
8286 result = MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR;
8288 else
8289 result = MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR;
8290 break;
8293 prev_method = it->method;
8294 if (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER)
8295 prev_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
8296 /* The current display element has been consumed. Advance
8297 to the next. */
8298 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
8299 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < CHARPOS (this_line_min_pos))
8300 SET_TEXT_POS (this_line_min_pos, IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
8301 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < to_charpos)
8302 saw_smaller_pos = 1;
8303 if (it->bidi_p
8304 && (op & MOVE_TO_POS)
8305 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= to_charpos
8306 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < IT_CHARPOS (ppos_it))
8307 SAVE_IT (ppos_it, *it, ppos_data);
8309 /* Stop if lines are truncated and IT's current x-position is
8310 past the right edge of the window now. */
8311 if (it->line_wrap == TRUNCATE
8312 && it->current_x >= it->last_visible_x)
8314 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
8315 || IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE (it))
8317 int at_eob_p = 0;
8319 if ((at_eob_p = !get_next_display_element (it))
8320 || BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ()
8321 /* If we are past TO_CHARPOS, but never saw any
8322 character positions smaller than TO_CHARPOS,
8323 return MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV, like the
8324 unidirectional display did. */
8325 || (it->bidi_p && (op & MOVE_TO_POS) != 0
8326 && !saw_smaller_pos
8327 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos))
8329 if (it->bidi_p
8330 && !at_eob_p && IT_CHARPOS (ppos_it) < ZV)
8331 RESTORE_IT (it, &ppos_it, ppos_data);
8332 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8333 break;
8335 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
8337 result = MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR;
8338 break;
8341 else if (it->bidi_p && (op & MOVE_TO_POS) != 0
8342 && !saw_smaller_pos
8343 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos)
8345 if (IT_CHARPOS (ppos_it) < ZV)
8346 RESTORE_IT (it, &ppos_it, ppos_data);
8347 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8348 break;
8350 result = MOVE_LINE_TRUNCATED;
8351 break;
8353 #undef IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT
8356 #undef BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P
8358 /* If we scanned beyond to_pos and didn't find a point to wrap at,
8359 restore the saved iterator. */
8360 if (atpos_it.sp >= 0)
8361 RESTORE_IT (it, &atpos_it, atpos_data);
8362 else if (atx_it.sp >= 0)
8363 RESTORE_IT (it, &atx_it, atx_data);
8365 done:
8367 if (atpos_data)
8368 bidi_unshelve_cache (atpos_data, 1);
8369 if (atx_data)
8370 bidi_unshelve_cache (atx_data, 1);
8371 if (wrap_data)
8372 bidi_unshelve_cache (wrap_data, 1);
8373 if (ppos_data)
8374 bidi_unshelve_cache (ppos_data, 1);
8376 /* Restore the iterator settings altered at the beginning of this
8377 function. */
8378 it->glyph_row = saved_glyph_row;
8379 return result;
8382 /* For external use. */
8383 void
8384 move_it_in_display_line (struct it *it,
8385 EMACS_INT to_charpos, int to_x,
8386 enum move_operation_enum op)
8388 if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP
8389 && (op & MOVE_TO_X))
8391 struct it save_it;
8392 void *save_data = NULL;
8393 int skip;
8395 SAVE_IT (save_it, *it, save_data);
8396 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, to_charpos, to_x, op);
8397 /* When word-wrap is on, TO_X may lie past the end
8398 of a wrapped line. Then it->current is the
8399 character on the next line, so backtrack to the
8400 space before the wrap point. */
8401 if (skip == MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED)
8403 int prev_x = max (it->current_x - 1, 0);
8404 RESTORE_IT (it, &save_it, save_data);
8405 move_it_in_display_line_to
8406 (it, -1, prev_x, MOVE_TO_X);
8408 else
8409 bidi_unshelve_cache (save_data, 1);
8411 else
8412 move_it_in_display_line_to (it, to_charpos, to_x, op);
8416 /* Move IT forward until it satisfies one or more of the criteria in
8417 TO_CHARPOS, TO_X, TO_Y, and TO_VPOS.
8419 OP is a bit-mask that specifies where to stop, and in particular,
8420 which of those four position arguments makes a difference. See the
8421 description of enum move_operation_enum.
8423 If TO_CHARPOS is in invisible text, e.g. a truncated part of a
8424 screen line, this function will set IT to the next position that is
8425 displayed to the right of TO_CHARPOS on the screen. */
8427 void
8428 move_it_to (struct it *it, EMACS_INT to_charpos, int to_x, int to_y, int to_vpos, int op)
8430 enum move_it_result skip, skip2 = MOVE_X_REACHED;
8431 int line_height, line_start_x = 0, reached = 0;
8432 void *backup_data = NULL;
8434 for (;;)
8436 if (op & MOVE_TO_VPOS)
8438 /* If no TO_CHARPOS and no TO_X specified, stop at the
8439 start of the line TO_VPOS. */
8440 if ((op & (MOVE_TO_X | MOVE_TO_POS)) == 0)
8442 if (it->vpos == to_vpos)
8444 reached = 1;
8445 break;
8447 else
8448 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, -1, -1, 0);
8450 else
8452 /* TO_VPOS >= 0 means stop at TO_X in the line at
8453 TO_VPOS, or at TO_POS, whichever comes first. */
8454 if (it->vpos == to_vpos)
8456 reached = 2;
8457 break;
8460 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, to_charpos, to_x, op);
8462 if (skip == MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV || it->vpos == to_vpos)
8464 reached = 3;
8465 break;
8467 else if (skip == MOVE_X_REACHED && it->vpos != to_vpos)
8469 /* We have reached TO_X but not in the line we want. */
8470 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, to_charpos,
8471 -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
8472 if (skip == MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV)
8474 reached = 4;
8475 break;
8480 else if (op & MOVE_TO_Y)
8482 struct it it_backup;
8484 if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP)
8485 SAVE_IT (it_backup, *it, backup_data);
8487 /* TO_Y specified means stop at TO_X in the line containing
8488 TO_Y---or at TO_CHARPOS if this is reached first. The
8489 problem is that we can't really tell whether the line
8490 contains TO_Y before we have completely scanned it, and
8491 this may skip past TO_X. What we do is to first scan to
8492 TO_X.
8494 If TO_X is not specified, use a TO_X of zero. The reason
8495 is to make the outcome of this function more predictable.
8496 If we didn't use TO_X == 0, we would stop at the end of
8497 the line which is probably not what a caller would expect
8498 to happen. */
8499 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to
8500 (it, to_charpos, ((op & MOVE_TO_X) ? to_x : 0),
8501 (MOVE_TO_X | (op & MOVE_TO_POS)));
8503 /* If TO_CHARPOS is reached or ZV, we don't have to do more. */
8504 if (skip == MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV)
8505 reached = 5;
8506 else if (skip == MOVE_X_REACHED)
8508 /* If TO_X was reached, we want to know whether TO_Y is
8509 in the line. We know this is the case if the already
8510 scanned glyphs make the line tall enough. Otherwise,
8511 we must check by scanning the rest of the line. */
8512 line_height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
8513 if (to_y >= it->current_y
8514 && to_y < it->current_y + line_height)
8516 reached = 6;
8517 break;
8519 SAVE_IT (it_backup, *it, backup_data);
8520 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it: from %d\n", IT_CHARPOS (*it)));
8521 skip2 = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, to_charpos, -1,
8522 op & MOVE_TO_POS);
8523 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it: to %d\n", IT_CHARPOS (*it)));
8524 line_height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
8525 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it: line_height = %d\n", line_height));
8527 if (to_y >= it->current_y
8528 && to_y < it->current_y + line_height)
8530 /* If TO_Y is in this line and TO_X was reached
8531 above, we scanned too far. We have to restore
8532 IT's settings to the ones before skipping. */
8533 RESTORE_IT (it, &it_backup, backup_data);
8534 reached = 6;
8536 else
8538 skip = skip2;
8539 if (skip == MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV)
8540 reached = 7;
8543 else
8545 /* Check whether TO_Y is in this line. */
8546 line_height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
8547 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it: line_height = %d\n", line_height));
8549 if (to_y >= it->current_y
8550 && to_y < it->current_y + line_height)
8552 /* When word-wrap is on, TO_X may lie past the end
8553 of a wrapped line. Then it->current is the
8554 character on the next line, so backtrack to the
8555 space before the wrap point. */
8556 if (skip == MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED
8557 && it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP)
8559 int prev_x = max (it->current_x - 1, 0);
8560 RESTORE_IT (it, &it_backup, backup_data);
8561 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to
8562 (it, -1, prev_x, MOVE_TO_X);
8564 reached = 6;
8568 if (reached)
8569 break;
8571 else if (BUFFERP (it->object)
8572 && (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER
8573 || it->method == GET_FROM_STRETCH)
8574 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= to_charpos
8575 /* Under bidi iteration, a call to set_iterator_to_next
8576 can scan far beyond to_charpos if the initial
8577 portion of the next line needs to be reordered. In
8578 that case, give move_it_in_display_line_to another
8579 chance below. */
8580 && !(it->bidi_p
8581 && it->bidi_it.scan_dir == -1))
8582 skip = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8583 else
8584 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, to_charpos, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
8586 switch (skip)
8588 case MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV:
8589 reached = 8;
8590 goto out;
8592 case MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR:
8593 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
8594 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
8595 break;
8597 case MOVE_LINE_TRUNCATED:
8598 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
8599 reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (it, 0);
8600 if ((op & MOVE_TO_POS) != 0
8601 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos)
8603 reached = 9;
8604 goto out;
8606 break;
8608 case MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED:
8609 /* For continued lines ending in a tab, some of the glyphs
8610 associated with the tab are displayed on the current
8611 line. Since it->current_x does not include these glyphs,
8612 we use it->last_visible_x instead. */
8613 if (it->c == '\t')
8615 it->continuation_lines_width += it->last_visible_x;
8616 /* When moving by vpos, ensure that the iterator really
8617 advances to the next line (bug#847, bug#969). Fixme:
8618 do we need to do this in other circumstances? */
8619 if (it->current_x != it->last_visible_x
8620 && (op & MOVE_TO_VPOS)
8621 && !(op & (MOVE_TO_X | MOVE_TO_POS)))
8623 line_start_x = it->current_x + it->pixel_width
8624 - it->last_visible_x;
8625 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
8628 else
8629 it->continuation_lines_width += it->current_x;
8630 break;
8632 default:
8633 abort ();
8636 /* Reset/increment for the next run. */
8637 recenter_overlay_lists (current_buffer, IT_CHARPOS (*it));
8638 it->current_x = line_start_x;
8639 line_start_x = 0;
8640 it->hpos = 0;
8641 it->current_y += it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
8642 ++it->vpos;
8643 last_height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
8644 last_max_ascent = it->max_ascent;
8645 it->max_ascent = it->max_descent = 0;
8648 out:
8650 /* On text terminals, we may stop at the end of a line in the middle
8651 of a multi-character glyph. If the glyph itself is continued,
8652 i.e. it is actually displayed on the next line, don't treat this
8653 stopping point as valid; move to the next line instead (unless
8654 that brings us offscreen). */
8655 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
8656 && op & MOVE_TO_POS
8657 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) == to_charpos
8658 && it->what == IT_CHARACTER
8659 && it->nglyphs > 1
8660 && it->line_wrap == WINDOW_WRAP
8661 && it->current_x == it->last_visible_x - 1
8662 && it->c != '\n'
8663 && it->c != '\t'
8664 && it->vpos < XFASTINT (it->w->window_end_vpos))
8666 it->continuation_lines_width += it->current_x;
8667 it->current_x = it->hpos = it->max_ascent = it->max_descent = 0;
8668 it->current_y += it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
8669 ++it->vpos;
8670 last_height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
8671 last_max_ascent = it->max_ascent;
8674 if (backup_data)
8675 bidi_unshelve_cache (backup_data, 1);
8677 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it_to: reached %d\n", reached));
8681 /* Move iterator IT backward by a specified y-distance DY, DY >= 0.
8683 If DY > 0, move IT backward at least that many pixels. DY = 0
8684 means move IT backward to the preceding line start or BEGV. This
8685 function may move over more than DY pixels if IT->current_y - DY
8686 ends up in the middle of a line; in this case IT->current_y will be
8687 set to the top of the line moved to. */
8689 void
8690 move_it_vertically_backward (struct it *it, int dy)
8692 int nlines, h;
8693 struct it it2, it3;
8694 void *it2data = NULL, *it3data = NULL;
8695 EMACS_INT start_pos;
8697 move_further_back:
8698 xassert (dy >= 0);
8700 start_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
8702 /* Estimate how many newlines we must move back. */
8703 nlines = max (1, dy / FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it->f));
8705 /* Set the iterator's position that many lines back. */
8706 while (nlines-- && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > BEGV)
8707 back_to_previous_visible_line_start (it);
8709 /* Reseat the iterator here. When moving backward, we don't want
8710 reseat to skip forward over invisible text, set up the iterator
8711 to deliver from overlay strings at the new position etc. So,
8712 use reseat_1 here. */
8713 reseat_1 (it, it->current.pos, 1);
8715 /* We are now surely at a line start. */
8716 it->current_x = it->hpos = 0; /* FIXME: this is incorrect when bidi
8717 reordering is in effect. */
8718 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
8720 /* Move forward and see what y-distance we moved. First move to the
8721 start of the next line so that we get its height. We need this
8722 height to be able to tell whether we reached the specified
8723 y-distance. */
8724 SAVE_IT (it2, *it, it2data);
8725 it2.max_ascent = it2.max_descent = 0;
8728 move_it_to (&it2, start_pos, -1, -1, it2.vpos + 1,
8729 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_VPOS);
8731 while (!(IT_POS_VALID_AFTER_MOVE_P (&it2)
8732 /* If we are in a display string which starts at START_POS,
8733 and that display string includes a newline, and we are
8734 right after that newline (i.e. at the beginning of a
8735 display line), exit the loop, because otherwise we will
8736 infloop, since move_it_to will see that it is already at
8737 START_POS and will not move. */
8738 || (it2.method == GET_FROM_STRING
8739 && IT_CHARPOS (it2) == start_pos
8740 && SREF (it2.string, IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (it2) - 1) == '\n')));
8741 xassert (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= BEGV);
8742 SAVE_IT (it3, it2, it3data);
8744 move_it_to (&it2, start_pos, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
8745 xassert (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= BEGV);
8746 /* H is the actual vertical distance from the position in *IT
8747 and the starting position. */
8748 h = it2.current_y - it->current_y;
8749 /* NLINES is the distance in number of lines. */
8750 nlines = it2.vpos - it->vpos;
8752 /* Correct IT's y and vpos position
8753 so that they are relative to the starting point. */
8754 it->vpos -= nlines;
8755 it->current_y -= h;
8757 if (dy == 0)
8759 /* DY == 0 means move to the start of the screen line. The
8760 value of nlines is > 0 if continuation lines were involved,
8761 or if the original IT position was at start of a line. */
8762 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it2data);
8763 if (nlines > 0)
8764 move_it_by_lines (it, nlines);
8765 /* The above code moves us to some position NLINES down,
8766 usually to its first glyph (leftmost in an L2R line), but
8767 that's not necessarily the start of the line, under bidi
8768 reordering. We want to get to the character position
8769 that is immediately after the newline of the previous
8770 line. */
8771 if (it->bidi_p && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > BEGV
8772 && FETCH_BYTE (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) - 1) != '\n')
8774 EMACS_INT nl_pos =
8775 find_next_newline_no_quit (IT_CHARPOS (*it) - 1, -1);
8777 move_it_to (it, nl_pos, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
8779 bidi_unshelve_cache (it3data, 1);
8781 else
8783 /* The y-position we try to reach, relative to *IT.
8784 Note that H has been subtracted in front of the if-statement. */
8785 int target_y = it->current_y + h - dy;
8786 int y0 = it3.current_y;
8787 int y1;
8788 int line_height;
8790 RESTORE_IT (&it3, &it3, it3data);
8791 y1 = line_bottom_y (&it3);
8792 line_height = y1 - y0;
8793 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it2data);
8794 /* If we did not reach target_y, try to move further backward if
8795 we can. If we moved too far backward, try to move forward. */
8796 if (target_y < it->current_y
8797 /* This is heuristic. In a window that's 3 lines high, with
8798 a line height of 13 pixels each, recentering with point
8799 on the bottom line will try to move -39/2 = 19 pixels
8800 backward. Try to avoid moving into the first line. */
8801 && (it->current_y - target_y
8802 > min (window_box_height (it->w), line_height * 2 / 3))
8803 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > BEGV)
8805 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, " not far enough -> move_vert %d\n",
8806 target_y - it->current_y));
8807 dy = it->current_y - target_y;
8808 goto move_further_back;
8810 else if (target_y >= it->current_y + line_height
8811 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < ZV)
8813 /* Should move forward by at least one line, maybe more.
8815 Note: Calling move_it_by_lines can be expensive on
8816 terminal frames, where compute_motion is used (via
8817 vmotion) to do the job, when there are very long lines
8818 and truncate-lines is nil. That's the reason for
8819 treating terminal frames specially here. */
8821 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
8822 move_it_vertically (it, target_y - (it->current_y + line_height));
8823 else
8827 move_it_by_lines (it, 1);
8829 while (target_y >= line_bottom_y (it) && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < ZV);
8836 /* Move IT by a specified amount of pixel lines DY. DY negative means
8837 move backwards. DY = 0 means move to start of screen line. At the
8838 end, IT will be on the start of a screen line. */
8840 void
8841 move_it_vertically (struct it *it, int dy)
8843 if (dy <= 0)
8844 move_it_vertically_backward (it, -dy);
8845 else
8847 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it_v: from %d, %d\n", IT_CHARPOS (*it), dy));
8848 move_it_to (it, ZV, -1, it->current_y + dy, -1,
8849 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_Y);
8850 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it_v: to %d\n", IT_CHARPOS (*it)));
8852 /* If buffer ends in ZV without a newline, move to the start of
8853 the line to satisfy the post-condition. */
8854 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) == ZV
8855 && ZV > BEGV
8856 && FETCH_BYTE (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) - 1) != '\n')
8857 move_it_by_lines (it, 0);
8862 /* Move iterator IT past the end of the text line it is in. */
8864 void
8865 move_it_past_eol (struct it *it)
8867 enum move_it_result rc;
8869 rc = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, Z, 0, MOVE_TO_POS);
8870 if (rc == MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR)
8871 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
8875 /* Move IT by a specified number DVPOS of screen lines down. DVPOS
8876 negative means move up. DVPOS == 0 means move to the start of the
8877 screen line.
8879 Optimization idea: If we would know that IT->f doesn't use
8880 a face with proportional font, we could be faster for
8881 truncate-lines nil. */
8883 void
8884 move_it_by_lines (struct it *it, int dvpos)
8887 /* The commented-out optimization uses vmotion on terminals. This
8888 gives bad results, because elements like it->what, on which
8889 callers such as pos_visible_p rely, aren't updated. */
8890 /* struct position pos;
8891 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
8893 struct text_pos textpos;
8895 pos = *vmotion (IT_CHARPOS (*it), dvpos, it->w);
8896 SET_TEXT_POS (textpos, pos.bufpos, pos.bytepos);
8897 reseat (it, textpos, 1);
8898 it->vpos += pos.vpos;
8899 it->current_y += pos.vpos;
8901 else */
8903 if (dvpos == 0)
8905 /* DVPOS == 0 means move to the start of the screen line. */
8906 move_it_vertically_backward (it, 0);
8907 xassert (it->current_x == 0 && it->hpos == 0);
8908 /* Let next call to line_bottom_y calculate real line height */
8909 last_height = 0;
8911 else if (dvpos > 0)
8913 move_it_to (it, -1, -1, -1, it->vpos + dvpos, MOVE_TO_VPOS);
8914 if (!IT_POS_VALID_AFTER_MOVE_P (it))
8915 move_it_to (it, IT_CHARPOS (*it) + 1, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
8917 else
8919 struct it it2;
8920 void *it2data = NULL;
8921 EMACS_INT start_charpos, i;
8923 /* Start at the beginning of the screen line containing IT's
8924 position. This may actually move vertically backwards,
8925 in case of overlays, so adjust dvpos accordingly. */
8926 dvpos += it->vpos;
8927 move_it_vertically_backward (it, 0);
8928 dvpos -= it->vpos;
8930 /* Go back -DVPOS visible lines and reseat the iterator there. */
8931 start_charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
8932 for (i = -dvpos; i > 0 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > BEGV; --i)
8933 back_to_previous_visible_line_start (it);
8934 reseat (it, it->current.pos, 1);
8936 /* Move further back if we end up in a string or an image. */
8937 while (!IT_POS_VALID_AFTER_MOVE_P (it))
8939 /* First try to move to start of display line. */
8940 dvpos += it->vpos;
8941 move_it_vertically_backward (it, 0);
8942 dvpos -= it->vpos;
8943 if (IT_POS_VALID_AFTER_MOVE_P (it))
8944 break;
8945 /* If start of line is still in string or image,
8946 move further back. */
8947 back_to_previous_visible_line_start (it);
8948 reseat (it, it->current.pos, 1);
8949 dvpos--;
8952 it->current_x = it->hpos = 0;
8954 /* Above call may have moved too far if continuation lines
8955 are involved. Scan forward and see if it did. */
8956 SAVE_IT (it2, *it, it2data);
8957 it2.vpos = it2.current_y = 0;
8958 move_it_to (&it2, start_charpos, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
8959 it->vpos -= it2.vpos;
8960 it->current_y -= it2.current_y;
8961 it->current_x = it->hpos = 0;
8963 /* If we moved too far back, move IT some lines forward. */
8964 if (it2.vpos > -dvpos)
8966 int delta = it2.vpos + dvpos;
8968 RESTORE_IT (&it2, &it2, it2data);
8969 SAVE_IT (it2, *it, it2data);
8970 move_it_to (it, -1, -1, -1, it->vpos + delta, MOVE_TO_VPOS);
8971 /* Move back again if we got too far ahead. */
8972 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= start_charpos)
8973 RESTORE_IT (it, &it2, it2data);
8974 else
8975 bidi_unshelve_cache (it2data, 1);
8977 else
8978 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it2data);
8982 /* Return 1 if IT points into the middle of a display vector. */
8985 in_display_vector_p (struct it *it)
8987 return (it->method == GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR
8988 && it->current.dpvec_index > 0
8989 && it->dpvec + it->current.dpvec_index != it->dpend);
8993 /***********************************************************************
8994 Messages
8995 ***********************************************************************/
8998 /* Add a message with format string FORMAT and arguments ARG1 and ARG2
8999 to *Messages*. */
9001 void
9002 add_to_log (const char *format, Lisp_Object arg1, Lisp_Object arg2)
9004 Lisp_Object args[3];
9005 Lisp_Object msg, fmt;
9006 char *buffer;
9007 EMACS_INT len;
9008 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2, gcpro3, gcpro4;
9009 USE_SAFE_ALLOCA;
9011 /* Do nothing if called asynchronously. Inserting text into
9012 a buffer may call after-change-functions and alike and
9013 that would means running Lisp asynchronously. */
9014 if (handling_signal)
9015 return;
9017 fmt = msg = Qnil;
9018 GCPRO4 (fmt, msg, arg1, arg2);
9020 args[0] = fmt = build_string (format);
9021 args[1] = arg1;
9022 args[2] = arg2;
9023 msg = Fformat (3, args);
9025 len = SBYTES (msg) + 1;
9026 SAFE_ALLOCA (buffer, char *, len);
9027 memcpy (buffer, SDATA (msg), len);
9029 message_dolog (buffer, len - 1, 1, 0);
9030 SAFE_FREE ();
9032 UNGCPRO;
9036 /* Output a newline in the *Messages* buffer if "needs" one. */
9038 void
9039 message_log_maybe_newline (void)
9041 if (message_log_need_newline)
9042 message_dolog ("", 0, 1, 0);
9046 /* Add a string M of length NBYTES to the message log, optionally
9047 terminated with a newline when NLFLAG is non-zero. MULTIBYTE, if
9048 nonzero, means interpret the contents of M as multibyte. This
9049 function calls low-level routines in order to bypass text property
9050 hooks, etc. which might not be safe to run.
9052 This may GC (insert may run before/after change hooks),
9053 so the buffer M must NOT point to a Lisp string. */
9055 void
9056 message_dolog (const char *m, EMACS_INT nbytes, int nlflag, int multibyte)
9058 const unsigned char *msg = (const unsigned char *) m;
9060 if (!NILP (Vmemory_full))
9061 return;
9063 if (!NILP (Vmessage_log_max))
9065 struct buffer *oldbuf;
9066 Lisp_Object oldpoint, oldbegv, oldzv;
9067 int old_windows_or_buffers_changed = windows_or_buffers_changed;
9068 EMACS_INT point_at_end = 0;
9069 EMACS_INT zv_at_end = 0;
9070 Lisp_Object old_deactivate_mark, tem;
9071 struct gcpro gcpro1;
9073 old_deactivate_mark = Vdeactivate_mark;
9074 oldbuf = current_buffer;
9075 Fset_buffer (Fget_buffer_create (Vmessages_buffer_name));
9076 BVAR (current_buffer, undo_list) = Qt;
9078 oldpoint = message_dolog_marker1;
9079 set_marker_restricted (oldpoint, make_number (PT), Qnil);
9080 oldbegv = message_dolog_marker2;
9081 set_marker_restricted (oldbegv, make_number (BEGV), Qnil);
9082 oldzv = message_dolog_marker3;
9083 set_marker_restricted (oldzv, make_number (ZV), Qnil);
9084 GCPRO1 (old_deactivate_mark);
9086 if (PT == Z)
9087 point_at_end = 1;
9088 if (ZV == Z)
9089 zv_at_end = 1;
9091 BEGV = BEG;
9092 BEGV_BYTE = BEG_BYTE;
9093 ZV = Z;
9094 ZV_BYTE = Z_BYTE;
9095 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (Z, Z_BYTE);
9097 /* Insert the string--maybe converting multibyte to single byte
9098 or vice versa, so that all the text fits the buffer. */
9099 if (multibyte
9100 && NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)))
9102 EMACS_INT i;
9103 int c, char_bytes;
9104 char work[1];
9106 /* Convert a multibyte string to single-byte
9107 for the *Message* buffer. */
9108 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += char_bytes)
9110 c = string_char_and_length (msg + i, &char_bytes);
9111 work[0] = (ASCII_CHAR_P (c)
9113 : multibyte_char_to_unibyte (c));
9114 insert_1_both (work, 1, 1, 1, 0, 0);
9117 else if (! multibyte
9118 && ! NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)))
9120 EMACS_INT i;
9121 int c, char_bytes;
9122 unsigned char str[MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH];
9123 /* Convert a single-byte string to multibyte
9124 for the *Message* buffer. */
9125 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
9127 c = msg[i];
9128 MAKE_CHAR_MULTIBYTE (c);
9129 char_bytes = CHAR_STRING (c, str);
9130 insert_1_both ((char *) str, 1, char_bytes, 1, 0, 0);
9133 else if (nbytes)
9134 insert_1 (m, nbytes, 1, 0, 0);
9136 if (nlflag)
9138 EMACS_INT this_bol, this_bol_byte, prev_bol, prev_bol_byte;
9139 printmax_t dups;
9140 insert_1 ("\n", 1, 1, 0, 0);
9142 scan_newline (Z, Z_BYTE, BEG, BEG_BYTE, -2, 0);
9143 this_bol = PT;
9144 this_bol_byte = PT_BYTE;
9146 /* See if this line duplicates the previous one.
9147 If so, combine duplicates. */
9148 if (this_bol > BEG)
9150 scan_newline (PT, PT_BYTE, BEG, BEG_BYTE, -2, 0);
9151 prev_bol = PT;
9152 prev_bol_byte = PT_BYTE;
9154 dups = message_log_check_duplicate (prev_bol_byte,
9155 this_bol_byte);
9156 if (dups)
9158 del_range_both (prev_bol, prev_bol_byte,
9159 this_bol, this_bol_byte, 0);
9160 if (dups > 1)
9162 char dupstr[sizeof " [ times]"
9163 + INT_STRLEN_BOUND (printmax_t)];
9164 int duplen;
9166 /* If you change this format, don't forget to also
9167 change message_log_check_duplicate. */
9168 sprintf (dupstr, " [%"pMd" times]", dups);
9169 duplen = strlen (dupstr);
9170 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (Z - 1, Z_BYTE - 1);
9171 insert_1 (dupstr, duplen, 1, 0, 1);
9176 /* If we have more than the desired maximum number of lines
9177 in the *Messages* buffer now, delete the oldest ones.
9178 This is safe because we don't have undo in this buffer. */
9180 if (NATNUMP (Vmessage_log_max))
9182 scan_newline (Z, Z_BYTE, BEG, BEG_BYTE,
9183 -XFASTINT (Vmessage_log_max) - 1, 0);
9184 del_range_both (BEG, BEG_BYTE, PT, PT_BYTE, 0);
9187 BEGV = XMARKER (oldbegv)->charpos;
9188 BEGV_BYTE = marker_byte_position (oldbegv);
9190 if (zv_at_end)
9192 ZV = Z;
9193 ZV_BYTE = Z_BYTE;
9195 else
9197 ZV = XMARKER (oldzv)->charpos;
9198 ZV_BYTE = marker_byte_position (oldzv);
9201 if (point_at_end)
9202 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (Z, Z_BYTE);
9203 else
9204 /* We can't do Fgoto_char (oldpoint) because it will run some
9205 Lisp code. */
9206 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (XMARKER (oldpoint)->charpos,
9207 XMARKER (oldpoint)->bytepos);
9209 UNGCPRO;
9210 unchain_marker (XMARKER (oldpoint));
9211 unchain_marker (XMARKER (oldbegv));
9212 unchain_marker (XMARKER (oldzv));
9214 tem = Fget_buffer_window (Fcurrent_buffer (), Qt);
9215 set_buffer_internal (oldbuf);
9216 if (NILP (tem))
9217 windows_or_buffers_changed = old_windows_or_buffers_changed;
9218 message_log_need_newline = !nlflag;
9219 Vdeactivate_mark = old_deactivate_mark;
9224 /* We are at the end of the buffer after just having inserted a newline.
9225 (Note: We depend on the fact we won't be crossing the gap.)
9226 Check to see if the most recent message looks a lot like the previous one.
9227 Return 0 if different, 1 if the new one should just replace it, or a
9228 value N > 1 if we should also append " [N times]". */
9230 static intmax_t
9231 message_log_check_duplicate (EMACS_INT prev_bol_byte, EMACS_INT this_bol_byte)
9233 EMACS_INT i;
9234 EMACS_INT len = Z_BYTE - 1 - this_bol_byte;
9235 int seen_dots = 0;
9236 unsigned char *p1 = BUF_BYTE_ADDRESS (current_buffer, prev_bol_byte);
9237 unsigned char *p2 = BUF_BYTE_ADDRESS (current_buffer, this_bol_byte);
9239 for (i = 0; i < len; i++)
9241 if (i >= 3 && p1[i-3] == '.' && p1[i-2] == '.' && p1[i-1] == '.')
9242 seen_dots = 1;
9243 if (p1[i] != p2[i])
9244 return seen_dots;
9246 p1 += len;
9247 if (*p1 == '\n')
9248 return 2;
9249 if (*p1++ == ' ' && *p1++ == '[')
9251 char *pend;
9252 intmax_t n = strtoimax ((char *) p1, &pend, 10);
9253 if (0 < n && n < INTMAX_MAX && strncmp (pend, " times]\n", 8) == 0)
9254 return n+1;
9256 return 0;
9260 /* Display an echo area message M with a specified length of NBYTES
9261 bytes. The string may include null characters. If M is 0, clear
9262 out any existing message, and let the mini-buffer text show
9263 through.
9265 This may GC, so the buffer M must NOT point to a Lisp string. */
9267 void
9268 message2 (const char *m, EMACS_INT nbytes, int multibyte)
9270 /* First flush out any partial line written with print. */
9271 message_log_maybe_newline ();
9272 if (m)
9273 message_dolog (m, nbytes, 1, multibyte);
9274 message2_nolog (m, nbytes, multibyte);
9278 /* The non-logging counterpart of message2. */
9280 void
9281 message2_nolog (const char *m, EMACS_INT nbytes, int multibyte)
9283 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
9284 message_enable_multibyte = multibyte;
9286 if (FRAME_INITIAL_P (sf))
9288 if (noninteractive_need_newline)
9289 putc ('\n', stderr);
9290 noninteractive_need_newline = 0;
9291 if (m)
9292 fwrite (m, nbytes, 1, stderr);
9293 if (cursor_in_echo_area == 0)
9294 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9295 fflush (stderr);
9297 /* A null message buffer means that the frame hasn't really been
9298 initialized yet. Error messages get reported properly by
9299 cmd_error, so this must be just an informative message; toss it. */
9300 else if (INTERACTIVE
9301 && sf->glyphs_initialized_p
9302 && FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (sf))
9304 Lisp_Object mini_window;
9305 struct frame *f;
9307 /* Get the frame containing the mini-buffer
9308 that the selected frame is using. */
9309 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
9310 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
9312 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9313 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (sf)
9314 && ! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9315 Fmake_frame_visible (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
9317 if (m)
9319 set_message (m, Qnil, nbytes, multibyte);
9320 if (minibuffer_auto_raise)
9321 Fraise_frame (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
9323 else
9324 clear_message (1, 1);
9326 do_pending_window_change (0);
9327 echo_area_display (1);
9328 do_pending_window_change (0);
9329 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->frame_up_to_date_hook != 0 && ! gc_in_progress)
9330 (*FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->frame_up_to_date_hook) (f);
9335 /* Display an echo area message M with a specified length of NBYTES
9336 bytes. The string may include null characters. If M is not a
9337 string, clear out any existing message, and let the mini-buffer
9338 text show through.
9340 This function cancels echoing. */
9342 void
9343 message3 (Lisp_Object m, EMACS_INT nbytes, int multibyte)
9345 struct gcpro gcpro1;
9347 GCPRO1 (m);
9348 clear_message (1,1);
9349 cancel_echoing ();
9351 /* First flush out any partial line written with print. */
9352 message_log_maybe_newline ();
9353 if (STRINGP (m))
9355 char *buffer;
9356 USE_SAFE_ALLOCA;
9358 SAFE_ALLOCA (buffer, char *, nbytes);
9359 memcpy (buffer, SDATA (m), nbytes);
9360 message_dolog (buffer, nbytes, 1, multibyte);
9361 SAFE_FREE ();
9363 message3_nolog (m, nbytes, multibyte);
9365 UNGCPRO;
9369 /* The non-logging version of message3.
9370 This does not cancel echoing, because it is used for echoing.
9371 Perhaps we need to make a separate function for echoing
9372 and make this cancel echoing. */
9374 void
9375 message3_nolog (Lisp_Object m, EMACS_INT nbytes, int multibyte)
9377 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
9378 message_enable_multibyte = multibyte;
9380 if (FRAME_INITIAL_P (sf))
9382 if (noninteractive_need_newline)
9383 putc ('\n', stderr);
9384 noninteractive_need_newline = 0;
9385 if (STRINGP (m))
9386 fwrite (SDATA (m), nbytes, 1, stderr);
9387 if (cursor_in_echo_area == 0)
9388 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9389 fflush (stderr);
9391 /* A null message buffer means that the frame hasn't really been
9392 initialized yet. Error messages get reported properly by
9393 cmd_error, so this must be just an informative message; toss it. */
9394 else if (INTERACTIVE
9395 && sf->glyphs_initialized_p
9396 && FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (sf))
9398 Lisp_Object mini_window;
9399 Lisp_Object frame;
9400 struct frame *f;
9402 /* Get the frame containing the mini-buffer
9403 that the selected frame is using. */
9404 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
9405 frame = XWINDOW (mini_window)->frame;
9406 f = XFRAME (frame);
9408 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9409 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (sf)
9410 && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9411 Fmake_frame_visible (frame);
9413 if (STRINGP (m) && SCHARS (m) > 0)
9415 set_message (NULL, m, nbytes, multibyte);
9416 if (minibuffer_auto_raise)
9417 Fraise_frame (frame);
9418 /* Assume we are not echoing.
9419 (If we are, echo_now will override this.) */
9420 echo_message_buffer = Qnil;
9422 else
9423 clear_message (1, 1);
9425 do_pending_window_change (0);
9426 echo_area_display (1);
9427 do_pending_window_change (0);
9428 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->frame_up_to_date_hook != 0 && ! gc_in_progress)
9429 (*FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->frame_up_to_date_hook) (f);
9434 /* Display a null-terminated echo area message M. If M is 0, clear
9435 out any existing message, and let the mini-buffer text show through.
9437 The buffer M must continue to exist until after the echo area gets
9438 cleared or some other message gets displayed there. Do not pass
9439 text that is stored in a Lisp string. Do not pass text in a buffer
9440 that was alloca'd. */
9442 void
9443 message1 (const char *m)
9445 message2 (m, (m ? strlen (m) : 0), 0);
9449 /* The non-logging counterpart of message1. */
9451 void
9452 message1_nolog (const char *m)
9454 message2_nolog (m, (m ? strlen (m) : 0), 0);
9457 /* Display a message M which contains a single %s
9458 which gets replaced with STRING. */
9460 void
9461 message_with_string (const char *m, Lisp_Object string, int log)
9463 CHECK_STRING (string);
9465 if (noninteractive)
9467 if (m)
9469 if (noninteractive_need_newline)
9470 putc ('\n', stderr);
9471 noninteractive_need_newline = 0;
9472 fprintf (stderr, m, SDATA (string));
9473 if (!cursor_in_echo_area)
9474 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9475 fflush (stderr);
9478 else if (INTERACTIVE)
9480 /* The frame whose minibuffer we're going to display the message on.
9481 It may be larger than the selected frame, so we need
9482 to use its buffer, not the selected frame's buffer. */
9483 Lisp_Object mini_window;
9484 struct frame *f, *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
9486 /* Get the frame containing the minibuffer
9487 that the selected frame is using. */
9488 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
9489 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
9491 /* A null message buffer means that the frame hasn't really been
9492 initialized yet. Error messages get reported properly by
9493 cmd_error, so this must be just an informative message; toss it. */
9494 if (FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (f))
9496 Lisp_Object args[2], msg;
9497 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2;
9499 args[0] = build_string (m);
9500 args[1] = msg = string;
9501 GCPRO2 (args[0], msg);
9502 gcpro1.nvars = 2;
9504 msg = Fformat (2, args);
9506 if (log)
9507 message3 (msg, SBYTES (msg), STRING_MULTIBYTE (msg));
9508 else
9509 message3_nolog (msg, SBYTES (msg), STRING_MULTIBYTE (msg));
9511 UNGCPRO;
9513 /* Print should start at the beginning of the message
9514 buffer next time. */
9515 message_buf_print = 0;
9521 /* Dump an informative message to the minibuf. If M is 0, clear out
9522 any existing message, and let the mini-buffer text show through. */
9524 static void
9525 vmessage (const char *m, va_list ap)
9527 if (noninteractive)
9529 if (m)
9531 if (noninteractive_need_newline)
9532 putc ('\n', stderr);
9533 noninteractive_need_newline = 0;
9534 vfprintf (stderr, m, ap);
9535 if (cursor_in_echo_area == 0)
9536 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9537 fflush (stderr);
9540 else if (INTERACTIVE)
9542 /* The frame whose mini-buffer we're going to display the message
9543 on. It may be larger than the selected frame, so we need to
9544 use its buffer, not the selected frame's buffer. */
9545 Lisp_Object mini_window;
9546 struct frame *f, *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
9548 /* Get the frame containing the mini-buffer
9549 that the selected frame is using. */
9550 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
9551 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
9553 /* A null message buffer means that the frame hasn't really been
9554 initialized yet. Error messages get reported properly by
9555 cmd_error, so this must be just an informative message; toss
9556 it. */
9557 if (FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (f))
9559 if (m)
9561 ptrdiff_t len;
9563 len = doprnt (FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (f),
9564 FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF_SIZE (f), m, (char *)0, ap);
9566 message2 (FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (f), len, 0);
9568 else
9569 message1 (0);
9571 /* Print should start at the beginning of the message
9572 buffer next time. */
9573 message_buf_print = 0;
9578 void
9579 message (const char *m, ...)
9581 va_list ap;
9582 va_start (ap, m);
9583 vmessage (m, ap);
9584 va_end (ap);
9588 #if 0
9589 /* The non-logging version of message. */
9591 void
9592 message_nolog (const char *m, ...)
9594 Lisp_Object old_log_max;
9595 va_list ap;
9596 va_start (ap, m);
9597 old_log_max = Vmessage_log_max;
9598 Vmessage_log_max = Qnil;
9599 vmessage (m, ap);
9600 Vmessage_log_max = old_log_max;
9601 va_end (ap);
9603 #endif
9606 /* Display the current message in the current mini-buffer. This is
9607 only called from error handlers in process.c, and is not time
9608 critical. */
9610 void
9611 update_echo_area (void)
9613 if (!NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]))
9615 Lisp_Object string;
9616 string = Fcurrent_message ();
9617 message3 (string, SBYTES (string),
9618 !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)));
9623 /* Make sure echo area buffers in `echo_buffers' are live.
9624 If they aren't, make new ones. */
9626 static void
9627 ensure_echo_area_buffers (void)
9629 int i;
9631 for (i = 0; i < 2; ++i)
9632 if (!BUFFERP (echo_buffer[i])
9633 || NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (echo_buffer[i]), name)))
9635 char name[30];
9636 Lisp_Object old_buffer;
9637 int j;
9639 old_buffer = echo_buffer[i];
9640 sprintf (name, " *Echo Area %d*", i);
9641 echo_buffer[i] = Fget_buffer_create (build_string (name));
9642 BVAR (XBUFFER (echo_buffer[i]), truncate_lines) = Qnil;
9643 /* to force word wrap in echo area -
9644 it was decided to postpone this*/
9645 /* XBUFFER (echo_buffer[i])->word_wrap = Qt; */
9647 for (j = 0; j < 2; ++j)
9648 if (EQ (old_buffer, echo_area_buffer[j]))
9649 echo_area_buffer[j] = echo_buffer[i];
9654 /* Call FN with args A1..A4 with either the current or last displayed
9655 echo_area_buffer as current buffer.
9657 WHICH zero means use the current message buffer
9658 echo_area_buffer[0]. If that is nil, choose a suitable buffer
9659 from echo_buffer[] and clear it.
9661 WHICH > 0 means use echo_area_buffer[1]. If that is nil, choose a
9662 suitable buffer from echo_buffer[] and clear it.
9664 If WHICH < 0, set echo_area_buffer[1] to echo_area_buffer[0], so
9665 that the current message becomes the last displayed one, make
9666 choose a suitable buffer for echo_area_buffer[0], and clear it.
9668 Value is what FN returns. */
9670 static int
9671 with_echo_area_buffer (struct window *w, int which,
9672 int (*fn) (EMACS_INT, Lisp_Object, EMACS_INT, EMACS_INT),
9673 EMACS_INT a1, Lisp_Object a2, EMACS_INT a3, EMACS_INT a4)
9675 Lisp_Object buffer;
9676 int this_one, the_other, clear_buffer_p, rc;
9677 int count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
9679 /* If buffers aren't live, make new ones. */
9680 ensure_echo_area_buffers ();
9682 clear_buffer_p = 0;
9684 if (which == 0)
9685 this_one = 0, the_other = 1;
9686 else if (which > 0)
9687 this_one = 1, the_other = 0;
9688 else
9690 this_one = 0, the_other = 1;
9691 clear_buffer_p = 1;
9693 /* We need a fresh one in case the current echo buffer equals
9694 the one containing the last displayed echo area message. */
9695 if (!NILP (echo_area_buffer[this_one])
9696 && EQ (echo_area_buffer[this_one], echo_area_buffer[the_other]))
9697 echo_area_buffer[this_one] = Qnil;
9700 /* Choose a suitable buffer from echo_buffer[] is we don't
9701 have one. */
9702 if (NILP (echo_area_buffer[this_one]))
9704 echo_area_buffer[this_one]
9705 = (EQ (echo_area_buffer[the_other], echo_buffer[this_one])
9706 ? echo_buffer[the_other]
9707 : echo_buffer[this_one]);
9708 clear_buffer_p = 1;
9711 buffer = echo_area_buffer[this_one];
9713 /* Don't get confused by reusing the buffer used for echoing
9714 for a different purpose. */
9715 if (echo_kboard == NULL && EQ (buffer, echo_message_buffer))
9716 cancel_echoing ();
9718 record_unwind_protect (unwind_with_echo_area_buffer,
9719 with_echo_area_buffer_unwind_data (w));
9721 /* Make the echo area buffer current. Note that for display
9722 purposes, it is not necessary that the displayed window's buffer
9723 == current_buffer, except for text property lookup. So, let's
9724 only set that buffer temporarily here without doing a full
9725 Fset_window_buffer. We must also change w->pointm, though,
9726 because otherwise an assertions in unshow_buffer fails, and Emacs
9727 aborts. */
9728 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (buffer));
9729 if (w)
9731 w->buffer = buffer;
9732 set_marker_both (w->pointm, buffer, BEG, BEG_BYTE);
9735 BVAR (current_buffer, undo_list) = Qt;
9736 BVAR (current_buffer, read_only) = Qnil;
9737 specbind (Qinhibit_read_only, Qt);
9738 specbind (Qinhibit_modification_hooks, Qt);
9740 if (clear_buffer_p && Z > BEG)
9741 del_range (BEG, Z);
9743 xassert (BEGV >= BEG);
9744 xassert (ZV <= Z && ZV >= BEGV);
9746 rc = fn (a1, a2, a3, a4);
9748 xassert (BEGV >= BEG);
9749 xassert (ZV <= Z && ZV >= BEGV);
9751 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
9752 return rc;
9756 /* Save state that should be preserved around the call to the function
9757 FN called in with_echo_area_buffer. */
9759 static Lisp_Object
9760 with_echo_area_buffer_unwind_data (struct window *w)
9762 int i = 0;
9763 Lisp_Object vector, tmp;
9765 /* Reduce consing by keeping one vector in
9766 Vwith_echo_area_save_vector. */
9767 vector = Vwith_echo_area_save_vector;
9768 Vwith_echo_area_save_vector = Qnil;
9770 if (NILP (vector))
9771 vector = Fmake_vector (make_number (7), Qnil);
9773 XSETBUFFER (tmp, current_buffer); ASET (vector, i, tmp); ++i;
9774 ASET (vector, i, Vdeactivate_mark); ++i;
9775 ASET (vector, i, make_number (windows_or_buffers_changed)); ++i;
9777 if (w)
9779 XSETWINDOW (tmp, w); ASET (vector, i, tmp); ++i;
9780 ASET (vector, i, w->buffer); ++i;
9781 ASET (vector, i, make_number (XMARKER (w->pointm)->charpos)); ++i;
9782 ASET (vector, i, make_number (XMARKER (w->pointm)->bytepos)); ++i;
9784 else
9786 int end = i + 4;
9787 for (; i < end; ++i)
9788 ASET (vector, i, Qnil);
9791 xassert (i == ASIZE (vector));
9792 return vector;
9796 /* Restore global state from VECTOR which was created by
9797 with_echo_area_buffer_unwind_data. */
9799 static Lisp_Object
9800 unwind_with_echo_area_buffer (Lisp_Object vector)
9802 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (AREF (vector, 0)));
9803 Vdeactivate_mark = AREF (vector, 1);
9804 windows_or_buffers_changed = XFASTINT (AREF (vector, 2));
9806 if (WINDOWP (AREF (vector, 3)))
9808 struct window *w;
9809 Lisp_Object buffer, charpos, bytepos;
9811 w = XWINDOW (AREF (vector, 3));
9812 buffer = AREF (vector, 4);
9813 charpos = AREF (vector, 5);
9814 bytepos = AREF (vector, 6);
9816 w->buffer = buffer;
9817 set_marker_both (w->pointm, buffer,
9818 XFASTINT (charpos), XFASTINT (bytepos));
9821 Vwith_echo_area_save_vector = vector;
9822 return Qnil;
9826 /* Set up the echo area for use by print functions. MULTIBYTE_P
9827 non-zero means we will print multibyte. */
9829 void
9830 setup_echo_area_for_printing (int multibyte_p)
9832 /* If we can't find an echo area any more, exit. */
9833 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (selected_frame)))
9834 Fkill_emacs (Qnil);
9836 ensure_echo_area_buffers ();
9838 if (!message_buf_print)
9840 /* A message has been output since the last time we printed.
9841 Choose a fresh echo area buffer. */
9842 if (EQ (echo_area_buffer[1], echo_buffer[0]))
9843 echo_area_buffer[0] = echo_buffer[1];
9844 else
9845 echo_area_buffer[0] = echo_buffer[0];
9847 /* Switch to that buffer and clear it. */
9848 set_buffer_internal (XBUFFER (echo_area_buffer[0]));
9849 BVAR (current_buffer, truncate_lines) = Qnil;
9851 if (Z > BEG)
9853 int count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
9854 specbind (Qinhibit_read_only, Qt);
9855 /* Note that undo recording is always disabled. */
9856 del_range (BEG, Z);
9857 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
9859 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (BEG, BEG_BYTE);
9861 /* Set up the buffer for the multibyteness we need. */
9862 if (multibyte_p
9863 != !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)))
9864 Fset_buffer_multibyte (multibyte_p ? Qt : Qnil);
9866 /* Raise the frame containing the echo area. */
9867 if (minibuffer_auto_raise)
9869 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
9870 Lisp_Object mini_window;
9871 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
9872 Fraise_frame (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
9875 message_log_maybe_newline ();
9876 message_buf_print = 1;
9878 else
9880 if (NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]))
9882 if (EQ (echo_area_buffer[1], echo_buffer[0]))
9883 echo_area_buffer[0] = echo_buffer[1];
9884 else
9885 echo_area_buffer[0] = echo_buffer[0];
9888 if (current_buffer != XBUFFER (echo_area_buffer[0]))
9890 /* Someone switched buffers between print requests. */
9891 set_buffer_internal (XBUFFER (echo_area_buffer[0]));
9892 BVAR (current_buffer, truncate_lines) = Qnil;
9898 /* Display an echo area message in window W. Value is non-zero if W's
9899 height is changed. If display_last_displayed_message_p is
9900 non-zero, display the message that was last displayed, otherwise
9901 display the current message. */
9903 static int
9904 display_echo_area (struct window *w)
9906 int i, no_message_p, window_height_changed_p, count;
9908 /* Temporarily disable garbage collections while displaying the echo
9909 area. This is done because a GC can print a message itself.
9910 That message would modify the echo area buffer's contents while a
9911 redisplay of the buffer is going on, and seriously confuse
9912 redisplay. */
9913 count = inhibit_garbage_collection ();
9915 /* If there is no message, we must call display_echo_area_1
9916 nevertheless because it resizes the window. But we will have to
9917 reset the echo_area_buffer in question to nil at the end because
9918 with_echo_area_buffer will sets it to an empty buffer. */
9919 i = display_last_displayed_message_p ? 1 : 0;
9920 no_message_p = NILP (echo_area_buffer[i]);
9922 window_height_changed_p
9923 = with_echo_area_buffer (w, display_last_displayed_message_p,
9924 display_echo_area_1,
9925 (intptr_t) w, Qnil, 0, 0);
9927 if (no_message_p)
9928 echo_area_buffer[i] = Qnil;
9930 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
9931 return window_height_changed_p;
9935 /* Helper for display_echo_area. Display the current buffer which
9936 contains the current echo area message in window W, a mini-window,
9937 a pointer to which is passed in A1. A2..A4 are currently not used.
9938 Change the height of W so that all of the message is displayed.
9939 Value is non-zero if height of W was changed. */
9941 static int
9942 display_echo_area_1 (EMACS_INT a1, Lisp_Object a2, EMACS_INT a3, EMACS_INT a4)
9944 intptr_t i1 = a1;
9945 struct window *w = (struct window *) i1;
9946 Lisp_Object window;
9947 struct text_pos start;
9948 int window_height_changed_p = 0;
9950 /* Do this before displaying, so that we have a large enough glyph
9951 matrix for the display. If we can't get enough space for the
9952 whole text, display the last N lines. That works by setting w->start. */
9953 window_height_changed_p = resize_mini_window (w, 0);
9955 /* Use the starting position chosen by resize_mini_window. */
9956 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (start, w->start);
9958 /* Display. */
9959 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
9960 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
9961 try_window (window, start, 0);
9963 return window_height_changed_p;
9967 /* Resize the echo area window to exactly the size needed for the
9968 currently displayed message, if there is one. If a mini-buffer
9969 is active, don't shrink it. */
9971 void
9972 resize_echo_area_exactly (void)
9974 if (BUFFERP (echo_area_buffer[0])
9975 && WINDOWP (echo_area_window))
9977 struct window *w = XWINDOW (echo_area_window);
9978 int resized_p;
9979 Lisp_Object resize_exactly;
9981 if (minibuf_level == 0)
9982 resize_exactly = Qt;
9983 else
9984 resize_exactly = Qnil;
9986 resized_p = with_echo_area_buffer (w, 0, resize_mini_window_1,
9987 (intptr_t) w, resize_exactly,
9988 0, 0);
9989 if (resized_p)
9991 ++windows_or_buffers_changed;
9992 ++update_mode_lines;
9993 redisplay_internal ();
9999 /* Callback function for with_echo_area_buffer, when used from
10000 resize_echo_area_exactly. A1 contains a pointer to the window to
10001 resize, EXACTLY non-nil means resize the mini-window exactly to the
10002 size of the text displayed. A3 and A4 are not used. Value is what
10003 resize_mini_window returns. */
10005 static int
10006 resize_mini_window_1 (EMACS_INT a1, Lisp_Object exactly, EMACS_INT a3, EMACS_INT a4)
10008 intptr_t i1 = a1;
10009 return resize_mini_window ((struct window *) i1, !NILP (exactly));
10013 /* Resize mini-window W to fit the size of its contents. EXACT_P
10014 means size the window exactly to the size needed. Otherwise, it's
10015 only enlarged until W's buffer is empty.
10017 Set W->start to the right place to begin display. If the whole
10018 contents fit, start at the beginning. Otherwise, start so as
10019 to make the end of the contents appear. This is particularly
10020 important for y-or-n-p, but seems desirable generally.
10022 Value is non-zero if the window height has been changed. */
10025 resize_mini_window (struct window *w, int exact_p)
10027 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
10028 int window_height_changed_p = 0;
10030 xassert (MINI_WINDOW_P (w));
10032 /* By default, start display at the beginning. */
10033 set_marker_both (w->start, w->buffer,
10034 BUF_BEGV (XBUFFER (w->buffer)),
10035 BUF_BEGV_BYTE (XBUFFER (w->buffer)));
10037 /* Don't resize windows while redisplaying a window; it would
10038 confuse redisplay functions when the size of the window they are
10039 displaying changes from under them. Such a resizing can happen,
10040 for instance, when which-func prints a long message while
10041 we are running fontification-functions. We're running these
10042 functions with safe_call which binds inhibit-redisplay to t. */
10043 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
10044 return 0;
10046 /* Nil means don't try to resize. */
10047 if (NILP (Vresize_mini_windows)
10048 || (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f) == NULL))
10049 return 0;
10051 if (!FRAME_MINIBUF_ONLY_P (f))
10053 struct it it;
10054 struct window *root = XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f));
10055 int total_height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (root) + WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
10056 int height, max_height;
10057 int unit = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
10058 struct text_pos start;
10059 struct buffer *old_current_buffer = NULL;
10061 if (current_buffer != XBUFFER (w->buffer))
10063 old_current_buffer = current_buffer;
10064 set_buffer_internal (XBUFFER (w->buffer));
10067 init_iterator (&it, w, BEGV, BEGV_BYTE, NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
10069 /* Compute the max. number of lines specified by the user. */
10070 if (FLOATP (Vmax_mini_window_height))
10071 max_height = XFLOATINT (Vmax_mini_window_height) * FRAME_LINES (f);
10072 else if (INTEGERP (Vmax_mini_window_height))
10073 max_height = XINT (Vmax_mini_window_height);
10074 else
10075 max_height = total_height / 4;
10077 /* Correct that max. height if it's bogus. */
10078 max_height = max (1, max_height);
10079 max_height = min (total_height, max_height);
10081 /* Find out the height of the text in the window. */
10082 if (it.line_wrap == TRUNCATE)
10083 height = 1;
10084 else
10086 last_height = 0;
10087 move_it_to (&it, ZV, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
10088 if (it.max_ascent == 0 && it.max_descent == 0)
10089 height = it.current_y + last_height;
10090 else
10091 height = it.current_y + it.max_ascent + it.max_descent;
10092 height -= min (it.extra_line_spacing, it.max_extra_line_spacing);
10093 height = (height + unit - 1) / unit;
10096 /* Compute a suitable window start. */
10097 if (height > max_height)
10099 height = max_height;
10100 init_iterator (&it, w, ZV, ZV_BYTE, NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
10101 move_it_vertically_backward (&it, (height - 1) * unit);
10102 start = it.current.pos;
10104 else
10105 SET_TEXT_POS (start, BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
10106 SET_MARKER_FROM_TEXT_POS (w->start, start);
10108 if (EQ (Vresize_mini_windows, Qgrow_only))
10110 /* Let it grow only, until we display an empty message, in which
10111 case the window shrinks again. */
10112 if (height > WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w))
10114 int old_height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
10115 freeze_window_starts (f, 1);
10116 grow_mini_window (w, height - WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w));
10117 window_height_changed_p = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) != old_height;
10119 else if (height < WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w)
10120 && (exact_p || BEGV == ZV))
10122 int old_height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
10123 freeze_window_starts (f, 0);
10124 shrink_mini_window (w);
10125 window_height_changed_p = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) != old_height;
10128 else
10130 /* Always resize to exact size needed. */
10131 if (height > WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w))
10133 int old_height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
10134 freeze_window_starts (f, 1);
10135 grow_mini_window (w, height - WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w));
10136 window_height_changed_p = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) != old_height;
10138 else if (height < WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w))
10140 int old_height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
10141 freeze_window_starts (f, 0);
10142 shrink_mini_window (w);
10144 if (height)
10146 freeze_window_starts (f, 1);
10147 grow_mini_window (w, height - WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w));
10150 window_height_changed_p = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) != old_height;
10154 if (old_current_buffer)
10155 set_buffer_internal (old_current_buffer);
10158 return window_height_changed_p;
10162 /* Value is the current message, a string, or nil if there is no
10163 current message. */
10165 Lisp_Object
10166 current_message (void)
10168 Lisp_Object msg;
10170 if (!BUFFERP (echo_area_buffer[0]))
10171 msg = Qnil;
10172 else
10174 with_echo_area_buffer (0, 0, current_message_1,
10175 (intptr_t) &msg, Qnil, 0, 0);
10176 if (NILP (msg))
10177 echo_area_buffer[0] = Qnil;
10180 return msg;
10184 static int
10185 current_message_1 (EMACS_INT a1, Lisp_Object a2, EMACS_INT a3, EMACS_INT a4)
10187 intptr_t i1 = a1;
10188 Lisp_Object *msg = (Lisp_Object *) i1;
10190 if (Z > BEG)
10191 *msg = make_buffer_string (BEG, Z, 1);
10192 else
10193 *msg = Qnil;
10194 return 0;
10198 /* Push the current message on Vmessage_stack for later restauration
10199 by restore_message. Value is non-zero if the current message isn't
10200 empty. This is a relatively infrequent operation, so it's not
10201 worth optimizing. */
10204 push_message (void)
10206 Lisp_Object msg;
10207 msg = current_message ();
10208 Vmessage_stack = Fcons (msg, Vmessage_stack);
10209 return STRINGP (msg);
10213 /* Restore message display from the top of Vmessage_stack. */
10215 void
10216 restore_message (void)
10218 Lisp_Object msg;
10220 xassert (CONSP (Vmessage_stack));
10221 msg = XCAR (Vmessage_stack);
10222 if (STRINGP (msg))
10223 message3_nolog (msg, SBYTES (msg), STRING_MULTIBYTE (msg));
10224 else
10225 message3_nolog (msg, 0, 0);
10229 /* Handler for record_unwind_protect calling pop_message. */
10231 Lisp_Object
10232 pop_message_unwind (Lisp_Object dummy)
10234 pop_message ();
10235 return Qnil;
10238 /* Pop the top-most entry off Vmessage_stack. */
10240 static void
10241 pop_message (void)
10243 xassert (CONSP (Vmessage_stack));
10244 Vmessage_stack = XCDR (Vmessage_stack);
10248 /* Check that Vmessage_stack is nil. Called from emacs.c when Emacs
10249 exits. If the stack is not empty, we have a missing pop_message
10250 somewhere. */
10252 void
10253 check_message_stack (void)
10255 if (!NILP (Vmessage_stack))
10256 abort ();
10260 /* Truncate to NCHARS what will be displayed in the echo area the next
10261 time we display it---but don't redisplay it now. */
10263 void
10264 truncate_echo_area (EMACS_INT nchars)
10266 if (nchars == 0)
10267 echo_area_buffer[0] = Qnil;
10268 /* A null message buffer means that the frame hasn't really been
10269 initialized yet. Error messages get reported properly by
10270 cmd_error, so this must be just an informative message; toss it. */
10271 else if (!noninteractive
10272 && INTERACTIVE
10273 && !NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]))
10275 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
10276 if (FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (sf))
10277 with_echo_area_buffer (0, 0, truncate_message_1, nchars, Qnil, 0, 0);
10282 /* Helper function for truncate_echo_area. Truncate the current
10283 message to at most NCHARS characters. */
10285 static int
10286 truncate_message_1 (EMACS_INT nchars, Lisp_Object a2, EMACS_INT a3, EMACS_INT a4)
10288 if (BEG + nchars < Z)
10289 del_range (BEG + nchars, Z);
10290 if (Z == BEG)
10291 echo_area_buffer[0] = Qnil;
10292 return 0;
10296 /* Set the current message to a substring of S or STRING.
10298 If STRING is a Lisp string, set the message to the first NBYTES
10299 bytes from STRING. NBYTES zero means use the whole string. If
10300 STRING is multibyte, the message will be displayed multibyte.
10302 If S is not null, set the message to the first LEN bytes of S. LEN
10303 zero means use the whole string. MULTIBYTE_P non-zero means S is
10304 multibyte. Display the message multibyte in that case.
10306 Doesn't GC, as with_echo_area_buffer binds Qinhibit_modification_hooks
10307 to t before calling set_message_1 (which calls insert).
10310 static void
10311 set_message (const char *s, Lisp_Object string,
10312 EMACS_INT nbytes, int multibyte_p)
10314 message_enable_multibyte
10315 = ((s && multibyte_p)
10316 || (STRINGP (string) && STRING_MULTIBYTE (string)));
10318 with_echo_area_buffer (0, -1, set_message_1,
10319 (intptr_t) s, string, nbytes, multibyte_p);
10320 message_buf_print = 0;
10321 help_echo_showing_p = 0;
10325 /* Helper function for set_message. Arguments have the same meaning
10326 as there, with A1 corresponding to S and A2 corresponding to STRING
10327 This function is called with the echo area buffer being
10328 current. */
10330 static int
10331 set_message_1 (EMACS_INT a1, Lisp_Object a2, EMACS_INT nbytes, EMACS_INT multibyte_p)
10333 intptr_t i1 = a1;
10334 const char *s = (const char *) i1;
10335 const unsigned char *msg = (const unsigned char *) s;
10336 Lisp_Object string = a2;
10338 /* Change multibyteness of the echo buffer appropriately. */
10339 if (message_enable_multibyte
10340 != !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)))
10341 Fset_buffer_multibyte (message_enable_multibyte ? Qt : Qnil);
10343 BVAR (current_buffer, truncate_lines) = message_truncate_lines ? Qt : Qnil;
10344 if (!NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, bidi_display_reordering)))
10345 BVAR (current_buffer, bidi_paragraph_direction) = Qleft_to_right;
10347 /* Insert new message at BEG. */
10348 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (BEG, BEG_BYTE);
10350 if (STRINGP (string))
10352 EMACS_INT nchars;
10354 if (nbytes == 0)
10355 nbytes = SBYTES (string);
10356 nchars = string_byte_to_char (string, nbytes);
10358 /* This function takes care of single/multibyte conversion. We
10359 just have to ensure that the echo area buffer has the right
10360 setting of enable_multibyte_characters. */
10361 insert_from_string (string, 0, 0, nchars, nbytes, 1);
10363 else if (s)
10365 if (nbytes == 0)
10366 nbytes = strlen (s);
10368 if (multibyte_p && NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)))
10370 /* Convert from multi-byte to single-byte. */
10371 EMACS_INT i;
10372 int c, n;
10373 char work[1];
10375 /* Convert a multibyte string to single-byte. */
10376 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += n)
10378 c = string_char_and_length (msg + i, &n);
10379 work[0] = (ASCII_CHAR_P (c)
10381 : multibyte_char_to_unibyte (c));
10382 insert_1_both (work, 1, 1, 1, 0, 0);
10385 else if (!multibyte_p
10386 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)))
10388 /* Convert from single-byte to multi-byte. */
10389 EMACS_INT i;
10390 int c, n;
10391 unsigned char str[MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH];
10393 /* Convert a single-byte string to multibyte. */
10394 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
10396 c = msg[i];
10397 MAKE_CHAR_MULTIBYTE (c);
10398 n = CHAR_STRING (c, str);
10399 insert_1_both ((char *) str, 1, n, 1, 0, 0);
10402 else
10403 insert_1 (s, nbytes, 1, 0, 0);
10406 return 0;
10410 /* Clear messages. CURRENT_P non-zero means clear the current
10411 message. LAST_DISPLAYED_P non-zero means clear the message
10412 last displayed. */
10414 void
10415 clear_message (int current_p, int last_displayed_p)
10417 if (current_p)
10419 echo_area_buffer[0] = Qnil;
10420 message_cleared_p = 1;
10423 if (last_displayed_p)
10424 echo_area_buffer[1] = Qnil;
10426 message_buf_print = 0;
10429 /* Clear garbaged frames.
10431 This function is used where the old redisplay called
10432 redraw_garbaged_frames which in turn called redraw_frame which in
10433 turn called clear_frame. The call to clear_frame was a source of
10434 flickering. I believe a clear_frame is not necessary. It should
10435 suffice in the new redisplay to invalidate all current matrices,
10436 and ensure a complete redisplay of all windows. */
10438 static void
10439 clear_garbaged_frames (void)
10441 if (frame_garbaged)
10443 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
10444 int changed_count = 0;
10446 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
10448 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
10450 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
10452 if (f->resized_p)
10454 Fredraw_frame (frame);
10455 f->force_flush_display_p = 1;
10457 clear_current_matrices (f);
10458 changed_count++;
10459 f->garbaged = 0;
10460 f->resized_p = 0;
10464 frame_garbaged = 0;
10465 if (changed_count)
10466 ++windows_or_buffers_changed;
10471 /* Redisplay the echo area of the selected frame. If UPDATE_FRAME_P
10472 is non-zero update selected_frame. Value is non-zero if the
10473 mini-windows height has been changed. */
10475 static int
10476 echo_area_display (int update_frame_p)
10478 Lisp_Object mini_window;
10479 struct window *w;
10480 struct frame *f;
10481 int window_height_changed_p = 0;
10482 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
10484 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
10485 w = XWINDOW (mini_window);
10486 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
10488 /* Don't display if frame is invisible or not yet initialized. */
10489 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || !f->glyphs_initialized_p)
10490 return 0;
10492 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
10493 /* When Emacs starts, selected_frame may be the initial terminal
10494 frame. If we let this through, a message would be displayed on
10495 the terminal. */
10496 if (FRAME_INITIAL_P (XFRAME (selected_frame)))
10497 return 0;
10498 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
10500 /* Redraw garbaged frames. */
10501 if (frame_garbaged)
10502 clear_garbaged_frames ();
10504 if (!NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]) || minibuf_level == 0)
10506 echo_area_window = mini_window;
10507 window_height_changed_p = display_echo_area (w);
10508 w->must_be_updated_p = 1;
10510 /* Update the display, unless called from redisplay_internal.
10511 Also don't update the screen during redisplay itself. The
10512 update will happen at the end of redisplay, and an update
10513 here could cause confusion. */
10514 if (update_frame_p && !redisplaying_p)
10516 int n = 0;
10518 /* If the display update has been interrupted by pending
10519 input, update mode lines in the frame. Due to the
10520 pending input, it might have been that redisplay hasn't
10521 been called, so that mode lines above the echo area are
10522 garbaged. This looks odd, so we prevent it here. */
10523 if (!display_completed)
10524 n = redisplay_mode_lines (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f), 0);
10526 if (window_height_changed_p
10527 /* Don't do this if Emacs is shutting down. Redisplay
10528 needs to run hooks. */
10529 && !NILP (Vrun_hooks))
10531 /* Must update other windows. Likewise as in other
10532 cases, don't let this update be interrupted by
10533 pending input. */
10534 int count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
10535 specbind (Qredisplay_dont_pause, Qt);
10536 windows_or_buffers_changed = 1;
10537 redisplay_internal ();
10538 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
10540 else if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f) && n == 0)
10542 /* Window configuration is the same as before.
10543 Can do with a display update of the echo area,
10544 unless we displayed some mode lines. */
10545 update_single_window (w, 1);
10546 FRAME_RIF (f)->flush_display (f);
10548 else
10549 update_frame (f, 1, 1);
10551 /* If cursor is in the echo area, make sure that the next
10552 redisplay displays the minibuffer, so that the cursor will
10553 be replaced with what the minibuffer wants. */
10554 if (cursor_in_echo_area)
10555 ++windows_or_buffers_changed;
10558 else if (!EQ (mini_window, selected_window))
10559 windows_or_buffers_changed++;
10561 /* Last displayed message is now the current message. */
10562 echo_area_buffer[1] = echo_area_buffer[0];
10563 /* Inform read_char that we're not echoing. */
10564 echo_message_buffer = Qnil;
10566 /* Prevent redisplay optimization in redisplay_internal by resetting
10567 this_line_start_pos. This is done because the mini-buffer now
10568 displays the message instead of its buffer text. */
10569 if (EQ (mini_window, selected_window))
10570 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos) = 0;
10572 return window_height_changed_p;
10577 /***********************************************************************
10578 Mode Lines and Frame Titles
10579 ***********************************************************************/
10581 /* A buffer for constructing non-propertized mode-line strings and
10582 frame titles in it; allocated from the heap in init_xdisp and
10583 resized as needed in store_mode_line_noprop_char. */
10585 static char *mode_line_noprop_buf;
10587 /* The buffer's end, and a current output position in it. */
10589 static char *mode_line_noprop_buf_end;
10590 static char *mode_line_noprop_ptr;
10592 #define MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN(start) \
10593 ((mode_line_noprop_ptr - mode_line_noprop_buf) - start)
10595 static enum {
10596 MODE_LINE_DISPLAY = 0,
10597 MODE_LINE_TITLE,
10598 MODE_LINE_NOPROP,
10599 MODE_LINE_STRING
10600 } mode_line_target;
10602 /* Alist that caches the results of :propertize.
10603 Each element is (PROPERTIZED-STRING . PROPERTY-LIST). */
10604 static Lisp_Object mode_line_proptrans_alist;
10606 /* List of strings making up the mode-line. */
10607 static Lisp_Object mode_line_string_list;
10609 /* Base face property when building propertized mode line string. */
10610 static Lisp_Object mode_line_string_face;
10611 static Lisp_Object mode_line_string_face_prop;
10614 /* Unwind data for mode line strings */
10616 static Lisp_Object Vmode_line_unwind_vector;
10618 static Lisp_Object
10619 format_mode_line_unwind_data (struct buffer *obuf,
10620 Lisp_Object owin,
10621 int save_proptrans)
10623 Lisp_Object vector, tmp;
10625 /* Reduce consing by keeping one vector in
10626 Vwith_echo_area_save_vector. */
10627 vector = Vmode_line_unwind_vector;
10628 Vmode_line_unwind_vector = Qnil;
10630 if (NILP (vector))
10631 vector = Fmake_vector (make_number (8), Qnil);
10633 ASET (vector, 0, make_number (mode_line_target));
10634 ASET (vector, 1, make_number (MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN (0)));
10635 ASET (vector, 2, mode_line_string_list);
10636 ASET (vector, 3, save_proptrans ? mode_line_proptrans_alist : Qt);
10637 ASET (vector, 4, mode_line_string_face);
10638 ASET (vector, 5, mode_line_string_face_prop);
10640 if (obuf)
10641 XSETBUFFER (tmp, obuf);
10642 else
10643 tmp = Qnil;
10644 ASET (vector, 6, tmp);
10645 ASET (vector, 7, owin);
10647 return vector;
10650 static Lisp_Object
10651 unwind_format_mode_line (Lisp_Object vector)
10653 mode_line_target = XINT (AREF (vector, 0));
10654 mode_line_noprop_ptr = mode_line_noprop_buf + XINT (AREF (vector, 1));
10655 mode_line_string_list = AREF (vector, 2);
10656 if (! EQ (AREF (vector, 3), Qt))
10657 mode_line_proptrans_alist = AREF (vector, 3);
10658 mode_line_string_face = AREF (vector, 4);
10659 mode_line_string_face_prop = AREF (vector, 5);
10661 if (!NILP (AREF (vector, 7)))
10662 /* Select window before buffer, since it may change the buffer. */
10663 Fselect_window (AREF (vector, 7), Qt);
10665 if (!NILP (AREF (vector, 6)))
10667 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (AREF (vector, 6)));
10668 ASET (vector, 6, Qnil);
10671 Vmode_line_unwind_vector = vector;
10672 return Qnil;
10676 /* Store a single character C for the frame title in mode_line_noprop_buf.
10677 Re-allocate mode_line_noprop_buf if necessary. */
10679 static void
10680 store_mode_line_noprop_char (char c)
10682 /* If output position has reached the end of the allocated buffer,
10683 increase the buffer's size. */
10684 if (mode_line_noprop_ptr == mode_line_noprop_buf_end)
10686 ptrdiff_t len = MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN (0);
10687 ptrdiff_t size = len;
10688 mode_line_noprop_buf =
10689 xpalloc (mode_line_noprop_buf, &size, 1, STRING_BYTES_BOUND, 1);
10690 mode_line_noprop_buf_end = mode_line_noprop_buf + size;
10691 mode_line_noprop_ptr = mode_line_noprop_buf + len;
10694 *mode_line_noprop_ptr++ = c;
10698 /* Store part of a frame title in mode_line_noprop_buf, beginning at
10699 mode_line_noprop_ptr. STRING is the string to store. Do not copy
10700 characters that yield more columns than PRECISION; PRECISION <= 0
10701 means copy the whole string. Pad with spaces until FIELD_WIDTH
10702 number of characters have been copied; FIELD_WIDTH <= 0 means don't
10703 pad. Called from display_mode_element when it is used to build a
10704 frame title. */
10706 static int
10707 store_mode_line_noprop (const char *string, int field_width, int precision)
10709 const unsigned char *str = (const unsigned char *) string;
10710 int n = 0;
10711 EMACS_INT dummy, nbytes;
10713 /* Copy at most PRECISION chars from STR. */
10714 nbytes = strlen (string);
10715 n += c_string_width (str, nbytes, precision, &dummy, &nbytes);
10716 while (nbytes--)
10717 store_mode_line_noprop_char (*str++);
10719 /* Fill up with spaces until FIELD_WIDTH reached. */
10720 while (field_width > 0
10721 && n < field_width)
10723 store_mode_line_noprop_char (' ');
10724 ++n;
10727 return n;
10730 /***********************************************************************
10731 Frame Titles
10732 ***********************************************************************/
10734 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
10736 /* Set the title of FRAME, if it has changed. The title format is
10737 Vicon_title_format if FRAME is iconified, otherwise it is
10738 frame_title_format. */
10740 static void
10741 x_consider_frame_title (Lisp_Object frame)
10743 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
10745 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
10746 || FRAME_MINIBUF_ONLY_P (f)
10747 || f->explicit_name)
10749 /* Do we have more than one visible frame on this X display? */
10750 Lisp_Object tail;
10751 Lisp_Object fmt;
10752 ptrdiff_t title_start;
10753 char *title;
10754 ptrdiff_t len;
10755 struct it it;
10756 int count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
10758 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
10760 Lisp_Object other_frame = XCAR (tail);
10761 struct frame *tf = XFRAME (other_frame);
10763 if (tf != f
10764 && FRAME_KBOARD (tf) == FRAME_KBOARD (f)
10765 && !FRAME_MINIBUF_ONLY_P (tf)
10766 && !EQ (other_frame, tip_frame)
10767 && (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (tf) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (tf)))
10768 break;
10771 /* Set global variable indicating that multiple frames exist. */
10772 multiple_frames = CONSP (tail);
10774 /* Switch to the buffer of selected window of the frame. Set up
10775 mode_line_target so that display_mode_element will output into
10776 mode_line_noprop_buf; then display the title. */
10777 record_unwind_protect (unwind_format_mode_line,
10778 format_mode_line_unwind_data
10779 (current_buffer, selected_window, 0));
10781 Fselect_window (f->selected_window, Qt);
10782 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (XWINDOW (f->selected_window)->buffer));
10783 fmt = FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) ? Vicon_title_format : Vframe_title_format;
10785 mode_line_target = MODE_LINE_TITLE;
10786 title_start = MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN (0);
10787 init_iterator (&it, XWINDOW (f->selected_window), -1, -1,
10788 NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
10789 display_mode_element (&it, 0, -1, -1, fmt, Qnil, 0);
10790 len = MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN (title_start);
10791 title = mode_line_noprop_buf + title_start;
10792 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
10794 /* Set the title only if it's changed. This avoids consing in
10795 the common case where it hasn't. (If it turns out that we've
10796 already wasted too much time by walking through the list with
10797 display_mode_element, then we might need to optimize at a
10798 higher level than this.) */
10799 if (! STRINGP (f->name)
10800 || SBYTES (f->name) != len
10801 || memcmp (title, SDATA (f->name), len) != 0)
10802 x_implicitly_set_name (f, make_string (title, len), Qnil);
10806 #endif /* not HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
10811 /***********************************************************************
10812 Menu Bars
10813 ***********************************************************************/
10816 /* Prepare for redisplay by updating menu-bar item lists when
10817 appropriate. This can call eval. */
10819 void
10820 prepare_menu_bars (void)
10822 int all_windows;
10823 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2;
10824 struct frame *f;
10825 Lisp_Object tooltip_frame;
10827 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
10828 tooltip_frame = tip_frame;
10829 #else
10830 tooltip_frame = Qnil;
10831 #endif
10833 /* Update all frame titles based on their buffer names, etc. We do
10834 this before the menu bars so that the buffer-menu will show the
10835 up-to-date frame titles. */
10836 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
10837 if (windows_or_buffers_changed || update_mode_lines)
10839 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
10841 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
10843 f = XFRAME (frame);
10844 if (!EQ (frame, tooltip_frame)
10845 && (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)))
10846 x_consider_frame_title (frame);
10849 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
10851 /* Update the menu bar item lists, if appropriate. This has to be
10852 done before any actual redisplay or generation of display lines. */
10853 all_windows = (update_mode_lines
10854 || buffer_shared > 1
10855 || windows_or_buffers_changed);
10856 if (all_windows)
10858 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
10859 int count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
10860 /* 1 means that update_menu_bar has run its hooks
10861 so any further calls to update_menu_bar shouldn't do so again. */
10862 int menu_bar_hooks_run = 0;
10864 record_unwind_save_match_data ();
10866 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
10868 f = XFRAME (frame);
10870 /* Ignore tooltip frame. */
10871 if (EQ (frame, tooltip_frame))
10872 continue;
10874 /* If a window on this frame changed size, report that to
10875 the user and clear the size-change flag. */
10876 if (FRAME_WINDOW_SIZES_CHANGED (f))
10878 Lisp_Object functions;
10880 /* Clear flag first in case we get an error below. */
10881 FRAME_WINDOW_SIZES_CHANGED (f) = 0;
10882 functions = Vwindow_size_change_functions;
10883 GCPRO2 (tail, functions);
10885 while (CONSP (functions))
10887 if (!EQ (XCAR (functions), Qt))
10888 call1 (XCAR (functions), frame);
10889 functions = XCDR (functions);
10891 UNGCPRO;
10894 GCPRO1 (tail);
10895 menu_bar_hooks_run = update_menu_bar (f, 0, menu_bar_hooks_run);
10896 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
10897 update_tool_bar (f, 0);
10898 #endif
10899 #ifdef HAVE_NS
10900 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
10901 && FRAME_NS_P (f))
10902 ns_set_doc_edited (f, Fbuffer_modified_p
10903 (XWINDOW (f->selected_window)->buffer));
10904 #endif
10905 UNGCPRO;
10908 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
10910 else
10912 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
10913 update_menu_bar (sf, 1, 0);
10914 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
10915 update_tool_bar (sf, 1);
10916 #endif
10921 /* Update the menu bar item list for frame F. This has to be done
10922 before we start to fill in any display lines, because it can call
10923 eval.
10925 If SAVE_MATCH_DATA is non-zero, we must save and restore it here.
10927 If HOOKS_RUN is 1, that means a previous call to update_menu_bar
10928 already ran the menu bar hooks for this redisplay, so there
10929 is no need to run them again. The return value is the
10930 updated value of this flag, to pass to the next call. */
10932 static int
10933 update_menu_bar (struct frame *f, int save_match_data, int hooks_run)
10935 Lisp_Object window;
10936 register struct window *w;
10938 /* If called recursively during a menu update, do nothing. This can
10939 happen when, for instance, an activate-menubar-hook causes a
10940 redisplay. */
10941 if (inhibit_menubar_update)
10942 return hooks_run;
10944 window = FRAME_SELECTED_WINDOW (f);
10945 w = XWINDOW (window);
10947 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
10949 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (HAVE_NTGUI) \
10950 || defined (HAVE_NS) || defined (USE_GTK)
10951 FRAME_EXTERNAL_MENU_BAR (f)
10952 #else
10953 FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f) > 0
10954 #endif
10955 : FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f) > 0)
10957 /* If the user has switched buffers or windows, we need to
10958 recompute to reflect the new bindings. But we'll
10959 recompute when update_mode_lines is set too; that means
10960 that people can use force-mode-line-update to request
10961 that the menu bar be recomputed. The adverse effect on
10962 the rest of the redisplay algorithm is about the same as
10963 windows_or_buffers_changed anyway. */
10964 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
10965 /* This used to test w->update_mode_line, but we believe
10966 there is no need to recompute the menu in that case. */
10967 || update_mode_lines
10968 || ((BUF_SAVE_MODIFF (XBUFFER (w->buffer))
10969 < BUF_MODIFF (XBUFFER (w->buffer)))
10970 != !NILP (w->last_had_star))
10971 || ((!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
10972 && !NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), mark_active)))
10973 != !NILP (w->region_showing)))
10975 struct buffer *prev = current_buffer;
10976 int count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
10978 specbind (Qinhibit_menubar_update, Qt);
10980 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (w->buffer));
10981 if (save_match_data)
10982 record_unwind_save_match_data ();
10983 if (NILP (Voverriding_local_map_menu_flag))
10985 specbind (Qoverriding_terminal_local_map, Qnil);
10986 specbind (Qoverriding_local_map, Qnil);
10989 if (!hooks_run)
10991 /* Run the Lucid hook. */
10992 safe_run_hooks (Qactivate_menubar_hook);
10994 /* If it has changed current-menubar from previous value,
10995 really recompute the menu-bar from the value. */
10996 if (! NILP (Vlucid_menu_bar_dirty_flag))
10997 call0 (Qrecompute_lucid_menubar);
10999 safe_run_hooks (Qmenu_bar_update_hook);
11001 hooks_run = 1;
11004 XSETFRAME (Vmenu_updating_frame, f);
11005 FRAME_MENU_BAR_ITEMS (f) = menu_bar_items (FRAME_MENU_BAR_ITEMS (f));
11007 /* Redisplay the menu bar in case we changed it. */
11008 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (HAVE_NTGUI) \
11009 || defined (HAVE_NS) || defined (USE_GTK)
11010 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
11012 #if defined (HAVE_NS)
11013 /* All frames on Mac OS share the same menubar. So only
11014 the selected frame should be allowed to set it. */
11015 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
11016 #endif
11017 set_frame_menubar (f, 0, 0);
11019 else
11020 /* On a terminal screen, the menu bar is an ordinary screen
11021 line, and this makes it get updated. */
11022 w->update_mode_line = Qt;
11023 #else /* ! (USE_X_TOOLKIT || HAVE_NTGUI || HAVE_NS || USE_GTK) */
11024 /* In the non-toolkit version, the menu bar is an ordinary screen
11025 line, and this makes it get updated. */
11026 w->update_mode_line = Qt;
11027 #endif /* ! (USE_X_TOOLKIT || HAVE_NTGUI || HAVE_NS || USE_GTK) */
11029 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
11030 set_buffer_internal_1 (prev);
11034 return hooks_run;
11039 /***********************************************************************
11040 Output Cursor
11041 ***********************************************************************/
11043 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
11045 /* EXPORT:
11046 Nominal cursor position -- where to draw output.
11047 HPOS and VPOS are window relative glyph matrix coordinates.
11048 X and Y are window relative pixel coordinates. */
11050 struct cursor_pos output_cursor;
11053 /* EXPORT:
11054 Set the global variable output_cursor to CURSOR. All cursor
11055 positions are relative to updated_window. */
11057 void
11058 set_output_cursor (struct cursor_pos *cursor)
11060 output_cursor.hpos = cursor->hpos;
11061 output_cursor.vpos = cursor->vpos;
11062 output_cursor.x = cursor->x;
11063 output_cursor.y = cursor->y;
11067 /* EXPORT for RIF:
11068 Set a nominal cursor position.
11070 HPOS and VPOS are column/row positions in a window glyph matrix. X
11071 and Y are window text area relative pixel positions.
11073 If this is done during an update, updated_window will contain the
11074 window that is being updated and the position is the future output
11075 cursor position for that window. If updated_window is null, use
11076 selected_window and display the cursor at the given position. */
11078 void
11079 x_cursor_to (int vpos, int hpos, int y, int x)
11081 struct window *w;
11083 /* If updated_window is not set, work on selected_window. */
11084 if (updated_window)
11085 w = updated_window;
11086 else
11087 w = XWINDOW (selected_window);
11089 /* Set the output cursor. */
11090 output_cursor.hpos = hpos;
11091 output_cursor.vpos = vpos;
11092 output_cursor.x = x;
11093 output_cursor.y = y;
11095 /* If not called as part of an update, really display the cursor.
11096 This will also set the cursor position of W. */
11097 if (updated_window == NULL)
11099 BLOCK_INPUT;
11100 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, hpos, vpos, x, y);
11101 if (FRAME_RIF (SELECTED_FRAME ())->flush_display_optional)
11102 FRAME_RIF (SELECTED_FRAME ())->flush_display_optional (SELECTED_FRAME ());
11103 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11107 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
11110 /***********************************************************************
11111 Tool-bars
11112 ***********************************************************************/
11114 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
11116 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
11118 FRAME_PTR last_mouse_frame;
11120 /* Tool-bar item index of the item on which a mouse button was pressed
11121 or -1. */
11123 int last_tool_bar_item;
11126 static Lisp_Object
11127 update_tool_bar_unwind (Lisp_Object frame)
11129 selected_frame = frame;
11130 return Qnil;
11133 /* Update the tool-bar item list for frame F. This has to be done
11134 before we start to fill in any display lines. Called from
11135 prepare_menu_bars. If SAVE_MATCH_DATA is non-zero, we must save
11136 and restore it here. */
11138 static void
11139 update_tool_bar (struct frame *f, int save_match_data)
11141 #if defined (USE_GTK) || defined (HAVE_NS)
11142 int do_update = FRAME_EXTERNAL_TOOL_BAR (f);
11143 #else
11144 int do_update = WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
11145 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)) > 0;
11146 #endif
11148 if (do_update)
11150 Lisp_Object window;
11151 struct window *w;
11153 window = FRAME_SELECTED_WINDOW (f);
11154 w = XWINDOW (window);
11156 /* If the user has switched buffers or windows, we need to
11157 recompute to reflect the new bindings. But we'll
11158 recompute when update_mode_lines is set too; that means
11159 that people can use force-mode-line-update to request
11160 that the menu bar be recomputed. The adverse effect on
11161 the rest of the redisplay algorithm is about the same as
11162 windows_or_buffers_changed anyway. */
11163 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
11164 || !NILP (w->update_mode_line)
11165 || update_mode_lines
11166 || ((BUF_SAVE_MODIFF (XBUFFER (w->buffer))
11167 < BUF_MODIFF (XBUFFER (w->buffer)))
11168 != !NILP (w->last_had_star))
11169 || ((!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
11170 && !NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), mark_active)))
11171 != !NILP (w->region_showing)))
11173 struct buffer *prev = current_buffer;
11174 int count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
11175 Lisp_Object frame, new_tool_bar;
11176 int new_n_tool_bar;
11177 struct gcpro gcpro1;
11179 /* Set current_buffer to the buffer of the selected
11180 window of the frame, so that we get the right local
11181 keymaps. */
11182 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (w->buffer));
11184 /* Save match data, if we must. */
11185 if (save_match_data)
11186 record_unwind_save_match_data ();
11188 /* Make sure that we don't accidentally use bogus keymaps. */
11189 if (NILP (Voverriding_local_map_menu_flag))
11191 specbind (Qoverriding_terminal_local_map, Qnil);
11192 specbind (Qoverriding_local_map, Qnil);
11195 GCPRO1 (new_tool_bar);
11197 /* We must temporarily set the selected frame to this frame
11198 before calling tool_bar_items, because the calculation of
11199 the tool-bar keymap uses the selected frame (see
11200 `tool-bar-make-keymap' in tool-bar.el). */
11201 record_unwind_protect (update_tool_bar_unwind, selected_frame);
11202 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
11203 selected_frame = frame;
11205 /* Build desired tool-bar items from keymaps. */
11206 new_tool_bar = tool_bar_items (Fcopy_sequence (f->tool_bar_items),
11207 &new_n_tool_bar);
11209 /* Redisplay the tool-bar if we changed it. */
11210 if (new_n_tool_bar != f->n_tool_bar_items
11211 || NILP (Fequal (new_tool_bar, f->tool_bar_items)))
11213 /* Redisplay that happens asynchronously due to an expose event
11214 may access f->tool_bar_items. Make sure we update both
11215 variables within BLOCK_INPUT so no such event interrupts. */
11216 BLOCK_INPUT;
11217 f->tool_bar_items = new_tool_bar;
11218 f->n_tool_bar_items = new_n_tool_bar;
11219 w->update_mode_line = Qt;
11220 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11223 UNGCPRO;
11225 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
11226 set_buffer_internal_1 (prev);
11232 /* Set F->desired_tool_bar_string to a Lisp string representing frame
11233 F's desired tool-bar contents. F->tool_bar_items must have
11234 been set up previously by calling prepare_menu_bars. */
11236 static void
11237 build_desired_tool_bar_string (struct frame *f)
11239 int i, size, size_needed;
11240 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2, gcpro3;
11241 Lisp_Object image, plist, props;
11243 image = plist = props = Qnil;
11244 GCPRO3 (image, plist, props);
11246 /* Prepare F->desired_tool_bar_string. If we can reuse it, do so.
11247 Otherwise, make a new string. */
11249 /* The size of the string we might be able to reuse. */
11250 size = (STRINGP (f->desired_tool_bar_string)
11251 ? SCHARS (f->desired_tool_bar_string)
11252 : 0);
11254 /* We need one space in the string for each image. */
11255 size_needed = f->n_tool_bar_items;
11257 /* Reuse f->desired_tool_bar_string, if possible. */
11258 if (size < size_needed || NILP (f->desired_tool_bar_string))
11259 f->desired_tool_bar_string = Fmake_string (make_number (size_needed),
11260 make_number (' '));
11261 else
11263 props = list4 (Qdisplay, Qnil, Qmenu_item, Qnil);
11264 Fremove_text_properties (make_number (0), make_number (size),
11265 props, f->desired_tool_bar_string);
11268 /* Put a `display' property on the string for the images to display,
11269 put a `menu_item' property on tool-bar items with a value that
11270 is the index of the item in F's tool-bar item vector. */
11271 for (i = 0; i < f->n_tool_bar_items; ++i)
11273 #define PROP(IDX) AREF (f->tool_bar_items, i * TOOL_BAR_ITEM_NSLOTS + (IDX))
11275 int enabled_p = !NILP (PROP (TOOL_BAR_ITEM_ENABLED_P));
11276 int selected_p = !NILP (PROP (TOOL_BAR_ITEM_SELECTED_P));
11277 int hmargin, vmargin, relief, idx, end;
11279 /* If image is a vector, choose the image according to the
11280 button state. */
11281 image = PROP (TOOL_BAR_ITEM_IMAGES);
11282 if (VECTORP (image))
11284 if (enabled_p)
11285 idx = (selected_p
11286 ? TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_ENABLED_SELECTED
11287 : TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_ENABLED_DESELECTED);
11288 else
11289 idx = (selected_p
11290 ? TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_DISABLED_SELECTED
11291 : TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_DISABLED_DESELECTED);
11293 xassert (ASIZE (image) >= idx);
11294 image = AREF (image, idx);
11296 else
11297 idx = -1;
11299 /* Ignore invalid image specifications. */
11300 if (!valid_image_p (image))
11301 continue;
11303 /* Display the tool-bar button pressed, or depressed. */
11304 plist = Fcopy_sequence (XCDR (image));
11306 /* Compute margin and relief to draw. */
11307 relief = (tool_bar_button_relief >= 0
11308 ? tool_bar_button_relief
11309 : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF);
11310 hmargin = vmargin = relief;
11312 if (INTEGERP (Vtool_bar_button_margin)
11313 && XINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin) > 0)
11315 hmargin += XFASTINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin);
11316 vmargin += XFASTINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin);
11318 else if (CONSP (Vtool_bar_button_margin))
11320 if (INTEGERP (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin))
11321 && XINT (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin)) > 0)
11322 hmargin += XFASTINT (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin));
11324 if (INTEGERP (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin))
11325 && XINT (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin)) > 0)
11326 vmargin += XFASTINT (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin));
11329 if (auto_raise_tool_bar_buttons_p)
11331 /* Add a `:relief' property to the image spec if the item is
11332 selected. */
11333 if (selected_p)
11335 plist = Fplist_put (plist, QCrelief, make_number (-relief));
11336 hmargin -= relief;
11337 vmargin -= relief;
11340 else
11342 /* If image is selected, display it pressed, i.e. with a
11343 negative relief. If it's not selected, display it with a
11344 raised relief. */
11345 plist = Fplist_put (plist, QCrelief,
11346 (selected_p
11347 ? make_number (-relief)
11348 : make_number (relief)));
11349 hmargin -= relief;
11350 vmargin -= relief;
11353 /* Put a margin around the image. */
11354 if (hmargin || vmargin)
11356 if (hmargin == vmargin)
11357 plist = Fplist_put (plist, QCmargin, make_number (hmargin));
11358 else
11359 plist = Fplist_put (plist, QCmargin,
11360 Fcons (make_number (hmargin),
11361 make_number (vmargin)));
11364 /* If button is not enabled, and we don't have special images
11365 for the disabled state, make the image appear disabled by
11366 applying an appropriate algorithm to it. */
11367 if (!enabled_p && idx < 0)
11368 plist = Fplist_put (plist, QCconversion, Qdisabled);
11370 /* Put a `display' text property on the string for the image to
11371 display. Put a `menu-item' property on the string that gives
11372 the start of this item's properties in the tool-bar items
11373 vector. */
11374 image = Fcons (Qimage, plist);
11375 props = list4 (Qdisplay, image,
11376 Qmenu_item, make_number (i * TOOL_BAR_ITEM_NSLOTS));
11378 /* Let the last image hide all remaining spaces in the tool bar
11379 string. The string can be longer than needed when we reuse a
11380 previous string. */
11381 if (i + 1 == f->n_tool_bar_items)
11382 end = SCHARS (f->desired_tool_bar_string);
11383 else
11384 end = i + 1;
11385 Fadd_text_properties (make_number (i), make_number (end),
11386 props, f->desired_tool_bar_string);
11387 #undef PROP
11390 UNGCPRO;
11394 /* Display one line of the tool-bar of frame IT->f.
11396 HEIGHT specifies the desired height of the tool-bar line.
11397 If the actual height of the glyph row is less than HEIGHT, the
11398 row's height is increased to HEIGHT, and the icons are centered
11399 vertically in the new height.
11401 If HEIGHT is -1, we are counting needed tool-bar lines, so don't
11402 count a final empty row in case the tool-bar width exactly matches
11403 the window width.
11406 static void
11407 display_tool_bar_line (struct it *it, int height)
11409 struct glyph_row *row = it->glyph_row;
11410 int max_x = it->last_visible_x;
11411 struct glyph *last;
11413 prepare_desired_row (row);
11414 row->y = it->current_y;
11416 /* Note that this isn't made use of if the face hasn't a box,
11417 so there's no need to check the face here. */
11418 it->start_of_box_run_p = 1;
11420 while (it->current_x < max_x)
11422 int x, n_glyphs_before, i, nglyphs;
11423 struct it it_before;
11425 /* Get the next display element. */
11426 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
11428 /* Don't count empty row if we are counting needed tool-bar lines. */
11429 if (height < 0 && !it->hpos)
11430 return;
11431 break;
11434 /* Produce glyphs. */
11435 n_glyphs_before = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
11436 it_before = *it;
11438 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
11440 nglyphs = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - n_glyphs_before;
11441 i = 0;
11442 x = it_before.current_x;
11443 while (i < nglyphs)
11445 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + n_glyphs_before + i;
11447 if (x + glyph->pixel_width > max_x)
11449 /* Glyph doesn't fit on line. Backtrack. */
11450 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = n_glyphs_before;
11451 *it = it_before;
11452 /* If this is the only glyph on this line, it will never fit on the
11453 tool-bar, so skip it. But ensure there is at least one glyph,
11454 so we don't accidentally disable the tool-bar. */
11455 if (n_glyphs_before == 0
11456 && (it->vpos > 0 || IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) < it->end_charpos-1))
11457 break;
11458 goto out;
11461 ++it->hpos;
11462 x += glyph->pixel_width;
11463 ++i;
11466 /* Stop at line end. */
11467 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
11468 break;
11470 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
11473 out:;
11475 row->displays_text_p = row->used[TEXT_AREA] != 0;
11477 /* Use default face for the border below the tool bar.
11479 FIXME: When auto-resize-tool-bars is grow-only, there is
11480 no additional border below the possibly empty tool-bar lines.
11481 So to make the extra empty lines look "normal", we have to
11482 use the tool-bar face for the border too. */
11483 if (!row->displays_text_p && !EQ (Vauto_resize_tool_bars, Qgrow_only))
11484 it->face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
11486 extend_face_to_end_of_line (it);
11487 last = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
11488 last->right_box_line_p = 1;
11489 if (last == row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA])
11490 last->left_box_line_p = 1;
11492 /* Make line the desired height and center it vertically. */
11493 if ((height -= it->max_ascent + it->max_descent) > 0)
11495 /* Don't add more than one line height. */
11496 height %= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it->f);
11497 it->max_ascent += height / 2;
11498 it->max_descent += (height + 1) / 2;
11501 compute_line_metrics (it);
11503 /* If line is empty, make it occupy the rest of the tool-bar. */
11504 if (!row->displays_text_p)
11506 row->height = row->phys_height = it->last_visible_y - row->y;
11507 row->visible_height = row->height;
11508 row->ascent = row->phys_ascent = 0;
11509 row->extra_line_spacing = 0;
11512 row->full_width_p = 1;
11513 row->continued_p = 0;
11514 row->truncated_on_left_p = 0;
11515 row->truncated_on_right_p = 0;
11517 it->current_x = it->hpos = 0;
11518 it->current_y += row->height;
11519 ++it->vpos;
11520 ++it->glyph_row;
11524 /* Max tool-bar height. */
11526 #define MAX_FRAME_TOOL_BAR_HEIGHT(f) \
11527 ((FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) * FRAME_LINES (f)))
11529 /* Value is the number of screen lines needed to make all tool-bar
11530 items of frame F visible. The number of actual rows needed is
11531 returned in *N_ROWS if non-NULL. */
11533 static int
11534 tool_bar_lines_needed (struct frame *f, int *n_rows)
11536 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window);
11537 struct it it;
11538 /* tool_bar_lines_needed is called from redisplay_tool_bar after building
11539 the desired matrix, so use (unused) mode-line row as temporary row to
11540 avoid destroying the first tool-bar row. */
11541 struct glyph_row *temp_row = MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->desired_matrix);
11543 /* Initialize an iterator for iteration over
11544 F->desired_tool_bar_string in the tool-bar window of frame F. */
11545 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, temp_row, TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID);
11546 it.first_visible_x = 0;
11547 it.last_visible_x = FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
11548 reseat_to_string (&it, NULL, f->desired_tool_bar_string, 0, 0, 0, -1);
11549 it.paragraph_embedding = L2R;
11551 while (!ITERATOR_AT_END_P (&it))
11553 clear_glyph_row (temp_row);
11554 it.glyph_row = temp_row;
11555 display_tool_bar_line (&it, -1);
11557 clear_glyph_row (temp_row);
11559 /* f->n_tool_bar_rows == 0 means "unknown"; -1 means no tool-bar. */
11560 if (n_rows)
11561 *n_rows = it.vpos > 0 ? it.vpos : -1;
11563 return (it.current_y + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) - 1) / FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
11567 DEFUN ("tool-bar-lines-needed", Ftool_bar_lines_needed, Stool_bar_lines_needed,
11568 0, 1, 0,
11569 doc: /* Return the number of lines occupied by the tool bar of FRAME. */)
11570 (Lisp_Object frame)
11572 struct frame *f;
11573 struct window *w;
11574 int nlines = 0;
11576 if (NILP (frame))
11577 frame = selected_frame;
11578 else
11579 CHECK_FRAME (frame);
11580 f = XFRAME (frame);
11582 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
11583 && (w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window),
11584 WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) > 0))
11586 update_tool_bar (f, 1);
11587 if (f->n_tool_bar_items)
11589 build_desired_tool_bar_string (f);
11590 nlines = tool_bar_lines_needed (f, NULL);
11594 return make_number (nlines);
11598 /* Display the tool-bar of frame F. Value is non-zero if tool-bar's
11599 height should be changed. */
11601 static int
11602 redisplay_tool_bar (struct frame *f)
11604 struct window *w;
11605 struct it it;
11606 struct glyph_row *row;
11608 #if defined (USE_GTK) || defined (HAVE_NS)
11609 if (FRAME_EXTERNAL_TOOL_BAR (f))
11610 update_frame_tool_bar (f);
11611 return 0;
11612 #endif
11614 /* If frame hasn't a tool-bar window or if it is zero-height, don't
11615 do anything. This means you must start with tool-bar-lines
11616 non-zero to get the auto-sizing effect. Or in other words, you
11617 can turn off tool-bars by specifying tool-bar-lines zero. */
11618 if (!WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
11619 || (w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window),
11620 WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) == 0))
11621 return 0;
11623 /* Set up an iterator for the tool-bar window. */
11624 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, w->desired_matrix->rows, TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID);
11625 it.first_visible_x = 0;
11626 it.last_visible_x = FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
11627 row = it.glyph_row;
11629 /* Build a string that represents the contents of the tool-bar. */
11630 build_desired_tool_bar_string (f);
11631 reseat_to_string (&it, NULL, f->desired_tool_bar_string, 0, 0, 0, -1);
11632 /* FIXME: This should be controlled by a user option. But it
11633 doesn't make sense to have an R2L tool bar if the menu bar cannot
11634 be drawn also R2L, and making the menu bar R2L is tricky due
11635 toolkit-specific code that implements it. If an R2L tool bar is
11636 ever supported, display_tool_bar_line should also be augmented to
11637 call unproduce_glyphs like display_line and display_string
11638 do. */
11639 it.paragraph_embedding = L2R;
11641 if (f->n_tool_bar_rows == 0)
11643 int nlines;
11645 if ((nlines = tool_bar_lines_needed (f, &f->n_tool_bar_rows),
11646 nlines != WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w)))
11648 Lisp_Object frame;
11649 int old_height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
11651 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
11652 Fmodify_frame_parameters (frame,
11653 Fcons (Fcons (Qtool_bar_lines,
11654 make_number (nlines)),
11655 Qnil));
11656 if (WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) != old_height)
11658 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
11659 fonts_changed_p = 1;
11660 return 1;
11665 /* Display as many lines as needed to display all tool-bar items. */
11667 if (f->n_tool_bar_rows > 0)
11669 int border, rows, height, extra;
11671 if (INTEGERP (Vtool_bar_border))
11672 border = XINT (Vtool_bar_border);
11673 else if (EQ (Vtool_bar_border, Qinternal_border_width))
11674 border = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
11675 else if (EQ (Vtool_bar_border, Qborder_width))
11676 border = f->border_width;
11677 else
11678 border = 0;
11679 if (border < 0)
11680 border = 0;
11682 rows = f->n_tool_bar_rows;
11683 height = max (1, (it.last_visible_y - border) / rows);
11684 extra = it.last_visible_y - border - height * rows;
11686 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y)
11688 int h = 0;
11689 if (extra > 0 && rows-- > 0)
11691 h = (extra + rows - 1) / rows;
11692 extra -= h;
11694 display_tool_bar_line (&it, height + h);
11697 else
11699 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y)
11700 display_tool_bar_line (&it, 0);
11703 /* It doesn't make much sense to try scrolling in the tool-bar
11704 window, so don't do it. */
11705 w->desired_matrix->no_scrolling_p = 1;
11706 w->must_be_updated_p = 1;
11708 if (!NILP (Vauto_resize_tool_bars))
11710 int max_tool_bar_height = MAX_FRAME_TOOL_BAR_HEIGHT (f);
11711 int change_height_p = 0;
11713 /* If we couldn't display everything, change the tool-bar's
11714 height if there is room for more. */
11715 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (it) < it.end_charpos
11716 && it.current_y < max_tool_bar_height)
11717 change_height_p = 1;
11719 row = it.glyph_row - 1;
11721 /* If there are blank lines at the end, except for a partially
11722 visible blank line at the end that is smaller than
11723 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT, change the tool-bar's height. */
11724 if (!row->displays_text_p
11725 && row->height >= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
11726 change_height_p = 1;
11728 /* If row displays tool-bar items, but is partially visible,
11729 change the tool-bar's height. */
11730 if (row->displays_text_p
11731 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) > it.last_visible_y
11732 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < max_tool_bar_height)
11733 change_height_p = 1;
11735 /* Resize windows as needed by changing the `tool-bar-lines'
11736 frame parameter. */
11737 if (change_height_p)
11739 Lisp_Object frame;
11740 int old_height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
11741 int nrows;
11742 int nlines = tool_bar_lines_needed (f, &nrows);
11744 change_height_p = ((EQ (Vauto_resize_tool_bars, Qgrow_only)
11745 && !f->minimize_tool_bar_window_p)
11746 ? (nlines > old_height)
11747 : (nlines != old_height));
11748 f->minimize_tool_bar_window_p = 0;
11750 if (change_height_p)
11752 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
11753 Fmodify_frame_parameters (frame,
11754 Fcons (Fcons (Qtool_bar_lines,
11755 make_number (nlines)),
11756 Qnil));
11757 if (WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) != old_height)
11759 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
11760 f->n_tool_bar_rows = nrows;
11761 fonts_changed_p = 1;
11762 return 1;
11768 f->minimize_tool_bar_window_p = 0;
11769 return 0;
11773 /* Get information about the tool-bar item which is displayed in GLYPH
11774 on frame F. Return in *PROP_IDX the index where tool-bar item
11775 properties start in F->tool_bar_items. Value is zero if
11776 GLYPH doesn't display a tool-bar item. */
11778 static int
11779 tool_bar_item_info (struct frame *f, struct glyph *glyph, int *prop_idx)
11781 Lisp_Object prop;
11782 int success_p;
11783 int charpos;
11785 /* This function can be called asynchronously, which means we must
11786 exclude any possibility that Fget_text_property signals an
11787 error. */
11788 charpos = min (SCHARS (f->current_tool_bar_string), glyph->charpos);
11789 charpos = max (0, charpos);
11791 /* Get the text property `menu-item' at pos. The value of that
11792 property is the start index of this item's properties in
11793 F->tool_bar_items. */
11794 prop = Fget_text_property (make_number (charpos),
11795 Qmenu_item, f->current_tool_bar_string);
11796 if (INTEGERP (prop))
11798 *prop_idx = XINT (prop);
11799 success_p = 1;
11801 else
11802 success_p = 0;
11804 return success_p;
11808 /* Get information about the tool-bar item at position X/Y on frame F.
11809 Return in *GLYPH a pointer to the glyph of the tool-bar item in
11810 the current matrix of the tool-bar window of F, or NULL if not
11811 on a tool-bar item. Return in *PROP_IDX the index of the tool-bar
11812 item in F->tool_bar_items. Value is
11814 -1 if X/Y is not on a tool-bar item
11815 0 if X/Y is on the same item that was highlighted before.
11816 1 otherwise. */
11818 static int
11819 get_tool_bar_item (struct frame *f, int x, int y, struct glyph **glyph,
11820 int *hpos, int *vpos, int *prop_idx)
11822 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
11823 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window);
11824 int area;
11826 /* Find the glyph under X/Y. */
11827 *glyph = x_y_to_hpos_vpos (w, x, y, hpos, vpos, 0, 0, &area);
11828 if (*glyph == NULL)
11829 return -1;
11831 /* Get the start of this tool-bar item's properties in
11832 f->tool_bar_items. */
11833 if (!tool_bar_item_info (f, *glyph, prop_idx))
11834 return -1;
11836 /* Is mouse on the highlighted item? */
11837 if (EQ (f->tool_bar_window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)
11838 && *vpos >= hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
11839 && *vpos <= hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
11840 && (*vpos > hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
11841 || *hpos >= hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col)
11842 && (*vpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
11843 || *hpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col
11844 || hlinfo->mouse_face_past_end))
11845 return 0;
11847 return 1;
11851 /* EXPORT:
11852 Handle mouse button event on the tool-bar of frame F, at
11853 frame-relative coordinates X/Y. DOWN_P is 1 for a button press,
11854 0 for button release. MODIFIERS is event modifiers for button
11855 release. */
11857 void
11858 handle_tool_bar_click (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int down_p,
11859 unsigned int modifiers)
11861 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
11862 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window);
11863 int hpos, vpos, prop_idx;
11864 struct glyph *glyph;
11865 Lisp_Object enabled_p;
11867 /* If not on the highlighted tool-bar item, return. */
11868 frame_to_window_pixel_xy (w, &x, &y);
11869 if (get_tool_bar_item (f, x, y, &glyph, &hpos, &vpos, &prop_idx) != 0)
11870 return;
11872 /* If item is disabled, do nothing. */
11873 enabled_p = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_ENABLED_P);
11874 if (NILP (enabled_p))
11875 return;
11877 if (down_p)
11879 /* Show item in pressed state. */
11880 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN);
11881 hlinfo->mouse_face_image_state = DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN;
11882 last_tool_bar_item = prop_idx;
11884 else
11886 Lisp_Object key, frame;
11887 struct input_event event;
11888 EVENT_INIT (event);
11890 /* Show item in released state. */
11891 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED);
11892 hlinfo->mouse_face_image_state = DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
11894 key = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_KEY);
11896 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
11897 event.kind = TOOL_BAR_EVENT;
11898 event.frame_or_window = frame;
11899 event.arg = frame;
11900 kbd_buffer_store_event (&event);
11902 event.kind = TOOL_BAR_EVENT;
11903 event.frame_or_window = frame;
11904 event.arg = key;
11905 event.modifiers = modifiers;
11906 kbd_buffer_store_event (&event);
11907 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
11912 /* Possibly highlight a tool-bar item on frame F when mouse moves to
11913 tool-bar window-relative coordinates X/Y. Called from
11914 note_mouse_highlight. */
11916 static void
11917 note_tool_bar_highlight (struct frame *f, int x, int y)
11919 Lisp_Object window = f->tool_bar_window;
11920 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
11921 Display_Info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
11922 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
11923 int hpos, vpos;
11924 struct glyph *glyph;
11925 struct glyph_row *row;
11926 int i;
11927 Lisp_Object enabled_p;
11928 int prop_idx;
11929 enum draw_glyphs_face draw = DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
11930 int mouse_down_p, rc;
11932 /* Function note_mouse_highlight is called with negative X/Y
11933 values when mouse moves outside of the frame. */
11934 if (x <= 0 || y <= 0)
11936 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
11937 return;
11940 rc = get_tool_bar_item (f, x, y, &glyph, &hpos, &vpos, &prop_idx);
11941 if (rc < 0)
11943 /* Not on tool-bar item. */
11944 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
11945 return;
11947 else if (rc == 0)
11948 /* On same tool-bar item as before. */
11949 goto set_help_echo;
11951 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
11953 /* Mouse is down, but on different tool-bar item? */
11954 mouse_down_p = (dpyinfo->grabbed
11955 && f == last_mouse_frame
11956 && FRAME_LIVE_P (f));
11957 if (mouse_down_p
11958 && last_tool_bar_item != prop_idx)
11959 return;
11961 hlinfo->mouse_face_image_state = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
11962 draw = mouse_down_p ? DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN : DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
11964 /* If tool-bar item is not enabled, don't highlight it. */
11965 enabled_p = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_ENABLED_P);
11966 if (!NILP (enabled_p))
11968 /* Compute the x-position of the glyph. In front and past the
11969 image is a space. We include this in the highlighted area. */
11970 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
11971 for (i = x = 0; i < hpos; ++i)
11972 x += row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][i].pixel_width;
11974 /* Record this as the current active region. */
11975 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = hpos;
11976 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = vpos;
11977 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = x;
11978 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_y = row->y;
11979 hlinfo->mouse_face_past_end = 0;
11981 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = hpos + 1;
11982 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = vpos;
11983 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = x + glyph->pixel_width;
11984 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_y = row->y;
11985 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
11986 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id = TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID;
11988 /* Display it as active. */
11989 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, draw);
11990 hlinfo->mouse_face_image_state = draw;
11993 set_help_echo:
11995 /* Set help_echo_string to a help string to display for this tool-bar item.
11996 XTread_socket does the rest. */
11997 help_echo_object = help_echo_window = Qnil;
11998 help_echo_pos = -1;
11999 help_echo_string = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_HELP);
12000 if (NILP (help_echo_string))
12001 help_echo_string = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_CAPTION);
12004 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
12008 /************************************************************************
12009 Horizontal scrolling
12010 ************************************************************************/
12012 static int hscroll_window_tree (Lisp_Object);
12013 static int hscroll_windows (Lisp_Object);
12015 /* For all leaf windows in the window tree rooted at WINDOW, set their
12016 hscroll value so that PT is (i) visible in the window, and (ii) so
12017 that it is not within a certain margin at the window's left and
12018 right border. Value is non-zero if any window's hscroll has been
12019 changed. */
12021 static int
12022 hscroll_window_tree (Lisp_Object window)
12024 int hscrolled_p = 0;
12025 int hscroll_relative_p = FLOATP (Vhscroll_step);
12026 int hscroll_step_abs = 0;
12027 double hscroll_step_rel = 0;
12029 if (hscroll_relative_p)
12031 hscroll_step_rel = XFLOAT_DATA (Vhscroll_step);
12032 if (hscroll_step_rel < 0)
12034 hscroll_relative_p = 0;
12035 hscroll_step_abs = 0;
12038 else if (INTEGERP (Vhscroll_step))
12040 hscroll_step_abs = XINT (Vhscroll_step);
12041 if (hscroll_step_abs < 0)
12042 hscroll_step_abs = 0;
12044 else
12045 hscroll_step_abs = 0;
12047 while (WINDOWP (window))
12049 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
12051 if (WINDOWP (w->hchild))
12052 hscrolled_p |= hscroll_window_tree (w->hchild);
12053 else if (WINDOWP (w->vchild))
12054 hscrolled_p |= hscroll_window_tree (w->vchild);
12055 else if (w->cursor.vpos >= 0)
12057 int h_margin;
12058 int text_area_width;
12059 struct glyph_row *current_cursor_row
12060 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->cursor.vpos);
12061 struct glyph_row *desired_cursor_row
12062 = MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix, w->cursor.vpos);
12063 struct glyph_row *cursor_row
12064 = (desired_cursor_row->enabled_p
12065 ? desired_cursor_row
12066 : current_cursor_row);
12067 int row_r2l_p = cursor_row->reversed_p;
12069 text_area_width = window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA);
12071 /* Scroll when cursor is inside this scroll margin. */
12072 h_margin = hscroll_margin * WINDOW_FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (w);
12074 if (!NILP (Fbuffer_local_value (Qauto_hscroll_mode, w->buffer))
12075 /* For left-to-right rows, hscroll when cursor is either
12076 (i) inside the right hscroll margin, or (ii) if it is
12077 inside the left margin and the window is already
12078 hscrolled. */
12079 && ((!row_r2l_p
12080 && ((XFASTINT (w->hscroll)
12081 && w->cursor.x <= h_margin)
12082 || (cursor_row->enabled_p
12083 && cursor_row->truncated_on_right_p
12084 && (w->cursor.x >= text_area_width - h_margin))))
12085 /* For right-to-left rows, the logic is similar,
12086 except that rules for scrolling to left and right
12087 are reversed. E.g., if cursor.x <= h_margin, we
12088 need to hscroll "to the right" unconditionally,
12089 and that will scroll the screen to the left so as
12090 to reveal the next portion of the row. */
12091 || (row_r2l_p
12092 && ((cursor_row->enabled_p
12093 /* FIXME: It is confusing to set the
12094 truncated_on_right_p flag when R2L rows
12095 are actually truncated on the left. */
12096 && cursor_row->truncated_on_right_p
12097 && w->cursor.x <= h_margin)
12098 || (XFASTINT (w->hscroll)
12099 && (w->cursor.x >= text_area_width - h_margin))))))
12101 struct it it;
12102 int hscroll;
12103 struct buffer *saved_current_buffer;
12104 EMACS_INT pt;
12105 int wanted_x;
12107 /* Find point in a display of infinite width. */
12108 saved_current_buffer = current_buffer;
12109 current_buffer = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
12111 if (w == XWINDOW (selected_window))
12112 pt = PT;
12113 else
12115 pt = marker_position (w->pointm);
12116 pt = max (BEGV, pt);
12117 pt = min (ZV, pt);
12120 /* Move iterator to pt starting at cursor_row->start in
12121 a line with infinite width. */
12122 init_to_row_start (&it, w, cursor_row);
12123 it.last_visible_x = INFINITY;
12124 move_it_in_display_line_to (&it, pt, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
12125 current_buffer = saved_current_buffer;
12127 /* Position cursor in window. */
12128 if (!hscroll_relative_p && hscroll_step_abs == 0)
12129 hscroll = max (0, (it.current_x
12130 - (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (&it)
12131 ? (text_area_width - 4 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it.f))
12132 : (text_area_width / 2))))
12133 / FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it.f);
12134 else if ((!row_r2l_p
12135 && w->cursor.x >= text_area_width - h_margin)
12136 || (row_r2l_p && w->cursor.x <= h_margin))
12138 if (hscroll_relative_p)
12139 wanted_x = text_area_width * (1 - hscroll_step_rel)
12140 - h_margin;
12141 else
12142 wanted_x = text_area_width
12143 - hscroll_step_abs * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it.f)
12144 - h_margin;
12145 hscroll
12146 = max (0, it.current_x - wanted_x) / FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it.f);
12148 else
12150 if (hscroll_relative_p)
12151 wanted_x = text_area_width * hscroll_step_rel
12152 + h_margin;
12153 else
12154 wanted_x = hscroll_step_abs * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it.f)
12155 + h_margin;
12156 hscroll
12157 = max (0, it.current_x - wanted_x) / FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it.f);
12159 hscroll = max (hscroll, XFASTINT (w->min_hscroll));
12161 /* Don't prevent redisplay optimizations if hscroll
12162 hasn't changed, as it will unnecessarily slow down
12163 redisplay. */
12164 if (XFASTINT (w->hscroll) != hscroll)
12166 XBUFFER (w->buffer)->prevent_redisplay_optimizations_p = 1;
12167 w->hscroll = make_number (hscroll);
12168 hscrolled_p = 1;
12173 window = w->next;
12176 /* Value is non-zero if hscroll of any leaf window has been changed. */
12177 return hscrolled_p;
12181 /* Set hscroll so that cursor is visible and not inside horizontal
12182 scroll margins for all windows in the tree rooted at WINDOW. See
12183 also hscroll_window_tree above. Value is non-zero if any window's
12184 hscroll has been changed. If it has, desired matrices on the frame
12185 of WINDOW are cleared. */
12187 static int
12188 hscroll_windows (Lisp_Object window)
12190 int hscrolled_p = hscroll_window_tree (window);
12191 if (hscrolled_p)
12192 clear_desired_matrices (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (window))));
12193 return hscrolled_p;
12198 /************************************************************************
12199 Redisplay
12200 ************************************************************************/
12202 /* Variables holding some state of redisplay if GLYPH_DEBUG is defined
12203 to a non-zero value. This is sometimes handy to have in a debugger
12204 session. */
12206 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
12208 /* First and last unchanged row for try_window_id. */
12210 static int debug_first_unchanged_at_end_vpos;
12211 static int debug_last_unchanged_at_beg_vpos;
12213 /* Delta vpos and y. */
12215 static int debug_dvpos, debug_dy;
12217 /* Delta in characters and bytes for try_window_id. */
12219 static EMACS_INT debug_delta, debug_delta_bytes;
12221 /* Values of window_end_pos and window_end_vpos at the end of
12222 try_window_id. */
12224 static EMACS_INT debug_end_vpos;
12226 /* Append a string to W->desired_matrix->method. FMT is a printf
12227 format string. If trace_redisplay_p is non-zero also printf the
12228 resulting string to stderr. */
12230 static void debug_method_add (struct window *, char const *, ...)
12231 ATTRIBUTE_FORMAT_PRINTF (2, 3);
12233 static void
12234 debug_method_add (struct window *w, char const *fmt, ...)
12236 char buffer[512];
12237 char *method = w->desired_matrix->method;
12238 int len = strlen (method);
12239 int size = sizeof w->desired_matrix->method;
12240 int remaining = size - len - 1;
12241 va_list ap;
12243 va_start (ap, fmt);
12244 vsprintf (buffer, fmt, ap);
12245 va_end (ap);
12246 if (len && remaining)
12248 method[len] = '|';
12249 --remaining, ++len;
12252 strncpy (method + len, buffer, remaining);
12254 if (trace_redisplay_p)
12255 fprintf (stderr, "%p (%s): %s\n",
12257 ((BUFFERP (w->buffer)
12258 && STRINGP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), name)))
12259 ? SSDATA (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), name))
12260 : "no buffer"),
12261 buffer);
12264 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
12267 /* Value is non-zero if all changes in window W, which displays
12268 current_buffer, are in the text between START and END. START is a
12269 buffer position, END is given as a distance from Z. Used in
12270 redisplay_internal for display optimization. */
12272 static inline int
12273 text_outside_line_unchanged_p (struct window *w,
12274 EMACS_INT start, EMACS_INT end)
12276 int unchanged_p = 1;
12278 /* If text or overlays have changed, see where. */
12279 if (XFASTINT (w->last_modified) < MODIFF
12280 || XFASTINT (w->last_overlay_modified) < OVERLAY_MODIFF)
12282 /* Gap in the line? */
12283 if (GPT < start || Z - GPT < end)
12284 unchanged_p = 0;
12286 /* Changes start in front of the line, or end after it? */
12287 if (unchanged_p
12288 && (BEG_UNCHANGED < start - 1
12289 || END_UNCHANGED < end))
12290 unchanged_p = 0;
12292 /* If selective display, can't optimize if changes start at the
12293 beginning of the line. */
12294 if (unchanged_p
12295 && INTEGERP (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display))
12296 && XINT (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display)) > 0
12297 && (BEG_UNCHANGED < start || GPT <= start))
12298 unchanged_p = 0;
12300 /* If there are overlays at the start or end of the line, these
12301 may have overlay strings with newlines in them. A change at
12302 START, for instance, may actually concern the display of such
12303 overlay strings as well, and they are displayed on different
12304 lines. So, quickly rule out this case. (For the future, it
12305 might be desirable to implement something more telling than
12306 just BEG/END_UNCHANGED.) */
12307 if (unchanged_p)
12309 if (BEG + BEG_UNCHANGED == start
12310 && overlay_touches_p (start))
12311 unchanged_p = 0;
12312 if (END_UNCHANGED == end
12313 && overlay_touches_p (Z - end))
12314 unchanged_p = 0;
12317 /* Under bidi reordering, adding or deleting a character in the
12318 beginning of a paragraph, before the first strong directional
12319 character, can change the base direction of the paragraph (unless
12320 the buffer specifies a fixed paragraph direction), which will
12321 require to redisplay the whole paragraph. It might be worthwhile
12322 to find the paragraph limits and widen the range of redisplayed
12323 lines to that, but for now just give up this optimization. */
12324 if (!NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_display_reordering))
12325 && NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_paragraph_direction)))
12326 unchanged_p = 0;
12329 return unchanged_p;
12333 /* Do a frame update, taking possible shortcuts into account. This is
12334 the main external entry point for redisplay.
12336 If the last redisplay displayed an echo area message and that message
12337 is no longer requested, we clear the echo area or bring back the
12338 mini-buffer if that is in use. */
12340 void
12341 redisplay (void)
12343 redisplay_internal ();
12347 static Lisp_Object
12348 overlay_arrow_string_or_property (Lisp_Object var)
12350 Lisp_Object val;
12352 if (val = Fget (var, Qoverlay_arrow_string), STRINGP (val))
12353 return val;
12355 return Voverlay_arrow_string;
12358 /* Return 1 if there are any overlay-arrows in current_buffer. */
12359 static int
12360 overlay_arrow_in_current_buffer_p (void)
12362 Lisp_Object vlist;
12364 for (vlist = Voverlay_arrow_variable_list;
12365 CONSP (vlist);
12366 vlist = XCDR (vlist))
12368 Lisp_Object var = XCAR (vlist);
12369 Lisp_Object val;
12371 if (!SYMBOLP (var))
12372 continue;
12373 val = find_symbol_value (var);
12374 if (MARKERP (val)
12375 && current_buffer == XMARKER (val)->buffer)
12376 return 1;
12378 return 0;
12382 /* Return 1 if any overlay_arrows have moved or overlay-arrow-string
12383 has changed. */
12385 static int
12386 overlay_arrows_changed_p (void)
12388 Lisp_Object vlist;
12390 for (vlist = Voverlay_arrow_variable_list;
12391 CONSP (vlist);
12392 vlist = XCDR (vlist))
12394 Lisp_Object var = XCAR (vlist);
12395 Lisp_Object val, pstr;
12397 if (!SYMBOLP (var))
12398 continue;
12399 val = find_symbol_value (var);
12400 if (!MARKERP (val))
12401 continue;
12402 if (! EQ (COERCE_MARKER (val),
12403 Fget (var, Qlast_arrow_position))
12404 || ! (pstr = overlay_arrow_string_or_property (var),
12405 EQ (pstr, Fget (var, Qlast_arrow_string))))
12406 return 1;
12408 return 0;
12411 /* Mark overlay arrows to be updated on next redisplay. */
12413 static void
12414 update_overlay_arrows (int up_to_date)
12416 Lisp_Object vlist;
12418 for (vlist = Voverlay_arrow_variable_list;
12419 CONSP (vlist);
12420 vlist = XCDR (vlist))
12422 Lisp_Object var = XCAR (vlist);
12424 if (!SYMBOLP (var))
12425 continue;
12427 if (up_to_date > 0)
12429 Lisp_Object val = find_symbol_value (var);
12430 Fput (var, Qlast_arrow_position,
12431 COERCE_MARKER (val));
12432 Fput (var, Qlast_arrow_string,
12433 overlay_arrow_string_or_property (var));
12435 else if (up_to_date < 0
12436 || !NILP (Fget (var, Qlast_arrow_position)))
12438 Fput (var, Qlast_arrow_position, Qt);
12439 Fput (var, Qlast_arrow_string, Qt);
12445 /* Return overlay arrow string to display at row.
12446 Return integer (bitmap number) for arrow bitmap in left fringe.
12447 Return nil if no overlay arrow. */
12449 static Lisp_Object
12450 overlay_arrow_at_row (struct it *it, struct glyph_row *row)
12452 Lisp_Object vlist;
12454 for (vlist = Voverlay_arrow_variable_list;
12455 CONSP (vlist);
12456 vlist = XCDR (vlist))
12458 Lisp_Object var = XCAR (vlist);
12459 Lisp_Object val;
12461 if (!SYMBOLP (var))
12462 continue;
12464 val = find_symbol_value (var);
12466 if (MARKERP (val)
12467 && current_buffer == XMARKER (val)->buffer
12468 && (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) == marker_position (val)))
12470 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
12471 /* FIXME: if ROW->reversed_p is set, this should test
12472 the right fringe, not the left one. */
12473 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w) > 0)
12475 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
12476 if (val = Fget (var, Qoverlay_arrow_bitmap), SYMBOLP (val))
12478 int fringe_bitmap;
12479 if ((fringe_bitmap = lookup_fringe_bitmap (val)) != 0)
12480 return make_number (fringe_bitmap);
12482 #endif
12483 return make_number (-1); /* Use default arrow bitmap */
12485 return overlay_arrow_string_or_property (var);
12489 return Qnil;
12492 /* Return 1 if point moved out of or into a composition. Otherwise
12493 return 0. PREV_BUF and PREV_PT are the last point buffer and
12494 position. BUF and PT are the current point buffer and position. */
12496 static int
12497 check_point_in_composition (struct buffer *prev_buf, EMACS_INT prev_pt,
12498 struct buffer *buf, EMACS_INT pt)
12500 EMACS_INT start, end;
12501 Lisp_Object prop;
12502 Lisp_Object buffer;
12504 XSETBUFFER (buffer, buf);
12505 /* Check a composition at the last point if point moved within the
12506 same buffer. */
12507 if (prev_buf == buf)
12509 if (prev_pt == pt)
12510 /* Point didn't move. */
12511 return 0;
12513 if (prev_pt > BUF_BEGV (buf) && prev_pt < BUF_ZV (buf)
12514 && find_composition (prev_pt, -1, &start, &end, &prop, buffer)
12515 && COMPOSITION_VALID_P (start, end, prop)
12516 && start < prev_pt && end > prev_pt)
12517 /* The last point was within the composition. Return 1 iff
12518 point moved out of the composition. */
12519 return (pt <= start || pt >= end);
12522 /* Check a composition at the current point. */
12523 return (pt > BUF_BEGV (buf) && pt < BUF_ZV (buf)
12524 && find_composition (pt, -1, &start, &end, &prop, buffer)
12525 && COMPOSITION_VALID_P (start, end, prop)
12526 && start < pt && end > pt);
12530 /* Reconsider the setting of B->clip_changed which is displayed
12531 in window W. */
12533 static inline void
12534 reconsider_clip_changes (struct window *w, struct buffer *b)
12536 if (b->clip_changed
12537 && !NILP (w->window_end_valid)
12538 && w->current_matrix->buffer == b
12539 && w->current_matrix->zv == BUF_ZV (b)
12540 && w->current_matrix->begv == BUF_BEGV (b))
12541 b->clip_changed = 0;
12543 /* If display wasn't paused, and W is not a tool bar window, see if
12544 point has been moved into or out of a composition. In that case,
12545 we set b->clip_changed to 1 to force updating the screen. If
12546 b->clip_changed has already been set to 1, we can skip this
12547 check. */
12548 if (!b->clip_changed
12549 && BUFFERP (w->buffer) && !NILP (w->window_end_valid))
12551 EMACS_INT pt;
12553 if (w == XWINDOW (selected_window))
12554 pt = PT;
12555 else
12556 pt = marker_position (w->pointm);
12558 if ((w->current_matrix->buffer != XBUFFER (w->buffer)
12559 || pt != XINT (w->last_point))
12560 && check_point_in_composition (w->current_matrix->buffer,
12561 XINT (w->last_point),
12562 XBUFFER (w->buffer), pt))
12563 b->clip_changed = 1;
12568 /* Select FRAME to forward the values of frame-local variables into C
12569 variables so that the redisplay routines can access those values
12570 directly. */
12572 static void
12573 select_frame_for_redisplay (Lisp_Object frame)
12575 Lisp_Object tail, tem;
12576 Lisp_Object old = selected_frame;
12577 struct Lisp_Symbol *sym;
12579 xassert (FRAMEP (frame) && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (frame)));
12581 selected_frame = frame;
12583 do {
12584 for (tail = XFRAME (frame)->param_alist; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
12585 if (CONSP (XCAR (tail))
12586 && (tem = XCAR (XCAR (tail)),
12587 SYMBOLP (tem))
12588 && (sym = indirect_variable (XSYMBOL (tem)),
12589 sym->redirect == SYMBOL_LOCALIZED)
12590 && sym->val.blv->frame_local)
12591 /* Use find_symbol_value rather than Fsymbol_value
12592 to avoid an error if it is void. */
12593 find_symbol_value (tem);
12594 } while (!EQ (frame, old) && (frame = old, 1));
12598 #define STOP_POLLING \
12599 do { if (! polling_stopped_here) stop_polling (); \
12600 polling_stopped_here = 1; } while (0)
12602 #define RESUME_POLLING \
12603 do { if (polling_stopped_here) start_polling (); \
12604 polling_stopped_here = 0; } while (0)
12607 /* Perhaps in the future avoid recentering windows if it
12608 is not necessary; currently that causes some problems. */
12610 static void
12611 redisplay_internal (void)
12613 struct window *w = XWINDOW (selected_window);
12614 struct window *sw;
12615 struct frame *fr;
12616 int pending;
12617 int must_finish = 0;
12618 struct text_pos tlbufpos, tlendpos;
12619 int number_of_visible_frames;
12620 int count, count1;
12621 struct frame *sf;
12622 int polling_stopped_here = 0;
12623 Lisp_Object old_frame = selected_frame;
12625 /* Non-zero means redisplay has to consider all windows on all
12626 frames. Zero means, only selected_window is considered. */
12627 int consider_all_windows_p;
12629 TRACE ((stderr, "redisplay_internal %d\n", redisplaying_p));
12631 /* No redisplay if running in batch mode or frame is not yet fully
12632 initialized, or redisplay is explicitly turned off by setting
12633 Vinhibit_redisplay. */
12634 if (FRAME_INITIAL_P (SELECTED_FRAME ())
12635 || !NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
12636 return;
12638 /* Don't examine these until after testing Vinhibit_redisplay.
12639 When Emacs is shutting down, perhaps because its connection to
12640 X has dropped, we should not look at them at all. */
12641 fr = XFRAME (w->frame);
12642 sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
12644 if (!fr->glyphs_initialized_p)
12645 return;
12647 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK) || defined (HAVE_NS)
12648 if (popup_activated ())
12649 return;
12650 #endif
12652 /* I don't think this happens but let's be paranoid. */
12653 if (redisplaying_p)
12654 return;
12656 /* Record a function that resets redisplaying_p to its old value
12657 when we leave this function. */
12658 count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
12659 record_unwind_protect (unwind_redisplay,
12660 Fcons (make_number (redisplaying_p), selected_frame));
12661 ++redisplaying_p;
12662 specbind (Qinhibit_free_realized_faces, Qnil);
12665 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
12667 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
12669 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
12670 f->already_hscrolled_p = 0;
12674 retry:
12675 /* Remember the currently selected window. */
12676 sw = w;
12678 if (!EQ (old_frame, selected_frame)
12679 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (old_frame)))
12680 /* When running redisplay, we play a bit fast-and-loose and allow e.g.
12681 selected_frame and selected_window to be temporarily out-of-sync so
12682 when we come back here via `goto retry', we need to resync because we
12683 may need to run Elisp code (via prepare_menu_bars). */
12684 select_frame_for_redisplay (old_frame);
12686 pending = 0;
12687 reconsider_clip_changes (w, current_buffer);
12688 last_escape_glyph_frame = NULL;
12689 last_escape_glyph_face_id = (1 << FACE_ID_BITS);
12690 last_glyphless_glyph_frame = NULL;
12691 last_glyphless_glyph_face_id = (1 << FACE_ID_BITS);
12693 /* If new fonts have been loaded that make a glyph matrix adjustment
12694 necessary, do it. */
12695 if (fonts_changed_p)
12697 adjust_glyphs (NULL);
12698 ++windows_or_buffers_changed;
12699 fonts_changed_p = 0;
12702 /* If face_change_count is non-zero, init_iterator will free all
12703 realized faces, which includes the faces referenced from current
12704 matrices. So, we can't reuse current matrices in this case. */
12705 if (face_change_count)
12706 ++windows_or_buffers_changed;
12708 if ((FRAME_TERMCAP_P (sf) || FRAME_MSDOS_P (sf))
12709 && FRAME_TTY (sf)->previous_frame != sf)
12711 /* Since frames on a single ASCII terminal share the same
12712 display area, displaying a different frame means redisplay
12713 the whole thing. */
12714 windows_or_buffers_changed++;
12715 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (sf);
12716 #ifndef DOS_NT
12717 set_tty_color_mode (FRAME_TTY (sf), sf);
12718 #endif
12719 FRAME_TTY (sf)->previous_frame = sf;
12722 /* Set the visible flags for all frames. Do this before checking
12723 for resized or garbaged frames; they want to know if their frames
12724 are visible. See the comment in frame.h for
12725 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY. */
12727 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
12729 number_of_visible_frames = 0;
12731 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
12733 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
12735 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
12736 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
12737 ++number_of_visible_frames;
12738 clear_desired_matrices (f);
12742 /* Notice any pending interrupt request to change frame size. */
12743 do_pending_window_change (1);
12745 /* do_pending_window_change could change the selected_window due to
12746 frame resizing which makes the selected window too small. */
12747 if (WINDOWP (selected_window) && (w = XWINDOW (selected_window)) != sw)
12749 sw = w;
12750 reconsider_clip_changes (w, current_buffer);
12753 /* Clear frames marked as garbaged. */
12754 if (frame_garbaged)
12755 clear_garbaged_frames ();
12757 /* Build menubar and tool-bar items. */
12758 if (NILP (Vmemory_full))
12759 prepare_menu_bars ();
12761 if (windows_or_buffers_changed)
12762 update_mode_lines++;
12764 /* Detect case that we need to write or remove a star in the mode line. */
12765 if ((SAVE_MODIFF < MODIFF) != !NILP (w->last_had_star))
12767 w->update_mode_line = Qt;
12768 if (buffer_shared > 1)
12769 update_mode_lines++;
12772 /* Avoid invocation of point motion hooks by `current_column' below. */
12773 count1 = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
12774 specbind (Qinhibit_point_motion_hooks, Qt);
12776 /* If %c is in the mode line, update it if needed. */
12777 if (!NILP (w->column_number_displayed)
12778 /* This alternative quickly identifies a common case
12779 where no change is needed. */
12780 && !(PT == XFASTINT (w->last_point)
12781 && XFASTINT (w->last_modified) >= MODIFF
12782 && XFASTINT (w->last_overlay_modified) >= OVERLAY_MODIFF)
12783 && (XFASTINT (w->column_number_displayed) != current_column ()))
12784 w->update_mode_line = Qt;
12786 unbind_to (count1, Qnil);
12788 FRAME_SCROLL_BOTTOM_VPOS (XFRAME (w->frame)) = -1;
12790 /* The variable buffer_shared is set in redisplay_window and
12791 indicates that we redisplay a buffer in different windows. See
12792 there. */
12793 consider_all_windows_p = (update_mode_lines || buffer_shared > 1
12794 || cursor_type_changed);
12796 /* If specs for an arrow have changed, do thorough redisplay
12797 to ensure we remove any arrow that should no longer exist. */
12798 if (overlay_arrows_changed_p ())
12799 consider_all_windows_p = windows_or_buffers_changed = 1;
12801 /* Normally the message* functions will have already displayed and
12802 updated the echo area, but the frame may have been trashed, or
12803 the update may have been preempted, so display the echo area
12804 again here. Checking message_cleared_p captures the case that
12805 the echo area should be cleared. */
12806 if ((!NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]) && !display_last_displayed_message_p)
12807 || (!NILP (echo_area_buffer[1]) && display_last_displayed_message_p)
12808 || (message_cleared_p
12809 && minibuf_level == 0
12810 /* If the mini-window is currently selected, this means the
12811 echo-area doesn't show through. */
12812 && !MINI_WINDOW_P (XWINDOW (selected_window))))
12814 int window_height_changed_p = echo_area_display (0);
12815 must_finish = 1;
12817 /* If we don't display the current message, don't clear the
12818 message_cleared_p flag, because, if we did, we wouldn't clear
12819 the echo area in the next redisplay which doesn't preserve
12820 the echo area. */
12821 if (!display_last_displayed_message_p)
12822 message_cleared_p = 0;
12824 if (fonts_changed_p)
12825 goto retry;
12826 else if (window_height_changed_p)
12828 consider_all_windows_p = 1;
12829 ++update_mode_lines;
12830 ++windows_or_buffers_changed;
12832 /* If window configuration was changed, frames may have been
12833 marked garbaged. Clear them or we will experience
12834 surprises wrt scrolling. */
12835 if (frame_garbaged)
12836 clear_garbaged_frames ();
12839 else if (EQ (selected_window, minibuf_window)
12840 && (current_buffer->clip_changed
12841 || XFASTINT (w->last_modified) < MODIFF
12842 || XFASTINT (w->last_overlay_modified) < OVERLAY_MODIFF)
12843 && resize_mini_window (w, 0))
12845 /* Resized active mini-window to fit the size of what it is
12846 showing if its contents might have changed. */
12847 must_finish = 1;
12848 /* FIXME: this causes all frames to be updated, which seems unnecessary
12849 since only the current frame needs to be considered. This function needs
12850 to be rewritten with two variables, consider_all_windows and
12851 consider_all_frames. */
12852 consider_all_windows_p = 1;
12853 ++windows_or_buffers_changed;
12854 ++update_mode_lines;
12856 /* If window configuration was changed, frames may have been
12857 marked garbaged. Clear them or we will experience
12858 surprises wrt scrolling. */
12859 if (frame_garbaged)
12860 clear_garbaged_frames ();
12864 /* If showing the region, and mark has changed, we must redisplay
12865 the whole window. The assignment to this_line_start_pos prevents
12866 the optimization directly below this if-statement. */
12867 if (((!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
12868 && !NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), mark_active)))
12869 != !NILP (w->region_showing))
12870 || (!NILP (w->region_showing)
12871 && !EQ (w->region_showing,
12872 Fmarker_position (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), mark)))))
12873 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos) = 0;
12875 /* Optimize the case that only the line containing the cursor in the
12876 selected window has changed. Variables starting with this_ are
12877 set in display_line and record information about the line
12878 containing the cursor. */
12879 tlbufpos = this_line_start_pos;
12880 tlendpos = this_line_end_pos;
12881 if (!consider_all_windows_p
12882 && CHARPOS (tlbufpos) > 0
12883 && NILP (w->update_mode_line)
12884 && !current_buffer->clip_changed
12885 && !current_buffer->prevent_redisplay_optimizations_p
12886 && FRAME_VISIBLE_P (XFRAME (w->frame))
12887 && !FRAME_OBSCURED_P (XFRAME (w->frame))
12888 /* Make sure recorded data applies to current buffer, etc. */
12889 && this_line_buffer == current_buffer
12890 && current_buffer == XBUFFER (w->buffer)
12891 && NILP (w->force_start)
12892 && NILP (w->optional_new_start)
12893 /* Point must be on the line that we have info recorded about. */
12894 && PT >= CHARPOS (tlbufpos)
12895 && PT <= Z - CHARPOS (tlendpos)
12896 /* All text outside that line, including its final newline,
12897 must be unchanged. */
12898 && text_outside_line_unchanged_p (w, CHARPOS (tlbufpos),
12899 CHARPOS (tlendpos)))
12901 if (CHARPOS (tlbufpos) > BEGV
12902 && FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (tlbufpos) - 1) != '\n'
12903 && (CHARPOS (tlbufpos) == ZV
12904 || FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (tlbufpos)) == '\n'))
12905 /* Former continuation line has disappeared by becoming empty. */
12906 goto cancel;
12907 else if (XFASTINT (w->last_modified) < MODIFF
12908 || XFASTINT (w->last_overlay_modified) < OVERLAY_MODIFF
12909 || MINI_WINDOW_P (w))
12911 /* We have to handle the case of continuation around a
12912 wide-column character (see the comment in indent.c around
12913 line 1340).
12915 For instance, in the following case:
12917 -------- Insert --------
12918 K_A_N_\\ `a' K_A_N_a\ `X_' are wide-column chars.
12919 J_I_ ==> J_I_ `^^' are cursors.
12920 ^^ ^^
12921 -------- --------
12923 As we have to redraw the line above, we cannot use this
12924 optimization. */
12926 struct it it;
12927 int line_height_before = this_line_pixel_height;
12929 /* Note that start_display will handle the case that the
12930 line starting at tlbufpos is a continuation line. */
12931 start_display (&it, w, tlbufpos);
12933 /* Implementation note: It this still necessary? */
12934 if (it.current_x != this_line_start_x)
12935 goto cancel;
12937 TRACE ((stderr, "trying display optimization 1\n"));
12938 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
12939 overlay_arrow_seen = 0;
12940 it.vpos = this_line_vpos;
12941 it.current_y = this_line_y;
12942 it.glyph_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix, this_line_vpos);
12943 display_line (&it);
12945 /* If line contains point, is not continued,
12946 and ends at same distance from eob as before, we win. */
12947 if (w->cursor.vpos >= 0
12948 /* Line is not continued, otherwise this_line_start_pos
12949 would have been set to 0 in display_line. */
12950 && CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos)
12951 /* Line ends as before. */
12952 && CHARPOS (this_line_end_pos) == CHARPOS (tlendpos)
12953 /* Line has same height as before. Otherwise other lines
12954 would have to be shifted up or down. */
12955 && this_line_pixel_height == line_height_before)
12957 /* If this is not the window's last line, we must adjust
12958 the charstarts of the lines below. */
12959 if (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y)
12961 struct glyph_row *row
12962 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, this_line_vpos + 1);
12963 EMACS_INT delta, delta_bytes;
12965 /* We used to distinguish between two cases here,
12966 conditioned by Z - CHARPOS (tlendpos) == ZV, for
12967 when the line ends in a newline or the end of the
12968 buffer's accessible portion. But both cases did
12969 the same, so they were collapsed. */
12970 delta = (Z
12971 - CHARPOS (tlendpos)
12972 - MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row));
12973 delta_bytes = (Z_BYTE
12974 - BYTEPOS (tlendpos)
12975 - MATRIX_ROW_START_BYTEPOS (row));
12977 increment_matrix_positions (w->current_matrix,
12978 this_line_vpos + 1,
12979 w->current_matrix->nrows,
12980 delta, delta_bytes);
12983 /* If this row displays text now but previously didn't,
12984 or vice versa, w->window_end_vpos may have to be
12985 adjusted. */
12986 if ((it.glyph_row - 1)->displays_text_p)
12988 if (XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos) < this_line_vpos)
12989 XSETINT (w->window_end_vpos, this_line_vpos);
12991 else if (XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos) == this_line_vpos
12992 && this_line_vpos > 0)
12993 XSETINT (w->window_end_vpos, this_line_vpos - 1);
12994 w->window_end_valid = Qnil;
12996 /* Update hint: No need to try to scroll in update_window. */
12997 w->desired_matrix->no_scrolling_p = 1;
12999 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
13000 *w->desired_matrix->method = 0;
13001 debug_method_add (w, "optimization 1");
13002 #endif
13003 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
13004 update_window_fringes (w, 0);
13005 #endif
13006 goto update;
13008 else
13009 goto cancel;
13011 else if (/* Cursor position hasn't changed. */
13012 PT == XFASTINT (w->last_point)
13013 /* Make sure the cursor was last displayed
13014 in this window. Otherwise we have to reposition it. */
13015 && 0 <= w->cursor.vpos
13016 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) > w->cursor.vpos)
13018 if (!must_finish)
13020 do_pending_window_change (1);
13021 /* If selected_window changed, redisplay again. */
13022 if (WINDOWP (selected_window)
13023 && (w = XWINDOW (selected_window)) != sw)
13024 goto retry;
13026 /* We used to always goto end_of_redisplay here, but this
13027 isn't enough if we have a blinking cursor. */
13028 if (w->cursor_off_p == w->last_cursor_off_p)
13029 goto end_of_redisplay;
13031 goto update;
13033 /* If highlighting the region, or if the cursor is in the echo area,
13034 then we can't just move the cursor. */
13035 else if (! (!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
13036 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, mark_active)))
13037 && (EQ (selected_window, BVAR (current_buffer, last_selected_window))
13038 || highlight_nonselected_windows)
13039 && NILP (w->region_showing)
13040 && NILP (Vshow_trailing_whitespace)
13041 && !cursor_in_echo_area)
13043 struct it it;
13044 struct glyph_row *row;
13046 /* Skip from tlbufpos to PT and see where it is. Note that
13047 PT may be in invisible text. If so, we will end at the
13048 next visible position. */
13049 init_iterator (&it, w, CHARPOS (tlbufpos), BYTEPOS (tlbufpos),
13050 NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
13051 it.current_x = this_line_start_x;
13052 it.current_y = this_line_y;
13053 it.vpos = this_line_vpos;
13055 /* The call to move_it_to stops in front of PT, but
13056 moves over before-strings. */
13057 move_it_to (&it, PT, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
13059 if (it.vpos == this_line_vpos
13060 && (row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, this_line_vpos),
13061 row->enabled_p))
13063 xassert (this_line_vpos == it.vpos);
13064 xassert (this_line_y == it.current_y);
13065 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
13066 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
13067 *w->desired_matrix->method = 0;
13068 debug_method_add (w, "optimization 3");
13069 #endif
13070 goto update;
13072 else
13073 goto cancel;
13076 cancel:
13077 /* Text changed drastically or point moved off of line. */
13078 SET_MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (w->desired_matrix, this_line_vpos, 0);
13081 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos) = 0;
13082 consider_all_windows_p |= buffer_shared > 1;
13083 ++clear_face_cache_count;
13084 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
13085 ++clear_image_cache_count;
13086 #endif
13088 /* Build desired matrices, and update the display. If
13089 consider_all_windows_p is non-zero, do it for all windows on all
13090 frames. Otherwise do it for selected_window, only. */
13092 if (consider_all_windows_p)
13094 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
13096 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
13097 XFRAME (frame)->updated_p = 0;
13099 /* Recompute # windows showing selected buffer. This will be
13100 incremented each time such a window is displayed. */
13101 buffer_shared = 0;
13103 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
13105 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
13107 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f) || FRAME_TERMCAP_P (f) || f == sf)
13109 if (! EQ (frame, selected_frame))
13110 /* Select the frame, for the sake of frame-local
13111 variables. */
13112 select_frame_for_redisplay (frame);
13114 /* Mark all the scroll bars to be removed; we'll redeem
13115 the ones we want when we redisplay their windows. */
13116 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->condemn_scroll_bars_hook)
13117 FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->condemn_scroll_bars_hook (f);
13119 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && !FRAME_OBSCURED_P (f))
13120 redisplay_windows (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f));
13122 /* The X error handler may have deleted that frame. */
13123 if (!FRAME_LIVE_P (f))
13124 continue;
13126 /* Any scroll bars which redisplay_windows should have
13127 nuked should now go away. */
13128 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->judge_scroll_bars_hook)
13129 FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->judge_scroll_bars_hook (f);
13131 /* If fonts changed, display again. */
13132 /* ??? rms: I suspect it is a mistake to jump all the way
13133 back to retry here. It should just retry this frame. */
13134 if (fonts_changed_p)
13135 goto retry;
13137 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && !FRAME_OBSCURED_P (f))
13139 /* See if we have to hscroll. */
13140 if (!f->already_hscrolled_p)
13142 f->already_hscrolled_p = 1;
13143 if (hscroll_windows (f->root_window))
13144 goto retry;
13147 /* Prevent various kinds of signals during display
13148 update. stdio is not robust about handling
13149 signals, which can cause an apparent I/O
13150 error. */
13151 if (interrupt_input)
13152 unrequest_sigio ();
13153 STOP_POLLING;
13155 /* Update the display. */
13156 set_window_update_flags (XWINDOW (f->root_window), 1);
13157 pending |= update_frame (f, 0, 0);
13158 f->updated_p = 1;
13163 if (!EQ (old_frame, selected_frame)
13164 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (old_frame)))
13165 /* We played a bit fast-and-loose above and allowed selected_frame
13166 and selected_window to be temporarily out-of-sync but let's make
13167 sure this stays contained. */
13168 select_frame_for_redisplay (old_frame);
13169 eassert (EQ (XFRAME (selected_frame)->selected_window, selected_window));
13171 if (!pending)
13173 /* Do the mark_window_display_accurate after all windows have
13174 been redisplayed because this call resets flags in buffers
13175 which are needed for proper redisplay. */
13176 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
13178 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
13179 if (f->updated_p)
13181 mark_window_display_accurate (f->root_window, 1);
13182 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->frame_up_to_date_hook)
13183 FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->frame_up_to_date_hook (f);
13188 else if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (sf) && !FRAME_OBSCURED_P (sf))
13190 Lisp_Object mini_window;
13191 struct frame *mini_frame;
13193 displayed_buffer = XBUFFER (XWINDOW (selected_window)->buffer);
13194 /* Use list_of_error, not Qerror, so that
13195 we catch only errors and don't run the debugger. */
13196 internal_condition_case_1 (redisplay_window_1, selected_window,
13197 list_of_error,
13198 redisplay_window_error);
13200 /* Compare desired and current matrices, perform output. */
13202 update:
13203 /* If fonts changed, display again. */
13204 if (fonts_changed_p)
13205 goto retry;
13207 /* Prevent various kinds of signals during display update.
13208 stdio is not robust about handling signals,
13209 which can cause an apparent I/O error. */
13210 if (interrupt_input)
13211 unrequest_sigio ();
13212 STOP_POLLING;
13214 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (sf) && !FRAME_OBSCURED_P (sf))
13216 if (hscroll_windows (selected_window))
13217 goto retry;
13219 XWINDOW (selected_window)->must_be_updated_p = 1;
13220 pending = update_frame (sf, 0, 0);
13223 /* We may have called echo_area_display at the top of this
13224 function. If the echo area is on another frame, that may
13225 have put text on a frame other than the selected one, so the
13226 above call to update_frame would not have caught it. Catch
13227 it here. */
13228 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
13229 mini_frame = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
13231 if (mini_frame != sf && FRAME_WINDOW_P (mini_frame))
13233 XWINDOW (mini_window)->must_be_updated_p = 1;
13234 pending |= update_frame (mini_frame, 0, 0);
13235 if (!pending && hscroll_windows (mini_window))
13236 goto retry;
13240 /* If display was paused because of pending input, make sure we do a
13241 thorough update the next time. */
13242 if (pending)
13244 /* Prevent the optimization at the beginning of
13245 redisplay_internal that tries a single-line update of the
13246 line containing the cursor in the selected window. */
13247 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos) = 0;
13249 /* Let the overlay arrow be updated the next time. */
13250 update_overlay_arrows (0);
13252 /* If we pause after scrolling, some rows in the current
13253 matrices of some windows are not valid. */
13254 if (!WINDOW_FULL_WIDTH_P (w)
13255 && !FRAME_WINDOW_P (XFRAME (w->frame)))
13256 update_mode_lines = 1;
13258 else
13260 if (!consider_all_windows_p)
13262 /* This has already been done above if
13263 consider_all_windows_p is set. */
13264 mark_window_display_accurate_1 (w, 1);
13266 /* Say overlay arrows are up to date. */
13267 update_overlay_arrows (1);
13269 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (sf)->frame_up_to_date_hook != 0)
13270 FRAME_TERMINAL (sf)->frame_up_to_date_hook (sf);
13273 update_mode_lines = 0;
13274 windows_or_buffers_changed = 0;
13275 cursor_type_changed = 0;
13278 /* Start SIGIO interrupts coming again. Having them off during the
13279 code above makes it less likely one will discard output, but not
13280 impossible, since there might be stuff in the system buffer here.
13281 But it is much hairier to try to do anything about that. */
13282 if (interrupt_input)
13283 request_sigio ();
13284 RESUME_POLLING;
13286 /* If a frame has become visible which was not before, redisplay
13287 again, so that we display it. Expose events for such a frame
13288 (which it gets when becoming visible) don't call the parts of
13289 redisplay constructing glyphs, so simply exposing a frame won't
13290 display anything in this case. So, we have to display these
13291 frames here explicitly. */
13292 if (!pending)
13294 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
13295 int new_count = 0;
13297 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
13299 int this_is_visible = 0;
13301 if (XFRAME (frame)->visible)
13302 this_is_visible = 1;
13303 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (XFRAME (frame));
13304 if (XFRAME (frame)->visible)
13305 this_is_visible = 1;
13307 if (this_is_visible)
13308 new_count++;
13311 if (new_count != number_of_visible_frames)
13312 windows_or_buffers_changed++;
13315 /* Change frame size now if a change is pending. */
13316 do_pending_window_change (1);
13318 /* If we just did a pending size change, or have additional
13319 visible frames, or selected_window changed, redisplay again. */
13320 if ((windows_or_buffers_changed && !pending)
13321 || (WINDOWP (selected_window) && (w = XWINDOW (selected_window)) != sw))
13322 goto retry;
13324 /* Clear the face and image caches.
13326 We used to do this only if consider_all_windows_p. But the cache
13327 needs to be cleared if a timer creates images in the current
13328 buffer (e.g. the test case in Bug#6230). */
13330 if (clear_face_cache_count > CLEAR_FACE_CACHE_COUNT)
13332 clear_face_cache (0);
13333 clear_face_cache_count = 0;
13336 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
13337 if (clear_image_cache_count > CLEAR_IMAGE_CACHE_COUNT)
13339 clear_image_caches (Qnil);
13340 clear_image_cache_count = 0;
13342 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
13344 end_of_redisplay:
13345 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
13346 RESUME_POLLING;
13350 /* Redisplay, but leave alone any recent echo area message unless
13351 another message has been requested in its place.
13353 This is useful in situations where you need to redisplay but no
13354 user action has occurred, making it inappropriate for the message
13355 area to be cleared. See tracking_off and
13356 wait_reading_process_output for examples of these situations.
13358 FROM_WHERE is an integer saying from where this function was
13359 called. This is useful for debugging. */
13361 void
13362 redisplay_preserve_echo_area (int from_where)
13364 TRACE ((stderr, "redisplay_preserve_echo_area (%d)\n", from_where));
13366 if (!NILP (echo_area_buffer[1]))
13368 /* We have a previously displayed message, but no current
13369 message. Redisplay the previous message. */
13370 display_last_displayed_message_p = 1;
13371 redisplay_internal ();
13372 display_last_displayed_message_p = 0;
13374 else
13375 redisplay_internal ();
13377 if (FRAME_RIF (SELECTED_FRAME ()) != NULL
13378 && FRAME_RIF (SELECTED_FRAME ())->flush_display_optional)
13379 FRAME_RIF (SELECTED_FRAME ())->flush_display_optional (NULL);
13383 /* Function registered with record_unwind_protect in
13384 redisplay_internal. Reset redisplaying_p to the value it had
13385 before redisplay_internal was called, and clear
13386 prevent_freeing_realized_faces_p. It also selects the previously
13387 selected frame, unless it has been deleted (by an X connection
13388 failure during redisplay, for example). */
13390 static Lisp_Object
13391 unwind_redisplay (Lisp_Object val)
13393 Lisp_Object old_redisplaying_p, old_frame;
13395 old_redisplaying_p = XCAR (val);
13396 redisplaying_p = XFASTINT (old_redisplaying_p);
13397 old_frame = XCDR (val);
13398 if (! EQ (old_frame, selected_frame)
13399 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (old_frame)))
13400 select_frame_for_redisplay (old_frame);
13401 return Qnil;
13405 /* Mark the display of window W as accurate or inaccurate. If
13406 ACCURATE_P is non-zero mark display of W as accurate. If
13407 ACCURATE_P is zero, arrange for W to be redisplayed the next time
13408 redisplay_internal is called. */
13410 static void
13411 mark_window_display_accurate_1 (struct window *w, int accurate_p)
13413 if (BUFFERP (w->buffer))
13415 struct buffer *b = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
13417 w->last_modified
13418 = make_number (accurate_p ? BUF_MODIFF (b) : 0);
13419 w->last_overlay_modified
13420 = make_number (accurate_p ? BUF_OVERLAY_MODIFF (b) : 0);
13421 w->last_had_star
13422 = BUF_MODIFF (b) > BUF_SAVE_MODIFF (b) ? Qt : Qnil;
13424 if (accurate_p)
13426 b->clip_changed = 0;
13427 b->prevent_redisplay_optimizations_p = 0;
13429 BUF_UNCHANGED_MODIFIED (b) = BUF_MODIFF (b);
13430 BUF_OVERLAY_UNCHANGED_MODIFIED (b) = BUF_OVERLAY_MODIFF (b);
13431 BUF_BEG_UNCHANGED (b) = BUF_GPT (b) - BUF_BEG (b);
13432 BUF_END_UNCHANGED (b) = BUF_Z (b) - BUF_GPT (b);
13434 w->current_matrix->buffer = b;
13435 w->current_matrix->begv = BUF_BEGV (b);
13436 w->current_matrix->zv = BUF_ZV (b);
13438 w->last_cursor = w->cursor;
13439 w->last_cursor_off_p = w->cursor_off_p;
13441 if (w == XWINDOW (selected_window))
13442 w->last_point = make_number (BUF_PT (b));
13443 else
13444 w->last_point = make_number (XMARKER (w->pointm)->charpos);
13448 if (accurate_p)
13450 w->window_end_valid = w->buffer;
13451 w->update_mode_line = Qnil;
13456 /* Mark the display of windows in the window tree rooted at WINDOW as
13457 accurate or inaccurate. If ACCURATE_P is non-zero mark display of
13458 windows as accurate. If ACCURATE_P is zero, arrange for windows to
13459 be redisplayed the next time redisplay_internal is called. */
13461 void
13462 mark_window_display_accurate (Lisp_Object window, int accurate_p)
13464 struct window *w;
13466 for (; !NILP (window); window = w->next)
13468 w = XWINDOW (window);
13469 mark_window_display_accurate_1 (w, accurate_p);
13471 if (!NILP (w->vchild))
13472 mark_window_display_accurate (w->vchild, accurate_p);
13473 if (!NILP (w->hchild))
13474 mark_window_display_accurate (w->hchild, accurate_p);
13477 if (accurate_p)
13479 update_overlay_arrows (1);
13481 else
13483 /* Force a thorough redisplay the next time by setting
13484 last_arrow_position and last_arrow_string to t, which is
13485 unequal to any useful value of Voverlay_arrow_... */
13486 update_overlay_arrows (-1);
13491 /* Return value in display table DP (Lisp_Char_Table *) for character
13492 C. Since a display table doesn't have any parent, we don't have to
13493 follow parent. Do not call this function directly but use the
13494 macro DISP_CHAR_VECTOR. */
13496 Lisp_Object
13497 disp_char_vector (struct Lisp_Char_Table *dp, int c)
13499 Lisp_Object val;
13501 if (ASCII_CHAR_P (c))
13503 val = dp->ascii;
13504 if (SUB_CHAR_TABLE_P (val))
13505 val = XSUB_CHAR_TABLE (val)->contents[c];
13507 else
13509 Lisp_Object table;
13511 XSETCHAR_TABLE (table, dp);
13512 val = char_table_ref (table, c);
13514 if (NILP (val))
13515 val = dp->defalt;
13516 return val;
13521 /***********************************************************************
13522 Window Redisplay
13523 ***********************************************************************/
13525 /* Redisplay all leaf windows in the window tree rooted at WINDOW. */
13527 static void
13528 redisplay_windows (Lisp_Object window)
13530 while (!NILP (window))
13532 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
13534 if (!NILP (w->hchild))
13535 redisplay_windows (w->hchild);
13536 else if (!NILP (w->vchild))
13537 redisplay_windows (w->vchild);
13538 else if (!NILP (w->buffer))
13540 displayed_buffer = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
13541 /* Use list_of_error, not Qerror, so that
13542 we catch only errors and don't run the debugger. */
13543 internal_condition_case_1 (redisplay_window_0, window,
13544 list_of_error,
13545 redisplay_window_error);
13548 window = w->next;
13552 static Lisp_Object
13553 redisplay_window_error (Lisp_Object ignore)
13555 displayed_buffer->display_error_modiff = BUF_MODIFF (displayed_buffer);
13556 return Qnil;
13559 static Lisp_Object
13560 redisplay_window_0 (Lisp_Object window)
13562 if (displayed_buffer->display_error_modiff < BUF_MODIFF (displayed_buffer))
13563 redisplay_window (window, 0);
13564 return Qnil;
13567 static Lisp_Object
13568 redisplay_window_1 (Lisp_Object window)
13570 if (displayed_buffer->display_error_modiff < BUF_MODIFF (displayed_buffer))
13571 redisplay_window (window, 1);
13572 return Qnil;
13576 /* Set cursor position of W. PT is assumed to be displayed in ROW.
13577 DELTA and DELTA_BYTES are the numbers of characters and bytes by
13578 which positions recorded in ROW differ from current buffer
13579 positions.
13581 Return 0 if cursor is not on this row, 1 otherwise. */
13583 static int
13584 set_cursor_from_row (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row,
13585 struct glyph_matrix *matrix,
13586 EMACS_INT delta, EMACS_INT delta_bytes,
13587 int dy, int dvpos)
13589 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
13590 struct glyph *end = glyph + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
13591 struct glyph *cursor = NULL;
13592 /* The last known character position in row. */
13593 EMACS_INT last_pos = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) + delta;
13594 int x = row->x;
13595 EMACS_INT pt_old = PT - delta;
13596 EMACS_INT pos_before = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) + delta;
13597 EMACS_INT pos_after = MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + delta;
13598 struct glyph *glyph_before = glyph - 1, *glyph_after = end;
13599 /* A glyph beyond the edge of TEXT_AREA which we should never
13600 touch. */
13601 struct glyph *glyphs_end = end;
13602 /* Non-zero means we've found a match for cursor position, but that
13603 glyph has the avoid_cursor_p flag set. */
13604 int match_with_avoid_cursor = 0;
13605 /* Non-zero means we've seen at least one glyph that came from a
13606 display string. */
13607 int string_seen = 0;
13608 /* Largest and smalles buffer positions seen so far during scan of
13609 glyph row. */
13610 EMACS_INT bpos_max = pos_before;
13611 EMACS_INT bpos_min = pos_after;
13612 /* Last buffer position covered by an overlay string with an integer
13613 `cursor' property. */
13614 EMACS_INT bpos_covered = 0;
13615 /* Non-zero means the display string on which to display the cursor
13616 comes from a text property, not from an overlay. */
13617 int string_from_text_prop = 0;
13619 /* Skip over glyphs not having an object at the start and the end of
13620 the row. These are special glyphs like truncation marks on
13621 terminal frames. */
13622 if (row->displays_text_p)
13624 if (!row->reversed_p)
13626 while (glyph < end
13627 && INTEGERP (glyph->object)
13628 && glyph->charpos < 0)
13630 x += glyph->pixel_width;
13631 ++glyph;
13633 while (end > glyph
13634 && INTEGERP ((end - 1)->object)
13635 /* CHARPOS is zero for blanks and stretch glyphs
13636 inserted by extend_face_to_end_of_line. */
13637 && (end - 1)->charpos <= 0)
13638 --end;
13639 glyph_before = glyph - 1;
13640 glyph_after = end;
13642 else
13644 struct glyph *g;
13646 /* If the glyph row is reversed, we need to process it from back
13647 to front, so swap the edge pointers. */
13648 glyphs_end = end = glyph - 1;
13649 glyph += row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
13651 while (glyph > end + 1
13652 && INTEGERP (glyph->object)
13653 && glyph->charpos < 0)
13655 --glyph;
13656 x -= glyph->pixel_width;
13658 if (INTEGERP (glyph->object) && glyph->charpos < 0)
13659 --glyph;
13660 /* By default, in reversed rows we put the cursor on the
13661 rightmost (first in the reading order) glyph. */
13662 for (g = end + 1; g < glyph; g++)
13663 x += g->pixel_width;
13664 while (end < glyph
13665 && INTEGERP ((end + 1)->object)
13666 && (end + 1)->charpos <= 0)
13667 ++end;
13668 glyph_before = glyph + 1;
13669 glyph_after = end;
13672 else if (row->reversed_p)
13674 /* In R2L rows that don't display text, put the cursor on the
13675 rightmost glyph. Case in point: an empty last line that is
13676 part of an R2L paragraph. */
13677 cursor = end - 1;
13678 /* Avoid placing the cursor on the last glyph of the row, where
13679 on terminal frames we hold the vertical border between
13680 adjacent windows. */
13681 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (WINDOW_XFRAME (w))
13682 && !WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
13683 && cursor == row->glyphs[LAST_AREA] - 1)
13684 cursor--;
13685 x = -1; /* will be computed below, at label compute_x */
13688 /* Step 1: Try to find the glyph whose character position
13689 corresponds to point. If that's not possible, find 2 glyphs
13690 whose character positions are the closest to point, one before
13691 point, the other after it. */
13692 if (!row->reversed_p)
13693 while (/* not marched to end of glyph row */
13694 glyph < end
13695 /* glyph was not inserted by redisplay for internal purposes */
13696 && !INTEGERP (glyph->object))
13698 if (BUFFERP (glyph->object))
13700 EMACS_INT dpos = glyph->charpos - pt_old;
13702 if (glyph->charpos > bpos_max)
13703 bpos_max = glyph->charpos;
13704 if (glyph->charpos < bpos_min)
13705 bpos_min = glyph->charpos;
13706 if (!glyph->avoid_cursor_p)
13708 /* If we hit point, we've found the glyph on which to
13709 display the cursor. */
13710 if (dpos == 0)
13712 match_with_avoid_cursor = 0;
13713 break;
13715 /* See if we've found a better approximation to
13716 POS_BEFORE or to POS_AFTER. Note that we want the
13717 first (leftmost) glyph of all those that are the
13718 closest from below, and the last (rightmost) of all
13719 those from above. */
13720 if (0 > dpos && dpos > pos_before - pt_old)
13722 pos_before = glyph->charpos;
13723 glyph_before = glyph;
13725 else if (0 < dpos && dpos <= pos_after - pt_old)
13727 pos_after = glyph->charpos;
13728 glyph_after = glyph;
13731 else if (dpos == 0)
13732 match_with_avoid_cursor = 1;
13734 else if (STRINGP (glyph->object))
13736 Lisp_Object chprop;
13737 EMACS_INT glyph_pos = glyph->charpos;
13739 chprop = Fget_char_property (make_number (glyph_pos), Qcursor,
13740 glyph->object);
13741 if (INTEGERP (chprop))
13743 bpos_covered = bpos_max + XINT (chprop);
13744 /* If the `cursor' property covers buffer positions up
13745 to and including point, we should display cursor on
13746 this glyph. Note that overlays and text properties
13747 with string values stop bidi reordering, so every
13748 buffer position to the left of the string is always
13749 smaller than any position to the right of the
13750 string. Therefore, if a `cursor' property on one
13751 of the string's characters has an integer value, we
13752 will break out of the loop below _before_ we get to
13753 the position match above. IOW, integer values of
13754 the `cursor' property override the "exact match for
13755 point" strategy of positioning the cursor. */
13756 /* Implementation note: bpos_max == pt_old when, e.g.,
13757 we are in an empty line, where bpos_max is set to
13758 MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS, see above. */
13759 if (bpos_max <= pt_old && bpos_covered >= pt_old)
13761 cursor = glyph;
13762 break;
13766 string_seen = 1;
13768 x += glyph->pixel_width;
13769 ++glyph;
13771 else if (glyph > end) /* row is reversed */
13772 while (!INTEGERP (glyph->object))
13774 if (BUFFERP (glyph->object))
13776 EMACS_INT dpos = glyph->charpos - pt_old;
13778 if (glyph->charpos > bpos_max)
13779 bpos_max = glyph->charpos;
13780 if (glyph->charpos < bpos_min)
13781 bpos_min = glyph->charpos;
13782 if (!glyph->avoid_cursor_p)
13784 if (dpos == 0)
13786 match_with_avoid_cursor = 0;
13787 break;
13789 if (0 > dpos && dpos > pos_before - pt_old)
13791 pos_before = glyph->charpos;
13792 glyph_before = glyph;
13794 else if (0 < dpos && dpos <= pos_after - pt_old)
13796 pos_after = glyph->charpos;
13797 glyph_after = glyph;
13800 else if (dpos == 0)
13801 match_with_avoid_cursor = 1;
13803 else if (STRINGP (glyph->object))
13805 Lisp_Object chprop;
13806 EMACS_INT glyph_pos = glyph->charpos;
13808 chprop = Fget_char_property (make_number (glyph_pos), Qcursor,
13809 glyph->object);
13810 if (INTEGERP (chprop))
13812 bpos_covered = bpos_max + XINT (chprop);
13813 /* If the `cursor' property covers buffer positions up
13814 to and including point, we should display cursor on
13815 this glyph. */
13816 if (bpos_max <= pt_old && bpos_covered >= pt_old)
13818 cursor = glyph;
13819 break;
13822 string_seen = 1;
13824 --glyph;
13825 if (glyph == glyphs_end) /* don't dereference outside TEXT_AREA */
13827 x--; /* can't use any pixel_width */
13828 break;
13830 x -= glyph->pixel_width;
13833 /* Step 2: If we didn't find an exact match for point, we need to
13834 look for a proper place to put the cursor among glyphs between
13835 GLYPH_BEFORE and GLYPH_AFTER. */
13836 if (!((row->reversed_p ? glyph > glyphs_end : glyph < glyphs_end)
13837 && BUFFERP (glyph->object) && glyph->charpos == pt_old)
13838 && bpos_covered < pt_old)
13840 /* An empty line has a single glyph whose OBJECT is zero and
13841 whose CHARPOS is the position of a newline on that line.
13842 Note that on a TTY, there are more glyphs after that, which
13843 were produced by extend_face_to_end_of_line, but their
13844 CHARPOS is zero or negative. */
13845 int empty_line_p =
13846 (row->reversed_p ? glyph > glyphs_end : glyph < glyphs_end)
13847 && INTEGERP (glyph->object) && glyph->charpos > 0;
13849 if (row->ends_in_ellipsis_p && pos_after == last_pos)
13851 EMACS_INT ellipsis_pos;
13853 /* Scan back over the ellipsis glyphs. */
13854 if (!row->reversed_p)
13856 ellipsis_pos = (glyph - 1)->charpos;
13857 while (glyph > row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
13858 && (glyph - 1)->charpos == ellipsis_pos)
13859 glyph--, x -= glyph->pixel_width;
13860 /* That loop always goes one position too far, including
13861 the glyph before the ellipsis. So scan forward over
13862 that one. */
13863 x += glyph->pixel_width;
13864 glyph++;
13866 else /* row is reversed */
13868 ellipsis_pos = (glyph + 1)->charpos;
13869 while (glyph < row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1
13870 && (glyph + 1)->charpos == ellipsis_pos)
13871 glyph++, x += glyph->pixel_width;
13872 x -= glyph->pixel_width;
13873 glyph--;
13876 else if (match_with_avoid_cursor)
13878 cursor = glyph_after;
13879 x = -1;
13881 else if (string_seen)
13883 int incr = row->reversed_p ? -1 : +1;
13885 /* Need to find the glyph that came out of a string which is
13886 present at point. That glyph is somewhere between
13887 GLYPH_BEFORE and GLYPH_AFTER, and it came from a string
13888 positioned between POS_BEFORE and POS_AFTER in the
13889 buffer. */
13890 struct glyph *start, *stop;
13891 EMACS_INT pos = pos_before;
13893 x = -1;
13895 /* If the row ends in a newline from a display string,
13896 reordering could have moved the glyphs belonging to the
13897 string out of the [GLYPH_BEFORE..GLYPH_AFTER] range. So
13898 in this case we extend the search to the last glyph in
13899 the row that was not inserted by redisplay. */
13900 if (row->ends_in_newline_from_string_p)
13902 glyph_after = end;
13903 pos_after = MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + delta;
13906 /* GLYPH_BEFORE and GLYPH_AFTER are the glyphs that
13907 correspond to POS_BEFORE and POS_AFTER, respectively. We
13908 need START and STOP in the order that corresponds to the
13909 row's direction as given by its reversed_p flag. If the
13910 directionality of characters between POS_BEFORE and
13911 POS_AFTER is the opposite of the row's base direction,
13912 these characters will have been reordered for display,
13913 and we need to reverse START and STOP. */
13914 if (!row->reversed_p)
13916 start = min (glyph_before, glyph_after);
13917 stop = max (glyph_before, glyph_after);
13919 else
13921 start = max (glyph_before, glyph_after);
13922 stop = min (glyph_before, glyph_after);
13924 for (glyph = start + incr;
13925 row->reversed_p ? glyph > stop : glyph < stop; )
13928 /* Any glyphs that come from the buffer are here because
13929 of bidi reordering. Skip them, and only pay
13930 attention to glyphs that came from some string. */
13931 if (STRINGP (glyph->object))
13933 Lisp_Object str;
13934 EMACS_INT tem;
13935 /* If the display property covers the newline, we
13936 need to search for it one position farther. */
13937 EMACS_INT lim = pos_after
13938 + (pos_after == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + delta);
13940 string_from_text_prop = 0;
13941 str = glyph->object;
13942 tem = string_buffer_position_lim (str, pos, lim, 0);
13943 if (tem == 0 /* from overlay */
13944 || pos <= tem)
13946 /* If the string from which this glyph came is
13947 found in the buffer at point, then we've
13948 found the glyph we've been looking for. If
13949 it comes from an overlay (tem == 0), and it
13950 has the `cursor' property on one of its
13951 glyphs, record that glyph as a candidate for
13952 displaying the cursor. (As in the
13953 unidirectional version, we will display the
13954 cursor on the last candidate we find.) */
13955 if (tem == 0 || tem == pt_old)
13957 /* The glyphs from this string could have
13958 been reordered. Find the one with the
13959 smallest string position. Or there could
13960 be a character in the string with the
13961 `cursor' property, which means display
13962 cursor on that character's glyph. */
13963 EMACS_INT strpos = glyph->charpos;
13965 if (tem)
13967 cursor = glyph;
13968 string_from_text_prop = 1;
13970 for ( ;
13971 (row->reversed_p ? glyph > stop : glyph < stop)
13972 && EQ (glyph->object, str);
13973 glyph += incr)
13975 Lisp_Object cprop;
13976 EMACS_INT gpos = glyph->charpos;
13978 cprop = Fget_char_property (make_number (gpos),
13979 Qcursor,
13980 glyph->object);
13981 if (!NILP (cprop))
13983 cursor = glyph;
13984 break;
13986 if (tem && glyph->charpos < strpos)
13988 strpos = glyph->charpos;
13989 cursor = glyph;
13993 if (tem == pt_old)
13994 goto compute_x;
13996 if (tem)
13997 pos = tem + 1; /* don't find previous instances */
13999 /* This string is not what we want; skip all of the
14000 glyphs that came from it. */
14001 while ((row->reversed_p ? glyph > stop : glyph < stop)
14002 && EQ (glyph->object, str))
14003 glyph += incr;
14005 else
14006 glyph += incr;
14009 /* If we reached the end of the line, and END was from a string,
14010 the cursor is not on this line. */
14011 if (cursor == NULL
14012 && (row->reversed_p ? glyph <= end : glyph >= end)
14013 && STRINGP (end->object)
14014 && row->continued_p)
14015 return 0;
14017 /* A truncated row may not include PT among its character positions.
14018 Setting the cursor inside the scroll margin will trigger
14019 recalculation of hscroll in hscroll_window_tree. But if a
14020 display string covers point, defer to the string-handling
14021 code below to figure this out. */
14022 else if (row->truncated_on_left_p && pt_old < bpos_min)
14024 cursor = glyph_before;
14025 x = -1;
14027 else if ((row->truncated_on_right_p && pt_old > bpos_max)
14028 /* Zero-width characters produce no glyphs. */
14029 || (!empty_line_p
14030 && (row->reversed_p
14031 ? glyph_after > glyphs_end
14032 : glyph_after < glyphs_end)))
14034 cursor = glyph_after;
14035 x = -1;
14039 compute_x:
14040 if (cursor != NULL)
14041 glyph = cursor;
14042 if (x < 0)
14044 struct glyph *g;
14046 /* Need to compute x that corresponds to GLYPH. */
14047 for (g = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA], x = row->x; g < glyph; g++)
14049 if (g >= row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA])
14050 abort ();
14051 x += g->pixel_width;
14055 /* ROW could be part of a continued line, which, under bidi
14056 reordering, might have other rows whose start and end charpos
14057 occlude point. Only set w->cursor if we found a better
14058 approximation to the cursor position than we have from previously
14059 examined candidate rows belonging to the same continued line. */
14060 if (/* we already have a candidate row */
14061 w->cursor.vpos >= 0
14062 /* that candidate is not the row we are processing */
14063 && MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos) != row
14064 /* Make sure cursor.vpos specifies a row whose start and end
14065 charpos occlude point, and it is valid candidate for being a
14066 cursor-row. This is because some callers of this function
14067 leave cursor.vpos at the row where the cursor was displayed
14068 during the last redisplay cycle. */
14069 && MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos)) <= pt_old
14070 && pt_old <= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos))
14071 && cursor_row_p (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos)))
14073 struct glyph *g1 =
14074 MATRIX_ROW_GLYPH_START (matrix, w->cursor.vpos) + w->cursor.hpos;
14076 /* Don't consider glyphs that are outside TEXT_AREA. */
14077 if (!(row->reversed_p ? glyph > glyphs_end : glyph < glyphs_end))
14078 return 0;
14079 /* Keep the candidate whose buffer position is the closest to
14080 point or has the `cursor' property. */
14081 if (/* previous candidate is a glyph in TEXT_AREA of that row */
14082 w->cursor.hpos >= 0
14083 && w->cursor.hpos < MATRIX_ROW_USED (matrix, w->cursor.vpos)
14084 && ((BUFFERP (g1->object)
14085 && (g1->charpos == pt_old /* an exact match always wins */
14086 || (BUFFERP (glyph->object)
14087 && eabs (g1->charpos - pt_old)
14088 < eabs (glyph->charpos - pt_old))))
14089 /* previous candidate is a glyph from a string that has
14090 a non-nil `cursor' property */
14091 || (STRINGP (g1->object)
14092 && (!NILP (Fget_char_property (make_number (g1->charpos),
14093 Qcursor, g1->object))
14094 /* pevious candidate is from the same display
14095 string as this one, and the display string
14096 came from a text property */
14097 || (EQ (g1->object, glyph->object)
14098 && string_from_text_prop)
14099 /* this candidate is from newline and its
14100 position is not an exact match */
14101 || (INTEGERP (glyph->object)
14102 && glyph->charpos != pt_old)))))
14103 return 0;
14104 /* If this candidate gives an exact match, use that. */
14105 if (!((BUFFERP (glyph->object) && glyph->charpos == pt_old)
14106 /* If this candidate is a glyph created for the
14107 terminating newline of a line, and point is on that
14108 newline, it wins because it's an exact match. */
14109 || (!row->continued_p
14110 && INTEGERP (glyph->object)
14111 && glyph->charpos == 0
14112 && pt_old == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) - 1))
14113 /* Otherwise, keep the candidate that comes from a row
14114 spanning less buffer positions. This may win when one or
14115 both candidate positions are on glyphs that came from
14116 display strings, for which we cannot compare buffer
14117 positions. */
14118 && MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos))
14119 - MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos))
14120 < MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) - MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row))
14121 return 0;
14123 w->cursor.hpos = glyph - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
14124 w->cursor.x = x;
14125 w->cursor.vpos = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (row, matrix) + dvpos;
14126 w->cursor.y = row->y + dy;
14128 if (w == XWINDOW (selected_window))
14130 if (!row->continued_p
14131 && !MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (row)
14132 && row->x == 0)
14134 this_line_buffer = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
14136 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos)
14137 = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) + delta;
14138 BYTEPOS (this_line_start_pos)
14139 = MATRIX_ROW_START_BYTEPOS (row) + delta_bytes;
14141 CHARPOS (this_line_end_pos)
14142 = Z - (MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + delta);
14143 BYTEPOS (this_line_end_pos)
14144 = Z_BYTE - (MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row) + delta_bytes);
14146 this_line_y = w->cursor.y;
14147 this_line_pixel_height = row->height;
14148 this_line_vpos = w->cursor.vpos;
14149 this_line_start_x = row->x;
14151 else
14152 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos) = 0;
14155 return 1;
14159 /* Run window scroll functions, if any, for WINDOW with new window
14160 start STARTP. Sets the window start of WINDOW to that position.
14162 We assume that the window's buffer is really current. */
14164 static inline struct text_pos
14165 run_window_scroll_functions (Lisp_Object window, struct text_pos startp)
14167 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
14168 SET_MARKER_FROM_TEXT_POS (w->start, startp);
14170 if (current_buffer != XBUFFER (w->buffer))
14171 abort ();
14173 if (!NILP (Vwindow_scroll_functions))
14175 run_hook_with_args_2 (Qwindow_scroll_functions, window,
14176 make_number (CHARPOS (startp)));
14177 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (startp, w->start);
14178 /* In case the hook functions switch buffers. */
14179 if (current_buffer != XBUFFER (w->buffer))
14180 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (w->buffer));
14183 return startp;
14187 /* Make sure the line containing the cursor is fully visible.
14188 A value of 1 means there is nothing to be done.
14189 (Either the line is fully visible, or it cannot be made so,
14190 or we cannot tell.)
14192 If FORCE_P is non-zero, return 0 even if partial visible cursor row
14193 is higher than window.
14195 A value of 0 means the caller should do scrolling
14196 as if point had gone off the screen. */
14198 static int
14199 cursor_row_fully_visible_p (struct window *w, int force_p, int current_matrix_p)
14201 struct glyph_matrix *matrix;
14202 struct glyph_row *row;
14203 int window_height;
14205 if (!make_cursor_line_fully_visible_p)
14206 return 1;
14208 /* It's not always possible to find the cursor, e.g, when a window
14209 is full of overlay strings. Don't do anything in that case. */
14210 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
14211 return 1;
14213 matrix = current_matrix_p ? w->current_matrix : w->desired_matrix;
14214 row = MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos);
14216 /* If the cursor row is not partially visible, there's nothing to do. */
14217 if (!MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_P (w, row))
14218 return 1;
14220 /* If the row the cursor is in is taller than the window's height,
14221 it's not clear what to do, so do nothing. */
14222 window_height = window_box_height (w);
14223 if (row->height >= window_height)
14225 if (!force_p || MINI_WINDOW_P (w)
14226 || w->vscroll || w->cursor.vpos == 0)
14227 return 1;
14229 return 0;
14233 /* Try scrolling PT into view in window WINDOW. JUST_THIS_ONE_P
14234 non-zero means only WINDOW is redisplayed in redisplay_internal.
14235 TEMP_SCROLL_STEP has the same meaning as emacs_scroll_step, and is used
14236 in redisplay_window to bring a partially visible line into view in
14237 the case that only the cursor has moved.
14239 LAST_LINE_MISFIT should be nonzero if we're scrolling because the
14240 last screen line's vertical height extends past the end of the screen.
14242 Value is
14244 1 if scrolling succeeded
14246 0 if scrolling didn't find point.
14248 -1 if new fonts have been loaded so that we must interrupt
14249 redisplay, adjust glyph matrices, and try again. */
14251 enum
14253 SCROLLING_SUCCESS,
14254 SCROLLING_FAILED,
14255 SCROLLING_NEED_LARGER_MATRICES
14258 /* If scroll-conservatively is more than this, never recenter.
14260 If you change this, don't forget to update the doc string of
14261 `scroll-conservatively' and the Emacs manual. */
14262 #define SCROLL_LIMIT 100
14264 static int
14265 try_scrolling (Lisp_Object window, int just_this_one_p,
14266 EMACS_INT arg_scroll_conservatively, EMACS_INT scroll_step,
14267 int temp_scroll_step, int last_line_misfit)
14269 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
14270 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
14271 struct text_pos pos, startp;
14272 struct it it;
14273 int this_scroll_margin, scroll_max, rc, height;
14274 int dy = 0, amount_to_scroll = 0, scroll_down_p = 0;
14275 int extra_scroll_margin_lines = last_line_misfit ? 1 : 0;
14276 Lisp_Object aggressive;
14277 /* We will never try scrolling more than this number of lines. */
14278 int scroll_limit = SCROLL_LIMIT;
14280 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
14281 debug_method_add (w, "try_scrolling");
14282 #endif
14284 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (startp, w->start);
14286 /* Compute scroll margin height in pixels. We scroll when point is
14287 within this distance from the top or bottom of the window. */
14288 if (scroll_margin > 0)
14289 this_scroll_margin = min (scroll_margin, WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) / 4)
14290 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
14291 else
14292 this_scroll_margin = 0;
14294 /* Force arg_scroll_conservatively to have a reasonable value, to
14295 avoid scrolling too far away with slow move_it_* functions. Note
14296 that the user can supply scroll-conservatively equal to
14297 `most-positive-fixnum', which can be larger than INT_MAX. */
14298 if (arg_scroll_conservatively > scroll_limit)
14300 arg_scroll_conservatively = scroll_limit + 1;
14301 scroll_max = scroll_limit * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
14303 else if (scroll_step || arg_scroll_conservatively || temp_scroll_step)
14304 /* Compute how much we should try to scroll maximally to bring
14305 point into view. */
14306 scroll_max = (max (scroll_step,
14307 max (arg_scroll_conservatively, temp_scroll_step))
14308 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f));
14309 else if (NUMBERP (BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_down_aggressively))
14310 || NUMBERP (BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_up_aggressively)))
14311 /* We're trying to scroll because of aggressive scrolling but no
14312 scroll_step is set. Choose an arbitrary one. */
14313 scroll_max = 10 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
14314 else
14315 scroll_max = 0;
14317 too_near_end:
14319 /* Decide whether to scroll down. */
14320 if (PT > CHARPOS (startp))
14322 int scroll_margin_y;
14324 /* Compute the pixel ypos of the scroll margin, then move it to
14325 either that ypos or PT, whichever comes first. */
14326 start_display (&it, w, startp);
14327 scroll_margin_y = it.last_visible_y - this_scroll_margin
14328 - FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) * extra_scroll_margin_lines;
14329 move_it_to (&it, PT, -1, scroll_margin_y - 1, -1,
14330 (MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_Y));
14332 if (PT > CHARPOS (it.current.pos))
14334 int y0 = line_bottom_y (&it);
14335 /* Compute how many pixels below window bottom to stop searching
14336 for PT. This avoids costly search for PT that is far away if
14337 the user limited scrolling by a small number of lines, but
14338 always finds PT if scroll_conservatively is set to a large
14339 number, such as most-positive-fixnum. */
14340 int slack = max (scroll_max, 10 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f));
14341 int y_to_move = it.last_visible_y + slack;
14343 /* Compute the distance from the scroll margin to PT or to
14344 the scroll limit, whichever comes first. This should
14345 include the height of the cursor line, to make that line
14346 fully visible. */
14347 move_it_to (&it, PT, -1, y_to_move,
14348 -1, MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_Y);
14349 dy = line_bottom_y (&it) - y0;
14351 if (dy > scroll_max)
14352 return SCROLLING_FAILED;
14354 scroll_down_p = 1;
14358 if (scroll_down_p)
14360 /* Point is in or below the bottom scroll margin, so move the
14361 window start down. If scrolling conservatively, move it just
14362 enough down to make point visible. If scroll_step is set,
14363 move it down by scroll_step. */
14364 if (arg_scroll_conservatively)
14365 amount_to_scroll
14366 = min (max (dy, FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
14367 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) * arg_scroll_conservatively);
14368 else if (scroll_step || temp_scroll_step)
14369 amount_to_scroll = scroll_max;
14370 else
14372 aggressive = BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_up_aggressively);
14373 height = WINDOW_BOX_TEXT_HEIGHT (w);
14374 if (NUMBERP (aggressive))
14376 double float_amount = XFLOATINT (aggressive) * height;
14377 amount_to_scroll = float_amount;
14378 if (amount_to_scroll == 0 && float_amount > 0)
14379 amount_to_scroll = 1;
14380 /* Don't let point enter the scroll margin near top of
14381 the window. */
14382 if (amount_to_scroll > height - 2*this_scroll_margin + dy)
14383 amount_to_scroll = height - 2*this_scroll_margin + dy;
14387 if (amount_to_scroll <= 0)
14388 return SCROLLING_FAILED;
14390 start_display (&it, w, startp);
14391 if (arg_scroll_conservatively <= scroll_limit)
14392 move_it_vertically (&it, amount_to_scroll);
14393 else
14395 /* Extra precision for users who set scroll-conservatively
14396 to a large number: make sure the amount we scroll
14397 the window start is never less than amount_to_scroll,
14398 which was computed as distance from window bottom to
14399 point. This matters when lines at window top and lines
14400 below window bottom have different height. */
14401 struct it it1;
14402 void *it1data = NULL;
14403 /* We use a temporary it1 because line_bottom_y can modify
14404 its argument, if it moves one line down; see there. */
14405 int start_y;
14407 SAVE_IT (it1, it, it1data);
14408 start_y = line_bottom_y (&it1);
14409 do {
14410 RESTORE_IT (&it, &it, it1data);
14411 move_it_by_lines (&it, 1);
14412 SAVE_IT (it1, it, it1data);
14413 } while (line_bottom_y (&it1) - start_y < amount_to_scroll);
14416 /* If STARTP is unchanged, move it down another screen line. */
14417 if (CHARPOS (it.current.pos) == CHARPOS (startp))
14418 move_it_by_lines (&it, 1);
14419 startp = it.current.pos;
14421 else
14423 struct text_pos scroll_margin_pos = startp;
14425 /* See if point is inside the scroll margin at the top of the
14426 window. */
14427 if (this_scroll_margin)
14429 start_display (&it, w, startp);
14430 move_it_vertically (&it, this_scroll_margin);
14431 scroll_margin_pos = it.current.pos;
14434 if (PT < CHARPOS (scroll_margin_pos))
14436 /* Point is in the scroll margin at the top of the window or
14437 above what is displayed in the window. */
14438 int y0, y_to_move;
14440 /* Compute the vertical distance from PT to the scroll
14441 margin position. Move as far as scroll_max allows, or
14442 one screenful, or 10 screen lines, whichever is largest.
14443 Give up if distance is greater than scroll_max. */
14444 SET_TEXT_POS (pos, PT, PT_BYTE);
14445 start_display (&it, w, pos);
14446 y0 = it.current_y;
14447 y_to_move = max (it.last_visible_y,
14448 max (scroll_max, 10 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)));
14449 move_it_to (&it, CHARPOS (scroll_margin_pos), 0,
14450 y_to_move, -1,
14451 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_X | MOVE_TO_Y);
14452 dy = it.current_y - y0;
14453 if (dy > scroll_max)
14454 return SCROLLING_FAILED;
14456 /* Compute new window start. */
14457 start_display (&it, w, startp);
14459 if (arg_scroll_conservatively)
14460 amount_to_scroll = max (dy, FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) *
14461 max (scroll_step, temp_scroll_step));
14462 else if (scroll_step || temp_scroll_step)
14463 amount_to_scroll = scroll_max;
14464 else
14466 aggressive = BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_down_aggressively);
14467 height = WINDOW_BOX_TEXT_HEIGHT (w);
14468 if (NUMBERP (aggressive))
14470 double float_amount = XFLOATINT (aggressive) * height;
14471 amount_to_scroll = float_amount;
14472 if (amount_to_scroll == 0 && float_amount > 0)
14473 amount_to_scroll = 1;
14474 amount_to_scroll -=
14475 this_scroll_margin - dy - FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
14476 /* Don't let point enter the scroll margin near
14477 bottom of the window. */
14478 if (amount_to_scroll > height - 2*this_scroll_margin + dy)
14479 amount_to_scroll = height - 2*this_scroll_margin + dy;
14483 if (amount_to_scroll <= 0)
14484 return SCROLLING_FAILED;
14486 move_it_vertically_backward (&it, amount_to_scroll);
14487 startp = it.current.pos;
14491 /* Run window scroll functions. */
14492 startp = run_window_scroll_functions (window, startp);
14494 /* Display the window. Give up if new fonts are loaded, or if point
14495 doesn't appear. */
14496 if (!try_window (window, startp, 0))
14497 rc = SCROLLING_NEED_LARGER_MATRICES;
14498 else if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
14500 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
14501 rc = SCROLLING_FAILED;
14503 else
14505 /* Maybe forget recorded base line for line number display. */
14506 if (!just_this_one_p
14507 || current_buffer->clip_changed
14508 || BEG_UNCHANGED < CHARPOS (startp))
14509 w->base_line_number = Qnil;
14511 /* If cursor ends up on a partially visible line,
14512 treat that as being off the bottom of the screen. */
14513 if (! cursor_row_fully_visible_p (w, extra_scroll_margin_lines <= 1, 0)
14514 /* It's possible that the cursor is on the first line of the
14515 buffer, which is partially obscured due to a vscroll
14516 (Bug#7537). In that case, avoid looping forever . */
14517 && extra_scroll_margin_lines < w->desired_matrix->nrows - 1)
14519 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
14520 ++extra_scroll_margin_lines;
14521 goto too_near_end;
14523 rc = SCROLLING_SUCCESS;
14526 return rc;
14530 /* Compute a suitable window start for window W if display of W starts
14531 on a continuation line. Value is non-zero if a new window start
14532 was computed.
14534 The new window start will be computed, based on W's width, starting
14535 from the start of the continued line. It is the start of the
14536 screen line with the minimum distance from the old start W->start. */
14538 static int
14539 compute_window_start_on_continuation_line (struct window *w)
14541 struct text_pos pos, start_pos;
14542 int window_start_changed_p = 0;
14544 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (start_pos, w->start);
14546 /* If window start is on a continuation line... Window start may be
14547 < BEGV in case there's invisible text at the start of the
14548 buffer (M-x rmail, for example). */
14549 if (CHARPOS (start_pos) > BEGV
14550 && FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (start_pos) - 1) != '\n')
14552 struct it it;
14553 struct glyph_row *row;
14555 /* Handle the case that the window start is out of range. */
14556 if (CHARPOS (start_pos) < BEGV)
14557 SET_TEXT_POS (start_pos, BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
14558 else if (CHARPOS (start_pos) > ZV)
14559 SET_TEXT_POS (start_pos, ZV, ZV_BYTE);
14561 /* Find the start of the continued line. This should be fast
14562 because scan_buffer is fast (newline cache). */
14563 row = w->desired_matrix->rows + (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w) ? 1 : 0);
14564 init_iterator (&it, w, CHARPOS (start_pos), BYTEPOS (start_pos),
14565 row, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
14566 reseat_at_previous_visible_line_start (&it);
14568 /* If the line start is "too far" away from the window start,
14569 say it takes too much time to compute a new window start. */
14570 if (CHARPOS (start_pos) - IT_CHARPOS (it)
14571 < WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) * WINDOW_TOTAL_COLS (w))
14573 int min_distance, distance;
14575 /* Move forward by display lines to find the new window
14576 start. If window width was enlarged, the new start can
14577 be expected to be > the old start. If window width was
14578 decreased, the new window start will be < the old start.
14579 So, we're looking for the display line start with the
14580 minimum distance from the old window start. */
14581 pos = it.current.pos;
14582 min_distance = INFINITY;
14583 while ((distance = eabs (CHARPOS (start_pos) - IT_CHARPOS (it))),
14584 distance < min_distance)
14586 min_distance = distance;
14587 pos = it.current.pos;
14588 move_it_by_lines (&it, 1);
14591 /* Set the window start there. */
14592 SET_MARKER_FROM_TEXT_POS (w->start, pos);
14593 window_start_changed_p = 1;
14597 return window_start_changed_p;
14601 /* Try cursor movement in case text has not changed in window WINDOW,
14602 with window start STARTP. Value is
14604 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS if successful
14606 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_CANNOT_BE_USED if this method cannot be used
14608 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL if we know we have to scroll the
14609 display. *SCROLL_STEP is set to 1, under certain circumstances, if
14610 we want to scroll as if scroll-step were set to 1. See the code.
14612 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_NEED_LARGER_MATRICES if we need larger matrices, in
14613 which case we have to abort this redisplay, and adjust matrices
14614 first. */
14616 enum
14618 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS,
14619 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_CANNOT_BE_USED,
14620 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL,
14621 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_NEED_LARGER_MATRICES
14624 static int
14625 try_cursor_movement (Lisp_Object window, struct text_pos startp, int *scroll_step)
14627 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
14628 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
14629 int rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_CANNOT_BE_USED;
14631 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
14632 if (inhibit_try_cursor_movement)
14633 return rc;
14634 #endif
14636 /* Handle case where text has not changed, only point, and it has
14637 not moved off the frame. */
14638 if (/* Point may be in this window. */
14639 PT >= CHARPOS (startp)
14640 /* Selective display hasn't changed. */
14641 && !current_buffer->clip_changed
14642 /* Function force-mode-line-update is used to force a thorough
14643 redisplay. It sets either windows_or_buffers_changed or
14644 update_mode_lines. So don't take a shortcut here for these
14645 cases. */
14646 && !update_mode_lines
14647 && !windows_or_buffers_changed
14648 && !cursor_type_changed
14649 /* Can't use this case if highlighting a region. When a
14650 region exists, cursor movement has to do more than just
14651 set the cursor. */
14652 && !(!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
14653 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, mark_active)))
14654 && NILP (w->region_showing)
14655 && NILP (Vshow_trailing_whitespace)
14656 /* Right after splitting windows, last_point may be nil. */
14657 && INTEGERP (w->last_point)
14658 /* This code is not used for mini-buffer for the sake of the case
14659 of redisplaying to replace an echo area message; since in
14660 that case the mini-buffer contents per se are usually
14661 unchanged. This code is of no real use in the mini-buffer
14662 since the handling of this_line_start_pos, etc., in redisplay
14663 handles the same cases. */
14664 && !EQ (window, minibuf_window)
14665 /* When splitting windows or for new windows, it happens that
14666 redisplay is called with a nil window_end_vpos or one being
14667 larger than the window. This should really be fixed in
14668 window.c. I don't have this on my list, now, so we do
14669 approximately the same as the old redisplay code. --gerd. */
14670 && INTEGERP (w->window_end_vpos)
14671 && XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos) < w->current_matrix->nrows
14672 && (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
14673 || !overlay_arrow_in_current_buffer_p ()))
14675 int this_scroll_margin, top_scroll_margin;
14676 struct glyph_row *row = NULL;
14678 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
14679 debug_method_add (w, "cursor movement");
14680 #endif
14682 /* Scroll if point within this distance from the top or bottom
14683 of the window. This is a pixel value. */
14684 if (scroll_margin > 0)
14686 this_scroll_margin = min (scroll_margin, WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) / 4);
14687 this_scroll_margin *= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
14689 else
14690 this_scroll_margin = 0;
14692 top_scroll_margin = this_scroll_margin;
14693 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w))
14694 top_scroll_margin += CURRENT_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
14696 /* Start with the row the cursor was displayed during the last
14697 not paused redisplay. Give up if that row is not valid. */
14698 if (w->last_cursor.vpos < 0
14699 || w->last_cursor.vpos >= w->current_matrix->nrows)
14700 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
14701 else
14703 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->last_cursor.vpos);
14704 if (row->mode_line_p)
14705 ++row;
14706 if (!row->enabled_p)
14707 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
14710 if (rc == CURSOR_MOVEMENT_CANNOT_BE_USED)
14712 int scroll_p = 0, must_scroll = 0;
14713 int last_y = window_text_bottom_y (w) - this_scroll_margin;
14715 if (PT > XFASTINT (w->last_point))
14717 /* Point has moved forward. */
14718 while (MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) < PT
14719 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < last_y)
14721 xassert (row->enabled_p);
14722 ++row;
14725 /* If the end position of a row equals the start
14726 position of the next row, and PT is at that position,
14727 we would rather display cursor in the next line. */
14728 while (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < last_y
14729 && MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) == PT
14730 && row < w->current_matrix->rows
14731 + w->current_matrix->nrows - 1
14732 && MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row+1) == PT
14733 && !cursor_row_p (row))
14734 ++row;
14736 /* If within the scroll margin, scroll. Note that
14737 MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y gives the pixel position at which
14738 the next line would be drawn, and that
14739 this_scroll_margin can be zero. */
14740 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) > last_y
14741 || PT > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
14742 /* Line is completely visible last line in window
14743 and PT is to be set in the next line. */
14744 || (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) == last_y
14745 && PT == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
14746 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
14747 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row)))
14748 scroll_p = 1;
14750 else if (PT < XFASTINT (w->last_point))
14752 /* Cursor has to be moved backward. Note that PT >=
14753 CHARPOS (startp) because of the outer if-statement. */
14754 while (!row->mode_line_p
14755 && (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) > PT
14756 || (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) == PT
14757 && (MATRIX_ROW_STARTS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row)
14758 || (/* STARTS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_STRING_P (row) */
14759 row > w->current_matrix->rows
14760 && (row-1)->ends_in_newline_from_string_p))))
14761 && (row->y > top_scroll_margin
14762 || CHARPOS (startp) == BEGV))
14764 xassert (row->enabled_p);
14765 --row;
14768 /* Consider the following case: Window starts at BEGV,
14769 there is invisible, intangible text at BEGV, so that
14770 display starts at some point START > BEGV. It can
14771 happen that we are called with PT somewhere between
14772 BEGV and START. Try to handle that case. */
14773 if (row < w->current_matrix->rows
14774 || row->mode_line_p)
14776 row = w->current_matrix->rows;
14777 if (row->mode_line_p)
14778 ++row;
14781 /* Due to newlines in overlay strings, we may have to
14782 skip forward over overlay strings. */
14783 while (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < last_y
14784 && MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) == PT
14785 && !cursor_row_p (row))
14786 ++row;
14788 /* If within the scroll margin, scroll. */
14789 if (row->y < top_scroll_margin
14790 && CHARPOS (startp) != BEGV)
14791 scroll_p = 1;
14793 else
14795 /* Cursor did not move. So don't scroll even if cursor line
14796 is partially visible, as it was so before. */
14797 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS;
14800 if (PT < MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row)
14801 || PT > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row))
14803 /* if PT is not in the glyph row, give up. */
14804 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
14805 must_scroll = 1;
14807 else if (rc != CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS
14808 && !NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_display_reordering)))
14810 /* If rows are bidi-reordered and point moved, back up
14811 until we find a row that does not belong to a
14812 continuation line. This is because we must consider
14813 all rows of a continued line as candidates for the
14814 new cursor positioning, since row start and end
14815 positions change non-linearly with vertical position
14816 in such rows. */
14817 /* FIXME: Revisit this when glyph ``spilling'' in
14818 continuation lines' rows is implemented for
14819 bidi-reordered rows. */
14820 while (MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (row))
14822 xassert (row->enabled_p);
14823 --row;
14824 /* If we hit the beginning of the displayed portion
14825 without finding the first row of a continued
14826 line, give up. */
14827 if (row <= w->current_matrix->rows)
14829 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
14830 break;
14835 if (must_scroll)
14837 else if (rc != CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS
14838 && MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_P (w, row)
14839 && make_cursor_line_fully_visible_p)
14841 if (PT == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
14842 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
14843 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row))
14844 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
14845 else if (row->height > window_box_height (w))
14847 /* If we end up in a partially visible line, let's
14848 make it fully visible, except when it's taller
14849 than the window, in which case we can't do much
14850 about it. */
14851 *scroll_step = 1;
14852 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
14854 else
14856 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
14857 if (!cursor_row_fully_visible_p (w, 0, 1))
14858 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
14859 else
14860 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS;
14863 else if (scroll_p)
14864 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
14865 else if (rc != CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS
14866 && !NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_display_reordering)))
14868 /* With bidi-reordered rows, there could be more than
14869 one candidate row whose start and end positions
14870 occlude point. We need to let set_cursor_from_row
14871 find the best candidate. */
14872 /* FIXME: Revisit this when glyph ``spilling'' in
14873 continuation lines' rows is implemented for
14874 bidi-reordered rows. */
14875 int rv = 0;
14879 int at_zv_p = 0, exact_match_p = 0;
14881 if (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) <= PT
14882 && PT <= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
14883 && cursor_row_p (row))
14884 rv |= set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix,
14885 0, 0, 0, 0);
14886 /* As soon as we've found the exact match for point,
14887 or the first suitable row whose ends_at_zv_p flag
14888 is set, we are done. */
14889 at_zv_p =
14890 MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->cursor.vpos)->ends_at_zv_p;
14891 if (rv && !at_zv_p
14892 && w->cursor.hpos >= 0
14893 && w->cursor.hpos < MATRIX_ROW_USED (w->current_matrix,
14894 w->cursor.vpos))
14896 struct glyph_row *candidate =
14897 MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->cursor.vpos);
14898 struct glyph *g =
14899 candidate->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + w->cursor.hpos;
14900 EMACS_INT endpos = MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (candidate);
14902 exact_match_p =
14903 (BUFFERP (g->object) && g->charpos == PT)
14904 || (INTEGERP (g->object)
14905 && (g->charpos == PT
14906 || (g->charpos == 0 && endpos - 1 == PT)));
14908 if (rv && (at_zv_p || exact_match_p))
14910 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS;
14911 break;
14913 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) == last_y)
14914 break;
14915 ++row;
14917 while (((MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (row)
14918 || row->continued_p)
14919 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) <= last_y)
14920 || (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) == PT
14921 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < last_y));
14922 /* If we didn't find any candidate rows, or exited the
14923 loop before all the candidates were examined, signal
14924 to the caller that this method failed. */
14925 if (rc != CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS
14926 && !(rv
14927 && !MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (row)
14928 && !row->continued_p))
14929 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
14930 else if (rv)
14931 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS;
14933 else
14937 if (set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0))
14939 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS;
14940 break;
14942 ++row;
14944 while (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < last_y
14945 && MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) == PT
14946 && cursor_row_p (row));
14951 return rc;
14954 #if !defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS || defined USE_GTK
14955 static
14956 #endif
14957 void
14958 set_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window *w)
14960 EMACS_INT start, end, whole;
14962 /* Calculate the start and end positions for the current window.
14963 At some point, it would be nice to choose between scrollbars
14964 which reflect the whole buffer size, with special markers
14965 indicating narrowing, and scrollbars which reflect only the
14966 visible region.
14968 Note that mini-buffers sometimes aren't displaying any text. */
14969 if (!MINI_WINDOW_P (w)
14970 || (w == XWINDOW (minibuf_window)
14971 && NILP (echo_area_buffer[0])))
14973 struct buffer *buf = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
14974 whole = BUF_ZV (buf) - BUF_BEGV (buf);
14975 start = marker_position (w->start) - BUF_BEGV (buf);
14976 /* I don't think this is guaranteed to be right. For the
14977 moment, we'll pretend it is. */
14978 end = BUF_Z (buf) - XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos) - BUF_BEGV (buf);
14980 if (end < start)
14981 end = start;
14982 if (whole < (end - start))
14983 whole = end - start;
14985 else
14986 start = end = whole = 0;
14988 /* Indicate what this scroll bar ought to be displaying now. */
14989 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (XFRAME (w->frame))->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook)
14990 (*FRAME_TERMINAL (XFRAME (w->frame))->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook)
14991 (w, end - start, whole, start);
14995 /* Redisplay leaf window WINDOW. JUST_THIS_ONE_P non-zero means only
14996 selected_window is redisplayed.
14998 We can return without actually redisplaying the window if
14999 fonts_changed_p is nonzero. In that case, redisplay_internal will
15000 retry. */
15002 static void
15003 redisplay_window (Lisp_Object window, int just_this_one_p)
15005 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
15006 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
15007 struct buffer *buffer = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
15008 struct buffer *old = current_buffer;
15009 struct text_pos lpoint, opoint, startp;
15010 int update_mode_line;
15011 int tem;
15012 struct it it;
15013 /* Record it now because it's overwritten. */
15014 int current_matrix_up_to_date_p = 0;
15015 int used_current_matrix_p = 0;
15016 /* This is less strict than current_matrix_up_to_date_p.
15017 It indictes that the buffer contents and narrowing are unchanged. */
15018 int buffer_unchanged_p = 0;
15019 int temp_scroll_step = 0;
15020 int count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
15021 int rc;
15022 int centering_position = -1;
15023 int last_line_misfit = 0;
15024 EMACS_INT beg_unchanged, end_unchanged;
15026 SET_TEXT_POS (lpoint, PT, PT_BYTE);
15027 opoint = lpoint;
15029 /* W must be a leaf window here. */
15030 xassert (!NILP (w->buffer));
15031 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
15032 *w->desired_matrix->method = 0;
15033 #endif
15035 restart:
15036 reconsider_clip_changes (w, buffer);
15038 /* Has the mode line to be updated? */
15039 update_mode_line = (!NILP (w->update_mode_line)
15040 || update_mode_lines
15041 || buffer->clip_changed
15042 || buffer->prevent_redisplay_optimizations_p);
15044 if (MINI_WINDOW_P (w))
15046 if (w == XWINDOW (echo_area_window)
15047 && !NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]))
15049 if (update_mode_line)
15050 /* We may have to update a tty frame's menu bar or a
15051 tool-bar. Example `M-x C-h C-h C-g'. */
15052 goto finish_menu_bars;
15053 else
15054 /* We've already displayed the echo area glyphs in this window. */
15055 goto finish_scroll_bars;
15057 else if ((w != XWINDOW (minibuf_window)
15058 || minibuf_level == 0)
15059 /* When buffer is nonempty, redisplay window normally. */
15060 && BUF_Z (XBUFFER (w->buffer)) == BUF_BEG (XBUFFER (w->buffer))
15061 /* Quail displays non-mini buffers in minibuffer window.
15062 In that case, redisplay the window normally. */
15063 && !NILP (Fmemq (w->buffer, Vminibuffer_list)))
15065 /* W is a mini-buffer window, but it's not active, so clear
15066 it. */
15067 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
15068 struct glyph_row *row;
15069 int y;
15071 for (y = 0, row = w->desired_matrix->rows;
15072 y < yb;
15073 y += row->height, ++row)
15074 blank_row (w, row, y);
15075 goto finish_scroll_bars;
15078 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
15081 /* Otherwise set up data on this window; select its buffer and point
15082 value. */
15083 /* Really select the buffer, for the sake of buffer-local
15084 variables. */
15085 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (w->buffer));
15087 current_matrix_up_to_date_p
15088 = (!NILP (w->window_end_valid)
15089 && !current_buffer->clip_changed
15090 && !current_buffer->prevent_redisplay_optimizations_p
15091 && XFASTINT (w->last_modified) >= MODIFF
15092 && XFASTINT (w->last_overlay_modified) >= OVERLAY_MODIFF);
15094 /* Run the window-bottom-change-functions
15095 if it is possible that the text on the screen has changed
15096 (either due to modification of the text, or any other reason). */
15097 if (!current_matrix_up_to_date_p
15098 && !NILP (Vwindow_text_change_functions))
15100 safe_run_hooks (Qwindow_text_change_functions);
15101 goto restart;
15104 beg_unchanged = BEG_UNCHANGED;
15105 end_unchanged = END_UNCHANGED;
15107 SET_TEXT_POS (opoint, PT, PT_BYTE);
15109 specbind (Qinhibit_point_motion_hooks, Qt);
15111 buffer_unchanged_p
15112 = (!NILP (w->window_end_valid)
15113 && !current_buffer->clip_changed
15114 && XFASTINT (w->last_modified) >= MODIFF
15115 && XFASTINT (w->last_overlay_modified) >= OVERLAY_MODIFF);
15117 /* When windows_or_buffers_changed is non-zero, we can't rely on
15118 the window end being valid, so set it to nil there. */
15119 if (windows_or_buffers_changed)
15121 /* If window starts on a continuation line, maybe adjust the
15122 window start in case the window's width changed. */
15123 if (XMARKER (w->start)->buffer == current_buffer)
15124 compute_window_start_on_continuation_line (w);
15126 w->window_end_valid = Qnil;
15129 /* Some sanity checks. */
15130 CHECK_WINDOW_END (w);
15131 if (Z == Z_BYTE && CHARPOS (opoint) != BYTEPOS (opoint))
15132 abort ();
15133 if (BYTEPOS (opoint) < CHARPOS (opoint))
15134 abort ();
15136 /* If %c is in mode line, update it if needed. */
15137 if (!NILP (w->column_number_displayed)
15138 /* This alternative quickly identifies a common case
15139 where no change is needed. */
15140 && !(PT == XFASTINT (w->last_point)
15141 && XFASTINT (w->last_modified) >= MODIFF
15142 && XFASTINT (w->last_overlay_modified) >= OVERLAY_MODIFF)
15143 && (XFASTINT (w->column_number_displayed) != current_column ()))
15144 update_mode_line = 1;
15146 /* Count number of windows showing the selected buffer. An indirect
15147 buffer counts as its base buffer. */
15148 if (!just_this_one_p)
15150 struct buffer *current_base, *window_base;
15151 current_base = current_buffer;
15152 window_base = XBUFFER (XWINDOW (selected_window)->buffer);
15153 if (current_base->base_buffer)
15154 current_base = current_base->base_buffer;
15155 if (window_base->base_buffer)
15156 window_base = window_base->base_buffer;
15157 if (current_base == window_base)
15158 buffer_shared++;
15161 /* Point refers normally to the selected window. For any other
15162 window, set up appropriate value. */
15163 if (!EQ (window, selected_window))
15165 EMACS_INT new_pt = XMARKER (w->pointm)->charpos;
15166 EMACS_INT new_pt_byte = marker_byte_position (w->pointm);
15167 if (new_pt < BEGV)
15169 new_pt = BEGV;
15170 new_pt_byte = BEGV_BYTE;
15171 set_marker_both (w->pointm, Qnil, BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
15173 else if (new_pt > (ZV - 1))
15175 new_pt = ZV;
15176 new_pt_byte = ZV_BYTE;
15177 set_marker_both (w->pointm, Qnil, ZV, ZV_BYTE);
15180 /* We don't use SET_PT so that the point-motion hooks don't run. */
15181 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (new_pt, new_pt_byte);
15184 /* If any of the character widths specified in the display table
15185 have changed, invalidate the width run cache. It's true that
15186 this may be a bit late to catch such changes, but the rest of
15187 redisplay goes (non-fatally) haywire when the display table is
15188 changed, so why should we worry about doing any better? */
15189 if (current_buffer->width_run_cache)
15191 struct Lisp_Char_Table *disptab = buffer_display_table ();
15193 if (! disptab_matches_widthtab (disptab,
15194 XVECTOR (BVAR (current_buffer, width_table))))
15196 invalidate_region_cache (current_buffer,
15197 current_buffer->width_run_cache,
15198 BEG, Z);
15199 recompute_width_table (current_buffer, disptab);
15203 /* If window-start is screwed up, choose a new one. */
15204 if (XMARKER (w->start)->buffer != current_buffer)
15205 goto recenter;
15207 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (startp, w->start);
15209 /* If someone specified a new starting point but did not insist,
15210 check whether it can be used. */
15211 if (!NILP (w->optional_new_start)
15212 && CHARPOS (startp) >= BEGV
15213 && CHARPOS (startp) <= ZV)
15215 w->optional_new_start = Qnil;
15216 start_display (&it, w, startp);
15217 move_it_to (&it, PT, 0, it.last_visible_y, -1,
15218 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_X | MOVE_TO_Y);
15219 if (IT_CHARPOS (it) == PT)
15220 w->force_start = Qt;
15221 /* IT may overshoot PT if text at PT is invisible. */
15222 else if (IT_CHARPOS (it) > PT && CHARPOS (startp) <= PT)
15223 w->force_start = Qt;
15226 force_start:
15228 /* Handle case where place to start displaying has been specified,
15229 unless the specified location is outside the accessible range. */
15230 if (!NILP (w->force_start)
15231 || w->frozen_window_start_p)
15233 /* We set this later on if we have to adjust point. */
15234 int new_vpos = -1;
15236 w->force_start = Qnil;
15237 w->vscroll = 0;
15238 w->window_end_valid = Qnil;
15240 /* Forget any recorded base line for line number display. */
15241 if (!buffer_unchanged_p)
15242 w->base_line_number = Qnil;
15244 /* Redisplay the mode line. Select the buffer properly for that.
15245 Also, run the hook window-scroll-functions
15246 because we have scrolled. */
15247 /* Note, we do this after clearing force_start because
15248 if there's an error, it is better to forget about force_start
15249 than to get into an infinite loop calling the hook functions
15250 and having them get more errors. */
15251 if (!update_mode_line
15252 || ! NILP (Vwindow_scroll_functions))
15254 update_mode_line = 1;
15255 w->update_mode_line = Qt;
15256 startp = run_window_scroll_functions (window, startp);
15259 w->last_modified = make_number (0);
15260 w->last_overlay_modified = make_number (0);
15261 if (CHARPOS (startp) < BEGV)
15262 SET_TEXT_POS (startp, BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
15263 else if (CHARPOS (startp) > ZV)
15264 SET_TEXT_POS (startp, ZV, ZV_BYTE);
15266 /* Redisplay, then check if cursor has been set during the
15267 redisplay. Give up if new fonts were loaded. */
15268 /* We used to issue a CHECK_MARGINS argument to try_window here,
15269 but this causes scrolling to fail when point begins inside
15270 the scroll margin (bug#148) -- cyd */
15271 if (!try_window (window, startp, 0))
15273 w->force_start = Qt;
15274 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
15275 goto need_larger_matrices;
15278 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0 && !w->frozen_window_start_p)
15280 /* If point does not appear, try to move point so it does
15281 appear. The desired matrix has been built above, so we
15282 can use it here. */
15283 new_vpos = window_box_height (w) / 2;
15286 if (!cursor_row_fully_visible_p (w, 0, 0))
15288 /* Point does appear, but on a line partly visible at end of window.
15289 Move it back to a fully-visible line. */
15290 new_vpos = window_box_height (w);
15293 /* If we need to move point for either of the above reasons,
15294 now actually do it. */
15295 if (new_vpos >= 0)
15297 struct glyph_row *row;
15299 row = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->desired_matrix);
15300 while (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < new_vpos)
15301 ++row;
15303 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row),
15304 MATRIX_ROW_START_BYTEPOS (row));
15306 if (w != XWINDOW (selected_window))
15307 set_marker_both (w->pointm, Qnil, PT, PT_BYTE);
15308 else if (current_buffer == old)
15309 SET_TEXT_POS (lpoint, PT, PT_BYTE);
15311 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->desired_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
15313 /* If we are highlighting the region, then we just changed
15314 the region, so redisplay to show it. */
15315 if (!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
15316 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, mark_active)))
15318 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
15319 if (!try_window (window, startp, 0))
15320 goto need_larger_matrices;
15324 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
15325 debug_method_add (w, "forced window start");
15326 #endif
15327 goto done;
15330 /* Handle case where text has not changed, only point, and it has
15331 not moved off the frame, and we are not retrying after hscroll.
15332 (current_matrix_up_to_date_p is nonzero when retrying.) */
15333 if (current_matrix_up_to_date_p
15334 && (rc = try_cursor_movement (window, startp, &temp_scroll_step),
15335 rc != CURSOR_MOVEMENT_CANNOT_BE_USED))
15337 switch (rc)
15339 case CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS:
15340 used_current_matrix_p = 1;
15341 goto done;
15343 case CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL:
15344 goto try_to_scroll;
15346 default:
15347 abort ();
15350 /* If current starting point was originally the beginning of a line
15351 but no longer is, find a new starting point. */
15352 else if (!NILP (w->start_at_line_beg)
15353 && !(CHARPOS (startp) <= BEGV
15354 || FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (startp) - 1) == '\n'))
15356 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
15357 debug_method_add (w, "recenter 1");
15358 #endif
15359 goto recenter;
15362 /* Try scrolling with try_window_id. Value is > 0 if update has
15363 been done, it is -1 if we know that the same window start will
15364 not work. It is 0 if unsuccessful for some other reason. */
15365 else if ((tem = try_window_id (w)) != 0)
15367 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
15368 debug_method_add (w, "try_window_id %d", tem);
15369 #endif
15371 if (fonts_changed_p)
15372 goto need_larger_matrices;
15373 if (tem > 0)
15374 goto done;
15376 /* Otherwise try_window_id has returned -1 which means that we
15377 don't want the alternative below this comment to execute. */
15379 else if (CHARPOS (startp) >= BEGV
15380 && CHARPOS (startp) <= ZV
15381 && PT >= CHARPOS (startp)
15382 && (CHARPOS (startp) < ZV
15383 /* Avoid starting at end of buffer. */
15384 || CHARPOS (startp) == BEGV
15385 || (XFASTINT (w->last_modified) >= MODIFF
15386 && XFASTINT (w->last_overlay_modified) >= OVERLAY_MODIFF)))
15388 int d1, d2, d3, d4, d5, d6;
15390 /* If first window line is a continuation line, and window start
15391 is inside the modified region, but the first change is before
15392 current window start, we must select a new window start.
15394 However, if this is the result of a down-mouse event (e.g. by
15395 extending the mouse-drag-overlay), we don't want to select a
15396 new window start, since that would change the position under
15397 the mouse, resulting in an unwanted mouse-movement rather
15398 than a simple mouse-click. */
15399 if (NILP (w->start_at_line_beg)
15400 && NILP (do_mouse_tracking)
15401 && CHARPOS (startp) > BEGV
15402 && CHARPOS (startp) > BEG + beg_unchanged
15403 && CHARPOS (startp) <= Z - end_unchanged
15404 /* Even if w->start_at_line_beg is nil, a new window may
15405 start at a line_beg, since that's how set_buffer_window
15406 sets it. So, we need to check the return value of
15407 compute_window_start_on_continuation_line. (See also
15408 bug#197). */
15409 && XMARKER (w->start)->buffer == current_buffer
15410 && compute_window_start_on_continuation_line (w)
15411 /* It doesn't make sense to force the window start like we
15412 do at label force_start if it is already known that point
15413 will not be visible in the resulting window, because
15414 doing so will move point from its correct position
15415 instead of scrolling the window to bring point into view.
15416 See bug#9324. */
15417 && pos_visible_p (w, PT, &d1, &d2, &d3, &d4, &d5, &d6))
15419 w->force_start = Qt;
15420 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (startp, w->start);
15421 goto force_start;
15424 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
15425 debug_method_add (w, "same window start");
15426 #endif
15428 /* Try to redisplay starting at same place as before.
15429 If point has not moved off frame, accept the results. */
15430 if (!current_matrix_up_to_date_p
15431 /* Don't use try_window_reusing_current_matrix in this case
15432 because a window scroll function can have changed the
15433 buffer. */
15434 || !NILP (Vwindow_scroll_functions)
15435 || MINI_WINDOW_P (w)
15436 || !(used_current_matrix_p
15437 = try_window_reusing_current_matrix (w)))
15439 IF_DEBUG (debug_method_add (w, "1"));
15440 if (try_window (window, startp, TRY_WINDOW_CHECK_MARGINS) < 0)
15441 /* -1 means we need to scroll.
15442 0 means we need new matrices, but fonts_changed_p
15443 is set in that case, so we will detect it below. */
15444 goto try_to_scroll;
15447 if (fonts_changed_p)
15448 goto need_larger_matrices;
15450 if (w->cursor.vpos >= 0)
15452 if (!just_this_one_p
15453 || current_buffer->clip_changed
15454 || BEG_UNCHANGED < CHARPOS (startp))
15455 /* Forget any recorded base line for line number display. */
15456 w->base_line_number = Qnil;
15458 if (!cursor_row_fully_visible_p (w, 1, 0))
15460 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
15461 last_line_misfit = 1;
15463 /* Drop through and scroll. */
15464 else
15465 goto done;
15467 else
15468 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
15471 try_to_scroll:
15473 w->last_modified = make_number (0);
15474 w->last_overlay_modified = make_number (0);
15476 /* Redisplay the mode line. Select the buffer properly for that. */
15477 if (!update_mode_line)
15479 update_mode_line = 1;
15480 w->update_mode_line = Qt;
15483 /* Try to scroll by specified few lines. */
15484 if ((scroll_conservatively
15485 || emacs_scroll_step
15486 || temp_scroll_step
15487 || NUMBERP (BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_up_aggressively))
15488 || NUMBERP (BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_down_aggressively)))
15489 && CHARPOS (startp) >= BEGV
15490 && CHARPOS (startp) <= ZV)
15492 /* The function returns -1 if new fonts were loaded, 1 if
15493 successful, 0 if not successful. */
15494 int ss = try_scrolling (window, just_this_one_p,
15495 scroll_conservatively,
15496 emacs_scroll_step,
15497 temp_scroll_step, last_line_misfit);
15498 switch (ss)
15500 case SCROLLING_SUCCESS:
15501 goto done;
15503 case SCROLLING_NEED_LARGER_MATRICES:
15504 goto need_larger_matrices;
15506 case SCROLLING_FAILED:
15507 break;
15509 default:
15510 abort ();
15514 /* Finally, just choose a place to start which positions point
15515 according to user preferences. */
15517 recenter:
15519 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
15520 debug_method_add (w, "recenter");
15521 #endif
15523 /* w->vscroll = 0; */
15525 /* Forget any previously recorded base line for line number display. */
15526 if (!buffer_unchanged_p)
15527 w->base_line_number = Qnil;
15529 /* Determine the window start relative to point. */
15530 init_iterator (&it, w, PT, PT_BYTE, NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
15531 it.current_y = it.last_visible_y;
15532 if (centering_position < 0)
15534 int margin =
15535 scroll_margin > 0
15536 ? min (scroll_margin, WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) / 4)
15537 : 0;
15538 EMACS_INT margin_pos = CHARPOS (startp);
15539 int scrolling_up;
15540 Lisp_Object aggressive;
15542 /* If there is a scroll margin at the top of the window, find
15543 its character position. */
15544 if (margin
15545 /* Cannot call start_display if startp is not in the
15546 accessible region of the buffer. This can happen when we
15547 have just switched to a different buffer and/or changed
15548 its restriction. In that case, startp is initialized to
15549 the character position 1 (BEG) because we did not yet
15550 have chance to display the buffer even once. */
15551 && BEGV <= CHARPOS (startp) && CHARPOS (startp) <= ZV)
15553 struct it it1;
15554 void *it1data = NULL;
15556 SAVE_IT (it1, it, it1data);
15557 start_display (&it1, w, startp);
15558 move_it_vertically (&it1, margin);
15559 margin_pos = IT_CHARPOS (it1);
15560 RESTORE_IT (&it, &it, it1data);
15562 scrolling_up = PT > margin_pos;
15563 aggressive =
15564 scrolling_up
15565 ? BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_up_aggressively)
15566 : BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_down_aggressively);
15568 if (!MINI_WINDOW_P (w)
15569 && (scroll_conservatively > SCROLL_LIMIT || NUMBERP (aggressive)))
15571 int pt_offset = 0;
15573 /* Setting scroll-conservatively overrides
15574 scroll-*-aggressively. */
15575 if (!scroll_conservatively && NUMBERP (aggressive))
15577 double float_amount = XFLOATINT (aggressive);
15579 pt_offset = float_amount * WINDOW_BOX_TEXT_HEIGHT (w);
15580 if (pt_offset == 0 && float_amount > 0)
15581 pt_offset = 1;
15582 if (pt_offset)
15583 margin -= 1;
15585 /* Compute how much to move the window start backward from
15586 point so that point will be displayed where the user
15587 wants it. */
15588 if (scrolling_up)
15590 centering_position = it.last_visible_y;
15591 if (pt_offset)
15592 centering_position -= pt_offset;
15593 centering_position -=
15594 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) * (1 + margin + (last_line_misfit != 0))
15595 + WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
15596 /* Don't let point enter the scroll margin near top of
15597 the window. */
15598 if (centering_position < margin * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
15599 centering_position = margin * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
15601 else
15602 centering_position = margin * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) + pt_offset;
15604 else
15605 /* Set the window start half the height of the window backward
15606 from point. */
15607 centering_position = window_box_height (w) / 2;
15609 move_it_vertically_backward (&it, centering_position);
15611 xassert (IT_CHARPOS (it) >= BEGV);
15613 /* The function move_it_vertically_backward may move over more
15614 than the specified y-distance. If it->w is small, e.g. a
15615 mini-buffer window, we may end up in front of the window's
15616 display area. Start displaying at the start of the line
15617 containing PT in this case. */
15618 if (it.current_y <= 0)
15620 init_iterator (&it, w, PT, PT_BYTE, NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
15621 move_it_vertically_backward (&it, 0);
15622 it.current_y = 0;
15625 it.current_x = it.hpos = 0;
15627 /* Set the window start position here explicitly, to avoid an
15628 infinite loop in case the functions in window-scroll-functions
15629 get errors. */
15630 set_marker_both (w->start, Qnil, IT_CHARPOS (it), IT_BYTEPOS (it));
15632 /* Run scroll hooks. */
15633 startp = run_window_scroll_functions (window, it.current.pos);
15635 /* Redisplay the window. */
15636 if (!current_matrix_up_to_date_p
15637 || windows_or_buffers_changed
15638 || cursor_type_changed
15639 /* Don't use try_window_reusing_current_matrix in this case
15640 because it can have changed the buffer. */
15641 || !NILP (Vwindow_scroll_functions)
15642 || !just_this_one_p
15643 || MINI_WINDOW_P (w)
15644 || !(used_current_matrix_p
15645 = try_window_reusing_current_matrix (w)))
15646 try_window (window, startp, 0);
15648 /* If new fonts have been loaded (due to fontsets), give up. We
15649 have to start a new redisplay since we need to re-adjust glyph
15650 matrices. */
15651 if (fonts_changed_p)
15652 goto need_larger_matrices;
15654 /* If cursor did not appear assume that the middle of the window is
15655 in the first line of the window. Do it again with the next line.
15656 (Imagine a window of height 100, displaying two lines of height
15657 60. Moving back 50 from it->last_visible_y will end in the first
15658 line.) */
15659 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
15661 if (!NILP (w->window_end_valid)
15662 && PT >= Z - XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos))
15664 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
15665 move_it_by_lines (&it, 1);
15666 try_window (window, it.current.pos, 0);
15668 else if (PT < IT_CHARPOS (it))
15670 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
15671 move_it_by_lines (&it, -1);
15672 try_window (window, it.current.pos, 0);
15674 else
15676 /* Not much we can do about it. */
15680 /* Consider the following case: Window starts at BEGV, there is
15681 invisible, intangible text at BEGV, so that display starts at
15682 some point START > BEGV. It can happen that we are called with
15683 PT somewhere between BEGV and START. Try to handle that case. */
15684 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
15686 struct glyph_row *row = w->current_matrix->rows;
15687 if (row->mode_line_p)
15688 ++row;
15689 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
15692 if (!cursor_row_fully_visible_p (w, 0, 0))
15694 /* If vscroll is enabled, disable it and try again. */
15695 if (w->vscroll)
15697 w->vscroll = 0;
15698 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
15699 goto recenter;
15702 /* If centering point failed to make the whole line visible,
15703 put point at the top instead. That has to make the whole line
15704 visible, if it can be done. */
15705 if (centering_position == 0)
15706 goto done;
15708 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
15709 centering_position = 0;
15710 goto recenter;
15713 done:
15715 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (startp, w->start);
15716 w->start_at_line_beg = ((CHARPOS (startp) == BEGV
15717 || FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (startp) - 1) == '\n')
15718 ? Qt : Qnil);
15720 /* Display the mode line, if we must. */
15721 if ((update_mode_line
15722 /* If window not full width, must redo its mode line
15723 if (a) the window to its side is being redone and
15724 (b) we do a frame-based redisplay. This is a consequence
15725 of how inverted lines are drawn in frame-based redisplay. */
15726 || (!just_this_one_p
15727 && !FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
15728 && !WINDOW_FULL_WIDTH_P (w))
15729 /* Line number to display. */
15730 || INTEGERP (w->base_line_pos)
15731 /* Column number is displayed and different from the one displayed. */
15732 || (!NILP (w->column_number_displayed)
15733 && (XFASTINT (w->column_number_displayed) != current_column ())))
15734 /* This means that the window has a mode line. */
15735 && (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w)
15736 || WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w)))
15738 display_mode_lines (w);
15740 /* If mode line height has changed, arrange for a thorough
15741 immediate redisplay using the correct mode line height. */
15742 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w)
15743 && CURRENT_MODE_LINE_HEIGHT (w) != DESIRED_MODE_LINE_HEIGHT (w))
15745 fonts_changed_p = 1;
15746 MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)->height
15747 = DESIRED_MODE_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
15750 /* If header line height has changed, arrange for a thorough
15751 immediate redisplay using the correct header line height. */
15752 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w)
15753 && CURRENT_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w) != DESIRED_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w))
15755 fonts_changed_p = 1;
15756 MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)->height
15757 = DESIRED_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
15760 if (fonts_changed_p)
15761 goto need_larger_matrices;
15764 if (!line_number_displayed
15765 && !BUFFERP (w->base_line_pos))
15767 w->base_line_pos = Qnil;
15768 w->base_line_number = Qnil;
15771 finish_menu_bars:
15773 /* When we reach a frame's selected window, redo the frame's menu bar. */
15774 if (update_mode_line
15775 && EQ (FRAME_SELECTED_WINDOW (f), window))
15777 int redisplay_menu_p = 0;
15779 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
15781 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (HAVE_NTGUI) \
15782 || defined (HAVE_NS) || defined (USE_GTK)
15783 redisplay_menu_p = FRAME_EXTERNAL_MENU_BAR (f);
15784 #else
15785 redisplay_menu_p = FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f) > 0;
15786 #endif
15788 else
15789 redisplay_menu_p = FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f) > 0;
15791 if (redisplay_menu_p)
15792 display_menu_bar (w);
15794 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
15795 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
15797 #if defined (USE_GTK) || defined (HAVE_NS)
15798 if (FRAME_EXTERNAL_TOOL_BAR (f))
15799 redisplay_tool_bar (f);
15800 #else
15801 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
15802 && (FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) > 0
15803 || !NILP (Vauto_resize_tool_bars))
15804 && redisplay_tool_bar (f))
15805 ignore_mouse_drag_p = 1;
15806 #endif
15808 #endif
15811 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
15812 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
15813 && update_window_fringes (w, (just_this_one_p
15814 || (!used_current_matrix_p && !overlay_arrow_seen)
15815 || w->pseudo_window_p)))
15817 update_begin (f);
15818 BLOCK_INPUT;
15819 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
15820 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
15821 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
15822 update_end (f);
15824 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
15826 /* We go to this label, with fonts_changed_p nonzero,
15827 if it is necessary to try again using larger glyph matrices.
15828 We have to redeem the scroll bar even in this case,
15829 because the loop in redisplay_internal expects that. */
15830 need_larger_matrices:
15832 finish_scroll_bars:
15834 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR (w))
15836 /* Set the thumb's position and size. */
15837 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
15839 /* Note that we actually used the scroll bar attached to this
15840 window, so it shouldn't be deleted at the end of redisplay. */
15841 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->redeem_scroll_bar_hook)
15842 (*FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->redeem_scroll_bar_hook) (w);
15845 /* Restore current_buffer and value of point in it. The window
15846 update may have changed the buffer, so first make sure `opoint'
15847 is still valid (Bug#6177). */
15848 if (CHARPOS (opoint) < BEGV)
15849 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
15850 else if (CHARPOS (opoint) > ZV)
15851 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (Z, Z_BYTE);
15852 else
15853 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (CHARPOS (opoint), BYTEPOS (opoint));
15855 set_buffer_internal_1 (old);
15856 /* Avoid an abort in TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH if the buffer has become
15857 shorter. This can be caused by log truncation in *Messages*. */
15858 if (CHARPOS (lpoint) <= ZV)
15859 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (CHARPOS (lpoint), BYTEPOS (lpoint));
15861 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
15865 /* Build the complete desired matrix of WINDOW with a window start
15866 buffer position POS.
15868 Value is 1 if successful. It is zero if fonts were loaded during
15869 redisplay which makes re-adjusting glyph matrices necessary, and -1
15870 if point would appear in the scroll margins.
15871 (We check the former only if TRY_WINDOW_IGNORE_FONTS_CHANGE is
15872 unset in FLAGS, and the latter only if TRY_WINDOW_CHECK_MARGINS is
15873 set in FLAGS.) */
15876 try_window (Lisp_Object window, struct text_pos pos, int flags)
15878 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
15879 struct it it;
15880 struct glyph_row *last_text_row = NULL;
15881 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
15883 /* Make POS the new window start. */
15884 set_marker_both (w->start, Qnil, CHARPOS (pos), BYTEPOS (pos));
15886 /* Mark cursor position as unknown. No overlay arrow seen. */
15887 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
15888 overlay_arrow_seen = 0;
15890 /* Initialize iterator and info to start at POS. */
15891 start_display (&it, w, pos);
15893 /* Display all lines of W. */
15894 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y)
15896 if (display_line (&it))
15897 last_text_row = it.glyph_row - 1;
15898 if (fonts_changed_p && !(flags & TRY_WINDOW_IGNORE_FONTS_CHANGE))
15899 return 0;
15902 /* Don't let the cursor end in the scroll margins. */
15903 if ((flags & TRY_WINDOW_CHECK_MARGINS)
15904 && !MINI_WINDOW_P (w))
15906 int this_scroll_margin;
15908 if (scroll_margin > 0)
15910 this_scroll_margin = min (scroll_margin, WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) / 4);
15911 this_scroll_margin *= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
15913 else
15914 this_scroll_margin = 0;
15916 if ((w->cursor.y >= 0 /* not vscrolled */
15917 && w->cursor.y < this_scroll_margin
15918 && CHARPOS (pos) > BEGV
15919 && IT_CHARPOS (it) < ZV)
15920 /* rms: considering make_cursor_line_fully_visible_p here
15921 seems to give wrong results. We don't want to recenter
15922 when the last line is partly visible, we want to allow
15923 that case to be handled in the usual way. */
15924 || w->cursor.y > it.last_visible_y - this_scroll_margin - 1)
15926 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
15927 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
15928 return -1;
15932 /* If bottom moved off end of frame, change mode line percentage. */
15933 if (XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos) <= 0
15934 && Z != IT_CHARPOS (it))
15935 w->update_mode_line = Qt;
15937 /* Set window_end_pos to the offset of the last character displayed
15938 on the window from the end of current_buffer. Set
15939 window_end_vpos to its row number. */
15940 if (last_text_row)
15942 xassert (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (last_text_row));
15943 w->window_end_bytepos
15944 = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (last_text_row);
15945 w->window_end_pos
15946 = make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (last_text_row));
15947 w->window_end_vpos
15948 = make_number (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_text_row, w->desired_matrix));
15949 xassert (MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix, XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos))
15950 ->displays_text_p);
15952 else
15954 w->window_end_bytepos = Z_BYTE - ZV_BYTE;
15955 w->window_end_pos = make_number (Z - ZV);
15956 w->window_end_vpos = make_number (0);
15959 /* But that is not valid info until redisplay finishes. */
15960 w->window_end_valid = Qnil;
15961 return 1;
15966 /************************************************************************
15967 Window redisplay reusing current matrix when buffer has not changed
15968 ************************************************************************/
15970 /* Try redisplay of window W showing an unchanged buffer with a
15971 different window start than the last time it was displayed by
15972 reusing its current matrix. Value is non-zero if successful.
15973 W->start is the new window start. */
15975 static int
15976 try_window_reusing_current_matrix (struct window *w)
15978 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
15979 struct glyph_row *bottom_row;
15980 struct it it;
15981 struct run run;
15982 struct text_pos start, new_start;
15983 int nrows_scrolled, i;
15984 struct glyph_row *last_text_row;
15985 struct glyph_row *last_reused_text_row;
15986 struct glyph_row *start_row;
15987 int start_vpos, min_y, max_y;
15989 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
15990 if (inhibit_try_window_reusing)
15991 return 0;
15992 #endif
15994 if (/* This function doesn't handle terminal frames. */
15995 !FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
15996 /* Don't try to reuse the display if windows have been split
15997 or such. */
15998 || windows_or_buffers_changed
15999 || cursor_type_changed)
16000 return 0;
16002 /* Can't do this if region may have changed. */
16003 if ((!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
16004 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, mark_active)))
16005 || !NILP (w->region_showing)
16006 || !NILP (Vshow_trailing_whitespace))
16007 return 0;
16009 /* If top-line visibility has changed, give up. */
16010 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w)
16011 != MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)->mode_line_p)
16012 return 0;
16014 /* Give up if old or new display is scrolled vertically. We could
16015 make this function handle this, but right now it doesn't. */
16016 start_row = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
16017 if (w->vscroll || MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_P (w, start_row))
16018 return 0;
16020 /* The variable new_start now holds the new window start. The old
16021 start `start' can be determined from the current matrix. */
16022 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (new_start, w->start);
16023 start = start_row->minpos;
16024 start_vpos = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (start_row, w->current_matrix);
16026 /* Clear the desired matrix for the display below. */
16027 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16029 if (CHARPOS (new_start) <= CHARPOS (start))
16031 /* Don't use this method if the display starts with an ellipsis
16032 displayed for invisible text. It's not easy to handle that case
16033 below, and it's certainly not worth the effort since this is
16034 not a frequent case. */
16035 if (in_ellipses_for_invisible_text_p (&start_row->start, w))
16036 return 0;
16038 IF_DEBUG (debug_method_add (w, "twu1"));
16040 /* Display up to a row that can be reused. The variable
16041 last_text_row is set to the last row displayed that displays
16042 text. Note that it.vpos == 0 if or if not there is a
16043 header-line; it's not the same as the MATRIX_ROW_VPOS! */
16044 start_display (&it, w, new_start);
16045 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
16046 last_text_row = last_reused_text_row = NULL;
16048 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y
16049 && !fonts_changed_p)
16051 /* If we have reached into the characters in the START row,
16052 that means the line boundaries have changed. So we
16053 can't start copying with the row START. Maybe it will
16054 work to start copying with the following row. */
16055 while (IT_CHARPOS (it) > CHARPOS (start))
16057 /* Advance to the next row as the "start". */
16058 start_row++;
16059 start = start_row->minpos;
16060 /* If there are no more rows to try, or just one, give up. */
16061 if (start_row == MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix) - 1
16062 || w->vscroll || MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_P (w, start_row)
16063 || CHARPOS (start) == ZV)
16065 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16066 return 0;
16069 start_vpos = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (start_row, w->current_matrix);
16071 /* If we have reached alignment,
16072 we can copy the rest of the rows. */
16073 if (IT_CHARPOS (it) == CHARPOS (start))
16074 break;
16076 if (display_line (&it))
16077 last_text_row = it.glyph_row - 1;
16080 /* A value of current_y < last_visible_y means that we stopped
16081 at the previous window start, which in turn means that we
16082 have at least one reusable row. */
16083 if (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y)
16085 struct glyph_row *row;
16087 /* IT.vpos always starts from 0; it counts text lines. */
16088 nrows_scrolled = it.vpos - (start_row - MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix));
16090 /* Find PT if not already found in the lines displayed. */
16091 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
16093 int dy = it.current_y - start_row->y;
16095 row = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
16096 row = row_containing_pos (w, PT, row, NULL, dy);
16097 if (row)
16098 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, 0, 0,
16099 dy, nrows_scrolled);
16100 else
16102 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16103 return 0;
16107 /* Scroll the display. Do it before the current matrix is
16108 changed. The problem here is that update has not yet
16109 run, i.e. part of the current matrix is not up to date.
16110 scroll_run_hook will clear the cursor, and use the
16111 current matrix to get the height of the row the cursor is
16112 in. */
16113 run.current_y = start_row->y;
16114 run.desired_y = it.current_y;
16115 run.height = it.last_visible_y - it.current_y;
16117 if (run.height > 0 && run.current_y != run.desired_y)
16119 update_begin (f);
16120 FRAME_RIF (f)->update_window_begin_hook (w);
16121 FRAME_RIF (f)->clear_window_mouse_face (w);
16122 FRAME_RIF (f)->scroll_run_hook (w, &run);
16123 FRAME_RIF (f)->update_window_end_hook (w, 0, 0);
16124 update_end (f);
16127 /* Shift current matrix down by nrows_scrolled lines. */
16128 bottom_row = MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix, w);
16129 rotate_matrix (w->current_matrix,
16130 start_vpos,
16131 MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (bottom_row, w->current_matrix),
16132 nrows_scrolled);
16134 /* Disable lines that must be updated. */
16135 for (i = 0; i < nrows_scrolled; ++i)
16136 (start_row + i)->enabled_p = 0;
16138 /* Re-compute Y positions. */
16139 min_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
16140 max_y = it.last_visible_y;
16141 for (row = start_row + nrows_scrolled;
16142 row < bottom_row;
16143 ++row)
16145 row->y = it.current_y;
16146 row->visible_height = row->height;
16148 if (row->y < min_y)
16149 row->visible_height -= min_y - row->y;
16150 if (row->y + row->height > max_y)
16151 row->visible_height -= row->y + row->height - max_y;
16152 if (row->fringe_bitmap_periodic_p)
16153 row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
16155 it.current_y += row->height;
16157 if (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row))
16158 last_reused_text_row = row;
16159 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) >= it.last_visible_y)
16160 break;
16163 /* Disable lines in the current matrix which are now
16164 below the window. */
16165 for (++row; row < bottom_row; ++row)
16166 row->enabled_p = row->mode_line_p = 0;
16169 /* Update window_end_pos etc.; last_reused_text_row is the last
16170 reused row from the current matrix containing text, if any.
16171 The value of last_text_row is the last displayed line
16172 containing text. */
16173 if (last_reused_text_row)
16175 w->window_end_bytepos
16176 = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (last_reused_text_row);
16177 w->window_end_pos
16178 = make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (last_reused_text_row));
16179 w->window_end_vpos
16180 = make_number (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_reused_text_row,
16181 w->current_matrix));
16183 else if (last_text_row)
16185 w->window_end_bytepos
16186 = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (last_text_row);
16187 w->window_end_pos
16188 = make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (last_text_row));
16189 w->window_end_vpos
16190 = make_number (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_text_row, w->desired_matrix));
16192 else
16194 /* This window must be completely empty. */
16195 w->window_end_bytepos = Z_BYTE - ZV_BYTE;
16196 w->window_end_pos = make_number (Z - ZV);
16197 w->window_end_vpos = make_number (0);
16199 w->window_end_valid = Qnil;
16201 /* Update hint: don't try scrolling again in update_window. */
16202 w->desired_matrix->no_scrolling_p = 1;
16204 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
16205 debug_method_add (w, "try_window_reusing_current_matrix 1");
16206 #endif
16207 return 1;
16209 else if (CHARPOS (new_start) > CHARPOS (start))
16211 struct glyph_row *pt_row, *row;
16212 struct glyph_row *first_reusable_row;
16213 struct glyph_row *first_row_to_display;
16214 int dy;
16215 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
16217 /* Find the row starting at new_start, if there is one. Don't
16218 reuse a partially visible line at the end. */
16219 first_reusable_row = start_row;
16220 while (first_reusable_row->enabled_p
16221 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (first_reusable_row) < yb
16222 && (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (first_reusable_row)
16223 < CHARPOS (new_start)))
16224 ++first_reusable_row;
16226 /* Give up if there is no row to reuse. */
16227 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (first_reusable_row) >= yb
16228 || !first_reusable_row->enabled_p
16229 || (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (first_reusable_row)
16230 != CHARPOS (new_start)))
16231 return 0;
16233 /* We can reuse fully visible rows beginning with
16234 first_reusable_row to the end of the window. Set
16235 first_row_to_display to the first row that cannot be reused.
16236 Set pt_row to the row containing point, if there is any. */
16237 pt_row = NULL;
16238 for (first_row_to_display = first_reusable_row;
16239 MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (first_row_to_display) < yb;
16240 ++first_row_to_display)
16242 if (PT >= MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (first_row_to_display)
16243 && PT < MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (first_row_to_display))
16244 pt_row = first_row_to_display;
16247 /* Start displaying at the start of first_row_to_display. */
16248 xassert (first_row_to_display->y < yb);
16249 init_to_row_start (&it, w, first_row_to_display);
16251 nrows_scrolled = (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (first_reusable_row, w->current_matrix)
16252 - start_vpos);
16253 it.vpos = (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (first_row_to_display, w->current_matrix)
16254 - nrows_scrolled);
16255 it.current_y = (first_row_to_display->y - first_reusable_row->y
16256 + WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w));
16258 /* Display lines beginning with first_row_to_display in the
16259 desired matrix. Set last_text_row to the last row displayed
16260 that displays text. */
16261 it.glyph_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix, it.vpos);
16262 if (pt_row == NULL)
16263 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
16264 last_text_row = NULL;
16265 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y && !fonts_changed_p)
16266 if (display_line (&it))
16267 last_text_row = it.glyph_row - 1;
16269 /* If point is in a reused row, adjust y and vpos of the cursor
16270 position. */
16271 if (pt_row)
16273 w->cursor.vpos -= nrows_scrolled;
16274 w->cursor.y -= first_reusable_row->y - start_row->y;
16277 /* Give up if point isn't in a row displayed or reused. (This
16278 also handles the case where w->cursor.vpos < nrows_scrolled
16279 after the calls to display_line, which can happen with scroll
16280 margins. See bug#1295.) */
16281 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
16283 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16284 return 0;
16287 /* Scroll the display. */
16288 run.current_y = first_reusable_row->y;
16289 run.desired_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
16290 run.height = it.last_visible_y - run.current_y;
16291 dy = run.current_y - run.desired_y;
16293 if (run.height)
16295 update_begin (f);
16296 FRAME_RIF (f)->update_window_begin_hook (w);
16297 FRAME_RIF (f)->clear_window_mouse_face (w);
16298 FRAME_RIF (f)->scroll_run_hook (w, &run);
16299 FRAME_RIF (f)->update_window_end_hook (w, 0, 0);
16300 update_end (f);
16303 /* Adjust Y positions of reused rows. */
16304 bottom_row = MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix, w);
16305 min_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
16306 max_y = it.last_visible_y;
16307 for (row = first_reusable_row; row < first_row_to_display; ++row)
16309 row->y -= dy;
16310 row->visible_height = row->height;
16311 if (row->y < min_y)
16312 row->visible_height -= min_y - row->y;
16313 if (row->y + row->height > max_y)
16314 row->visible_height -= row->y + row->height - max_y;
16315 if (row->fringe_bitmap_periodic_p)
16316 row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
16319 /* Scroll the current matrix. */
16320 xassert (nrows_scrolled > 0);
16321 rotate_matrix (w->current_matrix,
16322 start_vpos,
16323 MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (bottom_row, w->current_matrix),
16324 -nrows_scrolled);
16326 /* Disable rows not reused. */
16327 for (row -= nrows_scrolled; row < bottom_row; ++row)
16328 row->enabled_p = 0;
16330 /* Point may have moved to a different line, so we cannot assume that
16331 the previous cursor position is valid; locate the correct row. */
16332 if (pt_row)
16334 for (row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->cursor.vpos);
16335 row < bottom_row && PT >= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row);
16336 row++)
16338 w->cursor.vpos++;
16339 w->cursor.y = row->y;
16341 if (row < bottom_row)
16343 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + w->cursor.hpos;
16344 struct glyph *end = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
16346 /* Can't use this optimization with bidi-reordered glyph
16347 rows, unless cursor is already at point. */
16348 if (!NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_display_reordering)))
16350 if (!(w->cursor.hpos >= 0
16351 && w->cursor.hpos < row->used[TEXT_AREA]
16352 && BUFFERP (glyph->object)
16353 && glyph->charpos == PT))
16354 return 0;
16356 else
16357 for (; glyph < end
16358 && (!BUFFERP (glyph->object)
16359 || glyph->charpos < PT);
16360 glyph++)
16362 w->cursor.hpos++;
16363 w->cursor.x += glyph->pixel_width;
16368 /* Adjust window end. A null value of last_text_row means that
16369 the window end is in reused rows which in turn means that
16370 only its vpos can have changed. */
16371 if (last_text_row)
16373 w->window_end_bytepos
16374 = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (last_text_row);
16375 w->window_end_pos
16376 = make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (last_text_row));
16377 w->window_end_vpos
16378 = make_number (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_text_row, w->desired_matrix));
16380 else
16382 w->window_end_vpos
16383 = make_number (XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos) - nrows_scrolled);
16386 w->window_end_valid = Qnil;
16387 w->desired_matrix->no_scrolling_p = 1;
16389 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
16390 debug_method_add (w, "try_window_reusing_current_matrix 2");
16391 #endif
16392 return 1;
16395 return 0;
16400 /************************************************************************
16401 Window redisplay reusing current matrix when buffer has changed
16402 ************************************************************************/
16404 static struct glyph_row *find_last_unchanged_at_beg_row (struct window *);
16405 static struct glyph_row *find_first_unchanged_at_end_row (struct window *,
16406 EMACS_INT *, EMACS_INT *);
16407 static struct glyph_row *
16408 find_last_row_displaying_text (struct glyph_matrix *, struct it *,
16409 struct glyph_row *);
16412 /* Return the last row in MATRIX displaying text. If row START is
16413 non-null, start searching with that row. IT gives the dimensions
16414 of the display. Value is null if matrix is empty; otherwise it is
16415 a pointer to the row found. */
16417 static struct glyph_row *
16418 find_last_row_displaying_text (struct glyph_matrix *matrix, struct it *it,
16419 struct glyph_row *start)
16421 struct glyph_row *row, *row_found;
16423 /* Set row_found to the last row in IT->w's current matrix
16424 displaying text. The loop looks funny but think of partially
16425 visible lines. */
16426 row_found = NULL;
16427 row = start ? start : MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (matrix);
16428 while (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row))
16430 xassert (row->enabled_p);
16431 row_found = row;
16432 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) >= it->last_visible_y)
16433 break;
16434 ++row;
16437 return row_found;
16441 /* Return the last row in the current matrix of W that is not affected
16442 by changes at the start of current_buffer that occurred since W's
16443 current matrix was built. Value is null if no such row exists.
16445 BEG_UNCHANGED us the number of characters unchanged at the start of
16446 current_buffer. BEG + BEG_UNCHANGED is the buffer position of the
16447 first changed character in current_buffer. Characters at positions <
16448 BEG + BEG_UNCHANGED are at the same buffer positions as they were
16449 when the current matrix was built. */
16451 static struct glyph_row *
16452 find_last_unchanged_at_beg_row (struct window *w)
16454 EMACS_INT first_changed_pos = BEG + BEG_UNCHANGED;
16455 struct glyph_row *row;
16456 struct glyph_row *row_found = NULL;
16457 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
16459 /* Find the last row displaying unchanged text. */
16460 for (row = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
16461 MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row)
16462 && MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) < first_changed_pos;
16463 ++row)
16465 if (/* If row ends before first_changed_pos, it is unchanged,
16466 except in some case. */
16467 MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) <= first_changed_pos
16468 /* When row ends in ZV and we write at ZV it is not
16469 unchanged. */
16470 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
16471 /* When first_changed_pos is the end of a continued line,
16472 row is not unchanged because it may be no longer
16473 continued. */
16474 && !(MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) == first_changed_pos
16475 && (row->continued_p
16476 || row->exact_window_width_line_p)))
16477 row_found = row;
16479 /* Stop if last visible row. */
16480 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) >= yb)
16481 break;
16484 return row_found;
16488 /* Find the first glyph row in the current matrix of W that is not
16489 affected by changes at the end of current_buffer since the
16490 time W's current matrix was built.
16492 Return in *DELTA the number of chars by which buffer positions in
16493 unchanged text at the end of current_buffer must be adjusted.
16495 Return in *DELTA_BYTES the corresponding number of bytes.
16497 Value is null if no such row exists, i.e. all rows are affected by
16498 changes. */
16500 static struct glyph_row *
16501 find_first_unchanged_at_end_row (struct window *w,
16502 EMACS_INT *delta, EMACS_INT *delta_bytes)
16504 struct glyph_row *row;
16505 struct glyph_row *row_found = NULL;
16507 *delta = *delta_bytes = 0;
16509 /* Display must not have been paused, otherwise the current matrix
16510 is not up to date. */
16511 eassert (!NILP (w->window_end_valid));
16513 /* A value of window_end_pos >= END_UNCHANGED means that the window
16514 end is in the range of changed text. If so, there is no
16515 unchanged row at the end of W's current matrix. */
16516 if (XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos) >= END_UNCHANGED)
16517 return NULL;
16519 /* Set row to the last row in W's current matrix displaying text. */
16520 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos));
16522 /* If matrix is entirely empty, no unchanged row exists. */
16523 if (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row))
16525 /* The value of row is the last glyph row in the matrix having a
16526 meaningful buffer position in it. The end position of row
16527 corresponds to window_end_pos. This allows us to translate
16528 buffer positions in the current matrix to current buffer
16529 positions for characters not in changed text. */
16530 EMACS_INT Z_old =
16531 MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos);
16532 EMACS_INT Z_BYTE_old =
16533 MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row) + w->window_end_bytepos;
16534 EMACS_INT last_unchanged_pos, last_unchanged_pos_old;
16535 struct glyph_row *first_text_row
16536 = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
16538 *delta = Z - Z_old;
16539 *delta_bytes = Z_BYTE - Z_BYTE_old;
16541 /* Set last_unchanged_pos to the buffer position of the last
16542 character in the buffer that has not been changed. Z is the
16543 index + 1 of the last character in current_buffer, i.e. by
16544 subtracting END_UNCHANGED we get the index of the last
16545 unchanged character, and we have to add BEG to get its buffer
16546 position. */
16547 last_unchanged_pos = Z - END_UNCHANGED + BEG;
16548 last_unchanged_pos_old = last_unchanged_pos - *delta;
16550 /* Search backward from ROW for a row displaying a line that
16551 starts at a minimum position >= last_unchanged_pos_old. */
16552 for (; row > first_text_row; --row)
16554 /* This used to abort, but it can happen.
16555 It is ok to just stop the search instead here. KFS. */
16556 if (!row->enabled_p || !MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row))
16557 break;
16559 if (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) >= last_unchanged_pos_old)
16560 row_found = row;
16564 eassert (!row_found || MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row_found));
16566 return row_found;
16570 /* Make sure that glyph rows in the current matrix of window W
16571 reference the same glyph memory as corresponding rows in the
16572 frame's frame matrix. This function is called after scrolling W's
16573 current matrix on a terminal frame in try_window_id and
16574 try_window_reusing_current_matrix. */
16576 static void
16577 sync_frame_with_window_matrix_rows (struct window *w)
16579 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
16580 struct glyph_row *window_row, *window_row_end, *frame_row;
16582 /* Preconditions: W must be a leaf window and full-width. Its frame
16583 must have a frame matrix. */
16584 xassert (NILP (w->hchild) && NILP (w->vchild));
16585 xassert (WINDOW_FULL_WIDTH_P (w));
16586 xassert (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f));
16588 /* If W is a full-width window, glyph pointers in W's current matrix
16589 have, by definition, to be the same as glyph pointers in the
16590 corresponding frame matrix. Note that frame matrices have no
16591 marginal areas (see build_frame_matrix). */
16592 window_row = w->current_matrix->rows;
16593 window_row_end = window_row + w->current_matrix->nrows;
16594 frame_row = f->current_matrix->rows + WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_LINE (w);
16595 while (window_row < window_row_end)
16597 struct glyph *start = window_row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA];
16598 struct glyph *end = window_row->glyphs[LAST_AREA];
16600 frame_row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA] = start;
16601 frame_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] = start;
16602 frame_row->glyphs[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA] = end;
16603 frame_row->glyphs[LAST_AREA] = end;
16605 /* Disable frame rows whose corresponding window rows have
16606 been disabled in try_window_id. */
16607 if (!window_row->enabled_p)
16608 frame_row->enabled_p = 0;
16610 ++window_row, ++frame_row;
16615 /* Find the glyph row in window W containing CHARPOS. Consider all
16616 rows between START and END (not inclusive). END null means search
16617 all rows to the end of the display area of W. Value is the row
16618 containing CHARPOS or null. */
16620 struct glyph_row *
16621 row_containing_pos (struct window *w, EMACS_INT charpos,
16622 struct glyph_row *start, struct glyph_row *end, int dy)
16624 struct glyph_row *row = start;
16625 struct glyph_row *best_row = NULL;
16626 EMACS_INT mindif = BUF_ZV (XBUFFER (w->buffer)) + 1;
16627 int last_y;
16629 /* If we happen to start on a header-line, skip that. */
16630 if (row->mode_line_p)
16631 ++row;
16633 if ((end && row >= end) || !row->enabled_p)
16634 return NULL;
16636 last_y = window_text_bottom_y (w) - dy;
16638 while (1)
16640 /* Give up if we have gone too far. */
16641 if (end && row >= end)
16642 return NULL;
16643 /* This formerly returned if they were equal.
16644 I think that both quantities are of a "last plus one" type;
16645 if so, when they are equal, the row is within the screen. -- rms. */
16646 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) > last_y)
16647 return NULL;
16649 /* If it is in this row, return this row. */
16650 if (! (MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) < charpos
16651 || (MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) == charpos
16652 /* The end position of a row equals the start
16653 position of the next row. If CHARPOS is there, we
16654 would rather display it in the next line, except
16655 when this line ends in ZV. */
16656 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
16657 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row)))
16658 && charpos >= MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row))
16660 struct glyph *g;
16662 if (NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_display_reordering))
16663 || (!best_row && !row->continued_p))
16664 return row;
16665 /* In bidi-reordered rows, there could be several rows
16666 occluding point, all of them belonging to the same
16667 continued line. We need to find the row which fits
16668 CHARPOS the best. */
16669 for (g = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
16670 g < row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
16671 g++)
16673 if (!STRINGP (g->object))
16675 if (g->charpos > 0 && eabs (g->charpos - charpos) < mindif)
16677 mindif = eabs (g->charpos - charpos);
16678 best_row = row;
16679 /* Exact match always wins. */
16680 if (mindif == 0)
16681 return best_row;
16686 else if (best_row && !row->continued_p)
16687 return best_row;
16688 ++row;
16693 /* Try to redisplay window W by reusing its existing display. W's
16694 current matrix must be up to date when this function is called,
16695 i.e. window_end_valid must not be nil.
16697 Value is
16699 1 if display has been updated
16700 0 if otherwise unsuccessful
16701 -1 if redisplay with same window start is known not to succeed
16703 The following steps are performed:
16705 1. Find the last row in the current matrix of W that is not
16706 affected by changes at the start of current_buffer. If no such row
16707 is found, give up.
16709 2. Find the first row in W's current matrix that is not affected by
16710 changes at the end of current_buffer. Maybe there is no such row.
16712 3. Display lines beginning with the row + 1 found in step 1 to the
16713 row found in step 2 or, if step 2 didn't find a row, to the end of
16714 the window.
16716 4. If cursor is not known to appear on the window, give up.
16718 5. If display stopped at the row found in step 2, scroll the
16719 display and current matrix as needed.
16721 6. Maybe display some lines at the end of W, if we must. This can
16722 happen under various circumstances, like a partially visible line
16723 becoming fully visible, or because newly displayed lines are displayed
16724 in smaller font sizes.
16726 7. Update W's window end information. */
16728 static int
16729 try_window_id (struct window *w)
16731 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
16732 struct glyph_matrix *current_matrix = w->current_matrix;
16733 struct glyph_matrix *desired_matrix = w->desired_matrix;
16734 struct glyph_row *last_unchanged_at_beg_row;
16735 struct glyph_row *first_unchanged_at_end_row;
16736 struct glyph_row *row;
16737 struct glyph_row *bottom_row;
16738 int bottom_vpos;
16739 struct it it;
16740 EMACS_INT delta = 0, delta_bytes = 0, stop_pos;
16741 int dvpos, dy;
16742 struct text_pos start_pos;
16743 struct run run;
16744 int first_unchanged_at_end_vpos = 0;
16745 struct glyph_row *last_text_row, *last_text_row_at_end;
16746 struct text_pos start;
16747 EMACS_INT first_changed_charpos, last_changed_charpos;
16749 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
16750 if (inhibit_try_window_id)
16751 return 0;
16752 #endif
16754 /* This is handy for debugging. */
16755 #if 0
16756 #define GIVE_UP(X) \
16757 do { \
16758 fprintf (stderr, "try_window_id give up %d\n", (X)); \
16759 return 0; \
16760 } while (0)
16761 #else
16762 #define GIVE_UP(X) return 0
16763 #endif
16765 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (start, w->start);
16767 /* Don't use this for mini-windows because these can show
16768 messages and mini-buffers, and we don't handle that here. */
16769 if (MINI_WINDOW_P (w))
16770 GIVE_UP (1);
16772 /* This flag is used to prevent redisplay optimizations. */
16773 if (windows_or_buffers_changed || cursor_type_changed)
16774 GIVE_UP (2);
16776 /* Verify that narrowing has not changed.
16777 Also verify that we were not told to prevent redisplay optimizations.
16778 It would be nice to further
16779 reduce the number of cases where this prevents try_window_id. */
16780 if (current_buffer->clip_changed
16781 || current_buffer->prevent_redisplay_optimizations_p)
16782 GIVE_UP (3);
16784 /* Window must either use window-based redisplay or be full width. */
16785 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
16786 && (!FRAME_LINE_INS_DEL_OK (f)
16787 || !WINDOW_FULL_WIDTH_P (w)))
16788 GIVE_UP (4);
16790 /* Give up if point is known NOT to appear in W. */
16791 if (PT < CHARPOS (start))
16792 GIVE_UP (5);
16794 /* Another way to prevent redisplay optimizations. */
16795 if (XFASTINT (w->last_modified) == 0)
16796 GIVE_UP (6);
16798 /* Verify that window is not hscrolled. */
16799 if (XFASTINT (w->hscroll) != 0)
16800 GIVE_UP (7);
16802 /* Verify that display wasn't paused. */
16803 if (NILP (w->window_end_valid))
16804 GIVE_UP (8);
16806 /* Can't use this if highlighting a region because a cursor movement
16807 will do more than just set the cursor. */
16808 if (!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
16809 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, mark_active)))
16810 GIVE_UP (9);
16812 /* Likewise if highlighting trailing whitespace. */
16813 if (!NILP (Vshow_trailing_whitespace))
16814 GIVE_UP (11);
16816 /* Likewise if showing a region. */
16817 if (!NILP (w->region_showing))
16818 GIVE_UP (10);
16820 /* Can't use this if overlay arrow position and/or string have
16821 changed. */
16822 if (overlay_arrows_changed_p ())
16823 GIVE_UP (12);
16825 /* When word-wrap is on, adding a space to the first word of a
16826 wrapped line can change the wrap position, altering the line
16827 above it. It might be worthwhile to handle this more
16828 intelligently, but for now just redisplay from scratch. */
16829 if (!NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), word_wrap)))
16830 GIVE_UP (21);
16832 /* Under bidi reordering, adding or deleting a character in the
16833 beginning of a paragraph, before the first strong directional
16834 character, can change the base direction of the paragraph (unless
16835 the buffer specifies a fixed paragraph direction), which will
16836 require to redisplay the whole paragraph. It might be worthwhile
16837 to find the paragraph limits and widen the range of redisplayed
16838 lines to that, but for now just give up this optimization and
16839 redisplay from scratch. */
16840 if (!NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_display_reordering))
16841 && NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_paragraph_direction)))
16842 GIVE_UP (22);
16844 /* Make sure beg_unchanged and end_unchanged are up to date. Do it
16845 only if buffer has really changed. The reason is that the gap is
16846 initially at Z for freshly visited files. The code below would
16847 set end_unchanged to 0 in that case. */
16848 if (MODIFF > SAVE_MODIFF
16849 /* This seems to happen sometimes after saving a buffer. */
16850 || BEG_UNCHANGED + END_UNCHANGED > Z_BYTE)
16852 if (GPT - BEG < BEG_UNCHANGED)
16853 BEG_UNCHANGED = GPT - BEG;
16854 if (Z - GPT < END_UNCHANGED)
16855 END_UNCHANGED = Z - GPT;
16858 /* The position of the first and last character that has been changed. */
16859 first_changed_charpos = BEG + BEG_UNCHANGED;
16860 last_changed_charpos = Z - END_UNCHANGED;
16862 /* If window starts after a line end, and the last change is in
16863 front of that newline, then changes don't affect the display.
16864 This case happens with stealth-fontification. Note that although
16865 the display is unchanged, glyph positions in the matrix have to
16866 be adjusted, of course. */
16867 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos));
16868 if (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row)
16869 && ((last_changed_charpos < CHARPOS (start)
16870 && CHARPOS (start) == BEGV)
16871 || (last_changed_charpos < CHARPOS (start) - 1
16872 && FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (start) - 1) == '\n')))
16874 EMACS_INT Z_old, Z_delta, Z_BYTE_old, Z_delta_bytes;
16875 struct glyph_row *r0;
16877 /* Compute how many chars/bytes have been added to or removed
16878 from the buffer. */
16879 Z_old = MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos);
16880 Z_BYTE_old = MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row) + w->window_end_bytepos;
16881 Z_delta = Z - Z_old;
16882 Z_delta_bytes = Z_BYTE - Z_BYTE_old;
16884 /* Give up if PT is not in the window. Note that it already has
16885 been checked at the start of try_window_id that PT is not in
16886 front of the window start. */
16887 if (PT >= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + Z_delta)
16888 GIVE_UP (13);
16890 /* If window start is unchanged, we can reuse the whole matrix
16891 as is, after adjusting glyph positions. No need to compute
16892 the window end again, since its offset from Z hasn't changed. */
16893 r0 = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (current_matrix);
16894 if (CHARPOS (start) == MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (r0) + Z_delta
16895 && BYTEPOS (start) == MATRIX_ROW_START_BYTEPOS (r0) + Z_delta_bytes
16896 /* PT must not be in a partially visible line. */
16897 && !(PT >= MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) + Z_delta
16898 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) > window_text_bottom_y (w)))
16900 /* Adjust positions in the glyph matrix. */
16901 if (Z_delta || Z_delta_bytes)
16903 struct glyph_row *r1
16904 = MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (current_matrix, w);
16905 increment_matrix_positions (w->current_matrix,
16906 MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (r0, current_matrix),
16907 MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (r1, current_matrix),
16908 Z_delta, Z_delta_bytes);
16911 /* Set the cursor. */
16912 row = row_containing_pos (w, PT, r0, NULL, 0);
16913 if (row)
16914 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
16915 else
16916 abort ();
16917 return 1;
16921 /* Handle the case that changes are all below what is displayed in
16922 the window, and that PT is in the window. This shortcut cannot
16923 be taken if ZV is visible in the window, and text has been added
16924 there that is visible in the window. */
16925 if (first_changed_charpos >= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
16926 /* ZV is not visible in the window, or there are no
16927 changes at ZV, actually. */
16928 && (current_matrix->zv > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
16929 || first_changed_charpos == last_changed_charpos))
16931 struct glyph_row *r0;
16933 /* Give up if PT is not in the window. Note that it already has
16934 been checked at the start of try_window_id that PT is not in
16935 front of the window start. */
16936 if (PT >= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row))
16937 GIVE_UP (14);
16939 /* If window start is unchanged, we can reuse the whole matrix
16940 as is, without changing glyph positions since no text has
16941 been added/removed in front of the window end. */
16942 r0 = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (current_matrix);
16943 if (TEXT_POS_EQUAL_P (start, r0->minpos)
16944 /* PT must not be in a partially visible line. */
16945 && !(PT >= MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row)
16946 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) > window_text_bottom_y (w)))
16948 /* We have to compute the window end anew since text
16949 could have been added/removed after it. */
16950 w->window_end_pos
16951 = make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row));
16952 w->window_end_bytepos
16953 = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row);
16955 /* Set the cursor. */
16956 row = row_containing_pos (w, PT, r0, NULL, 0);
16957 if (row)
16958 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
16959 else
16960 abort ();
16961 return 2;
16965 /* Give up if window start is in the changed area.
16967 The condition used to read
16969 (BEG_UNCHANGED + END_UNCHANGED != Z - BEG && ...)
16971 but why that was tested escapes me at the moment. */
16972 if (CHARPOS (start) >= first_changed_charpos
16973 && CHARPOS (start) <= last_changed_charpos)
16974 GIVE_UP (15);
16976 /* Check that window start agrees with the start of the first glyph
16977 row in its current matrix. Check this after we know the window
16978 start is not in changed text, otherwise positions would not be
16979 comparable. */
16980 row = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (current_matrix);
16981 if (!TEXT_POS_EQUAL_P (start, row->minpos))
16982 GIVE_UP (16);
16984 /* Give up if the window ends in strings. Overlay strings
16985 at the end are difficult to handle, so don't try. */
16986 row = MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos));
16987 if (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row))
16988 GIVE_UP (20);
16990 /* Compute the position at which we have to start displaying new
16991 lines. Some of the lines at the top of the window might be
16992 reusable because they are not displaying changed text. Find the
16993 last row in W's current matrix not affected by changes at the
16994 start of current_buffer. Value is null if changes start in the
16995 first line of window. */
16996 last_unchanged_at_beg_row = find_last_unchanged_at_beg_row (w);
16997 if (last_unchanged_at_beg_row)
16999 /* Avoid starting to display in the moddle of a character, a TAB
17000 for instance. This is easier than to set up the iterator
17001 exactly, and it's not a frequent case, so the additional
17002 effort wouldn't really pay off. */
17003 while ((MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (last_unchanged_at_beg_row)
17004 || last_unchanged_at_beg_row->ends_in_newline_from_string_p)
17005 && last_unchanged_at_beg_row > w->current_matrix->rows)
17006 --last_unchanged_at_beg_row;
17008 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (last_unchanged_at_beg_row))
17009 GIVE_UP (17);
17011 if (init_to_row_end (&it, w, last_unchanged_at_beg_row) == 0)
17012 GIVE_UP (18);
17013 start_pos = it.current.pos;
17015 /* Start displaying new lines in the desired matrix at the same
17016 vpos we would use in the current matrix, i.e. below
17017 last_unchanged_at_beg_row. */
17018 it.vpos = 1 + MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_unchanged_at_beg_row,
17019 current_matrix);
17020 it.glyph_row = MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, it.vpos);
17021 it.current_y = MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (last_unchanged_at_beg_row);
17023 xassert (it.hpos == 0 && it.current_x == 0);
17025 else
17027 /* There are no reusable lines at the start of the window.
17028 Start displaying in the first text line. */
17029 start_display (&it, w, start);
17030 it.vpos = it.first_vpos;
17031 start_pos = it.current.pos;
17034 /* Find the first row that is not affected by changes at the end of
17035 the buffer. Value will be null if there is no unchanged row, in
17036 which case we must redisplay to the end of the window. delta
17037 will be set to the value by which buffer positions beginning with
17038 first_unchanged_at_end_row have to be adjusted due to text
17039 changes. */
17040 first_unchanged_at_end_row
17041 = find_first_unchanged_at_end_row (w, &delta, &delta_bytes);
17042 IF_DEBUG (debug_delta = delta);
17043 IF_DEBUG (debug_delta_bytes = delta_bytes);
17045 /* Set stop_pos to the buffer position up to which we will have to
17046 display new lines. If first_unchanged_at_end_row != NULL, this
17047 is the buffer position of the start of the line displayed in that
17048 row. For first_unchanged_at_end_row == NULL, use 0 to indicate
17049 that we don't stop at a buffer position. */
17050 stop_pos = 0;
17051 if (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17053 xassert (last_unchanged_at_beg_row == NULL
17054 || first_unchanged_at_end_row >= last_unchanged_at_beg_row);
17056 /* If this is a continuation line, move forward to the next one
17057 that isn't. Changes in lines above affect this line.
17058 Caution: this may move first_unchanged_at_end_row to a row
17059 not displaying text. */
17060 while (MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17061 && MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17062 && (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17063 < it.last_visible_y))
17064 ++first_unchanged_at_end_row;
17066 if (!MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17067 || (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17068 >= it.last_visible_y))
17069 first_unchanged_at_end_row = NULL;
17070 else
17072 stop_pos = (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17073 + delta);
17074 first_unchanged_at_end_vpos
17075 = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (first_unchanged_at_end_row, current_matrix);
17076 xassert (stop_pos >= Z - END_UNCHANGED);
17079 else if (last_unchanged_at_beg_row == NULL)
17080 GIVE_UP (19);
17083 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
17085 /* Either there is no unchanged row at the end, or the one we have
17086 now displays text. This is a necessary condition for the window
17087 end pos calculation at the end of this function. */
17088 xassert (first_unchanged_at_end_row == NULL
17089 || MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (first_unchanged_at_end_row));
17091 debug_last_unchanged_at_beg_vpos
17092 = (last_unchanged_at_beg_row
17093 ? MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_unchanged_at_beg_row, current_matrix)
17094 : -1);
17095 debug_first_unchanged_at_end_vpos = first_unchanged_at_end_vpos;
17097 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
17100 /* Display new lines. Set last_text_row to the last new line
17101 displayed which has text on it, i.e. might end up as being the
17102 line where the window_end_vpos is. */
17103 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
17104 last_text_row = NULL;
17105 overlay_arrow_seen = 0;
17106 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y
17107 && !fonts_changed_p
17108 && (first_unchanged_at_end_row == NULL
17109 || IT_CHARPOS (it) < stop_pos))
17111 if (display_line (&it))
17112 last_text_row = it.glyph_row - 1;
17115 if (fonts_changed_p)
17116 return -1;
17119 /* Compute differences in buffer positions, y-positions etc. for
17120 lines reused at the bottom of the window. Compute what we can
17121 scroll. */
17122 if (first_unchanged_at_end_row
17123 /* No lines reused because we displayed everything up to the
17124 bottom of the window. */
17125 && it.current_y < it.last_visible_y)
17127 dvpos = (it.vpos
17128 - MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (first_unchanged_at_end_row,
17129 current_matrix));
17130 dy = it.current_y - first_unchanged_at_end_row->y;
17131 run.current_y = first_unchanged_at_end_row->y;
17132 run.desired_y = run.current_y + dy;
17133 run.height = it.last_visible_y - max (run.current_y, run.desired_y);
17135 else
17137 delta = delta_bytes = dvpos = dy
17138 = run.current_y = run.desired_y = run.height = 0;
17139 first_unchanged_at_end_row = NULL;
17141 IF_DEBUG (debug_dvpos = dvpos; debug_dy = dy);
17144 /* Find the cursor if not already found. We have to decide whether
17145 PT will appear on this window (it sometimes doesn't, but this is
17146 not a very frequent case.) This decision has to be made before
17147 the current matrix is altered. A value of cursor.vpos < 0 means
17148 that PT is either in one of the lines beginning at
17149 first_unchanged_at_end_row or below the window. Don't care for
17150 lines that might be displayed later at the window end; as
17151 mentioned, this is not a frequent case. */
17152 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
17154 /* Cursor in unchanged rows at the top? */
17155 if (PT < CHARPOS (start_pos)
17156 && last_unchanged_at_beg_row)
17158 row = row_containing_pos (w, PT,
17159 MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix),
17160 last_unchanged_at_beg_row + 1, 0);
17161 if (row)
17162 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
17165 /* Start from first_unchanged_at_end_row looking for PT. */
17166 else if (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17168 row = row_containing_pos (w, PT - delta,
17169 first_unchanged_at_end_row, NULL, 0);
17170 if (row)
17171 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, delta,
17172 delta_bytes, dy, dvpos);
17175 /* Give up if cursor was not found. */
17176 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
17178 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
17179 return -1;
17183 /* Don't let the cursor end in the scroll margins. */
17185 int this_scroll_margin, cursor_height;
17187 this_scroll_margin =
17188 max (0, min (scroll_margin, WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) / 4));
17189 this_scroll_margin *= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it.f);
17190 cursor_height = MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix, w->cursor.vpos)->height;
17192 if ((w->cursor.y < this_scroll_margin
17193 && CHARPOS (start) > BEGV)
17194 /* Old redisplay didn't take scroll margin into account at the bottom,
17195 but then global-hl-line-mode doesn't scroll. KFS 2004-06-14 */
17196 || (w->cursor.y + (make_cursor_line_fully_visible_p
17197 ? cursor_height + this_scroll_margin
17198 : 1)) > it.last_visible_y)
17200 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
17201 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
17202 return -1;
17206 /* Scroll the display. Do it before changing the current matrix so
17207 that xterm.c doesn't get confused about where the cursor glyph is
17208 found. */
17209 if (dy && run.height)
17211 update_begin (f);
17213 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
17215 FRAME_RIF (f)->update_window_begin_hook (w);
17216 FRAME_RIF (f)->clear_window_mouse_face (w);
17217 FRAME_RIF (f)->scroll_run_hook (w, &run);
17218 FRAME_RIF (f)->update_window_end_hook (w, 0, 0);
17220 else
17222 /* Terminal frame. In this case, dvpos gives the number of
17223 lines to scroll by; dvpos < 0 means scroll up. */
17224 int from_vpos
17225 = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (first_unchanged_at_end_row, w->current_matrix);
17226 int from = WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_LINE (w) + from_vpos;
17227 int end = (WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_LINE (w)
17228 + (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w) ? 1 : 0)
17229 + window_internal_height (w));
17231 #if defined (HAVE_GPM) || defined (MSDOS)
17232 x_clear_window_mouse_face (w);
17233 #endif
17234 /* Perform the operation on the screen. */
17235 if (dvpos > 0)
17237 /* Scroll last_unchanged_at_beg_row to the end of the
17238 window down dvpos lines. */
17239 set_terminal_window (f, end);
17241 /* On dumb terminals delete dvpos lines at the end
17242 before inserting dvpos empty lines. */
17243 if (!FRAME_SCROLL_REGION_OK (f))
17244 ins_del_lines (f, end - dvpos, -dvpos);
17246 /* Insert dvpos empty lines in front of
17247 last_unchanged_at_beg_row. */
17248 ins_del_lines (f, from, dvpos);
17250 else if (dvpos < 0)
17252 /* Scroll up last_unchanged_at_beg_vpos to the end of
17253 the window to last_unchanged_at_beg_vpos - |dvpos|. */
17254 set_terminal_window (f, end);
17256 /* Delete dvpos lines in front of
17257 last_unchanged_at_beg_vpos. ins_del_lines will set
17258 the cursor to the given vpos and emit |dvpos| delete
17259 line sequences. */
17260 ins_del_lines (f, from + dvpos, dvpos);
17262 /* On a dumb terminal insert dvpos empty lines at the
17263 end. */
17264 if (!FRAME_SCROLL_REGION_OK (f))
17265 ins_del_lines (f, end + dvpos, -dvpos);
17268 set_terminal_window (f, 0);
17271 update_end (f);
17274 /* Shift reused rows of the current matrix to the right position.
17275 BOTTOM_ROW is the last + 1 row in the current matrix reserved for
17276 text. */
17277 bottom_row = MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (current_matrix, w);
17278 bottom_vpos = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (bottom_row, current_matrix);
17279 if (dvpos < 0)
17281 rotate_matrix (current_matrix, first_unchanged_at_end_vpos + dvpos,
17282 bottom_vpos, dvpos);
17283 enable_glyph_matrix_rows (current_matrix, bottom_vpos + dvpos,
17284 bottom_vpos, 0);
17286 else if (dvpos > 0)
17288 rotate_matrix (current_matrix, first_unchanged_at_end_vpos,
17289 bottom_vpos, dvpos);
17290 enable_glyph_matrix_rows (current_matrix, first_unchanged_at_end_vpos,
17291 first_unchanged_at_end_vpos + dvpos, 0);
17294 /* For frame-based redisplay, make sure that current frame and window
17295 matrix are in sync with respect to glyph memory. */
17296 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
17297 sync_frame_with_window_matrix_rows (w);
17299 /* Adjust buffer positions in reused rows. */
17300 if (delta || delta_bytes)
17301 increment_matrix_positions (current_matrix,
17302 first_unchanged_at_end_vpos + dvpos,
17303 bottom_vpos, delta, delta_bytes);
17305 /* Adjust Y positions. */
17306 if (dy)
17307 shift_glyph_matrix (w, current_matrix,
17308 first_unchanged_at_end_vpos + dvpos,
17309 bottom_vpos, dy);
17311 if (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17313 first_unchanged_at_end_row += dvpos;
17314 if (first_unchanged_at_end_row->y >= it.last_visible_y
17315 || !MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (first_unchanged_at_end_row))
17316 first_unchanged_at_end_row = NULL;
17319 /* If scrolling up, there may be some lines to display at the end of
17320 the window. */
17321 last_text_row_at_end = NULL;
17322 if (dy < 0)
17324 /* Scrolling up can leave for example a partially visible line
17325 at the end of the window to be redisplayed. */
17326 /* Set last_row to the glyph row in the current matrix where the
17327 window end line is found. It has been moved up or down in
17328 the matrix by dvpos. */
17329 int last_vpos = XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos) + dvpos;
17330 struct glyph_row *last_row = MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, last_vpos);
17332 /* If last_row is the window end line, it should display text. */
17333 xassert (last_row->displays_text_p);
17335 /* If window end line was partially visible before, begin
17336 displaying at that line. Otherwise begin displaying with the
17337 line following it. */
17338 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (last_row) - dy >= it.last_visible_y)
17340 init_to_row_start (&it, w, last_row);
17341 it.vpos = last_vpos;
17342 it.current_y = last_row->y;
17344 else
17346 init_to_row_end (&it, w, last_row);
17347 it.vpos = 1 + last_vpos;
17348 it.current_y = MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (last_row);
17349 ++last_row;
17352 /* We may start in a continuation line. If so, we have to
17353 get the right continuation_lines_width and current_x. */
17354 it.continuation_lines_width = last_row->continuation_lines_width;
17355 it.hpos = it.current_x = 0;
17357 /* Display the rest of the lines at the window end. */
17358 it.glyph_row = MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, it.vpos);
17359 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y
17360 && !fonts_changed_p)
17362 /* Is it always sure that the display agrees with lines in
17363 the current matrix? I don't think so, so we mark rows
17364 displayed invalid in the current matrix by setting their
17365 enabled_p flag to zero. */
17366 MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, it.vpos)->enabled_p = 0;
17367 if (display_line (&it))
17368 last_text_row_at_end = it.glyph_row - 1;
17372 /* Update window_end_pos and window_end_vpos. */
17373 if (first_unchanged_at_end_row
17374 && !last_text_row_at_end)
17376 /* Window end line if one of the preserved rows from the current
17377 matrix. Set row to the last row displaying text in current
17378 matrix starting at first_unchanged_at_end_row, after
17379 scrolling. */
17380 xassert (first_unchanged_at_end_row->displays_text_p);
17381 row = find_last_row_displaying_text (w->current_matrix, &it,
17382 first_unchanged_at_end_row);
17383 xassert (row && MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row));
17385 w->window_end_pos = make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row));
17386 w->window_end_bytepos = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row);
17387 w->window_end_vpos
17388 = make_number (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (row, w->current_matrix));
17389 xassert (w->window_end_bytepos >= 0);
17390 IF_DEBUG (debug_method_add (w, "A"));
17392 else if (last_text_row_at_end)
17394 w->window_end_pos
17395 = make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (last_text_row_at_end));
17396 w->window_end_bytepos
17397 = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (last_text_row_at_end);
17398 w->window_end_vpos
17399 = make_number (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_text_row_at_end, desired_matrix));
17400 xassert (w->window_end_bytepos >= 0);
17401 IF_DEBUG (debug_method_add (w, "B"));
17403 else if (last_text_row)
17405 /* We have displayed either to the end of the window or at the
17406 end of the window, i.e. the last row with text is to be found
17407 in the desired matrix. */
17408 w->window_end_pos
17409 = make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (last_text_row));
17410 w->window_end_bytepos
17411 = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (last_text_row);
17412 w->window_end_vpos
17413 = make_number (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_text_row, desired_matrix));
17414 xassert (w->window_end_bytepos >= 0);
17416 else if (first_unchanged_at_end_row == NULL
17417 && last_text_row == NULL
17418 && last_text_row_at_end == NULL)
17420 /* Displayed to end of window, but no line containing text was
17421 displayed. Lines were deleted at the end of the window. */
17422 int first_vpos = WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w) ? 1 : 0;
17423 int vpos = XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos);
17424 struct glyph_row *current_row = current_matrix->rows + vpos;
17425 struct glyph_row *desired_row = desired_matrix->rows + vpos;
17427 for (row = NULL;
17428 row == NULL && vpos >= first_vpos;
17429 --vpos, --current_row, --desired_row)
17431 if (desired_row->enabled_p)
17433 if (desired_row->displays_text_p)
17434 row = desired_row;
17436 else if (current_row->displays_text_p)
17437 row = current_row;
17440 xassert (row != NULL);
17441 w->window_end_vpos = make_number (vpos + 1);
17442 w->window_end_pos = make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row));
17443 w->window_end_bytepos = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row);
17444 xassert (w->window_end_bytepos >= 0);
17445 IF_DEBUG (debug_method_add (w, "C"));
17447 else
17448 abort ();
17450 IF_DEBUG (debug_end_pos = XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos);
17451 debug_end_vpos = XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos));
17453 /* Record that display has not been completed. */
17454 w->window_end_valid = Qnil;
17455 w->desired_matrix->no_scrolling_p = 1;
17456 return 3;
17458 #undef GIVE_UP
17463 /***********************************************************************
17464 More debugging support
17465 ***********************************************************************/
17467 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
17469 void dump_glyph_row (struct glyph_row *, int, int) EXTERNALLY_VISIBLE;
17470 void dump_glyph_matrix (struct glyph_matrix *, int) EXTERNALLY_VISIBLE;
17471 void dump_glyph (struct glyph_row *, struct glyph *, int) EXTERNALLY_VISIBLE;
17474 /* Dump the contents of glyph matrix MATRIX on stderr.
17476 GLYPHS 0 means don't show glyph contents.
17477 GLYPHS 1 means show glyphs in short form
17478 GLYPHS > 1 means show glyphs in long form. */
17480 void
17481 dump_glyph_matrix (struct glyph_matrix *matrix, int glyphs)
17483 int i;
17484 for (i = 0; i < matrix->nrows; ++i)
17485 dump_glyph_row (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, i), i, glyphs);
17489 /* Dump contents of glyph GLYPH to stderr. ROW and AREA are
17490 the glyph row and area where the glyph comes from. */
17492 void
17493 dump_glyph (struct glyph_row *row, struct glyph *glyph, int area)
17495 if (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
17497 fprintf (stderr,
17498 " %5td %4c %6"pI"d %c %3d 0x%05x %c %4d %1.1d%1.1d\n",
17499 glyph - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA],
17500 'C',
17501 glyph->charpos,
17502 (BUFFERP (glyph->object)
17503 ? 'B'
17504 : (STRINGP (glyph->object)
17505 ? 'S'
17506 : '-')),
17507 glyph->pixel_width,
17508 glyph->u.ch,
17509 (glyph->u.ch < 0x80 && glyph->u.ch >= ' '
17510 ? glyph->u.ch
17511 : '.'),
17512 glyph->face_id,
17513 glyph->left_box_line_p,
17514 glyph->right_box_line_p);
17516 else if (glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
17518 fprintf (stderr,
17519 " %5td %4c %6"pI"d %c %3d 0x%05x %c %4d %1.1d%1.1d\n",
17520 glyph - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA],
17521 'S',
17522 glyph->charpos,
17523 (BUFFERP (glyph->object)
17524 ? 'B'
17525 : (STRINGP (glyph->object)
17526 ? 'S'
17527 : '-')),
17528 glyph->pixel_width,
17530 '.',
17531 glyph->face_id,
17532 glyph->left_box_line_p,
17533 glyph->right_box_line_p);
17535 else if (glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
17537 fprintf (stderr,
17538 " %5td %4c %6"pI"d %c %3d 0x%05x %c %4d %1.1d%1.1d\n",
17539 glyph - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA],
17540 'I',
17541 glyph->charpos,
17542 (BUFFERP (glyph->object)
17543 ? 'B'
17544 : (STRINGP (glyph->object)
17545 ? 'S'
17546 : '-')),
17547 glyph->pixel_width,
17548 glyph->u.img_id,
17549 '.',
17550 glyph->face_id,
17551 glyph->left_box_line_p,
17552 glyph->right_box_line_p);
17554 else if (glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH)
17556 fprintf (stderr,
17557 " %5td %4c %6"pI"d %c %3d 0x%05x",
17558 glyph - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA],
17559 '+',
17560 glyph->charpos,
17561 (BUFFERP (glyph->object)
17562 ? 'B'
17563 : (STRINGP (glyph->object)
17564 ? 'S'
17565 : '-')),
17566 glyph->pixel_width,
17567 glyph->u.cmp.id);
17568 if (glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
17569 fprintf (stderr,
17570 "[%d-%d]",
17571 glyph->slice.cmp.from, glyph->slice.cmp.to);
17572 fprintf (stderr, " . %4d %1.1d%1.1d\n",
17573 glyph->face_id,
17574 glyph->left_box_line_p,
17575 glyph->right_box_line_p);
17580 /* Dump the contents of glyph row at VPOS in MATRIX to stderr.
17581 GLYPHS 0 means don't show glyph contents.
17582 GLYPHS 1 means show glyphs in short form
17583 GLYPHS > 1 means show glyphs in long form. */
17585 void
17586 dump_glyph_row (struct glyph_row *row, int vpos, int glyphs)
17588 if (glyphs != 1)
17590 fprintf (stderr, "Row Start End Used oE><\\CTZFesm X Y W H V A P\n");
17591 fprintf (stderr, "======================================================================\n");
17593 fprintf (stderr, "%3d %5"pI"d %5"pI"d %4d %1.1d%1.1d%1.1d%1.1d\
17594 %1.1d%1.1d%1.1d%1.1d%1.1d%1.1d%1.1d%1.1d %4d %4d %4d %4d %4d %4d %4d\n",
17595 vpos,
17596 MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row),
17597 MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row),
17598 row->used[TEXT_AREA],
17599 row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p,
17600 row->enabled_p,
17601 row->truncated_on_left_p,
17602 row->truncated_on_right_p,
17603 row->continued_p,
17604 MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (row),
17605 row->displays_text_p,
17606 row->ends_at_zv_p,
17607 row->fill_line_p,
17608 row->ends_in_middle_of_char_p,
17609 row->starts_in_middle_of_char_p,
17610 row->mouse_face_p,
17611 row->x,
17612 row->y,
17613 row->pixel_width,
17614 row->height,
17615 row->visible_height,
17616 row->ascent,
17617 row->phys_ascent);
17618 fprintf (stderr, "%9d %5d\t%5d\n", row->start.overlay_string_index,
17619 row->end.overlay_string_index,
17620 row->continuation_lines_width);
17621 fprintf (stderr, "%9"pI"d %5"pI"d\n",
17622 CHARPOS (row->start.string_pos),
17623 CHARPOS (row->end.string_pos));
17624 fprintf (stderr, "%9d %5d\n", row->start.dpvec_index,
17625 row->end.dpvec_index);
17628 if (glyphs > 1)
17630 int area;
17632 for (area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA; area < LAST_AREA; ++area)
17634 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[area];
17635 struct glyph *glyph_end = glyph + row->used[area];
17637 /* Glyph for a line end in text. */
17638 if (area == TEXT_AREA && glyph == glyph_end && glyph->charpos > 0)
17639 ++glyph_end;
17641 if (glyph < glyph_end)
17642 fprintf (stderr, " Glyph Type Pos O W Code C Face LR\n");
17644 for (; glyph < glyph_end; ++glyph)
17645 dump_glyph (row, glyph, area);
17648 else if (glyphs == 1)
17650 int area;
17652 for (area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA; area < LAST_AREA; ++area)
17654 char *s = (char *) alloca (row->used[area] + 1);
17655 int i;
17657 for (i = 0; i < row->used[area]; ++i)
17659 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[area] + i;
17660 if (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
17661 && glyph->u.ch < 0x80
17662 && glyph->u.ch >= ' ')
17663 s[i] = glyph->u.ch;
17664 else
17665 s[i] = '.';
17668 s[i] = '\0';
17669 fprintf (stderr, "%3d: (%d) '%s'\n", vpos, row->enabled_p, s);
17675 DEFUN ("dump-glyph-matrix", Fdump_glyph_matrix,
17676 Sdump_glyph_matrix, 0, 1, "p",
17677 doc: /* Dump the current matrix of the selected window to stderr.
17678 Shows contents of glyph row structures. With non-nil
17679 parameter GLYPHS, dump glyphs as well. If GLYPHS is 1 show
17680 glyphs in short form, otherwise show glyphs in long form. */)
17681 (Lisp_Object glyphs)
17683 struct window *w = XWINDOW (selected_window);
17684 struct buffer *buffer = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
17686 fprintf (stderr, "PT = %"pI"d, BEGV = %"pI"d. ZV = %"pI"d\n",
17687 BUF_PT (buffer), BUF_BEGV (buffer), BUF_ZV (buffer));
17688 fprintf (stderr, "Cursor x = %d, y = %d, hpos = %d, vpos = %d\n",
17689 w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y, w->cursor.hpos, w->cursor.vpos);
17690 fprintf (stderr, "=============================================\n");
17691 dump_glyph_matrix (w->current_matrix,
17692 NILP (glyphs) ? 0 : XINT (glyphs));
17693 return Qnil;
17697 DEFUN ("dump-frame-glyph-matrix", Fdump_frame_glyph_matrix,
17698 Sdump_frame_glyph_matrix, 0, 0, "", doc: /* */)
17699 (void)
17701 struct frame *f = XFRAME (selected_frame);
17702 dump_glyph_matrix (f->current_matrix, 1);
17703 return Qnil;
17707 DEFUN ("dump-glyph-row", Fdump_glyph_row, Sdump_glyph_row, 1, 2, "",
17708 doc: /* Dump glyph row ROW to stderr.
17709 GLYPH 0 means don't dump glyphs.
17710 GLYPH 1 means dump glyphs in short form.
17711 GLYPH > 1 or omitted means dump glyphs in long form. */)
17712 (Lisp_Object row, Lisp_Object glyphs)
17714 struct glyph_matrix *matrix;
17715 int vpos;
17717 CHECK_NUMBER (row);
17718 matrix = XWINDOW (selected_window)->current_matrix;
17719 vpos = XINT (row);
17720 if (vpos >= 0 && vpos < matrix->nrows)
17721 dump_glyph_row (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, vpos),
17722 vpos,
17723 INTEGERP (glyphs) ? XINT (glyphs) : 2);
17724 return Qnil;
17728 DEFUN ("dump-tool-bar-row", Fdump_tool_bar_row, Sdump_tool_bar_row, 1, 2, "",
17729 doc: /* Dump glyph row ROW of the tool-bar of the current frame to stderr.
17730 GLYPH 0 means don't dump glyphs.
17731 GLYPH 1 means dump glyphs in short form.
17732 GLYPH > 1 or omitted means dump glyphs in long form. */)
17733 (Lisp_Object row, Lisp_Object glyphs)
17735 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
17736 struct glyph_matrix *m = XWINDOW (sf->tool_bar_window)->current_matrix;
17737 int vpos;
17739 CHECK_NUMBER (row);
17740 vpos = XINT (row);
17741 if (vpos >= 0 && vpos < m->nrows)
17742 dump_glyph_row (MATRIX_ROW (m, vpos), vpos,
17743 INTEGERP (glyphs) ? XINT (glyphs) : 2);
17744 return Qnil;
17748 DEFUN ("trace-redisplay", Ftrace_redisplay, Strace_redisplay, 0, 1, "P",
17749 doc: /* Toggle tracing of redisplay.
17750 With ARG, turn tracing on if and only if ARG is positive. */)
17751 (Lisp_Object arg)
17753 if (NILP (arg))
17754 trace_redisplay_p = !trace_redisplay_p;
17755 else
17757 arg = Fprefix_numeric_value (arg);
17758 trace_redisplay_p = XINT (arg) > 0;
17761 return Qnil;
17765 DEFUN ("trace-to-stderr", Ftrace_to_stderr, Strace_to_stderr, 1, MANY, "",
17766 doc: /* Like `format', but print result to stderr.
17767 usage: (trace-to-stderr STRING &rest OBJECTS) */)
17768 (ptrdiff_t nargs, Lisp_Object *args)
17770 Lisp_Object s = Fformat (nargs, args);
17771 fprintf (stderr, "%s", SDATA (s));
17772 return Qnil;
17775 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
17779 /***********************************************************************
17780 Building Desired Matrix Rows
17781 ***********************************************************************/
17783 /* Return a temporary glyph row holding the glyphs of an overlay arrow.
17784 Used for non-window-redisplay windows, and for windows w/o left fringe. */
17786 static struct glyph_row *
17787 get_overlay_arrow_glyph_row (struct window *w, Lisp_Object overlay_arrow_string)
17789 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
17790 struct buffer *buffer = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
17791 struct buffer *old = current_buffer;
17792 const unsigned char *arrow_string = SDATA (overlay_arrow_string);
17793 int arrow_len = SCHARS (overlay_arrow_string);
17794 const unsigned char *arrow_end = arrow_string + arrow_len;
17795 const unsigned char *p;
17796 struct it it;
17797 int multibyte_p;
17798 int n_glyphs_before;
17800 set_buffer_temp (buffer);
17801 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, &scratch_glyph_row, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
17802 it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] = 0;
17803 SET_TEXT_POS (it.position, 0, 0);
17805 multibyte_p = !NILP (BVAR (buffer, enable_multibyte_characters));
17806 p = arrow_string;
17807 while (p < arrow_end)
17809 Lisp_Object face, ilisp;
17811 /* Get the next character. */
17812 if (multibyte_p)
17813 it.c = it.char_to_display = string_char_and_length (p, &it.len);
17814 else
17816 it.c = it.char_to_display = *p, it.len = 1;
17817 if (! ASCII_CHAR_P (it.c))
17818 it.char_to_display = BYTE8_TO_CHAR (it.c);
17820 p += it.len;
17822 /* Get its face. */
17823 ilisp = make_number (p - arrow_string);
17824 face = Fget_text_property (ilisp, Qface, overlay_arrow_string);
17825 it.face_id = compute_char_face (f, it.char_to_display, face);
17827 /* Compute its width, get its glyphs. */
17828 n_glyphs_before = it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
17829 SET_TEXT_POS (it.position, -1, -1);
17830 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (&it);
17832 /* If this character doesn't fit any more in the line, we have
17833 to remove some glyphs. */
17834 if (it.current_x > it.last_visible_x)
17836 it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] = n_glyphs_before;
17837 break;
17841 set_buffer_temp (old);
17842 return it.glyph_row;
17846 /* Insert truncation glyphs at the start of IT->glyph_row. Truncation
17847 glyphs are only inserted for terminal frames since we can't really
17848 win with truncation glyphs when partially visible glyphs are
17849 involved. Which glyphs to insert is determined by
17850 produce_special_glyphs. */
17852 static void
17853 insert_left_trunc_glyphs (struct it *it)
17855 struct it truncate_it;
17856 struct glyph *from, *end, *to, *toend;
17858 xassert (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f));
17860 /* Get the truncation glyphs. */
17861 truncate_it = *it;
17862 truncate_it.current_x = 0;
17863 truncate_it.face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
17864 truncate_it.glyph_row = &scratch_glyph_row;
17865 truncate_it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] = 0;
17866 CHARPOS (truncate_it.position) = BYTEPOS (truncate_it.position) = -1;
17867 truncate_it.object = make_number (0);
17868 produce_special_glyphs (&truncate_it, IT_TRUNCATION);
17870 /* Overwrite glyphs from IT with truncation glyphs. */
17871 if (!it->glyph_row->reversed_p)
17873 from = truncate_it.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
17874 end = from + truncate_it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
17875 to = it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
17876 toend = to + it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
17878 while (from < end)
17879 *to++ = *from++;
17881 /* There may be padding glyphs left over. Overwrite them too. */
17882 while (to < toend && CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (*to))
17884 from = truncate_it.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
17885 while (from < end)
17886 *to++ = *from++;
17889 if (to > toend)
17890 it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] = to - it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
17892 else
17894 /* In R2L rows, overwrite the last (rightmost) glyphs, and do
17895 that back to front. */
17896 end = truncate_it.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
17897 from = end + truncate_it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
17898 toend = it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
17899 to = toend + it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
17901 while (from >= end && to >= toend)
17902 *to-- = *from--;
17903 while (to >= toend && CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (*to))
17905 from =
17906 truncate_it.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
17907 + truncate_it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
17908 while (from >= end && to >= toend)
17909 *to-- = *from--;
17911 if (from >= end)
17913 /* Need to free some room before prepending additional
17914 glyphs. */
17915 int move_by = from - end + 1;
17916 struct glyph *g0 = it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
17917 struct glyph *g = g0 + it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
17919 for ( ; g >= g0; g--)
17920 g[move_by] = *g;
17921 while (from >= end)
17922 *to-- = *from--;
17923 it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] += move_by;
17929 /* Compute the pixel height and width of IT->glyph_row.
17931 Most of the time, ascent and height of a display line will be equal
17932 to the max_ascent and max_height values of the display iterator
17933 structure. This is not the case if
17935 1. We hit ZV without displaying anything. In this case, max_ascent
17936 and max_height will be zero.
17938 2. We have some glyphs that don't contribute to the line height.
17939 (The glyph row flag contributes_to_line_height_p is for future
17940 pixmap extensions).
17942 The first case is easily covered by using default values because in
17943 these cases, the line height does not really matter, except that it
17944 must not be zero. */
17946 static void
17947 compute_line_metrics (struct it *it)
17949 struct glyph_row *row = it->glyph_row;
17951 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
17953 int i, min_y, max_y;
17955 /* The line may consist of one space only, that was added to
17956 place the cursor on it. If so, the row's height hasn't been
17957 computed yet. */
17958 if (row->height == 0)
17960 if (it->max_ascent + it->max_descent == 0)
17961 it->max_descent = it->max_phys_descent = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it->f);
17962 row->ascent = it->max_ascent;
17963 row->height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
17964 row->phys_ascent = it->max_phys_ascent;
17965 row->phys_height = it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent;
17966 row->extra_line_spacing = it->max_extra_line_spacing;
17969 /* Compute the width of this line. */
17970 row->pixel_width = row->x;
17971 for (i = 0; i < row->used[TEXT_AREA]; ++i)
17972 row->pixel_width += row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][i].pixel_width;
17974 xassert (row->pixel_width >= 0);
17975 xassert (row->ascent >= 0 && row->height > 0);
17977 row->overlapping_p = (MATRIX_ROW_OVERLAPS_SUCC_P (row)
17978 || MATRIX_ROW_OVERLAPS_PRED_P (row));
17980 /* If first line's physical ascent is larger than its logical
17981 ascent, use the physical ascent, and make the row taller.
17982 This makes accented characters fully visible. */
17983 if (row == MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (it->w->desired_matrix)
17984 && row->phys_ascent > row->ascent)
17986 row->height += row->phys_ascent - row->ascent;
17987 row->ascent = row->phys_ascent;
17990 /* Compute how much of the line is visible. */
17991 row->visible_height = row->height;
17993 min_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (it->w);
17994 max_y = WINDOW_BOX_HEIGHT_NO_MODE_LINE (it->w);
17996 if (row->y < min_y)
17997 row->visible_height -= min_y - row->y;
17998 if (row->y + row->height > max_y)
17999 row->visible_height -= row->y + row->height - max_y;
18001 else
18003 row->pixel_width = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18004 if (row->continued_p)
18005 row->pixel_width -= it->continuation_pixel_width;
18006 else if (row->truncated_on_right_p)
18007 row->pixel_width -= it->truncation_pixel_width;
18008 row->ascent = row->phys_ascent = 0;
18009 row->height = row->phys_height = row->visible_height = 1;
18010 row->extra_line_spacing = 0;
18013 /* Compute a hash code for this row. */
18015 int area, i;
18016 row->hash = 0;
18017 for (area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA; area < LAST_AREA; ++area)
18018 for (i = 0; i < row->used[area]; ++i)
18019 row->hash = ((((row->hash << 4) + (row->hash >> 24)) & 0x0fffffff)
18020 + row->glyphs[area][i].u.val
18021 + row->glyphs[area][i].face_id
18022 + row->glyphs[area][i].padding_p
18023 + (row->glyphs[area][i].type << 2));
18026 it->max_ascent = it->max_descent = 0;
18027 it->max_phys_ascent = it->max_phys_descent = 0;
18031 /* Append one space to the glyph row of iterator IT if doing a
18032 window-based redisplay. The space has the same face as
18033 IT->face_id. Value is non-zero if a space was added.
18035 This function is called to make sure that there is always one glyph
18036 at the end of a glyph row that the cursor can be set on under
18037 window-systems. (If there weren't such a glyph we would not know
18038 how wide and tall a box cursor should be displayed).
18040 At the same time this space let's a nicely handle clearing to the
18041 end of the line if the row ends in italic text. */
18043 static int
18044 append_space_for_newline (struct it *it, int default_face_p)
18046 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
18048 int n = it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18050 if (it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + n
18051 < it->glyph_row->glyphs[1 + TEXT_AREA])
18053 /* Save some values that must not be changed.
18054 Must save IT->c and IT->len because otherwise
18055 ITERATOR_AT_END_P wouldn't work anymore after
18056 append_space_for_newline has been called. */
18057 enum display_element_type saved_what = it->what;
18058 int saved_c = it->c, saved_len = it->len;
18059 int saved_char_to_display = it->char_to_display;
18060 int saved_x = it->current_x;
18061 int saved_face_id = it->face_id;
18062 struct text_pos saved_pos;
18063 Lisp_Object saved_object;
18064 struct face *face;
18066 saved_object = it->object;
18067 saved_pos = it->position;
18069 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
18070 memset (&it->position, 0, sizeof it->position);
18071 it->object = make_number (0);
18072 it->c = it->char_to_display = ' ';
18073 it->len = 1;
18075 if (default_face_p)
18076 it->face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
18077 else if (it->face_before_selective_p)
18078 it->face_id = it->saved_face_id;
18079 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
18080 it->face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
18082 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
18084 it->override_ascent = -1;
18085 it->constrain_row_ascent_descent_p = 0;
18086 it->current_x = saved_x;
18087 it->object = saved_object;
18088 it->position = saved_pos;
18089 it->what = saved_what;
18090 it->face_id = saved_face_id;
18091 it->len = saved_len;
18092 it->c = saved_c;
18093 it->char_to_display = saved_char_to_display;
18094 return 1;
18098 return 0;
18102 /* Extend the face of the last glyph in the text area of IT->glyph_row
18103 to the end of the display line. Called from display_line. If the
18104 glyph row is empty, add a space glyph to it so that we know the
18105 face to draw. Set the glyph row flag fill_line_p. If the glyph
18106 row is R2L, prepend a stretch glyph to cover the empty space to the
18107 left of the leftmost glyph. */
18109 static void
18110 extend_face_to_end_of_line (struct it *it)
18112 struct face *face;
18113 struct frame *f = it->f;
18115 /* If line is already filled, do nothing. Non window-system frames
18116 get a grace of one more ``pixel'' because their characters are
18117 1-``pixel'' wide, so they hit the equality too early. This grace
18118 is needed only for R2L rows that are not continued, to produce
18119 one extra blank where we could display the cursor. */
18120 if (it->current_x >= it->last_visible_x
18121 + (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
18122 && it->glyph_row->reversed_p
18123 && !it->glyph_row->continued_p))
18124 return;
18126 /* Face extension extends the background and box of IT->face_id
18127 to the end of the line. If the background equals the background
18128 of the frame, we don't have to do anything. */
18129 if (it->face_before_selective_p)
18130 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, it->saved_face_id);
18131 else
18132 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, it->face_id);
18134 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
18135 && it->glyph_row->displays_text_p
18136 && face->box == FACE_NO_BOX
18137 && face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f)
18138 && !face->stipple
18139 && !it->glyph_row->reversed_p)
18140 return;
18142 /* Set the glyph row flag indicating that the face of the last glyph
18143 in the text area has to be drawn to the end of the text area. */
18144 it->glyph_row->fill_line_p = 1;
18146 /* If current character of IT is not ASCII, make sure we have the
18147 ASCII face. This will be automatically undone the next time
18148 get_next_display_element returns a multibyte character. Note
18149 that the character will always be single byte in unibyte
18150 text. */
18151 if (!ASCII_CHAR_P (it->c))
18153 it->face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
18156 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
18158 /* If the row is empty, add a space with the current face of IT,
18159 so that we know which face to draw. */
18160 if (it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] == 0)
18162 it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][0] = space_glyph;
18163 it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][0].face_id = it->face_id;
18164 it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] = 1;
18166 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
18167 if (it->glyph_row->reversed_p)
18169 /* Prepend a stretch glyph to the row, such that the
18170 rightmost glyph will be drawn flushed all the way to the
18171 right margin of the window. The stretch glyph that will
18172 occupy the empty space, if any, to the left of the
18173 glyphs. */
18174 struct font *font = face->font ? face->font : FRAME_FONT (f);
18175 struct glyph *row_start = it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18176 struct glyph *row_end = row_start + it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18177 struct glyph *g;
18178 int row_width, stretch_ascent, stretch_width;
18179 struct text_pos saved_pos;
18180 int saved_face_id, saved_avoid_cursor;
18182 for (row_width = 0, g = row_start; g < row_end; g++)
18183 row_width += g->pixel_width;
18184 stretch_width = window_box_width (it->w, TEXT_AREA) - row_width;
18185 if (stretch_width > 0)
18187 stretch_ascent =
18188 (((it->ascent + it->descent)
18189 * FONT_BASE (font)) / FONT_HEIGHT (font));
18190 saved_pos = it->position;
18191 memset (&it->position, 0, sizeof it->position);
18192 saved_avoid_cursor = it->avoid_cursor_p;
18193 it->avoid_cursor_p = 1;
18194 saved_face_id = it->face_id;
18195 /* The last row's stretch glyph should get the default
18196 face, to avoid painting the rest of the window with
18197 the region face, if the region ends at ZV. */
18198 if (it->glyph_row->ends_at_zv_p)
18199 it->face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
18200 else
18201 it->face_id = face->id;
18202 append_stretch_glyph (it, make_number (0), stretch_width,
18203 it->ascent + it->descent, stretch_ascent);
18204 it->position = saved_pos;
18205 it->avoid_cursor_p = saved_avoid_cursor;
18206 it->face_id = saved_face_id;
18209 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
18211 else
18213 /* Save some values that must not be changed. */
18214 int saved_x = it->current_x;
18215 struct text_pos saved_pos;
18216 Lisp_Object saved_object;
18217 enum display_element_type saved_what = it->what;
18218 int saved_face_id = it->face_id;
18220 saved_object = it->object;
18221 saved_pos = it->position;
18223 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
18224 memset (&it->position, 0, sizeof it->position);
18225 it->object = make_number (0);
18226 it->c = it->char_to_display = ' ';
18227 it->len = 1;
18228 /* The last row's blank glyphs should get the default face, to
18229 avoid painting the rest of the window with the region face,
18230 if the region ends at ZV. */
18231 if (it->glyph_row->ends_at_zv_p)
18232 it->face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
18233 else
18234 it->face_id = face->id;
18236 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
18238 while (it->current_x <= it->last_visible_x)
18239 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
18241 /* Don't count these blanks really. It would let us insert a left
18242 truncation glyph below and make us set the cursor on them, maybe. */
18243 it->current_x = saved_x;
18244 it->object = saved_object;
18245 it->position = saved_pos;
18246 it->what = saved_what;
18247 it->face_id = saved_face_id;
18252 /* Value is non-zero if text starting at CHARPOS in current_buffer is
18253 trailing whitespace. */
18255 static int
18256 trailing_whitespace_p (EMACS_INT charpos)
18258 EMACS_INT bytepos = CHAR_TO_BYTE (charpos);
18259 int c = 0;
18261 while (bytepos < ZV_BYTE
18262 && (c = FETCH_CHAR (bytepos),
18263 c == ' ' || c == '\t'))
18264 ++bytepos;
18266 if (bytepos >= ZV_BYTE || c == '\n' || c == '\r')
18268 if (bytepos != PT_BYTE)
18269 return 1;
18271 return 0;
18275 /* Highlight trailing whitespace, if any, in ROW. */
18277 static void
18278 highlight_trailing_whitespace (struct frame *f, struct glyph_row *row)
18280 int used = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18282 if (used)
18284 struct glyph *start = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18285 struct glyph *glyph = start + used - 1;
18287 if (row->reversed_p)
18289 /* Right-to-left rows need to be processed in the opposite
18290 direction, so swap the edge pointers. */
18291 glyph = start;
18292 start = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + used - 1;
18295 /* Skip over glyphs inserted to display the cursor at the
18296 end of a line, for extending the face of the last glyph
18297 to the end of the line on terminals, and for truncation
18298 and continuation glyphs. */
18299 if (!row->reversed_p)
18301 while (glyph >= start
18302 && glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
18303 && INTEGERP (glyph->object))
18304 --glyph;
18306 else
18308 while (glyph <= start
18309 && glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
18310 && INTEGERP (glyph->object))
18311 ++glyph;
18314 /* If last glyph is a space or stretch, and it's trailing
18315 whitespace, set the face of all trailing whitespace glyphs in
18316 IT->glyph_row to `trailing-whitespace'. */
18317 if ((row->reversed_p ? glyph <= start : glyph >= start)
18318 && BUFFERP (glyph->object)
18319 && (glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
18320 || (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
18321 && glyph->u.ch == ' '))
18322 && trailing_whitespace_p (glyph->charpos))
18324 int face_id = lookup_named_face (f, Qtrailing_whitespace, 0);
18325 if (face_id < 0)
18326 return;
18328 if (!row->reversed_p)
18330 while (glyph >= start
18331 && BUFFERP (glyph->object)
18332 && (glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
18333 || (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
18334 && glyph->u.ch == ' ')))
18335 (glyph--)->face_id = face_id;
18337 else
18339 while (glyph <= start
18340 && BUFFERP (glyph->object)
18341 && (glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
18342 || (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
18343 && glyph->u.ch == ' ')))
18344 (glyph++)->face_id = face_id;
18351 /* Value is non-zero if glyph row ROW should be
18352 used to hold the cursor. */
18354 static int
18355 cursor_row_p (struct glyph_row *row)
18357 int result = 1;
18359 if (PT == CHARPOS (row->end.pos)
18360 || PT == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row))
18362 /* Suppose the row ends on a string.
18363 Unless the row is continued, that means it ends on a newline
18364 in the string. If it's anything other than a display string
18365 (e.g. a before-string from an overlay), we don't want the
18366 cursor there. (This heuristic seems to give the optimal
18367 behavior for the various types of multi-line strings.) */
18368 if (CHARPOS (row->end.string_pos) >= 0)
18370 if (row->continued_p)
18371 result = 1;
18372 else
18374 /* Check for `display' property. */
18375 struct glyph *beg = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18376 struct glyph *end = beg + row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
18377 struct glyph *glyph;
18379 result = 0;
18380 for (glyph = end; glyph >= beg; --glyph)
18381 if (STRINGP (glyph->object))
18383 Lisp_Object prop
18384 = Fget_char_property (make_number (PT),
18385 Qdisplay, Qnil);
18386 result =
18387 (!NILP (prop)
18388 && display_prop_string_p (prop, glyph->object));
18389 break;
18393 else if (MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row))
18395 /* If the row ends in middle of a real character,
18396 and the line is continued, we want the cursor here.
18397 That's because CHARPOS (ROW->end.pos) would equal
18398 PT if PT is before the character. */
18399 if (!row->ends_in_ellipsis_p)
18400 result = row->continued_p;
18401 else
18402 /* If the row ends in an ellipsis, then
18403 CHARPOS (ROW->end.pos) will equal point after the
18404 invisible text. We want that position to be displayed
18405 after the ellipsis. */
18406 result = 0;
18408 /* If the row ends at ZV, display the cursor at the end of that
18409 row instead of at the start of the row below. */
18410 else if (row->ends_at_zv_p)
18411 result = 1;
18412 else
18413 result = 0;
18416 return result;
18421 /* Push the property PROP so that it will be rendered at the current
18422 position in IT. Return 1 if PROP was successfully pushed, 0
18423 otherwise. Called from handle_line_prefix to handle the
18424 `line-prefix' and `wrap-prefix' properties. */
18426 static int
18427 push_display_prop (struct it *it, Lisp_Object prop)
18429 struct text_pos pos =
18430 (it->method == GET_FROM_STRING) ? it->current.string_pos : it->current.pos;
18432 xassert (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER
18433 || it->method == GET_FROM_STRING);
18435 /* We need to save the current buffer/string position, so it will be
18436 restored by pop_it, because iterate_out_of_display_property
18437 depends on that being set correctly, but some situations leave
18438 it->position not yet set when this function is called. */
18439 push_it (it, &pos);
18441 if (STRINGP (prop))
18443 if (SCHARS (prop) == 0)
18445 pop_it (it);
18446 return 0;
18449 it->string = prop;
18450 it->multibyte_p = STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string);
18451 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
18452 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = 0;
18453 it->end_charpos = it->string_nchars = SCHARS (it->string);
18454 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
18455 it->stop_charpos = 0;
18456 it->prev_stop = 0;
18457 it->base_level_stop = 0;
18459 /* Force paragraph direction to be that of the parent
18460 buffer/string. */
18461 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
18462 it->paragraph_embedding = it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir;
18463 else
18464 it->paragraph_embedding = L2R;
18466 /* Set up the bidi iterator for this display string. */
18467 if (it->bidi_p)
18469 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = it->string;
18470 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
18471 it->bidi_it.string.schars = it->end_charpos;
18472 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
18473 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = it->string_from_display_prop_p;
18474 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
18475 bidi_init_it (0, 0, FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f), &it->bidi_it);
18478 else if (CONSP (prop) && EQ (XCAR (prop), Qspace))
18480 it->method = GET_FROM_STRETCH;
18481 it->object = prop;
18483 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
18484 else if (IMAGEP (prop))
18486 it->what = IT_IMAGE;
18487 it->image_id = lookup_image (it->f, prop);
18488 it->method = GET_FROM_IMAGE;
18490 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
18491 else
18493 pop_it (it); /* bogus display property, give up */
18494 return 0;
18497 return 1;
18500 /* Return the character-property PROP at the current position in IT. */
18502 static Lisp_Object
18503 get_it_property (struct it *it, Lisp_Object prop)
18505 Lisp_Object position;
18507 if (STRINGP (it->object))
18508 position = make_number (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it));
18509 else if (BUFFERP (it->object))
18510 position = make_number (IT_CHARPOS (*it));
18511 else
18512 return Qnil;
18514 return Fget_char_property (position, prop, it->object);
18517 /* See if there's a line- or wrap-prefix, and if so, push it on IT. */
18519 static void
18520 handle_line_prefix (struct it *it)
18522 Lisp_Object prefix;
18524 if (it->continuation_lines_width > 0)
18526 prefix = get_it_property (it, Qwrap_prefix);
18527 if (NILP (prefix))
18528 prefix = Vwrap_prefix;
18530 else
18532 prefix = get_it_property (it, Qline_prefix);
18533 if (NILP (prefix))
18534 prefix = Vline_prefix;
18536 if (! NILP (prefix) && push_display_prop (it, prefix))
18538 /* If the prefix is wider than the window, and we try to wrap
18539 it, it would acquire its own wrap prefix, and so on till the
18540 iterator stack overflows. So, don't wrap the prefix. */
18541 it->line_wrap = TRUNCATE;
18542 it->avoid_cursor_p = 1;
18548 /* Remove N glyphs at the start of a reversed IT->glyph_row. Called
18549 only for R2L lines from display_line and display_string, when they
18550 decide that too many glyphs were produced by PRODUCE_GLYPHS, and
18551 the line/string needs to be continued on the next glyph row. */
18552 static void
18553 unproduce_glyphs (struct it *it, int n)
18555 struct glyph *glyph, *end;
18557 xassert (it->glyph_row);
18558 xassert (it->glyph_row->reversed_p);
18559 xassert (it->area == TEXT_AREA);
18560 xassert (n <= it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA]);
18562 if (n > it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])
18563 n = it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18564 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + n;
18565 end = it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18566 for ( ; glyph < end; glyph++)
18567 glyph[-n] = *glyph;
18570 /* Find the positions in a bidi-reordered ROW to serve as ROW->minpos
18571 and ROW->maxpos. */
18572 static void
18573 find_row_edges (struct it *it, struct glyph_row *row,
18574 EMACS_INT min_pos, EMACS_INT min_bpos,
18575 EMACS_INT max_pos, EMACS_INT max_bpos)
18577 /* FIXME: Revisit this when glyph ``spilling'' in continuation
18578 lines' rows is implemented for bidi-reordered rows. */
18580 /* ROW->minpos is the value of min_pos, the minimal buffer position
18581 we have in ROW, or ROW->start.pos if that is smaller. */
18582 if (min_pos <= ZV && min_pos < row->start.pos.charpos)
18583 SET_TEXT_POS (row->minpos, min_pos, min_bpos);
18584 else
18585 /* We didn't find buffer positions smaller than ROW->start, or
18586 didn't find _any_ valid buffer positions in any of the glyphs,
18587 so we must trust the iterator's computed positions. */
18588 row->minpos = row->start.pos;
18589 if (max_pos <= 0)
18591 max_pos = CHARPOS (it->current.pos);
18592 max_bpos = BYTEPOS (it->current.pos);
18595 /* Here are the various use-cases for ending the row, and the
18596 corresponding values for ROW->maxpos:
18598 Line ends in a newline from buffer eol_pos + 1
18599 Line is continued from buffer max_pos + 1
18600 Line is truncated on right it->current.pos
18601 Line ends in a newline from string max_pos + 1(*)
18602 (*) + 1 only when line ends in a forward scan
18603 Line is continued from string max_pos
18604 Line is continued from display vector max_pos
18605 Line is entirely from a string min_pos == max_pos
18606 Line is entirely from a display vector min_pos == max_pos
18607 Line that ends at ZV ZV
18609 If you discover other use-cases, please add them here as
18610 appropriate. */
18611 if (row->ends_at_zv_p)
18612 row->maxpos = it->current.pos;
18613 else if (row->used[TEXT_AREA])
18615 int seen_this_string = 0;
18616 struct glyph_row *r1 = row - 1;
18618 /* Did we see the same display string on the previous row? */
18619 if (STRINGP (it->object)
18620 /* this is not the first row */
18621 && row > it->w->desired_matrix->rows
18622 /* previous row is not the header line */
18623 && !r1->mode_line_p
18624 /* previous row also ends in a newline from a string */
18625 && r1->ends_in_newline_from_string_p)
18627 struct glyph *start, *end;
18629 /* Search for the last glyph of the previous row that came
18630 from buffer or string. Depending on whether the row is
18631 L2R or R2L, we need to process it front to back or the
18632 other way round. */
18633 if (!r1->reversed_p)
18635 start = r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18636 end = start + r1->used[TEXT_AREA];
18637 /* Glyphs inserted by redisplay have an integer (zero)
18638 as their object. */
18639 while (end > start
18640 && INTEGERP ((end - 1)->object)
18641 && (end - 1)->charpos <= 0)
18642 --end;
18643 if (end > start)
18645 if (EQ ((end - 1)->object, it->object))
18646 seen_this_string = 1;
18648 else
18649 /* If all the glyphs of the previous row were inserted
18650 by redisplay, it means the previous row was
18651 produced from a single newline, which is only
18652 possible if that newline came from the same string
18653 as the one which produced this ROW. */
18654 seen_this_string = 1;
18656 else
18658 end = r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
18659 start = end + r1->used[TEXT_AREA];
18660 while (end < start
18661 && INTEGERP ((end + 1)->object)
18662 && (end + 1)->charpos <= 0)
18663 ++end;
18664 if (end < start)
18666 if (EQ ((end + 1)->object, it->object))
18667 seen_this_string = 1;
18669 else
18670 seen_this_string = 1;
18673 /* Take note of each display string that covers a newline only
18674 once, the first time we see it. This is for when a display
18675 string includes more than one newline in it. */
18676 if (row->ends_in_newline_from_string_p && !seen_this_string)
18678 /* If we were scanning the buffer forward when we displayed
18679 the string, we want to account for at least one buffer
18680 position that belongs to this row (position covered by
18681 the display string), so that cursor positioning will
18682 consider this row as a candidate when point is at the end
18683 of the visual line represented by this row. This is not
18684 required when scanning back, because max_pos will already
18685 have a much larger value. */
18686 if (CHARPOS (row->end.pos) > max_pos)
18687 INC_BOTH (max_pos, max_bpos);
18688 SET_TEXT_POS (row->maxpos, max_pos, max_bpos);
18690 else if (CHARPOS (it->eol_pos) > 0)
18691 SET_TEXT_POS (row->maxpos,
18692 CHARPOS (it->eol_pos) + 1, BYTEPOS (it->eol_pos) + 1);
18693 else if (row->continued_p)
18695 /* If max_pos is different from IT's current position, it
18696 means IT->method does not belong to the display element
18697 at max_pos. However, it also means that the display
18698 element at max_pos was displayed in its entirety on this
18699 line, which is equivalent to saying that the next line
18700 starts at the next buffer position. */
18701 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) == max_pos && it->method != GET_FROM_BUFFER)
18702 SET_TEXT_POS (row->maxpos, max_pos, max_bpos);
18703 else
18705 INC_BOTH (max_pos, max_bpos);
18706 SET_TEXT_POS (row->maxpos, max_pos, max_bpos);
18709 else if (row->truncated_on_right_p)
18710 /* display_line already called reseat_at_next_visible_line_start,
18711 which puts the iterator at the beginning of the next line, in
18712 the logical order. */
18713 row->maxpos = it->current.pos;
18714 else if (max_pos == min_pos && it->method != GET_FROM_BUFFER)
18715 /* A line that is entirely from a string/image/stretch... */
18716 row->maxpos = row->minpos;
18717 else
18718 abort ();
18720 else
18721 row->maxpos = it->current.pos;
18724 /* Construct the glyph row IT->glyph_row in the desired matrix of
18725 IT->w from text at the current position of IT. See dispextern.h
18726 for an overview of struct it. Value is non-zero if
18727 IT->glyph_row displays text, as opposed to a line displaying ZV
18728 only. */
18730 static int
18731 display_line (struct it *it)
18733 struct glyph_row *row = it->glyph_row;
18734 Lisp_Object overlay_arrow_string;
18735 struct it wrap_it;
18736 void *wrap_data = NULL;
18737 int may_wrap = 0, wrap_x IF_LINT (= 0);
18738 int wrap_row_used = -1;
18739 int wrap_row_ascent IF_LINT (= 0), wrap_row_height IF_LINT (= 0);
18740 int wrap_row_phys_ascent IF_LINT (= 0), wrap_row_phys_height IF_LINT (= 0);
18741 int wrap_row_extra_line_spacing IF_LINT (= 0);
18742 EMACS_INT wrap_row_min_pos IF_LINT (= 0), wrap_row_min_bpos IF_LINT (= 0);
18743 EMACS_INT wrap_row_max_pos IF_LINT (= 0), wrap_row_max_bpos IF_LINT (= 0);
18744 int cvpos;
18745 EMACS_INT min_pos = ZV + 1, max_pos = 0;
18746 EMACS_INT min_bpos IF_LINT (= 0), max_bpos IF_LINT (= 0);
18748 /* We always start displaying at hpos zero even if hscrolled. */
18749 xassert (it->hpos == 0 && it->current_x == 0);
18751 if (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (row, it->w->desired_matrix)
18752 >= it->w->desired_matrix->nrows)
18754 it->w->nrows_scale_factor++;
18755 fonts_changed_p = 1;
18756 return 0;
18759 /* Is IT->w showing the region? */
18760 it->w->region_showing = it->region_beg_charpos > 0 ? Qt : Qnil;
18762 /* Clear the result glyph row and enable it. */
18763 prepare_desired_row (row);
18765 row->y = it->current_y;
18766 row->start = it->start;
18767 row->continuation_lines_width = it->continuation_lines_width;
18768 row->displays_text_p = 1;
18769 row->starts_in_middle_of_char_p = it->starts_in_middle_of_char_p;
18770 it->starts_in_middle_of_char_p = 0;
18772 /* Arrange the overlays nicely for our purposes. Usually, we call
18773 display_line on only one line at a time, in which case this
18774 can't really hurt too much, or we call it on lines which appear
18775 one after another in the buffer, in which case all calls to
18776 recenter_overlay_lists but the first will be pretty cheap. */
18777 recenter_overlay_lists (current_buffer, IT_CHARPOS (*it));
18779 /* Move over display elements that are not visible because we are
18780 hscrolled. This may stop at an x-position < IT->first_visible_x
18781 if the first glyph is partially visible or if we hit a line end. */
18782 if (it->current_x < it->first_visible_x)
18784 this_line_min_pos = row->start.pos;
18785 move_it_in_display_line_to (it, ZV, it->first_visible_x,
18786 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_X);
18787 /* Record the smallest positions seen while we moved over
18788 display elements that are not visible. This is needed by
18789 redisplay_internal for optimizing the case where the cursor
18790 stays inside the same line. The rest of this function only
18791 considers positions that are actually displayed, so
18792 RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS will not otherwise record positions that
18793 are hscrolled to the left of the left edge of the window. */
18794 min_pos = CHARPOS (this_line_min_pos);
18795 min_bpos = BYTEPOS (this_line_min_pos);
18797 else
18799 /* We only do this when not calling `move_it_in_display_line_to'
18800 above, because move_it_in_display_line_to calls
18801 handle_line_prefix itself. */
18802 handle_line_prefix (it);
18805 /* Get the initial row height. This is either the height of the
18806 text hscrolled, if there is any, or zero. */
18807 row->ascent = it->max_ascent;
18808 row->height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
18809 row->phys_ascent = it->max_phys_ascent;
18810 row->phys_height = it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent;
18811 row->extra_line_spacing = it->max_extra_line_spacing;
18813 /* Utility macro to record max and min buffer positions seen until now. */
18814 #define RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS(IT) \
18815 do \
18817 int composition_p = (IT)->what == IT_COMPOSITION; \
18818 EMACS_INT current_pos = \
18819 composition_p ? (IT)->cmp_it.charpos \
18820 : IT_CHARPOS (*(IT)); \
18821 EMACS_INT current_bpos = \
18822 composition_p ? CHAR_TO_BYTE (current_pos) \
18823 : IT_BYTEPOS (*(IT)); \
18824 if (current_pos < min_pos) \
18826 min_pos = current_pos; \
18827 min_bpos = current_bpos; \
18829 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) > max_pos) \
18831 max_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it); \
18832 max_bpos = IT_BYTEPOS (*it); \
18835 while (0)
18837 /* Loop generating characters. The loop is left with IT on the next
18838 character to display. */
18839 while (1)
18841 int n_glyphs_before, hpos_before, x_before;
18842 int x, nglyphs;
18843 int ascent = 0, descent = 0, phys_ascent = 0, phys_descent = 0;
18845 /* Retrieve the next thing to display. Value is zero if end of
18846 buffer reached. */
18847 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
18849 /* Maybe add a space at the end of this line that is used to
18850 display the cursor there under X. Set the charpos of the
18851 first glyph of blank lines not corresponding to any text
18852 to -1. */
18853 if (IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE (it))
18854 row->exact_window_width_line_p = 1;
18855 else if ((append_space_for_newline (it, 1) && row->used[TEXT_AREA] == 1)
18856 || row->used[TEXT_AREA] == 0)
18858 row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]->charpos = -1;
18859 row->displays_text_p = 0;
18861 if (!NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (it->w->buffer), indicate_empty_lines))
18862 && (!MINI_WINDOW_P (it->w)
18863 || (minibuf_level && EQ (it->window, minibuf_window))))
18864 row->indicate_empty_line_p = 1;
18867 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
18868 row->ends_at_zv_p = 1;
18869 /* A row that displays right-to-left text must always have
18870 its last face extended all the way to the end of line,
18871 even if this row ends in ZV, because we still write to
18872 the screen left to right. */
18873 if (row->reversed_p)
18874 extend_face_to_end_of_line (it);
18875 break;
18878 /* Now, get the metrics of what we want to display. This also
18879 generates glyphs in `row' (which is IT->glyph_row). */
18880 n_glyphs_before = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18881 x = it->current_x;
18883 /* Remember the line height so far in case the next element doesn't
18884 fit on the line. */
18885 if (it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE)
18887 ascent = it->max_ascent;
18888 descent = it->max_descent;
18889 phys_ascent = it->max_phys_ascent;
18890 phys_descent = it->max_phys_descent;
18892 if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP && it->area == TEXT_AREA)
18894 if (IT_DISPLAYING_WHITESPACE (it))
18895 may_wrap = 1;
18896 else if (may_wrap)
18898 SAVE_IT (wrap_it, *it, wrap_data);
18899 wrap_x = x;
18900 wrap_row_used = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18901 wrap_row_ascent = row->ascent;
18902 wrap_row_height = row->height;
18903 wrap_row_phys_ascent = row->phys_ascent;
18904 wrap_row_phys_height = row->phys_height;
18905 wrap_row_extra_line_spacing = row->extra_line_spacing;
18906 wrap_row_min_pos = min_pos;
18907 wrap_row_min_bpos = min_bpos;
18908 wrap_row_max_pos = max_pos;
18909 wrap_row_max_bpos = max_bpos;
18910 may_wrap = 0;
18915 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
18917 /* If this display element was in marginal areas, continue with
18918 the next one. */
18919 if (it->area != TEXT_AREA)
18921 row->ascent = max (row->ascent, it->max_ascent);
18922 row->height = max (row->height, it->max_ascent + it->max_descent);
18923 row->phys_ascent = max (row->phys_ascent, it->max_phys_ascent);
18924 row->phys_height = max (row->phys_height,
18925 it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent);
18926 row->extra_line_spacing = max (row->extra_line_spacing,
18927 it->max_extra_line_spacing);
18928 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
18929 continue;
18932 /* Does the display element fit on the line? If we truncate
18933 lines, we should draw past the right edge of the window. If
18934 we don't truncate, we want to stop so that we can display the
18935 continuation glyph before the right margin. If lines are
18936 continued, there are two possible strategies for characters
18937 resulting in more than 1 glyph (e.g. tabs): Display as many
18938 glyphs as possible in this line and leave the rest for the
18939 continuation line, or display the whole element in the next
18940 line. Original redisplay did the former, so we do it also. */
18941 nglyphs = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - n_glyphs_before;
18942 hpos_before = it->hpos;
18943 x_before = x;
18945 if (/* Not a newline. */
18946 nglyphs > 0
18947 /* Glyphs produced fit entirely in the line. */
18948 && it->current_x < it->last_visible_x)
18950 it->hpos += nglyphs;
18951 row->ascent = max (row->ascent, it->max_ascent);
18952 row->height = max (row->height, it->max_ascent + it->max_descent);
18953 row->phys_ascent = max (row->phys_ascent, it->max_phys_ascent);
18954 row->phys_height = max (row->phys_height,
18955 it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent);
18956 row->extra_line_spacing = max (row->extra_line_spacing,
18957 it->max_extra_line_spacing);
18958 if (it->current_x - it->pixel_width < it->first_visible_x)
18959 row->x = x - it->first_visible_x;
18960 /* Record the maximum and minimum buffer positions seen so
18961 far in glyphs that will be displayed by this row. */
18962 if (it->bidi_p)
18963 RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS (it);
18965 else
18967 int i, new_x;
18968 struct glyph *glyph;
18970 for (i = 0; i < nglyphs; ++i, x = new_x)
18972 glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + n_glyphs_before + i;
18973 new_x = x + glyph->pixel_width;
18975 if (/* Lines are continued. */
18976 it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE
18977 && (/* Glyph doesn't fit on the line. */
18978 new_x > it->last_visible_x
18979 /* Or it fits exactly on a window system frame. */
18980 || (new_x == it->last_visible_x
18981 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))))
18983 /* End of a continued line. */
18985 if (it->hpos == 0
18986 || (new_x == it->last_visible_x
18987 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)))
18989 /* Current glyph is the only one on the line or
18990 fits exactly on the line. We must continue
18991 the line because we can't draw the cursor
18992 after the glyph. */
18993 row->continued_p = 1;
18994 it->current_x = new_x;
18995 it->continuation_lines_width += new_x;
18996 ++it->hpos;
18997 if (i == nglyphs - 1)
18999 /* If line-wrap is on, check if a previous
19000 wrap point was found. */
19001 if (wrap_row_used > 0
19002 /* Even if there is a previous wrap
19003 point, continue the line here as
19004 usual, if (i) the previous character
19005 was a space or tab AND (ii) the
19006 current character is not. */
19007 && (!may_wrap
19008 || IT_DISPLAYING_WHITESPACE (it)))
19009 goto back_to_wrap;
19011 /* Record the maximum and minimum buffer
19012 positions seen so far in glyphs that will be
19013 displayed by this row. */
19014 if (it->bidi_p)
19015 RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS (it);
19016 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
19017 if (IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE (it))
19019 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
19021 row->exact_window_width_line_p = 1;
19022 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
19023 row->continued_p = 0;
19024 row->ends_at_zv_p = 1;
19026 else if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
19028 row->continued_p = 0;
19029 row->exact_window_width_line_p = 1;
19033 else if (it->bidi_p)
19034 RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS (it);
19036 else if (CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (*glyph)
19037 && !FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
19039 /* A padding glyph that doesn't fit on this line.
19040 This means the whole character doesn't fit
19041 on the line. */
19042 if (row->reversed_p)
19043 unproduce_glyphs (it, row->used[TEXT_AREA]
19044 - n_glyphs_before);
19045 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = n_glyphs_before;
19047 /* Fill the rest of the row with continuation
19048 glyphs like in 20.x. */
19049 while (row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA]
19050 < row->glyphs[1 + TEXT_AREA])
19051 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_CONTINUATION);
19053 row->continued_p = 1;
19054 it->current_x = x_before;
19055 it->continuation_lines_width += x_before;
19057 /* Restore the height to what it was before the
19058 element not fitting on the line. */
19059 it->max_ascent = ascent;
19060 it->max_descent = descent;
19061 it->max_phys_ascent = phys_ascent;
19062 it->max_phys_descent = phys_descent;
19064 else if (wrap_row_used > 0)
19066 back_to_wrap:
19067 if (row->reversed_p)
19068 unproduce_glyphs (it,
19069 row->used[TEXT_AREA] - wrap_row_used);
19070 RESTORE_IT (it, &wrap_it, wrap_data);
19071 it->continuation_lines_width += wrap_x;
19072 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = wrap_row_used;
19073 row->ascent = wrap_row_ascent;
19074 row->height = wrap_row_height;
19075 row->phys_ascent = wrap_row_phys_ascent;
19076 row->phys_height = wrap_row_phys_height;
19077 row->extra_line_spacing = wrap_row_extra_line_spacing;
19078 min_pos = wrap_row_min_pos;
19079 min_bpos = wrap_row_min_bpos;
19080 max_pos = wrap_row_max_pos;
19081 max_bpos = wrap_row_max_bpos;
19082 row->continued_p = 1;
19083 row->ends_at_zv_p = 0;
19084 row->exact_window_width_line_p = 0;
19085 it->continuation_lines_width += x;
19087 /* Make sure that a non-default face is extended
19088 up to the right margin of the window. */
19089 extend_face_to_end_of_line (it);
19091 else if (it->c == '\t' && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
19093 /* A TAB that extends past the right edge of the
19094 window. This produces a single glyph on
19095 window system frames. We leave the glyph in
19096 this row and let it fill the row, but don't
19097 consume the TAB. */
19098 it->continuation_lines_width += it->last_visible_x;
19099 row->ends_in_middle_of_char_p = 1;
19100 row->continued_p = 1;
19101 glyph->pixel_width = it->last_visible_x - x;
19102 it->starts_in_middle_of_char_p = 1;
19104 else
19106 /* Something other than a TAB that draws past
19107 the right edge of the window. Restore
19108 positions to values before the element. */
19109 if (row->reversed_p)
19110 unproduce_glyphs (it, row->used[TEXT_AREA]
19111 - (n_glyphs_before + i));
19112 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = n_glyphs_before + i;
19114 /* Display continuation glyphs. */
19115 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
19116 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_CONTINUATION);
19117 row->continued_p = 1;
19119 it->current_x = x_before;
19120 it->continuation_lines_width += x;
19121 extend_face_to_end_of_line (it);
19123 if (nglyphs > 1 && i > 0)
19125 row->ends_in_middle_of_char_p = 1;
19126 it->starts_in_middle_of_char_p = 1;
19129 /* Restore the height to what it was before the
19130 element not fitting on the line. */
19131 it->max_ascent = ascent;
19132 it->max_descent = descent;
19133 it->max_phys_ascent = phys_ascent;
19134 it->max_phys_descent = phys_descent;
19137 break;
19139 else if (new_x > it->first_visible_x)
19141 /* Increment number of glyphs actually displayed. */
19142 ++it->hpos;
19144 /* Record the maximum and minimum buffer positions
19145 seen so far in glyphs that will be displayed by
19146 this row. */
19147 if (it->bidi_p)
19148 RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS (it);
19150 if (x < it->first_visible_x)
19151 /* Glyph is partially visible, i.e. row starts at
19152 negative X position. */
19153 row->x = x - it->first_visible_x;
19155 else
19157 /* Glyph is completely off the left margin of the
19158 window. This should not happen because of the
19159 move_it_in_display_line at the start of this
19160 function, unless the text display area of the
19161 window is empty. */
19162 xassert (it->first_visible_x <= it->last_visible_x);
19165 /* Even if this display element produced no glyphs at all,
19166 we want to record its position. */
19167 if (it->bidi_p && nglyphs == 0)
19168 RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS (it);
19170 row->ascent = max (row->ascent, it->max_ascent);
19171 row->height = max (row->height, it->max_ascent + it->max_descent);
19172 row->phys_ascent = max (row->phys_ascent, it->max_phys_ascent);
19173 row->phys_height = max (row->phys_height,
19174 it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent);
19175 row->extra_line_spacing = max (row->extra_line_spacing,
19176 it->max_extra_line_spacing);
19178 /* End of this display line if row is continued. */
19179 if (row->continued_p || row->ends_at_zv_p)
19180 break;
19183 at_end_of_line:
19184 /* Is this a line end? If yes, we're also done, after making
19185 sure that a non-default face is extended up to the right
19186 margin of the window. */
19187 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
19189 int used_before = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
19191 row->ends_in_newline_from_string_p = STRINGP (it->object);
19193 /* Add a space at the end of the line that is used to
19194 display the cursor there. */
19195 if (!IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE (it))
19196 append_space_for_newline (it, 0);
19198 /* Extend the face to the end of the line. */
19199 extend_face_to_end_of_line (it);
19201 /* Make sure we have the position. */
19202 if (used_before == 0)
19203 row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
19205 /* Record the position of the newline, for use in
19206 find_row_edges. */
19207 it->eol_pos = it->current.pos;
19209 /* Consume the line end. This skips over invisible lines. */
19210 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
19211 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
19212 break;
19215 /* Proceed with next display element. Note that this skips
19216 over lines invisible because of selective display. */
19217 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
19219 /* If we truncate lines, we are done when the last displayed
19220 glyphs reach past the right margin of the window. */
19221 if (it->line_wrap == TRUNCATE
19222 && (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
19223 ? (it->current_x >= it->last_visible_x)
19224 : (it->current_x > it->last_visible_x)))
19226 /* Maybe add truncation glyphs. */
19227 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
19229 int i, n;
19231 if (!row->reversed_p)
19233 for (i = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1; i > 0; --i)
19234 if (!CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][i]))
19235 break;
19237 else
19239 for (i = 0; i < row->used[TEXT_AREA]; i++)
19240 if (!CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][i]))
19241 break;
19242 /* Remove any padding glyphs at the front of ROW, to
19243 make room for the truncation glyphs we will be
19244 adding below. The loop below always inserts at
19245 least one truncation glyph, so also remove the
19246 last glyph added to ROW. */
19247 unproduce_glyphs (it, i + 1);
19248 /* Adjust i for the loop below. */
19249 i = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - (i + 1);
19252 for (n = row->used[TEXT_AREA]; i < n; ++i)
19254 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = i;
19255 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_TRUNCATION);
19258 else if (IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE (it))
19260 /* Don't truncate if we can overflow newline into fringe. */
19261 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
19263 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
19264 row->ends_at_zv_p = 1;
19265 row->exact_window_width_line_p = 1;
19266 break;
19268 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
19270 row->exact_window_width_line_p = 1;
19271 goto at_end_of_line;
19275 row->truncated_on_right_p = 1;
19276 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
19277 reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (it, 0);
19278 row->ends_at_zv_p = FETCH_BYTE (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) - 1) != '\n';
19279 it->hpos = hpos_before;
19280 it->current_x = x_before;
19281 break;
19285 if (wrap_data)
19286 bidi_unshelve_cache (wrap_data, 1);
19288 /* If line is not empty and hscrolled, maybe insert truncation glyphs
19289 at the left window margin. */
19290 if (it->first_visible_x
19291 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) != CHARPOS (row->start.pos))
19293 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
19294 insert_left_trunc_glyphs (it);
19295 row->truncated_on_left_p = 1;
19298 /* Remember the position at which this line ends.
19300 BIDI Note: any code that needs MATRIX_ROW_START/END_CHARPOS
19301 cannot be before the call to find_row_edges below, since that is
19302 where these positions are determined. */
19303 row->end = it->current;
19304 if (!it->bidi_p)
19306 row->minpos = row->start.pos;
19307 row->maxpos = row->end.pos;
19309 else
19311 /* ROW->minpos and ROW->maxpos must be the smallest and
19312 `1 + the largest' buffer positions in ROW. But if ROW was
19313 bidi-reordered, these two positions can be anywhere in the
19314 row, so we must determine them now. */
19315 find_row_edges (it, row, min_pos, min_bpos, max_pos, max_bpos);
19318 /* If the start of this line is the overlay arrow-position, then
19319 mark this glyph row as the one containing the overlay arrow.
19320 This is clearly a mess with variable size fonts. It would be
19321 better to let it be displayed like cursors under X. */
19322 if ((row->displays_text_p || !overlay_arrow_seen)
19323 && (overlay_arrow_string = overlay_arrow_at_row (it, row),
19324 !NILP (overlay_arrow_string)))
19326 /* Overlay arrow in window redisplay is a fringe bitmap. */
19327 if (STRINGP (overlay_arrow_string))
19329 struct glyph_row *arrow_row
19330 = get_overlay_arrow_glyph_row (it->w, overlay_arrow_string);
19331 struct glyph *glyph = arrow_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
19332 struct glyph *arrow_end = glyph + arrow_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
19333 struct glyph *p = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
19334 struct glyph *p2, *end;
19336 /* Copy the arrow glyphs. */
19337 while (glyph < arrow_end)
19338 *p++ = *glyph++;
19340 /* Throw away padding glyphs. */
19341 p2 = p;
19342 end = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
19343 while (p2 < end && CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (*p2))
19344 ++p2;
19345 if (p2 > p)
19347 while (p2 < end)
19348 *p++ = *p2++;
19349 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = p2 - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
19352 else
19354 xassert (INTEGERP (overlay_arrow_string));
19355 row->overlay_arrow_bitmap = XINT (overlay_arrow_string);
19357 overlay_arrow_seen = 1;
19360 /* Compute pixel dimensions of this line. */
19361 compute_line_metrics (it);
19363 /* Record whether this row ends inside an ellipsis. */
19364 row->ends_in_ellipsis_p
19365 = (it->method == GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR
19366 && it->ellipsis_p);
19368 /* Save fringe bitmaps in this row. */
19369 row->left_user_fringe_bitmap = it->left_user_fringe_bitmap;
19370 row->left_user_fringe_face_id = it->left_user_fringe_face_id;
19371 row->right_user_fringe_bitmap = it->right_user_fringe_bitmap;
19372 row->right_user_fringe_face_id = it->right_user_fringe_face_id;
19374 it->left_user_fringe_bitmap = 0;
19375 it->left_user_fringe_face_id = 0;
19376 it->right_user_fringe_bitmap = 0;
19377 it->right_user_fringe_face_id = 0;
19379 /* Maybe set the cursor. */
19380 cvpos = it->w->cursor.vpos;
19381 if ((cvpos < 0
19382 /* In bidi-reordered rows, keep checking for proper cursor
19383 position even if one has been found already, because buffer
19384 positions in such rows change non-linearly with ROW->VPOS,
19385 when a line is continued. One exception: when we are at ZV,
19386 display cursor on the first suitable glyph row, since all
19387 the empty rows after that also have their position set to ZV. */
19388 /* FIXME: Revisit this when glyph ``spilling'' in continuation
19389 lines' rows is implemented for bidi-reordered rows. */
19390 || (it->bidi_p
19391 && !MATRIX_ROW (it->w->desired_matrix, cvpos)->ends_at_zv_p))
19392 && PT >= MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row)
19393 && PT <= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
19394 && cursor_row_p (row))
19395 set_cursor_from_row (it->w, row, it->w->desired_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
19397 /* Highlight trailing whitespace. */
19398 if (!NILP (Vshow_trailing_whitespace))
19399 highlight_trailing_whitespace (it->f, it->glyph_row);
19401 /* Prepare for the next line. This line starts horizontally at (X
19402 HPOS) = (0 0). Vertical positions are incremented. As a
19403 convenience for the caller, IT->glyph_row is set to the next
19404 row to be used. */
19405 it->current_x = it->hpos = 0;
19406 it->current_y += row->height;
19407 SET_TEXT_POS (it->eol_pos, 0, 0);
19408 ++it->vpos;
19409 ++it->glyph_row;
19410 /* The next row should by default use the same value of the
19411 reversed_p flag as this one. set_iterator_to_next decides when
19412 it's a new paragraph, and PRODUCE_GLYPHS recomputes the value of
19413 the flag accordingly. */
19414 if (it->glyph_row < MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (it->w->desired_matrix, it->w))
19415 it->glyph_row->reversed_p = row->reversed_p;
19416 it->start = row->end;
19417 return row->displays_text_p;
19419 #undef RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS
19422 DEFUN ("current-bidi-paragraph-direction", Fcurrent_bidi_paragraph_direction,
19423 Scurrent_bidi_paragraph_direction, 0, 1, 0,
19424 doc: /* Return paragraph direction at point in BUFFER.
19425 Value is either `left-to-right' or `right-to-left'.
19426 If BUFFER is omitted or nil, it defaults to the current buffer.
19428 Paragraph direction determines how the text in the paragraph is displayed.
19429 In left-to-right paragraphs, text begins at the left margin of the window
19430 and the reading direction is generally left to right. In right-to-left
19431 paragraphs, text begins at the right margin and is read from right to left.
19433 See also `bidi-paragraph-direction'. */)
19434 (Lisp_Object buffer)
19436 struct buffer *buf = current_buffer;
19437 struct buffer *old = buf;
19439 if (! NILP (buffer))
19441 CHECK_BUFFER (buffer);
19442 buf = XBUFFER (buffer);
19445 if (NILP (BVAR (buf, bidi_display_reordering))
19446 || NILP (BVAR (buf, enable_multibyte_characters)))
19447 return Qleft_to_right;
19448 else if (!NILP (BVAR (buf, bidi_paragraph_direction)))
19449 return BVAR (buf, bidi_paragraph_direction);
19450 else
19452 /* Determine the direction from buffer text. We could try to
19453 use current_matrix if it is up to date, but this seems fast
19454 enough as it is. */
19455 struct bidi_it itb;
19456 EMACS_INT pos = BUF_PT (buf);
19457 EMACS_INT bytepos = BUF_PT_BYTE (buf);
19458 int c;
19459 void *itb_data = bidi_shelve_cache ();
19461 set_buffer_temp (buf);
19462 /* bidi_paragraph_init finds the base direction of the paragraph
19463 by searching forward from paragraph start. We need the base
19464 direction of the current or _previous_ paragraph, so we need
19465 to make sure we are within that paragraph. To that end, find
19466 the previous non-empty line. */
19467 if (pos >= ZV && pos > BEGV)
19469 pos--;
19470 bytepos = CHAR_TO_BYTE (pos);
19472 if (fast_looking_at (build_string ("[\f\t ]*\n"),
19473 pos, bytepos, ZV, ZV_BYTE, Qnil) > 0)
19475 while ((c = FETCH_BYTE (bytepos)) == '\n'
19476 || c == ' ' || c == '\t' || c == '\f')
19478 if (bytepos <= BEGV_BYTE)
19479 break;
19480 bytepos--;
19481 pos--;
19483 while (!CHAR_HEAD_P (FETCH_BYTE (bytepos)))
19484 bytepos--;
19486 bidi_init_it (pos, bytepos, FRAME_WINDOW_P (SELECTED_FRAME ()), &itb);
19487 itb.string.s = NULL;
19488 itb.string.lstring = Qnil;
19489 itb.string.bufpos = 0;
19490 itb.string.unibyte = 0;
19491 bidi_paragraph_init (NEUTRAL_DIR, &itb, 1);
19492 bidi_unshelve_cache (itb_data, 0);
19493 set_buffer_temp (old);
19494 switch (itb.paragraph_dir)
19496 case L2R:
19497 return Qleft_to_right;
19498 break;
19499 case R2L:
19500 return Qright_to_left;
19501 break;
19502 default:
19503 abort ();
19510 /***********************************************************************
19511 Menu Bar
19512 ***********************************************************************/
19514 /* Redisplay the menu bar in the frame for window W.
19516 The menu bar of X frames that don't have X toolkit support is
19517 displayed in a special window W->frame->menu_bar_window.
19519 The menu bar of terminal frames is treated specially as far as
19520 glyph matrices are concerned. Menu bar lines are not part of
19521 windows, so the update is done directly on the frame matrix rows
19522 for the menu bar. */
19524 static void
19525 display_menu_bar (struct window *w)
19527 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
19528 struct it it;
19529 Lisp_Object items;
19530 int i;
19532 /* Don't do all this for graphical frames. */
19533 #ifdef HAVE_NTGUI
19534 if (FRAME_W32_P (f))
19535 return;
19536 #endif
19537 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
19538 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
19539 return;
19540 #endif
19542 #ifdef HAVE_NS
19543 if (FRAME_NS_P (f))
19544 return;
19545 #endif /* HAVE_NS */
19547 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
19548 xassert (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f));
19549 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, f->desired_matrix->rows, MENU_FACE_ID);
19550 it.first_visible_x = 0;
19551 it.last_visible_x = FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
19552 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
19553 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
19555 /* Menu bar lines are displayed in the desired matrix of the
19556 dummy window menu_bar_window. */
19557 struct window *menu_w;
19558 xassert (WINDOWP (f->menu_bar_window));
19559 menu_w = XWINDOW (f->menu_bar_window);
19560 init_iterator (&it, menu_w, -1, -1, menu_w->desired_matrix->rows,
19561 MENU_FACE_ID);
19562 it.first_visible_x = 0;
19563 it.last_visible_x = FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
19565 else
19567 /* This is a TTY frame, i.e. character hpos/vpos are used as
19568 pixel x/y. */
19569 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, f->desired_matrix->rows,
19570 MENU_FACE_ID);
19571 it.first_visible_x = 0;
19572 it.last_visible_x = FRAME_COLS (f);
19574 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
19576 /* FIXME: This should be controlled by a user option. See the
19577 comments in redisplay_tool_bar and display_mode_line about
19578 this. */
19579 it.paragraph_embedding = L2R;
19581 if (! mode_line_inverse_video)
19582 /* Force the menu-bar to be displayed in the default face. */
19583 it.base_face_id = it.face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
19585 /* Clear all rows of the menu bar. */
19586 for (i = 0; i < FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f); ++i)
19588 struct glyph_row *row = it.glyph_row + i;
19589 clear_glyph_row (row);
19590 row->enabled_p = 1;
19591 row->full_width_p = 1;
19594 /* Display all items of the menu bar. */
19595 items = FRAME_MENU_BAR_ITEMS (it.f);
19596 for (i = 0; i < ASIZE (items); i += 4)
19598 Lisp_Object string;
19600 /* Stop at nil string. */
19601 string = AREF (items, i + 1);
19602 if (NILP (string))
19603 break;
19605 /* Remember where item was displayed. */
19606 ASET (items, i + 3, make_number (it.hpos));
19608 /* Display the item, pad with one space. */
19609 if (it.current_x < it.last_visible_x)
19610 display_string (NULL, string, Qnil, 0, 0, &it,
19611 SCHARS (string) + 1, 0, 0, -1);
19614 /* Fill out the line with spaces. */
19615 if (it.current_x < it.last_visible_x)
19616 display_string ("", Qnil, Qnil, 0, 0, &it, -1, 0, 0, -1);
19618 /* Compute the total height of the lines. */
19619 compute_line_metrics (&it);
19624 /***********************************************************************
19625 Mode Line
19626 ***********************************************************************/
19628 /* Redisplay mode lines in the window tree whose root is WINDOW. If
19629 FORCE is non-zero, redisplay mode lines unconditionally.
19630 Otherwise, redisplay only mode lines that are garbaged. Value is
19631 the number of windows whose mode lines were redisplayed. */
19633 static int
19634 redisplay_mode_lines (Lisp_Object window, int force)
19636 int nwindows = 0;
19638 while (!NILP (window))
19640 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
19642 if (WINDOWP (w->hchild))
19643 nwindows += redisplay_mode_lines (w->hchild, force);
19644 else if (WINDOWP (w->vchild))
19645 nwindows += redisplay_mode_lines (w->vchild, force);
19646 else if (force
19647 || FRAME_GARBAGED_P (XFRAME (w->frame))
19648 || !MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)->enabled_p)
19650 struct text_pos lpoint;
19651 struct buffer *old = current_buffer;
19653 /* Set the window's buffer for the mode line display. */
19654 SET_TEXT_POS (lpoint, PT, PT_BYTE);
19655 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (w->buffer));
19657 /* Point refers normally to the selected window. For any
19658 other window, set up appropriate value. */
19659 if (!EQ (window, selected_window))
19661 struct text_pos pt;
19663 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (pt, w->pointm);
19664 if (CHARPOS (pt) < BEGV)
19665 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
19666 else if (CHARPOS (pt) > (ZV - 1))
19667 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (ZV, ZV_BYTE);
19668 else
19669 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (CHARPOS (pt), BYTEPOS (pt));
19672 /* Display mode lines. */
19673 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
19674 if (display_mode_lines (w))
19676 ++nwindows;
19677 w->must_be_updated_p = 1;
19680 /* Restore old settings. */
19681 set_buffer_internal_1 (old);
19682 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (CHARPOS (lpoint), BYTEPOS (lpoint));
19685 window = w->next;
19688 return nwindows;
19692 /* Display the mode and/or header line of window W. Value is the
19693 sum number of mode lines and header lines displayed. */
19695 static int
19696 display_mode_lines (struct window *w)
19698 Lisp_Object old_selected_window, old_selected_frame;
19699 int n = 0;
19701 old_selected_frame = selected_frame;
19702 selected_frame = w->frame;
19703 old_selected_window = selected_window;
19704 XSETWINDOW (selected_window, w);
19706 /* These will be set while the mode line specs are processed. */
19707 line_number_displayed = 0;
19708 w->column_number_displayed = Qnil;
19710 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w))
19712 struct window *sel_w = XWINDOW (old_selected_window);
19714 /* Select mode line face based on the real selected window. */
19715 display_mode_line (w, CURRENT_MODE_LINE_FACE_ID_3 (sel_w, sel_w, w),
19716 BVAR (current_buffer, mode_line_format));
19717 ++n;
19720 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w))
19722 display_mode_line (w, HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID,
19723 BVAR (current_buffer, header_line_format));
19724 ++n;
19727 selected_frame = old_selected_frame;
19728 selected_window = old_selected_window;
19729 return n;
19733 /* Display mode or header line of window W. FACE_ID specifies which
19734 line to display; it is either MODE_LINE_FACE_ID or
19735 HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID. FORMAT is the mode/header line format to
19736 display. Value is the pixel height of the mode/header line
19737 displayed. */
19739 static int
19740 display_mode_line (struct window *w, enum face_id face_id, Lisp_Object format)
19742 struct it it;
19743 struct face *face;
19744 int count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
19746 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, NULL, face_id);
19747 /* Don't extend on a previously drawn mode-line.
19748 This may happen if called from pos_visible_p. */
19749 it.glyph_row->enabled_p = 0;
19750 prepare_desired_row (it.glyph_row);
19752 it.glyph_row->mode_line_p = 1;
19754 if (! mode_line_inverse_video)
19755 /* Force the mode-line to be displayed in the default face. */
19756 it.base_face_id = it.face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
19758 /* FIXME: This should be controlled by a user option. But
19759 supporting such an option is not trivial, since the mode line is
19760 made up of many separate strings. */
19761 it.paragraph_embedding = L2R;
19763 record_unwind_protect (unwind_format_mode_line,
19764 format_mode_line_unwind_data (NULL, Qnil, 0));
19766 mode_line_target = MODE_LINE_DISPLAY;
19768 /* Temporarily make frame's keyboard the current kboard so that
19769 kboard-local variables in the mode_line_format will get the right
19770 values. */
19771 push_kboard (FRAME_KBOARD (it.f));
19772 record_unwind_save_match_data ();
19773 display_mode_element (&it, 0, 0, 0, format, Qnil, 0);
19774 pop_kboard ();
19776 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
19778 /* Fill up with spaces. */
19779 display_string (" ", Qnil, Qnil, 0, 0, &it, 10000, -1, -1, 0);
19781 compute_line_metrics (&it);
19782 it.glyph_row->full_width_p = 1;
19783 it.glyph_row->continued_p = 0;
19784 it.glyph_row->truncated_on_left_p = 0;
19785 it.glyph_row->truncated_on_right_p = 0;
19787 /* Make a 3D mode-line have a shadow at its right end. */
19788 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it.f, face_id);
19789 extend_face_to_end_of_line (&it);
19790 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
19792 struct glyph *last = (it.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
19793 + it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1);
19794 last->right_box_line_p = 1;
19797 return it.glyph_row->height;
19800 /* Move element ELT in LIST to the front of LIST.
19801 Return the updated list. */
19803 static Lisp_Object
19804 move_elt_to_front (Lisp_Object elt, Lisp_Object list)
19806 register Lisp_Object tail, prev;
19807 register Lisp_Object tem;
19809 tail = list;
19810 prev = Qnil;
19811 while (CONSP (tail))
19813 tem = XCAR (tail);
19815 if (EQ (elt, tem))
19817 /* Splice out the link TAIL. */
19818 if (NILP (prev))
19819 list = XCDR (tail);
19820 else
19821 Fsetcdr (prev, XCDR (tail));
19823 /* Now make it the first. */
19824 Fsetcdr (tail, list);
19825 return tail;
19827 else
19828 prev = tail;
19829 tail = XCDR (tail);
19830 QUIT;
19833 /* Not found--return unchanged LIST. */
19834 return list;
19837 /* Contribute ELT to the mode line for window IT->w. How it
19838 translates into text depends on its data type.
19840 IT describes the display environment in which we display, as usual.
19842 DEPTH is the depth in recursion. It is used to prevent
19843 infinite recursion here.
19845 FIELD_WIDTH is the number of characters the display of ELT should
19846 occupy in the mode line, and PRECISION is the maximum number of
19847 characters to display from ELT's representation. See
19848 display_string for details.
19850 Returns the hpos of the end of the text generated by ELT.
19852 PROPS is a property list to add to any string we encounter.
19854 If RISKY is nonzero, remove (disregard) any properties in any string
19855 we encounter, and ignore :eval and :propertize.
19857 The global variable `mode_line_target' determines whether the
19858 output is passed to `store_mode_line_noprop',
19859 `store_mode_line_string', or `display_string'. */
19861 static int
19862 display_mode_element (struct it *it, int depth, int field_width, int precision,
19863 Lisp_Object elt, Lisp_Object props, int risky)
19865 int n = 0, field, prec;
19866 int literal = 0;
19868 tail_recurse:
19869 if (depth > 100)
19870 elt = build_string ("*too-deep*");
19872 depth++;
19874 switch (SWITCH_ENUM_CAST (XTYPE (elt)))
19876 case Lisp_String:
19878 /* A string: output it and check for %-constructs within it. */
19879 unsigned char c;
19880 EMACS_INT offset = 0;
19882 if (SCHARS (elt) > 0
19883 && (!NILP (props) || risky))
19885 Lisp_Object oprops, aelt;
19886 oprops = Ftext_properties_at (make_number (0), elt);
19888 /* If the starting string's properties are not what
19889 we want, translate the string. Also, if the string
19890 is risky, do that anyway. */
19892 if (NILP (Fequal (props, oprops)) || risky)
19894 /* If the starting string has properties,
19895 merge the specified ones onto the existing ones. */
19896 if (! NILP (oprops) && !risky)
19898 Lisp_Object tem;
19900 oprops = Fcopy_sequence (oprops);
19901 tem = props;
19902 while (CONSP (tem))
19904 oprops = Fplist_put (oprops, XCAR (tem),
19905 XCAR (XCDR (tem)));
19906 tem = XCDR (XCDR (tem));
19908 props = oprops;
19911 aelt = Fassoc (elt, mode_line_proptrans_alist);
19912 if (! NILP (aelt) && !NILP (Fequal (props, XCDR (aelt))))
19914 /* AELT is what we want. Move it to the front
19915 without consing. */
19916 elt = XCAR (aelt);
19917 mode_line_proptrans_alist
19918 = move_elt_to_front (aelt, mode_line_proptrans_alist);
19920 else
19922 Lisp_Object tem;
19924 /* If AELT has the wrong props, it is useless.
19925 so get rid of it. */
19926 if (! NILP (aelt))
19927 mode_line_proptrans_alist
19928 = Fdelq (aelt, mode_line_proptrans_alist);
19930 elt = Fcopy_sequence (elt);
19931 Fset_text_properties (make_number (0), Flength (elt),
19932 props, elt);
19933 /* Add this item to mode_line_proptrans_alist. */
19934 mode_line_proptrans_alist
19935 = Fcons (Fcons (elt, props),
19936 mode_line_proptrans_alist);
19937 /* Truncate mode_line_proptrans_alist
19938 to at most 50 elements. */
19939 tem = Fnthcdr (make_number (50),
19940 mode_line_proptrans_alist);
19941 if (! NILP (tem))
19942 XSETCDR (tem, Qnil);
19947 offset = 0;
19949 if (literal)
19951 prec = precision - n;
19952 switch (mode_line_target)
19954 case MODE_LINE_NOPROP:
19955 case MODE_LINE_TITLE:
19956 n += store_mode_line_noprop (SSDATA (elt), -1, prec);
19957 break;
19958 case MODE_LINE_STRING:
19959 n += store_mode_line_string (NULL, elt, 1, 0, prec, Qnil);
19960 break;
19961 case MODE_LINE_DISPLAY:
19962 n += display_string (NULL, elt, Qnil, 0, 0, it,
19963 0, prec, 0, STRING_MULTIBYTE (elt));
19964 break;
19967 break;
19970 /* Handle the non-literal case. */
19972 while ((precision <= 0 || n < precision)
19973 && SREF (elt, offset) != 0
19974 && (mode_line_target != MODE_LINE_DISPLAY
19975 || it->current_x < it->last_visible_x))
19977 EMACS_INT last_offset = offset;
19979 /* Advance to end of string or next format specifier. */
19980 while ((c = SREF (elt, offset++)) != '\0' && c != '%')
19983 if (offset - 1 != last_offset)
19985 EMACS_INT nchars, nbytes;
19987 /* Output to end of string or up to '%'. Field width
19988 is length of string. Don't output more than
19989 PRECISION allows us. */
19990 offset--;
19992 prec = c_string_width (SDATA (elt) + last_offset,
19993 offset - last_offset, precision - n,
19994 &nchars, &nbytes);
19996 switch (mode_line_target)
19998 case MODE_LINE_NOPROP:
19999 case MODE_LINE_TITLE:
20000 n += store_mode_line_noprop (SSDATA (elt) + last_offset, 0, prec);
20001 break;
20002 case MODE_LINE_STRING:
20004 EMACS_INT bytepos = last_offset;
20005 EMACS_INT charpos = string_byte_to_char (elt, bytepos);
20006 EMACS_INT endpos = (precision <= 0
20007 ? string_byte_to_char (elt, offset)
20008 : charpos + nchars);
20010 n += store_mode_line_string (NULL,
20011 Fsubstring (elt, make_number (charpos),
20012 make_number (endpos)),
20013 0, 0, 0, Qnil);
20015 break;
20016 case MODE_LINE_DISPLAY:
20018 EMACS_INT bytepos = last_offset;
20019 EMACS_INT charpos = string_byte_to_char (elt, bytepos);
20021 if (precision <= 0)
20022 nchars = string_byte_to_char (elt, offset) - charpos;
20023 n += display_string (NULL, elt, Qnil, 0, charpos,
20024 it, 0, nchars, 0,
20025 STRING_MULTIBYTE (elt));
20027 break;
20030 else /* c == '%' */
20032 EMACS_INT percent_position = offset;
20034 /* Get the specified minimum width. Zero means
20035 don't pad. */
20036 field = 0;
20037 while ((c = SREF (elt, offset++)) >= '0' && c <= '9')
20038 field = field * 10 + c - '0';
20040 /* Don't pad beyond the total padding allowed. */
20041 if (field_width - n > 0 && field > field_width - n)
20042 field = field_width - n;
20044 /* Note that either PRECISION <= 0 or N < PRECISION. */
20045 prec = precision - n;
20047 if (c == 'M')
20048 n += display_mode_element (it, depth, field, prec,
20049 Vglobal_mode_string, props,
20050 risky);
20051 else if (c != 0)
20053 int multibyte;
20054 EMACS_INT bytepos, charpos;
20055 const char *spec;
20056 Lisp_Object string;
20058 bytepos = percent_position;
20059 charpos = (STRING_MULTIBYTE (elt)
20060 ? string_byte_to_char (elt, bytepos)
20061 : bytepos);
20062 spec = decode_mode_spec (it->w, c, field, &string);
20063 multibyte = STRINGP (string) && STRING_MULTIBYTE (string);
20065 switch (mode_line_target)
20067 case MODE_LINE_NOPROP:
20068 case MODE_LINE_TITLE:
20069 n += store_mode_line_noprop (spec, field, prec);
20070 break;
20071 case MODE_LINE_STRING:
20073 Lisp_Object tem = build_string (spec);
20074 props = Ftext_properties_at (make_number (charpos), elt);
20075 /* Should only keep face property in props */
20076 n += store_mode_line_string (NULL, tem, 0, field, prec, props);
20078 break;
20079 case MODE_LINE_DISPLAY:
20081 int nglyphs_before, nwritten;
20083 nglyphs_before = it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
20084 nwritten = display_string (spec, string, elt,
20085 charpos, 0, it,
20086 field, prec, 0,
20087 multibyte);
20089 /* Assign to the glyphs written above the
20090 string where the `%x' came from, position
20091 of the `%'. */
20092 if (nwritten > 0)
20094 struct glyph *glyph
20095 = (it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
20096 + nglyphs_before);
20097 int i;
20099 for (i = 0; i < nwritten; ++i)
20101 glyph[i].object = elt;
20102 glyph[i].charpos = charpos;
20105 n += nwritten;
20108 break;
20111 else /* c == 0 */
20112 break;
20116 break;
20118 case Lisp_Symbol:
20119 /* A symbol: process the value of the symbol recursively
20120 as if it appeared here directly. Avoid error if symbol void.
20121 Special case: if value of symbol is a string, output the string
20122 literally. */
20124 register Lisp_Object tem;
20126 /* If the variable is not marked as risky to set
20127 then its contents are risky to use. */
20128 if (NILP (Fget (elt, Qrisky_local_variable)))
20129 risky = 1;
20131 tem = Fboundp (elt);
20132 if (!NILP (tem))
20134 tem = Fsymbol_value (elt);
20135 /* If value is a string, output that string literally:
20136 don't check for % within it. */
20137 if (STRINGP (tem))
20138 literal = 1;
20140 if (!EQ (tem, elt))
20142 /* Give up right away for nil or t. */
20143 elt = tem;
20144 goto tail_recurse;
20148 break;
20150 case Lisp_Cons:
20152 register Lisp_Object car, tem;
20154 /* A cons cell: five distinct cases.
20155 If first element is :eval or :propertize, do something special.
20156 If first element is a string or a cons, process all the elements
20157 and effectively concatenate them.
20158 If first element is a negative number, truncate displaying cdr to
20159 at most that many characters. If positive, pad (with spaces)
20160 to at least that many characters.
20161 If first element is a symbol, process the cadr or caddr recursively
20162 according to whether the symbol's value is non-nil or nil. */
20163 car = XCAR (elt);
20164 if (EQ (car, QCeval))
20166 /* An element of the form (:eval FORM) means evaluate FORM
20167 and use the result as mode line elements. */
20169 if (risky)
20170 break;
20172 if (CONSP (XCDR (elt)))
20174 Lisp_Object spec;
20175 spec = safe_eval (XCAR (XCDR (elt)));
20176 n += display_mode_element (it, depth, field_width - n,
20177 precision - n, spec, props,
20178 risky);
20181 else if (EQ (car, QCpropertize))
20183 /* An element of the form (:propertize ELT PROPS...)
20184 means display ELT but applying properties PROPS. */
20186 if (risky)
20187 break;
20189 if (CONSP (XCDR (elt)))
20190 n += display_mode_element (it, depth, field_width - n,
20191 precision - n, XCAR (XCDR (elt)),
20192 XCDR (XCDR (elt)), risky);
20194 else if (SYMBOLP (car))
20196 tem = Fboundp (car);
20197 elt = XCDR (elt);
20198 if (!CONSP (elt))
20199 goto invalid;
20200 /* elt is now the cdr, and we know it is a cons cell.
20201 Use its car if CAR has a non-nil value. */
20202 if (!NILP (tem))
20204 tem = Fsymbol_value (car);
20205 if (!NILP (tem))
20207 elt = XCAR (elt);
20208 goto tail_recurse;
20211 /* Symbol's value is nil (or symbol is unbound)
20212 Get the cddr of the original list
20213 and if possible find the caddr and use that. */
20214 elt = XCDR (elt);
20215 if (NILP (elt))
20216 break;
20217 else if (!CONSP (elt))
20218 goto invalid;
20219 elt = XCAR (elt);
20220 goto tail_recurse;
20222 else if (INTEGERP (car))
20224 register int lim = XINT (car);
20225 elt = XCDR (elt);
20226 if (lim < 0)
20228 /* Negative int means reduce maximum width. */
20229 if (precision <= 0)
20230 precision = -lim;
20231 else
20232 precision = min (precision, -lim);
20234 else if (lim > 0)
20236 /* Padding specified. Don't let it be more than
20237 current maximum. */
20238 if (precision > 0)
20239 lim = min (precision, lim);
20241 /* If that's more padding than already wanted, queue it.
20242 But don't reduce padding already specified even if
20243 that is beyond the current truncation point. */
20244 field_width = max (lim, field_width);
20246 goto tail_recurse;
20248 else if (STRINGP (car) || CONSP (car))
20250 Lisp_Object halftail = elt;
20251 int len = 0;
20253 while (CONSP (elt)
20254 && (precision <= 0 || n < precision))
20256 n += display_mode_element (it, depth,
20257 /* Do padding only after the last
20258 element in the list. */
20259 (! CONSP (XCDR (elt))
20260 ? field_width - n
20261 : 0),
20262 precision - n, XCAR (elt),
20263 props, risky);
20264 elt = XCDR (elt);
20265 len++;
20266 if ((len & 1) == 0)
20267 halftail = XCDR (halftail);
20268 /* Check for cycle. */
20269 if (EQ (halftail, elt))
20270 break;
20274 break;
20276 default:
20277 invalid:
20278 elt = build_string ("*invalid*");
20279 goto tail_recurse;
20282 /* Pad to FIELD_WIDTH. */
20283 if (field_width > 0 && n < field_width)
20285 switch (mode_line_target)
20287 case MODE_LINE_NOPROP:
20288 case MODE_LINE_TITLE:
20289 n += store_mode_line_noprop ("", field_width - n, 0);
20290 break;
20291 case MODE_LINE_STRING:
20292 n += store_mode_line_string ("", Qnil, 0, field_width - n, 0, Qnil);
20293 break;
20294 case MODE_LINE_DISPLAY:
20295 n += display_string ("", Qnil, Qnil, 0, 0, it, field_width - n,
20296 0, 0, 0);
20297 break;
20301 return n;
20304 /* Store a mode-line string element in mode_line_string_list.
20306 If STRING is non-null, display that C string. Otherwise, the Lisp
20307 string LISP_STRING is displayed.
20309 FIELD_WIDTH is the minimum number of output glyphs to produce.
20310 If STRING has fewer characters than FIELD_WIDTH, pad to the right
20311 with spaces. FIELD_WIDTH <= 0 means don't pad.
20313 PRECISION is the maximum number of characters to output from
20314 STRING. PRECISION <= 0 means don't truncate the string.
20316 If COPY_STRING is non-zero, make a copy of LISP_STRING before adding
20317 properties to the string.
20319 PROPS are the properties to add to the string.
20320 The mode_line_string_face face property is always added to the string.
20323 static int
20324 store_mode_line_string (const char *string, Lisp_Object lisp_string, int copy_string,
20325 int field_width, int precision, Lisp_Object props)
20327 EMACS_INT len;
20328 int n = 0;
20330 if (string != NULL)
20332 len = strlen (string);
20333 if (precision > 0 && len > precision)
20334 len = precision;
20335 lisp_string = make_string (string, len);
20336 if (NILP (props))
20337 props = mode_line_string_face_prop;
20338 else if (!NILP (mode_line_string_face))
20340 Lisp_Object face = Fplist_get (props, Qface);
20341 props = Fcopy_sequence (props);
20342 if (NILP (face))
20343 face = mode_line_string_face;
20344 else
20345 face = Fcons (face, Fcons (mode_line_string_face, Qnil));
20346 props = Fplist_put (props, Qface, face);
20348 Fadd_text_properties (make_number (0), make_number (len),
20349 props, lisp_string);
20351 else
20353 len = XFASTINT (Flength (lisp_string));
20354 if (precision > 0 && len > precision)
20356 len = precision;
20357 lisp_string = Fsubstring (lisp_string, make_number (0), make_number (len));
20358 precision = -1;
20360 if (!NILP (mode_line_string_face))
20362 Lisp_Object face;
20363 if (NILP (props))
20364 props = Ftext_properties_at (make_number (0), lisp_string);
20365 face = Fplist_get (props, Qface);
20366 if (NILP (face))
20367 face = mode_line_string_face;
20368 else
20369 face = Fcons (face, Fcons (mode_line_string_face, Qnil));
20370 props = Fcons (Qface, Fcons (face, Qnil));
20371 if (copy_string)
20372 lisp_string = Fcopy_sequence (lisp_string);
20374 if (!NILP (props))
20375 Fadd_text_properties (make_number (0), make_number (len),
20376 props, lisp_string);
20379 if (len > 0)
20381 mode_line_string_list = Fcons (lisp_string, mode_line_string_list);
20382 n += len;
20385 if (field_width > len)
20387 field_width -= len;
20388 lisp_string = Fmake_string (make_number (field_width), make_number (' '));
20389 if (!NILP (props))
20390 Fadd_text_properties (make_number (0), make_number (field_width),
20391 props, lisp_string);
20392 mode_line_string_list = Fcons (lisp_string, mode_line_string_list);
20393 n += field_width;
20396 return n;
20400 DEFUN ("format-mode-line", Fformat_mode_line, Sformat_mode_line,
20401 1, 4, 0,
20402 doc: /* Format a string out of a mode line format specification.
20403 First arg FORMAT specifies the mode line format (see `mode-line-format'
20404 for details) to use.
20406 By default, the format is evaluated for the currently selected window.
20408 Optional second arg FACE specifies the face property to put on all
20409 characters for which no face is specified. The value nil means the
20410 default face. The value t means whatever face the window's mode line
20411 currently uses (either `mode-line' or `mode-line-inactive',
20412 depending on whether the window is the selected window or not).
20413 An integer value means the value string has no text
20414 properties.
20416 Optional third and fourth args WINDOW and BUFFER specify the window
20417 and buffer to use as the context for the formatting (defaults
20418 are the selected window and the WINDOW's buffer). */)
20419 (Lisp_Object format, Lisp_Object face,
20420 Lisp_Object window, Lisp_Object buffer)
20422 struct it it;
20423 int len;
20424 struct window *w;
20425 struct buffer *old_buffer = NULL;
20426 int face_id;
20427 int no_props = INTEGERP (face);
20428 int count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
20429 Lisp_Object str;
20430 int string_start = 0;
20432 if (NILP (window))
20433 window = selected_window;
20434 CHECK_WINDOW (window);
20435 w = XWINDOW (window);
20437 if (NILP (buffer))
20438 buffer = w->buffer;
20439 CHECK_BUFFER (buffer);
20441 /* Make formatting the modeline a non-op when noninteractive, otherwise
20442 there will be problems later caused by a partially initialized frame. */
20443 if (NILP (format) || noninteractive)
20444 return empty_unibyte_string;
20446 if (no_props)
20447 face = Qnil;
20449 face_id = (NILP (face) || EQ (face, Qdefault)) ? DEFAULT_FACE_ID
20450 : EQ (face, Qt) ? (EQ (window, selected_window)
20451 ? MODE_LINE_FACE_ID : MODE_LINE_INACTIVE_FACE_ID)
20452 : EQ (face, Qmode_line) ? MODE_LINE_FACE_ID
20453 : EQ (face, Qmode_line_inactive) ? MODE_LINE_INACTIVE_FACE_ID
20454 : EQ (face, Qheader_line) ? HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID
20455 : EQ (face, Qtool_bar) ? TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID
20456 : DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
20458 if (XBUFFER (buffer) != current_buffer)
20459 old_buffer = current_buffer;
20461 /* Save things including mode_line_proptrans_alist,
20462 and set that to nil so that we don't alter the outer value. */
20463 record_unwind_protect (unwind_format_mode_line,
20464 format_mode_line_unwind_data
20465 (old_buffer, selected_window, 1));
20466 mode_line_proptrans_alist = Qnil;
20468 Fselect_window (window, Qt);
20469 if (old_buffer)
20470 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (buffer));
20472 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, NULL, face_id);
20474 if (no_props)
20476 mode_line_target = MODE_LINE_NOPROP;
20477 mode_line_string_face_prop = Qnil;
20478 mode_line_string_list = Qnil;
20479 string_start = MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN (0);
20481 else
20483 mode_line_target = MODE_LINE_STRING;
20484 mode_line_string_list = Qnil;
20485 mode_line_string_face = face;
20486 mode_line_string_face_prop
20487 = (NILP (face) ? Qnil : Fcons (Qface, Fcons (face, Qnil)));
20490 push_kboard (FRAME_KBOARD (it.f));
20491 display_mode_element (&it, 0, 0, 0, format, Qnil, 0);
20492 pop_kboard ();
20494 if (no_props)
20496 len = MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN (string_start);
20497 str = make_string (mode_line_noprop_buf + string_start, len);
20499 else
20501 mode_line_string_list = Fnreverse (mode_line_string_list);
20502 str = Fmapconcat (intern ("identity"), mode_line_string_list,
20503 empty_unibyte_string);
20506 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
20507 return str;
20510 /* Write a null-terminated, right justified decimal representation of
20511 the positive integer D to BUF using a minimal field width WIDTH. */
20513 static void
20514 pint2str (register char *buf, register int width, register EMACS_INT d)
20516 register char *p = buf;
20518 if (d <= 0)
20519 *p++ = '0';
20520 else
20522 while (d > 0)
20524 *p++ = d % 10 + '0';
20525 d /= 10;
20529 for (width -= (int) (p - buf); width > 0; --width)
20530 *p++ = ' ';
20531 *p-- = '\0';
20532 while (p > buf)
20534 d = *buf;
20535 *buf++ = *p;
20536 *p-- = d;
20540 /* Write a null-terminated, right justified decimal and "human
20541 readable" representation of the nonnegative integer D to BUF using
20542 a minimal field width WIDTH. D should be smaller than 999.5e24. */
20544 static const char power_letter[] =
20546 0, /* no letter */
20547 'k', /* kilo */
20548 'M', /* mega */
20549 'G', /* giga */
20550 'T', /* tera */
20551 'P', /* peta */
20552 'E', /* exa */
20553 'Z', /* zetta */
20554 'Y' /* yotta */
20557 static void
20558 pint2hrstr (char *buf, int width, EMACS_INT d)
20560 /* We aim to represent the nonnegative integer D as
20561 QUOTIENT.TENTHS * 10 ^ (3 * EXPONENT). */
20562 EMACS_INT quotient = d;
20563 int remainder = 0;
20564 /* -1 means: do not use TENTHS. */
20565 int tenths = -1;
20566 int exponent = 0;
20568 /* Length of QUOTIENT.TENTHS as a string. */
20569 int length;
20571 char * psuffix;
20572 char * p;
20574 if (1000 <= quotient)
20576 /* Scale to the appropriate EXPONENT. */
20579 remainder = quotient % 1000;
20580 quotient /= 1000;
20581 exponent++;
20583 while (1000 <= quotient);
20585 /* Round to nearest and decide whether to use TENTHS or not. */
20586 if (quotient <= 9)
20588 tenths = remainder / 100;
20589 if (50 <= remainder % 100)
20591 if (tenths < 9)
20592 tenths++;
20593 else
20595 quotient++;
20596 if (quotient == 10)
20597 tenths = -1;
20598 else
20599 tenths = 0;
20603 else
20604 if (500 <= remainder)
20606 if (quotient < 999)
20607 quotient++;
20608 else
20610 quotient = 1;
20611 exponent++;
20612 tenths = 0;
20617 /* Calculate the LENGTH of QUOTIENT.TENTHS as a string. */
20618 if (tenths == -1 && quotient <= 99)
20619 if (quotient <= 9)
20620 length = 1;
20621 else
20622 length = 2;
20623 else
20624 length = 3;
20625 p = psuffix = buf + max (width, length);
20627 /* Print EXPONENT. */
20628 *psuffix++ = power_letter[exponent];
20629 *psuffix = '\0';
20631 /* Print TENTHS. */
20632 if (tenths >= 0)
20634 *--p = '0' + tenths;
20635 *--p = '.';
20638 /* Print QUOTIENT. */
20641 int digit = quotient % 10;
20642 *--p = '0' + digit;
20644 while ((quotient /= 10) != 0);
20646 /* Print leading spaces. */
20647 while (buf < p)
20648 *--p = ' ';
20651 /* Set a mnemonic character for coding_system (Lisp symbol) in BUF.
20652 If EOL_FLAG is 1, set also a mnemonic character for end-of-line
20653 type of CODING_SYSTEM. Return updated pointer into BUF. */
20655 static unsigned char invalid_eol_type[] = "(*invalid*)";
20657 static char *
20658 decode_mode_spec_coding (Lisp_Object coding_system, register char *buf, int eol_flag)
20660 Lisp_Object val;
20661 int multibyte = !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters));
20662 const unsigned char *eol_str;
20663 int eol_str_len;
20664 /* The EOL conversion we are using. */
20665 Lisp_Object eoltype;
20667 val = CODING_SYSTEM_SPEC (coding_system);
20668 eoltype = Qnil;
20670 if (!VECTORP (val)) /* Not yet decided. */
20672 if (multibyte)
20673 *buf++ = '-';
20674 if (eol_flag)
20675 eoltype = eol_mnemonic_undecided;
20676 /* Don't mention EOL conversion if it isn't decided. */
20678 else
20680 Lisp_Object attrs;
20681 Lisp_Object eolvalue;
20683 attrs = AREF (val, 0);
20684 eolvalue = AREF (val, 2);
20686 if (multibyte)
20687 *buf++ = XFASTINT (CODING_ATTR_MNEMONIC (attrs));
20689 if (eol_flag)
20691 /* The EOL conversion that is normal on this system. */
20693 if (NILP (eolvalue)) /* Not yet decided. */
20694 eoltype = eol_mnemonic_undecided;
20695 else if (VECTORP (eolvalue)) /* Not yet decided. */
20696 eoltype = eol_mnemonic_undecided;
20697 else /* eolvalue is Qunix, Qdos, or Qmac. */
20698 eoltype = (EQ (eolvalue, Qunix)
20699 ? eol_mnemonic_unix
20700 : (EQ (eolvalue, Qdos) == 1
20701 ? eol_mnemonic_dos : eol_mnemonic_mac));
20705 if (eol_flag)
20707 /* Mention the EOL conversion if it is not the usual one. */
20708 if (STRINGP (eoltype))
20710 eol_str = SDATA (eoltype);
20711 eol_str_len = SBYTES (eoltype);
20713 else if (CHARACTERP (eoltype))
20715 unsigned char *tmp = (unsigned char *) alloca (MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH);
20716 int c = XFASTINT (eoltype);
20717 eol_str_len = CHAR_STRING (c, tmp);
20718 eol_str = tmp;
20720 else
20722 eol_str = invalid_eol_type;
20723 eol_str_len = sizeof (invalid_eol_type) - 1;
20725 memcpy (buf, eol_str, eol_str_len);
20726 buf += eol_str_len;
20729 return buf;
20732 /* Return a string for the output of a mode line %-spec for window W,
20733 generated by character C. FIELD_WIDTH > 0 means pad the string
20734 returned with spaces to that value. Return a Lisp string in
20735 *STRING if the resulting string is taken from that Lisp string.
20737 Note we operate on the current buffer for most purposes,
20738 the exception being w->base_line_pos. */
20740 static char lots_of_dashes[] = "--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------";
20742 static const char *
20743 decode_mode_spec (struct window *w, register int c, int field_width,
20744 Lisp_Object *string)
20746 Lisp_Object obj;
20747 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
20748 char *decode_mode_spec_buf = f->decode_mode_spec_buffer;
20749 struct buffer *b = current_buffer;
20751 obj = Qnil;
20752 *string = Qnil;
20754 switch (c)
20756 case '*':
20757 if (!NILP (BVAR (b, read_only)))
20758 return "%";
20759 if (BUF_MODIFF (b) > BUF_SAVE_MODIFF (b))
20760 return "*";
20761 return "-";
20763 case '+':
20764 /* This differs from %* only for a modified read-only buffer. */
20765 if (BUF_MODIFF (b) > BUF_SAVE_MODIFF (b))
20766 return "*";
20767 if (!NILP (BVAR (b, read_only)))
20768 return "%";
20769 return "-";
20771 case '&':
20772 /* This differs from %* in ignoring read-only-ness. */
20773 if (BUF_MODIFF (b) > BUF_SAVE_MODIFF (b))
20774 return "*";
20775 return "-";
20777 case '%':
20778 return "%";
20780 case '[':
20782 int i;
20783 char *p;
20785 if (command_loop_level > 5)
20786 return "[[[... ";
20787 p = decode_mode_spec_buf;
20788 for (i = 0; i < command_loop_level; i++)
20789 *p++ = '[';
20790 *p = 0;
20791 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
20794 case ']':
20796 int i;
20797 char *p;
20799 if (command_loop_level > 5)
20800 return " ...]]]";
20801 p = decode_mode_spec_buf;
20802 for (i = 0; i < command_loop_level; i++)
20803 *p++ = ']';
20804 *p = 0;
20805 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
20808 case '-':
20810 register int i;
20812 /* Let lots_of_dashes be a string of infinite length. */
20813 if (mode_line_target == MODE_LINE_NOPROP ||
20814 mode_line_target == MODE_LINE_STRING)
20815 return "--";
20816 if (field_width <= 0
20817 || field_width > sizeof (lots_of_dashes))
20819 for (i = 0; i < FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF_SIZE (f) - 1; ++i)
20820 decode_mode_spec_buf[i] = '-';
20821 decode_mode_spec_buf[i] = '\0';
20822 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
20824 else
20825 return lots_of_dashes;
20828 case 'b':
20829 obj = BVAR (b, name);
20830 break;
20832 case 'c':
20833 /* %c and %l are ignored in `frame-title-format'.
20834 (In redisplay_internal, the frame title is drawn _before_ the
20835 windows are updated, so the stuff which depends on actual
20836 window contents (such as %l) may fail to render properly, or
20837 even crash emacs.) */
20838 if (mode_line_target == MODE_LINE_TITLE)
20839 return "";
20840 else
20842 EMACS_INT col = current_column ();
20843 w->column_number_displayed = make_number (col);
20844 pint2str (decode_mode_spec_buf, field_width, col);
20845 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
20848 case 'e':
20849 #ifndef SYSTEM_MALLOC
20851 if (NILP (Vmemory_full))
20852 return "";
20853 else
20854 return "!MEM FULL! ";
20856 #else
20857 return "";
20858 #endif
20860 case 'F':
20861 /* %F displays the frame name. */
20862 if (!NILP (f->title))
20863 return SSDATA (f->title);
20864 if (f->explicit_name || ! FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
20865 return SSDATA (f->name);
20866 return "Emacs";
20868 case 'f':
20869 obj = BVAR (b, filename);
20870 break;
20872 case 'i':
20874 EMACS_INT size = ZV - BEGV;
20875 pint2str (decode_mode_spec_buf, field_width, size);
20876 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
20879 case 'I':
20881 EMACS_INT size = ZV - BEGV;
20882 pint2hrstr (decode_mode_spec_buf, field_width, size);
20883 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
20886 case 'l':
20888 EMACS_INT startpos, startpos_byte, line, linepos, linepos_byte;
20889 EMACS_INT topline, nlines, height;
20890 EMACS_INT junk;
20892 /* %c and %l are ignored in `frame-title-format'. */
20893 if (mode_line_target == MODE_LINE_TITLE)
20894 return "";
20896 startpos = XMARKER (w->start)->charpos;
20897 startpos_byte = marker_byte_position (w->start);
20898 height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
20900 /* If we decided that this buffer isn't suitable for line numbers,
20901 don't forget that too fast. */
20902 if (EQ (w->base_line_pos, w->buffer))
20903 goto no_value;
20904 /* But do forget it, if the window shows a different buffer now. */
20905 else if (BUFFERP (w->base_line_pos))
20906 w->base_line_pos = Qnil;
20908 /* If the buffer is very big, don't waste time. */
20909 if (INTEGERP (Vline_number_display_limit)
20910 && BUF_ZV (b) - BUF_BEGV (b) > XINT (Vline_number_display_limit))
20912 w->base_line_pos = Qnil;
20913 w->base_line_number = Qnil;
20914 goto no_value;
20917 if (INTEGERP (w->base_line_number)
20918 && INTEGERP (w->base_line_pos)
20919 && XFASTINT (w->base_line_pos) <= startpos)
20921 line = XFASTINT (w->base_line_number);
20922 linepos = XFASTINT (w->base_line_pos);
20923 linepos_byte = buf_charpos_to_bytepos (b, linepos);
20925 else
20927 line = 1;
20928 linepos = BUF_BEGV (b);
20929 linepos_byte = BUF_BEGV_BYTE (b);
20932 /* Count lines from base line to window start position. */
20933 nlines = display_count_lines (linepos_byte,
20934 startpos_byte,
20935 startpos, &junk);
20937 topline = nlines + line;
20939 /* Determine a new base line, if the old one is too close
20940 or too far away, or if we did not have one.
20941 "Too close" means it's plausible a scroll-down would
20942 go back past it. */
20943 if (startpos == BUF_BEGV (b))
20945 w->base_line_number = make_number (topline);
20946 w->base_line_pos = make_number (BUF_BEGV (b));
20948 else if (nlines < height + 25 || nlines > height * 3 + 50
20949 || linepos == BUF_BEGV (b))
20951 EMACS_INT limit = BUF_BEGV (b);
20952 EMACS_INT limit_byte = BUF_BEGV_BYTE (b);
20953 EMACS_INT position;
20954 EMACS_INT distance =
20955 (height * 2 + 30) * line_number_display_limit_width;
20957 if (startpos - distance > limit)
20959 limit = startpos - distance;
20960 limit_byte = CHAR_TO_BYTE (limit);
20963 nlines = display_count_lines (startpos_byte,
20964 limit_byte,
20965 - (height * 2 + 30),
20966 &position);
20967 /* If we couldn't find the lines we wanted within
20968 line_number_display_limit_width chars per line,
20969 give up on line numbers for this window. */
20970 if (position == limit_byte && limit == startpos - distance)
20972 w->base_line_pos = w->buffer;
20973 w->base_line_number = Qnil;
20974 goto no_value;
20977 w->base_line_number = make_number (topline - nlines);
20978 w->base_line_pos = make_number (BYTE_TO_CHAR (position));
20981 /* Now count lines from the start pos to point. */
20982 nlines = display_count_lines (startpos_byte,
20983 PT_BYTE, PT, &junk);
20985 /* Record that we did display the line number. */
20986 line_number_displayed = 1;
20988 /* Make the string to show. */
20989 pint2str (decode_mode_spec_buf, field_width, topline + nlines);
20990 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
20991 no_value:
20993 char* p = decode_mode_spec_buf;
20994 int pad = field_width - 2;
20995 while (pad-- > 0)
20996 *p++ = ' ';
20997 *p++ = '?';
20998 *p++ = '?';
20999 *p = '\0';
21000 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21003 break;
21005 case 'm':
21006 obj = BVAR (b, mode_name);
21007 break;
21009 case 'n':
21010 if (BUF_BEGV (b) > BUF_BEG (b) || BUF_ZV (b) < BUF_Z (b))
21011 return " Narrow";
21012 break;
21014 case 'p':
21016 EMACS_INT pos = marker_position (w->start);
21017 EMACS_INT total = BUF_ZV (b) - BUF_BEGV (b);
21019 if (XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos) <= BUF_Z (b) - BUF_ZV (b))
21021 if (pos <= BUF_BEGV (b))
21022 return "All";
21023 else
21024 return "Bottom";
21026 else if (pos <= BUF_BEGV (b))
21027 return "Top";
21028 else
21030 if (total > 1000000)
21031 /* Do it differently for a large value, to avoid overflow. */
21032 total = ((pos - BUF_BEGV (b)) + (total / 100) - 1) / (total / 100);
21033 else
21034 total = ((pos - BUF_BEGV (b)) * 100 + total - 1) / total;
21035 /* We can't normally display a 3-digit number,
21036 so get us a 2-digit number that is close. */
21037 if (total == 100)
21038 total = 99;
21039 sprintf (decode_mode_spec_buf, "%2"pI"d%%", total);
21040 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21044 /* Display percentage of size above the bottom of the screen. */
21045 case 'P':
21047 EMACS_INT toppos = marker_position (w->start);
21048 EMACS_INT botpos = BUF_Z (b) - XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos);
21049 EMACS_INT total = BUF_ZV (b) - BUF_BEGV (b);
21051 if (botpos >= BUF_ZV (b))
21053 if (toppos <= BUF_BEGV (b))
21054 return "All";
21055 else
21056 return "Bottom";
21058 else
21060 if (total > 1000000)
21061 /* Do it differently for a large value, to avoid overflow. */
21062 total = ((botpos - BUF_BEGV (b)) + (total / 100) - 1) / (total / 100);
21063 else
21064 total = ((botpos - BUF_BEGV (b)) * 100 + total - 1) / total;
21065 /* We can't normally display a 3-digit number,
21066 so get us a 2-digit number that is close. */
21067 if (total == 100)
21068 total = 99;
21069 if (toppos <= BUF_BEGV (b))
21070 sprintf (decode_mode_spec_buf, "Top%2"pI"d%%", total);
21071 else
21072 sprintf (decode_mode_spec_buf, "%2"pI"d%%", total);
21073 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21077 case 's':
21078 /* status of process */
21079 obj = Fget_buffer_process (Fcurrent_buffer ());
21080 if (NILP (obj))
21081 return "no process";
21082 #ifndef MSDOS
21083 obj = Fsymbol_name (Fprocess_status (obj));
21084 #endif
21085 break;
21087 case '@':
21089 int count = inhibit_garbage_collection ();
21090 Lisp_Object val = call1 (intern ("file-remote-p"),
21091 BVAR (current_buffer, directory));
21092 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
21094 if (NILP (val))
21095 return "-";
21096 else
21097 return "@";
21100 case 't': /* indicate TEXT or BINARY */
21101 return "T";
21103 case 'z':
21104 /* coding-system (not including end-of-line format) */
21105 case 'Z':
21106 /* coding-system (including end-of-line type) */
21108 int eol_flag = (c == 'Z');
21109 char *p = decode_mode_spec_buf;
21111 if (! FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
21113 /* No need to mention EOL here--the terminal never needs
21114 to do EOL conversion. */
21115 p = decode_mode_spec_coding (CODING_ID_NAME
21116 (FRAME_KEYBOARD_CODING (f)->id),
21117 p, 0);
21118 p = decode_mode_spec_coding (CODING_ID_NAME
21119 (FRAME_TERMINAL_CODING (f)->id),
21120 p, 0);
21122 p = decode_mode_spec_coding (BVAR (b, buffer_file_coding_system),
21123 p, eol_flag);
21125 #if 0 /* This proves to be annoying; I think we can do without. -- rms. */
21126 #ifdef subprocesses
21127 obj = Fget_buffer_process (Fcurrent_buffer ());
21128 if (PROCESSP (obj))
21130 p = decode_mode_spec_coding (XPROCESS (obj)->decode_coding_system,
21131 p, eol_flag);
21132 p = decode_mode_spec_coding (XPROCESS (obj)->encode_coding_system,
21133 p, eol_flag);
21135 #endif /* subprocesses */
21136 #endif /* 0 */
21137 *p = 0;
21138 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21142 if (STRINGP (obj))
21144 *string = obj;
21145 return SSDATA (obj);
21147 else
21148 return "";
21152 /* Count up to COUNT lines starting from START_BYTE.
21153 But don't go beyond LIMIT_BYTE.
21154 Return the number of lines thus found (always nonnegative).
21156 Set *BYTE_POS_PTR to 1 if we found COUNT lines, 0 if we hit LIMIT. */
21158 static EMACS_INT
21159 display_count_lines (EMACS_INT start_byte,
21160 EMACS_INT limit_byte, EMACS_INT count,
21161 EMACS_INT *byte_pos_ptr)
21163 register unsigned char *cursor;
21164 unsigned char *base;
21166 register EMACS_INT ceiling;
21167 register unsigned char *ceiling_addr;
21168 EMACS_INT orig_count = count;
21170 /* If we are not in selective display mode,
21171 check only for newlines. */
21172 int selective_display = (!NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display))
21173 && !INTEGERP (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display)));
21175 if (count > 0)
21177 while (start_byte < limit_byte)
21179 ceiling = BUFFER_CEILING_OF (start_byte);
21180 ceiling = min (limit_byte - 1, ceiling);
21181 ceiling_addr = BYTE_POS_ADDR (ceiling) + 1;
21182 base = (cursor = BYTE_POS_ADDR (start_byte));
21183 while (1)
21185 if (selective_display)
21186 while (*cursor != '\n' && *cursor != 015 && ++cursor != ceiling_addr)
21188 else
21189 while (*cursor != '\n' && ++cursor != ceiling_addr)
21192 if (cursor != ceiling_addr)
21194 if (--count == 0)
21196 start_byte += cursor - base + 1;
21197 *byte_pos_ptr = start_byte;
21198 return orig_count;
21200 else
21201 if (++cursor == ceiling_addr)
21202 break;
21204 else
21205 break;
21207 start_byte += cursor - base;
21210 else
21212 while (start_byte > limit_byte)
21214 ceiling = BUFFER_FLOOR_OF (start_byte - 1);
21215 ceiling = max (limit_byte, ceiling);
21216 ceiling_addr = BYTE_POS_ADDR (ceiling) - 1;
21217 base = (cursor = BYTE_POS_ADDR (start_byte - 1) + 1);
21218 while (1)
21220 if (selective_display)
21221 while (--cursor != ceiling_addr
21222 && *cursor != '\n' && *cursor != 015)
21224 else
21225 while (--cursor != ceiling_addr && *cursor != '\n')
21228 if (cursor != ceiling_addr)
21230 if (++count == 0)
21232 start_byte += cursor - base + 1;
21233 *byte_pos_ptr = start_byte;
21234 /* When scanning backwards, we should
21235 not count the newline posterior to which we stop. */
21236 return - orig_count - 1;
21239 else
21240 break;
21242 /* Here we add 1 to compensate for the last decrement
21243 of CURSOR, which took it past the valid range. */
21244 start_byte += cursor - base + 1;
21248 *byte_pos_ptr = limit_byte;
21250 if (count < 0)
21251 return - orig_count + count;
21252 return orig_count - count;
21258 /***********************************************************************
21259 Displaying strings
21260 ***********************************************************************/
21262 /* Display a NUL-terminated string, starting with index START.
21264 If STRING is non-null, display that C string. Otherwise, the Lisp
21265 string LISP_STRING is displayed. There's a case that STRING is
21266 non-null and LISP_STRING is not nil. It means STRING is a string
21267 data of LISP_STRING. In that case, we display LISP_STRING while
21268 ignoring its text properties.
21270 If FACE_STRING is not nil, FACE_STRING_POS is a position in
21271 FACE_STRING. Display STRING or LISP_STRING with the face at
21272 FACE_STRING_POS in FACE_STRING:
21274 Display the string in the environment given by IT, but use the
21275 standard display table, temporarily.
21277 FIELD_WIDTH is the minimum number of output glyphs to produce.
21278 If STRING has fewer characters than FIELD_WIDTH, pad to the right
21279 with spaces. If STRING has more characters, more than FIELD_WIDTH
21280 glyphs will be produced. FIELD_WIDTH <= 0 means don't pad.
21282 PRECISION is the maximum number of characters to output from
21283 STRING. PRECISION < 0 means don't truncate the string.
21285 This is roughly equivalent to printf format specifiers:
21287 FIELD_WIDTH PRECISION PRINTF
21288 ----------------------------------------
21289 -1 -1 %s
21290 -1 10 %.10s
21291 10 -1 %10s
21292 20 10 %20.10s
21294 MULTIBYTE zero means do not display multibyte chars, > 0 means do
21295 display them, and < 0 means obey the current buffer's value of
21296 enable_multibyte_characters.
21298 Value is the number of columns displayed. */
21300 static int
21301 display_string (const char *string, Lisp_Object lisp_string, Lisp_Object face_string,
21302 EMACS_INT face_string_pos, EMACS_INT start, struct it *it,
21303 int field_width, int precision, int max_x, int multibyte)
21305 int hpos_at_start = it->hpos;
21306 int saved_face_id = it->face_id;
21307 struct glyph_row *row = it->glyph_row;
21308 EMACS_INT it_charpos;
21310 /* Initialize the iterator IT for iteration over STRING beginning
21311 with index START. */
21312 reseat_to_string (it, NILP (lisp_string) ? string : NULL, lisp_string, start,
21313 precision, field_width, multibyte);
21314 if (string && STRINGP (lisp_string))
21315 /* LISP_STRING is the one returned by decode_mode_spec. We should
21316 ignore its text properties. */
21317 it->stop_charpos = it->end_charpos;
21319 /* If displaying STRING, set up the face of the iterator from
21320 FACE_STRING, if that's given. */
21321 if (STRINGP (face_string))
21323 EMACS_INT endptr;
21324 struct face *face;
21326 it->face_id
21327 = face_at_string_position (it->w, face_string, face_string_pos,
21328 0, it->region_beg_charpos,
21329 it->region_end_charpos,
21330 &endptr, it->base_face_id, 0);
21331 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
21332 it->face_box_p = face->box != FACE_NO_BOX;
21335 /* Set max_x to the maximum allowed X position. Don't let it go
21336 beyond the right edge of the window. */
21337 if (max_x <= 0)
21338 max_x = it->last_visible_x;
21339 else
21340 max_x = min (max_x, it->last_visible_x);
21342 /* Skip over display elements that are not visible. because IT->w is
21343 hscrolled. */
21344 if (it->current_x < it->first_visible_x)
21345 move_it_in_display_line_to (it, 100000, it->first_visible_x,
21346 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_X);
21348 row->ascent = it->max_ascent;
21349 row->height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
21350 row->phys_ascent = it->max_phys_ascent;
21351 row->phys_height = it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent;
21352 row->extra_line_spacing = it->max_extra_line_spacing;
21354 if (STRINGP (it->string))
21355 it_charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
21356 else
21357 it_charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
21359 /* This condition is for the case that we are called with current_x
21360 past last_visible_x. */
21361 while (it->current_x < max_x)
21363 int x_before, x, n_glyphs_before, i, nglyphs;
21365 /* Get the next display element. */
21366 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
21367 break;
21369 /* Produce glyphs. */
21370 x_before = it->current_x;
21371 n_glyphs_before = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
21372 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
21374 nglyphs = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - n_glyphs_before;
21375 i = 0;
21376 x = x_before;
21377 while (i < nglyphs)
21379 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + n_glyphs_before + i;
21381 if (it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE
21382 && x + glyph->pixel_width > max_x)
21384 /* End of continued line or max_x reached. */
21385 if (CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (*glyph))
21387 /* A wide character is unbreakable. */
21388 if (row->reversed_p)
21389 unproduce_glyphs (it, row->used[TEXT_AREA]
21390 - n_glyphs_before);
21391 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = n_glyphs_before;
21392 it->current_x = x_before;
21394 else
21396 if (row->reversed_p)
21397 unproduce_glyphs (it, row->used[TEXT_AREA]
21398 - (n_glyphs_before + i));
21399 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = n_glyphs_before + i;
21400 it->current_x = x;
21402 break;
21404 else if (x + glyph->pixel_width >= it->first_visible_x)
21406 /* Glyph is at least partially visible. */
21407 ++it->hpos;
21408 if (x < it->first_visible_x)
21409 row->x = x - it->first_visible_x;
21411 else
21413 /* Glyph is off the left margin of the display area.
21414 Should not happen. */
21415 abort ();
21418 row->ascent = max (row->ascent, it->max_ascent);
21419 row->height = max (row->height, it->max_ascent + it->max_descent);
21420 row->phys_ascent = max (row->phys_ascent, it->max_phys_ascent);
21421 row->phys_height = max (row->phys_height,
21422 it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent);
21423 row->extra_line_spacing = max (row->extra_line_spacing,
21424 it->max_extra_line_spacing);
21425 x += glyph->pixel_width;
21426 ++i;
21429 /* Stop if max_x reached. */
21430 if (i < nglyphs)
21431 break;
21433 /* Stop at line ends. */
21434 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
21436 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
21437 break;
21440 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
21441 if (STRINGP (it->string))
21442 it_charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
21443 else
21444 it_charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
21446 /* Stop if truncating at the right edge. */
21447 if (it->line_wrap == TRUNCATE
21448 && it->current_x >= it->last_visible_x)
21450 /* Add truncation mark, but don't do it if the line is
21451 truncated at a padding space. */
21452 if (it_charpos < it->string_nchars)
21454 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
21456 int ii, n;
21458 if (it->current_x > it->last_visible_x)
21460 if (!row->reversed_p)
21462 for (ii = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1; ii > 0; --ii)
21463 if (!CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][ii]))
21464 break;
21466 else
21468 for (ii = 0; ii < row->used[TEXT_AREA]; ii++)
21469 if (!CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][ii]))
21470 break;
21471 unproduce_glyphs (it, ii + 1);
21472 ii = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - (ii + 1);
21474 for (n = row->used[TEXT_AREA]; ii < n; ++ii)
21476 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = ii;
21477 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_TRUNCATION);
21480 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_TRUNCATION);
21482 row->truncated_on_right_p = 1;
21484 break;
21488 /* Maybe insert a truncation at the left. */
21489 if (it->first_visible_x
21490 && it_charpos > 0)
21492 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
21493 insert_left_trunc_glyphs (it);
21494 row->truncated_on_left_p = 1;
21497 it->face_id = saved_face_id;
21499 /* Value is number of columns displayed. */
21500 return it->hpos - hpos_at_start;
21505 /* This is like a combination of memq and assq. Return 1/2 if PROPVAL
21506 appears as an element of LIST or as the car of an element of LIST.
21507 If PROPVAL is a list, compare each element against LIST in that
21508 way, and return 1/2 if any element of PROPVAL is found in LIST.
21509 Otherwise return 0. This function cannot quit.
21510 The return value is 2 if the text is invisible but with an ellipsis
21511 and 1 if it's invisible and without an ellipsis. */
21514 invisible_p (register Lisp_Object propval, Lisp_Object list)
21516 register Lisp_Object tail, proptail;
21518 for (tail = list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
21520 register Lisp_Object tem;
21521 tem = XCAR (tail);
21522 if (EQ (propval, tem))
21523 return 1;
21524 if (CONSP (tem) && EQ (propval, XCAR (tem)))
21525 return NILP (XCDR (tem)) ? 1 : 2;
21528 if (CONSP (propval))
21530 for (proptail = propval; CONSP (proptail); proptail = XCDR (proptail))
21532 Lisp_Object propelt;
21533 propelt = XCAR (proptail);
21534 for (tail = list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
21536 register Lisp_Object tem;
21537 tem = XCAR (tail);
21538 if (EQ (propelt, tem))
21539 return 1;
21540 if (CONSP (tem) && EQ (propelt, XCAR (tem)))
21541 return NILP (XCDR (tem)) ? 1 : 2;
21546 return 0;
21549 DEFUN ("invisible-p", Finvisible_p, Sinvisible_p, 1, 1, 0,
21550 doc: /* Non-nil if the property makes the text invisible.
21551 POS-OR-PROP can be a marker or number, in which case it is taken to be
21552 a position in the current buffer and the value of the `invisible' property
21553 is checked; or it can be some other value, which is then presumed to be the
21554 value of the `invisible' property of the text of interest.
21555 The non-nil value returned can be t for truly invisible text or something
21556 else if the text is replaced by an ellipsis. */)
21557 (Lisp_Object pos_or_prop)
21559 Lisp_Object prop
21560 = (NATNUMP (pos_or_prop) || MARKERP (pos_or_prop)
21561 ? Fget_char_property (pos_or_prop, Qinvisible, Qnil)
21562 : pos_or_prop);
21563 int invis = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop);
21564 return (invis == 0 ? Qnil
21565 : invis == 1 ? Qt
21566 : make_number (invis));
21569 /* Calculate a width or height in pixels from a specification using
21570 the following elements:
21572 SPEC ::=
21573 NUM - a (fractional) multiple of the default font width/height
21574 (NUM) - specifies exactly NUM pixels
21575 UNIT - a fixed number of pixels, see below.
21576 ELEMENT - size of a display element in pixels, see below.
21577 (NUM . SPEC) - equals NUM * SPEC
21578 (+ SPEC SPEC ...) - add pixel values
21579 (- SPEC SPEC ...) - subtract pixel values
21580 (- SPEC) - negate pixel value
21582 NUM ::=
21583 INT or FLOAT - a number constant
21584 SYMBOL - use symbol's (buffer local) variable binding.
21586 UNIT ::=
21587 in - pixels per inch *)
21588 mm - pixels per 1/1000 meter *)
21589 cm - pixels per 1/100 meter *)
21590 width - width of current font in pixels.
21591 height - height of current font in pixels.
21593 *) using the ratio(s) defined in display-pixels-per-inch.
21595 ELEMENT ::=
21597 left-fringe - left fringe width in pixels
21598 right-fringe - right fringe width in pixels
21600 left-margin - left margin width in pixels
21601 right-margin - right margin width in pixels
21603 scroll-bar - scroll-bar area width in pixels
21605 Examples:
21607 Pixels corresponding to 5 inches:
21608 (5 . in)
21610 Total width of non-text areas on left side of window (if scroll-bar is on left):
21611 '(space :width (+ left-fringe left-margin scroll-bar))
21613 Align to first text column (in header line):
21614 '(space :align-to 0)
21616 Align to middle of text area minus half the width of variable `my-image'
21617 containing a loaded image:
21618 '(space :align-to (0.5 . (- text my-image)))
21620 Width of left margin minus width of 1 character in the default font:
21621 '(space :width (- left-margin 1))
21623 Width of left margin minus width of 2 characters in the current font:
21624 '(space :width (- left-margin (2 . width)))
21626 Center 1 character over left-margin (in header line):
21627 '(space :align-to (+ left-margin (0.5 . left-margin) -0.5))
21629 Different ways to express width of left fringe plus left margin minus one pixel:
21630 '(space :width (- (+ left-fringe left-margin) (1)))
21631 '(space :width (+ left-fringe left-margin (- (1))))
21632 '(space :width (+ left-fringe left-margin (-1)))
21636 #define NUMVAL(X) \
21637 ((INTEGERP (X) || FLOATP (X)) \
21638 ? XFLOATINT (X) \
21639 : - 1)
21641 static int
21642 calc_pixel_width_or_height (double *res, struct it *it, Lisp_Object prop,
21643 struct font *font, int width_p, int *align_to)
21645 double pixels;
21647 #define OK_PIXELS(val) ((*res = (double)(val)), 1)
21648 #define OK_ALIGN_TO(val) ((*align_to = (int)(val)), 1)
21650 if (NILP (prop))
21651 return OK_PIXELS (0);
21653 xassert (FRAME_LIVE_P (it->f));
21655 if (SYMBOLP (prop))
21657 if (SCHARS (SYMBOL_NAME (prop)) == 2)
21659 char *unit = SSDATA (SYMBOL_NAME (prop));
21661 if (unit[0] == 'i' && unit[1] == 'n')
21662 pixels = 1.0;
21663 else if (unit[0] == 'm' && unit[1] == 'm')
21664 pixels = 25.4;
21665 else if (unit[0] == 'c' && unit[1] == 'm')
21666 pixels = 2.54;
21667 else
21668 pixels = 0;
21669 if (pixels > 0)
21671 double ppi;
21672 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
21673 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
21674 && (ppi = (width_p
21675 ? FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (it->f)->resx
21676 : FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (it->f)->resy),
21677 ppi > 0))
21678 return OK_PIXELS (ppi / pixels);
21679 #endif
21681 if ((ppi = NUMVAL (Vdisplay_pixels_per_inch), ppi > 0)
21682 || (CONSP (Vdisplay_pixels_per_inch)
21683 && (ppi = (width_p
21684 ? NUMVAL (XCAR (Vdisplay_pixels_per_inch))
21685 : NUMVAL (XCDR (Vdisplay_pixels_per_inch))),
21686 ppi > 0)))
21687 return OK_PIXELS (ppi / pixels);
21689 return 0;
21693 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
21694 if (EQ (prop, Qheight))
21695 return OK_PIXELS (font ? FONT_HEIGHT (font) : FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it->f));
21696 if (EQ (prop, Qwidth))
21697 return OK_PIXELS (font ? FONT_WIDTH (font) : FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it->f));
21698 #else
21699 if (EQ (prop, Qheight) || EQ (prop, Qwidth))
21700 return OK_PIXELS (1);
21701 #endif
21703 if (EQ (prop, Qtext))
21704 return OK_PIXELS (width_p
21705 ? window_box_width (it->w, TEXT_AREA)
21706 : WINDOW_BOX_HEIGHT_NO_MODE_LINE (it->w));
21708 if (align_to && *align_to < 0)
21710 *res = 0;
21711 if (EQ (prop, Qleft))
21712 return OK_ALIGN_TO (window_box_left_offset (it->w, TEXT_AREA));
21713 if (EQ (prop, Qright))
21714 return OK_ALIGN_TO (window_box_right_offset (it->w, TEXT_AREA));
21715 if (EQ (prop, Qcenter))
21716 return OK_ALIGN_TO (window_box_left_offset (it->w, TEXT_AREA)
21717 + window_box_width (it->w, TEXT_AREA) / 2);
21718 if (EQ (prop, Qleft_fringe))
21719 return OK_ALIGN_TO (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (it->w)
21720 ? WINDOW_LEFT_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (it->w)
21721 : window_box_right_offset (it->w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA));
21722 if (EQ (prop, Qright_fringe))
21723 return OK_ALIGN_TO (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (it->w)
21724 ? window_box_right_offset (it->w, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA)
21725 : window_box_right_offset (it->w, TEXT_AREA));
21726 if (EQ (prop, Qleft_margin))
21727 return OK_ALIGN_TO (window_box_left_offset (it->w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA));
21728 if (EQ (prop, Qright_margin))
21729 return OK_ALIGN_TO (window_box_left_offset (it->w, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA));
21730 if (EQ (prop, Qscroll_bar))
21731 return OK_ALIGN_TO (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (it->w)
21733 : (window_box_right_offset (it->w, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA)
21734 + (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (it->w)
21735 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
21736 : 0)));
21738 else
21740 if (EQ (prop, Qleft_fringe))
21741 return OK_PIXELS (WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w));
21742 if (EQ (prop, Qright_fringe))
21743 return OK_PIXELS (WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w));
21744 if (EQ (prop, Qleft_margin))
21745 return OK_PIXELS (WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_WIDTH (it->w));
21746 if (EQ (prop, Qright_margin))
21747 return OK_PIXELS (WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_WIDTH (it->w));
21748 if (EQ (prop, Qscroll_bar))
21749 return OK_PIXELS (WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (it->w));
21752 prop = Fbuffer_local_value (prop, it->w->buffer);
21755 if (INTEGERP (prop) || FLOATP (prop))
21757 int base_unit = (width_p
21758 ? FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it->f)
21759 : FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it->f));
21760 return OK_PIXELS (XFLOATINT (prop) * base_unit);
21763 if (CONSP (prop))
21765 Lisp_Object car = XCAR (prop);
21766 Lisp_Object cdr = XCDR (prop);
21768 if (SYMBOLP (car))
21770 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
21771 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
21772 && valid_image_p (prop))
21774 ptrdiff_t id = lookup_image (it->f, prop);
21775 struct image *img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (it->f, id);
21777 return OK_PIXELS (width_p ? img->width : img->height);
21779 #endif
21780 if (EQ (car, Qplus) || EQ (car, Qminus))
21782 int first = 1;
21783 double px;
21785 pixels = 0;
21786 while (CONSP (cdr))
21788 if (!calc_pixel_width_or_height (&px, it, XCAR (cdr),
21789 font, width_p, align_to))
21790 return 0;
21791 if (first)
21792 pixels = (EQ (car, Qplus) ? px : -px), first = 0;
21793 else
21794 pixels += px;
21795 cdr = XCDR (cdr);
21797 if (EQ (car, Qminus))
21798 pixels = -pixels;
21799 return OK_PIXELS (pixels);
21802 car = Fbuffer_local_value (car, it->w->buffer);
21805 if (INTEGERP (car) || FLOATP (car))
21807 double fact;
21808 pixels = XFLOATINT (car);
21809 if (NILP (cdr))
21810 return OK_PIXELS (pixels);
21811 if (calc_pixel_width_or_height (&fact, it, cdr,
21812 font, width_p, align_to))
21813 return OK_PIXELS (pixels * fact);
21814 return 0;
21817 return 0;
21820 return 0;
21824 /***********************************************************************
21825 Glyph Display
21826 ***********************************************************************/
21828 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
21830 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
21832 void
21833 dump_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
21835 fprintf (stderr, "glyph string\n");
21836 fprintf (stderr, " x, y, w, h = %d, %d, %d, %d\n",
21837 s->x, s->y, s->width, s->height);
21838 fprintf (stderr, " ybase = %d\n", s->ybase);
21839 fprintf (stderr, " hl = %d\n", s->hl);
21840 fprintf (stderr, " left overhang = %d, right = %d\n",
21841 s->left_overhang, s->right_overhang);
21842 fprintf (stderr, " nchars = %d\n", s->nchars);
21843 fprintf (stderr, " extends to end of line = %d\n",
21844 s->extends_to_end_of_line_p);
21845 fprintf (stderr, " font height = %d\n", FONT_HEIGHT (s->font));
21846 fprintf (stderr, " bg width = %d\n", s->background_width);
21849 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
21851 /* Initialize glyph string S. CHAR2B is a suitably allocated vector
21852 of XChar2b structures for S; it can't be allocated in
21853 init_glyph_string because it must be allocated via `alloca'. W
21854 is the window on which S is drawn. ROW and AREA are the glyph row
21855 and area within the row from which S is constructed. START is the
21856 index of the first glyph structure covered by S. HL is a
21857 face-override for drawing S. */
21859 #ifdef HAVE_NTGUI
21860 #define OPTIONAL_HDC(hdc) HDC hdc,
21861 #define DECLARE_HDC(hdc) HDC hdc;
21862 #define ALLOCATE_HDC(hdc, f) hdc = get_frame_dc ((f))
21863 #define RELEASE_HDC(hdc, f) release_frame_dc ((f), (hdc))
21864 #endif
21866 #ifndef OPTIONAL_HDC
21867 #define OPTIONAL_HDC(hdc)
21868 #define DECLARE_HDC(hdc)
21869 #define ALLOCATE_HDC(hdc, f)
21870 #define RELEASE_HDC(hdc, f)
21871 #endif
21873 static void
21874 init_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s,
21875 OPTIONAL_HDC (hdc)
21876 XChar2b *char2b, struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row,
21877 enum glyph_row_area area, int start, enum draw_glyphs_face hl)
21879 memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
21880 s->w = w;
21881 s->f = XFRAME (w->frame);
21882 #ifdef HAVE_NTGUI
21883 s->hdc = hdc;
21884 #endif
21885 s->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (s->f);
21886 s->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (s->f);
21887 s->char2b = char2b;
21888 s->hl = hl;
21889 s->row = row;
21890 s->area = area;
21891 s->first_glyph = row->glyphs[area] + start;
21892 s->height = row->height;
21893 s->y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
21894 s->ybase = s->y + row->ascent;
21898 /* Append the list of glyph strings with head H and tail T to the list
21899 with head *HEAD and tail *TAIL. Set *HEAD and *TAIL to the result. */
21901 static inline void
21902 append_glyph_string_lists (struct glyph_string **head, struct glyph_string **tail,
21903 struct glyph_string *h, struct glyph_string *t)
21905 if (h)
21907 if (*head)
21908 (*tail)->next = h;
21909 else
21910 *head = h;
21911 h->prev = *tail;
21912 *tail = t;
21917 /* Prepend the list of glyph strings with head H and tail T to the
21918 list with head *HEAD and tail *TAIL. Set *HEAD and *TAIL to the
21919 result. */
21921 static inline void
21922 prepend_glyph_string_lists (struct glyph_string **head, struct glyph_string **tail,
21923 struct glyph_string *h, struct glyph_string *t)
21925 if (h)
21927 if (*head)
21928 (*head)->prev = t;
21929 else
21930 *tail = t;
21931 t->next = *head;
21932 *head = h;
21937 /* Append glyph string S to the list with head *HEAD and tail *TAIL.
21938 Set *HEAD and *TAIL to the resulting list. */
21940 static inline void
21941 append_glyph_string (struct glyph_string **head, struct glyph_string **tail,
21942 struct glyph_string *s)
21944 s->next = s->prev = NULL;
21945 append_glyph_string_lists (head, tail, s, s);
21949 /* Get face and two-byte form of character C in face FACE_ID on frame F.
21950 The encoding of C is returned in *CHAR2B. DISPLAY_P non-zero means
21951 make sure that X resources for the face returned are allocated.
21952 Value is a pointer to a realized face that is ready for display if
21953 DISPLAY_P is non-zero. */
21955 static inline struct face *
21956 get_char_face_and_encoding (struct frame *f, int c, int face_id,
21957 XChar2b *char2b, int display_p)
21959 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, face_id);
21961 if (face->font)
21963 unsigned code = face->font->driver->encode_char (face->font, c);
21965 if (code != FONT_INVALID_CODE)
21966 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b, (code >> 8), (code & 0xFF));
21967 else
21968 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b, 0, 0);
21971 /* Make sure X resources of the face are allocated. */
21972 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
21973 if (display_p)
21974 #endif
21976 xassert (face != NULL);
21977 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (f, face);
21980 return face;
21984 /* Get face and two-byte form of character glyph GLYPH on frame F.
21985 The encoding of GLYPH->u.ch is returned in *CHAR2B. Value is
21986 a pointer to a realized face that is ready for display. */
21988 static inline struct face *
21989 get_glyph_face_and_encoding (struct frame *f, struct glyph *glyph,
21990 XChar2b *char2b, int *two_byte_p)
21992 struct face *face;
21994 xassert (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH);
21995 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, glyph->face_id);
21997 if (two_byte_p)
21998 *two_byte_p = 0;
22000 if (face->font)
22002 unsigned code;
22004 if (CHAR_BYTE8_P (glyph->u.ch))
22005 code = CHAR_TO_BYTE8 (glyph->u.ch);
22006 else
22007 code = face->font->driver->encode_char (face->font, glyph->u.ch);
22009 if (code != FONT_INVALID_CODE)
22010 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b, (code >> 8), (code & 0xFF));
22011 else
22012 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b, 0, 0);
22015 /* Make sure X resources of the face are allocated. */
22016 xassert (face != NULL);
22017 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (f, face);
22018 return face;
22022 /* Get glyph code of character C in FONT in the two-byte form CHAR2B.
22023 Retunr 1 if FONT has a glyph for C, otherwise return 0. */
22025 static inline int
22026 get_char_glyph_code (int c, struct font *font, XChar2b *char2b)
22028 unsigned code;
22030 if (CHAR_BYTE8_P (c))
22031 code = CHAR_TO_BYTE8 (c);
22032 else
22033 code = font->driver->encode_char (font, c);
22035 if (code == FONT_INVALID_CODE)
22036 return 0;
22037 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b, (code >> 8), (code & 0xFF));
22038 return 1;
22042 /* Fill glyph string S with composition components specified by S->cmp.
22044 BASE_FACE is the base face of the composition.
22045 S->cmp_from is the index of the first component for S.
22047 OVERLAPS non-zero means S should draw the foreground only, and use
22048 its physical height for clipping. See also draw_glyphs.
22050 Value is the index of a component not in S. */
22052 static int
22053 fill_composite_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s, struct face *base_face,
22054 int overlaps)
22056 int i;
22057 /* For all glyphs of this composition, starting at the offset
22058 S->cmp_from, until we reach the end of the definition or encounter a
22059 glyph that requires the different face, add it to S. */
22060 struct face *face;
22062 xassert (s);
22064 s->for_overlaps = overlaps;
22065 s->face = NULL;
22066 s->font = NULL;
22067 for (i = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp->glyph_len; i++)
22069 int c = COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s->cmp, i);
22071 /* TAB in a composition means display glyphs with padding space
22072 on the left or right. */
22073 if (c != '\t')
22075 int face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, base_face->ascii_face, c,
22076 -1, Qnil);
22078 face = get_char_face_and_encoding (s->f, c, face_id,
22079 s->char2b + i, 1);
22080 if (face)
22082 if (! s->face)
22084 s->face = face;
22085 s->font = s->face->font;
22087 else if (s->face != face)
22088 break;
22091 ++s->nchars;
22093 s->cmp_to = i;
22095 /* All glyph strings for the same composition has the same width,
22096 i.e. the width set for the first component of the composition. */
22097 s->width = s->first_glyph->pixel_width;
22099 /* If the specified font could not be loaded, use the frame's
22100 default font, but record the fact that we couldn't load it in
22101 the glyph string so that we can draw rectangles for the
22102 characters of the glyph string. */
22103 if (s->font == NULL)
22105 s->font_not_found_p = 1;
22106 s->font = FRAME_FONT (s->f);
22109 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
22110 s->ybase += s->first_glyph->voffset;
22112 /* This glyph string must always be drawn with 16-bit functions. */
22113 s->two_byte_p = 1;
22115 return s->cmp_to;
22118 static int
22119 fill_gstring_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s, int face_id,
22120 int start, int end, int overlaps)
22122 struct glyph *glyph, *last;
22123 Lisp_Object lgstring;
22124 int i;
22126 s->for_overlaps = overlaps;
22127 glyph = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + start;
22128 last = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + end;
22129 s->cmp_id = glyph->u.cmp.id;
22130 s->cmp_from = glyph->slice.cmp.from;
22131 s->cmp_to = glyph->slice.cmp.to + 1;
22132 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
22133 lgstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
22134 s->font = XFONT_OBJECT (LGSTRING_FONT (lgstring));
22135 glyph++;
22136 while (glyph < last
22137 && glyph->u.cmp.automatic
22138 && glyph->u.cmp.id == s->cmp_id
22139 && s->cmp_to == glyph->slice.cmp.from)
22140 s->cmp_to = (glyph++)->slice.cmp.to + 1;
22142 for (i = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp_to; i++)
22144 Lisp_Object lglyph = LGSTRING_GLYPH (lgstring, i);
22145 unsigned code = LGLYPH_CODE (lglyph);
22147 STORE_XCHAR2B ((s->char2b + i), code >> 8, code & 0xFF);
22149 s->width = composition_gstring_width (lgstring, s->cmp_from, s->cmp_to, NULL);
22150 return glyph - s->row->glyphs[s->area];
22154 /* Fill glyph string S from a sequence glyphs for glyphless characters.
22155 See the comment of fill_glyph_string for arguments.
22156 Value is the index of the first glyph not in S. */
22159 static int
22160 fill_glyphless_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s, int face_id,
22161 int start, int end, int overlaps)
22163 struct glyph *glyph, *last;
22164 int voffset;
22166 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == GLYPHLESS_GLYPH);
22167 s->for_overlaps = overlaps;
22168 glyph = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + start;
22169 last = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + end;
22170 voffset = glyph->voffset;
22171 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
22172 s->font = s->face->font;
22173 s->nchars = 1;
22174 s->width = glyph->pixel_width;
22175 glyph++;
22176 while (glyph < last
22177 && glyph->type == GLYPHLESS_GLYPH
22178 && glyph->voffset == voffset
22179 && glyph->face_id == face_id)
22181 s->nchars++;
22182 s->width += glyph->pixel_width;
22183 glyph++;
22185 s->ybase += voffset;
22186 return glyph - s->row->glyphs[s->area];
22190 /* Fill glyph string S from a sequence of character glyphs.
22192 FACE_ID is the face id of the string. START is the index of the
22193 first glyph to consider, END is the index of the last + 1.
22194 OVERLAPS non-zero means S should draw the foreground only, and use
22195 its physical height for clipping. See also draw_glyphs.
22197 Value is the index of the first glyph not in S. */
22199 static int
22200 fill_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s, int face_id,
22201 int start, int end, int overlaps)
22203 struct glyph *glyph, *last;
22204 int voffset;
22205 int glyph_not_available_p;
22207 xassert (s->f == XFRAME (s->w->frame));
22208 xassert (s->nchars == 0);
22209 xassert (start >= 0 && end > start);
22211 s->for_overlaps = overlaps;
22212 glyph = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + start;
22213 last = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + end;
22214 voffset = glyph->voffset;
22215 s->padding_p = glyph->padding_p;
22216 glyph_not_available_p = glyph->glyph_not_available_p;
22218 while (glyph < last
22219 && glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
22220 && glyph->voffset == voffset
22221 /* Same face id implies same font, nowadays. */
22222 && glyph->face_id == face_id
22223 && glyph->glyph_not_available_p == glyph_not_available_p)
22225 int two_byte_p;
22227 s->face = get_glyph_face_and_encoding (s->f, glyph,
22228 s->char2b + s->nchars,
22229 &two_byte_p);
22230 s->two_byte_p = two_byte_p;
22231 ++s->nchars;
22232 xassert (s->nchars <= end - start);
22233 s->width += glyph->pixel_width;
22234 if (glyph++->padding_p != s->padding_p)
22235 break;
22238 s->font = s->face->font;
22240 /* If the specified font could not be loaded, use the frame's font,
22241 but record the fact that we couldn't load it in
22242 S->font_not_found_p so that we can draw rectangles for the
22243 characters of the glyph string. */
22244 if (s->font == NULL || glyph_not_available_p)
22246 s->font_not_found_p = 1;
22247 s->font = FRAME_FONT (s->f);
22250 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
22251 s->ybase += voffset;
22253 xassert (s->face && s->face->gc);
22254 return glyph - s->row->glyphs[s->area];
22258 /* Fill glyph string S from image glyph S->first_glyph. */
22260 static void
22261 fill_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
22263 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH);
22264 s->img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (s->f, s->first_glyph->u.img_id);
22265 xassert (s->img);
22266 s->slice = s->first_glyph->slice.img;
22267 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, s->first_glyph->face_id);
22268 s->font = s->face->font;
22269 s->width = s->first_glyph->pixel_width;
22271 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
22272 s->ybase += s->first_glyph->voffset;
22276 /* Fill glyph string S from a sequence of stretch glyphs.
22278 START is the index of the first glyph to consider,
22279 END is the index of the last + 1.
22281 Value is the index of the first glyph not in S. */
22283 static int
22284 fill_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s, int start, int end)
22286 struct glyph *glyph, *last;
22287 int voffset, face_id;
22289 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
22291 glyph = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + start;
22292 last = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + end;
22293 face_id = glyph->face_id;
22294 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
22295 s->font = s->face->font;
22296 s->width = glyph->pixel_width;
22297 s->nchars = 1;
22298 voffset = glyph->voffset;
22300 for (++glyph;
22301 (glyph < last
22302 && glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
22303 && glyph->voffset == voffset
22304 && glyph->face_id == face_id);
22305 ++glyph)
22306 s->width += glyph->pixel_width;
22308 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
22309 s->ybase += voffset;
22311 /* The case that face->gc == 0 is handled when drawing the glyph
22312 string by calling PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY. */
22313 xassert (s->face);
22314 return glyph - s->row->glyphs[s->area];
22317 static struct font_metrics *
22318 get_per_char_metric (struct font *font, XChar2b *char2b)
22320 static struct font_metrics metrics;
22321 unsigned code = (XCHAR2B_BYTE1 (char2b) << 8) | XCHAR2B_BYTE2 (char2b);
22323 if (! font || code == FONT_INVALID_CODE)
22324 return NULL;
22325 font->driver->text_extents (font, &code, 1, &metrics);
22326 return &metrics;
22329 /* EXPORT for RIF:
22330 Set *LEFT and *RIGHT to the left and right overhang of GLYPH on
22331 frame F. Overhangs of glyphs other than type CHAR_GLYPH are
22332 assumed to be zero. */
22334 void
22335 x_get_glyph_overhangs (struct glyph *glyph, struct frame *f, int *left, int *right)
22337 *left = *right = 0;
22339 if (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
22341 struct face *face;
22342 XChar2b char2b;
22343 struct font_metrics *pcm;
22345 face = get_glyph_face_and_encoding (f, glyph, &char2b, NULL);
22346 if (face->font && (pcm = get_per_char_metric (face->font, &char2b)))
22348 if (pcm->rbearing > pcm->width)
22349 *right = pcm->rbearing - pcm->width;
22350 if (pcm->lbearing < 0)
22351 *left = -pcm->lbearing;
22354 else if (glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH)
22356 if (! glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
22358 struct composition *cmp = composition_table[glyph->u.cmp.id];
22360 if (cmp->rbearing > cmp->pixel_width)
22361 *right = cmp->rbearing - cmp->pixel_width;
22362 if (cmp->lbearing < 0)
22363 *left = - cmp->lbearing;
22365 else
22367 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (glyph->u.cmp.id);
22368 struct font_metrics metrics;
22370 composition_gstring_width (gstring, glyph->slice.cmp.from,
22371 glyph->slice.cmp.to + 1, &metrics);
22372 if (metrics.rbearing > metrics.width)
22373 *right = metrics.rbearing - metrics.width;
22374 if (metrics.lbearing < 0)
22375 *left = - metrics.lbearing;
22381 /* Return the index of the first glyph preceding glyph string S that
22382 is overwritten by S because of S's left overhang. Value is -1
22383 if no glyphs are overwritten. */
22385 static int
22386 left_overwritten (struct glyph_string *s)
22388 int k;
22390 if (s->left_overhang)
22392 int x = 0, i;
22393 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
22394 int first = s->first_glyph - glyphs;
22396 for (i = first - 1; i >= 0 && x > -s->left_overhang; --i)
22397 x -= glyphs[i].pixel_width;
22399 k = i + 1;
22401 else
22402 k = -1;
22404 return k;
22408 /* Return the index of the first glyph preceding glyph string S that
22409 is overwriting S because of its right overhang. Value is -1 if no
22410 glyph in front of S overwrites S. */
22412 static int
22413 left_overwriting (struct glyph_string *s)
22415 int i, k, x;
22416 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
22417 int first = s->first_glyph - glyphs;
22419 k = -1;
22420 x = 0;
22421 for (i = first - 1; i >= 0; --i)
22423 int left, right;
22424 x_get_glyph_overhangs (glyphs + i, s->f, &left, &right);
22425 if (x + right > 0)
22426 k = i;
22427 x -= glyphs[i].pixel_width;
22430 return k;
22434 /* Return the index of the last glyph following glyph string S that is
22435 overwritten by S because of S's right overhang. Value is -1 if
22436 no such glyph is found. */
22438 static int
22439 right_overwritten (struct glyph_string *s)
22441 int k = -1;
22443 if (s->right_overhang)
22445 int x = 0, i;
22446 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
22447 int first = (s->first_glyph - glyphs) + (s->cmp ? 1 : s->nchars);
22448 int end = s->row->used[s->area];
22450 for (i = first; i < end && s->right_overhang > x; ++i)
22451 x += glyphs[i].pixel_width;
22453 k = i;
22456 return k;
22460 /* Return the index of the last glyph following glyph string S that
22461 overwrites S because of its left overhang. Value is negative
22462 if no such glyph is found. */
22464 static int
22465 right_overwriting (struct glyph_string *s)
22467 int i, k, x;
22468 int end = s->row->used[s->area];
22469 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
22470 int first = (s->first_glyph - glyphs) + (s->cmp ? 1 : s->nchars);
22472 k = -1;
22473 x = 0;
22474 for (i = first; i < end; ++i)
22476 int left, right;
22477 x_get_glyph_overhangs (glyphs + i, s->f, &left, &right);
22478 if (x - left < 0)
22479 k = i;
22480 x += glyphs[i].pixel_width;
22483 return k;
22487 /* Set background width of glyph string S. START is the index of the
22488 first glyph following S. LAST_X is the right-most x-position + 1
22489 in the drawing area. */
22491 static inline void
22492 set_glyph_string_background_width (struct glyph_string *s, int start, int last_x)
22494 /* If the face of this glyph string has to be drawn to the end of
22495 the drawing area, set S->extends_to_end_of_line_p. */
22497 if (start == s->row->used[s->area]
22498 && s->area == TEXT_AREA
22499 && ((s->row->fill_line_p
22500 && (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT
22501 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
22502 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN))
22503 || s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE))
22504 s->extends_to_end_of_line_p = 1;
22506 /* If S extends its face to the end of the line, set its
22507 background_width to the distance to the right edge of the drawing
22508 area. */
22509 if (s->extends_to_end_of_line_p)
22510 s->background_width = last_x - s->x + 1;
22511 else
22512 s->background_width = s->width;
22516 /* Compute overhangs and x-positions for glyph string S and its
22517 predecessors, or successors. X is the starting x-position for S.
22518 BACKWARD_P non-zero means process predecessors. */
22520 static void
22521 compute_overhangs_and_x (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int backward_p)
22523 if (backward_p)
22525 while (s)
22527 if (FRAME_RIF (s->f)->compute_glyph_string_overhangs)
22528 FRAME_RIF (s->f)->compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s);
22529 x -= s->width;
22530 s->x = x;
22531 s = s->prev;
22534 else
22536 while (s)
22538 if (FRAME_RIF (s->f)->compute_glyph_string_overhangs)
22539 FRAME_RIF (s->f)->compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s);
22540 s->x = x;
22541 x += s->width;
22542 s = s->next;
22549 /* The following macros are only called from draw_glyphs below.
22550 They reference the following parameters of that function directly:
22551 `w', `row', `area', and `overlap_p'
22552 as well as the following local variables:
22553 `s', `f', and `hdc' (in W32) */
22555 #ifdef HAVE_NTGUI
22556 /* On W32, silently add local `hdc' variable to argument list of
22557 init_glyph_string. */
22558 #define INIT_GLYPH_STRING(s, char2b, w, row, area, start, hl) \
22559 init_glyph_string (s, hdc, char2b, w, row, area, start, hl)
22560 #else
22561 #define INIT_GLYPH_STRING(s, char2b, w, row, area, start, hl) \
22562 init_glyph_string (s, char2b, w, row, area, start, hl)
22563 #endif
22565 /* Add a glyph string for a stretch glyph to the list of strings
22566 between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the stretch glyph in
22567 row area AREA of glyph row ROW. END is the index of the last glyph
22568 in that glyph row area. X is the current output position assigned
22569 to the new glyph string constructed. HL overrides that face of the
22570 glyph; e.g. it is DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X
22571 is the right-most x-position of the drawing area. */
22573 /* SunOS 4 bundled cc, barfed on continuations in the arg lists here
22574 and below -- keep them on one line. */
22575 #define BUILD_STRETCH_GLYPH_STRING(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
22576 do \
22578 s = (struct glyph_string *) alloca (sizeof *s); \
22579 INIT_GLYPH_STRING (s, NULL, w, row, area, START, HL); \
22580 START = fill_stretch_glyph_string (s, START, END); \
22581 append_glyph_string (&HEAD, &TAIL, s); \
22582 s->x = (X); \
22584 while (0)
22587 /* Add a glyph string for an image glyph to the list of strings
22588 between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the image glyph in
22589 row area AREA of glyph row ROW. END is the index of the last glyph
22590 in that glyph row area. X is the current output position assigned
22591 to the new glyph string constructed. HL overrides that face of the
22592 glyph; e.g. it is DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X
22593 is the right-most x-position of the drawing area. */
22595 #define BUILD_IMAGE_GLYPH_STRING(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
22596 do \
22598 s = (struct glyph_string *) alloca (sizeof *s); \
22599 INIT_GLYPH_STRING (s, NULL, w, row, area, START, HL); \
22600 fill_image_glyph_string (s); \
22601 append_glyph_string (&HEAD, &TAIL, s); \
22602 ++START; \
22603 s->x = (X); \
22605 while (0)
22608 /* Add a glyph string for a sequence of character glyphs to the list
22609 of strings between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the first
22610 glyph in row area AREA of glyph row ROW that is part of the new
22611 glyph string. END is the index of the last glyph in that glyph row
22612 area. X is the current output position assigned to the new glyph
22613 string constructed. HL overrides that face of the glyph; e.g. it
22614 is DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X is the
22615 right-most x-position of the drawing area. */
22617 #define BUILD_CHAR_GLYPH_STRINGS(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
22618 do \
22620 int face_id; \
22621 XChar2b *char2b; \
22623 face_id = (row)->glyphs[area][START].face_id; \
22625 s = (struct glyph_string *) alloca (sizeof *s); \
22626 char2b = (XChar2b *) alloca ((END - START) * sizeof *char2b); \
22627 INIT_GLYPH_STRING (s, char2b, w, row, area, START, HL); \
22628 append_glyph_string (&HEAD, &TAIL, s); \
22629 s->x = (X); \
22630 START = fill_glyph_string (s, face_id, START, END, overlaps); \
22632 while (0)
22635 /* Add a glyph string for a composite sequence to the list of strings
22636 between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the first glyph in
22637 row area AREA of glyph row ROW that is part of the new glyph
22638 string. END is the index of the last glyph in that glyph row area.
22639 X is the current output position assigned to the new glyph string
22640 constructed. HL overrides that face of the glyph; e.g. it is
22641 DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X is the right-most
22642 x-position of the drawing area. */
22644 #define BUILD_COMPOSITE_GLYPH_STRING(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
22645 do { \
22646 int face_id = (row)->glyphs[area][START].face_id; \
22647 struct face *base_face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, face_id); \
22648 ptrdiff_t cmp_id = (row)->glyphs[area][START].u.cmp.id; \
22649 struct composition *cmp = composition_table[cmp_id]; \
22650 XChar2b *char2b; \
22651 struct glyph_string *first_s IF_LINT (= NULL); \
22652 int n; \
22654 char2b = (XChar2b *) alloca ((sizeof *char2b) * cmp->glyph_len); \
22656 /* Make glyph_strings for each glyph sequence that is drawable by \
22657 the same face, and append them to HEAD/TAIL. */ \
22658 for (n = 0; n < cmp->glyph_len;) \
22660 s = (struct glyph_string *) alloca (sizeof *s); \
22661 INIT_GLYPH_STRING (s, char2b, w, row, area, START, HL); \
22662 append_glyph_string (&(HEAD), &(TAIL), s); \
22663 s->cmp = cmp; \
22664 s->cmp_from = n; \
22665 s->x = (X); \
22666 if (n == 0) \
22667 first_s = s; \
22668 n = fill_composite_glyph_string (s, base_face, overlaps); \
22671 ++START; \
22672 s = first_s; \
22673 } while (0)
22676 /* Add a glyph string for a glyph-string sequence to the list of strings
22677 between HEAD and TAIL. */
22679 #define BUILD_GSTRING_GLYPH_STRING(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
22680 do { \
22681 int face_id; \
22682 XChar2b *char2b; \
22683 Lisp_Object gstring; \
22685 face_id = (row)->glyphs[area][START].face_id; \
22686 gstring = (composition_gstring_from_id \
22687 ((row)->glyphs[area][START].u.cmp.id)); \
22688 s = (struct glyph_string *) alloca (sizeof *s); \
22689 char2b = (XChar2b *) alloca ((sizeof *char2b) \
22690 * LGSTRING_GLYPH_LEN (gstring)); \
22691 INIT_GLYPH_STRING (s, char2b, w, row, area, START, HL); \
22692 append_glyph_string (&(HEAD), &(TAIL), s); \
22693 s->x = (X); \
22694 START = fill_gstring_glyph_string (s, face_id, START, END, overlaps); \
22695 } while (0)
22698 /* Add a glyph string for a sequence of glyphless character's glyphs
22699 to the list of strings between HEAD and TAIL. The meanings of
22700 arguments are the same as those of BUILD_CHAR_GLYPH_STRINGS. */
22702 #define BUILD_GLYPHLESS_GLYPH_STRING(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
22703 do \
22705 int face_id; \
22707 face_id = (row)->glyphs[area][START].face_id; \
22709 s = (struct glyph_string *) alloca (sizeof *s); \
22710 INIT_GLYPH_STRING (s, NULL, w, row, area, START, HL); \
22711 append_glyph_string (&HEAD, &TAIL, s); \
22712 s->x = (X); \
22713 START = fill_glyphless_glyph_string (s, face_id, START, END, \
22714 overlaps); \
22716 while (0)
22719 /* Build a list of glyph strings between HEAD and TAIL for the glyphs
22720 of AREA of glyph row ROW on window W between indices START and END.
22721 HL overrides the face for drawing glyph strings, e.g. it is
22722 DRAW_CURSOR to draw a cursor. X and LAST_X are start and end
22723 x-positions of the drawing area.
22725 This is an ugly monster macro construct because we must use alloca
22726 to allocate glyph strings (because draw_glyphs can be called
22727 asynchronously). */
22729 #define BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
22730 do \
22732 HEAD = TAIL = NULL; \
22733 while (START < END) \
22735 struct glyph *first_glyph = (row)->glyphs[area] + START; \
22736 switch (first_glyph->type) \
22738 case CHAR_GLYPH: \
22739 BUILD_CHAR_GLYPH_STRINGS (START, END, HEAD, TAIL, \
22740 HL, X, LAST_X); \
22741 break; \
22743 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH: \
22744 if (first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic) \
22745 BUILD_GSTRING_GLYPH_STRING (START, END, HEAD, TAIL, \
22746 HL, X, LAST_X); \
22747 else \
22748 BUILD_COMPOSITE_GLYPH_STRING (START, END, HEAD, TAIL, \
22749 HL, X, LAST_X); \
22750 break; \
22752 case STRETCH_GLYPH: \
22753 BUILD_STRETCH_GLYPH_STRING (START, END, HEAD, TAIL, \
22754 HL, X, LAST_X); \
22755 break; \
22757 case IMAGE_GLYPH: \
22758 BUILD_IMAGE_GLYPH_STRING (START, END, HEAD, TAIL, \
22759 HL, X, LAST_X); \
22760 break; \
22762 case GLYPHLESS_GLYPH: \
22763 BUILD_GLYPHLESS_GLYPH_STRING (START, END, HEAD, TAIL, \
22764 HL, X, LAST_X); \
22765 break; \
22767 default: \
22768 abort (); \
22771 if (s) \
22773 set_glyph_string_background_width (s, START, LAST_X); \
22774 (X) += s->width; \
22777 } while (0)
22780 /* Draw glyphs between START and END in AREA of ROW on window W,
22781 starting at x-position X. X is relative to AREA in W. HL is a
22782 face-override with the following meaning:
22784 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT draw normally
22785 DRAW_CURSOR draw in cursor face
22786 DRAW_MOUSE_FACE draw in mouse face.
22787 DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO draw in mode line face
22788 DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN draw an image with a sunken relief around it
22789 DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED draw an image with a raised relief around it
22791 If OVERLAPS is non-zero, draw only the foreground of characters and
22792 clip to the physical height of ROW. Non-zero value also defines
22793 the overlapping part to be drawn:
22795 OVERLAPS_PRED overlap with preceding rows
22796 OVERLAPS_SUCC overlap with succeeding rows
22797 OVERLAPS_BOTH overlap with both preceding/succeeding rows
22798 OVERLAPS_ERASED_CURSOR overlap with erased cursor area
22800 Value is the x-position reached, relative to AREA of W. */
22802 static int
22803 draw_glyphs (struct window *w, int x, struct glyph_row *row,
22804 enum glyph_row_area area, EMACS_INT start, EMACS_INT end,
22805 enum draw_glyphs_face hl, int overlaps)
22807 struct glyph_string *head, *tail;
22808 struct glyph_string *s;
22809 struct glyph_string *clip_head = NULL, *clip_tail = NULL;
22810 int i, j, x_reached, last_x, area_left = 0;
22811 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
22812 DECLARE_HDC (hdc);
22814 ALLOCATE_HDC (hdc, f);
22816 /* Let's rather be paranoid than getting a SEGV. */
22817 end = min (end, row->used[area]);
22818 start = max (0, start);
22819 start = min (end, start);
22821 /* Translate X to frame coordinates. Set last_x to the right
22822 end of the drawing area. */
22823 if (row->full_width_p)
22825 /* X is relative to the left edge of W, without scroll bars
22826 or fringes. */
22827 area_left = WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w);
22828 last_x = WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w) + WINDOW_TOTAL_WIDTH (w);
22830 else
22832 area_left = window_box_left (w, area);
22833 last_x = area_left + window_box_width (w, area);
22835 x += area_left;
22837 /* Build a doubly-linked list of glyph_string structures between
22838 head and tail from what we have to draw. Note that the macro
22839 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS will modify its start parameter. That's
22840 the reason we use a separate variable `i'. */
22841 i = start;
22842 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (i, end, head, tail, hl, x, last_x);
22843 if (tail)
22844 x_reached = tail->x + tail->background_width;
22845 else
22846 x_reached = x;
22848 /* If there are any glyphs with lbearing < 0 or rbearing > width in
22849 the row, redraw some glyphs in front or following the glyph
22850 strings built above. */
22851 if (head && !overlaps && row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p)
22853 struct glyph_string *h, *t;
22854 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
22855 int mouse_beg_col IF_LINT (= 0), mouse_end_col IF_LINT (= 0);
22856 int check_mouse_face = 0;
22857 int dummy_x = 0;
22859 /* If mouse highlighting is on, we may need to draw adjacent
22860 glyphs using mouse-face highlighting. */
22861 if (area == TEXT_AREA && row->mouse_face_p)
22863 struct glyph_row *mouse_beg_row, *mouse_end_row;
22865 mouse_beg_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row);
22866 mouse_end_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row);
22868 if (row >= mouse_beg_row && row <= mouse_end_row)
22870 check_mouse_face = 1;
22871 mouse_beg_col = (row == mouse_beg_row)
22872 ? hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col : 0;
22873 mouse_end_col = (row == mouse_end_row)
22874 ? hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col
22875 : row->used[TEXT_AREA];
22879 /* Compute overhangs for all glyph strings. */
22880 if (FRAME_RIF (f)->compute_glyph_string_overhangs)
22881 for (s = head; s; s = s->next)
22882 FRAME_RIF (f)->compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s);
22884 /* Prepend glyph strings for glyphs in front of the first glyph
22885 string that are overwritten because of the first glyph
22886 string's left overhang. The background of all strings
22887 prepended must be drawn because the first glyph string
22888 draws over it. */
22889 i = left_overwritten (head);
22890 if (i >= 0)
22892 enum draw_glyphs_face overlap_hl;
22894 /* If this row contains mouse highlighting, attempt to draw
22895 the overlapped glyphs with the correct highlight. This
22896 code fails if the overlap encompasses more than one glyph
22897 and mouse-highlight spans only some of these glyphs.
22898 However, making it work perfectly involves a lot more
22899 code, and I don't know if the pathological case occurs in
22900 practice, so we'll stick to this for now. --- cyd */
22901 if (check_mouse_face
22902 && mouse_beg_col < start && mouse_end_col > i)
22903 overlap_hl = DRAW_MOUSE_FACE;
22904 else
22905 overlap_hl = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
22907 j = i;
22908 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (j, start, h, t,
22909 overlap_hl, dummy_x, last_x);
22910 start = i;
22911 compute_overhangs_and_x (t, head->x, 1);
22912 prepend_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
22913 clip_head = head;
22916 /* Prepend glyph strings for glyphs in front of the first glyph
22917 string that overwrite that glyph string because of their
22918 right overhang. For these strings, only the foreground must
22919 be drawn, because it draws over the glyph string at `head'.
22920 The background must not be drawn because this would overwrite
22921 right overhangs of preceding glyphs for which no glyph
22922 strings exist. */
22923 i = left_overwriting (head);
22924 if (i >= 0)
22926 enum draw_glyphs_face overlap_hl;
22928 if (check_mouse_face
22929 && mouse_beg_col < start && mouse_end_col > i)
22930 overlap_hl = DRAW_MOUSE_FACE;
22931 else
22932 overlap_hl = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
22934 clip_head = head;
22935 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (i, start, h, t,
22936 overlap_hl, dummy_x, last_x);
22937 for (s = h; s; s = s->next)
22938 s->background_filled_p = 1;
22939 compute_overhangs_and_x (t, head->x, 1);
22940 prepend_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
22943 /* Append glyphs strings for glyphs following the last glyph
22944 string tail that are overwritten by tail. The background of
22945 these strings has to be drawn because tail's foreground draws
22946 over it. */
22947 i = right_overwritten (tail);
22948 if (i >= 0)
22950 enum draw_glyphs_face overlap_hl;
22952 if (check_mouse_face
22953 && mouse_beg_col < i && mouse_end_col > end)
22954 overlap_hl = DRAW_MOUSE_FACE;
22955 else
22956 overlap_hl = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
22958 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (end, i, h, t,
22959 overlap_hl, x, last_x);
22960 /* Because BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS updates the first argument,
22961 we don't have `end = i;' here. */
22962 compute_overhangs_and_x (h, tail->x + tail->width, 0);
22963 append_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
22964 clip_tail = tail;
22967 /* Append glyph strings for glyphs following the last glyph
22968 string tail that overwrite tail. The foreground of such
22969 glyphs has to be drawn because it writes into the background
22970 of tail. The background must not be drawn because it could
22971 paint over the foreground of following glyphs. */
22972 i = right_overwriting (tail);
22973 if (i >= 0)
22975 enum draw_glyphs_face overlap_hl;
22976 if (check_mouse_face
22977 && mouse_beg_col < i && mouse_end_col > end)
22978 overlap_hl = DRAW_MOUSE_FACE;
22979 else
22980 overlap_hl = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
22982 clip_tail = tail;
22983 i++; /* We must include the Ith glyph. */
22984 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (end, i, h, t,
22985 overlap_hl, x, last_x);
22986 for (s = h; s; s = s->next)
22987 s->background_filled_p = 1;
22988 compute_overhangs_and_x (h, tail->x + tail->width, 0);
22989 append_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
22991 if (clip_head || clip_tail)
22992 for (s = head; s; s = s->next)
22994 s->clip_head = clip_head;
22995 s->clip_tail = clip_tail;
22999 /* Draw all strings. */
23000 for (s = head; s; s = s->next)
23001 FRAME_RIF (f)->draw_glyph_string (s);
23003 #ifndef HAVE_NS
23004 /* When focus a sole frame and move horizontally, this sets on_p to 0
23005 causing a failure to erase prev cursor position. */
23006 if (area == TEXT_AREA
23007 && !row->full_width_p
23008 /* When drawing overlapping rows, only the glyph strings'
23009 foreground is drawn, which doesn't erase a cursor
23010 completely. */
23011 && !overlaps)
23013 int x0 = clip_head ? clip_head->x : (head ? head->x : x);
23014 int x1 = (clip_tail ? clip_tail->x + clip_tail->background_width
23015 : (tail ? tail->x + tail->background_width : x));
23016 x0 -= area_left;
23017 x1 -= area_left;
23019 notice_overwritten_cursor (w, TEXT_AREA, x0, x1,
23020 row->y, MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row));
23022 #endif
23024 /* Value is the x-position up to which drawn, relative to AREA of W.
23025 This doesn't include parts drawn because of overhangs. */
23026 if (row->full_width_p)
23027 x_reached = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_X (w, x_reached);
23028 else
23029 x_reached -= area_left;
23031 RELEASE_HDC (hdc, f);
23033 return x_reached;
23036 /* Expand row matrix if too narrow. Don't expand if area
23037 is not present. */
23039 #define IT_EXPAND_MATRIX_WIDTH(it, area) \
23041 if (!fonts_changed_p \
23042 && (it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] \
23043 < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])) \
23045 it->w->ncols_scale_factor++; \
23046 fonts_changed_p = 1; \
23050 /* Store one glyph for IT->char_to_display in IT->glyph_row.
23051 Called from x_produce_glyphs when IT->glyph_row is non-null. */
23053 static inline void
23054 append_glyph (struct it *it)
23056 struct glyph *glyph;
23057 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
23059 xassert (it->glyph_row);
23060 xassert (it->char_to_display != '\n' && it->char_to_display != '\t');
23062 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
23063 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
23065 /* If the glyph row is reversed, we need to prepend the glyph
23066 rather than append it. */
23067 if (it->glyph_row->reversed_p && area == TEXT_AREA)
23069 struct glyph *g;
23071 /* Make room for the additional glyph. */
23072 for (g = glyph - 1; g >= it->glyph_row->glyphs[area]; g--)
23073 g[1] = *g;
23074 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area];
23076 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
23077 glyph->object = it->object;
23078 if (it->pixel_width > 0)
23080 glyph->pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
23081 glyph->padding_p = 0;
23083 else
23085 /* Assure at least 1-pixel width. Otherwise, cursor can't
23086 be displayed correctly. */
23087 glyph->pixel_width = 1;
23088 glyph->padding_p = 1;
23090 glyph->ascent = it->ascent;
23091 glyph->descent = it->descent;
23092 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
23093 glyph->type = CHAR_GLYPH;
23094 glyph->avoid_cursor_p = it->avoid_cursor_p;
23095 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
23096 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
23097 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
23098 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = (it->phys_ascent > it->ascent
23099 || it->phys_descent > it->descent);
23100 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = it->glyph_not_available_p;
23101 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
23102 glyph->u.ch = it->char_to_display;
23103 glyph->slice.img = null_glyph_slice;
23104 glyph->font_type = FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
23105 if (it->bidi_p)
23107 glyph->resolved_level = it->bidi_it.resolved_level;
23108 if ((it->bidi_it.type & 7) != it->bidi_it.type)
23109 abort ();
23110 glyph->bidi_type = it->bidi_it.type;
23112 else
23114 glyph->resolved_level = 0;
23115 glyph->bidi_type = UNKNOWN_BT;
23117 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
23119 else
23120 IT_EXPAND_MATRIX_WIDTH (it, area);
23123 /* Store one glyph for the composition IT->cmp_it.id in
23124 IT->glyph_row. Called from x_produce_glyphs when IT->glyph_row is
23125 non-null. */
23127 static inline void
23128 append_composite_glyph (struct it *it)
23130 struct glyph *glyph;
23131 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
23133 xassert (it->glyph_row);
23135 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
23136 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
23138 /* If the glyph row is reversed, we need to prepend the glyph
23139 rather than append it. */
23140 if (it->glyph_row->reversed_p && it->area == TEXT_AREA)
23142 struct glyph *g;
23144 /* Make room for the new glyph. */
23145 for (g = glyph - 1; g >= it->glyph_row->glyphs[it->area]; g--)
23146 g[1] = *g;
23147 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[it->area];
23149 glyph->charpos = it->cmp_it.charpos;
23150 glyph->object = it->object;
23151 glyph->pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
23152 glyph->ascent = it->ascent;
23153 glyph->descent = it->descent;
23154 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
23155 glyph->type = COMPOSITE_GLYPH;
23156 if (it->cmp_it.ch < 0)
23158 glyph->u.cmp.automatic = 0;
23159 glyph->u.cmp.id = it->cmp_it.id;
23160 glyph->slice.cmp.from = glyph->slice.cmp.to = 0;
23162 else
23164 glyph->u.cmp.automatic = 1;
23165 glyph->u.cmp.id = it->cmp_it.id;
23166 glyph->slice.cmp.from = it->cmp_it.from;
23167 glyph->slice.cmp.to = it->cmp_it.to - 1;
23169 glyph->avoid_cursor_p = it->avoid_cursor_p;
23170 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
23171 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
23172 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
23173 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = (it->phys_ascent > it->ascent
23174 || it->phys_descent > it->descent);
23175 glyph->padding_p = 0;
23176 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
23177 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
23178 glyph->font_type = FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
23179 if (it->bidi_p)
23181 glyph->resolved_level = it->bidi_it.resolved_level;
23182 if ((it->bidi_it.type & 7) != it->bidi_it.type)
23183 abort ();
23184 glyph->bidi_type = it->bidi_it.type;
23186 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
23188 else
23189 IT_EXPAND_MATRIX_WIDTH (it, area);
23193 /* Change IT->ascent and IT->height according to the setting of
23194 IT->voffset. */
23196 static inline void
23197 take_vertical_position_into_account (struct it *it)
23199 if (it->voffset)
23201 if (it->voffset < 0)
23202 /* Increase the ascent so that we can display the text higher
23203 in the line. */
23204 it->ascent -= it->voffset;
23205 else
23206 /* Increase the descent so that we can display the text lower
23207 in the line. */
23208 it->descent += it->voffset;
23213 /* Produce glyphs/get display metrics for the image IT is loaded with.
23214 See the description of struct display_iterator in dispextern.h for
23215 an overview of struct display_iterator. */
23217 static void
23218 produce_image_glyph (struct it *it)
23220 struct image *img;
23221 struct face *face;
23222 int glyph_ascent, crop;
23223 struct glyph_slice slice;
23225 xassert (it->what == IT_IMAGE);
23227 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
23228 xassert (face);
23229 /* Make sure X resources of the face is loaded. */
23230 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (it->f, face);
23232 if (it->image_id < 0)
23234 /* Fringe bitmap. */
23235 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = 0;
23236 it->descent = it->phys_descent = 0;
23237 it->pixel_width = 0;
23238 it->nglyphs = 0;
23239 return;
23242 img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->image_id);
23243 xassert (img);
23244 /* Make sure X resources of the image is loaded. */
23245 prepare_image_for_display (it->f, img);
23247 slice.x = slice.y = 0;
23248 slice.width = img->width;
23249 slice.height = img->height;
23251 if (INTEGERP (it->slice.x))
23252 slice.x = XINT (it->slice.x);
23253 else if (FLOATP (it->slice.x))
23254 slice.x = XFLOAT_DATA (it->slice.x) * img->width;
23256 if (INTEGERP (it->slice.y))
23257 slice.y = XINT (it->slice.y);
23258 else if (FLOATP (it->slice.y))
23259 slice.y = XFLOAT_DATA (it->slice.y) * img->height;
23261 if (INTEGERP (it->slice.width))
23262 slice.width = XINT (it->slice.width);
23263 else if (FLOATP (it->slice.width))
23264 slice.width = XFLOAT_DATA (it->slice.width) * img->width;
23266 if (INTEGERP (it->slice.height))
23267 slice.height = XINT (it->slice.height);
23268 else if (FLOATP (it->slice.height))
23269 slice.height = XFLOAT_DATA (it->slice.height) * img->height;
23271 if (slice.x >= img->width)
23272 slice.x = img->width;
23273 if (slice.y >= img->height)
23274 slice.y = img->height;
23275 if (slice.x + slice.width >= img->width)
23276 slice.width = img->width - slice.x;
23277 if (slice.y + slice.height > img->height)
23278 slice.height = img->height - slice.y;
23280 if (slice.width == 0 || slice.height == 0)
23281 return;
23283 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = glyph_ascent = image_ascent (img, face, &slice);
23285 it->descent = slice.height - glyph_ascent;
23286 if (slice.y == 0)
23287 it->descent += img->vmargin;
23288 if (slice.y + slice.height == img->height)
23289 it->descent += img->vmargin;
23290 it->phys_descent = it->descent;
23292 it->pixel_width = slice.width;
23293 if (slice.x == 0)
23294 it->pixel_width += img->hmargin;
23295 if (slice.x + slice.width == img->width)
23296 it->pixel_width += img->hmargin;
23298 /* It's quite possible for images to have an ascent greater than
23299 their height, so don't get confused in that case. */
23300 if (it->descent < 0)
23301 it->descent = 0;
23303 it->nglyphs = 1;
23305 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
23307 if (face->box_line_width > 0)
23309 if (slice.y == 0)
23310 it->ascent += face->box_line_width;
23311 if (slice.y + slice.height == img->height)
23312 it->descent += face->box_line_width;
23315 if (it->start_of_box_run_p && slice.x == 0)
23316 it->pixel_width += eabs (face->box_line_width);
23317 if (it->end_of_box_run_p && slice.x + slice.width == img->width)
23318 it->pixel_width += eabs (face->box_line_width);
23321 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
23323 /* Automatically crop wide image glyphs at right edge so we can
23324 draw the cursor on same display row. */
23325 if ((crop = it->pixel_width - (it->last_visible_x - it->current_x), crop > 0)
23326 && (it->hpos == 0 || it->pixel_width > it->last_visible_x / 4))
23328 it->pixel_width -= crop;
23329 slice.width -= crop;
23332 if (it->glyph_row)
23334 struct glyph *glyph;
23335 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
23337 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
23338 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
23340 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
23341 glyph->object = it->object;
23342 glyph->pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
23343 glyph->ascent = glyph_ascent;
23344 glyph->descent = it->descent;
23345 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
23346 glyph->type = IMAGE_GLYPH;
23347 glyph->avoid_cursor_p = it->avoid_cursor_p;
23348 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
23349 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
23350 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
23351 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = 0;
23352 glyph->padding_p = 0;
23353 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
23354 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
23355 glyph->u.img_id = img->id;
23356 glyph->slice.img = slice;
23357 glyph->font_type = FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
23358 if (it->bidi_p)
23360 glyph->resolved_level = it->bidi_it.resolved_level;
23361 if ((it->bidi_it.type & 7) != it->bidi_it.type)
23362 abort ();
23363 glyph->bidi_type = it->bidi_it.type;
23365 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
23367 else
23368 IT_EXPAND_MATRIX_WIDTH (it, area);
23373 /* Append a stretch glyph to IT->glyph_row. OBJECT is the source
23374 of the glyph, WIDTH and HEIGHT are the width and height of the
23375 stretch. ASCENT is the ascent of the glyph (0 <= ASCENT <= HEIGHT). */
23377 static void
23378 append_stretch_glyph (struct it *it, Lisp_Object object,
23379 int width, int height, int ascent)
23381 struct glyph *glyph;
23382 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
23384 xassert (ascent >= 0 && ascent <= height);
23386 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
23387 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
23389 /* If the glyph row is reversed, we need to prepend the glyph
23390 rather than append it. */
23391 if (it->glyph_row->reversed_p && area == TEXT_AREA)
23393 struct glyph *g;
23395 /* Make room for the additional glyph. */
23396 for (g = glyph - 1; g >= it->glyph_row->glyphs[area]; g--)
23397 g[1] = *g;
23398 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area];
23400 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
23401 glyph->object = object;
23402 glyph->pixel_width = width;
23403 glyph->ascent = ascent;
23404 glyph->descent = height - ascent;
23405 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
23406 glyph->type = STRETCH_GLYPH;
23407 glyph->avoid_cursor_p = it->avoid_cursor_p;
23408 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
23409 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
23410 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
23411 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = 0;
23412 glyph->padding_p = 0;
23413 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
23414 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
23415 glyph->u.stretch.ascent = ascent;
23416 glyph->u.stretch.height = height;
23417 glyph->slice.img = null_glyph_slice;
23418 glyph->font_type = FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
23419 if (it->bidi_p)
23421 glyph->resolved_level = it->bidi_it.resolved_level;
23422 if ((it->bidi_it.type & 7) != it->bidi_it.type)
23423 abort ();
23424 glyph->bidi_type = it->bidi_it.type;
23426 else
23428 glyph->resolved_level = 0;
23429 glyph->bidi_type = UNKNOWN_BT;
23431 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
23433 else
23434 IT_EXPAND_MATRIX_WIDTH (it, area);
23437 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
23439 /* Produce a stretch glyph for iterator IT. IT->object is the value
23440 of the glyph property displayed. The value must be a list
23441 `(space KEYWORD VALUE ...)' with the following KEYWORD/VALUE pairs
23442 being recognized:
23444 1. `:width WIDTH' specifies that the space should be WIDTH *
23445 canonical char width wide. WIDTH may be an integer or floating
23446 point number.
23448 2. `:relative-width FACTOR' specifies that the width of the stretch
23449 should be computed from the width of the first character having the
23450 `glyph' property, and should be FACTOR times that width.
23452 3. `:align-to HPOS' specifies that the space should be wide enough
23453 to reach HPOS, a value in canonical character units.
23455 Exactly one of the above pairs must be present.
23457 4. `:height HEIGHT' specifies that the height of the stretch produced
23458 should be HEIGHT, measured in canonical character units.
23460 5. `:relative-height FACTOR' specifies that the height of the
23461 stretch should be FACTOR times the height of the characters having
23462 the glyph property.
23464 Either none or exactly one of 4 or 5 must be present.
23466 6. `:ascent ASCENT' specifies that ASCENT percent of the height
23467 of the stretch should be used for the ascent of the stretch.
23468 ASCENT must be in the range 0 <= ASCENT <= 100. */
23470 void
23471 produce_stretch_glyph (struct it *it)
23473 /* (space :width WIDTH :height HEIGHT ...) */
23474 Lisp_Object prop, plist;
23475 int width = 0, height = 0, align_to = -1;
23476 int zero_width_ok_p = 0;
23477 int ascent = 0;
23478 double tem;
23479 struct face *face = NULL;
23480 struct font *font = NULL;
23482 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
23483 int zero_height_ok_p = 0;
23485 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
23487 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
23488 font = face->font ? face->font : FRAME_FONT (it->f);
23489 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (it->f, face);
23491 #endif
23493 /* List should start with `space'. */
23494 xassert (CONSP (it->object) && EQ (XCAR (it->object), Qspace));
23495 plist = XCDR (it->object);
23497 /* Compute the width of the stretch. */
23498 if ((prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCwidth), !NILP (prop))
23499 && calc_pixel_width_or_height (&tem, it, prop, font, 1, 0))
23501 /* Absolute width `:width WIDTH' specified and valid. */
23502 zero_width_ok_p = 1;
23503 width = (int)tem;
23505 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
23506 else if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
23507 && (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCrelative_width), NUMVAL (prop) > 0))
23509 /* Relative width `:relative-width FACTOR' specified and valid.
23510 Compute the width of the characters having the `glyph'
23511 property. */
23512 struct it it2;
23513 unsigned char *p = BYTE_POS_ADDR (IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
23515 it2 = *it;
23516 if (it->multibyte_p)
23517 it2.c = it2.char_to_display = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (p, it2.len);
23518 else
23520 it2.c = it2.char_to_display = *p, it2.len = 1;
23521 if (! ASCII_CHAR_P (it2.c))
23522 it2.char_to_display = BYTE8_TO_CHAR (it2.c);
23525 it2.glyph_row = NULL;
23526 it2.what = IT_CHARACTER;
23527 x_produce_glyphs (&it2);
23528 width = NUMVAL (prop) * it2.pixel_width;
23530 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
23531 else if ((prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCalign_to), !NILP (prop))
23532 && calc_pixel_width_or_height (&tem, it, prop, font, 1, &align_to))
23534 if (it->glyph_row == NULL || !it->glyph_row->mode_line_p)
23535 align_to = (align_to < 0
23537 : align_to - window_box_left_offset (it->w, TEXT_AREA));
23538 else if (align_to < 0)
23539 align_to = window_box_left_offset (it->w, TEXT_AREA);
23540 width = max (0, (int)tem + align_to - it->current_x);
23541 zero_width_ok_p = 1;
23543 else
23544 /* Nothing specified -> width defaults to canonical char width. */
23545 width = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it->f);
23547 if (width <= 0 && (width < 0 || !zero_width_ok_p))
23548 width = 1;
23550 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
23551 /* Compute height. */
23552 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
23554 if ((prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCheight), !NILP (prop))
23555 && calc_pixel_width_or_height (&tem, it, prop, font, 0, 0))
23557 height = (int)tem;
23558 zero_height_ok_p = 1;
23560 else if (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCrelative_height),
23561 NUMVAL (prop) > 0)
23562 height = FONT_HEIGHT (font) * NUMVAL (prop);
23563 else
23564 height = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
23566 if (height <= 0 && (height < 0 || !zero_height_ok_p))
23567 height = 1;
23569 /* Compute percentage of height used for ascent. If
23570 `:ascent ASCENT' is present and valid, use that. Otherwise,
23571 derive the ascent from the font in use. */
23572 if (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCascent),
23573 NUMVAL (prop) > 0 && NUMVAL (prop) <= 100)
23574 ascent = height * NUMVAL (prop) / 100.0;
23575 else if (!NILP (prop)
23576 && calc_pixel_width_or_height (&tem, it, prop, font, 0, 0))
23577 ascent = min (max (0, (int)tem), height);
23578 else
23579 ascent = (height * FONT_BASE (font)) / FONT_HEIGHT (font);
23581 else
23582 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
23583 height = 1;
23585 if (width > 0 && it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE
23586 && it->current_x + width > it->last_visible_x)
23588 width = it->last_visible_x - it->current_x;
23589 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
23590 /* Subtact one more pixel from the stretch width, but only on
23591 GUI frames, since on a TTY each glyph is one "pixel" wide. */
23592 width -= FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f);
23593 #endif
23596 if (width > 0 && height > 0 && it->glyph_row)
23598 Lisp_Object o_object = it->object;
23599 Lisp_Object object = it->stack[it->sp - 1].string;
23600 int n = width;
23602 if (!STRINGP (object))
23603 object = it->w->buffer;
23604 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
23605 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
23606 append_stretch_glyph (it, object, width, height, ascent);
23607 else
23608 #endif
23610 it->object = object;
23611 it->char_to_display = ' ';
23612 it->pixel_width = it->len = 1;
23613 while (n--)
23614 tty_append_glyph (it);
23615 it->object = o_object;
23619 it->pixel_width = width;
23620 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
23621 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
23623 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = ascent;
23624 it->descent = it->phys_descent = height - it->ascent;
23625 it->nglyphs = width > 0 && height > 0 ? 1 : 0;
23626 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
23628 else
23629 #endif
23630 it->nglyphs = width;
23633 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
23635 /* Calculate line-height and line-spacing properties.
23636 An integer value specifies explicit pixel value.
23637 A float value specifies relative value to current face height.
23638 A cons (float . face-name) specifies relative value to
23639 height of specified face font.
23641 Returns height in pixels, or nil. */
23644 static Lisp_Object
23645 calc_line_height_property (struct it *it, Lisp_Object val, struct font *font,
23646 int boff, int override)
23648 Lisp_Object face_name = Qnil;
23649 int ascent, descent, height;
23651 if (NILP (val) || INTEGERP (val) || (override && EQ (val, Qt)))
23652 return val;
23654 if (CONSP (val))
23656 face_name = XCAR (val);
23657 val = XCDR (val);
23658 if (!NUMBERP (val))
23659 val = make_number (1);
23660 if (NILP (face_name))
23662 height = it->ascent + it->descent;
23663 goto scale;
23667 if (NILP (face_name))
23669 font = FRAME_FONT (it->f);
23670 boff = FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (it->f);
23672 else if (EQ (face_name, Qt))
23674 override = 0;
23676 else
23678 int face_id;
23679 struct face *face;
23681 face_id = lookup_named_face (it->f, face_name, 0);
23682 if (face_id < 0)
23683 return make_number (-1);
23685 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
23686 font = face->font;
23687 if (font == NULL)
23688 return make_number (-1);
23689 boff = font->baseline_offset;
23690 if (font->vertical_centering)
23691 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, it->f) - boff;
23694 ascent = FONT_BASE (font) + boff;
23695 descent = FONT_DESCENT (font) - boff;
23697 if (override)
23699 it->override_ascent = ascent;
23700 it->override_descent = descent;
23701 it->override_boff = boff;
23704 height = ascent + descent;
23706 scale:
23707 if (FLOATP (val))
23708 height = (int)(XFLOAT_DATA (val) * height);
23709 else if (INTEGERP (val))
23710 height *= XINT (val);
23712 return make_number (height);
23716 /* Append a glyph for a glyphless character to IT->glyph_row. FACE_ID
23717 is a face ID to be used for the glyph. FOR_NO_FONT is nonzero if
23718 and only if this is for a character for which no font was found.
23720 If the display method (it->glyphless_method) is
23721 GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM or GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE, LEN is a
23722 length of the acronym or the hexadecimal string, UPPER_XOFF and
23723 UPPER_YOFF are pixel offsets for the upper part of the string,
23724 LOWER_XOFF and LOWER_YOFF are for the lower part.
23726 For the other display methods, LEN through LOWER_YOFF are zero. */
23728 static void
23729 append_glyphless_glyph (struct it *it, int face_id, int for_no_font, int len,
23730 short upper_xoff, short upper_yoff,
23731 short lower_xoff, short lower_yoff)
23733 struct glyph *glyph;
23734 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
23736 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
23737 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
23739 /* If the glyph row is reversed, we need to prepend the glyph
23740 rather than append it. */
23741 if (it->glyph_row->reversed_p && area == TEXT_AREA)
23743 struct glyph *g;
23745 /* Make room for the additional glyph. */
23746 for (g = glyph - 1; g >= it->glyph_row->glyphs[area]; g--)
23747 g[1] = *g;
23748 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area];
23750 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
23751 glyph->object = it->object;
23752 glyph->pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
23753 glyph->ascent = it->ascent;
23754 glyph->descent = it->descent;
23755 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
23756 glyph->type = GLYPHLESS_GLYPH;
23757 glyph->u.glyphless.method = it->glyphless_method;
23758 glyph->u.glyphless.for_no_font = for_no_font;
23759 glyph->u.glyphless.len = len;
23760 glyph->u.glyphless.ch = it->c;
23761 glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_xoff = upper_xoff;
23762 glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_yoff = upper_yoff;
23763 glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_xoff = lower_xoff;
23764 glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_yoff = lower_yoff;
23765 glyph->avoid_cursor_p = it->avoid_cursor_p;
23766 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
23767 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
23768 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
23769 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = (it->phys_ascent > it->ascent
23770 || it->phys_descent > it->descent);
23771 glyph->padding_p = 0;
23772 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
23773 glyph->face_id = face_id;
23774 glyph->font_type = FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
23775 if (it->bidi_p)
23777 glyph->resolved_level = it->bidi_it.resolved_level;
23778 if ((it->bidi_it.type & 7) != it->bidi_it.type)
23779 abort ();
23780 glyph->bidi_type = it->bidi_it.type;
23782 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
23784 else
23785 IT_EXPAND_MATRIX_WIDTH (it, area);
23789 /* Produce a glyph for a glyphless character for iterator IT.
23790 IT->glyphless_method specifies which method to use for displaying
23791 the character. See the description of enum
23792 glyphless_display_method in dispextern.h for the detail.
23794 FOR_NO_FONT is nonzero if and only if this is for a character for
23795 which no font was found. ACRONYM, if non-nil, is an acronym string
23796 for the character. */
23798 static void
23799 produce_glyphless_glyph (struct it *it, int for_no_font, Lisp_Object acronym)
23801 int face_id;
23802 struct face *face;
23803 struct font *font;
23804 int base_width, base_height, width, height;
23805 short upper_xoff, upper_yoff, lower_xoff, lower_yoff;
23806 int len;
23808 /* Get the metrics of the base font. We always refer to the current
23809 ASCII face. */
23810 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id)->ascii_face;
23811 font = face->font ? face->font : FRAME_FONT (it->f);
23812 it->ascent = FONT_BASE (font) + font->baseline_offset;
23813 it->descent = FONT_DESCENT (font) - font->baseline_offset;
23814 base_height = it->ascent + it->descent;
23815 base_width = font->average_width;
23817 /* Get a face ID for the glyph by utilizing a cache (the same way as
23818 done for `escape-glyph' in get_next_display_element). */
23819 if (it->f == last_glyphless_glyph_frame
23820 && it->face_id == last_glyphless_glyph_face_id)
23822 face_id = last_glyphless_glyph_merged_face_id;
23824 else
23826 /* Merge the `glyphless-char' face into the current face. */
23827 face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qglyphless_char, 0, it->face_id);
23828 last_glyphless_glyph_frame = it->f;
23829 last_glyphless_glyph_face_id = it->face_id;
23830 last_glyphless_glyph_merged_face_id = face_id;
23833 if (it->glyphless_method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE)
23835 it->pixel_width = THIN_SPACE_WIDTH;
23836 len = 0;
23837 upper_xoff = upper_yoff = lower_xoff = lower_yoff = 0;
23839 else if (it->glyphless_method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_EMPTY_BOX)
23841 width = CHAR_WIDTH (it->c);
23842 if (width == 0)
23843 width = 1;
23844 else if (width > 4)
23845 width = 4;
23846 it->pixel_width = base_width * width;
23847 len = 0;
23848 upper_xoff = upper_yoff = lower_xoff = lower_yoff = 0;
23850 else
23852 char buf[7];
23853 const char *str;
23854 unsigned int code[6];
23855 int upper_len;
23856 int ascent, descent;
23857 struct font_metrics metrics_upper, metrics_lower;
23859 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
23860 font = face->font ? face->font : FRAME_FONT (it->f);
23861 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (it->f, face);
23863 if (it->glyphless_method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM)
23865 if (! STRINGP (acronym) && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display))
23866 acronym = CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display, it->c);
23867 if (CONSP (acronym))
23868 acronym = XCAR (acronym);
23869 str = STRINGP (acronym) ? SSDATA (acronym) : "";
23871 else
23873 xassert (it->glyphless_method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE);
23874 sprintf (buf, "%0*X", it->c < 0x10000 ? 4 : 6, it->c);
23875 str = buf;
23877 for (len = 0; str[len] && ASCII_BYTE_P (str[len]); len++)
23878 code[len] = font->driver->encode_char (font, str[len]);
23879 upper_len = (len + 1) / 2;
23880 font->driver->text_extents (font, code, upper_len,
23881 &metrics_upper);
23882 font->driver->text_extents (font, code + upper_len, len - upper_len,
23883 &metrics_lower);
23887 /* +4 is for vertical bars of a box plus 1-pixel spaces at both side. */
23888 width = max (metrics_upper.width, metrics_lower.width) + 4;
23889 upper_xoff = upper_yoff = 2; /* the typical case */
23890 if (base_width >= width)
23892 /* Align the upper to the left, the lower to the right. */
23893 it->pixel_width = base_width;
23894 lower_xoff = base_width - 2 - metrics_lower.width;
23896 else
23898 /* Center the shorter one. */
23899 it->pixel_width = width;
23900 if (metrics_upper.width >= metrics_lower.width)
23901 lower_xoff = (width - metrics_lower.width) / 2;
23902 else
23904 /* FIXME: This code doesn't look right. It formerly was
23905 missing the "lower_xoff = 0;", which couldn't have
23906 been right since it left lower_xoff uninitialized. */
23907 lower_xoff = 0;
23908 upper_xoff = (width - metrics_upper.width) / 2;
23912 /* +5 is for horizontal bars of a box plus 1-pixel spaces at
23913 top, bottom, and between upper and lower strings. */
23914 height = (metrics_upper.ascent + metrics_upper.descent
23915 + metrics_lower.ascent + metrics_lower.descent) + 5;
23916 /* Center vertically.
23917 H:base_height, D:base_descent
23918 h:height, ld:lower_descent, la:lower_ascent, ud:upper_descent
23920 ascent = - (D - H/2 - h/2 + 1); "+ 1" for rounding up
23921 descent = D - H/2 + h/2;
23922 lower_yoff = descent - 2 - ld;
23923 upper_yoff = lower_yoff - la - 1 - ud; */
23924 ascent = - (it->descent - (base_height + height + 1) / 2);
23925 descent = it->descent - (base_height - height) / 2;
23926 lower_yoff = descent - 2 - metrics_lower.descent;
23927 upper_yoff = (lower_yoff - metrics_lower.ascent - 1
23928 - metrics_upper.descent);
23929 /* Don't make the height shorter than the base height. */
23930 if (height > base_height)
23932 it->ascent = ascent;
23933 it->descent = descent;
23937 it->phys_ascent = it->ascent;
23938 it->phys_descent = it->descent;
23939 if (it->glyph_row)
23940 append_glyphless_glyph (it, face_id, for_no_font, len,
23941 upper_xoff, upper_yoff,
23942 lower_xoff, lower_yoff);
23943 it->nglyphs = 1;
23944 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
23948 /* RIF:
23949 Produce glyphs/get display metrics for the display element IT is
23950 loaded with. See the description of struct it in dispextern.h
23951 for an overview of struct it. */
23953 void
23954 x_produce_glyphs (struct it *it)
23956 int extra_line_spacing = it->extra_line_spacing;
23958 it->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
23960 if (it->what == IT_CHARACTER)
23962 XChar2b char2b;
23963 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
23964 struct font *font = face->font;
23965 struct font_metrics *pcm = NULL;
23966 int boff; /* baseline offset */
23968 if (font == NULL)
23970 /* When no suitable font is found, display this character by
23971 the method specified in the first extra slot of
23972 Vglyphless_char_display. */
23973 Lisp_Object acronym = lookup_glyphless_char_display (-1, it);
23975 xassert (it->what == IT_GLYPHLESS);
23976 produce_glyphless_glyph (it, 1, STRINGP (acronym) ? acronym : Qnil);
23977 goto done;
23980 boff = font->baseline_offset;
23981 if (font->vertical_centering)
23982 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, it->f) - boff;
23984 if (it->char_to_display != '\n' && it->char_to_display != '\t')
23986 int stretched_p;
23988 it->nglyphs = 1;
23990 if (it->override_ascent >= 0)
23992 it->ascent = it->override_ascent;
23993 it->descent = it->override_descent;
23994 boff = it->override_boff;
23996 else
23998 it->ascent = FONT_BASE (font) + boff;
23999 it->descent = FONT_DESCENT (font) - boff;
24002 if (get_char_glyph_code (it->char_to_display, font, &char2b))
24004 pcm = get_per_char_metric (font, &char2b);
24005 if (pcm->width == 0
24006 && pcm->rbearing == 0 && pcm->lbearing == 0)
24007 pcm = NULL;
24010 if (pcm)
24012 it->phys_ascent = pcm->ascent + boff;
24013 it->phys_descent = pcm->descent - boff;
24014 it->pixel_width = pcm->width;
24016 else
24018 it->glyph_not_available_p = 1;
24019 it->phys_ascent = it->ascent;
24020 it->phys_descent = it->descent;
24021 it->pixel_width = font->space_width;
24024 if (it->constrain_row_ascent_descent_p)
24026 if (it->descent > it->max_descent)
24028 it->ascent += it->descent - it->max_descent;
24029 it->descent = it->max_descent;
24031 if (it->ascent > it->max_ascent)
24033 it->descent = min (it->max_descent, it->descent + it->ascent - it->max_ascent);
24034 it->ascent = it->max_ascent;
24036 it->phys_ascent = min (it->phys_ascent, it->ascent);
24037 it->phys_descent = min (it->phys_descent, it->descent);
24038 extra_line_spacing = 0;
24041 /* If this is a space inside a region of text with
24042 `space-width' property, change its width. */
24043 stretched_p = it->char_to_display == ' ' && !NILP (it->space_width);
24044 if (stretched_p)
24045 it->pixel_width *= XFLOATINT (it->space_width);
24047 /* If face has a box, add the box thickness to the character
24048 height. If character has a box line to the left and/or
24049 right, add the box line width to the character's width. */
24050 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
24052 int thick = face->box_line_width;
24054 if (thick > 0)
24056 it->ascent += thick;
24057 it->descent += thick;
24059 else
24060 thick = -thick;
24062 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
24063 it->pixel_width += thick;
24064 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
24065 it->pixel_width += thick;
24068 /* If face has an overline, add the height of the overline
24069 (1 pixel) and a 1 pixel margin to the character height. */
24070 if (face->overline_p)
24071 it->ascent += overline_margin;
24073 if (it->constrain_row_ascent_descent_p)
24075 if (it->ascent > it->max_ascent)
24076 it->ascent = it->max_ascent;
24077 if (it->descent > it->max_descent)
24078 it->descent = it->max_descent;
24081 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
24083 /* If we have to actually produce glyphs, do it. */
24084 if (it->glyph_row)
24086 if (stretched_p)
24088 /* Translate a space with a `space-width' property
24089 into a stretch glyph. */
24090 int ascent = (((it->ascent + it->descent) * FONT_BASE (font))
24091 / FONT_HEIGHT (font));
24092 append_stretch_glyph (it, it->object, it->pixel_width,
24093 it->ascent + it->descent, ascent);
24095 else
24096 append_glyph (it);
24098 /* If characters with lbearing or rbearing are displayed
24099 in this line, record that fact in a flag of the
24100 glyph row. This is used to optimize X output code. */
24101 if (pcm && (pcm->lbearing < 0 || pcm->rbearing > pcm->width))
24102 it->glyph_row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p = 1;
24104 if (! stretched_p && it->pixel_width == 0)
24105 /* We assure that all visible glyphs have at least 1-pixel
24106 width. */
24107 it->pixel_width = 1;
24109 else if (it->char_to_display == '\n')
24111 /* A newline has no width, but we need the height of the
24112 line. But if previous part of the line sets a height,
24113 don't increase that height */
24115 Lisp_Object height;
24116 Lisp_Object total_height = Qnil;
24118 it->override_ascent = -1;
24119 it->pixel_width = 0;
24120 it->nglyphs = 0;
24122 height = get_it_property (it, Qline_height);
24123 /* Split (line-height total-height) list */
24124 if (CONSP (height)
24125 && CONSP (XCDR (height))
24126 && NILP (XCDR (XCDR (height))))
24128 total_height = XCAR (XCDR (height));
24129 height = XCAR (height);
24131 height = calc_line_height_property (it, height, font, boff, 1);
24133 if (it->override_ascent >= 0)
24135 it->ascent = it->override_ascent;
24136 it->descent = it->override_descent;
24137 boff = it->override_boff;
24139 else
24141 it->ascent = FONT_BASE (font) + boff;
24142 it->descent = FONT_DESCENT (font) - boff;
24145 if (EQ (height, Qt))
24147 if (it->descent > it->max_descent)
24149 it->ascent += it->descent - it->max_descent;
24150 it->descent = it->max_descent;
24152 if (it->ascent > it->max_ascent)
24154 it->descent = min (it->max_descent, it->descent + it->ascent - it->max_ascent);
24155 it->ascent = it->max_ascent;
24157 it->phys_ascent = min (it->phys_ascent, it->ascent);
24158 it->phys_descent = min (it->phys_descent, it->descent);
24159 it->constrain_row_ascent_descent_p = 1;
24160 extra_line_spacing = 0;
24162 else
24164 Lisp_Object spacing;
24166 it->phys_ascent = it->ascent;
24167 it->phys_descent = it->descent;
24169 if ((it->max_ascent > 0 || it->max_descent > 0)
24170 && face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
24171 && face->box_line_width > 0)
24173 it->ascent += face->box_line_width;
24174 it->descent += face->box_line_width;
24176 if (!NILP (height)
24177 && XINT (height) > it->ascent + it->descent)
24178 it->ascent = XINT (height) - it->descent;
24180 if (!NILP (total_height))
24181 spacing = calc_line_height_property (it, total_height, font, boff, 0);
24182 else
24184 spacing = get_it_property (it, Qline_spacing);
24185 spacing = calc_line_height_property (it, spacing, font, boff, 0);
24187 if (INTEGERP (spacing))
24189 extra_line_spacing = XINT (spacing);
24190 if (!NILP (total_height))
24191 extra_line_spacing -= (it->phys_ascent + it->phys_descent);
24195 else /* i.e. (it->char_to_display == '\t') */
24197 if (font->space_width > 0)
24199 int tab_width = it->tab_width * font->space_width;
24200 int x = it->current_x + it->continuation_lines_width;
24201 int next_tab_x = ((1 + x + tab_width - 1) / tab_width) * tab_width;
24203 /* If the distance from the current position to the next tab
24204 stop is less than a space character width, use the
24205 tab stop after that. */
24206 if (next_tab_x - x < font->space_width)
24207 next_tab_x += tab_width;
24209 it->pixel_width = next_tab_x - x;
24210 it->nglyphs = 1;
24211 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = FONT_BASE (font) + boff;
24212 it->descent = it->phys_descent = FONT_DESCENT (font) - boff;
24214 if (it->glyph_row)
24216 append_stretch_glyph (it, it->object, it->pixel_width,
24217 it->ascent + it->descent, it->ascent);
24220 else
24222 it->pixel_width = 0;
24223 it->nglyphs = 1;
24227 else if (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION && it->cmp_it.ch < 0)
24229 /* A static composition.
24231 Note: A composition is represented as one glyph in the
24232 glyph matrix. There are no padding glyphs.
24234 Important note: pixel_width, ascent, and descent are the
24235 values of what is drawn by draw_glyphs (i.e. the values of
24236 the overall glyphs composed). */
24237 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
24238 int boff; /* baseline offset */
24239 struct composition *cmp = composition_table[it->cmp_it.id];
24240 int glyph_len = cmp->glyph_len;
24241 struct font *font = face->font;
24243 it->nglyphs = 1;
24245 /* If we have not yet calculated pixel size data of glyphs of
24246 the composition for the current face font, calculate them
24247 now. Theoretically, we have to check all fonts for the
24248 glyphs, but that requires much time and memory space. So,
24249 here we check only the font of the first glyph. This may
24250 lead to incorrect display, but it's very rare, and C-l
24251 (recenter-top-bottom) can correct the display anyway. */
24252 if (! cmp->font || cmp->font != font)
24254 /* Ascent and descent of the font of the first character
24255 of this composition (adjusted by baseline offset).
24256 Ascent and descent of overall glyphs should not be less
24257 than these, respectively. */
24258 int font_ascent, font_descent, font_height;
24259 /* Bounding box of the overall glyphs. */
24260 int leftmost, rightmost, lowest, highest;
24261 int lbearing, rbearing;
24262 int i, width, ascent, descent;
24263 int left_padded = 0, right_padded = 0;
24264 int c IF_LINT (= 0); /* cmp->glyph_len can't be zero; see Bug#8512 */
24265 XChar2b char2b;
24266 struct font_metrics *pcm;
24267 int font_not_found_p;
24268 EMACS_INT pos;
24270 for (glyph_len = cmp->glyph_len; glyph_len > 0; glyph_len--)
24271 if ((c = COMPOSITION_GLYPH (cmp, glyph_len - 1)) != '\t')
24272 break;
24273 if (glyph_len < cmp->glyph_len)
24274 right_padded = 1;
24275 for (i = 0; i < glyph_len; i++)
24277 if ((c = COMPOSITION_GLYPH (cmp, i)) != '\t')
24278 break;
24279 cmp->offsets[i * 2] = cmp->offsets[i * 2 + 1] = 0;
24281 if (i > 0)
24282 left_padded = 1;
24284 pos = (STRINGP (it->string) ? IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it)
24285 : IT_CHARPOS (*it));
24286 /* If no suitable font is found, use the default font. */
24287 font_not_found_p = font == NULL;
24288 if (font_not_found_p)
24290 face = face->ascii_face;
24291 font = face->font;
24293 boff = font->baseline_offset;
24294 if (font->vertical_centering)
24295 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, it->f) - boff;
24296 font_ascent = FONT_BASE (font) + boff;
24297 font_descent = FONT_DESCENT (font) - boff;
24298 font_height = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
24300 cmp->font = (void *) font;
24302 pcm = NULL;
24303 if (! font_not_found_p)
24305 get_char_face_and_encoding (it->f, c, it->face_id,
24306 &char2b, 0);
24307 pcm = get_per_char_metric (font, &char2b);
24310 /* Initialize the bounding box. */
24311 if (pcm)
24313 width = pcm->width;
24314 ascent = pcm->ascent;
24315 descent = pcm->descent;
24316 lbearing = pcm->lbearing;
24317 rbearing = pcm->rbearing;
24319 else
24321 width = font->space_width;
24322 ascent = FONT_BASE (font);
24323 descent = FONT_DESCENT (font);
24324 lbearing = 0;
24325 rbearing = width;
24328 rightmost = width;
24329 leftmost = 0;
24330 lowest = - descent + boff;
24331 highest = ascent + boff;
24333 if (! font_not_found_p
24334 && font->default_ascent
24335 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vuse_default_ascent)
24336 && !NILP (Faref (Vuse_default_ascent,
24337 make_number (it->char_to_display))))
24338 highest = font->default_ascent + boff;
24340 /* Draw the first glyph at the normal position. It may be
24341 shifted to right later if some other glyphs are drawn
24342 at the left. */
24343 cmp->offsets[i * 2] = 0;
24344 cmp->offsets[i * 2 + 1] = boff;
24345 cmp->lbearing = lbearing;
24346 cmp->rbearing = rbearing;
24348 /* Set cmp->offsets for the remaining glyphs. */
24349 for (i++; i < glyph_len; i++)
24351 int left, right, btm, top;
24352 int ch = COMPOSITION_GLYPH (cmp, i);
24353 int face_id;
24354 struct face *this_face;
24356 if (ch == '\t')
24357 ch = ' ';
24358 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, ch, pos, it->string);
24359 this_face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
24360 font = this_face->font;
24362 if (font == NULL)
24363 pcm = NULL;
24364 else
24366 get_char_face_and_encoding (it->f, ch, face_id,
24367 &char2b, 0);
24368 pcm = get_per_char_metric (font, &char2b);
24370 if (! pcm)
24371 cmp->offsets[i * 2] = cmp->offsets[i * 2 + 1] = 0;
24372 else
24374 width = pcm->width;
24375 ascent = pcm->ascent;
24376 descent = pcm->descent;
24377 lbearing = pcm->lbearing;
24378 rbearing = pcm->rbearing;
24379 if (cmp->method != COMPOSITION_WITH_RULE_ALTCHARS)
24381 /* Relative composition with or without
24382 alternate chars. */
24383 left = (leftmost + rightmost - width) / 2;
24384 btm = - descent + boff;
24385 if (font->relative_compose
24386 && (! CHAR_TABLE_P (Vignore_relative_composition)
24387 || NILP (Faref (Vignore_relative_composition,
24388 make_number (ch)))))
24391 if (- descent >= font->relative_compose)
24392 /* One extra pixel between two glyphs. */
24393 btm = highest + 1;
24394 else if (ascent <= 0)
24395 /* One extra pixel between two glyphs. */
24396 btm = lowest - 1 - ascent - descent;
24399 else
24401 /* A composition rule is specified by an integer
24402 value that encodes global and new reference
24403 points (GREF and NREF). GREF and NREF are
24404 specified by numbers as below:
24406 0---1---2 -- ascent
24410 9--10--11 -- center
24412 ---3---4---5--- baseline
24414 6---7---8 -- descent
24416 int rule = COMPOSITION_RULE (cmp, i);
24417 int gref, nref, grefx, grefy, nrefx, nrefy, xoff, yoff;
24419 COMPOSITION_DECODE_RULE (rule, gref, nref, xoff, yoff);
24420 grefx = gref % 3, nrefx = nref % 3;
24421 grefy = gref / 3, nrefy = nref / 3;
24422 if (xoff)
24423 xoff = font_height * (xoff - 128) / 256;
24424 if (yoff)
24425 yoff = font_height * (yoff - 128) / 256;
24427 left = (leftmost
24428 + grefx * (rightmost - leftmost) / 2
24429 - nrefx * width / 2
24430 + xoff);
24432 btm = ((grefy == 0 ? highest
24433 : grefy == 1 ? 0
24434 : grefy == 2 ? lowest
24435 : (highest + lowest) / 2)
24436 - (nrefy == 0 ? ascent + descent
24437 : nrefy == 1 ? descent - boff
24438 : nrefy == 2 ? 0
24439 : (ascent + descent) / 2)
24440 + yoff);
24443 cmp->offsets[i * 2] = left;
24444 cmp->offsets[i * 2 + 1] = btm + descent;
24446 /* Update the bounding box of the overall glyphs. */
24447 if (width > 0)
24449 right = left + width;
24450 if (left < leftmost)
24451 leftmost = left;
24452 if (right > rightmost)
24453 rightmost = right;
24455 top = btm + descent + ascent;
24456 if (top > highest)
24457 highest = top;
24458 if (btm < lowest)
24459 lowest = btm;
24461 if (cmp->lbearing > left + lbearing)
24462 cmp->lbearing = left + lbearing;
24463 if (cmp->rbearing < left + rbearing)
24464 cmp->rbearing = left + rbearing;
24468 /* If there are glyphs whose x-offsets are negative,
24469 shift all glyphs to the right and make all x-offsets
24470 non-negative. */
24471 if (leftmost < 0)
24473 for (i = 0; i < cmp->glyph_len; i++)
24474 cmp->offsets[i * 2] -= leftmost;
24475 rightmost -= leftmost;
24476 cmp->lbearing -= leftmost;
24477 cmp->rbearing -= leftmost;
24480 if (left_padded && cmp->lbearing < 0)
24482 for (i = 0; i < cmp->glyph_len; i++)
24483 cmp->offsets[i * 2] -= cmp->lbearing;
24484 rightmost -= cmp->lbearing;
24485 cmp->rbearing -= cmp->lbearing;
24486 cmp->lbearing = 0;
24488 if (right_padded && rightmost < cmp->rbearing)
24490 rightmost = cmp->rbearing;
24493 cmp->pixel_width = rightmost;
24494 cmp->ascent = highest;
24495 cmp->descent = - lowest;
24496 if (cmp->ascent < font_ascent)
24497 cmp->ascent = font_ascent;
24498 if (cmp->descent < font_descent)
24499 cmp->descent = font_descent;
24502 if (it->glyph_row
24503 && (cmp->lbearing < 0
24504 || cmp->rbearing > cmp->pixel_width))
24505 it->glyph_row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p = 1;
24507 it->pixel_width = cmp->pixel_width;
24508 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = cmp->ascent;
24509 it->descent = it->phys_descent = cmp->descent;
24510 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
24512 int thick = face->box_line_width;
24514 if (thick > 0)
24516 it->ascent += thick;
24517 it->descent += thick;
24519 else
24520 thick = - thick;
24522 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
24523 it->pixel_width += thick;
24524 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
24525 it->pixel_width += thick;
24528 /* If face has an overline, add the height of the overline
24529 (1 pixel) and a 1 pixel margin to the character height. */
24530 if (face->overline_p)
24531 it->ascent += overline_margin;
24533 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
24534 if (it->ascent < 0)
24535 it->ascent = 0;
24536 if (it->descent < 0)
24537 it->descent = 0;
24539 if (it->glyph_row)
24540 append_composite_glyph (it);
24542 else if (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION)
24544 /* A dynamic (automatic) composition. */
24545 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
24546 Lisp_Object gstring;
24547 struct font_metrics metrics;
24549 it->nglyphs = 1;
24551 gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (it->cmp_it.id);
24552 it->pixel_width
24553 = composition_gstring_width (gstring, it->cmp_it.from, it->cmp_it.to,
24554 &metrics);
24555 if (it->glyph_row
24556 && (metrics.lbearing < 0 || metrics.rbearing > metrics.width))
24557 it->glyph_row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p = 1;
24558 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = metrics.ascent;
24559 it->descent = it->phys_descent = metrics.descent;
24560 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
24562 int thick = face->box_line_width;
24564 if (thick > 0)
24566 it->ascent += thick;
24567 it->descent += thick;
24569 else
24570 thick = - thick;
24572 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
24573 it->pixel_width += thick;
24574 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
24575 it->pixel_width += thick;
24577 /* If face has an overline, add the height of the overline
24578 (1 pixel) and a 1 pixel margin to the character height. */
24579 if (face->overline_p)
24580 it->ascent += overline_margin;
24581 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
24582 if (it->ascent < 0)
24583 it->ascent = 0;
24584 if (it->descent < 0)
24585 it->descent = 0;
24587 if (it->glyph_row)
24588 append_composite_glyph (it);
24590 else if (it->what == IT_GLYPHLESS)
24591 produce_glyphless_glyph (it, 0, Qnil);
24592 else if (it->what == IT_IMAGE)
24593 produce_image_glyph (it);
24594 else if (it->what == IT_STRETCH)
24595 produce_stretch_glyph (it);
24597 done:
24598 /* Accumulate dimensions. Note: can't assume that it->descent > 0
24599 because this isn't true for images with `:ascent 100'. */
24600 xassert (it->ascent >= 0 && it->descent >= 0);
24601 if (it->area == TEXT_AREA)
24602 it->current_x += it->pixel_width;
24604 if (extra_line_spacing > 0)
24606 it->descent += extra_line_spacing;
24607 if (extra_line_spacing > it->max_extra_line_spacing)
24608 it->max_extra_line_spacing = extra_line_spacing;
24611 it->max_ascent = max (it->max_ascent, it->ascent);
24612 it->max_descent = max (it->max_descent, it->descent);
24613 it->max_phys_ascent = max (it->max_phys_ascent, it->phys_ascent);
24614 it->max_phys_descent = max (it->max_phys_descent, it->phys_descent);
24617 /* EXPORT for RIF:
24618 Output LEN glyphs starting at START at the nominal cursor position.
24619 Advance the nominal cursor over the text. The global variable
24620 updated_window contains the window being updated, updated_row is
24621 the glyph row being updated, and updated_area is the area of that
24622 row being updated. */
24624 void
24625 x_write_glyphs (struct glyph *start, int len)
24627 int x, hpos;
24629 xassert (updated_window && updated_row);
24630 BLOCK_INPUT;
24632 /* Write glyphs. */
24634 hpos = start - updated_row->glyphs[updated_area];
24635 x = draw_glyphs (updated_window, output_cursor.x,
24636 updated_row, updated_area,
24637 hpos, hpos + len,
24638 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
24640 /* Invalidate old phys cursor if the glyph at its hpos is redrawn. */
24641 if (updated_area == TEXT_AREA
24642 && updated_window->phys_cursor_on_p
24643 && updated_window->phys_cursor.vpos == output_cursor.vpos
24644 && updated_window->phys_cursor.hpos >= hpos
24645 && updated_window->phys_cursor.hpos < hpos + len)
24646 updated_window->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
24648 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
24650 /* Advance the output cursor. */
24651 output_cursor.hpos += len;
24652 output_cursor.x = x;
24656 /* EXPORT for RIF:
24657 Insert LEN glyphs from START at the nominal cursor position. */
24659 void
24660 x_insert_glyphs (struct glyph *start, int len)
24662 struct frame *f;
24663 struct window *w;
24664 int line_height, shift_by_width, shifted_region_width;
24665 struct glyph_row *row;
24666 struct glyph *glyph;
24667 int frame_x, frame_y;
24668 EMACS_INT hpos;
24670 xassert (updated_window && updated_row);
24671 BLOCK_INPUT;
24672 w = updated_window;
24673 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
24675 /* Get the height of the line we are in. */
24676 row = updated_row;
24677 line_height = row->height;
24679 /* Get the width of the glyphs to insert. */
24680 shift_by_width = 0;
24681 for (glyph = start; glyph < start + len; ++glyph)
24682 shift_by_width += glyph->pixel_width;
24684 /* Get the width of the region to shift right. */
24685 shifted_region_width = (window_box_width (w, updated_area)
24686 - output_cursor.x
24687 - shift_by_width);
24689 /* Shift right. */
24690 frame_x = window_box_left (w, updated_area) + output_cursor.x;
24691 frame_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, output_cursor.y);
24693 FRAME_RIF (f)->shift_glyphs_for_insert (f, frame_x, frame_y, shifted_region_width,
24694 line_height, shift_by_width);
24696 /* Write the glyphs. */
24697 hpos = start - row->glyphs[updated_area];
24698 draw_glyphs (w, output_cursor.x, row, updated_area,
24699 hpos, hpos + len,
24700 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
24702 /* Advance the output cursor. */
24703 output_cursor.hpos += len;
24704 output_cursor.x += shift_by_width;
24705 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
24709 /* EXPORT for RIF:
24710 Erase the current text line from the nominal cursor position
24711 (inclusive) to pixel column TO_X (exclusive). The idea is that
24712 everything from TO_X onward is already erased.
24714 TO_X is a pixel position relative to updated_area of
24715 updated_window. TO_X == -1 means clear to the end of this area. */
24717 void
24718 x_clear_end_of_line (int to_x)
24720 struct frame *f;
24721 struct window *w = updated_window;
24722 int max_x, min_y, max_y;
24723 int from_x, from_y, to_y;
24725 xassert (updated_window && updated_row);
24726 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
24728 if (updated_row->full_width_p)
24729 max_x = WINDOW_TOTAL_WIDTH (w);
24730 else
24731 max_x = window_box_width (w, updated_area);
24732 max_y = window_text_bottom_y (w);
24734 /* TO_X == 0 means don't do anything. TO_X < 0 means clear to end
24735 of window. For TO_X > 0, truncate to end of drawing area. */
24736 if (to_x == 0)
24737 return;
24738 else if (to_x < 0)
24739 to_x = max_x;
24740 else
24741 to_x = min (to_x, max_x);
24743 to_y = min (max_y, output_cursor.y + updated_row->height);
24745 /* Notice if the cursor will be cleared by this operation. */
24746 if (!updated_row->full_width_p)
24747 notice_overwritten_cursor (w, updated_area,
24748 output_cursor.x, -1,
24749 updated_row->y,
24750 MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (updated_row));
24752 from_x = output_cursor.x;
24754 /* Translate to frame coordinates. */
24755 if (updated_row->full_width_p)
24757 from_x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, from_x);
24758 to_x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, to_x);
24760 else
24762 int area_left = window_box_left (w, updated_area);
24763 from_x += area_left;
24764 to_x += area_left;
24767 min_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
24768 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (min_y, output_cursor.y));
24769 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, to_y);
24771 /* Prevent inadvertently clearing to end of the X window. */
24772 if (to_x > from_x && to_y > from_y)
24774 BLOCK_INPUT;
24775 FRAME_RIF (f)->clear_frame_area (f, from_x, from_y,
24776 to_x - from_x, to_y - from_y);
24777 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
24781 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
24785 /***********************************************************************
24786 Cursor types
24787 ***********************************************************************/
24789 /* Value is the internal representation of the specified cursor type
24790 ARG. If type is BAR_CURSOR, return in *WIDTH the specified width
24791 of the bar cursor. */
24793 static enum text_cursor_kinds
24794 get_specified_cursor_type (Lisp_Object arg, int *width)
24796 enum text_cursor_kinds type;
24798 if (NILP (arg))
24799 return NO_CURSOR;
24801 if (EQ (arg, Qbox))
24802 return FILLED_BOX_CURSOR;
24804 if (EQ (arg, Qhollow))
24805 return HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
24807 if (EQ (arg, Qbar))
24809 *width = 2;
24810 return BAR_CURSOR;
24813 if (CONSP (arg)
24814 && EQ (XCAR (arg), Qbar)
24815 && INTEGERP (XCDR (arg))
24816 && XINT (XCDR (arg)) >= 0)
24818 *width = XINT (XCDR (arg));
24819 return BAR_CURSOR;
24822 if (EQ (arg, Qhbar))
24824 *width = 2;
24825 return HBAR_CURSOR;
24828 if (CONSP (arg)
24829 && EQ (XCAR (arg), Qhbar)
24830 && INTEGERP (XCDR (arg))
24831 && XINT (XCDR (arg)) >= 0)
24833 *width = XINT (XCDR (arg));
24834 return HBAR_CURSOR;
24837 /* Treat anything unknown as "hollow box cursor".
24838 It was bad to signal an error; people have trouble fixing
24839 .Xdefaults with Emacs, when it has something bad in it. */
24840 type = HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
24842 return type;
24845 /* Set the default cursor types for specified frame. */
24846 void
24847 set_frame_cursor_types (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object arg)
24849 int width = 1;
24850 Lisp_Object tem;
24852 FRAME_DESIRED_CURSOR (f) = get_specified_cursor_type (arg, &width);
24853 FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f) = width;
24855 /* By default, set up the blink-off state depending on the on-state. */
24857 tem = Fassoc (arg, Vblink_cursor_alist);
24858 if (!NILP (tem))
24860 FRAME_BLINK_OFF_CURSOR (f)
24861 = get_specified_cursor_type (XCDR (tem), &width);
24862 FRAME_BLINK_OFF_CURSOR_WIDTH (f) = width;
24864 else
24865 FRAME_BLINK_OFF_CURSOR (f) = DEFAULT_CURSOR;
24869 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24871 /* Return the cursor we want to be displayed in window W. Return
24872 width of bar/hbar cursor through WIDTH arg. Return with
24873 ACTIVE_CURSOR arg set to 1 if cursor in window W is `active'
24874 (i.e. if the `system caret' should track this cursor).
24876 In a mini-buffer window, we want the cursor only to appear if we
24877 are reading input from this window. For the selected window, we
24878 want the cursor type given by the frame parameter or buffer local
24879 setting of cursor-type. If explicitly marked off, draw no cursor.
24880 In all other cases, we want a hollow box cursor. */
24882 static enum text_cursor_kinds
24883 get_window_cursor_type (struct window *w, struct glyph *glyph, int *width,
24884 int *active_cursor)
24886 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
24887 struct buffer *b = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
24888 int cursor_type = DEFAULT_CURSOR;
24889 Lisp_Object alt_cursor;
24890 int non_selected = 0;
24892 *active_cursor = 1;
24894 /* Echo area */
24895 if (cursor_in_echo_area
24896 && FRAME_HAS_MINIBUF_P (f)
24897 && EQ (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (f), echo_area_window))
24899 if (w == XWINDOW (echo_area_window))
24901 if (EQ (BVAR (b, cursor_type), Qt) || NILP (BVAR (b, cursor_type)))
24903 *width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
24904 return FRAME_DESIRED_CURSOR (f);
24906 else
24907 return get_specified_cursor_type (BVAR (b, cursor_type), width);
24910 *active_cursor = 0;
24911 non_selected = 1;
24914 /* Detect a nonselected window or nonselected frame. */
24915 else if (w != XWINDOW (f->selected_window)
24916 || f != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame)
24918 *active_cursor = 0;
24920 if (MINI_WINDOW_P (w) && minibuf_level == 0)
24921 return NO_CURSOR;
24923 non_selected = 1;
24926 /* Never display a cursor in a window in which cursor-type is nil. */
24927 if (NILP (BVAR (b, cursor_type)))
24928 return NO_CURSOR;
24930 /* Get the normal cursor type for this window. */
24931 if (EQ (BVAR (b, cursor_type), Qt))
24933 cursor_type = FRAME_DESIRED_CURSOR (f);
24934 *width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
24936 else
24937 cursor_type = get_specified_cursor_type (BVAR (b, cursor_type), width);
24939 /* Use cursor-in-non-selected-windows instead
24940 for non-selected window or frame. */
24941 if (non_selected)
24943 alt_cursor = BVAR (b, cursor_in_non_selected_windows);
24944 if (!EQ (Qt, alt_cursor))
24945 return get_specified_cursor_type (alt_cursor, width);
24946 /* t means modify the normal cursor type. */
24947 if (cursor_type == FILLED_BOX_CURSOR)
24948 cursor_type = HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
24949 else if (cursor_type == BAR_CURSOR && *width > 1)
24950 --*width;
24951 return cursor_type;
24954 /* Use normal cursor if not blinked off. */
24955 if (!w->cursor_off_p)
24957 if (glyph != NULL && glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
24959 if (cursor_type == FILLED_BOX_CURSOR)
24961 /* Using a block cursor on large images can be very annoying.
24962 So use a hollow cursor for "large" images.
24963 If image is not transparent (no mask), also use hollow cursor. */
24964 struct image *img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (f, glyph->u.img_id);
24965 if (img != NULL && IMAGEP (img->spec))
24967 /* Arbitrarily, interpret "Large" as >32x32 and >NxN
24968 where N = size of default frame font size.
24969 This should cover most of the "tiny" icons people may use. */
24970 if (!img->mask
24971 || img->width > max (32, WINDOW_FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (w))
24972 || img->height > max (32, WINDOW_FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (w)))
24973 cursor_type = HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
24976 else if (cursor_type != NO_CURSOR)
24978 /* Display current only supports BOX and HOLLOW cursors for images.
24979 So for now, unconditionally use a HOLLOW cursor when cursor is
24980 not a solid box cursor. */
24981 cursor_type = HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
24984 return cursor_type;
24987 /* Cursor is blinked off, so determine how to "toggle" it. */
24989 /* First look for an entry matching the buffer's cursor-type in blink-cursor-alist. */
24990 if ((alt_cursor = Fassoc (BVAR (b, cursor_type), Vblink_cursor_alist), !NILP (alt_cursor)))
24991 return get_specified_cursor_type (XCDR (alt_cursor), width);
24993 /* Then see if frame has specified a specific blink off cursor type. */
24994 if (FRAME_BLINK_OFF_CURSOR (f) != DEFAULT_CURSOR)
24996 *width = FRAME_BLINK_OFF_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
24997 return FRAME_BLINK_OFF_CURSOR (f);
25000 #if 0
25001 /* Some people liked having a permanently visible blinking cursor,
25002 while others had very strong opinions against it. So it was
25003 decided to remove it. KFS 2003-09-03 */
25005 /* Finally perform built-in cursor blinking:
25006 filled box <-> hollow box
25007 wide [h]bar <-> narrow [h]bar
25008 narrow [h]bar <-> no cursor
25009 other type <-> no cursor */
25011 if (cursor_type == FILLED_BOX_CURSOR)
25012 return HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
25014 if ((cursor_type == BAR_CURSOR || cursor_type == HBAR_CURSOR) && *width > 1)
25016 *width = 1;
25017 return cursor_type;
25019 #endif
25021 return NO_CURSOR;
25025 /* Notice when the text cursor of window W has been completely
25026 overwritten by a drawing operation that outputs glyphs in AREA
25027 starting at X0 and ending at X1 in the line starting at Y0 and
25028 ending at Y1. X coordinates are area-relative. X1 < 0 means all
25029 the rest of the line after X0 has been written. Y coordinates
25030 are window-relative. */
25032 static void
25033 notice_overwritten_cursor (struct window *w, enum glyph_row_area area,
25034 int x0, int x1, int y0, int y1)
25036 int cx0, cx1, cy0, cy1;
25037 struct glyph_row *row;
25039 if (!w->phys_cursor_on_p)
25040 return;
25041 if (area != TEXT_AREA)
25042 return;
25044 if (w->phys_cursor.vpos < 0
25045 || w->phys_cursor.vpos >= w->current_matrix->nrows
25046 || (row = w->current_matrix->rows + w->phys_cursor.vpos,
25047 !(row->enabled_p && row->displays_text_p)))
25048 return;
25050 if (row->cursor_in_fringe_p)
25052 row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 0;
25053 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, row, row->reversed_p);
25054 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
25055 return;
25058 cx0 = w->phys_cursor.x;
25059 cx1 = cx0 + w->phys_cursor_width;
25060 if (x0 > cx0 || (x1 >= 0 && x1 < cx1))
25061 return;
25063 /* The cursor image will be completely removed from the
25064 screen if the output area intersects the cursor area in
25065 y-direction. When we draw in [y0 y1[, and some part of
25066 the cursor is at y < y0, that part must have been drawn
25067 before. When scrolling, the cursor is erased before
25068 actually scrolling, so we don't come here. When not
25069 scrolling, the rows above the old cursor row must have
25070 changed, and in this case these rows must have written
25071 over the cursor image.
25073 Likewise if part of the cursor is below y1, with the
25074 exception of the cursor being in the first blank row at
25075 the buffer and window end because update_text_area
25076 doesn't draw that row. (Except when it does, but
25077 that's handled in update_text_area.) */
25079 cy0 = w->phys_cursor.y;
25080 cy1 = cy0 + w->phys_cursor_height;
25081 if ((y0 < cy0 || y0 >= cy1) && (y1 <= cy0 || y1 >= cy1))
25082 return;
25084 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
25087 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
25090 /************************************************************************
25091 Mouse Face
25092 ************************************************************************/
25094 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
25096 /* EXPORT for RIF:
25097 Fix the display of area AREA of overlapping row ROW in window W
25098 with respect to the overlapping part OVERLAPS. */
25100 void
25101 x_fix_overlapping_area (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row,
25102 enum glyph_row_area area, int overlaps)
25104 int i, x;
25106 BLOCK_INPUT;
25108 x = 0;
25109 for (i = 0; i < row->used[area];)
25111 if (row->glyphs[area][i].overlaps_vertically_p)
25113 int start = i, start_x = x;
25117 x += row->glyphs[area][i].pixel_width;
25118 ++i;
25120 while (i < row->used[area]
25121 && row->glyphs[area][i].overlaps_vertically_p);
25123 draw_glyphs (w, start_x, row, area,
25124 start, i,
25125 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, overlaps);
25127 else
25129 x += row->glyphs[area][i].pixel_width;
25130 ++i;
25134 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
25138 /* EXPORT:
25139 Draw the cursor glyph of window W in glyph row ROW. See the
25140 comment of draw_glyphs for the meaning of HL. */
25142 void
25143 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row,
25144 enum draw_glyphs_face hl)
25146 /* If cursor hpos is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can
25147 happen in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area
25148 glyphs and mini-buffer. */
25149 if ((row->reversed_p
25150 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= 0)
25151 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos < row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
25153 int on_p = w->phys_cursor_on_p;
25154 int x1;
25155 x1 = draw_glyphs (w, w->phys_cursor.x, row, TEXT_AREA,
25156 w->phys_cursor.hpos, w->phys_cursor.hpos + 1,
25157 hl, 0);
25158 w->phys_cursor_on_p = on_p;
25160 if (hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
25161 w->phys_cursor_width = x1 - w->phys_cursor.x;
25162 /* When we erase the cursor, and ROW is overlapped by other
25163 rows, make sure that these overlapping parts of other rows
25164 are redrawn. */
25165 else if (hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT && row->overlapped_p)
25167 w->phys_cursor_width = x1 - w->phys_cursor.x;
25169 if (row > w->current_matrix->rows
25170 && MATRIX_ROW_OVERLAPS_SUCC_P (row - 1))
25171 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row - 1, TEXT_AREA,
25172 OVERLAPS_ERASED_CURSOR);
25174 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < window_text_bottom_y (w)
25175 && MATRIX_ROW_OVERLAPS_PRED_P (row + 1))
25176 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row + 1, TEXT_AREA,
25177 OVERLAPS_ERASED_CURSOR);
25183 /* EXPORT:
25184 Erase the image of a cursor of window W from the screen. */
25186 void
25187 erase_phys_cursor (struct window *w)
25189 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
25190 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
25191 int hpos = w->phys_cursor.hpos;
25192 int vpos = w->phys_cursor.vpos;
25193 int mouse_face_here_p = 0;
25194 struct glyph_matrix *active_glyphs = w->current_matrix;
25195 struct glyph_row *cursor_row;
25196 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
25197 enum draw_glyphs_face hl;
25199 /* No cursor displayed or row invalidated => nothing to do on the
25200 screen. */
25201 if (w->phys_cursor_type == NO_CURSOR)
25202 goto mark_cursor_off;
25204 /* VPOS >= active_glyphs->nrows means that window has been resized.
25205 Don't bother to erase the cursor. */
25206 if (vpos >= active_glyphs->nrows)
25207 goto mark_cursor_off;
25209 /* If row containing cursor is marked invalid, there is nothing we
25210 can do. */
25211 cursor_row = MATRIX_ROW (active_glyphs, vpos);
25212 if (!cursor_row->enabled_p)
25213 goto mark_cursor_off;
25215 /* If line spacing is > 0, old cursor may only be partially visible in
25216 window after split-window. So adjust visible height. */
25217 cursor_row->visible_height = min (cursor_row->visible_height,
25218 window_text_bottom_y (w) - cursor_row->y);
25220 /* If row is completely invisible, don't attempt to delete a cursor which
25221 isn't there. This can happen if cursor is at top of a window, and
25222 we switch to a buffer with a header line in that window. */
25223 if (cursor_row->visible_height <= 0)
25224 goto mark_cursor_off;
25226 /* If cursor is in the fringe, erase by drawing actual bitmap there. */
25227 if (cursor_row->cursor_in_fringe_p)
25229 cursor_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 0;
25230 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, cursor_row, cursor_row->reversed_p);
25231 goto mark_cursor_off;
25234 /* This can happen when the new row is shorter than the old one.
25235 In this case, either draw_glyphs or clear_end_of_line
25236 should have cleared the cursor. Note that we wouldn't be
25237 able to erase the cursor in this case because we don't have a
25238 cursor glyph at hand. */
25239 if ((cursor_row->reversed_p
25240 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos < 0)
25241 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= cursor_row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
25242 goto mark_cursor_off;
25244 /* If the cursor is in the mouse face area, redisplay that when
25245 we clear the cursor. */
25246 if (! NILP (hlinfo->mouse_face_window)
25247 && coords_in_mouse_face_p (w, hpos, vpos)
25248 /* Don't redraw the cursor's spot in mouse face if it is at the
25249 end of a line (on a newline). The cursor appears there, but
25250 mouse highlighting does not. */
25251 && cursor_row->used[TEXT_AREA] > hpos && hpos >= 0)
25252 mouse_face_here_p = 1;
25254 /* Maybe clear the display under the cursor. */
25255 if (w->phys_cursor_type == HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR)
25257 int x, y, left_x;
25258 int header_line_height = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
25259 int width;
25261 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
25262 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
25263 goto mark_cursor_off;
25265 width = cursor_glyph->pixel_width;
25266 left_x = window_box_left_offset (w, TEXT_AREA);
25267 x = w->phys_cursor.x;
25268 if (x < left_x)
25269 width -= left_x - x;
25270 width = min (width, window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA) - x);
25271 y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height, cursor_row->y));
25272 x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, max (x, left_x));
25274 if (width > 0)
25275 FRAME_RIF (f)->clear_frame_area (f, x, y, width, cursor_row->visible_height);
25278 /* Erase the cursor by redrawing the character underneath it. */
25279 if (mouse_face_here_p)
25280 hl = DRAW_MOUSE_FACE;
25281 else
25282 hl = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
25283 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, cursor_row, hl);
25285 mark_cursor_off:
25286 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
25287 w->phys_cursor_type = NO_CURSOR;
25291 /* EXPORT:
25292 Display or clear cursor of window W. If ON is zero, clear the
25293 cursor. If it is non-zero, display the cursor. If ON is nonzero,
25294 where to put the cursor is specified by HPOS, VPOS, X and Y. */
25296 void
25297 display_and_set_cursor (struct window *w, int on,
25298 int hpos, int vpos, int x, int y)
25300 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
25301 int new_cursor_type;
25302 int new_cursor_width;
25303 int active_cursor;
25304 struct glyph_row *glyph_row;
25305 struct glyph *glyph;
25307 /* This is pointless on invisible frames, and dangerous on garbaged
25308 windows and frames; in the latter case, the frame or window may
25309 be in the midst of changing its size, and x and y may be off the
25310 window. */
25311 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
25312 || FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f)
25313 || vpos >= w->current_matrix->nrows
25314 || hpos >= w->current_matrix->matrix_w)
25315 return;
25317 /* If cursor is off and we want it off, return quickly. */
25318 if (!on && !w->phys_cursor_on_p)
25319 return;
25321 glyph_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
25322 /* If cursor row is not enabled, we don't really know where to
25323 display the cursor. */
25324 if (!glyph_row->enabled_p)
25326 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
25327 return;
25330 glyph = NULL;
25331 if (!glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
25332 || (0 <= hpos && hpos < glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA]))
25333 glyph = glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + hpos;
25335 xassert (interrupt_input_blocked);
25337 /* Set new_cursor_type to the cursor we want to be displayed. */
25338 new_cursor_type = get_window_cursor_type (w, glyph,
25339 &new_cursor_width, &active_cursor);
25341 /* If cursor is currently being shown and we don't want it to be or
25342 it is in the wrong place, or the cursor type is not what we want,
25343 erase it. */
25344 if (w->phys_cursor_on_p
25345 && (!on
25346 || w->phys_cursor.x != x
25347 || w->phys_cursor.y != y
25348 || new_cursor_type != w->phys_cursor_type
25349 || ((new_cursor_type == BAR_CURSOR || new_cursor_type == HBAR_CURSOR)
25350 && new_cursor_width != w->phys_cursor_width)))
25351 erase_phys_cursor (w);
25353 /* Don't check phys_cursor_on_p here because that flag is only set
25354 to zero in some cases where we know that the cursor has been
25355 completely erased, to avoid the extra work of erasing the cursor
25356 twice. In other words, phys_cursor_on_p can be 1 and the cursor
25357 still not be visible, or it has only been partly erased. */
25358 if (on)
25360 w->phys_cursor_ascent = glyph_row->ascent;
25361 w->phys_cursor_height = glyph_row->height;
25363 /* Set phys_cursor_.* before x_draw_.* is called because some
25364 of them may need the information. */
25365 w->phys_cursor.x = x;
25366 w->phys_cursor.y = glyph_row->y;
25367 w->phys_cursor.hpos = hpos;
25368 w->phys_cursor.vpos = vpos;
25371 FRAME_RIF (f)->draw_window_cursor (w, glyph_row, x, y,
25372 new_cursor_type, new_cursor_width,
25373 on, active_cursor);
25377 /* Switch the display of W's cursor on or off, according to the value
25378 of ON. */
25380 static void
25381 update_window_cursor (struct window *w, int on)
25383 /* Don't update cursor in windows whose frame is in the process
25384 of being deleted. */
25385 if (w->current_matrix)
25387 BLOCK_INPUT;
25388 display_and_set_cursor (w, on, w->phys_cursor.hpos, w->phys_cursor.vpos,
25389 w->phys_cursor.x, w->phys_cursor.y);
25390 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
25395 /* Call update_window_cursor with parameter ON_P on all leaf windows
25396 in the window tree rooted at W. */
25398 static void
25399 update_cursor_in_window_tree (struct window *w, int on_p)
25401 while (w)
25403 if (!NILP (w->hchild))
25404 update_cursor_in_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->hchild), on_p);
25405 else if (!NILP (w->vchild))
25406 update_cursor_in_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->vchild), on_p);
25407 else
25408 update_window_cursor (w, on_p);
25410 w = NILP (w->next) ? 0 : XWINDOW (w->next);
25415 /* EXPORT:
25416 Display the cursor on window W, or clear it, according to ON_P.
25417 Don't change the cursor's position. */
25419 void
25420 x_update_cursor (struct frame *f, int on_p)
25422 update_cursor_in_window_tree (XWINDOW (f->root_window), on_p);
25426 /* EXPORT:
25427 Clear the cursor of window W to background color, and mark the
25428 cursor as not shown. This is used when the text where the cursor
25429 is about to be rewritten. */
25431 void
25432 x_clear_cursor (struct window *w)
25434 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (XFRAME (w->frame)) && w->phys_cursor_on_p)
25435 update_window_cursor (w, 0);
25438 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
25440 /* Implementation of draw_row_with_mouse_face for GUI sessions, GPM,
25441 and MSDOS. */
25442 static void
25443 draw_row_with_mouse_face (struct window *w, int start_x, struct glyph_row *row,
25444 int start_hpos, int end_hpos,
25445 enum draw_glyphs_face draw)
25447 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
25448 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (XFRAME (w->frame)))
25450 draw_glyphs (w, start_x, row, TEXT_AREA, start_hpos, end_hpos, draw, 0);
25451 return;
25453 #endif
25454 #if defined (HAVE_GPM) || defined (MSDOS)
25455 tty_draw_row_with_mouse_face (w, row, start_hpos, end_hpos, draw);
25456 #endif
25459 /* Display the active region described by mouse_face_* according to DRAW. */
25461 static void
25462 show_mouse_face (Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo, enum draw_glyphs_face draw)
25464 struct window *w = XWINDOW (hlinfo->mouse_face_window);
25465 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
25467 if (/* If window is in the process of being destroyed, don't bother
25468 to do anything. */
25469 w->current_matrix != NULL
25470 /* Don't update mouse highlight if hidden */
25471 && (draw != DRAW_MOUSE_FACE || !hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
25472 /* Recognize when we are called to operate on rows that don't exist
25473 anymore. This can happen when a window is split. */
25474 && hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row < w->current_matrix->nrows)
25476 int phys_cursor_on_p = w->phys_cursor_on_p;
25477 struct glyph_row *row, *first, *last;
25479 first = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row);
25480 last = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row);
25482 for (row = first; row <= last && row->enabled_p; ++row)
25484 int start_hpos, end_hpos, start_x;
25486 /* For all but the first row, the highlight starts at column 0. */
25487 if (row == first)
25489 /* R2L rows have BEG and END in reversed order, but the
25490 screen drawing geometry is always left to right. So
25491 we need to mirror the beginning and end of the
25492 highlighted area in R2L rows. */
25493 if (!row->reversed_p)
25495 start_hpos = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col;
25496 start_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x;
25498 else if (row == last)
25500 start_hpos = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col;
25501 start_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x;
25503 else
25505 start_hpos = 0;
25506 start_x = 0;
25509 else if (row->reversed_p && row == last)
25511 start_hpos = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col;
25512 start_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x;
25514 else
25516 start_hpos = 0;
25517 start_x = 0;
25520 if (row == last)
25522 if (!row->reversed_p)
25523 end_hpos = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col;
25524 else if (row == first)
25525 end_hpos = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col;
25526 else
25528 end_hpos = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
25529 if (draw == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
25530 row->fill_line_p = 1; /* Clear to end of line */
25533 else if (row->reversed_p && row == first)
25534 end_hpos = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col;
25535 else
25537 end_hpos = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
25538 if (draw == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
25539 row->fill_line_p = 1; /* Clear to end of line */
25542 if (end_hpos > start_hpos)
25544 draw_row_with_mouse_face (w, start_x, row,
25545 start_hpos, end_hpos, draw);
25547 row->mouse_face_p
25548 = draw == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE || draw == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
25552 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
25553 /* When we've written over the cursor, arrange for it to
25554 be displayed again. */
25555 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
25556 && phys_cursor_on_p && !w->phys_cursor_on_p)
25558 BLOCK_INPUT;
25559 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1,
25560 w->phys_cursor.hpos, w->phys_cursor.vpos,
25561 w->phys_cursor.x, w->phys_cursor.y);
25562 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
25564 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
25567 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
25568 /* Change the mouse cursor. */
25569 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
25571 if (draw == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT
25572 && !EQ (hlinfo->mouse_face_window, f->tool_bar_window))
25573 FRAME_RIF (f)->define_frame_cursor (f, FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->text_cursor);
25574 else if (draw == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
25575 FRAME_RIF (f)->define_frame_cursor (f, FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->hand_cursor);
25576 else
25577 FRAME_RIF (f)->define_frame_cursor (f, FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->nontext_cursor);
25579 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
25582 /* EXPORT:
25583 Clear out the mouse-highlighted active region.
25584 Redraw it un-highlighted first. Value is non-zero if mouse
25585 face was actually drawn unhighlighted. */
25588 clear_mouse_face (Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo)
25590 int cleared = 0;
25592 if (!hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden && !NILP (hlinfo->mouse_face_window))
25594 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT);
25595 cleared = 1;
25598 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
25599 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
25600 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
25601 hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
25602 return cleared;
25605 /* Return non-zero if the coordinates HPOS and VPOS on windows W are
25606 within the mouse face on that window. */
25607 static int
25608 coords_in_mouse_face_p (struct window *w, int hpos, int vpos)
25610 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
25612 /* Quickly resolve the easy cases. */
25613 if (!(WINDOWP (hlinfo->mouse_face_window)
25614 && XWINDOW (hlinfo->mouse_face_window) == w))
25615 return 0;
25616 if (vpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
25617 || vpos > hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row)
25618 return 0;
25619 if (vpos > hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
25620 && vpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row)
25621 return 1;
25623 if (!MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos)->reversed_p)
25625 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row == hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row)
25627 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col <= hpos && hpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col)
25628 return 1;
25630 else if ((vpos == hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
25631 && hpos >= hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col)
25632 || (vpos == hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
25633 && hpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col))
25634 return 1;
25636 else
25638 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row == hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row)
25640 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col < hpos && hpos <= hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col)
25641 return 1;
25643 else if ((vpos == hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
25644 && hpos <= hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col)
25645 || (vpos == hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
25646 && hpos > hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col))
25647 return 1;
25649 return 0;
25653 /* EXPORT:
25654 Non-zero if physical cursor of window W is within mouse face. */
25657 cursor_in_mouse_face_p (struct window *w)
25659 return coords_in_mouse_face_p (w, w->phys_cursor.hpos, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
25664 /* Find the glyph rows START_ROW and END_ROW of window W that display
25665 characters between buffer positions START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS
25666 (excluding END_CHARPOS). This is similar to row_containing_pos,
25667 but is more accurate when bidi reordering makes buffer positions
25668 change non-linearly with glyph rows. */
25669 static void
25670 rows_from_pos_range (struct window *w,
25671 EMACS_INT start_charpos, EMACS_INT end_charpos,
25672 struct glyph_row **start, struct glyph_row **end)
25674 struct glyph_row *first = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
25675 int last_y = window_text_bottom_y (w);
25676 struct glyph_row *row;
25678 *start = NULL;
25679 *end = NULL;
25681 while (!first->enabled_p
25682 && first < MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix, w))
25683 first++;
25685 /* Find the START row. */
25686 for (row = first;
25687 row->enabled_p && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) <= last_y;
25688 row++)
25690 /* A row can potentially be the START row if the range of the
25691 characters it displays intersects the range
25692 [START_CHARPOS..END_CHARPOS). */
25693 if (! ((start_charpos < MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row)
25694 && end_charpos < MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row))
25695 /* See the commentary in row_containing_pos, for the
25696 explanation of the complicated way to check whether
25697 some position is beyond the end of the characters
25698 displayed by a row. */
25699 || ((start_charpos > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
25700 || (start_charpos == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
25701 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
25702 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row)))
25703 && (end_charpos > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
25704 || (end_charpos == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
25705 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
25706 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row))))))
25708 /* Found a candidate row. Now make sure at least one of the
25709 glyphs it displays has a charpos from the range
25710 [START_CHARPOS..END_CHARPOS).
25712 This is not obvious because bidi reordering could make
25713 buffer positions of a row be 1,2,3,102,101,100, and if we
25714 want to highlight characters in [50..60), we don't want
25715 this row, even though [50..60) does intersect [1..103),
25716 the range of character positions given by the row's start
25717 and end positions. */
25718 struct glyph *g = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
25719 struct glyph *e = g + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
25721 while (g < e)
25723 if ((BUFFERP (g->object) || INTEGERP (g->object))
25724 && start_charpos <= g->charpos && g->charpos < end_charpos)
25725 *start = row;
25726 g++;
25728 if (*start)
25729 break;
25733 /* Find the END row. */
25734 if (!*start
25735 /* If the last row is partially visible, start looking for END
25736 from that row, instead of starting from FIRST. */
25737 && !(row->enabled_p
25738 && row->y < last_y && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) > last_y))
25739 row = first;
25740 for ( ; row->enabled_p && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) <= last_y; row++)
25742 struct glyph_row *next = row + 1;
25744 if (!next->enabled_p
25745 || next >= MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix, w)
25746 /* The first row >= START whose range of displayed characters
25747 does NOT intersect the range [START_CHARPOS..END_CHARPOS]
25748 is the row END + 1. */
25749 || (start_charpos < MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (next)
25750 && end_charpos < MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (next))
25751 || ((start_charpos > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (next)
25752 || (start_charpos == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (next)
25753 && !next->ends_at_zv_p
25754 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (next)))
25755 && (end_charpos > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (next)
25756 || (end_charpos == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (next)
25757 && !next->ends_at_zv_p
25758 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (next)))))
25760 *end = row;
25761 break;
25763 else
25765 /* If the next row's edges intersect [START_CHARPOS..END_CHARPOS],
25766 but none of the characters it displays are in the range, it is
25767 also END + 1. */
25768 struct glyph *g = next->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
25769 struct glyph *e = g + next->used[TEXT_AREA];
25771 while (g < e)
25773 if ((BUFFERP (g->object) || INTEGERP (g->object))
25774 && start_charpos <= g->charpos && g->charpos < end_charpos)
25775 break;
25776 g++;
25778 if (g == e)
25780 *end = row;
25781 break;
25787 /* This function sets the mouse_face_* elements of HLINFO, assuming
25788 the mouse cursor is on a glyph with buffer charpos MOUSE_CHARPOS in
25789 window WINDOW. START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS are buffer positions
25790 for the overlay or run of text properties specifying the mouse
25791 face. BEFORE_STRING and AFTER_STRING, if non-nil, are a
25792 before-string and after-string that must also be highlighted.
25793 COVER_STRING, if non-nil, is a display string that may cover some
25794 or all of the highlighted text. */
25796 static void
25797 mouse_face_from_buffer_pos (Lisp_Object window,
25798 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo,
25799 EMACS_INT mouse_charpos,
25800 EMACS_INT start_charpos,
25801 EMACS_INT end_charpos,
25802 Lisp_Object before_string,
25803 Lisp_Object after_string,
25804 Lisp_Object cover_string)
25806 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
25807 struct glyph_row *first = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
25808 struct glyph_row *r1, *r2;
25809 struct glyph *glyph, *end;
25810 EMACS_INT ignore, pos;
25811 int x;
25813 xassert (NILP (cover_string) || STRINGP (cover_string));
25814 xassert (NILP (before_string) || STRINGP (before_string));
25815 xassert (NILP (after_string) || STRINGP (after_string));
25817 /* Find the rows corresponding to START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS. */
25818 rows_from_pos_range (w, start_charpos, end_charpos, &r1, &r2);
25819 if (r1 == NULL)
25820 r1 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos));
25821 /* If the before-string or display-string contains newlines,
25822 rows_from_pos_range skips to its last row. Move back. */
25823 if (!NILP (before_string) || !NILP (cover_string))
25825 struct glyph_row *prev;
25826 while ((prev = r1 - 1, prev >= first)
25827 && MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (prev) == start_charpos
25828 && prev->used[TEXT_AREA] > 0)
25830 struct glyph *beg = prev->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
25831 glyph = beg + prev->used[TEXT_AREA];
25832 while (--glyph >= beg && INTEGERP (glyph->object));
25833 if (glyph < beg
25834 || !(EQ (glyph->object, before_string)
25835 || EQ (glyph->object, cover_string)))
25836 break;
25837 r1 = prev;
25840 if (r2 == NULL)
25842 r2 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos));
25843 hlinfo->mouse_face_past_end = 1;
25845 else if (!NILP (after_string))
25847 /* If the after-string has newlines, advance to its last row. */
25848 struct glyph_row *next;
25849 struct glyph_row *last
25850 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos));
25852 for (next = r2 + 1;
25853 next <= last
25854 && next->used[TEXT_AREA] > 0
25855 && EQ (next->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]->object, after_string);
25856 ++next)
25857 r2 = next;
25859 /* The rest of the display engine assumes that mouse_face_beg_row is
25860 either above below mouse_face_end_row or identical to it. But
25861 with bidi-reordered continued lines, the row for START_CHARPOS
25862 could be below the row for END_CHARPOS. If so, swap the rows and
25863 store them in correct order. */
25864 if (r1->y > r2->y)
25866 struct glyph_row *tem = r2;
25868 r2 = r1;
25869 r1 = tem;
25872 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_y = r1->y;
25873 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (r1, w->current_matrix);
25874 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_y = r2->y;
25875 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (r2, w->current_matrix);
25877 /* For a bidi-reordered row, the positions of BEFORE_STRING,
25878 AFTER_STRING, COVER_STRING, START_CHARPOS, and END_CHARPOS
25879 could be anywhere in the row and in any order. The strategy
25880 below is to find the leftmost and the rightmost glyph that
25881 belongs to either of these 3 strings, or whose position is
25882 between START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS, and highlight all the
25883 glyphs between those two. This may cover more than just the text
25884 between START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS if the range of characters
25885 strides the bidi level boundary, e.g. if the beginning is in R2L
25886 text while the end is in L2R text or vice versa. */
25887 if (!r1->reversed_p)
25889 /* This row is in a left to right paragraph. Scan it left to
25890 right. */
25891 glyph = r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
25892 end = glyph + r1->used[TEXT_AREA];
25893 x = r1->x;
25895 /* Skip truncation glyphs at the start of the glyph row. */
25896 if (r1->displays_text_p)
25897 for (; glyph < end
25898 && INTEGERP (glyph->object)
25899 && glyph->charpos < 0;
25900 ++glyph)
25901 x += glyph->pixel_width;
25903 /* Scan the glyph row, looking for BEFORE_STRING, AFTER_STRING,
25904 or COVER_STRING, and the first glyph from buffer whose
25905 position is between START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS. */
25906 for (; glyph < end
25907 && !INTEGERP (glyph->object)
25908 && !EQ (glyph->object, cover_string)
25909 && !(BUFFERP (glyph->object)
25910 && (glyph->charpos >= start_charpos
25911 && glyph->charpos < end_charpos));
25912 ++glyph)
25914 /* BEFORE_STRING or AFTER_STRING are only relevant if they
25915 are present at buffer positions between START_CHARPOS and
25916 END_CHARPOS, or if they come from an overlay. */
25917 if (EQ (glyph->object, before_string))
25919 pos = string_buffer_position (before_string,
25920 start_charpos);
25921 /* If pos == 0, it means before_string came from an
25922 overlay, not from a buffer position. */
25923 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
25924 break;
25926 else if (EQ (glyph->object, after_string))
25928 pos = string_buffer_position (after_string, end_charpos);
25929 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
25930 break;
25932 x += glyph->pixel_width;
25934 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = x;
25935 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = glyph - r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
25937 else
25939 /* This row is in a right to left paragraph. Scan it right to
25940 left. */
25941 struct glyph *g;
25943 end = r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
25944 glyph = end + r1->used[TEXT_AREA];
25946 /* Skip truncation glyphs at the start of the glyph row. */
25947 if (r1->displays_text_p)
25948 for (; glyph > end
25949 && INTEGERP (glyph->object)
25950 && glyph->charpos < 0;
25951 --glyph)
25954 /* Scan the glyph row, looking for BEFORE_STRING, AFTER_STRING,
25955 or COVER_STRING, and the first glyph from buffer whose
25956 position is between START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS. */
25957 for (; glyph > end
25958 && !INTEGERP (glyph->object)
25959 && !EQ (glyph->object, cover_string)
25960 && !(BUFFERP (glyph->object)
25961 && (glyph->charpos >= start_charpos
25962 && glyph->charpos < end_charpos));
25963 --glyph)
25965 /* BEFORE_STRING or AFTER_STRING are only relevant if they
25966 are present at buffer positions between START_CHARPOS and
25967 END_CHARPOS, or if they come from an overlay. */
25968 if (EQ (glyph->object, before_string))
25970 pos = string_buffer_position (before_string, start_charpos);
25971 /* If pos == 0, it means before_string came from an
25972 overlay, not from a buffer position. */
25973 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
25974 break;
25976 else if (EQ (glyph->object, after_string))
25978 pos = string_buffer_position (after_string, end_charpos);
25979 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
25980 break;
25984 glyph++; /* first glyph to the right of the highlighted area */
25985 for (g = r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA], x = r1->x; g < glyph; g++)
25986 x += g->pixel_width;
25987 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = x;
25988 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = glyph - r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
25991 /* If the highlight ends in a different row, compute GLYPH and END
25992 for the end row. Otherwise, reuse the values computed above for
25993 the row where the highlight begins. */
25994 if (r2 != r1)
25996 if (!r2->reversed_p)
25998 glyph = r2->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
25999 end = glyph + r2->used[TEXT_AREA];
26000 x = r2->x;
26002 else
26004 end = r2->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
26005 glyph = end + r2->used[TEXT_AREA];
26009 if (!r2->reversed_p)
26011 /* Skip truncation and continuation glyphs near the end of the
26012 row, and also blanks and stretch glyphs inserted by
26013 extend_face_to_end_of_line. */
26014 while (end > glyph
26015 && INTEGERP ((end - 1)->object)
26016 && (end - 1)->charpos <= 0)
26017 --end;
26018 /* Scan the rest of the glyph row from the end, looking for the
26019 first glyph that comes from BEFORE_STRING, AFTER_STRING, or
26020 COVER_STRING, or whose position is between START_CHARPOS
26021 and END_CHARPOS */
26022 for (--end;
26023 end > glyph
26024 && !INTEGERP (end->object)
26025 && !EQ (end->object, cover_string)
26026 && !(BUFFERP (end->object)
26027 && (end->charpos >= start_charpos
26028 && end->charpos < end_charpos));
26029 --end)
26031 /* BEFORE_STRING or AFTER_STRING are only relevant if they
26032 are present at buffer positions between START_CHARPOS and
26033 END_CHARPOS, or if they come from an overlay. */
26034 if (EQ (end->object, before_string))
26036 pos = string_buffer_position (before_string, start_charpos);
26037 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
26038 break;
26040 else if (EQ (end->object, after_string))
26042 pos = string_buffer_position (after_string, end_charpos);
26043 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
26044 break;
26047 /* Find the X coordinate of the last glyph to be highlighted. */
26048 for (; glyph <= end; ++glyph)
26049 x += glyph->pixel_width;
26051 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = x;
26052 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = glyph - r2->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26054 else
26056 /* Skip truncation and continuation glyphs near the end of the
26057 row, and also blanks and stretch glyphs inserted by
26058 extend_face_to_end_of_line. */
26059 x = r2->x;
26060 end++;
26061 while (end < glyph
26062 && INTEGERP (end->object)
26063 && end->charpos <= 0)
26065 x += end->pixel_width;
26066 ++end;
26068 /* Scan the rest of the glyph row from the end, looking for the
26069 first glyph that comes from BEFORE_STRING, AFTER_STRING, or
26070 COVER_STRING, or whose position is between START_CHARPOS
26071 and END_CHARPOS */
26072 for ( ;
26073 end < glyph
26074 && !INTEGERP (end->object)
26075 && !EQ (end->object, cover_string)
26076 && !(BUFFERP (end->object)
26077 && (end->charpos >= start_charpos
26078 && end->charpos < end_charpos));
26079 ++end)
26081 /* BEFORE_STRING or AFTER_STRING are only relevant if they
26082 are present at buffer positions between START_CHARPOS and
26083 END_CHARPOS, or if they come from an overlay. */
26084 if (EQ (end->object, before_string))
26086 pos = string_buffer_position (before_string, start_charpos);
26087 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
26088 break;
26090 else if (EQ (end->object, after_string))
26092 pos = string_buffer_position (after_string, end_charpos);
26093 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
26094 break;
26096 x += end->pixel_width;
26098 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = x;
26099 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = end - r2->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26102 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
26103 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id
26104 = face_at_buffer_position (w, mouse_charpos, 0, 0, &ignore,
26105 mouse_charpos + 1,
26106 !hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden, -1);
26107 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, DRAW_MOUSE_FACE);
26110 /* The following function is not used anymore (replaced with
26111 mouse_face_from_string_pos), but I leave it here for the time
26112 being, in case someone would. */
26114 #if 0 /* not used */
26116 /* Find the position of the glyph for position POS in OBJECT in
26117 window W's current matrix, and return in *X, *Y the pixel
26118 coordinates, and return in *HPOS, *VPOS the column/row of the glyph.
26120 RIGHT_P non-zero means return the position of the right edge of the
26121 glyph, RIGHT_P zero means return the left edge position.
26123 If no glyph for POS exists in the matrix, return the position of
26124 the glyph with the next smaller position that is in the matrix, if
26125 RIGHT_P is zero. If RIGHT_P is non-zero, and no glyph for POS
26126 exists in the matrix, return the position of the glyph with the
26127 next larger position in OBJECT.
26129 Value is non-zero if a glyph was found. */
26131 static int
26132 fast_find_string_pos (struct window *w, EMACS_INT pos, Lisp_Object object,
26133 int *hpos, int *vpos, int *x, int *y, int right_p)
26135 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
26136 struct glyph_row *r;
26137 struct glyph *best_glyph = NULL;
26138 struct glyph_row *best_row = NULL;
26139 int best_x = 0;
26141 for (r = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
26142 r->enabled_p && r->y < yb;
26143 ++r)
26145 struct glyph *g = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26146 struct glyph *e = g + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
26147 int gx;
26149 for (gx = r->x; g < e; gx += g->pixel_width, ++g)
26150 if (EQ (g->object, object))
26152 if (g->charpos == pos)
26154 best_glyph = g;
26155 best_x = gx;
26156 best_row = r;
26157 goto found;
26159 else if (best_glyph == NULL
26160 || ((eabs (g->charpos - pos)
26161 < eabs (best_glyph->charpos - pos))
26162 && (right_p
26163 ? g->charpos < pos
26164 : g->charpos > pos)))
26166 best_glyph = g;
26167 best_x = gx;
26168 best_row = r;
26173 found:
26175 if (best_glyph)
26177 *x = best_x;
26178 *hpos = best_glyph - best_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26180 if (right_p)
26182 *x += best_glyph->pixel_width;
26183 ++*hpos;
26186 *y = best_row->y;
26187 *vpos = best_row - w->current_matrix->rows;
26190 return best_glyph != NULL;
26192 #endif /* not used */
26194 /* Find the positions of the first and the last glyphs in window W's
26195 current matrix that occlude positions [STARTPOS..ENDPOS] in OBJECT
26196 (assumed to be a string), and return in HLINFO's mouse_face_*
26197 members the pixel and column/row coordinates of those glyphs. */
26199 static void
26200 mouse_face_from_string_pos (struct window *w, Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo,
26201 Lisp_Object object,
26202 EMACS_INT startpos, EMACS_INT endpos)
26204 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
26205 struct glyph_row *r;
26206 struct glyph *g, *e;
26207 int gx;
26208 int found = 0;
26210 /* Find the glyph row with at least one position in the range
26211 [STARTPOS..ENDPOS], and the first glyph in that row whose
26212 position belongs to that range. */
26213 for (r = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
26214 r->enabled_p && r->y < yb;
26215 ++r)
26217 if (!r->reversed_p)
26219 g = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26220 e = g + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
26221 for (gx = r->x; g < e; gx += g->pixel_width, ++g)
26222 if (EQ (g->object, object)
26223 && startpos <= g->charpos && g->charpos <= endpos)
26225 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = r - w->current_matrix->rows;
26226 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_y = r->y;
26227 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = g - r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26228 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = gx;
26229 found = 1;
26230 break;
26233 else
26235 struct glyph *g1;
26237 e = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26238 g = e + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
26239 for ( ; g > e; --g)
26240 if (EQ ((g-1)->object, object)
26241 && startpos <= (g-1)->charpos && (g-1)->charpos <= endpos)
26243 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = r - w->current_matrix->rows;
26244 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_y = r->y;
26245 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = g - r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26246 for (gx = r->x, g1 = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]; g1 < g; ++g1)
26247 gx += g1->pixel_width;
26248 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = gx;
26249 found = 1;
26250 break;
26253 if (found)
26254 break;
26257 if (!found)
26258 return;
26260 /* Starting with the next row, look for the first row which does NOT
26261 include any glyphs whose positions are in the range. */
26262 for (++r; r->enabled_p && r->y < yb; ++r)
26264 g = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26265 e = g + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
26266 found = 0;
26267 for ( ; g < e; ++g)
26268 if (EQ (g->object, object)
26269 && startpos <= g->charpos && g->charpos <= endpos)
26271 found = 1;
26272 break;
26274 if (!found)
26275 break;
26278 /* The highlighted region ends on the previous row. */
26279 r--;
26281 /* Set the end row and its vertical pixel coordinate. */
26282 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = r - w->current_matrix->rows;
26283 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_y = r->y;
26285 /* Compute and set the end column and the end column's horizontal
26286 pixel coordinate. */
26287 if (!r->reversed_p)
26289 g = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26290 e = g + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
26291 for ( ; e > g; --e)
26292 if (EQ ((e-1)->object, object)
26293 && startpos <= (e-1)->charpos && (e-1)->charpos <= endpos)
26294 break;
26295 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = e - g;
26297 for (gx = r->x; g < e; ++g)
26298 gx += g->pixel_width;
26299 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = gx;
26301 else
26303 e = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26304 g = e + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
26305 for (gx = r->x ; e < g; ++e)
26307 if (EQ (e->object, object)
26308 && startpos <= e->charpos && e->charpos <= endpos)
26309 break;
26310 gx += e->pixel_width;
26312 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = e - r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26313 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = gx;
26317 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
26319 /* See if position X, Y is within a hot-spot of an image. */
26321 static int
26322 on_hot_spot_p (Lisp_Object hot_spot, int x, int y)
26324 if (!CONSP (hot_spot))
26325 return 0;
26327 if (EQ (XCAR (hot_spot), Qrect))
26329 /* CDR is (Top-Left . Bottom-Right) = ((x0 . y0) . (x1 . y1)) */
26330 Lisp_Object rect = XCDR (hot_spot);
26331 Lisp_Object tem;
26332 if (!CONSP (rect))
26333 return 0;
26334 if (!CONSP (XCAR (rect)))
26335 return 0;
26336 if (!CONSP (XCDR (rect)))
26337 return 0;
26338 if (!(tem = XCAR (XCAR (rect)), INTEGERP (tem) && x >= XINT (tem)))
26339 return 0;
26340 if (!(tem = XCDR (XCAR (rect)), INTEGERP (tem) && y >= XINT (tem)))
26341 return 0;
26342 if (!(tem = XCAR (XCDR (rect)), INTEGERP (tem) && x <= XINT (tem)))
26343 return 0;
26344 if (!(tem = XCDR (XCDR (rect)), INTEGERP (tem) && y <= XINT (tem)))
26345 return 0;
26346 return 1;
26348 else if (EQ (XCAR (hot_spot), Qcircle))
26350 /* CDR is (Center . Radius) = ((x0 . y0) . r) */
26351 Lisp_Object circ = XCDR (hot_spot);
26352 Lisp_Object lr, lx0, ly0;
26353 if (CONSP (circ)
26354 && CONSP (XCAR (circ))
26355 && (lr = XCDR (circ), INTEGERP (lr) || FLOATP (lr))
26356 && (lx0 = XCAR (XCAR (circ)), INTEGERP (lx0))
26357 && (ly0 = XCDR (XCAR (circ)), INTEGERP (ly0)))
26359 double r = XFLOATINT (lr);
26360 double dx = XINT (lx0) - x;
26361 double dy = XINT (ly0) - y;
26362 return (dx * dx + dy * dy <= r * r);
26365 else if (EQ (XCAR (hot_spot), Qpoly))
26367 /* CDR is [x0 y0 x1 y1 x2 y2 ...x(n-1) y(n-1)] */
26368 if (VECTORP (XCDR (hot_spot)))
26370 struct Lisp_Vector *v = XVECTOR (XCDR (hot_spot));
26371 Lisp_Object *poly = v->contents;
26372 int n = v->header.size;
26373 int i;
26374 int inside = 0;
26375 Lisp_Object lx, ly;
26376 int x0, y0;
26378 /* Need an even number of coordinates, and at least 3 edges. */
26379 if (n < 6 || n & 1)
26380 return 0;
26382 /* Count edge segments intersecting line from (X,Y) to (X,infinity).
26383 If count is odd, we are inside polygon. Pixels on edges
26384 may or may not be included depending on actual geometry of the
26385 polygon. */
26386 if ((lx = poly[n-2], !INTEGERP (lx))
26387 || (ly = poly[n-1], !INTEGERP (lx)))
26388 return 0;
26389 x0 = XINT (lx), y0 = XINT (ly);
26390 for (i = 0; i < n; i += 2)
26392 int x1 = x0, y1 = y0;
26393 if ((lx = poly[i], !INTEGERP (lx))
26394 || (ly = poly[i+1], !INTEGERP (ly)))
26395 return 0;
26396 x0 = XINT (lx), y0 = XINT (ly);
26398 /* Does this segment cross the X line? */
26399 if (x0 >= x)
26401 if (x1 >= x)
26402 continue;
26404 else if (x1 < x)
26405 continue;
26406 if (y > y0 && y > y1)
26407 continue;
26408 if (y < y0 + ((y1 - y0) * (x - x0)) / (x1 - x0))
26409 inside = !inside;
26411 return inside;
26414 return 0;
26417 Lisp_Object
26418 find_hot_spot (Lisp_Object map, int x, int y)
26420 while (CONSP (map))
26422 if (CONSP (XCAR (map))
26423 && on_hot_spot_p (XCAR (XCAR (map)), x, y))
26424 return XCAR (map);
26425 map = XCDR (map);
26428 return Qnil;
26431 DEFUN ("lookup-image-map", Flookup_image_map, Slookup_image_map,
26432 3, 3, 0,
26433 doc: /* Lookup in image map MAP coordinates X and Y.
26434 An image map is an alist where each element has the format (AREA ID PLIST).
26435 An AREA is specified as either a rectangle, a circle, or a polygon:
26436 A rectangle is a cons (rect . ((x0 . y0) . (x1 . y1))) specifying the
26437 pixel coordinates of the upper left and bottom right corners.
26438 A circle is a cons (circle . ((x0 . y0) . r)) specifying the center
26439 and the radius of the circle; r may be a float or integer.
26440 A polygon is a cons (poly . [x0 y0 x1 y1 ...]) where each pair in the
26441 vector describes one corner in the polygon.
26442 Returns the alist element for the first matching AREA in MAP. */)
26443 (Lisp_Object map, Lisp_Object x, Lisp_Object y)
26445 if (NILP (map))
26446 return Qnil;
26448 CHECK_NUMBER (x);
26449 CHECK_NUMBER (y);
26451 return find_hot_spot (map, XINT (x), XINT (y));
26455 /* Display frame CURSOR, optionally using shape defined by POINTER. */
26456 static void
26457 define_frame_cursor1 (struct frame *f, Cursor cursor, Lisp_Object pointer)
26459 /* Do not change cursor shape while dragging mouse. */
26460 if (!NILP (do_mouse_tracking))
26461 return;
26463 if (!NILP (pointer))
26465 if (EQ (pointer, Qarrow))
26466 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->nontext_cursor;
26467 else if (EQ (pointer, Qhand))
26468 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->hand_cursor;
26469 else if (EQ (pointer, Qtext))
26470 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->text_cursor;
26471 else if (EQ (pointer, intern ("hdrag")))
26472 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->horizontal_drag_cursor;
26473 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
26474 else if (EQ (pointer, intern ("vdrag")))
26475 cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
26476 #endif
26477 else if (EQ (pointer, intern ("hourglass")))
26478 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->hourglass_cursor;
26479 else if (EQ (pointer, Qmodeline))
26480 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->modeline_cursor;
26481 else
26482 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->nontext_cursor;
26485 if (cursor != No_Cursor)
26486 FRAME_RIF (f)->define_frame_cursor (f, cursor);
26489 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
26491 /* Take proper action when mouse has moved to the mode or header line
26492 or marginal area AREA of window W, x-position X and y-position Y.
26493 X is relative to the start of the text display area of W, so the
26494 width of bitmap areas and scroll bars must be subtracted to get a
26495 position relative to the start of the mode line. */
26497 static void
26498 note_mode_line_or_margin_highlight (Lisp_Object window, int x, int y,
26499 enum window_part area)
26501 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
26502 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
26503 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
26504 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
26505 Display_Info *dpyinfo;
26506 #endif
26507 Cursor cursor = No_Cursor;
26508 Lisp_Object pointer = Qnil;
26509 int dx, dy, width, height;
26510 EMACS_INT charpos;
26511 Lisp_Object string, object = Qnil;
26512 Lisp_Object pos, help;
26514 Lisp_Object mouse_face;
26515 int original_x_pixel = x;
26516 struct glyph * glyph = NULL, * row_start_glyph = NULL;
26517 struct glyph_row *row;
26519 if (area == ON_MODE_LINE || area == ON_HEADER_LINE)
26521 int x0;
26522 struct glyph *end;
26524 /* Kludge alert: mode_line_string takes X/Y in pixels, but
26525 returns them in row/column units! */
26526 string = mode_line_string (w, area, &x, &y, &charpos,
26527 &object, &dx, &dy, &width, &height);
26529 row = (area == ON_MODE_LINE
26530 ? MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)
26531 : MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix));
26533 /* Find the glyph under the mouse pointer. */
26534 if (row->mode_line_p && row->enabled_p)
26536 glyph = row_start_glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26537 end = glyph + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
26539 for (x0 = original_x_pixel;
26540 glyph < end && x0 >= glyph->pixel_width;
26541 ++glyph)
26542 x0 -= glyph->pixel_width;
26544 if (glyph >= end)
26545 glyph = NULL;
26548 else
26550 x -= WINDOW_LEFT_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (w);
26551 /* Kludge alert: marginal_area_string takes X/Y in pixels, but
26552 returns them in row/column units! */
26553 string = marginal_area_string (w, area, &x, &y, &charpos,
26554 &object, &dx, &dy, &width, &height);
26557 help = Qnil;
26559 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
26560 if (IMAGEP (object))
26562 Lisp_Object image_map, hotspot;
26563 if ((image_map = Fplist_get (XCDR (object), QCmap),
26564 !NILP (image_map))
26565 && (hotspot = find_hot_spot (image_map, dx, dy),
26566 CONSP (hotspot))
26567 && (hotspot = XCDR (hotspot), CONSP (hotspot)))
26569 Lisp_Object plist;
26571 /* Could check XCAR (hotspot) to see if we enter/leave this hot-spot.
26572 If so, we could look for mouse-enter, mouse-leave
26573 properties in PLIST (and do something...). */
26574 hotspot = XCDR (hotspot);
26575 if (CONSP (hotspot)
26576 && (plist = XCAR (hotspot), CONSP (plist)))
26578 pointer = Fplist_get (plist, Qpointer);
26579 if (NILP (pointer))
26580 pointer = Qhand;
26581 help = Fplist_get (plist, Qhelp_echo);
26582 if (!NILP (help))
26584 help_echo_string = help;
26585 /* Is this correct? ++kfs */
26586 XSETWINDOW (help_echo_window, w);
26587 help_echo_object = w->buffer;
26588 help_echo_pos = charpos;
26592 if (NILP (pointer))
26593 pointer = Fplist_get (XCDR (object), QCpointer);
26595 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
26597 if (STRINGP (string))
26599 pos = make_number (charpos);
26600 /* If we're on a string with `help-echo' text property, arrange
26601 for the help to be displayed. This is done by setting the
26602 global variable help_echo_string to the help string. */
26603 if (NILP (help))
26605 help = Fget_text_property (pos, Qhelp_echo, string);
26606 if (!NILP (help))
26608 help_echo_string = help;
26609 XSETWINDOW (help_echo_window, w);
26610 help_echo_object = string;
26611 help_echo_pos = charpos;
26615 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
26616 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
26618 dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
26619 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->nontext_cursor;
26620 if (NILP (pointer))
26621 pointer = Fget_text_property (pos, Qpointer, string);
26623 /* Change the mouse pointer according to what is under X/Y. */
26624 if (NILP (pointer)
26625 && ((area == ON_MODE_LINE) || (area == ON_HEADER_LINE)))
26627 Lisp_Object map;
26628 map = Fget_text_property (pos, Qlocal_map, string);
26629 if (!KEYMAPP (map))
26630 map = Fget_text_property (pos, Qkeymap, string);
26631 if (!KEYMAPP (map))
26632 cursor = dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
26635 #endif
26637 /* Change the mouse face according to what is under X/Y. */
26638 mouse_face = Fget_text_property (pos, Qmouse_face, string);
26639 if (!NILP (mouse_face)
26640 && ((area == ON_MODE_LINE) || (area == ON_HEADER_LINE))
26641 && glyph)
26643 Lisp_Object b, e;
26645 struct glyph * tmp_glyph;
26647 int gpos;
26648 int gseq_length;
26649 int total_pixel_width;
26650 EMACS_INT begpos, endpos, ignore;
26652 int vpos, hpos;
26654 b = Fprevious_single_property_change (make_number (charpos + 1),
26655 Qmouse_face, string, Qnil);
26656 if (NILP (b))
26657 begpos = 0;
26658 else
26659 begpos = XINT (b);
26661 e = Fnext_single_property_change (pos, Qmouse_face, string, Qnil);
26662 if (NILP (e))
26663 endpos = SCHARS (string);
26664 else
26665 endpos = XINT (e);
26667 /* Calculate the glyph position GPOS of GLYPH in the
26668 displayed string, relative to the beginning of the
26669 highlighted part of the string.
26671 Note: GPOS is different from CHARPOS. CHARPOS is the
26672 position of GLYPH in the internal string object. A mode
26673 line string format has structures which are converted to
26674 a flattened string by the Emacs Lisp interpreter. The
26675 internal string is an element of those structures. The
26676 displayed string is the flattened string. */
26677 tmp_glyph = row_start_glyph;
26678 while (tmp_glyph < glyph
26679 && (!(EQ (tmp_glyph->object, glyph->object)
26680 && begpos <= tmp_glyph->charpos
26681 && tmp_glyph->charpos < endpos)))
26682 tmp_glyph++;
26683 gpos = glyph - tmp_glyph;
26685 /* Calculate the length GSEQ_LENGTH of the glyph sequence of
26686 the highlighted part of the displayed string to which
26687 GLYPH belongs. Note: GSEQ_LENGTH is different from
26688 SCHARS (STRING), because the latter returns the length of
26689 the internal string. */
26690 for (tmp_glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
26691 tmp_glyph > glyph
26692 && (!(EQ (tmp_glyph->object, glyph->object)
26693 && begpos <= tmp_glyph->charpos
26694 && tmp_glyph->charpos < endpos));
26695 tmp_glyph--)
26697 gseq_length = gpos + (tmp_glyph - glyph) + 1;
26699 /* Calculate the total pixel width of all the glyphs between
26700 the beginning of the highlighted area and GLYPH. */
26701 total_pixel_width = 0;
26702 for (tmp_glyph = glyph - gpos; tmp_glyph != glyph; tmp_glyph++)
26703 total_pixel_width += tmp_glyph->pixel_width;
26705 /* Pre calculation of re-rendering position. Note: X is in
26706 column units here, after the call to mode_line_string or
26707 marginal_area_string. */
26708 hpos = x - gpos;
26709 vpos = (area == ON_MODE_LINE
26710 ? (w->current_matrix)->nrows - 1
26711 : 0);
26713 /* If GLYPH's position is included in the region that is
26714 already drawn in mouse face, we have nothing to do. */
26715 if ( EQ (window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)
26716 && (!row->reversed_p
26717 ? (hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col <= hpos
26718 && hpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col)
26719 /* In R2L rows we swap BEG and END, see below. */
26720 : (hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col <= hpos
26721 && hpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col))
26722 && hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row == vpos )
26723 return;
26725 if (clear_mouse_face (hlinfo))
26726 cursor = No_Cursor;
26728 if (!row->reversed_p)
26730 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = hpos;
26731 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = original_x_pixel
26732 - (total_pixel_width + dx);
26733 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = hpos + gseq_length;
26734 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = 0;
26736 else
26738 /* In R2L rows, show_mouse_face expects BEG and END
26739 coordinates to be swapped. */
26740 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = hpos;
26741 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = original_x_pixel
26742 - (total_pixel_width + dx);
26743 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = hpos + gseq_length;
26744 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = 0;
26747 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = vpos;
26748 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row;
26749 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_y = 0;
26750 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_y = 0;
26751 hlinfo->mouse_face_past_end = 0;
26752 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
26754 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id = face_at_string_position (w, string,
26755 charpos,
26756 0, 0, 0,
26757 &ignore,
26758 glyph->face_id,
26760 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, DRAW_MOUSE_FACE);
26762 if (NILP (pointer))
26763 pointer = Qhand;
26765 else if ((area == ON_MODE_LINE) || (area == ON_HEADER_LINE))
26766 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
26768 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
26769 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
26770 define_frame_cursor1 (f, cursor, pointer);
26771 #endif
26775 /* EXPORT:
26776 Take proper action when the mouse has moved to position X, Y on
26777 frame F as regards highlighting characters that have mouse-face
26778 properties. Also de-highlighting chars where the mouse was before.
26779 X and Y can be negative or out of range. */
26781 void
26782 note_mouse_highlight (struct frame *f, int x, int y)
26784 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
26785 enum window_part part;
26786 Lisp_Object window;
26787 struct window *w;
26788 Cursor cursor = No_Cursor;
26789 Lisp_Object pointer = Qnil; /* Takes precedence over cursor! */
26790 struct buffer *b;
26792 /* When a menu is active, don't highlight because this looks odd. */
26793 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK) || defined (HAVE_NS) || defined (MSDOS)
26794 if (popup_activated ())
26795 return;
26796 #endif
26798 if (NILP (Vmouse_highlight)
26799 || !f->glyphs_initialized_p
26800 || f->pointer_invisible)
26801 return;
26803 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = x;
26804 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = y;
26805 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = f;
26807 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_defer)
26808 return;
26810 if (gc_in_progress)
26812 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 1;
26813 return;
26816 /* Which window is that in? */
26817 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, &part, 1);
26819 /* If we were displaying active text in another window, clear that.
26820 Also clear if we move out of text area in same window. */
26821 if (! EQ (window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)
26822 || (part != ON_TEXT && part != ON_MODE_LINE && part != ON_HEADER_LINE
26823 && !NILP (hlinfo->mouse_face_window)))
26824 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
26826 /* Not on a window -> return. */
26827 if (!WINDOWP (window))
26828 return;
26830 /* Reset help_echo_string. It will get recomputed below. */
26831 help_echo_string = Qnil;
26833 /* Convert to window-relative pixel coordinates. */
26834 w = XWINDOW (window);
26835 frame_to_window_pixel_xy (w, &x, &y);
26837 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
26838 /* Handle tool-bar window differently since it doesn't display a
26839 buffer. */
26840 if (EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window))
26842 note_tool_bar_highlight (f, x, y);
26843 return;
26845 #endif
26847 /* Mouse is on the mode, header line or margin? */
26848 if (part == ON_MODE_LINE || part == ON_HEADER_LINE
26849 || part == ON_LEFT_MARGIN || part == ON_RIGHT_MARGIN)
26851 note_mode_line_or_margin_highlight (window, x, y, part);
26852 return;
26855 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
26856 if (part == ON_VERTICAL_BORDER)
26858 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->horizontal_drag_cursor;
26859 help_echo_string = build_string ("drag-mouse-1: resize");
26861 else if (part == ON_LEFT_FRINGE || part == ON_RIGHT_FRINGE
26862 || part == ON_SCROLL_BAR)
26863 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->nontext_cursor;
26864 else
26865 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->text_cursor;
26866 #endif
26868 /* Are we in a window whose display is up to date?
26869 And verify the buffer's text has not changed. */
26870 b = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
26871 if (part == ON_TEXT
26872 && EQ (w->window_end_valid, w->buffer)
26873 && XFASTINT (w->last_modified) == BUF_MODIFF (b)
26874 && XFASTINT (w->last_overlay_modified) == BUF_OVERLAY_MODIFF (b))
26876 int hpos, vpos, dx, dy, area;
26877 EMACS_INT pos;
26878 struct glyph *glyph;
26879 Lisp_Object object;
26880 Lisp_Object mouse_face = Qnil, position;
26881 Lisp_Object *overlay_vec = NULL;
26882 ptrdiff_t i, noverlays;
26883 struct buffer *obuf;
26884 EMACS_INT obegv, ozv;
26885 int same_region;
26887 /* Find the glyph under X/Y. */
26888 glyph = x_y_to_hpos_vpos (w, x, y, &hpos, &vpos, &dx, &dy, &area);
26890 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
26891 /* Look for :pointer property on image. */
26892 if (glyph != NULL && glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
26894 struct image *img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (f, glyph->u.img_id);
26895 if (img != NULL && IMAGEP (img->spec))
26897 Lisp_Object image_map, hotspot;
26898 if ((image_map = Fplist_get (XCDR (img->spec), QCmap),
26899 !NILP (image_map))
26900 && (hotspot = find_hot_spot (image_map,
26901 glyph->slice.img.x + dx,
26902 glyph->slice.img.y + dy),
26903 CONSP (hotspot))
26904 && (hotspot = XCDR (hotspot), CONSP (hotspot)))
26906 Lisp_Object plist;
26908 /* Could check XCAR (hotspot) to see if we enter/leave
26909 this hot-spot.
26910 If so, we could look for mouse-enter, mouse-leave
26911 properties in PLIST (and do something...). */
26912 hotspot = XCDR (hotspot);
26913 if (CONSP (hotspot)
26914 && (plist = XCAR (hotspot), CONSP (plist)))
26916 pointer = Fplist_get (plist, Qpointer);
26917 if (NILP (pointer))
26918 pointer = Qhand;
26919 help_echo_string = Fplist_get (plist, Qhelp_echo);
26920 if (!NILP (help_echo_string))
26922 help_echo_window = window;
26923 help_echo_object = glyph->object;
26924 help_echo_pos = glyph->charpos;
26928 if (NILP (pointer))
26929 pointer = Fplist_get (XCDR (img->spec), QCpointer);
26932 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
26934 /* Clear mouse face if X/Y not over text. */
26935 if (glyph == NULL
26936 || area != TEXT_AREA
26937 || !MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos)->displays_text_p
26938 /* Glyph's OBJECT is an integer for glyphs inserted by the
26939 display engine for its internal purposes, like truncation
26940 and continuation glyphs and blanks beyond the end of
26941 line's text on text terminals. If we are over such a
26942 glyph, we are not over any text. */
26943 || INTEGERP (glyph->object)
26944 /* R2L rows have a stretch glyph at their front, which
26945 stands for no text, whereas L2R rows have no glyphs at
26946 all beyond the end of text. Treat such stretch glyphs
26947 like we do with NULL glyphs in L2R rows. */
26948 || (MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos)->reversed_p
26949 && glyph == MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos)->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
26950 && glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
26951 && glyph->avoid_cursor_p))
26953 if (clear_mouse_face (hlinfo))
26954 cursor = No_Cursor;
26955 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
26956 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f) && NILP (pointer))
26958 if (area != TEXT_AREA)
26959 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->nontext_cursor;
26960 else
26961 pointer = Vvoid_text_area_pointer;
26963 #endif
26964 goto set_cursor;
26967 pos = glyph->charpos;
26968 object = glyph->object;
26969 if (!STRINGP (object) && !BUFFERP (object))
26970 goto set_cursor;
26972 /* If we get an out-of-range value, return now; avoid an error. */
26973 if (BUFFERP (object) && pos > BUF_Z (b))
26974 goto set_cursor;
26976 /* Make the window's buffer temporarily current for
26977 overlays_at and compute_char_face. */
26978 obuf = current_buffer;
26979 current_buffer = b;
26980 obegv = BEGV;
26981 ozv = ZV;
26982 BEGV = BEG;
26983 ZV = Z;
26985 /* Is this char mouse-active or does it have help-echo? */
26986 position = make_number (pos);
26988 if (BUFFERP (object))
26990 /* Put all the overlays we want in a vector in overlay_vec. */
26991 GET_OVERLAYS_AT (pos, overlay_vec, noverlays, NULL, 0);
26992 /* Sort overlays into increasing priority order. */
26993 noverlays = sort_overlays (overlay_vec, noverlays, w);
26995 else
26996 noverlays = 0;
26998 same_region = coords_in_mouse_face_p (w, hpos, vpos);
27000 if (same_region)
27001 cursor = No_Cursor;
27003 /* Check mouse-face highlighting. */
27004 if (! same_region
27005 /* If there exists an overlay with mouse-face overlapping
27006 the one we are currently highlighting, we have to
27007 check if we enter the overlapping overlay, and then
27008 highlight only that. */
27009 || (OVERLAYP (hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay)
27010 && mouse_face_overlay_overlaps (hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay)))
27012 /* Find the highest priority overlay with a mouse-face. */
27013 Lisp_Object overlay = Qnil;
27014 for (i = noverlays - 1; i >= 0 && NILP (overlay); --i)
27016 mouse_face = Foverlay_get (overlay_vec[i], Qmouse_face);
27017 if (!NILP (mouse_face))
27018 overlay = overlay_vec[i];
27021 /* If we're highlighting the same overlay as before, there's
27022 no need to do that again. */
27023 if (!NILP (overlay) && EQ (overlay, hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay))
27024 goto check_help_echo;
27025 hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay = overlay;
27027 /* Clear the display of the old active region, if any. */
27028 if (clear_mouse_face (hlinfo))
27029 cursor = No_Cursor;
27031 /* If no overlay applies, get a text property. */
27032 if (NILP (overlay))
27033 mouse_face = Fget_text_property (position, Qmouse_face, object);
27035 /* Next, compute the bounds of the mouse highlighting and
27036 display it. */
27037 if (!NILP (mouse_face) && STRINGP (object))
27039 /* The mouse-highlighting comes from a display string
27040 with a mouse-face. */
27041 Lisp_Object s, e;
27042 EMACS_INT ignore;
27044 s = Fprevious_single_property_change
27045 (make_number (pos + 1), Qmouse_face, object, Qnil);
27046 e = Fnext_single_property_change
27047 (position, Qmouse_face, object, Qnil);
27048 if (NILP (s))
27049 s = make_number (0);
27050 if (NILP (e))
27051 e = make_number (SCHARS (object) - 1);
27052 mouse_face_from_string_pos (w, hlinfo, object,
27053 XINT (s), XINT (e));
27054 hlinfo->mouse_face_past_end = 0;
27055 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
27056 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id
27057 = face_at_string_position (w, object, pos, 0, 0, 0, &ignore,
27058 glyph->face_id, 1);
27059 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, DRAW_MOUSE_FACE);
27060 cursor = No_Cursor;
27062 else
27064 /* The mouse-highlighting, if any, comes from an overlay
27065 or text property in the buffer. */
27066 Lisp_Object buffer IF_LINT (= Qnil);
27067 Lisp_Object cover_string IF_LINT (= Qnil);
27069 if (STRINGP (object))
27071 /* If we are on a display string with no mouse-face,
27072 check if the text under it has one. */
27073 struct glyph_row *r = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
27074 EMACS_INT start = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (r);
27075 pos = string_buffer_position (object, start);
27076 if (pos > 0)
27078 mouse_face = get_char_property_and_overlay
27079 (make_number (pos), Qmouse_face, w->buffer, &overlay);
27080 buffer = w->buffer;
27081 cover_string = object;
27084 else
27086 buffer = object;
27087 cover_string = Qnil;
27090 if (!NILP (mouse_face))
27092 Lisp_Object before, after;
27093 Lisp_Object before_string, after_string;
27094 /* To correctly find the limits of mouse highlight
27095 in a bidi-reordered buffer, we must not use the
27096 optimization of limiting the search in
27097 previous-single-property-change and
27098 next-single-property-change, because
27099 rows_from_pos_range needs the real start and end
27100 positions to DTRT in this case. That's because
27101 the first row visible in a window does not
27102 necessarily display the character whose position
27103 is the smallest. */
27104 Lisp_Object lim1 =
27105 NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (buffer), bidi_display_reordering))
27106 ? Fmarker_position (w->start)
27107 : Qnil;
27108 Lisp_Object lim2 =
27109 NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (buffer), bidi_display_reordering))
27110 ? make_number (BUF_Z (XBUFFER (buffer))
27111 - XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos))
27112 : Qnil;
27114 if (NILP (overlay))
27116 /* Handle the text property case. */
27117 before = Fprevious_single_property_change
27118 (make_number (pos + 1), Qmouse_face, buffer, lim1);
27119 after = Fnext_single_property_change
27120 (make_number (pos), Qmouse_face, buffer, lim2);
27121 before_string = after_string = Qnil;
27123 else
27125 /* Handle the overlay case. */
27126 before = Foverlay_start (overlay);
27127 after = Foverlay_end (overlay);
27128 before_string = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qbefore_string);
27129 after_string = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qafter_string);
27131 if (!STRINGP (before_string)) before_string = Qnil;
27132 if (!STRINGP (after_string)) after_string = Qnil;
27135 mouse_face_from_buffer_pos (window, hlinfo, pos,
27136 XFASTINT (before),
27137 XFASTINT (after),
27138 before_string, after_string,
27139 cover_string);
27140 cursor = No_Cursor;
27145 check_help_echo:
27147 /* Look for a `help-echo' property. */
27148 if (NILP (help_echo_string)) {
27149 Lisp_Object help, overlay;
27151 /* Check overlays first. */
27152 help = overlay = Qnil;
27153 for (i = noverlays - 1; i >= 0 && NILP (help); --i)
27155 overlay = overlay_vec[i];
27156 help = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qhelp_echo);
27159 if (!NILP (help))
27161 help_echo_string = help;
27162 help_echo_window = window;
27163 help_echo_object = overlay;
27164 help_echo_pos = pos;
27166 else
27168 Lisp_Object obj = glyph->object;
27169 EMACS_INT charpos = glyph->charpos;
27171 /* Try text properties. */
27172 if (STRINGP (obj)
27173 && charpos >= 0
27174 && charpos < SCHARS (obj))
27176 help = Fget_text_property (make_number (charpos),
27177 Qhelp_echo, obj);
27178 if (NILP (help))
27180 /* If the string itself doesn't specify a help-echo,
27181 see if the buffer text ``under'' it does. */
27182 struct glyph_row *r
27183 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
27184 EMACS_INT start = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (r);
27185 EMACS_INT p = string_buffer_position (obj, start);
27186 if (p > 0)
27188 help = Fget_char_property (make_number (p),
27189 Qhelp_echo, w->buffer);
27190 if (!NILP (help))
27192 charpos = p;
27193 obj = w->buffer;
27198 else if (BUFFERP (obj)
27199 && charpos >= BEGV
27200 && charpos < ZV)
27201 help = Fget_text_property (make_number (charpos), Qhelp_echo,
27202 obj);
27204 if (!NILP (help))
27206 help_echo_string = help;
27207 help_echo_window = window;
27208 help_echo_object = obj;
27209 help_echo_pos = charpos;
27214 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27215 /* Look for a `pointer' property. */
27216 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f) && NILP (pointer))
27218 /* Check overlays first. */
27219 for (i = noverlays - 1; i >= 0 && NILP (pointer); --i)
27220 pointer = Foverlay_get (overlay_vec[i], Qpointer);
27222 if (NILP (pointer))
27224 Lisp_Object obj = glyph->object;
27225 EMACS_INT charpos = glyph->charpos;
27227 /* Try text properties. */
27228 if (STRINGP (obj)
27229 && charpos >= 0
27230 && charpos < SCHARS (obj))
27232 pointer = Fget_text_property (make_number (charpos),
27233 Qpointer, obj);
27234 if (NILP (pointer))
27236 /* If the string itself doesn't specify a pointer,
27237 see if the buffer text ``under'' it does. */
27238 struct glyph_row *r
27239 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
27240 EMACS_INT start = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (r);
27241 EMACS_INT p = string_buffer_position (obj, start);
27242 if (p > 0)
27243 pointer = Fget_char_property (make_number (p),
27244 Qpointer, w->buffer);
27247 else if (BUFFERP (obj)
27248 && charpos >= BEGV
27249 && charpos < ZV)
27250 pointer = Fget_text_property (make_number (charpos),
27251 Qpointer, obj);
27254 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
27256 BEGV = obegv;
27257 ZV = ozv;
27258 current_buffer = obuf;
27261 set_cursor:
27263 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27264 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
27265 define_frame_cursor1 (f, cursor, pointer);
27266 #else
27267 /* This is here to prevent a compiler error, about "label at end of
27268 compound statement". */
27269 return;
27270 #endif
27274 /* EXPORT for RIF:
27275 Clear any mouse-face on window W. This function is part of the
27276 redisplay interface, and is called from try_window_id and similar
27277 functions to ensure the mouse-highlight is off. */
27279 void
27280 x_clear_window_mouse_face (struct window *w)
27282 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
27283 Lisp_Object window;
27285 BLOCK_INPUT;
27286 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
27287 if (EQ (window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window))
27288 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
27289 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
27293 /* EXPORT:
27294 Just discard the mouse face information for frame F, if any.
27295 This is used when the size of F is changed. */
27297 void
27298 cancel_mouse_face (struct frame *f)
27300 Lisp_Object window;
27301 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
27303 window = hlinfo->mouse_face_window;
27304 if (! NILP (window) && XFRAME (XWINDOW (window)->frame) == f)
27306 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
27307 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
27308 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
27314 /***********************************************************************
27315 Exposure Events
27316 ***********************************************************************/
27318 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27320 /* Redraw the part of glyph row area AREA of glyph row ROW on window W
27321 which intersects rectangle R. R is in window-relative coordinates. */
27323 static void
27324 expose_area (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, XRectangle *r,
27325 enum glyph_row_area area)
27327 struct glyph *first = row->glyphs[area];
27328 struct glyph *end = row->glyphs[area] + row->used[area];
27329 struct glyph *last;
27330 int first_x, start_x, x;
27332 if (area == TEXT_AREA && row->fill_line_p)
27333 /* If row extends face to end of line write the whole line. */
27334 draw_glyphs (w, 0, row, area,
27335 0, row->used[area],
27336 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
27337 else
27339 /* Set START_X to the window-relative start position for drawing glyphs of
27340 AREA. The first glyph of the text area can be partially visible.
27341 The first glyphs of other areas cannot. */
27342 start_x = window_box_left_offset (w, area);
27343 x = start_x;
27344 if (area == TEXT_AREA)
27345 x += row->x;
27347 /* Find the first glyph that must be redrawn. */
27348 while (first < end
27349 && x + first->pixel_width < r->x)
27351 x += first->pixel_width;
27352 ++first;
27355 /* Find the last one. */
27356 last = first;
27357 first_x = x;
27358 while (last < end
27359 && x < r->x + r->width)
27361 x += last->pixel_width;
27362 ++last;
27365 /* Repaint. */
27366 if (last > first)
27367 draw_glyphs (w, first_x - start_x, row, area,
27368 first - row->glyphs[area], last - row->glyphs[area],
27369 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
27374 /* Redraw the parts of the glyph row ROW on window W intersecting
27375 rectangle R. R is in window-relative coordinates. Value is
27376 non-zero if mouse-face was overwritten. */
27378 static int
27379 expose_line (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, XRectangle *r)
27381 xassert (row->enabled_p);
27383 if (row->mode_line_p || w->pseudo_window_p)
27384 draw_glyphs (w, 0, row, TEXT_AREA,
27385 0, row->used[TEXT_AREA],
27386 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
27387 else
27389 if (row->used[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA])
27390 expose_area (w, row, r, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA);
27391 if (row->used[TEXT_AREA])
27392 expose_area (w, row, r, TEXT_AREA);
27393 if (row->used[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA])
27394 expose_area (w, row, r, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA);
27395 draw_row_fringe_bitmaps (w, row);
27398 return row->mouse_face_p;
27402 /* Redraw those parts of glyphs rows during expose event handling that
27403 overlap other rows. Redrawing of an exposed line writes over parts
27404 of lines overlapping that exposed line; this function fixes that.
27406 W is the window being exposed. FIRST_OVERLAPPING_ROW is the first
27407 row in W's current matrix that is exposed and overlaps other rows.
27408 LAST_OVERLAPPING_ROW is the last such row. */
27410 static void
27411 expose_overlaps (struct window *w,
27412 struct glyph_row *first_overlapping_row,
27413 struct glyph_row *last_overlapping_row,
27414 XRectangle *r)
27416 struct glyph_row *row;
27418 for (row = first_overlapping_row; row <= last_overlapping_row; ++row)
27419 if (row->overlapping_p)
27421 xassert (row->enabled_p && !row->mode_line_p);
27423 row->clip = r;
27424 if (row->used[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA])
27425 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA, OVERLAPS_BOTH);
27427 if (row->used[TEXT_AREA])
27428 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row, TEXT_AREA, OVERLAPS_BOTH);
27430 if (row->used[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA])
27431 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA, OVERLAPS_BOTH);
27432 row->clip = NULL;
27437 /* Return non-zero if W's cursor intersects rectangle R. */
27439 static int
27440 phys_cursor_in_rect_p (struct window *w, XRectangle *r)
27442 XRectangle cr, result;
27443 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
27444 struct glyph_row *row;
27446 if (w->phys_cursor.vpos >= 0
27447 && w->phys_cursor.vpos < w->current_matrix->nrows
27448 && (row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos),
27449 row->enabled_p)
27450 && row->cursor_in_fringe_p)
27452 /* Cursor is in the fringe. */
27453 cr.x = window_box_right_offset (w,
27454 (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
27455 ? RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA
27456 : TEXT_AREA));
27457 cr.y = row->y;
27458 cr.width = WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w);
27459 cr.height = row->height;
27460 return x_intersect_rectangles (&cr, r, &result);
27463 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
27464 if (cursor_glyph)
27466 /* r is relative to W's box, but w->phys_cursor.x is relative
27467 to left edge of W's TEXT area. Adjust it. */
27468 cr.x = window_box_left_offset (w, TEXT_AREA) + w->phys_cursor.x;
27469 cr.y = w->phys_cursor.y;
27470 cr.width = cursor_glyph->pixel_width;
27471 cr.height = w->phys_cursor_height;
27472 /* ++KFS: W32 version used W32-specific IntersectRect here, but
27473 I assume the effect is the same -- and this is portable. */
27474 return x_intersect_rectangles (&cr, r, &result);
27476 /* If we don't understand the format, pretend we're not in the hot-spot. */
27477 return 0;
27481 /* EXPORT:
27482 Draw a vertical window border to the right of window W if W doesn't
27483 have vertical scroll bars. */
27485 void
27486 x_draw_vertical_border (struct window *w)
27488 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
27490 /* We could do better, if we knew what type of scroll-bar the adjacent
27491 windows (on either side) have... But we don't :-(
27492 However, I think this works ok. ++KFS 2003-04-25 */
27494 /* Redraw borders between horizontally adjacent windows. Don't
27495 do it for frames with vertical scroll bars because either the
27496 right scroll bar of a window, or the left scroll bar of its
27497 neighbor will suffice as a border. */
27498 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (w->frame)))
27499 return;
27501 if (!WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
27502 && !WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
27504 int x0, x1, y0, y1;
27506 window_box_edges (w, -1, &x0, &y0, &x1, &y1);
27507 y1 -= 1;
27509 if (WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w) == 0)
27510 x1 -= 1;
27512 FRAME_RIF (f)->draw_vertical_window_border (w, x1, y0, y1);
27514 else if (!WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
27515 && !WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
27517 int x0, x1, y0, y1;
27519 window_box_edges (w, -1, &x0, &y0, &x1, &y1);
27520 y1 -= 1;
27522 if (WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w) == 0)
27523 x0 -= 1;
27525 FRAME_RIF (f)->draw_vertical_window_border (w, x0, y0, y1);
27530 /* Redraw the part of window W intersection rectangle FR. Pixel
27531 coordinates in FR are frame-relative. Call this function with
27532 input blocked. Value is non-zero if the exposure overwrites
27533 mouse-face. */
27535 static int
27536 expose_window (struct window *w, XRectangle *fr)
27538 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
27539 XRectangle wr, r;
27540 int mouse_face_overwritten_p = 0;
27542 /* If window is not yet fully initialized, do nothing. This can
27543 happen when toolkit scroll bars are used and a window is split.
27544 Reconfiguring the scroll bar will generate an expose for a newly
27545 created window. */
27546 if (w->current_matrix == NULL)
27547 return 0;
27549 /* When we're currently updating the window, display and current
27550 matrix usually don't agree. Arrange for a thorough display
27551 later. */
27552 if (w == updated_window)
27554 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
27555 return 0;
27558 /* Frame-relative pixel rectangle of W. */
27559 wr.x = WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w);
27560 wr.y = WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_Y (w);
27561 wr.width = WINDOW_TOTAL_WIDTH (w);
27562 wr.height = WINDOW_TOTAL_HEIGHT (w);
27564 if (x_intersect_rectangles (fr, &wr, &r))
27566 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
27567 struct glyph_row *row;
27568 int cursor_cleared_p, phys_cursor_on_p;
27569 struct glyph_row *first_overlapping_row, *last_overlapping_row;
27571 TRACE ((stderr, "expose_window (%d, %d, %d, %d)\n",
27572 r.x, r.y, r.width, r.height));
27574 /* Convert to window coordinates. */
27575 r.x -= WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w);
27576 r.y -= WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_Y (w);
27578 /* Turn off the cursor. */
27579 if (!w->pseudo_window_p
27580 && phys_cursor_in_rect_p (w, &r))
27582 x_clear_cursor (w);
27583 cursor_cleared_p = 1;
27585 else
27586 cursor_cleared_p = 0;
27588 /* If the row containing the cursor extends face to end of line,
27589 then expose_area might overwrite the cursor outside the
27590 rectangle and thus notice_overwritten_cursor might clear
27591 w->phys_cursor_on_p. We remember the original value and
27592 check later if it is changed. */
27593 phys_cursor_on_p = w->phys_cursor_on_p;
27595 /* Update lines intersecting rectangle R. */
27596 first_overlapping_row = last_overlapping_row = NULL;
27597 for (row = w->current_matrix->rows;
27598 row->enabled_p;
27599 ++row)
27601 int y0 = row->y;
27602 int y1 = MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row);
27604 if ((y0 >= r.y && y0 < r.y + r.height)
27605 || (y1 > r.y && y1 < r.y + r.height)
27606 || (r.y >= y0 && r.y < y1)
27607 || (r.y + r.height > y0 && r.y + r.height < y1))
27609 /* A header line may be overlapping, but there is no need
27610 to fix overlapping areas for them. KFS 2005-02-12 */
27611 if (row->overlapping_p && !row->mode_line_p)
27613 if (first_overlapping_row == NULL)
27614 first_overlapping_row = row;
27615 last_overlapping_row = row;
27618 row->clip = fr;
27619 if (expose_line (w, row, &r))
27620 mouse_face_overwritten_p = 1;
27621 row->clip = NULL;
27623 else if (row->overlapping_p)
27625 /* We must redraw a row overlapping the exposed area. */
27626 if (y0 < r.y
27627 ? y0 + row->phys_height > r.y
27628 : y0 + row->ascent - row->phys_ascent < r.y +r.height)
27630 if (first_overlapping_row == NULL)
27631 first_overlapping_row = row;
27632 last_overlapping_row = row;
27636 if (y1 >= yb)
27637 break;
27640 /* Display the mode line if there is one. */
27641 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w)
27642 && (row = MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix),
27643 row->enabled_p)
27644 && row->y < r.y + r.height)
27646 if (expose_line (w, row, &r))
27647 mouse_face_overwritten_p = 1;
27650 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
27652 /* Fix the display of overlapping rows. */
27653 if (first_overlapping_row)
27654 expose_overlaps (w, first_overlapping_row, last_overlapping_row,
27655 fr);
27657 /* Draw border between windows. */
27658 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
27660 /* Turn the cursor on again. */
27661 if (cursor_cleared_p
27662 || (phys_cursor_on_p && !w->phys_cursor_on_p))
27663 update_window_cursor (w, 1);
27667 return mouse_face_overwritten_p;
27672 /* Redraw (parts) of all windows in the window tree rooted at W that
27673 intersect R. R contains frame pixel coordinates. Value is
27674 non-zero if the exposure overwrites mouse-face. */
27676 static int
27677 expose_window_tree (struct window *w, XRectangle *r)
27679 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
27680 int mouse_face_overwritten_p = 0;
27682 while (w && !FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
27684 if (!NILP (w->hchild))
27685 mouse_face_overwritten_p
27686 |= expose_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->hchild), r);
27687 else if (!NILP (w->vchild))
27688 mouse_face_overwritten_p
27689 |= expose_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->vchild), r);
27690 else
27691 mouse_face_overwritten_p |= expose_window (w, r);
27693 w = NILP (w->next) ? NULL : XWINDOW (w->next);
27696 return mouse_face_overwritten_p;
27700 /* EXPORT:
27701 Redisplay an exposed area of frame F. X and Y are the upper-left
27702 corner of the exposed rectangle. W and H are width and height of
27703 the exposed area. All are pixel values. W or H zero means redraw
27704 the entire frame. */
27706 void
27707 expose_frame (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int w, int h)
27709 XRectangle r;
27710 int mouse_face_overwritten_p = 0;
27712 TRACE ((stderr, "expose_frame "));
27714 /* No need to redraw if frame will be redrawn soon. */
27715 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
27717 TRACE ((stderr, " garbaged\n"));
27718 return;
27721 /* If basic faces haven't been realized yet, there is no point in
27722 trying to redraw anything. This can happen when we get an expose
27723 event while Emacs is starting, e.g. by moving another window. */
27724 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f) == NULL
27725 || FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f)->used < BASIC_FACE_ID_SENTINEL)
27727 TRACE ((stderr, " no faces\n"));
27728 return;
27731 if (w == 0 || h == 0)
27733 r.x = r.y = 0;
27734 r.width = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) * FRAME_COLS (f);
27735 r.height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) * FRAME_LINES (f);
27737 else
27739 r.x = x;
27740 r.y = y;
27741 r.width = w;
27742 r.height = h;
27745 TRACE ((stderr, "(%d, %d, %d, %d)\n", r.x, r.y, r.width, r.height));
27746 mouse_face_overwritten_p = expose_window_tree (XWINDOW (f->root_window), &r);
27748 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window))
27749 mouse_face_overwritten_p
27750 |= expose_window (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window), &r);
27752 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
27753 #ifndef MSDOS
27754 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
27755 if (WINDOWP (f->menu_bar_window))
27756 mouse_face_overwritten_p
27757 |= expose_window (XWINDOW (f->menu_bar_window), &r);
27758 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
27759 #endif
27760 #endif
27762 /* Some window managers support a focus-follows-mouse style with
27763 delayed raising of frames. Imagine a partially obscured frame,
27764 and moving the mouse into partially obscured mouse-face on that
27765 frame. The visible part of the mouse-face will be highlighted,
27766 then the WM raises the obscured frame. With at least one WM, KDE
27767 2.1, Emacs is not getting any event for the raising of the frame
27768 (even tried with SubstructureRedirectMask), only Expose events.
27769 These expose events will draw text normally, i.e. not
27770 highlighted. Which means we must redo the highlight here.
27771 Subsume it under ``we love X''. --gerd 2001-08-15 */
27772 /* Included in Windows version because Windows most likely does not
27773 do the right thing if any third party tool offers
27774 focus-follows-mouse with delayed raise. --jason 2001-10-12 */
27775 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p && !FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
27777 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
27778 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
27780 int mouse_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x;
27781 int mouse_y = hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y;
27782 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
27783 note_mouse_highlight (f, mouse_x, mouse_y);
27789 /* EXPORT:
27790 Determine the intersection of two rectangles R1 and R2. Return
27791 the intersection in *RESULT. Value is non-zero if RESULT is not
27792 empty. */
27795 x_intersect_rectangles (XRectangle *r1, XRectangle *r2, XRectangle *result)
27797 XRectangle *left, *right;
27798 XRectangle *upper, *lower;
27799 int intersection_p = 0;
27801 /* Rearrange so that R1 is the left-most rectangle. */
27802 if (r1->x < r2->x)
27803 left = r1, right = r2;
27804 else
27805 left = r2, right = r1;
27807 /* X0 of the intersection is right.x0, if this is inside R1,
27808 otherwise there is no intersection. */
27809 if (right->x <= left->x + left->width)
27811 result->x = right->x;
27813 /* The right end of the intersection is the minimum of
27814 the right ends of left and right. */
27815 result->width = (min (left->x + left->width, right->x + right->width)
27816 - result->x);
27818 /* Same game for Y. */
27819 if (r1->y < r2->y)
27820 upper = r1, lower = r2;
27821 else
27822 upper = r2, lower = r1;
27824 /* The upper end of the intersection is lower.y0, if this is inside
27825 of upper. Otherwise, there is no intersection. */
27826 if (lower->y <= upper->y + upper->height)
27828 result->y = lower->y;
27830 /* The lower end of the intersection is the minimum of the lower
27831 ends of upper and lower. */
27832 result->height = (min (lower->y + lower->height,
27833 upper->y + upper->height)
27834 - result->y);
27835 intersection_p = 1;
27839 return intersection_p;
27842 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
27845 /***********************************************************************
27846 Initialization
27847 ***********************************************************************/
27849 void
27850 syms_of_xdisp (void)
27852 Vwith_echo_area_save_vector = Qnil;
27853 staticpro (&Vwith_echo_area_save_vector);
27855 Vmessage_stack = Qnil;
27856 staticpro (&Vmessage_stack);
27858 DEFSYM (Qinhibit_redisplay, "inhibit-redisplay");
27860 message_dolog_marker1 = Fmake_marker ();
27861 staticpro (&message_dolog_marker1);
27862 message_dolog_marker2 = Fmake_marker ();
27863 staticpro (&message_dolog_marker2);
27864 message_dolog_marker3 = Fmake_marker ();
27865 staticpro (&message_dolog_marker3);
27867 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
27868 defsubr (&Sdump_frame_glyph_matrix);
27869 defsubr (&Sdump_glyph_matrix);
27870 defsubr (&Sdump_glyph_row);
27871 defsubr (&Sdump_tool_bar_row);
27872 defsubr (&Strace_redisplay);
27873 defsubr (&Strace_to_stderr);
27874 #endif
27875 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27876 defsubr (&Stool_bar_lines_needed);
27877 defsubr (&Slookup_image_map);
27878 #endif
27879 defsubr (&Sformat_mode_line);
27880 defsubr (&Sinvisible_p);
27881 defsubr (&Scurrent_bidi_paragraph_direction);
27883 DEFSYM (Qmenu_bar_update_hook, "menu-bar-update-hook");
27884 DEFSYM (Qoverriding_terminal_local_map, "overriding-terminal-local-map");
27885 DEFSYM (Qoverriding_local_map, "overriding-local-map");
27886 DEFSYM (Qwindow_scroll_functions, "window-scroll-functions");
27887 DEFSYM (Qwindow_text_change_functions, "window-text-change-functions");
27888 DEFSYM (Qredisplay_end_trigger_functions, "redisplay-end-trigger-functions");
27889 DEFSYM (Qinhibit_point_motion_hooks, "inhibit-point-motion-hooks");
27890 DEFSYM (Qeval, "eval");
27891 DEFSYM (QCdata, ":data");
27892 DEFSYM (Qdisplay, "display");
27893 DEFSYM (Qspace_width, "space-width");
27894 DEFSYM (Qraise, "raise");
27895 DEFSYM (Qslice, "slice");
27896 DEFSYM (Qspace, "space");
27897 DEFSYM (Qmargin, "margin");
27898 DEFSYM (Qpointer, "pointer");
27899 DEFSYM (Qleft_margin, "left-margin");
27900 DEFSYM (Qright_margin, "right-margin");
27901 DEFSYM (Qcenter, "center");
27902 DEFSYM (Qline_height, "line-height");
27903 DEFSYM (QCalign_to, ":align-to");
27904 DEFSYM (QCrelative_width, ":relative-width");
27905 DEFSYM (QCrelative_height, ":relative-height");
27906 DEFSYM (QCeval, ":eval");
27907 DEFSYM (QCpropertize, ":propertize");
27908 DEFSYM (QCfile, ":file");
27909 DEFSYM (Qfontified, "fontified");
27910 DEFSYM (Qfontification_functions, "fontification-functions");
27911 DEFSYM (Qtrailing_whitespace, "trailing-whitespace");
27912 DEFSYM (Qescape_glyph, "escape-glyph");
27913 DEFSYM (Qnobreak_space, "nobreak-space");
27914 DEFSYM (Qimage, "image");
27915 DEFSYM (Qtext, "text");
27916 DEFSYM (Qboth, "both");
27917 DEFSYM (Qboth_horiz, "both-horiz");
27918 DEFSYM (Qtext_image_horiz, "text-image-horiz");
27919 DEFSYM (QCmap, ":map");
27920 DEFSYM (QCpointer, ":pointer");
27921 DEFSYM (Qrect, "rect");
27922 DEFSYM (Qcircle, "circle");
27923 DEFSYM (Qpoly, "poly");
27924 DEFSYM (Qmessage_truncate_lines, "message-truncate-lines");
27925 DEFSYM (Qgrow_only, "grow-only");
27926 DEFSYM (Qinhibit_menubar_update, "inhibit-menubar-update");
27927 DEFSYM (Qinhibit_eval_during_redisplay, "inhibit-eval-during-redisplay");
27928 DEFSYM (Qposition, "position");
27929 DEFSYM (Qbuffer_position, "buffer-position");
27930 DEFSYM (Qobject, "object");
27931 DEFSYM (Qbar, "bar");
27932 DEFSYM (Qhbar, "hbar");
27933 DEFSYM (Qbox, "box");
27934 DEFSYM (Qhollow, "hollow");
27935 DEFSYM (Qhand, "hand");
27936 DEFSYM (Qarrow, "arrow");
27937 DEFSYM (Qtext, "text");
27938 DEFSYM (Qinhibit_free_realized_faces, "inhibit-free-realized-faces");
27940 list_of_error = Fcons (Fcons (intern_c_string ("error"),
27941 Fcons (intern_c_string ("void-variable"), Qnil)),
27942 Qnil);
27943 staticpro (&list_of_error);
27945 DEFSYM (Qlast_arrow_position, "last-arrow-position");
27946 DEFSYM (Qlast_arrow_string, "last-arrow-string");
27947 DEFSYM (Qoverlay_arrow_string, "overlay-arrow-string");
27948 DEFSYM (Qoverlay_arrow_bitmap, "overlay-arrow-bitmap");
27950 echo_buffer[0] = echo_buffer[1] = Qnil;
27951 staticpro (&echo_buffer[0]);
27952 staticpro (&echo_buffer[1]);
27954 echo_area_buffer[0] = echo_area_buffer[1] = Qnil;
27955 staticpro (&echo_area_buffer[0]);
27956 staticpro (&echo_area_buffer[1]);
27958 Vmessages_buffer_name = make_pure_c_string ("*Messages*");
27959 staticpro (&Vmessages_buffer_name);
27961 mode_line_proptrans_alist = Qnil;
27962 staticpro (&mode_line_proptrans_alist);
27963 mode_line_string_list = Qnil;
27964 staticpro (&mode_line_string_list);
27965 mode_line_string_face = Qnil;
27966 staticpro (&mode_line_string_face);
27967 mode_line_string_face_prop = Qnil;
27968 staticpro (&mode_line_string_face_prop);
27969 Vmode_line_unwind_vector = Qnil;
27970 staticpro (&Vmode_line_unwind_vector);
27972 help_echo_string = Qnil;
27973 staticpro (&help_echo_string);
27974 help_echo_object = Qnil;
27975 staticpro (&help_echo_object);
27976 help_echo_window = Qnil;
27977 staticpro (&help_echo_window);
27978 previous_help_echo_string = Qnil;
27979 staticpro (&previous_help_echo_string);
27980 help_echo_pos = -1;
27982 DEFSYM (Qright_to_left, "right-to-left");
27983 DEFSYM (Qleft_to_right, "left-to-right");
27985 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27986 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-stretch-cursor", x_stretch_cursor_p,
27987 doc: /* *Non-nil means draw block cursor as wide as the glyph under it.
27988 For example, if a block cursor is over a tab, it will be drawn as
27989 wide as that tab on the display. */);
27990 x_stretch_cursor_p = 0;
27991 #endif
27993 DEFVAR_LISP ("show-trailing-whitespace", Vshow_trailing_whitespace,
27994 doc: /* *Non-nil means highlight trailing whitespace.
27995 The face used for trailing whitespace is `trailing-whitespace'. */);
27996 Vshow_trailing_whitespace = Qnil;
27998 DEFVAR_LISP ("nobreak-char-display", Vnobreak_char_display,
27999 doc: /* *Control highlighting of nobreak space and soft hyphen.
28000 A value of t means highlight the character itself (for nobreak space,
28001 use face `nobreak-space').
28002 A value of nil means no highlighting.
28003 Other values mean display the escape glyph followed by an ordinary
28004 space or ordinary hyphen. */);
28005 Vnobreak_char_display = Qt;
28007 DEFVAR_LISP ("void-text-area-pointer", Vvoid_text_area_pointer,
28008 doc: /* *The pointer shape to show in void text areas.
28009 A value of nil means to show the text pointer. Other options are `arrow',
28010 `text', `hand', `vdrag', `hdrag', `modeline', and `hourglass'. */);
28011 Vvoid_text_area_pointer = Qarrow;
28013 DEFVAR_LISP ("inhibit-redisplay", Vinhibit_redisplay,
28014 doc: /* Non-nil means don't actually do any redisplay.
28015 This is used for internal purposes. */);
28016 Vinhibit_redisplay = Qnil;
28018 DEFVAR_LISP ("global-mode-string", Vglobal_mode_string,
28019 doc: /* String (or mode line construct) included (normally) in `mode-line-format'. */);
28020 Vglobal_mode_string = Qnil;
28022 DEFVAR_LISP ("overlay-arrow-position", Voverlay_arrow_position,
28023 doc: /* Marker for where to display an arrow on top of the buffer text.
28024 This must be the beginning of a line in order to work.
28025 See also `overlay-arrow-string'. */);
28026 Voverlay_arrow_position = Qnil;
28028 DEFVAR_LISP ("overlay-arrow-string", Voverlay_arrow_string,
28029 doc: /* String to display as an arrow in non-window frames.
28030 See also `overlay-arrow-position'. */);
28031 Voverlay_arrow_string = make_pure_c_string ("=>");
28033 DEFVAR_LISP ("overlay-arrow-variable-list", Voverlay_arrow_variable_list,
28034 doc: /* List of variables (symbols) which hold markers for overlay arrows.
28035 The symbols on this list are examined during redisplay to determine
28036 where to display overlay arrows. */);
28037 Voverlay_arrow_variable_list
28038 = Fcons (intern_c_string ("overlay-arrow-position"), Qnil);
28040 DEFVAR_INT ("scroll-step", emacs_scroll_step,
28041 doc: /* *The number of lines to try scrolling a window by when point moves out.
28042 If that fails to bring point back on frame, point is centered instead.
28043 If this is zero, point is always centered after it moves off frame.
28044 If you want scrolling to always be a line at a time, you should set
28045 `scroll-conservatively' to a large value rather than set this to 1. */);
28047 DEFVAR_INT ("scroll-conservatively", scroll_conservatively,
28048 doc: /* *Scroll up to this many lines, to bring point back on screen.
28049 If point moves off-screen, redisplay will scroll by up to
28050 `scroll-conservatively' lines in order to bring point just barely
28051 onto the screen again. If that cannot be done, then redisplay
28052 recenters point as usual.
28054 If the value is greater than 100, redisplay will never recenter point,
28055 but will always scroll just enough text to bring point into view, even
28056 if you move far away.
28058 A value of zero means always recenter point if it moves off screen. */);
28059 scroll_conservatively = 0;
28061 DEFVAR_INT ("scroll-margin", scroll_margin,
28062 doc: /* *Number of lines of margin at the top and bottom of a window.
28063 Recenter the window whenever point gets within this many lines
28064 of the top or bottom of the window. */);
28065 scroll_margin = 0;
28067 DEFVAR_LISP ("display-pixels-per-inch", Vdisplay_pixels_per_inch,
28068 doc: /* Pixels per inch value for non-window system displays.
28069 Value is a number or a cons (WIDTH-DPI . HEIGHT-DPI). */);
28070 Vdisplay_pixels_per_inch = make_float (72.0);
28072 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
28073 DEFVAR_INT ("debug-end-pos", debug_end_pos, doc: /* Don't ask. */);
28074 #endif
28076 DEFVAR_LISP ("truncate-partial-width-windows",
28077 Vtruncate_partial_width_windows,
28078 doc: /* Non-nil means truncate lines in windows narrower than the frame.
28079 For an integer value, truncate lines in each window narrower than the
28080 full frame width, provided the window width is less than that integer;
28081 otherwise, respect the value of `truncate-lines'.
28083 For any other non-nil value, truncate lines in all windows that do
28084 not span the full frame width.
28086 A value of nil means to respect the value of `truncate-lines'.
28088 If `word-wrap' is enabled, you might want to reduce this. */);
28089 Vtruncate_partial_width_windows = make_number (50);
28091 DEFVAR_BOOL ("mode-line-inverse-video", mode_line_inverse_video,
28092 doc: /* When nil, display the mode-line/header-line/menu-bar in the default face.
28093 Any other value means to use the appropriate face, `mode-line',
28094 `header-line', or `menu' respectively. */);
28095 mode_line_inverse_video = 1;
28097 DEFVAR_LISP ("line-number-display-limit", Vline_number_display_limit,
28098 doc: /* *Maximum buffer size for which line number should be displayed.
28099 If the buffer is bigger than this, the line number does not appear
28100 in the mode line. A value of nil means no limit. */);
28101 Vline_number_display_limit = Qnil;
28103 DEFVAR_INT ("line-number-display-limit-width",
28104 line_number_display_limit_width,
28105 doc: /* *Maximum line width (in characters) for line number display.
28106 If the average length of the lines near point is bigger than this, then the
28107 line number may be omitted from the mode line. */);
28108 line_number_display_limit_width = 200;
28110 DEFVAR_BOOL ("highlight-nonselected-windows", highlight_nonselected_windows,
28111 doc: /* *Non-nil means highlight region even in nonselected windows. */);
28112 highlight_nonselected_windows = 0;
28114 DEFVAR_BOOL ("multiple-frames", multiple_frames,
28115 doc: /* Non-nil if more than one frame is visible on this display.
28116 Minibuffer-only frames don't count, but iconified frames do.
28117 This variable is not guaranteed to be accurate except while processing
28118 `frame-title-format' and `icon-title-format'. */);
28120 DEFVAR_LISP ("frame-title-format", Vframe_title_format,
28121 doc: /* Template for displaying the title bar of visible frames.
28122 \(Assuming the window manager supports this feature.)
28124 This variable has the same structure as `mode-line-format', except that
28125 the %c and %l constructs are ignored. It is used only on frames for
28126 which no explicit name has been set \(see `modify-frame-parameters'). */);
28128 DEFVAR_LISP ("icon-title-format", Vicon_title_format,
28129 doc: /* Template for displaying the title bar of an iconified frame.
28130 \(Assuming the window manager supports this feature.)
28131 This variable has the same structure as `mode-line-format' (which see),
28132 and is used only on frames for which no explicit name has been set
28133 \(see `modify-frame-parameters'). */);
28134 Vicon_title_format
28135 = Vframe_title_format
28136 = pure_cons (intern_c_string ("multiple-frames"),
28137 pure_cons (make_pure_c_string ("%b"),
28138 pure_cons (pure_cons (empty_unibyte_string,
28139 pure_cons (intern_c_string ("invocation-name"),
28140 pure_cons (make_pure_c_string ("@"),
28141 pure_cons (intern_c_string ("system-name"),
28142 Qnil)))),
28143 Qnil)));
28145 DEFVAR_LISP ("message-log-max", Vmessage_log_max,
28146 doc: /* Maximum number of lines to keep in the message log buffer.
28147 If nil, disable message logging. If t, log messages but don't truncate
28148 the buffer when it becomes large. */);
28149 Vmessage_log_max = make_number (100);
28151 DEFVAR_LISP ("window-size-change-functions", Vwindow_size_change_functions,
28152 doc: /* Functions called before redisplay, if window sizes have changed.
28153 The value should be a list of functions that take one argument.
28154 Just before redisplay, for each frame, if any of its windows have changed
28155 size since the last redisplay, or have been split or deleted,
28156 all the functions in the list are called, with the frame as argument. */);
28157 Vwindow_size_change_functions = Qnil;
28159 DEFVAR_LISP ("window-scroll-functions", Vwindow_scroll_functions,
28160 doc: /* List of functions to call before redisplaying a window with scrolling.
28161 Each function is called with two arguments, the window and its new
28162 display-start position. Note that these functions are also called by
28163 `set-window-buffer'. Also note that the value of `window-end' is not
28164 valid when these functions are called. */);
28165 Vwindow_scroll_functions = Qnil;
28167 DEFVAR_LISP ("window-text-change-functions",
28168 Vwindow_text_change_functions,
28169 doc: /* Functions to call in redisplay when text in the window might change. */);
28170 Vwindow_text_change_functions = Qnil;
28172 DEFVAR_LISP ("redisplay-end-trigger-functions", Vredisplay_end_trigger_functions,
28173 doc: /* Functions called when redisplay of a window reaches the end trigger.
28174 Each function is called with two arguments, the window and the end trigger value.
28175 See `set-window-redisplay-end-trigger'. */);
28176 Vredisplay_end_trigger_functions = Qnil;
28178 DEFVAR_LISP ("mouse-autoselect-window", Vmouse_autoselect_window,
28179 doc: /* *Non-nil means autoselect window with mouse pointer.
28180 If nil, do not autoselect windows.
28181 A positive number means delay autoselection by that many seconds: a
28182 window is autoselected only after the mouse has remained in that
28183 window for the duration of the delay.
28184 A negative number has a similar effect, but causes windows to be
28185 autoselected only after the mouse has stopped moving. \(Because of
28186 the way Emacs compares mouse events, you will occasionally wait twice
28187 that time before the window gets selected.\)
28188 Any other value means to autoselect window instantaneously when the
28189 mouse pointer enters it.
28191 Autoselection selects the minibuffer only if it is active, and never
28192 unselects the minibuffer if it is active.
28194 When customizing this variable make sure that the actual value of
28195 `focus-follows-mouse' matches the behavior of your window manager. */);
28196 Vmouse_autoselect_window = Qnil;
28198 DEFVAR_LISP ("auto-resize-tool-bars", Vauto_resize_tool_bars,
28199 doc: /* *Non-nil means automatically resize tool-bars.
28200 This dynamically changes the tool-bar's height to the minimum height
28201 that is needed to make all tool-bar items visible.
28202 If value is `grow-only', the tool-bar's height is only increased
28203 automatically; to decrease the tool-bar height, use \\[recenter]. */);
28204 Vauto_resize_tool_bars = Qt;
28206 DEFVAR_BOOL ("auto-raise-tool-bar-buttons", auto_raise_tool_bar_buttons_p,
28207 doc: /* *Non-nil means raise tool-bar buttons when the mouse moves over them. */);
28208 auto_raise_tool_bar_buttons_p = 1;
28210 DEFVAR_BOOL ("make-cursor-line-fully-visible", make_cursor_line_fully_visible_p,
28211 doc: /* *Non-nil means to scroll (recenter) cursor line if it is not fully visible. */);
28212 make_cursor_line_fully_visible_p = 1;
28214 DEFVAR_LISP ("tool-bar-border", Vtool_bar_border,
28215 doc: /* *Border below tool-bar in pixels.
28216 If an integer, use it as the height of the border.
28217 If it is one of `internal-border-width' or `border-width', use the
28218 value of the corresponding frame parameter.
28219 Otherwise, no border is added below the tool-bar. */);
28220 Vtool_bar_border = Qinternal_border_width;
28222 DEFVAR_LISP ("tool-bar-button-margin", Vtool_bar_button_margin,
28223 doc: /* *Margin around tool-bar buttons in pixels.
28224 If an integer, use that for both horizontal and vertical margins.
28225 Otherwise, value should be a pair of integers `(HORZ . VERT)' with
28226 HORZ specifying the horizontal margin, and VERT specifying the
28227 vertical margin. */);
28228 Vtool_bar_button_margin = make_number (DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_MARGIN);
28230 DEFVAR_INT ("tool-bar-button-relief", tool_bar_button_relief,
28231 doc: /* *Relief thickness of tool-bar buttons. */);
28232 tool_bar_button_relief = DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
28234 DEFVAR_LISP ("tool-bar-style", Vtool_bar_style,
28235 doc: /* Tool bar style to use.
28236 It can be one of
28237 image - show images only
28238 text - show text only
28239 both - show both, text below image
28240 both-horiz - show text to the right of the image
28241 text-image-horiz - show text to the left of the image
28242 any other - use system default or image if no system default. */);
28243 Vtool_bar_style = Qnil;
28245 DEFVAR_INT ("tool-bar-max-label-size", tool_bar_max_label_size,
28246 doc: /* *Maximum number of characters a label can have to be shown.
28247 The tool bar style must also show labels for this to have any effect, see
28248 `tool-bar-style'. */);
28249 tool_bar_max_label_size = DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_LABEL_SIZE;
28251 DEFVAR_LISP ("fontification-functions", Vfontification_functions,
28252 doc: /* List of functions to call to fontify regions of text.
28253 Each function is called with one argument POS. Functions must
28254 fontify a region starting at POS in the current buffer, and give
28255 fontified regions the property `fontified'. */);
28256 Vfontification_functions = Qnil;
28257 Fmake_variable_buffer_local (Qfontification_functions);
28259 DEFVAR_BOOL ("unibyte-display-via-language-environment",
28260 unibyte_display_via_language_environment,
28261 doc: /* *Non-nil means display unibyte text according to language environment.
28262 Specifically, this means that raw bytes in the range 160-255 decimal
28263 are displayed by converting them to the equivalent multibyte characters
28264 according to the current language environment. As a result, they are
28265 displayed according to the current fontset.
28267 Note that this variable affects only how these bytes are displayed,
28268 but does not change the fact they are interpreted as raw bytes. */);
28269 unibyte_display_via_language_environment = 0;
28271 DEFVAR_LISP ("max-mini-window-height", Vmax_mini_window_height,
28272 doc: /* *Maximum height for resizing mini-windows (the minibuffer and the echo area).
28273 If a float, it specifies a fraction of the mini-window frame's height.
28274 If an integer, it specifies a number of lines. */);
28275 Vmax_mini_window_height = make_float (0.25);
28277 DEFVAR_LISP ("resize-mini-windows", Vresize_mini_windows,
28278 doc: /* How to resize mini-windows (the minibuffer and the echo area).
28279 A value of nil means don't automatically resize mini-windows.
28280 A value of t means resize them to fit the text displayed in them.
28281 A value of `grow-only', the default, means let mini-windows grow only;
28282 they return to their normal size when the minibuffer is closed, or the
28283 echo area becomes empty. */);
28284 Vresize_mini_windows = Qgrow_only;
28286 DEFVAR_LISP ("blink-cursor-alist", Vblink_cursor_alist,
28287 doc: /* Alist specifying how to blink the cursor off.
28288 Each element has the form (ON-STATE . OFF-STATE). Whenever the
28289 `cursor-type' frame-parameter or variable equals ON-STATE,
28290 comparing using `equal', Emacs uses OFF-STATE to specify
28291 how to blink it off. ON-STATE and OFF-STATE are values for
28292 the `cursor-type' frame parameter.
28294 If a frame's ON-STATE has no entry in this list,
28295 the frame's other specifications determine how to blink the cursor off. */);
28296 Vblink_cursor_alist = Qnil;
28298 DEFVAR_BOOL ("auto-hscroll-mode", automatic_hscrolling_p,
28299 doc: /* Allow or disallow automatic horizontal scrolling of windows.
28300 If non-nil, windows are automatically scrolled horizontally to make
28301 point visible. */);
28302 automatic_hscrolling_p = 1;
28303 DEFSYM (Qauto_hscroll_mode, "auto-hscroll-mode");
28305 DEFVAR_INT ("hscroll-margin", hscroll_margin,
28306 doc: /* *How many columns away from the window edge point is allowed to get
28307 before automatic hscrolling will horizontally scroll the window. */);
28308 hscroll_margin = 5;
28310 DEFVAR_LISP ("hscroll-step", Vhscroll_step,
28311 doc: /* *How many columns to scroll the window when point gets too close to the edge.
28312 When point is less than `hscroll-margin' columns from the window
28313 edge, automatic hscrolling will scroll the window by the amount of columns
28314 determined by this variable. If its value is a positive integer, scroll that
28315 many columns. If it's a positive floating-point number, it specifies the
28316 fraction of the window's width to scroll. If it's nil or zero, point will be
28317 centered horizontally after the scroll. Any other value, including negative
28318 numbers, are treated as if the value were zero.
28320 Automatic hscrolling always moves point outside the scroll margin, so if
28321 point was more than scroll step columns inside the margin, the window will
28322 scroll more than the value given by the scroll step.
28324 Note that the lower bound for automatic hscrolling specified by `scroll-left'
28325 and `scroll-right' overrides this variable's effect. */);
28326 Vhscroll_step = make_number (0);
28328 DEFVAR_BOOL ("message-truncate-lines", message_truncate_lines,
28329 doc: /* If non-nil, messages are truncated instead of resizing the echo area.
28330 Bind this around calls to `message' to let it take effect. */);
28331 message_truncate_lines = 0;
28333 DEFVAR_LISP ("menu-bar-update-hook", Vmenu_bar_update_hook,
28334 doc: /* Normal hook run to update the menu bar definitions.
28335 Redisplay runs this hook before it redisplays the menu bar.
28336 This is used to update submenus such as Buffers,
28337 whose contents depend on various data. */);
28338 Vmenu_bar_update_hook = Qnil;
28340 DEFVAR_LISP ("menu-updating-frame", Vmenu_updating_frame,
28341 doc: /* Frame for which we are updating a menu.
28342 The enable predicate for a menu binding should check this variable. */);
28343 Vmenu_updating_frame = Qnil;
28345 DEFVAR_BOOL ("inhibit-menubar-update", inhibit_menubar_update,
28346 doc: /* Non-nil means don't update menu bars. Internal use only. */);
28347 inhibit_menubar_update = 0;
28349 DEFVAR_LISP ("wrap-prefix", Vwrap_prefix,
28350 doc: /* Prefix prepended to all continuation lines at display time.
28351 The value may be a string, an image, or a stretch-glyph; it is
28352 interpreted in the same way as the value of a `display' text property.
28354 This variable is overridden by any `wrap-prefix' text or overlay
28355 property.
28357 To add a prefix to non-continuation lines, use `line-prefix'. */);
28358 Vwrap_prefix = Qnil;
28359 DEFSYM (Qwrap_prefix, "wrap-prefix");
28360 Fmake_variable_buffer_local (Qwrap_prefix);
28362 DEFVAR_LISP ("line-prefix", Vline_prefix,
28363 doc: /* Prefix prepended to all non-continuation lines at display time.
28364 The value may be a string, an image, or a stretch-glyph; it is
28365 interpreted in the same way as the value of a `display' text property.
28367 This variable is overridden by any `line-prefix' text or overlay
28368 property.
28370 To add a prefix to continuation lines, use `wrap-prefix'. */);
28371 Vline_prefix = Qnil;
28372 DEFSYM (Qline_prefix, "line-prefix");
28373 Fmake_variable_buffer_local (Qline_prefix);
28375 DEFVAR_BOOL ("inhibit-eval-during-redisplay", inhibit_eval_during_redisplay,
28376 doc: /* Non-nil means don't eval Lisp during redisplay. */);
28377 inhibit_eval_during_redisplay = 0;
28379 DEFVAR_BOOL ("inhibit-free-realized-faces", inhibit_free_realized_faces,
28380 doc: /* Non-nil means don't free realized faces. Internal use only. */);
28381 inhibit_free_realized_faces = 0;
28383 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
28384 DEFVAR_BOOL ("inhibit-try-window-id", inhibit_try_window_id,
28385 doc: /* Inhibit try_window_id display optimization. */);
28386 inhibit_try_window_id = 0;
28388 DEFVAR_BOOL ("inhibit-try-window-reusing", inhibit_try_window_reusing,
28389 doc: /* Inhibit try_window_reusing display optimization. */);
28390 inhibit_try_window_reusing = 0;
28392 DEFVAR_BOOL ("inhibit-try-cursor-movement", inhibit_try_cursor_movement,
28393 doc: /* Inhibit try_cursor_movement display optimization. */);
28394 inhibit_try_cursor_movement = 0;
28395 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
28397 DEFVAR_INT ("overline-margin", overline_margin,
28398 doc: /* *Space between overline and text, in pixels.
28399 The default value is 2: the height of the overline (1 pixel) plus 1 pixel
28400 margin to the caracter height. */);
28401 overline_margin = 2;
28403 DEFVAR_INT ("underline-minimum-offset",
28404 underline_minimum_offset,
28405 doc: /* Minimum distance between baseline and underline.
28406 This can improve legibility of underlined text at small font sizes,
28407 particularly when using variable `x-use-underline-position-properties'
28408 with fonts that specify an UNDERLINE_POSITION relatively close to the
28409 baseline. The default value is 1. */);
28410 underline_minimum_offset = 1;
28412 DEFVAR_BOOL ("display-hourglass", display_hourglass_p,
28413 doc: /* Non-nil means show an hourglass pointer, when Emacs is busy.
28414 This feature only works when on a window system that can change
28415 cursor shapes. */);
28416 display_hourglass_p = 1;
28418 DEFVAR_LISP ("hourglass-delay", Vhourglass_delay,
28419 doc: /* *Seconds to wait before displaying an hourglass pointer when Emacs is busy. */);
28420 Vhourglass_delay = make_number (DEFAULT_HOURGLASS_DELAY);
28422 hourglass_atimer = NULL;
28423 hourglass_shown_p = 0;
28425 DEFSYM (Qglyphless_char, "glyphless-char");
28426 DEFSYM (Qhex_code, "hex-code");
28427 DEFSYM (Qempty_box, "empty-box");
28428 DEFSYM (Qthin_space, "thin-space");
28429 DEFSYM (Qzero_width, "zero-width");
28431 DEFSYM (Qglyphless_char_display, "glyphless-char-display");
28432 /* Intern this now in case it isn't already done.
28433 Setting this variable twice is harmless.
28434 But don't staticpro it here--that is done in alloc.c. */
28435 Qchar_table_extra_slots = intern_c_string ("char-table-extra-slots");
28436 Fput (Qglyphless_char_display, Qchar_table_extra_slots, make_number (1));
28438 DEFVAR_LISP ("glyphless-char-display", Vglyphless_char_display,
28439 doc: /* Char-table defining glyphless characters.
28440 Each element, if non-nil, should be one of the following:
28441 an ASCII acronym string: display this string in a box
28442 `hex-code': display the hexadecimal code of a character in a box
28443 `empty-box': display as an empty box
28444 `thin-space': display as 1-pixel width space
28445 `zero-width': don't display
28446 An element may also be a cons cell (GRAPHICAL . TEXT), which specifies the
28447 display method for graphical terminals and text terminals respectively.
28448 GRAPHICAL and TEXT should each have one of the values listed above.
28450 The char-table has one extra slot to control the display of a character for
28451 which no font is found. This slot only takes effect on graphical terminals.
28452 Its value should be an ASCII acronym string, `hex-code', `empty-box', or
28453 `thin-space'. The default is `empty-box'. */);
28454 Vglyphless_char_display = Fmake_char_table (Qglyphless_char_display, Qnil);
28455 Fset_char_table_extra_slot (Vglyphless_char_display, make_number (0),
28456 Qempty_box);
28460 /* Initialize this module when Emacs starts. */
28462 void
28463 init_xdisp (void)
28465 current_header_line_height = current_mode_line_height = -1;
28467 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos) = 0;
28469 if (!noninteractive)
28471 struct window *m = XWINDOW (minibuf_window);
28472 Lisp_Object frame = m->frame;
28473 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
28474 Lisp_Object root = FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f);
28475 struct window *r = XWINDOW (root);
28476 int i;
28478 echo_area_window = minibuf_window;
28480 XSETFASTINT (r->top_line, FRAME_TOP_MARGIN (f));
28481 XSETFASTINT (r->total_lines, FRAME_LINES (f) - 1 - FRAME_TOP_MARGIN (f));
28482 XSETFASTINT (r->total_cols, FRAME_COLS (f));
28483 XSETFASTINT (m->top_line, FRAME_LINES (f) - 1);
28484 XSETFASTINT (m->total_lines, 1);
28485 XSETFASTINT (m->total_cols, FRAME_COLS (f));
28487 scratch_glyph_row.glyphs[TEXT_AREA] = scratch_glyphs;
28488 scratch_glyph_row.glyphs[TEXT_AREA + 1]
28489 = scratch_glyphs + MAX_SCRATCH_GLYPHS;
28491 /* The default ellipsis glyphs `...'. */
28492 for (i = 0; i < 3; ++i)
28493 default_invis_vector[i] = make_number ('.');
28497 /* Allocate the buffer for frame titles.
28498 Also used for `format-mode-line'. */
28499 int size = 100;
28500 mode_line_noprop_buf = (char *) xmalloc (size);
28501 mode_line_noprop_buf_end = mode_line_noprop_buf + size;
28502 mode_line_noprop_ptr = mode_line_noprop_buf;
28503 mode_line_target = MODE_LINE_DISPLAY;
28506 help_echo_showing_p = 0;
28509 /* Since w32 does not support atimers, it defines its own implementation of
28510 the following three functions in w32fns.c. */
28511 #ifndef WINDOWSNT
28513 /* Platform-independent portion of hourglass implementation. */
28515 /* Return non-zero if houglass timer has been started or hourglass is shown. */
28517 hourglass_started (void)
28519 return hourglass_shown_p || hourglass_atimer != NULL;
28522 /* Cancel a currently active hourglass timer, and start a new one. */
28523 void
28524 start_hourglass (void)
28526 #if defined (HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM)
28527 EMACS_TIME delay;
28528 int secs, usecs = 0;
28530 cancel_hourglass ();
28532 if (INTEGERP (Vhourglass_delay)
28533 && XINT (Vhourglass_delay) > 0)
28534 secs = XFASTINT (Vhourglass_delay);
28535 else if (FLOATP (Vhourglass_delay)
28536 && XFLOAT_DATA (Vhourglass_delay) > 0)
28538 Lisp_Object tem;
28539 tem = Ftruncate (Vhourglass_delay, Qnil);
28540 secs = XFASTINT (tem);
28541 usecs = (XFLOAT_DATA (Vhourglass_delay) - secs) * 1000000;
28543 else
28544 secs = DEFAULT_HOURGLASS_DELAY;
28546 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (delay, secs, usecs);
28547 hourglass_atimer = start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, delay,
28548 show_hourglass, NULL);
28549 #endif
28553 /* Cancel the hourglass cursor timer if active, hide a busy cursor if
28554 shown. */
28555 void
28556 cancel_hourglass (void)
28558 #if defined (HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM)
28559 if (hourglass_atimer)
28561 cancel_atimer (hourglass_atimer);
28562 hourglass_atimer = NULL;
28565 if (hourglass_shown_p)
28566 hide_hourglass ();
28567 #endif
28569 #endif /* ! WINDOWSNT */